Mortgage Brokering in Ontario – Agent Edition - TENTH Edition Joseph J. White Copyright © 2008‐2016 by Joseph J. White. All rights reserved. Printed in Canada. No part of this publication may be reproduced or distributed in any form or by any means, or stored in a database or retrieval system, without the prior written permission of the author. ISBN 978‐1‐988049‐03‐8 031516 Most recent update: February, 2016 This publication is intended to provide accurate information at the time of publication regarding the mortgage industry in Ontario. Legal and other decisions related to financial transactions should be completed only after seeking advice from a competent professional person and should not be based on information contained herein. Neither the publisher nor the author is engaged in rendering legal or other professional advice. The events and characters in this book are fictitious. Any resemblance to persons, living or dead is purely coincidental. Acknowledgements I’ve been blessed to have worked with some of the industry’s top professionals who have both mentored me and shared with me their experience and knowledge over the years. In researching this book, I’ve relied on many different sources, which I’ve highlighted throughout. My special thanks to my editor, Susan Horne, for her patience, technical writing expertise, dedication and friendship. My thanks to all of the students of the Real Estate and Mortgage Institute of Canada Inc., Seneca College and the consortium of Ontario Colleges through Ontario Learn who have so richly enhanced my career, and who constantly challenge my knowledge and assumptions. Special thanks to the Ontario Real Estate Association for permission to use their agreement of purchase and sale form. Sincere thanks to all of my colleagues for their constant support, input and dedication to our industry. My thanks to my cover designer, Sana Zaidi for bringing a fresh new look to this book. Finally, I would like to thank my incredible wife Jennifer for her unwavering support. Without her I would not be the man I am today. About the Author Joseph J. White has been involved in the mortgage industry for over 22 years. He began his career as a mortgage agent, and in the mortgage lending sector of the industry he has held positions as National Sales Manager and VP of Sales with two national mortgage lenders, and has owned a mortgage investment corporation. In the industry’s mortgage brokering sector he is a licensed mortgage agent and has been a partner at a successful mortgage brokerage, principal broker at a commercial brokerage, and owner of his own boutique brokerage. As an educator, Mr. White has been educating the mortgage industry for over 14 years, was a professor and program coordinator at Seneca College and is currently President of the Real Estate and Mortgage Institute of Canada Inc. (REMIC). Mr. White has developed several courses for Seneca College as well as the mortgage agent and broker courses, written two textbooks used in the mortgage industry and by over 20 Ontario colleges, as well as several business focused books and e‐books. He has instructed over twelve thousand students and in 2003 won the Excellence Award for teaching and leadership excellence at Seneca College. He can be contacted at joe.white@remic.ca Table of Contents Acknowledgements ......................................................................................................................... iii About the Author ............................................................................................................................ iii I n t r o d u c t i o n ............................................................................................................................ 1 Chapter 1: Market Overview 3 Learning Outcomes ......................................................................................................................... 3 Introduction……… ............................................................................................................................ 3 1.1 A Career as a Mortgage Agent ............................................................................................... 3 Pause for clarification – term “mortgage agent” and “mortgage broker” ...................... 4 1.2 Key Participants ...................................................................................................................... 5 For your information… ..................................................................................................... 5 Success Tip – Real estate salespeople ............................................................................. 6 Pause for clarification – Loan to Value (also referred to as LTV)..................................... 7 1.3 History of the Mortgage Industry in Ontario ......................................................................... 8 1.4 Market Demographics and Trends ....................................................................................... 12 Population............................................................................................................................ 12 Size of the Mortgage Market ............................................................................................... 13 Characteristics of a Mortgage Agent’s Client ...................................................................... 13 The Average Canadian’s Credit Score .................................................................................. 17 Pause for clarification – Credit score ............................................................................. 17 1.5 The Commercial Mortgage Market ...................................................................................... 18 Success Tip – Commercial transactions ......................................................................... 20 1.6 Investing in Mortgages ......................................................................................................... 20 Private Lending .................................................................................................................... 20 Syndicated Mortgages ......................................................................................................... 21 Mortgages as Investments .................................................................................................. 21 Pause for clarification – Power of Sale .......................................................................... 22 Pause for clarification ‐ Discount ................................................................................... 23 Indirect Investing in Mortgages ........................................................................................... 24 1.7 Real Estate and Mortgage Institute of Canada Inc. (REMIC) ................................................ 24 1.8 Mortgage Associations and Professional Designations........................................................ 25 1.9 Choosing a Brokerage........................................................................................................... 25 1.10 Key Terms and Definitions ................................................................................................... 29 1.11 Review Questions ................................................................................................................. 34 Short Answer Questions ...................................................................................................... 34 Appendix 1: Schedule 1 Banks ....................................................................................................... 35 Appendix 2: Schedule 2 Banks ....................................................................................................... 36 Appendix 3: Schedule 3 Banks ....................................................................................................... 37 Chapter 2: Basic Mortgage Concepts 39 Learning Outcomes ....................................................................................................................... 39 Introduction………. ......................................................................................................................... 39 2.1 What is a Mortgage? ............................................................................................................ 40 Definition ............................................................................................................................. 40 Pause for clarification ‐ Title .......................................................................................... 40 2.2 Collateral Mortgages ............................................................................................................ 40 2.3 What is a Mortgage Agent/Broker? ..................................................................................... 41 2.4 The Mortgage Contract ........................................................................................................ 42 The Standard Charge Terms ................................................................................................ 42 Borrower Covenants ............................................................................................................ 42 Lender Covenants ................................................................................................................ 43 2.5 Mortgage Registration Documentation ............................................................................... 44 The Charge/Mortgage ......................................................................................................... 44 The Collateral Charge/Mortgage ......................................................................................... 46 The Discharge of Charge ...................................................................................................... 48 2.6 Mortgage Ranks ................................................................................................................... 50 2.7 Why is Mortgage Financing Needed? .................................................................................. 50 Pause for clarification – Down payment........................................................................ 51 Pause for clarification – Down payment requirements for insured mortgages ............ 51 2.8 The Purposes of Using a Mortgage ...................................................................................... 51 Purchase .............................................................................................................................. 51 Refinance ............................................................................................................................. 51 Success Tip – Home Buyer’s Program (HBP) .................................................................. 52 Success Tip – Home Buyer’s Tax Credit (HBTC) ............................................................. 52 Equity Take‐Out (ETO) ......................................................................................................... 52 Bridge Financing .................................................................................................................. 52 2.9 Conventional and High Ratio Mortgages ............................................................................. 53 High Ratio Mortgage ............................................................................................................ 53 Pause for clarification – Self‐insured lender .................................................................. 54 Conventional Mortgage ....................................................................................................... 54 2.10 Key Terms and Definitions ................................................................................................... 56 2.11 Review Questions ................................................................................................................. 58 Short Answer Questions ...................................................................................................... 58 Chapter 3: Advanced Mortgage Concepts 59 Learning Outcomes ....................................................................................................................... 59 3.1 Financial Components of a Mortgage .................................................................................. 59 The Face Value ..................................................................................................................... 59 The Term .............................................................................................................................. 59 The Amortization ................................................................................................................. 60 The Interest Rate ................................................................................................................. 60 The Compounding Frequency of the Interest Rate ............................................................. 60 Payment Amount ................................................................................................................. 60 3.2 Types of Mortgage Products ................................................................................................ 61 The Partially Amortized, Blended Constant Payment Mortgage – Fixed Rate .................... 61 The Partially Amortized, Blended Constant Payment Mortgage – Variable Rate ............... 62 Success Tip – Determining a borrower’s needs ............................................................. 66 The Partially Amortized, Blended Variable Payment Mortgage – Variable Rate ................ 66 The Interest Only Mortgage ................................................................................................ 66 For your information… Interest Rates ........................................................................... 67 The Home Equity Line of Credit (HELOC) ............................................................................. 68 The Interest Accruing Mortgage .......................................................................................... 69 The Reverse Mortgage......................................................................................................... 70 The Straight Line Principal Reduction Mortgage ................................................................. 70 The Graduated Payment Mortgage ..................................................................................... 71 3.3 Mortgage Options ................................................................................................................ 72 1. Prepayment Options ....................................................................................................... 72 a) Fully Open ....................................................................................................................... 72 b) Partially Open ................................................................................................................. 73 Calculating the Prepayment Penalty ............................................................................. 73 c) Closed Mortgage Prepayment Option ............................................................................ 73 Success Tip – Defining a “Closed Mortgage” ................................................................. 74 2. Repayment Options ........................................................................................................ 74 a) Periodic Payment Increase ............................................................................................. 75 b) Accelerated Mortgage Payment ..................................................................................... 76 Success Tip – Payment frequency.................................................................................. 79 c) Lump Sum Payments ...................................................................................................... 79 d) Extended Amortization ................................................................................................... 80 3. Cash Back Option ............................................................................................................ 81 4. Combined or Bundled Option ......................................................................................... 82 5. Portability Option ........................................................................................................... 83 6. Assumability Option........................................................................................................ 83 Key Terms and Definitions............................................................................................................. 85 3.4 Review Questions ................................................................................................................. 89 Short Answer Questions ...................................................................................................... 89 Chapter 4: Property Ownership in Ontario 90 Learning Outcomes ....................................................................................................................... 90 4.1 Property…… .......................................................................................................................... 90 4.2 4.3 4.4 4.5 4.6 4.7 4.8 4.9 Real Property ....................................................................................................................... 90 Personal Property ................................................................................................................ 90 Ownership… ......................................................................................................................... 90 Estates in Land...................................................................................................................... 90 Fee Simple Estate................................................................................................................. 90 Leasehold Estate .................................................................................................................. 91 Life Estate / Life Lease ......................................................................................................... 91 Success Tip – Life Estate / Life Lease ............................................................................. 92 Condominium Ownership .................................................................................................... 92 Encumbrances ...................................................................................................................... 92 Mortgages ............................................................................................................................ 92 Easements............................................................................................................................ 92 Restrictive Covenants .......................................................................................................... 93 Building Schemes ................................................................................................................. 93 Co‐Ownership of Real Property............................................................................................ 93 Tenancy in Common ............................................................................................................ 93 Joint Tenancy ....................................................................................................................... 94 Judgments and Liens ............................................................................................................ 94 Judgments ............................................................................................................................ 94 Liens ..................................................................................................................................... 95 Key Terms and Definitions ................................................................................................... 96 Review Questions ................................................................................................................. 98 Short Answer Questions ...................................................................................................... 98 Chapter 5: Regulation and Legislation 99 Learning Outcomes ....................................................................................................................... 99 Introduction……… .......................................................................................................................... 99 Pause for clarification – Disclosure ................................................................................ 99 Pause for clarification – Regulate ................................................................................ 100 5.1 The Regulator: FSCO .......................................................................................................... 100 The Commission ................................................................................................................ 100 Financial Services Tribunal (Tribunal) ................................................................................ 100 The Superintendent and Staff ........................................................................................... 100 Summary of the Act and Regulations ................................................................................ 101 5.2 Activities that are Regulated .............................................................................................. 102 5.3 Licensure….. ........................................................................................................................ 103 Pause for clarification – Licensure ............................................................................... 103 Four Licenses ..................................................................................................................... 104 Pause for clarification – Corporations, partnerships and sole proprietorships........... 104 Restrictions ........................................................................................................................ 104 Exemptions to Licensure.................................................................................................... 104 Pause for clarification – Vendor take‐back .................................................................. 105 Getting and Keeping a License........................................................................................... 105 Having a License Issued by FSCO ....................................................................................... 106 FSCO's Public Registry ........................................................................................................ 106 Prohibited Activities .......................................................................................................... 107 Pause for clarification – Prohibited activities .............................................................. 107 Compliance and Enforcement ........................................................................................... 107 Pause for clarification – Trust funds ............................................................................ 108 Pause for clarification – Administrative penalties ....................................................... 108 Having a License Suspended or Revoked by FSCO ............................................................ 109 5.4 The Mortgage Brokerage License ....................................................................................... 110 Licensing Requirements (Sections 1 – 3, Regulation 408/07) ........................................... 110 Pause for clarification – Errors and omissions insurance (E & O) ................................ 111 Pause for clarification – Principal broker ..................................................................... 111 Suitability for Licensing (Sections 1 – 3, Regulation 408/07) ............................................ 111 Standards of Practice (Regulation 188/08) ....................................................................... 112 Public Relations ................................................................................................................. 112 Complaints Process ............................................................................................................ 112 Customer Relations ........................................................................................................... 112 Return of Documents (Section 17, Regulation 188/08) .................................................... 113 Information about the Brokerage...................................................................................... 113 Fees and Payments ............................................................................................................ 113 Pause for clarification – Remuneration ....................................................................... 114 Duties in Particular Transactions ....................................................................................... 114 Disclosure .......................................................................................................................... 114 Policies and Procedures ..................................................................................................... 115 Record Keeping .................................................................................................................. 115 Pause for clarification – Trade completion date.......................................................... 115 Reverse Mortgages ............................................................................................................ 116 Compliance Review............................................................................................................ 116 5.5 The Mortgage Agent License .............................................................................................. 116 Standards of Practice ......................................................................................................... 117 5.6 The Mortgage Broker License............................................................................................ 118 5.7 The Principal Broker ........................................................................................................... 119 5.8 The Mortgage Administrator License ................................................................................. 119 5.9 Summary…. ......................................................................................................................... 120 5.10 External Resources ............................................................................................................. 120 5.11 Key Terms and Definitions ................................................................................................. 121 5.12 Review Questions ............................................................................................................... 126 True or False Questions ..................................................................................................... 126 Short Answer Questions .................................................................................................... 127 Appendix 1: FSCO Organization Chart as of November 23, 2015 .............................................. 128 Chapter 6: Transaction Overview 129 Learning Outcomes ..................................................................................................................... 129 Introduction………. ....................................................................................................................... 129 6.1 Who is the Client? .............................................................................................................. 129 6.2 The Role of the Mortgage Agent as Advisor ...................................................................... 130 Lender Expectations .......................................................................................................... 130 Borrower Expectations ...................................................................................................... 131 Success Tip – Act in the best interests of the client .................................................... 133 Success Tip – Service is the key ................................................................................... 133 Success Tip – Stay up to date on lender’s products .................................................... 134 Success Tip – Adopt the four borrower expectations ................................................. 135 6.3 The Steps in a Brokered Transaction .................................................................................. 135 Pause for clarification‐ Origination software............................................................... 136 Pause for clarification ‐ Appraisal ................................................................................ 136 Pause for clarification – Amortization schedule .......................................................... 137 6.4 Key Terms and Definitions ................................................................................................. 139 6.5 Review Questions ............................................................................................................... 141 Short Answer Questions .................................................................................................... 141 Chapter 7: Insurance in the Mortgage Industry 142 Learning Outcomes ..................................................................................................................... 142 Introduction……… ........................................................................................................................ 142 7.1 Mortgage Default Insurance .............................................................................................. 142 What is Mortgage Default Insurance? ............................................................................... 142 Background ........................................................................................................................ 142 How Mortgage Default Insurance Works .......................................................................... 143 Programs ............................................................................................................................ 144 CMHC ................................................................................................................................. 144 Success Tip – Purchase plus improvements program.................................................. 145 Genworth Financial............................................................................................................ 145 Canada Guaranty ............................................................................................................... 145 Default Management Programs (also known as “workout options”) ............................... 146 7.2 Mortgage Creditor and Life Insurance ............................................................................... 147 What is Mortgage Creditor Insurance? ............................................................................. 147 What is Life Insurance? ...................................................................................................... 148 Success Tip – Partner with a professional ................................................................... 149 7.3 7.4 7.5 7.6 7.7 What insurance is best for your Client? ............................................................................ 150 Property Insurance ............................................................................................................. 151 What is Property Insurance? ............................................................................................. 151 Why is it necessary? .......................................................................................................... 151 Types of Insurance ............................................................................................................. 151 Title Insurance .................................................................................................................... 154 What is Title Insurance? .................................................................................................... 154 Types of Policies ................................................................................................................ 154 Solicitor’s Opinion on Title vs. Title Insurance – A Comparison ........................................ 155 Pause for clarification – “Solicitor’s Opinion on Title” ................................................ 155 The Cost of Title Insurance ................................................................................................ 156 Making a Claim on a Title Insurance Policy ....................................................................... 156 The History of Title Insurance ............................................................................................ 156 Providers of Title Insurance ............................................................................................... 157 Success Tip – Suggest title insurance to your clients ................................................... 157 Errors and Omissions Insurance ......................................................................................... 158 What is Errors and Omissions insurance (E&O)? ............................................................... 158 Key Terms and Definitions ................................................................................................. 159 Review Questions ............................................................................................................... 165 Short Answer Questions .................................................................................................... 165 Chapter 8: Calculating a Mortgage Payment 166 Learning Outcomes ..................................................................................................................... 166 Introduction……… ........................................................................................................................ 166 8.1 The Components of a Mortgage Payment ......................................................................... 166 8.2 Configuring the HP10BII ..................................................................................................... 167 8.3 Interest Rates ..................................................................................................................... 170 Pause for clarification – Equivalent interest rates ....................................................... 172 8.4 Converting an Interest Rate with the HP10BII ................................................................... 172 Pause for clarification – “E” in your display ................................................................. 174 Pause for clarification – Rounding interest rates ........................................................ 174 8.5 Calculating a Mortgage Payment with the HP10BII ........................................................... 176 Pause for clarification – “BEGIN” in your display ........................................................ 178 Pause for clarification – Rounding a mortgage payment ............................................ 179 Success Tip ‐ N ............................................................................................................. 180 Pause for clarification – Term’s effect on a mortgage payment ................................. 180 8.6 Calculating an Interest Only Mortgage Payment ............................................................... 181 8.7 Using the SHARP EL‐738 ..................................................................................................... 182 8.8 Using the Texas Instruments BAII Plus ............................................................................... 185 8.9 Advanced Mortgage Calculations....................................................................................... 188 Accelerating a Mortgage ................................................................................................... 188 Pause for clarification – Using the “+/‐“ Key ............................................................... 188 Calculating the Outstanding Balance (OSB) of a Mortgage ............................................... 189 Pause for clarification – Important note about the HP10BII + .................................... 189 Pause for clarification ‐ Rounding outstanding balances ............................................ 190 Calculating the prepayment penalty on a partially open mortgage.................................. 193 3 Months’ Interest Penalty ................................................................................................ 193 Interest Rate Differential ................................................................................................... 194 8.10 Conclusion… ....................................................................................................................... 194 Success Tip – Practice! ................................................................................................. 195 8.11 Key Terms and Definitions ................................................................................................. 196 8.12 Review Questions ............................................................................................................... 198 Short Answer Questions .................................................................................................... 198 Chapter 9: Attracting a Client 199 Learning Outcomes ..................................................................................................................... 199 Introduction……… ........................................................................................................................ 199 9.1 The Impact of Regulation and Legislation ............................................................................. 200 The Canadian Code of Advertising Standards ................................................................... 200 Pause for clarification – Advertising Standards Canada .............................................. 202 Legislation .......................................................................................................................... 202 Public Relations Materials: Agents and Brokers ................................................................ 202 Pause for clarification – Examples of public relations materials ................................. 202 Public Relations Materials: Mortgage Brokerages ............................................................ 203 Misleading, Deceptive and False Advertising .................................................................... 204 Advertising Tips – Competition Bureau of Canada ............................................................ 206 9.2 Business Development for Mortgage Agents ........................................................................ 207 Mission and Vision Statements ......................................................................................... 207 Business Cards ................................................................................................................... 208 Unique Forms of Business Cards ....................................................................................... 209 Success Tip – Business cards ........................................................................................ 210 Networking ........................................................................................................................ 210 Success Tip ‐ Networking ............................................................................................. 211 The Marketing/Advertising of Intangibles or Services ...................................................... 211 Marketing: the Art of Differentiation ................................................................................ 212 Success Tip – Make the phone ring! ............................................................................ 214 Database Marketing .......................................................................................................... 214 Referrals............................................................................................................................. 215 Success Tip – Getting family and friends’ mortgages .................................................. 215 9.3 Key Terms and Definitions ..................................................................................................... 216 9.4 Review Questions .................................................................................................................. 218 Short Answer Questions .................................................................................................... 218 Chapter 10: First Contact 219 Learning Outcomes ..................................................................................................................... 219 Introduction……… ........................................................................................................................ 219 10.1 The Initial Telephone Call .................................................................................................... 219 Pause for clarification – Call scripts ............................................................................. 220 10.2 Incoming Call Script ............................................................................................................. 221 Tips for Success .................................................................................................................. 223 10.3 Outgoing Cold Call Script for Referrals ................................................................................ 224 Pause for clarification – Cold calls ............................................................................... 224 10.4 Key Terms and Definitions ................................................................................................... 226 10.5 Review Questions ................................................................................................................ 227 Short Answer Questions .................................................................................................... 227 Chapter 11: The Initial Consultation 228 Learning Outcomes ..................................................................................................................... 228 Introduction……… ........................................................................................................................ 228 11.1 Required Documentation .................................................................................................... 228 Documentation for all Transactions .................................................................................. 229 Specific Documentation for a Purchase............................................................................. 229 Specific documentation for a Refinance, Equity take‐Out and Switch .............................. 230 11.2 File Creation......................................................................................................................... 230 File Checklist ...................................................................................................................... 230 File Worksheet ................................................................................................................... 232 Success Tip – Is your client working with someone else? ........................................... 233 11.3 Meeting the Client ............................................................................................................... 233 First Impressions ................................................................................................................ 233 Pause for clarification – Open‐ended question ........................................................... 234 The Client’s Home .............................................................................................................. 234 Pause for clarification – Decision‐maker ..................................................................... 234 The Mortgage Agent’s Office ............................................................................................. 235 Another Outside Location.................................................................................................. 235 11.4 Identity Verification ............................................................................................................. 235 11.5 The Application Form .......................................................................................................... 236 Section‐by‐Section Application Analysis ............................................................................ 239 Pause for clarification – Co‐applicants and guarantors ............................................... 240 Tips for a Complete Application ........................................................................................ 246 11.6 Determining the Applicant’s Needs .................................................................................... 246 11.7 Key Terms and Definitions ................................................................................................... 249 11.8 Review Questions ................................................................................................................ 251 Short Answer Questions .................................................................................................... 251 Chapter 12: Application Analysis – Borrower Documents 252 Learning Outcomes ..................................................................................................................... 252 Introduction……… ........................................................................................................................ 252 12.1 Fraud and Forgery .............................................................................................................. 252 12.2 Income Documentation...................................................................................................... 253 T4A ..................................................................................................................................... 253 Success Tip ‐ SIN........................................................................................................... 255 T4.. ..................................................................................................................................... 256 Success Tip – EI premiums ........................................................................................... 259 Success Tip – Income tax rates .................................................................................... 260 Job Letter ........................................................................................................................... 261 Paystub .............................................................................................................................. 264 Notice of Assessment (NOA) ............................................................................................. 266 Business License ................................................................................................................ 267 Financial Statements ......................................................................................................... 268 12.3 Property Documentation ................................................................................................... 271 Multiple Listing Service (MLS) ........................................................................................... 271 Agreement of Purchase and Sale....................................................................................... 272 12.4 Other Documentation ........................................................................................................ 278 Gift Letter........................................................................................................................... 278 Property Assessment ......................................................................................................... 279 Mortgage Statement ......................................................................................................... 281 Tax Bill ................................................................................................................................ 283 Condominium Status Certificate........................................................................................ 284 Sample Status Certificate................................................................................................... 284 Certificate of Independent Legal Advice (ILA) ................................................................... 287 Sample Certificate of Independent Legal Advice............................................................... 287 Creditor Insurance Application .......................................................................................... 288 Success Tip – Answer honestly in the creditor insurance application ......................... 288 Sample Creditor Insurance Application ............................................................................. 289 12.5 Summary…. ......................................................................................................................... 292 12.6 Key Terms and Definitions ................................................................................................. 293 12.7 Review Questions ............................................................................................................... 295 Short Answer Questions .................................................................................................... 295 Chapter 13: Application Analysis – Application Ratios 299 Learning Outcomes ..................................................................................................................... 299 Introduction……… ........................................................................................................................ 299 13.1 Loan to Value Ratio (LTV) ................................................................................................... 299 Pause for clarification – The “/” character .................................................................. 300 Calculating the LTV of a 1st Mortgage ................................................................................ 300 Pause for clarification – Converting decimals to percentages .................................... 300 Pause for clarification – “E” in your display ................................................................. 301 Calculating the LTV of a 2nd Mortgage ............................................................................. 301 Calculating the LTV of Additional Mortgages .................................................................... 302 Using the LTV to Calculate a Maximum Mortgage Amount .............................................. 302 13.2 Gross Debt Service (GDS) and Total Debt Service (TDS) Ratios.......................................... 303 Calculating the Gross Debt Service Ratio (GDS) ................................................................ 303 The Components of GDS .................................................................................................... 304 Pause for clarification – Frequency of payments in GDS ............................................. 305 Success Tip – If GDS is above industry standard .......................................................... 306 GDS and Second Mortgages .............................................................................................. 306 Calculating the Total Debt Service Ratio (TDS): Pre‐Qualifying ......................................... 307 Success Tip – Outstanding balance or credit limit in the TDS? .................................... 308 Calculating the Total Debt Service Ratio (TDS): Verifying ................................................. 310 Success Tip – If TDS is above industry standard .......................................................... 310 13.3 Calculating the Maximum Mortgage Amount.................................................................... 311 13.4 LTV, GDS and TDS Quick Reference Guide ......................................................................... 312 13.5 Key Terms and Definitions ................................................................................................. 313 13.6 Review Questions ............................................................................................................... 314 Chapter 14: Application Analysis – Borrower Credit 316 Learning Outcomes ..................................................................................................................... 316 Introduction……… ........................................................................................................................ 316 14.1 Credit Bureaus .................................................................................................................... 316 14.2 Credit Reports .................................................................................................................... 317 Sample Credit Report Provided to Consumers .................................................................. 317 Sample Credit Report Provided to Equifax Members........................................................ 319 Equifax Credit Report Legend ............................................................................................ 324 Trade Information Descriptions......................................................................................... 327 Trade Information Ratings ................................................................................................. 328 Credit Rating Examples ...................................................................................................... 328 Equifax Glossary of Terms Used in a Credit Report ........................................................... 329 Interpreting a Credit Report .............................................................................................. 330 Success Tip – Question discrepancies .......................................................................... 332 Success Tip ‐ Collections .............................................................................................. 334 Success Tip ‐ Notes ...................................................................................................... 335 Success Tip – Questioning credit issues ....................................................................... 336 14.3 Credit Scores and Analysis.................................................................................................. 337 Understanding a Credit Score ............................................................................................ 337 Items that affect a Credit Score ......................................................................................... 339 14.4 Key Terms and Definitions ................................................................................................. 341 14.5 Review Questions ............................................................................................................... 343 Short Answer Questions .................................................................................................... 343 Chapter 15: Application Analysis – The Property 344 Learning Outcomes ..................................................................................................................... 344 Introduction……… ........................................................................................................................ 344 15.1 Appraisal Basics .................................................................................................................. 344 The Appraiser..................................................................................................................... 344 Accreditations .................................................................................................................... 345 The Appraisal ..................................................................................................................... 346 The Value of a Property ..................................................................................................... 347 15.2 Calculating the Market Value of a Property ....................................................................... 347 Pause for clarification – The number of comparables ................................................. 349 15.3 The Types of Appraisals ...................................................................................................... 350 Desktop Appraisal (also referred to as a Sales Data Report) ............................................ 350 Drive‐by Appraisal ............................................................................................................. 350 Full Appraisal ..................................................................................................................... 351 15.4 Key Terms and Definitions ................................................................................................. 360 15.5 Review Questions ............................................................................................................... 362 Short Answer Questions .................................................................................................... 362 Chapter 16: Choosing a Lender 363 Learning Outcomes ..................................................................................................................... 363 Introduction……… ........................................................................................................................ 363 16.1 Types of Lenders ................................................................................................................ 363 Prime Mortgage Lending ................................................................................................... 364 Sub‐Prime Mortgage Lending (also referred to as “Self‐Insured” Lending) ...................... 364 The Private Mortgage Market ........................................................................................... 365 Success Tip – Sub‐prime lenders ................................................................................. 365 16.2 Understanding Lender Guidelines ...................................................................................... 365 Product Sheets ................................................................................................................... 366 Rate Sheets ........................................................................................................................ 367 Success Tip – If you’re unsure...................................................................................... 367 16.3 Choosing a Lender .............................................................................................................. 368 Pause for clarification – Loyalty or points program..................................................... 368 16.4 Key Terms and Definitions ................................................................................................. 369 16.5 Review Questions ............................................................................................................... 371 Short Answer Questions .................................................................................................... 371 Chapter 17: Submitting the Application and Obtaining a Commitment 372 Learning Outcomes ..................................................................................................................... 372 Introduction……… ........................................................................................................................ 372 Success Tip – Only submit to one lender ..................................................................... 372 17.1 Submitting the Application................................................................................................. 373 17.2 Investor/Lender Disclosure ................................................................................................ 374 What Must be Disclosed .................................................................................................... 374 How Disclosure Must be Made.......................................................................................... 377 When Disclosure Must be Made ....................................................................................... 377 The Investor/Lender Disclosure Statement for Brokered Transactions ............................ 378 17.3 The Commitment Letter ..................................................................................................... 392 Success Tip –Double check the commitment letter .................................................... 392 17.4 A Declined Application ....................................................................................................... 396 17.5 Key Terms and Definitions ................................................................................................. 397 Conditions 397 UFFI (Urea formaldehyde foam insulation) 397 17.6 Review Questions ............................................................................................................... 398 Short Answer Questions .................................................................................................... 398 Chapter 18: Borrower Disclosure 399 Learning Outcomes ..................................................................................................................... 399 Introduction……… ........................................................................................................................ 399 18.1 Amendments To Ontario Regulations – January, 2016 ...................................................... 400 18.2 Completing the Borrower Disclosure Document ............................................................... 401 What Must be Disclosed .................................................................................................... 401 1. Fees and payments associated with the mortgage................................................ 401 Pause for clarification – Fees are not regulated .......................................................... 401 2. The relationship between the brokerage and lender under the proposed mortgage…………………………………………………………………………………………………………………402 3. The role of the brokerage ...................................................................................... 403 4. The number of lenders the brokerage represented during the previous year ...... 403 5. Potential Conflicts of interest................................................................................. 404 Pause for clarification – Conflict of interest ................................................................ 404 6. Risks associated with the proposed mortgage ...................................................... 404 7. Terms and conditions of the proposed mortgage ................................................. 406 18.3 18.4 18.5 18.6 18.7 18.8 8. Estimated costs ...................................................................................................... 407 9. The cost of borrowing ............................................................................................ 407 Pause for clarification – The cost of borrowing: dollars and cents ............................. 407 Pause for clarification – Calculating the APR/cost of borrowing ................................. 408 Cost of Borrowing/APR – Included and Excluded Items .................................................... 408 Disclosure under Specific Circumstances .......................................................................... 409 1. Disclosure ‐ Fixed interest mortgage for a fixed amount....................................... 409 2. Disclosure ‐ Variable interest mortgage for a fixed amount .................................. 410 3. Disclosure ‐ Line of credit ....................................................................................... 411 4. Disclosure ‐ Credit card applications ...................................................................... 412 5. Disclosure ‐ Credit cards ......................................................................................... 413 How Disclosure Must be Made.......................................................................................... 414 When Disclosure Must be Made ....................................................................................... 414 Pause for clarification – What disclosure documents must be given to the borrower?....................................................................................................................414 Sample Borrower Disclosure .............................................................................................. 414 Borrower Disclosure Checklist............................................................................................ 423 Summary….. ........................................................................................................................ 424 Key Terms and Definitions ................................................................................................. 425 SAMPLE BORROWER DISCLOSURE ‐ FILOGIX ..................................................................... 426 Review Questions ............................................................................................................... 428 True or False Questions ..................................................................................................... 428 Short Answer Questions .................................................................................................... 428 Chapter 19: Closing the Transaction 429 Learning Outcomes ..................................................................................................................... 429 Introduction……… ........................................................................................................................ 429 19.1 Estimating Closing Costs ..................................................................................................... 429 Common Closing Costs ...................................................................................................... 429 Success Tip – Closing Cost Worksheet ......................................................................... 434 19.2 Electronic Land Registration............................................................................................... 434 19.3 The Closing Process ............................................................................................................ 435 Pause for clarification ‐ Subsearch .............................................................................. 437 19.4 The Interest Adjustment Date (IAD) ................................................................................... 438 19.5 Key Terms and Definitions ................................................................................................. 443 19.6 Review Questions ............................................................................................................... 444 Short Answer Questions .................................................................................................... 444 Appendix 1: Acknowledgment and Direction .............................................................................. 445 Appendix 2: Document Registration Agreement (DRA) .............................................................. 447 Appendix 3: Closing Costs Worksheet ......................................................................................... 449 Chapter 20: Contract Law 450 Learning Outcomes ..................................................................................................................... 450 Introduction……… ........................................................................................................................ 450 20.1 What is a Contract? ............................................................................................................ 450 Pause for clarification – Real estate contracts must be in writing .............................. 451 20.2 The Elements of a Valid Contract ....................................................................................... 451 The Offer ............................................................................................................................ 451 Acceptance of the Offer .................................................................................................... 451 Intention to Create a Legal Relationship ........................................................................... 452 The Legal Capacity to Enter into a Contract ...................................................................... 452 Legality Requirements ....................................................................................................... 452 Exchange of Consideration ................................................................................................ 453 20.3 Contractual Defects ............................................................................................................ 453 Misrepresentation ............................................................................................................. 453 Duress ................................................................................................................................ 454 Undue Influence ................................................................................................................ 454 Unconscionable Acts.......................................................................................................... 454 Mistake .............................................................................................................................. 454 Mistake of Law ............................................................................................................. 454 Mistake of Fact ............................................................................................................ 454 The Parties to a Mistake .............................................................................................. 454 20.4 Contractual Rights .............................................................................................................. 455 Privity of Contract .............................................................................................................. 455 Vicarious Performance ...................................................................................................... 455 Assignment ........................................................................................................................ 456 20.5 Discharging a Contract ....................................................................................................... 456 Performance ...................................................................................................................... 456 Agreement ......................................................................................................................... 457 Waiver .......................................................................................................................... 457 Material Alterations ..................................................................................................... 457 Right ................................................................................................................................... 458 Option to Terminate .................................................................................................... 458 Condition Precedent .................................................................................................... 458 Condition Subsequent ................................................................................................. 458 Frustration ......................................................................................................................... 458 Operation of Law ............................................................................................................... 459 20.6 Breach of Contract and Contractual Remedies .................................................................. 459 Damages ............................................................................................................................ 459 Specific Performance ......................................................................................................... 459 Substantial Performance ................................................................................................... 459 Quantum Meruit ................................................................................................................ 460 Injunction ........................................................................................................................... 460 Rescission........................................................................................................................... 460 20.7 Key Terms and Definitions ................................................................................................. 461 20.8 Review Questions ............................................................................................................... 464 Short Answer Questions .................................................................................................... 464 Chapter 21: Mortgage Remedies 465 Learning Outcomes ..................................................................................................................... 465 Introduction………. ....................................................................................................................... 465 21.1 Power of Sale ...................................................................................................................... 465 Power of Sale Process ........................................................................................................ 466 21.2 Foreclosure and other Remedies ....................................................................................... 469 Foreclosure ........................................................................................................................ 469 Other Remedies ................................................................................................................. 469 Working with the Lender ................................................................................................... 470 Success Tip – If your client is about to miss a payment... ........................................... 470 21.3 Key Terms and Definitions ................................................................................................. 471 21.4 Review Questions ............................................................................................................... 472 Short Answer Questions .................................................................................................... 472 Chapter 22: Mortgage Fraud 473 Learning Outcomes ..................................................................................................................... 473 22.1 What is Mortgage Fraud? ................................................................................................... 473 22.2 Types of Mortgage Fraud ................................................................................................... 474 Fraud for Criminal Activities .............................................................................................. 474 Fraud for Profit .................................................................................................................. 475 Fraud for Shelter ................................................................................................................ 478 22.3 The Impact of Mortgage Fraud .......................................................................................... 480 22.4 Fraud Prevention ................................................................................................................ 480 Steps in Fraud Prevention.................................................................................................. 480 Fraud Warning Signs .......................................................................................................... 481 22.5 The Land Titles Assurance Fund ......................................................................................... 482 22.6 Advice for Clients................................................................................................................ 482 22.7 Key Terms and Definitions ................................................................................................. 485 22.8 Review Questions ............................................................................................................... 487 Short Answer Questions .................................................................................................... 487 Chapter 23: Ethics and Mortgage Brokering 488 Learning Outcomes ..................................................................................................................... 488 Introduction……… ........................................................................................................................ 488 23.1 What is Ethics? ................................................................................................................... 488 23.2 The Core Values and Beliefs of the Mortgage Industry ..................................................... 488 Borrower Expectations ...................................................................................................... 489 Lender Expectations .......................................................................................................... 489 23.3 The Decision Making Model ............................................................................................... 490 23.4 Case Study 1 ....................................................................................................................... 492 23.5 Case Study 2 ....................................................................................................................... 494 23.6 Conclusion… ....................................................................................................................... 496 23.7 Key Terms and Definitions ................................................................................................. 497 23.8 Review Questions ............................................................................................................... 498 Short Answer Questions .................................................................................................... 498 Case Study 499 Scenario and Supporting Documents………………………………………………………………………………………499 Case Study 1 Questions ..................................................................................................... 512 Section One: Complete the Mortgage Application Form ........................................... 512 Section Two: Short Answer Questions........................................................................ 514 Section Three: Borrower Disclosure ............................................................................ 515 Section Four: Financial Calculations ........................................................................... 516 Case Study 1 Answer Guide ............................................................................................... 521 Section One: Complete the Mortgage Application Form ........................................... 521 Section Two: Short Answer Questions........................................................................ 523 Section Three: Borrower Disclosure ............................................................................ 524 Section Four: Financial Calculations ........................................................................... 525 Table of Figures…......................................................................................................................... 527 Index ………………………………………………………………………………………………………………………………………530 Introduction 1 Introduction Welcome to the exciting world of mortgage brokering! This book, the updated edition of the last publication of Mortgage Brokering in Ontario – Agent Edition, has been written to assist you in meeting the educational requirements to become licensed as a mortgage agent in Ontario. Since the publication of the First Edition, the new Mortgage Brokerages, lenders and Administrators Act, 2006 (while 2006 is part of the legislation’s title, it actually didn’t come into effect until 2008) also referred to as the MBLAA has been fully enacted, with the last piece of legislation coming into effect as of January 1, 2009. There have been several significant changes, all reflected in this book, to brokering in this province, such as changes to disclosure requirements for borrowers and Investors, marketing and the use of specific titles by brokers and agents, to name but a few. The MBLAA also raises the bar for both consumer protection and professionalism in the industry by promoting appropriate training as well as the licensing of mortgage agents to meet both the regulator’s and the industry’s demand for quality professionals to service the mortgage market. In addition, the industry has undergone significant changes. It has survived the mortgage crisis, experienced regulatory changes that have impacted how Ontarians borrow, and have seen market participants leave the industry while new ones have entered it. The one constant in our industry, as in life, is change. Change can have a positive or negative impact, depending on how we respond to it. To be successful you will have to surpass the minimum requirements for licensing and learn how to respond to the industry’s changes, and that’s where additional, practical, real life information in this book will be of great interest to you! I have organized this book in a way that prepares you to complete a mortgage transaction to a professional standard. To assist you further, I’ve added “Success Tips” throughout. These are designed to provide you practical success strategies that I have gathered from my own years of experience as well as those of my friends and colleagues in the industry. When new terms are introduced I’ve added “Pause for clarification,” designed to quickly define the new term. The opportunities in this industry are endless – the mortgage brokerage industry has many diverse participants and offers those involved incredible opportunities for long, rewarding careers. My own career has spanned over two decades, including positions on both the brokering and lending sides, with both brokerages and lenders. Having begun as a mortgage agent, I went on to manage mortgage agents for two large brokerages. I’ve been a partner in a brokerage and held the positions of Vice President of Sales and National Sales Manager for two national lenders. I’ve owned a Mortgage Investment Corporation (MIC) and an Administration company and am now President of the Real Estate and Mortgage Institute of Canada Inc. In addition, I spent twelve years at Seneca College as an Instructor, Part‐time Program Coordinator and developed both the mortgage agent and mortgage agent courses for licensing purposes in Ontario. The need for mortgage agents has never been greater! There are more lenders than ever before, even with the recent economic crisis, but the public has little or no knowledge of them. To illustrate this point, take a moment to list the names of all of the lenders that you know or have heard about. How many can you think of? In fact, there are dozens of lenders in the Canadian mortgage market. This incredible number of lenders provides consumers with an 2 Introduction overwhelming array of choice for their mortgage financing, and yet the majority of consumers are unaware of them. The typical consumer needs the assistance of a knowledgeable and skilled advisor to find a suitable product from among the various options available. In many cases consumers require “non‐conventional” lending ‐ unique, innovative products that serve their particular needs. Again, the consumer needs a professional mortgage agent with knowledge of and access to these products. Fraud is a growing concern. The professional mortgage agent must be trained to be alert to “red flags” – indicators of potential fraud. Fraud has no place in an industry with professional standards. By acquiring and maintaining clear personal standards and ethical values, professionals ensure that the industry continues to be held in high regard by consumers. The professional mortgage agent plays a key role in ensuring a healthy future for the whole industry. It is my hope that this text will provide you valuable insights into the mortgage brokerage industry and will continue to serve as a practical reference guide which will be of benefit on an ongoing basis. I firmly believe that every consumer, not just those who have been declined by their institution, should use a qualified mortgage agent or agent. I have had the honour and pleasure of working with and managing some of the most professional and ethical agents in our industry. They have acted and continue to act as ambassadors on our behalf, increasing the public’s awareness and respect of our industry. While the regulatory requirements discussed throughout this text will help raise the standards of professionalism for our industry as a whole, regulation is not the sole answer. In my opinion, to increase market penetration from the current level of approximately 30% requires a change in the public’s attitude about our industry. Every broker and agent who acts with the highest levels of integrity, ethics and professionalism is an ambassador for our industry, increasing consumer confidence in our abilities and reinforcing the belief that we are here to serve them, not ourselves. Unfortunately every broker and agent who acts unethically or unprofessionally tarnishes the reputation of the industry as a whole. Simply stated, there is no place in our industry for those who would tarnish our reputation by taking advantage of the public. Brokerages and lenders must continue to have and expand upon top down philosophies that reward ethical and professional behaviour and raise the standard of professionalism above what the MBLAA, its Regulations and the regulator require. In so doing our industry will shatter that 30% ceiling, an event that is long overdue. Joseph J. White Chapter 1: Market Overview 3 Chapter 1: Market Overview Learning Outcomes Successful understanding of the concepts presented in this chapter will enable the learner to: Describe the potential of a career as a mortgage agent List and describe the key participants in Ontario’s mortgage market Discuss the history of the mortgage industry in Ontario Discuss the market demographics and trends that affect the Ontario mortgage market Define the commercial mortgage market and explain the differences between it and the residential mortgage market Explain the private lending market Discuss the benefits and challenges of investing in mortgages Explain the different methods of investing in mortgages Explain the role of the Real Estate and Mortgage Institute of Canada Inc. List and describe the different mortgage associations operating in Ontario List and describe the different professional designations awarded by the mortgage associations in Ontario Introduction The Ontario mortgage market is a vast and diverse industry comprised of dozens of lenders and other key participants in the mortgage process. The following sections will break down the market into its different segments and attempt to provide context for the financing activities in the province. Of course to understand the market, the main participants in the market must be discussed, which brings us to our first section. 1.1 A Career as a Mortgage Agent A career as a mortgage agent can be both financially and personally rewarding. As the individual responsible for bringing borrowers and lenders together, you will typically be compensated by the lender in the form of a finder’s fee or commission based on a number of basis points (bps) multiplied by the amount of the mortgage. In other cases, where you are dealing with a borrower who doesn’t qualify with a traditional lender, you may arrange the mortgage with a private lender. In this case you would charge the borrower a brokerage fee that would be deducted directly from the mortgage proceeds. While the role of the mortgage agent will be discussed in more detail later, it is useful to discuss the potential income of a mortgage agent so that you have a clearer picture of the potential earnings attainable should you decide to make this your career. First, it is important to be mindful of the fact that your role is to always do what is in the best interests of your clients, while being concerned with your own income last. In this way you will always be conducting yourself in a professional and ethical manner. 4 Chapterr 1: Market O verview Pa ause for cla arification n – term “m mortgage a agent” and “mortga age broker” In Ontario there e are two lice enses that allo ow individualls to broker a mortgage: m mortgage agent and morttgage broker. The differen nce between these two liccenses is that a mortgage broker, in addittion to being able to broke er mortgages,, can also be tthe Principal Broker of a mo ortgage broke erage. Each mortgage m bro okerage must have one Priincipal Broker to ensure thaat the brokerrage, its agentts and brokerrs comply witth the approp priate legislatiion and reggulations. w can take a look at a typ pical transactiion. The typical finder’s feee or With this in mind we comm mission paid by b lenders in today’s t marke etplace is 85 basis points ((.85%), which h is referred to as 85 bps. If you have h arranged d a mortgage in the amounnt of $300,0000, then your brokerage would d be paid a fin nder’s fee of 85bps 8 x $300 0,000, or .00885 x 300,000 w which equals $2,550. Mortggage agents work w on a com mmission split with their bbrokerage. Fo or experienceed mortgage agentts the split can be, on averrage, 85/15 (the agent receeives 85% of the commission). This would d equate to a commission payable to yo ou of $2,167. 50. For new mortgage agents the splitt will tyypically be lesss until the brrokerage has determined tthat the agen nt has gained an appro opriate level of o experience e. The average transaaction will takke approximaately 6 hours tto complete (this is an aveerage; some will be e longer while others shorrter and this amount a of tim me is typicallyy spread overr several dayss). By divviding the com mmission by the t number of o hours ($2,1167.50 / 6) wee can determ mine that you would d have earned d $361.25 per hour for this transaction . If an agent were to averrage 1 transaaction per day, his or her income would d be approxim mately $520,2200 per year ($2,167.50 x 20 business days per p month x 12 1 months). Now that t we’ve discussed the upper u end of an agent’s in come potenttial, let’s discu uss the realityy for ne ew agents. A new w agent will tyypically not have an incom me for the firs t three months of his or her career. It takes time to find clients, then it takes time to close or fuund the transaaction, follow wed by receivving your com mmission. A new n agent sho ould expect tto see an inco ome after thee first three months, and shoulld be, given in ndustry averaages, aiming ffor 3 funded ttransactions p per month att the en nd of his or her first year. An average of o 3 fundings per month w would equal an income of $78,0 030 per year. Of course these are only averagges. A highly successful aggent may earn n substantiallly more than this amount in his or her first ye ear, while ano other agent m may earn subsstantially lesss. As you continue on n your new caareer path as a mortgage aagent it is important to no ote that manyy agentts earn six figu ure incomes while w others do d not; the p otential is dirrectly related d to the time, effortt and expertisse, among oth her factors, of the agent. As you can see, thiis can be an extremely e rew warding careeer. Agents haave the poten ntial to earn significant incomess while helpin ng borrowers find the prodduct that besst suits their n needs and Chapterr 1: Market O verview 5 mstances. In performing your y duties prrofessionally and ethically you will earn n the respect circum of you ur industry pe eers, and devvelop a fulfillin ng life long caareer. t market in which you w will be workingg. Our next step is to investigate the 1.2 Key Pa articipants s The mortgage m marrket in Ontario is comprise ed of several kkey industry p participants. In addition to the mortgage m agen nt, whose role e will be discu ussed throug hout this texttbook, the following particcipants are vittal to the indu ustry and are part of the pprocess of lan nd ownership. Institu utional lende er The le ender is the cornerstone of o the mortgagge industry. Lenders are ggenerally grouped into two o main categories: in nstitutional and private. Institu utional lenders represent the t majority of lenders in Ontario, but private lendeers have alwayys been and will w most likelyy always be a necessary prrovider of fun nds for borrow wers who don’t qualify throu ugh institution nal lenders. Institu utional lenders consist of Schedule S 1, 2 and 3 banks,, credit union ns, loan and trust comp panies, finance e companies or other corp porations connstructed to leend money on real estate.. Any le ender may alsso be referred d to as the mortgagee. Fo or your info formation… … Un nder the Bankk Act, banks are a defined ass: Schedu ule 1 (banks th hat are Canad dian owned) Schedu ule 2 (branche es or subsidiaries of foreig n banks) Schedu ule 3 (foreign owned bankss operating inn Canada) A list l of currentt Schedule 1, 2 and 3 bankks is located inn the Append dix Privatte lender A Privvate lender is typically an individual inve estor with fu nds who wou uld like to inveest in mortggages. This in ndividual will usually invest through his or her lawyeer who may have clients requirring mortgage e financing orr a mortgage agent. His o r her purposee may vary bu ut normally an investtor will investt in 2nd mortggages due to their t higher raate of return when compaared to 1st mortggages and oth her potential types of investments suchh as GICs or bonds. Any Private P lenderr may also be referred to as a the mortgaagee. Borro ower The borrower is caalled the morttgagor and is the individuaal or individuaals who are taaking the mortggage loan and d pledging the eir property as a security. Institu utional Mortgage Originator Severral financial in nstitutions no ow have their own Mortgagge Origination teams, ofteen referred to o as Road Warriors, who actively seek borrowers for them.. These Origin nators are co ompensated b by nd are not con nsidered to be brokering a mortgage trransaction sin nce they are their institution an 6 Chapterr 1: Market O verview der. The major differentiaating factor b etween an in nstitutional m mortgage using only one lend origin nator and a mortgage m agen nt is that, while both are d edicated to p providing the best solution ns to the eir clients, insstitutional mo ortgage origin nators can on ly place theirr clients with tthe lender byy whom m they are em mployed and therefore t do not have acceess to all of th he different p products availaable in the maarket. Real Estate E Salesp person The Real R Estate Salesperson is the t individuall who brokerss the purchasse and sale traansaction betwe een a vendor (seller) and the t purchaserr. This individdual is employed by a licen nsed Real Estate e Broker, has met licensingg guidelines and a is a membber of a local Real Estate B Board. Real Estate E Salespe ersons are a vital v link in th he process of purchasing and selling reaal estate and are th herefore of co onsiderable im mportance to o the mortgagge agent in reegards to obtaaining clients.. More information on Real Estatte Salespersons can be fouund through tthe Ontario R Real Estate Assocciation (OREA) at www.ore ea.com. Su uccess Tip – Real esta ate salespeople Altthough the number of real estate salespeople is signnificant in thee Ontario marrket, before yo ou attempt to obtain clientts from them keep the 80‐‐20 rule in min nd: 80% of trransactions are e typically do one by 20% off a sales force e. You shouldd focus on thee successful reeal estate salespeople to get the most referral busin ness possiblee. Real Estate E Appraiiser The Real R Estate Ap ppraiser also plays p a vital ro ole in the reaal estate process, especiallly from the standpoint of the mortgage m age ent. The Appraiser determ mines, in the ccase of financcing, the marke et value of the property to o be mortgage ed. Real Estaate Appraiserss do not havee to be licenssed in Ontario o, but unless they t have a professional p ddesignation, n no lender will accept their appraaisal for financing purposes. There e are several methods m used d to determin ne the markett value of a p property, as w well as several metho ods of completing an apprraisal. These topics will bee covered in tthe chapter, A Application Analyysis – The Property. Home e Inspector Home e Inspections began as a co onsumer servvice in the 19770s and havee grown in popularity sincee then. A qualified Home H Inspecttor will advise e the home p urchaser / ho omeowner in regards to the co ondition of th he home and advise regard ding issues suurrounding itss condition. TThe condition n of the e home naturally affects th he market value. More information on Home Inspectors in On ntario can be found througgh the Ontario Association n of Home Inspectorrs (OAHI) at www.oahi.ca. w Mortggage Default Insurer The Mortgage M Defaault Insurer provides p morttgage defaultt insurance po olicies to lend ders typically offering high ratio mortgages, although a defaault insurancee can be provvided on a mo ortgage loan o of oan to value. The main inssurers in the Ontario O markket include the governmen nt insurer, thee any lo Chapterr 1: Market O verview 7 da Mortgage and Housing Corporation (CMHC) and tthe two privaate insurers, G Genworth Canad Financial Canada and a Canada Guaranty Morttgage Insurannce Companyy (Canada Guaaranty). Pa ause for cla arification n – Loan to o Value (alsso referred d to as LTV V) A loan l to value is the amoun nt of the loan or mortgagee to the value of the propeerty. For example, if the mortgage is $200,000 $ and d the value off the propertyy is $400,000 0 then the loaan to value is 200,000 divided by $400,000 which eqquals 50%. Thhis is explaineed in detail in chapter 13. Mortggage Default Insurance pro ovides protecction for the l ender in the case of mortggage default by the e borrower. Typically T the lender will paass the cost oof this insuran nce policy on to the borro ower, who ben nefits from th he policy by being b able to gget a high loaan to value m mortgage at conve entional ratess. Lawye er A reall estate lawye er is the profe essional involved in a real estate transaaction who peerforms the follow wing tasks: Ne egotiating and d drafting Agrreements of Purchase P andd Sale Acting for buyers or sellers on o new or re‐sale home, coondominium,, or commerccial purchasess or sales owers or lend ders on mortggage transactiions, includin ng preparing d documents Acting for borro and registering documents Mortggage Creditorr Insurer A morrtgage credito or insurer is an a insurer thaat provides a policy to the mortgage bo orrower so that upon u a claim (in ( the case of o death; there are additionnal creditor in nsurance policies availablee) the mortgage m loan is paid by a one‐time o lum mp sum paymeent to the len nder. This inssurance is speciffic to the morrtgage loan. Title Insurer I A Title e Insurer is an n insurer thatt provides a policy p which pprovides coveerage for the insured’s titlee. It can compensate the insured for f real lossess associated w with covered issues found d in the termss of the e policy. For example, e if th here is an old mortgage onn title that waas never disch harged and this prevents the property p from m being conve eyed to the puurchasers, thee title insuran nce policy willl take steps s to reme edy this situattion. It also o assists in strreamlining the closing proccess (the pro cess of the laawyer closing the mortgage transaaction), prote ects against frraud and forggery and is av ailable on purchases, refin nances and to o home eowners who did not obtaiin a title insurance policy oon either of tthose occasions. Mortggage Adminisstrator A Mortgage Admin nistrator is a person p or enttity that servi ces a mortgage loan on beehalf of anoth her. For exam mple, a Mortggage Administtrator may prrocess paymeents, renewalss and dischaarges, provide e correspond dence and actt to collect moortgage arreaars for a lendeer that has contraacted them. 8 Chapter 1: Market Overview Under the Mortgage Brokerages, lenders and Administrators Act, 2006, Mortgage Administrators are licensed in Ontario. Regulation 406/07 of this legislation defines a Mortgage Administrator as one who is “Taking steps, on behalf of another person or entity, to enforce payment by a borrower under a mortgage.” 1.3 History of the Mortgage Industry in Ontario Although it might not make a significant difference to a borrower, the fact is that William the Conqueror’s victory over England’s army at the Battle of Hastings in 1066 has had an influence on how land is owned and mortgaged in Canada today by resulting in the imposition of the French feudal system of land ownership. This system was based on the principle that all land was ultimately owned by the Crown and individual citizens could only obtain rights to use this land based on agreement made with the Crown, usually for military service or for other feudal services. In Canada, this system was incorporated into the British North America Act, 1867 which was later renamed the Constitution Act, 1867. Under this legislation the Crown, being the ultimate landowner in Canada, granted rights, called patents, to Canadians to use land in exchange for clearing the land and building a shelter. The Crown would usually grant up to 100 acre farm lots to settlers arriving in the latter part of the 18th century and retained timber and mineral rights to the land. This had the result of granting an interest in the land that was less than full ownership, which allowed the owner of these rights the use of the land but not the ultimate ownership. In Ontario and the rest of Canada, where no initial patent was granted for a piece of land, no private ownership could result. This is the case, even to this day. In today’s Ontario, the Crown owns full residual interests in land which is what allows the Crown to expropriate land for its own use. Considering that the Crown is the residual owner of the land, expropriation or requiring the current owner of the land to sell the property back to the Crown makes sense. Examples of this can be seen on a regular basis, when the Crown, usually in the form of a municipality, expropriates a piece of land to build a new road. This can also be found to happen when a property owner fails to pay their property taxes. The municipality then has the right to take the property and sell it to recover those taxes. The mortgage market in Ontario has undergone significant changes during the last few decades, beginning with the introduction of bank mortgage lending in the 1960s, followed by insured mortgages and the influx of sub‐prime lenders more recently. Originally mortgage lending in Ontario was provided by life insurance companies. They had significant deposits paid by the premiums of their policy holders which allowed them to lend these amounts to individuals wishing to purchase land. Up until a major change in the Bank Act, Banks were not permitted to lend on residential mortgages. However, the writing was on the wall, so to speak, as banks were in a much greater competitive position to dominate the mortgage market due to their branch network. Banks, having Chapter 1: Market Overview 9 branches in virtually all communities could service their customers much more efficiently than life insurance companies and had much greater direct access to potential borrowers. In 1954 the Bank Act was changed to allow banks to lend on residential mortgages; however there was a limit to the amount of interest that they could charge. This limit was set at 6%. Unfortunately the market at the time saw interest rates at such a point that it was unprofitable for banks to lend based on that constraint, so the market remained dominated by life insurance companies until that cap was removed. That occurred in 1967 when the Bank Act was once again amended. This amendment removed the 6% cap and virtually overnight the banks became the predominant source of mortgage funds in Ontario. Today banks account for approximately 61% of all mortgages held in Canada and have a virtual lock on mortgage lending. In referring back to the 1970s, it can be seen why the mortgage brokerage community, in its infancy, was not necessarily a major benefit to consumers. The market was dominated by the main banks that offered standard mortgage products, namely 25 year amortizations, 5 year fixed rate terms with monthly payments and standard repayment options. If a borrower wanted a mortgage with a low rate of interest, he or she would be obtaining it from his or her bank. If that bank declined their application they would basically be declined by the other banks, since all of their lending criteria were virtually identical. The mortgage brokerage community rose from the need of borrowers to obtain financing if and when they were declined by the bank. Typically mortgage agents offered the borrower a private mortgage at a higher interest rate and charged a fee to arrange this financing. In other scenarios, borrowers would finance their home purchase from friends or family if they didn’t qualify at their bank. In essence mortgage agents offered a fringe service in the mortgage market that wouldn’t change for some time. In the United States, the mortgage market was traveling a different route. The mortgage lending market quickly became inundated with smaller, regional lenders which precipitated the need for mortgage agents to assist consumers in choosing the right lender and product that matched their needs. The mortgage industry in Ontario can currently be said to still be in its infancy. In the late 1980s mortgage agents were still primarily being used as sources of private mortgage funds for those declined by the major institutional lenders, but that was due for a change. As further legislative changes were being made that allowed an influx of mortgage funds into Canada, the number of lenders also began to increase. Non deposit taking institutions began to permeate the Ontario market, providing options that began to reflect the maturing real estate market. These options gave borrowers alternatives to a bank mortgage and began the competitive process of product innovation that is evident in today’s market. Compared to the options available to today’s consumer, the 1970s and 1980s were the Stone Age, while this can be compared to the Industrial or Golden Age of mortgage lending. 10 Chapter 1: Market Overview Where there was only a handful of lenders then, there are dozens of institutional lenders in today’s market in addition to private and non‐institutional sources of mortgage financing. Unfortunately there has also been a slight return to more conventional lending practices due to the market meltdown in the United States’ sub‐prime mortgage market. While not directly impacted by the American mortgage market in recent decades, the problems faced by our neighbours to the south in 2007 have had a significant impact on our sub‐prime mortgage market. To begin with, it is necessary to understand what constitutes a sub‐prime mortgage. The Sub‐Prime Mortgage Market The Sub‐Prime Mortgage Market, also referred to as the Alternative Mortgage Market, Non‐ Conforming Mortgage Market or “B” type lending has been with us since the early days of our industry when borrowers who were declined by their bank had to seek financing from private lenders. This was typically due to income or credit issues that disqualified them from traditional mortgage lending. In recent years the Ontario market has seen significant changes in its workforce and demographics. For example, there has been a 40% increase in self‐employed individuals in the workforce since the late 1980s1. Since most traditional lenders did not have products for these borrowers, they were relegated to obtaining private or non‐institutional financing. As this trend increased and as new lenders entered the Canadian mortgage market, products that catered to the self‐employed were introduced. Over time these products became more aggressive, allowing for programs that permitted borrowers to simply state their income without having to prove it. The concept behind these programs was that, if the borrower had good credit and other assets that would be evidence that they had sufficient income to meet these obligations, then they had the ability to repay a mortgage. Simply put a borrower would be required to write a letter, often referred to as a self‐declared income letter stating what their gross income was for the year. That amount would then be used to determine if they qualified for the mortgage based on ratios used to calculate loan amounts. There was not, and still isn’t, income verification under this program. These programs were introduced in the United States before they were picked up on in Canada. In addition, the American market was providing loans to borrowers that were far more aggressive than could be found in the Canadian market. While interest only loans were being introduced in Canada, they were amounting to nearly one third of all new mortgages in 2005 in the United States. Our American counterparts were also offering negative loan to value mortgages. In other words, an American borrower could borrow in excess of 100% of the value of their home. Consider then that borrowers were being allowed to state their own incomes, and in conjunction with income fraud (borrowers using false income verification), many American lenders were providing mortgages to borrowers who in essence could not afford those loans. 1 Statistics Canada Chapter 1: Market Overview 11 Just as crucial was the fact that lenders were offering teaser rates (over 90% of subprime mortgage in 2006 were adjustable rate mortgages with teaser rates) to these borrowers. A teaser rate was a rate that began low but that would increase over time. This resulted in a mortgage payment that was low for the first few years, but that would increase later. Although borrowers could afford these teaser rate payments, affordability became a problem when the rates increased. You may wonder why anyone would get a mortgage that would become unaffordable. The answer was simple. Lenders and brokers told borrowers that before their rates went up they would get refinanced into a new teaser rate mortgage, thereby avoiding the rate increase. Unfortunately that wasn’t the case, as the hot American housing market cooled and prices began to dip. Because of this (and other reasons) lenders would not refinance, leaving borrowers with increased mortgage payments that many could not afford. In 2007 the default ratios on these sub‐prime mortgages began to rise. As they increased more borrowers began to walk away from their homes, basically telling their lender that they could no longer afford the payments. This caused American lenders to take over these properties and foreclose, meaning that they took title from the original homeowner and sold the property. The first major indicator of market trouble occurred in California, where this became an increasing trend. As the number of properties being foreclosed increased, the number of homes in the real estate market increased, and supply began to outpace demand. Basic economics dictates that when supply is greater than demand, prices tend to fall in an attempt by the market to restore equilibrium. With falling prices, more homeowners found themselves with payments that they couldn’t afford and properties where they owed more than the house was worth. This resulted in a downward spiral where lenders had to foreclose on an ever increasing number of properties. The result was that many lenders had to write off billions of bad mortgage debt that was unrecoverable. In and of itself this might not have caused a major meltdown in the market. Lenders have had to write off bad debts before. However the way many of these lenders obtained the funds that they used to lend to borrowers was based on a system that had them borrowing money to lend. In other words, a non‐bank lender would find a major institution that would provide them with a line of credit (referred to as a warehouse line of credit). This lender would then make loans to borrowers and eventually, once the line of credit was full, sell the mortgages in a pool to other investors, such as banks or pension funds. This process is referred most typically to as securitization. The way a lender involved in this process would make their money would be from up front lender’s fees that they charged in addition to servicing the loan, if applicable, on behalf of the investor or purchaser of the pool of mortgages. However once the rates of default began to skyrocket on these mortgages the potentials buyers of these loan pools dried up. The market then had lenders with lines of credit that they couldn’t repay since there was virtually no one to purchase these pools of mortgages. The sub‐prime mortgage meltdown of 2007 had begun. 12 Chapterr 1: Market O verview e most Canadians looked on o with intere est in the earl y part of 20007, the impactt on the While Canad dian market wasn’t w immed diately forese een. The sub‐‐prime mortggage market in n Canada wass less aggressive thaan its counterpart in the United States aand thereforee less likely to o see the sam me types of default rates. By all accounts the e Canadian su ub‐prime market wasn’t exxhibiting the ssame number of bad loanss and th herefore shou uld not be subject to the same s problem ms associated d with the Am merican sub‐ prime e market. This outlook was soon proved to be erronneous. The world‐wide w market for purcchasing sub‐p prime pools oof mortgages virtually shutt down. Investtors and lenders alike were so paranoid d about sub‐pprime losses tthey were exp periencing in the United States that t there waas a virtual mo oratorium onn buying sub‐p prime pools o of mortgages,, includ ding Canadian n pools. This has h had a sign nificant impacct on the Canaadian sub‐pri me market w with a few sub b‐prime lende ers exiting the e market altoggether, otherrs adopting a more conservvative approaach to lendingg, while others still siimply struggliing to stay in business. Deeposit taking institutions, o on the other hand,, have not see en the same types t of volattility in the Caanadian markket due to theeir reliance on n depossits from conssumers as the e source of th heir mortgagee loans. This “old fashioneed” way of lendin ng has served d them well an nd should allo ow them to w weather this ““sub‐prime sttorm.” As lon ng as Canadiaan consumerss continue the eir strong rec ord of repaying mortgage debt, Canadaa will co ontinue to be e a profitable market for le enders. 1.4 Markett Demogra raphics an nd Trend ds The sttudy of Ontarrio’s demograaphics is requ uired to devel op an undersstanding of th he makeup off the market m and its potential fro om the standp point of morttgage financin ng. Pop pulation The fo ollowing figurre illustrates the t breakdow wn of the Cannadian populaation by proviince and territo ory, as of Julyy 1, 2013. With approximaately 39% of CCanada’s pop pulation, the m mortgage marke et in Ontario is the largest in Canada, re epresenting aapproximatelyy 40% of all m mortgages appro oved in the co ountry in 2010 0. Although Quebec Q rankss next in popu ulation, the n next largest provin nce for mortggage financingg was Albertaa, followed cloosely by British Columbia, then Quebec2. 2 Statistics Canada, Preliminary P posstcensal estimates 1 13 Chapterr 1: Market O verview Figure 13 – Population n and Age Distrib bution by Provin nce and Territorry July 1, 20133 All ages 0 to 14 15 to 64 65 and olderr Cana ada 35,158,304 4 16.1 68.6 15.3 Median Age 40.2 Albe erta 4,025,074 4 18.2 70.6 11.2 36 British Columbia 4,581,978 8 14.8 68.8 16.4 41.7 Man nitoba 1,265,015 5 18.7 66.9 14.4 37.7 New w Brunswick 756,050 14.7 67.7 17.6 43.9 New wfoundland an nd Labrador 526,702 14.5 68.4 17.1 44.2 Nortthwest Territo ories 43,537 21.1 72.8 6.1 32.4 Nova a Scotia 940,789 14.3 68 17.7 43.8 Nuna avut 35,591 30.8 65.7 3.5 25.4 Onta ario 13,537,994 4 16.2 68.6 15.2 40.3 145,237 15.8 66.9 17.3 43.1 Quebec 8,155,334 4 15.4 68 16.6 41.6 Saskkatchewan 1,108,303 3 18.8 66.7 14.4 37.1 36,700 16.7 73.4 9.9 38.9 Princce Edward Islland Yuko on Size e of the Mortgage M Market As of May, 2014 th he size of the Canadian mo ortgage markeet, in terms o of the value o of all outstaanding mortggages in the county was esstimated at $11.235 trillion4. The total reesidential mortggage credit ou utstanding in Canada has risen r significaantly since 19981, increasing by over 850% in 25 years. As the e following figgure illustrate es, the lendin ng market is ddominated byy the chartereed banks, who o accou unt for nearly half of all outstanding mo ortgages in anny given year.. Credit Unio ons are a distan nt second. Cha aracterist ics of a Mortgage M e Agent’s Client Appro oximately 30% % of Ontario consumers c ussed a mortga ge agent in 2014, a numbeer that has remaiined consistent for the passt several yeaars, while 50% % used a bankk. Accorrding to a rece ent Mortgage e Consumer Survey S by CM HC, the averaage mortgagee agent’s client had the follo owing charactteristics: 51% had a houssehold income under $60,0 000 while 49% % had an inco ome over $60 0,000 44% were betw ween 35 and 54 5 years old, while w 34% weere 18 to 34 yyears old and 22% were over 55 years old 3 4 Statistics Canada, http://www.sta h atcan.gc.ca/pu ub/91‐215‐x/20013002/t588‐eeng.htm#T588FN1 CMH HC, Canadian Housing Observver, http://www w.cmhc‐schl.gcc.ca/odpub/pd df/68189.pdf 14 Chapter 1: Market Overview 19% were self employed 92% of first time purchasers who used a mortgage agent were either rather or totally satisfied 87% of repeat purchasers who used a mortgage agent were either rather or totally satisfied 87% of refinancers who used a mortgage agent were either rather or totally satisfied 80% of renewers who used a mortgage agent were either rather or totally satisfied. Of all consumers, 81% of renewers remained with their current lender indicating that service was their major reason for this loyalty 65% of repeat purchasers remained with their current lender indicating that service was their major reason for this loyalty 65% of refinancers remained with their current lender indicating that service was their major reason for this loyalty 58% of first time purchasers remained with their current institution indicating that relationship was their major reason for this loyalty, followed closely by rate. In addition, 68% of all consumers indicated that they wanted to pay off their mortgage as quickly as possible. However, only 27% of consumers actually used prepayment options in 2009. According to an RBC Survey, 34% of respondents said they didn’t use prepayment options because they didn’t have the money to take advantage of prepayment options, while 30% had other debts they wanted to pay off first and 20% wanted to invest before prepaying their mortgage. The following chart illustrates the number of families by income segment in Canada. 2012 is the latest date that data is available from Statistics Canada. 15 Chapter 1: Market Overview Figure 2 – Residential Mortgage Credit by Lender by Year5 Residential Mortgage Credit by Lender by Year ($ millions) $1,200,000 $1,000,000 $800,000 $600,000 $400,000 $200,000 $0 1985 5 1990 1995 2000 2005 2010 2011 2012 Life Insurance Companies Chartered Banks Trust and Mortgage Loan Companies Credit Unions and Caisses Populaires Securitization MBS Pension Funds Totals 2013 Statistics Canada, Residential Mortgage Credit, http://www.statcan.gc.ca/tables‐tableaux/sum‐ som/l01/cst01/fin21‐eng.htm 16 Chapter 1: Market Overview Figure 36 – Family Income, by Family Type Total, all income groups Under $10,000 $10,000 and over $15,000 and over $20,000 and over $25,000 and over $30,000 and over $35,000 and over $40,000 and over $45,000 and over $50,000 and over $60,000 and over $70,000 and over $75,000 and over $80,000 and over $90,000 and over $100,000 and over $150,000 and over $200,000 and over $250,000 and over Family income, by family type (Couple families) 2008 2009 2010 7,832,060 7,926,210 7,989,380 194,670 199,350 189,700 7,637,400 7,726,860 7,799,670 7,527,140 7,613,770 7,695,970 7,374,900 7,459,680 7,552,050 7,177,060 7,262,910 7,355,530 6,876,780 6,958,650 7,045,540 6,549,220 6,620,770 6,708,710 6,228,650 6,288,200 6,383,220 5,900,920 5,949,750 6,052,150 5,571,420 5,611,520 5,719,630 4,915,080 4,939,370 5,059,180 4,277,270 4,292,660 4,420,250 3,969,160 3,982,590 4,111,920 3,672,840 3,684,990 3,815,020 3,119,370 3,129,560 3,258,520 2,626,660 2,636,310 2,761,360 1,063,240 1,072,990 1,148,440 476,110 476,050 510,820 261,300 256,550 274,930 2011 8,091,960 182,900 7,909,060 7,811,680 7,676,700 7,497,090 7,199,220 6,864,160 6,540,470 6,217,470 5,893,430 5,246,310 4,617,280 4,313,490 4,018,690 3,462,890 2,960,190 1,276,150 576,700 309,200 2012 8,169,080 181,120 7,987,950 7,896,460 7,768,900 7,604,140 7,334,630 7,006,160 6,685,630 6,368,450 6,050,800 5,414,280 4,793,640 4,492,200 4,198,650 3,642,000 3,135,540 1,395,820 641,950 341,540 Median total income $ 75,880 75,320 76,950 79,530 81,980 Note: Family income is the sum of the incomes of all members of the family. 1. A census couple family consists of a couple living together (married or common‐law, including same‐sex couples) living at the same address with or without children. Beginning in 2001, same‐sex couples reporting as couples are counted as couple families. Source: Statistics Canada, CANSIM, table 111‐0012. Last modified: 2014‐07‐23. 6 Statistics Canada 1 17 Chapterr 1: Market O verview Figure 47 – Median Total Income, by Family F Type, by Province and Teerritory Median totall income, by faamily type, by province and territory 2008 8 2009 2010 2011 2012 Canada 68,860 68,410 69,860 72,240 7 74,540 Newfoundlan nd and Labrado or 59,320 60,290 62,580 67,200 7 70,900 Prince Edwarrd Island 61,010 62,110 63,610 66,500 6 69,010 Nova Scotia 61,980 62,550 64,100 66,030 6 67,910 New Brunswiick 59,790 60,670 62,150 63,930 6 65,910 Quebec 63,830 64,420 65,900 68,170 7 70,480 Ontario 70,910 69,790 71,540 73,290 7 74,890 Manitoba 64,530 65,550 66,530 68,710 7 70,750 Saskatchewan 69,800 70,790 72,650 77,300 8 80,010 Alberta 86,080 83,560 85,380 89,830 9 94,460 British Colum mbia 67,890 66,700 66,970 69,150 7 71,660 Yukon 85,070 84,640 86,930 91,090 9 94,460 Northwest Te erritories 98,530 98,300 101,010 105,560 1 106,710 Nunavut 58,590 60,160 62,680 65,280 6 65,530 The Average e Canadia an’s Cred dit Score It is off particular in nterest to notte that historiically the majjority of morttgage agents surveyed believve that the avverage Canadian has a cred dit score nearr 650. In actu uality, the facct is quite different, with the average cred dit score of Caanadians beinng approximaately 740. The following h illustrates th he breakdown n of beacon scores (a cred it score used in Equifax’s ccredit report)) graph by percentage of the population according to Equifax Cannada. Pau use for cla arification – Credit sccore A crredit score, caalled Beacon Score by Equifax and Emppirica Score byy Transunion,, is a num merical repressentation of an a individual’s overall creddit. While e there are no o statistics avaailable to indicate the ave rage beacon score of a typ pical mortgagge broke erages’ clientss, anecdotal evidence e poin nts to the factt that the majjority of brokkerage business is in the range r of 650 and a below. This T would inddicate that brrokerages aree missing the majorrity of Canadians with good to excellentt credit. One factor f behind this trend maay be that maany brokerag es focus on cconsumers at the lower en nd of the e credit spectrum. This can n be evidence ed by commoon advertisingg found in maany publiccations that advertise a morrtgages availaable to consum mers with po oor credit, preevious bankrruptcies, non‐‐verifiable inccome, and so on. 7 Statistics Canada 18 Chapterr 1: Market O verview he mortgage brokerage b ind dustry to breaak through thhe 30% markeet penetration number, a For th parad digm shift mayy be required d: from focussing on those declined by tthe banks to tthose who arre appro oved by the banks. All ane ecdotal inform mation tends to point to th he fact that th he majority of consu umers, if apprroved by their bank, will ob btain their m ortgage finan ncing there ass opposed to from a mortgage agent. a Figure 5 – Distribution n of Canadian Beeacon Scores Distrribution of Canadian C B Beacon Sco ores source: Equifax Canada,, 2015 30% % % 27% 24% 25% % 1 9% 20% % 15% % 11% 10% % 5% % 0% % 1.5 6% 6% 550 to 599 600 to 649 5% 4% 549 and below 65 50 to 699 700 to 749 750 to 799 800 to 84 49 850 and over The Co ommercia al Mortgag ge Marke et The mortgage m marrket in Ontario can be divid ded into two major areas o of expertise: commercial and re esidential finaancing. Of co ourse, in eithe er specializatiion there can n be sub‐specializations. In n other words, a com mmercial morrtgage agent may focus onn financing ind plexes as dustrial comp oppossed to apartm ment buildings. Likewise, a mortgage aggent specializzing in residential financing may decide d to focu us on refinanccing, renewalls, etc. It’s im mportant to ke eep in mind that t commerccial mortgagee financing, allthough very lucrative, is also extremely e spe ecialized. It iss not uncomm mon for a com mmercial transaction to takke three months or longer to t be completted. In additiion, if a mortggage agent w who has not co ompleted a comm mercial transaaction before attempts one e, that brokerr is apt to find d that there aare substantiaal differences, from the t security or o property involved, to th e underwritin ng process. A common phrasse that “you don’t d know what you don’tt know” are w words to remember for co ommercial transaactions. A ressidential brokker with no co ommercial exxperience may attempt to apply the reside ential processs to the comm mercial transaaction becausse he or she d doesn’t realize the differences. This can c only lead to confusion and frustrati on for both the broker and the borro ower. Chapter 1: Market Overview 19 Here are six of the major differences between commercial and residential transactions. Property The property types of a commercial transaction are significantly different from residential. In a commercial transaction ICI, or Industrial, Commercial, Investment type properties are being dealt with. These can include: Apartment buildings Office buildings Strip plazas Shopping malls Warehouses Factories Recreational properties such as a golf course, etc. To be able to provide sound advice to the potential borrower, the mortgage agent must have intimate knowledge of the workings of the property that is the subject of the financing. Without such knowledge the broker will ultimately fail to ask the appropriate questions. Appraisal To appraise a residential property in Ontario will normally cost in the range of a few hundred dollars, depending on where the property is located. For example, in the GTA an appraisal may cost slightly less than three hundred dollars. In a commercial transaction an appraisal may cost from a low of $2,000 to a high of $50,000, depending on the property and the scope of the appraisal, and may take up to three months to complete. It is important to know what appraisal requirements are involved, based on the potential lender, before requiring a client to pay such a significant amount for an appraisal. Environmental Assessment In many cases at least a Phase 1 ESA (Environmental Site Assessment) will be required by the lender. This is to determine whether there are any contaminates in the property. If there are, a Phase 2 and Phase 3 may be required, which can take several months to complete and several thousand dollars in costs. Income To determine the viability of a commercial mortgage request, the broker must look at the type of property. If it is an incoming producing property such as an apartment building, then the Income Approach of appraising a property will be used. The broker must be familiar with the Net Operating Income, how to standardize it and what should be used and excluded within it. If it is not income producing, then typically the broker will have to obtain financial statements from the corporation applying for the mortgage and be knowledgeable enough to decipher and interpret them accurately. Lenders The commercial lending market in Ontario and Canada as a whole is quite small, limiting the number of options available to a broker. This has also resulted in commercial lenders being very selective about with whom they deal. Most commercial lenders do not like dealing with inexperienced brokers. They also have certain requirements regarding application submissions to which brokers must adhere. 20 Chapterr 1: Market O verview ng Timin While e a typical residential transsaction can be e completed within two w weeks (some ccan be funded d quicke er while othe ers, such as pu urchases mayy close a few months afterr the initial ap pplication) comm mercial transaactions can take anywhere e from three m months to a yyear, dependiing on the type of o the transacction and its complexity. c Su uccess Tip – Commerrcial transa actions If you y are new to t the mortgaage brokerage industry or if you have n not brokered a commerciaal traansaction beffore, seek the e advice of your supervisorr, manager, o or Broker befo ore proceeding. Co onsider co‐bro okering the application wi th a commerrcial mortgagee broker and t split their commission c with w you. In a best‐case sccenario, ask h him or her to ask him or her to e involved in the t transactio on so that you u might learn from an experienced Broker. be 1.6 Investin ng in Morrtgages Priv vate Lend ding In the e mortgage brrokerage indu ustry, the privvate lending m market has allways been and continues to be a major sourrce of funds fo or many morttgage agents.. Until the recent influx off institutionall sub‐p prime lenders into the marrket, the prim mary source off mortgage fin nancing for b borrowers who were declined by banks, b trust companies, an nd credit unioons was private lenders. A privvate lender is best describe ed as an indivvidual who le nds his or her own moneyy to a propertty owne er, securing th his loan by a mortgage. m Most private leenders in Ontaario are soph histicated and d have many charactteristics that resemble insttitutional len ders. A privaate lender will underwrite a ower’s applicaation based on his or her in ncome and crredit, and thee property. H However, borro where eas an institutional lenderr will base its decision prim marily on a bo orrower’s cred dit, a private lende er will base hiss or her decission primarilyy on the propeerty. This is ssimilar to insttitutional sub‐‐ prime e lenders. Wh hile these lenders will conssider a borrow wer’s credit, most private lenders will ignore e derogatory credit and baase the decisiion to lend prrimarily, and in many cases solely, on the prroperty and the t loan to vaalue of the loaan. Most privvate lenders w will not lend aabove 85% loan to t value, exce ept in rare circcumstances. Manyy well‐establisshed mortgagge agents havve private lendders with whom they currrently deal with and a are often n approached by individuals looking to llend money. Example Malikk Adams has a home valued d at $200,000 0 with a curreent mortgagee of $155,000. Mr. Adams has missed m several payments on his mortgagge in the pastt twelve montths and is currrently three months in arrears. He is curren ntly behind on n his two creddit card paym ments and alth hough up to o his car loan, has missed d two of those e payments inn the past tw welve months.. His date on mortggage came up p for renewal two months ago and his ccurrent institu utional lender is refusing tto renew w the mortgagge. The other institutio onal lenders he has approached have aalso declined Malik due to his poor creditt and the factt that he is currently in deffault on his m mortgage. Maalik’s banker ssuggested thaat Malikk approach a mortgage m age ent for the fin nancing, whic h Malik has d done. Chapterr 1: Market O verview 2 21 a was ablle to get Mali k a mortgagee from a privaate lender forr In thiss scenario, the mortgage agent 85% of o the propertty value, whicch allowed Malik M to consoolidate his oth her debts and d refinance hiss mortggage. This mo ortgage was an a interest on nly mortgage with a one‐yyear term at a rate 3% above e current bank posted rate es and a lende er’s fee of 2% % of the total mortgage am mount. Becau use private lenders typically do not pay finder’s feess, the mortgagge agent charrged a fee of 2% off the total mo ortgage amou unt. Syn dicated Mortgage M es Anoth her option forr a private len nder is to inve est in a singlee mortgage w with other privvate lenders. For exxample, if a developer requires two milllion dollars too begin consttruction of a ccondominium m building, the develloper may go to a mortgagge agent to obbtain that fun nding. Most iinstitutional ers won’t lend d money to a developer for soft costs, ssuch as markeeting, etc. and d if the lende developer doesn’t have enough h money of itss own, it mayy need additio onal soft cost funding to get th he project started. Howe ever most privvate lenders will w not have two million ddollars to inveest, so the mo ortgage agentt may gather g 10 of itts private lenders (it can be b as few as tw wo or as man ny as necessary) to pool their money. This is referred to o as a syndicated mortgagee. One morttgage will be rregistered on n title however h all off the investorrs are included in that morrtgage. Morrtgages as a Investm ments To understand whyy private inve estors will len nd money to bborrowers through mortgaages, it is imporrtant to unde erstand the ch haracteristics of a mortgagge as an invesstment. Rate of o Return The principal reaso on that an invvestor will len nd to a borrow wer is based o on the rate of return. A privatte lender can typically expect to receive e a rate of retturn far in exccess of traditional investtment vehicle es with limited risk in comparison to ot her high return investmen nts like the stock market. For a first mortgagge, a private le ender will traaditionally chaarge in excesss of 7% intereest, and as high as a 9% interestt, while on a second s mortggage interest rates of 13% % and higher aare typical, makin ng second mo ortgages the vehicle v of cho oice among m most private leenders. In add dition to a higgher rate, mo ost private len nders will cha rge a lender’ss fee. This reepresents an amou unt equal to a certain perce entage of the e total mortgaage (usually b between 1 and 4%) and is deduccted from the e mortgage prroceeds. A private lender’’s fee is also rreferred to ass a bonus, which h is an additio onal incentive e for the privaate lender to lend money tto a sub‐prim me borrower. Securrity It is offten assumed d that mortgaages are safe investments because the ssecurity for the loan is a prope erty. Howeve er, this assumption is some etimes faulty.. The privatee lender’s morrtgage will bee based d on a maximum loan to vaalue, set at his or her maxiimum risk tolerance. This is typically 85% loan to value. As discussed d earlier, a loan to value iss based on th e value of thee loan to the value of the prope erty, expressed as a percen ntage. Thereffore, the maxximum loan amount is determined by the e property’s value. v 22 Chapterr 1: Market O verview must have To ensure that his or her investment is adequately proteccted, the privvate lender m confid dence in the value v of the property p befo ore he or she makes the fin nal decision to lend. In orderr to determine e the value, the private len nder will requuest that a full appraisal be completed on the e property. To T further pro otect the private lender, h e or she will u usually only d deal with an appraaisal firm thatt is felt to be reliable, r accurate and consservative and d that the privvate lender has de ealt with in th he past. Even though t the private lender may have an n accurate ap praisal done tto determinee the exact marke et value of the property, that will be litttle consolatioon if the real estate markeet takes a down nturn and property prices fall, f especiallyy if the loan t o value is 85% % of the original appraised d value. Example To illu ustrate this po oint, let us co ontinue with the t Example. Malikk Adams received a private e mortgage tw wo years ago in the amoun nt of $170,000 that represented 85% of o the appraissed value at the time the m mortgage wass funded. Sin nce that time,, Malikk has once agaain failed to make m his morttgage payme nts and the p private lenderr has underrtaken steps to t sell the pro operty and re etrieve his invvestment. To do so, the prrivate lender has re etained a lawyer who is haandling the po ower of sale pprocess as weell as a Real Estate Salesp person who will w be selling the house on n behalf of th e private lend der. The Real R Estate Salesperson hass informed th he private lennder that the vvalue of the p property has declin ned over the past p year as the t market haas taken a dow wnturn. The price that the Real Estatee Salesp person is sugggesting that the t property be b sold for is $185,000. Iff that sale pricce is realized,, the prrivate lender will lose approximately $2 2,780. A costt analysis reveeals that the private lende er’s rate of retturn is reduce ed from 9% to o approximattely 7.4% (exccluding the bo onus). Pau use for cla arification – Power off Sale The term power of sale referss to the proce ess by which a lender can obtain the am mount lent to the borrower and associate ed costs, inclu uding unpaid interest, upo on default by the borrower. More e information on this can be b found in thhe chapter Mo ortgage Remeedies. Here is the breakdown of that transaction. t Although A thiss is a theoretical breakdow wn, it is evident that if therre is a decrease in the valu ue of the propperty a loan tto value of 85 5% does not necesssarily mean that t the lende er’s investme ent is safe. Fuurther, consid der the potential losses if the orriginal appraisal had been incorrect and d the value off the propertyy too high. Itt should now be evident why an accurate app praisal is so im mportant in a private morttgage. Outstanding mortggage balance $170,0000 (balance iss the same ass the advancee since it is an interestt only mortgaage) Mortggage Arrears $3,755..22 (based on n 3 months off missed interestt only paymeents) Collecction Costs $475.000 Real Estate E Fees $11,1000 (6% of the ssale price) Chapterr 1: Market O verview Legal Fees $2,450 Total to be repaid from procee eds $187,7880.22 2 23 Challe enges for the e Private lend der Although private mortgages m can n offer the prrivate lender a higher rate of return witth relatively low risk based on an a accurate appraisal a and a conservativve loan to value, there still remain challe enges for the private lende er. R Assessing the Risk t risk, or de etermining thhe probabilityy that the borrrower will The first challenge is assessing the e terms that are a set out in the mortgagge contract. TThis requires repayy the mortgagge loan on the the prrivate lender to understan nd the underw writing processs (the processs of assessin ng the merits of an application) as a well as being able to an nalyze the borrrower’s cred dit, income an nd debt he private len nder is not sophisticated e nough to com mplete these analyses, theen servicce ratios. If th he or she will have e to rely on th heir mortgage e agent to maake a recomm mendation. Siggnificant Capiital Outlay To invvest in a morttgage, a privaate lender will typically be required to invest tens off thousands of dollarrs as opposed d to hundredss of dollars. This T makes invvesting in mo ortgages difficcult for the small investor. Re einvestment of o Return The next challenge e is how the private p lenderr will reinvestt the return o on his or her investment. equire tens off thousands oof dollars to advance and tthe typical Since mortgage loaans usually re repayyment is a mo onthly amoun nt of interest only, o it will taake some timee before the private lendeer can accquire enough monthly paayments to invest in yet annother mortggage. In the m meantime, thee monthly returns will w have to be e invested in an a investmennt vehicle with h lower rates of return since the investme ent amount iss so low. Thiss is not the caase with somee other investtments such as mu utual funds th hat will reinve est profits as they t occur. Lacck of Liquiditty Unlike e the stock exxchange, therre is no centraal exchange tthat deals witth mortgages. A private lende er cannot list his h or her mo ortgage for sale in a centra l registry, since none existt. The result is that, if a private lender wishes to t sell his or her h mortgagee he or she must locate a p potential buyerr through a mortgage m agen nt or other so ource, possibl y even havingg to advertisee. The time involvved in this pro ocess may be lengthy and cause the priivate investorr to lose otheer investmentt opporrtunities and//or result in selling s the mo ortgage at a ddiscount to reecover their in nvestment more quickly. Pau use for cla arification ‐ Discountt The term discoun nt refers to an amount thaat is subtracteed from the ssale price of a mortgage to make m it more attractive to a buyer. The e concept is siimilar to obtaaining a piecee of merrchandise from a retailer for a price low wer than its o riginal; in oth her words, it iis on sale. 24 Chapterr 1: Market O verview Indi rect Inve esting in Mortgage M es To be able to mitiggate the challenges identiffied above, a private lendeer may decidee to invest in a pool of o mortgages, such as morrtgage‐backed d securities oor in a Mortgaage Investmen nt Corpo oration (MIC). Mortggage Backed Securities (M MBS) A morrtgage backed d‐security is an a investmen nt in a pool off amortized reesidential mo ortgages insure ed through CM MHC under th he National Housing H Act (N NHA). NHA M MBS issuers are approved by CM MHC and must be a chartered bank, a trrust companyy, an insurancce company, a caisse popullaire (meaning “people’s bank” b in Frencch), a credit uunion, or a loaan company. o a rate of return similar to GICs and higher thann Governmen nt of Canada B Bonds that MBS offer have equivalent te erms, although lower than private morttgage loans. They answer the isssue of liquidiity by being able a to be soldd easily and tthe issue of seecurity by being fully guarantteed by the Government G of o Canada. M MBS are not lim mited to the m maximum insuraable amount of $100,000 provided p by the t Canada D eposit Insurance Corporattion. Since being launch hed in 1987 byy CMHC, MBSS have becom me very popullar with over 47,000 investtors investingg over 27 billio on dollars in the t NHA MBSS program. Mortggage Investm ment Corporattion (MIC) A morrtgage investment corporaation (MIC) iss a corporatioon that enablees small invesstors to invest in a diversified poo ol of mortgagges on residen ntial real esta te with the b benefit of usin ng the corpo orate form by purchasing shares s in the corporation. c A MIC is gen nerally treated d as a conduitt for income tax purrposes. Its inccome may be flowed throuugh to its shareholders and d taxed in their hands withou ut tax at the corporate c leve el. One hundred h per cent c of a MIC’s annual net income mustt be distributted to its sharreholders in the fo orm of a divid dend. Accorrding to the In ncome Tax Acct, a MIC musst have at leasst 20 shareho olders with no o individual shareholder ownin ng more than 25% of the MIC. M In additiion, at least 550% of the MIIC’s assets must be comprised d of residential mortgagess. 1.7 Real Es state and d Mortgag ge Institu ute of Can nada Inc. (REMIC) The Real R Estate and Mortgage Institute of Caanada Inc. (REEMIC) is a nattional organizzation dedicated to providing the morrtgage and reaal estate induustries with reesources desiigned to increaase market pe enetration an nd the success of its membbers. Foundeed in 2008 by Joseph J. White e, REMIC is a membership driven organ nization that ffocuses on th e needs of aggents and broke ers by providing education, training and d a wealth of resources forr its memberss. e trade associations like CA AAMP and IM MBA representt the mortgagge industry to o regulators, While REMIC C’s focus is on n assisting itss members in building thei r businesses by providing a rich supplyy of eassily accessible e resources. These T resources focus on marketing, ad dvertising, seelling, sourcing business using a vaariety of strattegies, as well as other areeas vital to an n agent/brokeer’s success. Chapter 1: Market Overview 25 More information can be found on REMIC by visiting its website at www.remic.ca 1.8 Mortgage Associations and Professional Designations Mortgage associations have become much more prevalent in Ontario over the past several years. Providing a voice for their members as well as industry networking events, they represent a significant portion of Ontario ‘s mortgage brokering community. Association of Mortgage Investment Professionals (AMIPROS) – www.amipros.org The Association of Mortgage Investment Professionals, AMIPROS, a non‐profit organization, is the national association for and collective voice of the mortgage investment industry. The Association represents several mortgage investment disciplines, including syndicated mortgages, private mortgages and other mortgage investment vehicles. AMIPROS sets high quality industry standards designed to protect investors and ensure the continued integrity of the industry. AMIPROS’ designees are committed to promoting the industry with integrity, fairness and professionalism. AMIPROS offers the Certified Mortgage Investment Professional (CMIP) designation. Mortgage Professionals Canada, aka The Canadian Association of Accredited Mortgage Professionals (CAAMP) – www.caamp.org CAAMP, a national association, was founded in 1994 as the Canadian Institute of Mortgage agents and Lenders (CIMBL) and underwent a name change in 2006. They once again underwent a name change in 2016 and are now called Mortgage Professionals Canada. They have approximately 10,500 members throughout the country. They offer the Accredited Mortgage Professional (AMP) designation. This designation was launched in January of 2004 and as of 2015 the association has approximately 2,200 AMPs (down from 3,400 in 2011). The Independent Mortgage agents Association of Ontario (IMBA) – www.imba.ca Founded in 2000, IMBA is a provincial association. IMBA has over 1,800 members in Ontario. 1.9 Choosing a Brokerage Choosing a brokerage for whom to work can be a difficult process if you don’t know what questions to ask or what to look for. With several hundred brokerages licensed in Ontario, you certainly have choice, so the first tip in choosing a brokerage is to ensure that you interview with several before deciding which one to join. Be sure to treat your first contact and interview the same as you would any other interview. When making your initial inquiry be sure to use proper grammar, punctuation and if using email format it correctly. Be prepared to submit your resume before your interview. At the interview dress professionally, bring a copy of your resume and be prepared to answer questions, including why you feel you’ll be a success. 26 Chapter 1: Market Overview You can use FSCO’s website to search for brokerages and their contact information, as well as online search engines like Google, and other mediums like newspapers and the Yellow Pages. You may also wish to call an agent who works for the brokerage you’re considering to learn of his or her opinion on the brokerage. In addition I suggest asking some or all of the following questions so that you can get a feel for what the brokerage has to offer and you can compare different brokerages before making your final decision. Deciding which of the following questions is most important to you is a personal decision and will change from person to person. Keep in mind that the commission rate shouldn’t be your only consideration. You need to look at everything in context, determine what is ultimately in your best interests and then decide where you want to work. At the end of the following form there is a spot for your general comments on the brokerage as well as any additional questions that were not included in this guide. Question Commission 1. What is your commission split? 2. Do you pay volume bonus? 3. Does the commission split and/or volume bonus vary based on production? If so, what are the levels? 4. Do you have a minimum level of production that I must meet to remain an agent with you? Costs 5. What are the costs to join? 6. How much does your Errors and Omissions Insurance cost? 7. How much does a credit bureau report cost? 8. Do I have to be a member of CAAMP or IMBA? 9. Do you charge agents any other costs? If so, what are they? Contract 10. Do you have an agent contract that I have to sign? 11. Does the contract have a term during which I cannot work for another brokerage if I leave? 12. How much notice must I give if I decide to leave? Answer Chapter 1: Market Overview Training 13. Do you provide training? 14. If so, at what location or is it online? 15. If so, on what topics? 16. If so, how often? 17. If so, is there a cost to me? 18. Do you have lenders attend meetings to provide agents with information? 19. If so, how often? 20. If so, at what location? Policies and Procedures 21. Do you provide a compliance manual so I’m aware of your compliance policies? 22. Do you provide a file checklist so I know what I have to submit to get paid? 23. Do you have a Policies and Procedures Manual for your agents? Website 24. Do you provide me with a website? 25. Can I change its content? 26. Do you provide updated content? 27. Is there any cost? 28. Does it have an online application that submits the application to me? Support 29. Do you provide help on deals that I do not know which lender to use? 30. Do you have a central underwriting department that can handle a deal that I can’t do? If so, what is my commission split? 31. What is your process if I disagree with a lender that declines an application? 32. Do you provide office space for me to meet with clients? If so, is there a cost? 27 28 Chapter 1: Market Overview 33. Do you advertise? If so, do I get any leads from your advertising? Is the commission split different on these leads? General 34. How long have you been in business? 35. Are there any lenders you do not deal with? Why? 36. Do any lenders not deal with you? Why? 37. What origination software do you use? 38. Do you provide training on using that software and if so, when, where and is there a cost? Additional Questions (use this section to list any additional questions you may have) General Notes (Use this section to make notes on your impression of the brokerage and/or provide any other information relevant to making your decision) Chapter 1: Market Overview 29 1.10 Key Terms and Definitions “B” type lending Mortgage lending to borrowers who have impaired credit or some other impairment that prevents them from being able to qualify for traditional lending products Alternative Mortgage Market A market for borrowers who do not qualify for traditional lending products AMP Designation The Accredited Mortgage Professional designation awarded by CAAMP Bank An institution approved as a Schedule I, II, or III Bank under the Bank Act. Schedule 1 Banks are Canadian owned, while Schedule II Banks are subsidiaries of foreign owned Banks and Schedule III Banks are foreign owned Banks. Bank Act The legislation that governs chartered banks in Canada Borrower The individual responsible for the receipt and repayment of mortgage proceeds British North America Act, 1867 On March 29, 1867, the British Parliament passed the British North America Act, which established the provisions of the Confederation of the Province of Canada (Ontario and Quebec), New Brunswick and Nova Scotia into a federal state with a parliamentary system patterned on the British model. The Act established the division of powers between the central Parliament and the provincial legislatures. The federal government was responsible for, among other things, banking business, criminal law, the post office, the armed forces; the provinces could legislate, among other things, property law, contracts, and local work. Commercial Mortgages A commercial mortgage is similar to a residential mortgage, except the collateral is a commercial building or other business real estate, not residential property. Constitution Act, 1867 The Constitution Act, 1867 (formerly called the British North America Act, 1867, and still known informally as the BNA Act), constitutes a major part of Canada's Constitution. The Act entails the original creation of a federal dominion and defines much of the operation of the Government of Canada, including its federal structure, the House of Commons, the Senate, the justice system, and the taxation system. It received its current name in 1982, with the patriation of the constitution (originally being enacted by the British Parliament). 30 Chapter 1: Market Overview CPMA Designation The Certified Professional Mortgage Agent designation awarded by IMBA CPMB Designation The Certified Professional Mortgage Broker designation awarded by IMBA Crown The executive branch of government, the Queen acting through Her Agents (the members of the Cabinet) Demographics Refers to selected population characteristics as used in government, marketing or opinion research Errors and Omissions Insurance Insurance that provides coverage for errors or omissions made by a brokerage, broker, agent or Administrator. This insurance must contain a provision for fraud. Expropriate/Expropriation The act of a public authority (such as federal, provincial, municipal governments or other bodies empowered by statute) taking property without the consent of an owner through a statutory or common law process. This process involves the payment of compensation to the owner by the authority and the owner having the right to claim additional compensation to be determined by the courts or an administrative board. Compensation is intended to make the owner whole, in light of the loss suffered. Financial Statements Formal records of a business' financial activities. These statements provide an overview of a business' profitability and financial condition in both short and long term. Foreclosure A lender’s remedy that enables the lender to obtain title to the defaulted borrower’s property and dispose of it. Any profit or loss will belong to the lender while the borrower is free of the debt. FSCO The Financial Services Commission of Ontario. This is the regulatory body that oversees the mortgage brokerage industry and enforces the Mortgage Brokerages, lenders and Administrators Act, 2006 (formerly the Mortgage agents Act), as well as several other industries and Acts. Home Inspector A home inspection is a non‐invasive examination of the condition of a home, often in connection with the sale of that home. This is carried out by a home inspector, who usually has special equipment and training to carry out such inspections. IMBA The Independent Mortgage agents Association of Ontario, the provincial mortgage association of Ontario Chapter 1: Market Overview 31 Income Approach An approach to calculating the value of an income producing property through the usage of the net operating income and capitalization rate typical for that type of property and the area in which it is located Institutional lender A lender considered to be a Bank, Loan or Trust Company, Credit Union or caisses populaires. Institutional Mortgage Originator An individual employed by an institutional lender to provide suitable borrowers to that institution for mortgage financing Lawyer A person licensed to practice law Life Insurance Company A licensed company providing life insurance to policy holders Mortgage Administrator An individual or business that processes mortgage loans on behalf of another party. Mortgage Backed Security An investment in a pool of amortized residential mortgages insured through CMHC under the National Housing Act (NHA) Mortgage Agent or Broker Individuals who are remunerated for dealing in mortgages or trading in mortgages in Ontario, as employees or otherwise. A mortgage agent may hold the position of principal broker and may supervise licensed mortgage agents. Mortgage agents must be licensed. Mortgage Brokerage Community The mortgage brokerage industry as a whole Mortgage Brokerages, lenders and Administrators Act, 2006 The legislation that governs the mortgage brokerage industry in Ontario. This legislation is enforced by FSCO and replaces the previous Mortgage agents Act. Mortgage agents Act The legislation predating the Mortgage Brokerages, lenders and Administrators Act, 2006. This legislation governed the mortgage brokerage industry in Ontario until July 1st, 2008 and was enforced by FSCO. Mortgage Default Insurer An insurer that provides a policy to the insured lender. This policy will compensate the lender for losses incurred in a mortgage transaction. As of 2011 the insurers that are in Ontario include CMHC, Genworth Financial and Canada Guaranty. Mortgage Investment Corporation (MIC) A corporation created to invest in mortgages. Investors purchase shares in the corporation and 32 Chapter 1: Market Overview receive income through dividend payments. Mortgage Professionals Canada, aka The Canadian Association of Accredited Mortgage Professionals (CAAMP) A national mortgage industry association National Housing Act (NHA) The legislation that created mortgage default insurance in 1954 Non‐Conforming Mortgage Market Mortgage loans for borrowers who have impaired credit or some other impairment that prevents them from being able to qualify for traditional lending products Ontario Real Estate Association (OREA) A professional association of Ontario Real Estate practitioners Premiums (Life Insurance) Payments made in return for a policy Private lender A private lender is typically an individual investor with funds who would like to invest in mortgages. This individual will usually invest through his or her lawyer who may have clients requiring mortgage financing or a mortgage agent. His or her purpose may vary but normally an investor will invest in 2nd mortgages due to their higher rate of return when compared to 1st mortgages and other potential types of investments such as GICs or bonds. Real Estate and Mortgage Institute of Canada Inc. (REMIC) A national organization dedicated to providing the mortgage and real estate industries with resources designed to increase market penetration and the success of its members. Real Estate Appraiser An individual, usually licensed, who provides a report illustrating several components of a property, including its value, usually in the form of its market value Real Estate Board A non‐profit organization representing local real estate brokers and agents, that provides services to its members Real Estate Broker According to the Real Estate and Business Brokers Act, 2002, a “Broker” means an individual who has the prescribed qualifications to be registered as a broker under the Act and who is employed by a brokerage to trade in real estate. Real Estate Brokerage According to the Real Estate and Business Brokers Act, 2002, a “Brokerage” means a corporation, partnership, sole proprietor, association or other organization or entity that, on behalf of others and for compensation or reward or the expectation of such, trades in real estate or holds himself, herself or itself out as such. Real Estate Lawyer Chapter 1: Market Overview 33 A lawyer specializing in real estate law Real Estate Salesperson/Salespersons According to the Real Estate and Business Brokers Act, 2002, an “agent” means an individual who has the prescribed qualifications to be registered as an agent under this Act and who is employed by a brokerage to trade in real estate. Residential Mortgages Mortgage lending on properties that are zoned residential Securitization The selling of a pool of mortgages to a third party Sub‐Prime Mortgage A mortgage loan for a borrower who has impaired credit or some other impairment that prevents him or her from being able to qualify for traditional lending products Sub‐Prime Mortgage Market A market for borrowers who do not qualify for traditional lending products Title Insurer A provider of title insurance Title Insurance An insurance policy that provides protection against errors in title such as survey errors, zoning infractions and property encroachments. It can also protect the homeowner against fraud. 34 Chapterr 1: Market O verview 1.11 1 Review w Questio ons Answers to the Revview Questio ons are found at www.REM MIC.ca Sho ort Answe er Questio ons 1. Wh hat are the main m differencces between Schedule S I, II and III Banks? 2. Lisst and define the t key particcipants in the e Ontario morrtgage industtry. 3. Explain when an nd why bankss began lending in the resiidential mortggage market.. 4. De efine the sub‐prime mortgaage market. e sub‐prime market m in the United State s collapsed in n 2007. 5. Explain why the 6. Wh hat impact haas the U.S. sub‐prime markket collapse hhad on the On ntario mortgaage market? 7. Wh hich type of lender is the predominant p lender in thee Canadian mortgage markket? 8. Wh hat segment of the Canadian populatio on has a Beacon Score of 7750 to 799? 9. Wh hat are the six major differences betwe een the comm mercial and reesidential mo ortgage maarkets? 10. What W is the typ pical maximum loan to vallue of a privatte mortgage?? 11. What W advice would w you give e to an individual wishing to invest in m mortgages? W options are available for investors who wish to invest in mortgages but h have a low 12. What tollerance for rissk? 13. What W are the two t mortgage e associationss currently in operation in Ontario and what are thee diffferences betw ween the two o? 14. Discuss the rolle of professio onal designattions in the m mortgage indu ustry and explain how theyy are e of benefit to o the mortgage agent. 35 Chapter 1: Market Overview Appendix 1: Schedule 1 Banks Schedule 1 Banks8 As at December 31, 2014 Name of Bank B2B Bank Bank of Montreal Bank of Nova Scotia (The) Bridgewater Bank Canadian Imperial Bank of Commerce Canadian Tire Bank Canadian Western Bank CFF Bank Citizens Bank of Canada Continental Bank of Canada CS Alterna Bank DirectCash Bank Equitable Bank First Nations Bank of Canada General Bank of Canada Hollis Canadian Bank HomEquity Bank Laurentian Bank of Canada Manulife Bank of Canada National Bank of Canada Pacific & Western Bank of Canada President’s Choice Bank RedBrick Bank Rogers Bank Royal Bank of Canada Tangerine Bank Toronto‐Dominion Bank (The) Zag Bank 8 Schedule I, Bank Act ( 1991, c. 46 ) Head Office Ontario Quebec Nova Scotia Alberta Ontario Ontario Alberta Alberta British Columbia Ontario Ontario Alberta Ontario Saskatchewan Alberta Ontario Ontario Quebec Ontario Quebec Ontario Ontario Ontario Ontario Quebec Ontario Ontario Alberta 36 Chapter 1: Market Overview Appendix 2: Schedule 2 Banks Schedule 2 Banks9 As at December 31, 2014 Name of Bank Amex Bank of Canada Bank of America Canada Bank of China (Canada) Bank of Tokyo‐Mitsubishi UFJ (Canada) Bank One Canada BNP Paribas (Canada) BofA Canada Bank Citco Bank Canada Citibank Canada CTBC Bank Corp. (Canada) Habib Canadian Bank HSBC Bank Canada ICICI Bank Canada Industrial and Commercial Bank of China (Canada) J.P. Morgan Bank Canada J.P. Morgan Canada Korea Exchange Bank of Canada Mega International Commercial Bank (Canada) Shinhan Bank Canada Société Générale (Canada) State Bank of India (Canada) Sumitomo Mitsui Banking Corporation of Canada UBS Bank (Canada) Walmart Canada Bank 9 Schedule II, Bank Act ( 1991, c. 46 ) Head Office Ontario Ontario Ontario Ontario Ontario Quebec Ontario Ontario Ontario British Columbia Ontario British Columbia Ontario Ontario Ontario Ontario Ontario Ontario Ontario Quebec Ontario Ontario Ontario Ontario 37 Chapter 1: Market Overview Appendix 3: Schedule 3 Banks Schedule 3 Banks10 As at December 31, 2014 Name of Authorized Foreign Bank (FB) Bank of America, National Association Bank of New York Mellon (The) Barclays Bank PLC BNP Paribas Capital One Bank (USA), N.A. China Construction Bank Citibank, N.A. Comerica Bank Coöperatieve Centrale Raiffeisen‐ Boerenleenbank B.A. Credit Suisse AG Deutsche Bank AG Fifth Third Bank First Commercial Bank JPMorgan Chase Bank, National Association M&T Bank Maple Bank GmbH Merrill Lynch International Bank Limited Mizuho Bank, Ltd. Northern Trust Company (The) PNC Bank, National Association 10 Name under which FB is permitted to carry on business in Canada Bank of America, National Association Bank of New York Mellon (The) Barclays Bank PLC, Canada Branch BNP Baribas Capital One Bank (Canada Branch) China Construction Bank Toronto Branch Citibank, N.A. Comerica Bank Type of Foreign Bank Branch (FBB) Principal Office Full‐service Ontario Full‐service Ontario Full‐service Ontario Full‐service Quebec Full‐service Ontario Full‐service Ontario Full‐service Full‐service Ontario Ontario Full‐service Ontario Lending Ontario Full‐service Full‐service Ontario Ontario First Commercial Bank Full‐service British Columbia JPMorgan Chase Bank, National Association Full‐service Ontario M&T Bank Maple Bank Full‐service Full‐service Ontario Ontario Merrill Lynch International Bank Limited Lending Ontario Full‐service Ontario Full‐service Ontario Full‐service Ontario Rabobank Nederland Credit Suisse AG, Toronto Branch Deutsche Bank AG Fifth Third Bank Mizuho Bank, Ltd., Canada Branch Northern Trust Company, Canada Branch (The) PNC Bank Canada Branch Schedule III, Bank Act ( 1991, c. 46) 38 Royal Bank of Scotland N.V. (The) Royal Bank of Scotland plc (The) Société Générale State Street Bank and Trust Company U.S. Bank National Association UBS AG MUFG Union Bank, National Association United Overseas Bank Limited Wells Fargo Bank, National Association Chapter 1: Market Overview Royal Bank of Scotland N.V., (Canada) Branch (The) Royal Bank of Scotland plc, Canada Branch (The) Société Générale (Canada Branch) Full‐service Ontario Full‐service Ontario Full‐service Quebec Full‐service Ontario Full‐service Ontario Full‐service Ontario Union Bank, Canada Branch Lending Alberta United Overseas Bank Limited Full‐service British Columbia Wells Fargo Bank, National Association, Canadian Branch Full‐service Ontario State Street U.S. Bank National Association UBS AG Canada Branch Chapter 2: Basic Mortgage Concepts 39 Chapter 2: Basic Mortgage Concepts Learning Outcomes Successful understanding of the concepts presented in this chapter will enable the learner to: Explain the term “mortgage” Explain the role of a mortgage agent Explain what constitutes the mortgage contract Describe the documents related to the registration and discharge of a mortgage Explain how mortgages are ranked, such as 1st, 2nd and other mortgages Describe the need for mortgage financing Discuss the two main purposes of mortgages: purchasing and refinancing Differentiate between a conventional and high ratio mortgage Differentiate between a standard mortgage and a collateral mortgage Introduction The Ontario mortgage market has experienced various changes over the past two decades, with the introduction of new mortgage brokering legislation in 2008, and more recently with the loss of a few mortgage lenders, the introduction of several new lenders, changes in many lender’s guidelines and the implementation of several new regulatory modifications regarding mortgage financing in Canada, such as alterations of certain default insurance policies. The mortgage brokerage industry in Ontario has also experienced a variety of changes over the past several years. What was once a small, fringe industry has grown into the mainstream, gathering more acceptance by the consumer as a whole. Although the industry still has a long way to go to achieve the results of our American counterparts where it was estimated that between 75% and 80% of all mortgage transactions were brokered prior to the mortgage crisis (statistics are not precise at this time), the Ontario mortgage brokerage industry is well on its way. A major reason behind this transformation is the professionalism that both consumers and the industry itself have begun demanding of mortgage agents. In a complex market where consumer choice for mortgage financing is more diverse than at any other time in history, it has become necessary to upgrade the training available to the industry. As professional students of the mortgage industry, all must endeavour to keep abreast of the innovations in the market. For the new student or someone just entering the industry, it is necessary to begin with a firm foundation of knowledge related to mortgage financing in Ontario. 40 Chapter C 2: Bassic Mortgage Concepts 2.1 What is s a Mortg gage? Defiinition Accorrding to the Ontario O Mortg gages Act, R.SS.O. 1990 c.M M.40 (the legisslation that go overns mortggages in Ontaario), the word mortgage iss defined as, “any charge o on any propeerty for securing money orr money’s wo orth.” Most consumers would w not neccessarily unde erstand that ttechnical defiinition. In acttuality, a mortggage is eviden nce of a debt.. It is both an n interest in laand created b by the mortgaage contract and se ecurity for a debt. d Howe ever, the more common de efinition of a mortgage staates that: A morrtgage is a loaan secured byy real properrty That is a straightfo orward, simple definition, but b there is m more to a mortgage than tthis. This definiition must be broken down into its core e componentts. A loan This is the amou unt of moneyy advanced to o a borrower. Secured This means thatt a Charge (a legal docume ent that outli nes the terms of the loan)) is registered d on title of the property p to se ecure the loan n. If the borroower defaults on the loan, the lender has the right to exercise its interest in the e security throough several methods. Pa ause for cla arification n ‐ Title Tittle is a term that refers to the ownership of a bundlee of rights thaat its owner h has in a property, typicaally fee simple ownership. If somethingg is registered d “on title” it means that iit o regisstered againsst the ownersship of the prooperty througgh the Land TTitles Office, is officially wh here propertyy ownership is recorded. eal Property Re Re eal property iss the term use ed to describe the home aand the land u upon which itt resides. It iss a legal term thaat differentiattes real estate e ownership ffrom other tyypes of propeerty such as personal property. Personall property is comprised c of items that arre typically m movable pro operty, also often o referred d to as chatte els. 2.2 Collate eral Mortg gages Unlike e a standard mortgage thaat places a charge on title, a collateral m mortgage, wh hich has been n aroun nd for years but b typically only o used for secured s lines of credit, is a promissory note with a lien on the propertty for the totaal amount reggistered. Youu can registerr more debt aagainst the prope erty than the property is worth w since no ormal regulattory limitation ns on loan to values do no ot apply. Chapter 2: Basic Mortgage Concepts 41 For example, TD Bank changed their mortgage lending practices on October 18, 2010, changing their mortgages to collateral mortgages. They began registering 125% of the property value, even though that amount may not have been advanced to the borrower initially. Since the collateral mortgage allows for the “re‐advancing” of principal, like a revolving line of credit, the balance can rise. Most chartered banks will not allow transfers of collateral mortgages from other chartered banks. This results in additional legal fees over and above what are normally charged for a straight transfer on renewal because the mortgage must be fully discharged as opposed to simply being transferred. In addition, collateral mortgages allow lenders to lend more money to borrowers, based on their qualifications, after closing without registering a new mortgage because the current mortgage is registered at a higher amount than is advanced. The rate can also be increased because the rate on the collateral mortgage is also registered at a higher amount than is charged. For example, a bank can register a mortgage at 125% of the value of the home and at prime plus 10%, but may only advance 80% of the value of the home and charge prime at the time of closing. This allows for both additional advances of principal and increases in the rate during the life of the mortgage. Since the mortgage is registered for such a high loan to value, the homeowner won’t be able to take out a second mortgage, regardless of how low the outstanding balance is on the first mortgage. While this type of situation allows for the homeowner to borrow more funds after closing without having to discharge a current mortgage and register a new one, it also comes with the above mentioned risk, making it important to explain this to the borrower when arranging this type of product. 2.3 What is a Mortgage Agent/Broker? There are two licenses that allow individuals to broker a mortgage: mortgage agent and mortgage agent. The difference between these two licenses is that a mortgage broker, in addition to being able to broker mortgages, can also be the Principal Broker of a mortgage brokerage. Each mortgage brokerage must have one Principal Broker to ensure that the brokerage, its agents and brokers comply with the appropriate legislation and regulations. For our purposes we will use the term mortgage agent and mortgage agent interchangeably, as both terms refer to a licensed individual authorized to broker mortgages in Ontario. A mortgage agent/broker is a practicing professional, licensed by the Financial Services Commission of Ontario (FSCO) who assesses a borrower’s financial goals with respect to real estate financing and, after detailed analysis, provides solutions to meet those goals by acting as an intermediary with the appropriate lending source. Mortgage agents have two clients: the borrower (the individual receiving the mortgage) and the lender (the provider of the mortgage). In order to maintain a healthy market, it is imperative that the broker “marry” the borrower to the lender best suited for both. In Ontario, the legal distinction between a mortgage agent and a mortgage agent is determined by licensing. Until July 2008, mortgage agents had to be licensed in Ontario while mortgage 42 Chapter C 2: Bassic Mortgage Concepts ensed) by the eir broker withh the FSCO. A As a matter o of interest, the agentts were registtered (not lice term mortgage age ent did not evven exist in Ontario O legislaation until thee Mortgage a agents Act waas replacced by the Mortgage Brokkerages, lendeers and Adminnistrators Actt, 2006 (2006 6 makes up part of o the title and is not when n it was enactted). As of July 2008, un nder the Morttgage Brokera ages, lenders and Adminisstrators Act, 2 2006, there are th hree distinct licensing cate egories with re egards to brookering (theree is also a mortgage admin nistrator’s lice ense, but that doesn’t affe ect brokering activities). FFor individualss there are the mortgage m agen nt and mortgaage agent lice enses. For ann organization n there is the mortgage broke erage license. This le egislation takkes into accou unt that the in ndustry has c hanged from the “Mom and Pop” typee broke erage where a mortgage aggent was typiically an indivvidual, to the era of the “Super Broker”” where e brokerages typically emp ploy from sevveral to severral hundred m mortgage agen nts. The ro ole of the mo ortgage agentt/broker revolves around hhis or her abillity to obtain a client and fulfill the financingg needs of thaat client. In essence, the r ole of the mo ortgage agentt involves sellingg the right product to the client, and se elling the cliennt to the right lender. Forr the purpose of sim mplicity, the tiitles mortgage agent and mortgage m ageent will be useed interchanggeably throughout this bo ook. 2.4 The Mortgage M Contractt The Standarrd Charge e Terms The Standard Charrge Terms is a document th hat is createdd by the lendeer and must b be registered with the t Director of o Titles unde er the Land Tittles Act. Manny lenders’ Sttandard Chargge Terms can n be vie ewed at httpss://www.teranetexpress.caa/content/tv user/schedules/ereg_fidocs.html d is the mortgage contract. It contains c detaailed informattion on the leender’s and This document borro ower’s obligattions, referred d to as covenants, as well as the remed dies available to the lender if the borrower does not meet these t obligations. A covennant is a prom mise to do or not do something. In a mortgage m conttract, both the e mortgagee,, who is the leender, and mortgagor, thee borro ower, have covenants that each must ab bide by. It is viital to undersstand that the e borrower, while w at the laawyer’s signin ng the final do ocumentation n to reggister the morrtgage, signs acceptance of o the Standarrd Charge Terrms. What m many borro owers fail to re ealize is that they have Staandard Chargge Terms on ttheir mortgagge and that they outline o the rigghts and resp ponsibilities of the borroweer. Contravention of the tterms of this docum ment is consid dered defaultt and the lend der can exerccise its rights, which the bo orrower agree es to, that are e found in thiss document. The fo ollowing is a breakdown b of both the mo ortgagor and mortgagee ccovenants as listed in the Stand dard Charge Terms. T Borrrower Co ovenants When n a borrower pledges his or o her real pro operty as secuurity for a loaan by placing a mortgage on thaat property, he h or she has several obliggations. Chapter C 2: Bassic Mortgage Concepts 4 43 epay the loan 1. Re The borrower agrees a to repaay the loan baased on the ppayment scheedule outlined d in the contract. Failurre to do so re esults in the borrower deem med to be in default or in contraventio on of the terms of the mortgage e contract. 2. Inssure the prop perty The borrower agrees a to keep p adequate property insurrance on the property to p protect the len nder from losing his or herr security due e to a fire or oother covered d risks. If the borrower fails to keep insuran nce on their property, the lender l will coonsider him o or her in defau ult. 3. Ma aintain the property The borrower agrees a to keep p the propertty in good saleeable condition including repairing anyy po ortion of the property p that requires it. Failure F to do so will result in the lenderr considering the e borrower to o be in defaullt. 4. No ot to commit waste Waaste is a legall term which includes actio ons or conducct that could result in dam mage to the pro operty or a lo oss of propertty value. Com mmitting wastte will result in the lender considering the e borrower to o be in defaullt. This may include signifiicant renovattions, such ass the addition of another store ey to the buillding. This is due to the faact that if the borrower run ns out of mo oney during the renovation and it remaains incompleete, the valuee of the propeerty will be dim minished. axes 5. Pay Property Ta The borrower iss required to pay his or her property ta xes on time. If the borrow wer doesn’t the e lender can pay p those taxxes, add them m to the borroower’s mortgaage and/or co onsider the bo orrower in deffault. This is because the Municipality M can register a lien against the bo orrower’s prop perty for unp paid taxes. Th his lien will ta ke precedencce over any o other mo ortgages regisstered on title e reducing the lender’s se curity. 6. Follow the term ms of the Stan ndard Charge e Terms The Standard Charge Terms is the docum ment that makkes up the bulk of the conttract. It is vitaal to understand that t the borro ower, while at a the lawyer’ s signing the final documeentation to reggister the mo ortgage signs acceptance a of o the Standarrd Charge Terrms. This doccument details the e rights and responsibilitie es of the borrower. Contraavention of th he terms of this documentt is considered c de efault and the e lender can exercise e its ri ghts, which tthe borrower agrees to, thaat are found in i this docum ment. Len der Cove enants The mortgagee, m orr lender, also has several covenants by which they m must abide. TThe following list su ummarizes tho ose covenantts. 1. Ce ertificate of Discharge D On nce the mortggagee has recceived funds that t are sufficcient to comp pletely repay the outstanding ballance of the mortgage, m the e mortgagee is required to o provide the mortgagor, o or bo orrower, with a Certificate of Discharge that indicatees that the am mount borrow wed has been rep paid in full. The T mortgage ee does not haave to registeer this certificcate of dischaarge on title, wh hich means th hat the borrow wer is respon nsible for haviing this registtered. If the mortgage is 44 Chapter C 2: Bassic Mortgage Concepts being refinance ed by anotherr lender, it is standard s proccedure for the new lenderr to have their Solicitor closingg the mortgagge register the e certificate oof discharge b before they reegister their new charge. 2. Assignment of mortgage The mortgagor has the right to request th hat the mortggagee assign tthe mortgagee to a new len nder as long as a the mortgaagor’s mortgaage is in good standing and d the mortgaggor has the rigght to redeem m the mortgagge. For the exxact legislatioon referring to o assignmentts, refer to the Mo ortgages Act, Part 1, and Section S 2. 3. Pro ovide Quiet Possession P Qu uiet Possessio on is a legal te erm that refle ects the right of the mortggagor to have possession o of the e property fre ee from interference by th he mortgageee, except wheen in default. 2.5 Mortga age Regis stration Document D tation The Charge/Mortg C gage The Charge/Mortg C gage is the insstrument thatt is used to reegister the deebt or loan aggainst the borro ower’s properrty. It forms the t security of o the debt. D of Charge/Mortg C gage The Discharge This iss the instrument used to discharge d the debt or loan against the b borrower’s prroperty. It releasses the lender’s interest in n the propertyy. Case Study S – Figurres 6 ‐ 9 Jack Adams A curren ntly has a seco ond mortgage e on his cond ominium with a private leender. You have arranged a ne ew mortgage through Sup perBank for $225,000 that Jaack is using to o pay off this secon nd mortgage. Figure 6 sho ows the new charge/mortg c gage that is beeing registereed on Jack’s condo ominium whille Figure 9 shows the disch harge of charrge registered d by the privaate lender’s lawye er. If Jack wass getting a collateral mortggage, the chaarge would look like it does in figure 7. The Charge//Mortgage e Figure 6 – Charge/Mortgage LRO # 80 Charge/M Mortgage Receipted R as A AT1101777 on 2008 10 10 yyyyy mm dd pplicant(s) hereeby applies to the Land Regisstrar. The ap at 16:15 Page 1 of 1 Pro operties Pin 118 872‐0259 LT Interest/Estate Fee Simp le Descriiption UN NIT 6, LEVEL 16 6, METROPOLITTAN TORONTO O CONDOMINIU UM CORPORATTION NO. 811, PTT LT 2, PL 1234,, CITY OF TORO ONTO AS DESC RIBED IN SCHEEDULE ‘A’ OF D DECLARATION D1 167901 TORON NTO, CITY OF TO ORONTO Address 1211 SUITE 04 4727 SHEPPARD D AVENUE EASST TO ORONTO 45 Chapter 2: Basic Mortgage Concepts Chargor(s) The chargor(s) hereby charges the land to the chargee(s). The chargor(s) acknowledges the receipt of the charge and standard charge terms, if any Name ADAMS, JACK Address for Service 4727 Sheppard Avenue East Toronto, Ontario M1S 5B2 I am at least 18 years of age. This document is not authorized under Power of Attorney by this party. Chargee(s) Capacity Name SUPERBANK Address for Service 5588 King Street East Toronto, Ontario L1L 1L1 Share Provisions Principal $25,000.00 Calculation Period semi‐annually, not in advance Balance Due Date 2009 10 31 Interest Rate 14.75% Payments $338.26 Interest Adjustment Date 2008 10 10 Payment Date Last day of each and every month First Payment Date 2008 11 30 Last Payment Date 2009 10 31 Standard Charge Terms 200033 Insurance Amount full insurable value Guarantor N/A CurrencyCDN Additional Provisions This Charge/Mortgage of Land secures the monies owing by the Chargor to the Chargee from time to time up to the Principal Amount as set out in the Standard Charge Terms. See schedules 46 Chapter C 2: Bassic Mortgage Concepts Sig gned By Pau ul Jonathon Jacobs Tel Fax 55 Main Stree et Toronto M1M M 1K1 acting for Chargor(s) Signed 2008 8 10 10 4165559990 4165559991 1 ocument on beehalf of the Chaargor(s) I havve the authoritty to sign and register the do Sub bmitted By PAU UL JACOBS, BAR RRRISTOR & SOLLICITOR Tel 4165559990 1 Fax 4165559991 55 Main Stree et Toronto M1M M 1K1 8 10 10 Signed 2008 Fee es/Taxes/Pa ayment Statu utory Registratio on Fee $60.00 Totaal Paid $60.00 File e Number Charrgor Client File Number: N 08‐1823 The Collaterral Charg e/Mortga age Figure 7 – Collateral Charge/Mortgag C ge LRO # 80 Charge/M Mortgage Receipted R as A AT1101777 on 2008 10 10 yyyyy mm dd pplicant(s) hereeby applies to the Land Regisstrar. The ap at 16:15 Page 1 of 1 Pro operties Pin 118 872‐0259 LT Interest/Estate Fee Simp le Descriiption UN NIT 6, LEVEL 16 6, METROPOLITTAN TORONTO O CONDOMINIU UM CORPORATTION NO. 811, PTT LT 2, PL 1234,, CITY OF TORO ONTO AS DESC RIBED IN SCHEEDULE ‘A’ OF D DECLARATION D1 167901 TORON NTO, CITY OF TO ORONTO Address 1211 SUITE 04 4727 SHEPPARD D AVENUE EASST TO ORONTO Cha argor(s) The ch hargor(s) hereb by charges the land to the ch hargee(s). The chargor(s) ackknowledges thee receipt of thee charge e and standard d charge terms, if any Name ADAMS, JACK 47 Chapter 2: Basic Mortgage Concepts Address for Service 4727 Sheppard Avenue East Toronto, Ontario M1S 5B2 I am at least 18 years of age. This document is not authorized under Power of Attorney by this party. Chargee(s) Capacity Name SUPERBANK Address for Service 5588 King Street East Toronto, Ontario L1L 1L1 Share Provisions Principal $25,000.00 CurrencyCDN Calculation Period See Additional Provisions Interest Rate See Additional Provisions Payment Date ON DEMAND Interest Adjustment Date 2008 10 10 Payment Date Last day of each and every month First Payment Date 2008 11 30 Last Payment Date 2009 10 31 Standard Charge Terms 201027 Insurance Amount full insurable value Guarantor N/A Additional Provisions See Schedule 1 Signed By Paul Jonathon Jacobs Tel Fax 55 Main Street Toronto M1M 1K1 acting for Chargor(s) Signed 2008 10 10 4165559990 4165559991 I have the authority to sign and register the document on behalf of the Chargor(s) Submitted By PAUL JACOBS, BARRRISTOR & 55 Main Street Toronto M1M 1K1 Signed 2008 10 10 48 Chapter C 2: Bassic Mortgage Concepts SOLLICITOR Tel 4165559990 Fax 4165559991 1 Fee es/Taxes/Pa ayment Statu utory Registratio on Fee $60.00 Totaal Paid $60.00 File e Number Charrgor Client File Number: N 08‐1823 Figure 8 – Schedule forr Collateral Charge The Discharg ge of Cha arge Figure 9 – Discharge of Charge LRO # 80 Dischargge of Charge Receipted R as A AT1101589 on 2008 10 05 yyyyy mm dd pplicant(s) hereeby applies to the Land Regisstrar. The ap at 16:15 Page 1 of 1 Pro operties Pin 11872‐0259 9 LT Interest/Estate Fee Simp le Descriiption UN NIT 6, LEVEL 16 6, METROPOLITTAN TORONTO O CONDOMINIU UM CORPORATTION NO. 811, PTT LT 2, PL 1234,, CITY OF TORO ONTO AS DESC RIBED IN SCHEEDULE ‘A’ OF D DECLARATION D1 167901 TORON NTO, CITY OF TO ORONTO Address 1211 SUITE 04 4727 SHEPPARD D AVENUE EASST TO ORONTO 49 Chapter 2: Basic Mortgage Concepts Document to be Discharged Registration No. Date: Type of Instrument: AT770911 2008 10 05 Charge/Mortgage Discharging Party(s) This discharge complies with the Planning Act. This discharge discharges the charge. Name LENDER, PRIVATE Address for Service 1299 John Street, Toronto, Ontario, L4B 1B1 This document is not authorized under Power of Attorney by this party. This party giving this discharge is the original chargee and is the party entitled to file an effective discharge. Signed By Lender, Private Tel 416 5551255 Fax 4165551266 1299 John Street Toronto L4B 1B1 acting for Applicant(s) Signed 2008 10 01 Submitted By LEGALWORKS, INC. 987 Adams Street Toronto M1M 1K1 Tel 416 5556547 Fax 4165556548 Fees/Taxes/Payment Statutory Registration Fee Total Paid $60.00 $60.00 Signed 2008 10 05 50 2.6 Chapter 2: Basic Mortgage Concepts Mortgage Ranks There are different ranks of mortgages, referring to the number of mortgages on the same property. A first mortgage simply means that the mortgage was registered first, or before any other mortgages on the property. A mortgage registered after the first mortgage is called a second mortgage. A mortgage registered after the second mortgage would be considered a third mortgage, and so on. If a borrower who has a first and second mortgage pays off that first mortgage, the second mortgage would now become the first mortgage. The rank of the mortgage has nothing to do with the amount of the mortgage but in most cases lenders will not advance a second mortgage that is larger than the first mortgage or that exceeds a maximum percentage of the size of the first mortgage. Typically the interest rate on a mortgage will increase with the level of risk attached to that mortgage. A second mortgage is considered riskier than a first, a third mortgage riskier than a second, and so on. The reasoning behind this is that if the borrower defaulted on the first mortgage, the first mortgage lender would begin the power of sale process to recover the money owing on its mortgage. Once the property is sold, the remainder of the proceeds of the sale would go to the other mortgage holders, such as a second mortgage lender. This is a risk for the second mortgage lender since there may not be enough money left from the sale of the property to fully pay off their mortgage. To offset this risk the second mortgage lender will typically charge a higher interest rate. 2.7 Why is Mortgage Financing Needed? In Ontario, housing costs have risen from an average of $155,000 in 1995 to $360,000 in 2010. This represents an annual increase of 5.78%. If a family had wanted to purchase a home in 2010 and had started saving in 1995, it would have had to save $15,467 per year (assuming a rate of return on their savings of 6% for those fifteen years to come up with the full purchase price). That equates to $1,288.92 per month. The average Canadian family’s gross income as of 1995 was approximately $51,0001, or $4,250 per month. The amount that this average family would have to spend to save this amount would be equal to 30% of its gross income. Considering that this family would still be renting and using considerably more of its income, it becomes evident as to why there is such a significant need for mortgages. As it stands, the percentage of “shelter to income” costs (the percentage of income that is used to pay for shelter or housing costs) was approximately 21% in 19952. However the numbers are analyzed, they do not add up. It is therefore not plausible for the average Canadian to save the purchase price of a home. In addition it has become increasingly difficult for individuals to save for a down payment. In fact, the average debt‐to‐income ratio (the amount of debt compared to income, expressed as a 1 2 Statistics Canada, Statistics Canada Chapter C 2: Bassic Mortgage Concepts 5 51 entage) for the average Canadian house ehold was a sttaggering 1633% in 20123, ccompared to perce 150% in 2010, 105% in 1995 and 55% in 19834. This gavee birth to morre aggressive programs such as a the “No Money Down” mortgage wh here the purcchaser can ob btain a mortgaage without having to provide a down paym ment. Pa ause for cla arification n – Down payment p A down d payment is the amo ount of moneyy that a purchhaser will be providing from his or her proceeds (not borrowed) b tow wards the purchase price of the properrty being purchased. Pa ause for cla arification n – Down payment p reequiremen nts for insu ured mortgag ges Efffective February 15, 2016 the minimum m down paym ment for new iinsured mortgages inccreased from 5% to 10% fo or the portion n of the housee price abovee $500,000. TThe 5% miinimum down n payment for insured mortgages remaains for propeerties up to $5 500,000. For example, a pro operty being purchased p forr $500,000 w would require a minimum d down paayment of $25 5,000 (.05 x $500,000). A property beinng purchased d for $1,000,0 000 would req quire a minim mum down paayment of $75 5,000 (.05 x tthe first $500,,000 plus .10 x the next $5 500,000) 2.8 The Pu urposes of o Using a Mortgag ge There e are four typical purposess that mortgagges are used for. 1. Purchase 2. Refinance 3. Equity take e‐outs 4. Bridge Finaancing Purc chase Peoplle use mortgaages to assist in purchasingg a home in ccombination w with a down p payment, or depen nding on the financing avaailable, they may m qualify too borrow the complete purchase price. A dow wn payment is the amountt of money th hat the purchaaser has to giive to the ven ndor in cash. The balance of the e purchase price is made up of a mortgaage. Refiinance If a bo orrower alreaady has a hom me, he or she may wish to refinance thee property. R Refinancing mean ns to increase the size of th he mortgage, or renegotiatte it in some fashion. If hee or she decides to do this during the term of the mo ortgage, that person may h have to pay a penalty to the le ender for repaaying the morrtgage before e the end of t he mortgage contract, refferred to as the te erm, unless th he current mo ortgage is fullly open. The refinanced m mortgage will reflect the 3 4 http:://www.statcan.gc.ca/pub/75‐006‐x/20150 001/article/141167‐eng.htm CBC Newsworld 52 Chapter C 2: Bassic Mortgage Concepts er’s current raate of interestt, which may or may not bbe lower than the borroweer’s current lende rate. Su uccess Tip – Home Buyer’s Program (HBP P) Th he Canada Revenue Agenccy (CRA) has a program enttitled the Hom me Buyer’s Prrogram (HBP)) that allows a first time buye er to use up to o $25,000 of ttheir RRSPs aas a down payyment withou ut paaying tax on the withdrawaal. The amou unt removed must be repaaid within 15 years. pouse, or com RA defines a first f time buyer as an indivvidual or the iindividual’s sp mmon‐law CR paartner who haas not owned d a home thatt they occupieed as a principal place of rresidence du uring the period beginningg January 1 off the fourth yeear before th he year of thee withdrawal an nd ending 31 days before the t withdraw wal. or example, iff you withdrew w funds on March M 31, 20115, the four‐yyear period would have Fo be egun on Januaary 1, 2011 and would havve ended on FFebruary 28, 2015. Su uccess Tip – Home Buyer’s Taxx Credit (HB BTC) Fo or 2011 and subsequent ye ears, the fede eral governmeent provides a non‐refund dable tax credit, based on an amount of $5,000, fo or certain hom me buyers thaat acquire a q qualifying ho ome. The HBTTC is calculated by multipllying the loweest personal iincome tax raate for the ye ear by $5,000. The current maximum crredit is $750. More inform mation can bee found on thee Caanada Revenu ue Agency (CR RA) website. Equ ity Take--Out (ETO O) An eq quity take‐outt is when a bo orrower incre eases the size of their morttgage or takees out a secon nd mortgage or o another de ebt against th he property, ssuch as a line of credit. An n ETO is most often used to conssolidate highe er interest ratte debt such aas credit card ds. In the casee of paying offf other debts, on clo osing the lawyyer issues che eques to the ccreditors bein ng paid out frrom the proce eeds. Borrowers may also take equity out o of their prroperty to pu urchase otherr assets such as a boat b or a cottaage, or for an ny other reaso on as allowedd by their lend der. Brid dge Finan ncing Bridge e financing is used when a person is selling their currrent home and buying a n new home. In n some cases a buye er may find th hat the home that is being sold has a clo osing date aftter the homee hasing is set to t close. Thiss results in thee homeowneer temporarilyy owning two o that they are purch home es. The proble em with this is that normaally the down payment forr the new purrchase would be coming from th he sale of the current home. Without thhe down payment when the new homee is set to close, the borrower willl lose the new w home and fforfeit the deeposit. Bridgee financing is simplyy a second mortgage place ed on the first home whilee waiting for iit to sell. Thiss money is used as the down payment on the t new home. Once the ffirst home seells the mortggage is repaid. This provides p a “brridge” betwee en the two ho omes. Chapter C 2: Bassic Mortgage Concepts 2.9 5 53 Conven ntional an nd High Ratio R Morrtgages A morrtgage can be e described ass either conve entional or hiigh ratio. To determine ho ow the mortggage is classiffied, the loan to value of th he mortgage must first be calculated. This iss calculated by b dividing the e mortgage amount a by thee value of thee property. Example he had $50,000 as a down If a bo orrower wished to purchasse a propertyy for $400,0000 and he or sh n payment, the loan to value wou uld be calculaated using thee following fo ormula: Morttgage Amoun t Pro operty Value To ob btain the morttgage amount, the amoun nt of the downn payment m must first be su ubtracted from the purchase e price. Purchase Price e – Down Payment = Requ ired Mortgagge Amount $400,000 ‐ $50,000 = $3350,000 m amo ount is then divided d by the e property va lue (which is,, in this case, the purchasee The mortgage price)) $350,000 $ $400,000 $ = 0.875 or 87.5% loan too value Bill C‐‐37, enacted in i 2007 by the federal govvernment, conntains legislattion that chan nged the definiition of conve entional and high h ratio mo ortgages in Caanada. By am mending sectio on 418, subse ection 1 of the e Bank Act, th he federal govvernment chaanged what cconstitutes a high ratio mortggage in Canad da from 75% loan l to value to 80% loan to value. The fo ollowing is the text of the amendment: ( A bank sha all not make a loan in Canada on the seecurity of resiidential propeerty in Canada 418. (1) for the purpose of purchasing, renovating r orr improving thhat property, or refinance such a loan, iif the am mount of the loan, togetheer with the am mount then ooutstanding off any mortga age having an n equall or prior claim m against thee property, wo ould exceed 880 per cent off the value of the property at thee time of the loan. l High h Ratio Mortgage M A high h ratio mortgage is a mortgage that excceeds 80% loaan to value. TThis refers to o either a purch hase where th he purchaser has less than 20% for a doown paymentt or, in a refin nancing scenaario, where th here is less than 20% equitty in the propperty. If a mortgage is provvided by a federally regulated d bank, that bank b must obtain mortgagge default insu urance on thee loan if the loan exceeds e 80% loan to value e. This is impo ortant for an agent to know because th he premium 54 Chapter C 2: Bassic Mortgage Concepts t the mortgaage amount aand will increaase the for this default insurance is typically added to mortggage payment. ortgage defau ult insurance If the mortgage is not provided by a federally regulated bbank, then mo is not required. Many M lenders that t do not usse mortgage default insurers refer to th heir mortggages as “selff‐insured”. Th his simply me eans that the lender will ch harge a lendeer’s fee (referrred to as the self‐insured fee), typicallyy similar in am mount to a deefault insurerr’s fee. The lende er will often use these feess to create a reserve r fund tthat can be accessed to heelp offset lossess suffered by a borrower’s default. Pa ause for cllarification n – Self‐inssured lendeer A “Self‐Insured d” lender is sim mply a lenderr that does noot use defaultt insurance, b but that ch harges a lende er’s fee and pools p this mon ney in a reserrve fund to heelp offset thee risks asssociated with h lending high h ratio mortgages withoutt the protectio on of default insurance. Th he amount off this fee is typ pically similarr to what a boorrower would pay for deffault insurance. More information on mortgage e default insurrance may bee found in thee chapter, Inssurance in thee Mortggage Industryy. Con nventiona al Mortga ge A conventional mo ortgage is one e that is 80% loan to value or less. Thiss refers to eith her a purchasse where e the purchasser has 20% or o more for a down paymeent or, in casees of refinancing, where there is more than n 20% equity in i the properrty. 5 55 Chapter C 2: Bassic Mortgage Concepts High Ratio Over 80% (80 0.1% L and higher) LTV is called higgh ratio 100% % LTV 80% % LTV Conventional Up to o 80% LTTV is a convention nal mortgage m e 0% LTV 56 Chapter 2: Basic Mortgage Concepts 2.10 Key Terms and Definitions 1st Mortgage The first mortgage registered on title of a property 2nd Mortgage A mortgage registered on title of a property after a 1st mortgage 3rd Mortgage A mortgage registered on title of a property after a 2nd mortgage Assignment of mortgage The transference of a mortgage from one lender to another Charge/Mortgage The document that indicates that there is a debt registered against the title of a property Chattel Personal property, movable property and other property not deemed to be fixtures Collateral Mortgage A promissory note secured by a lien on the property for the total amount registered, which may differ from the total amount advanced. Conventional Mortgage A mortgage not exceeding 80% loan to value Discharge of Charge/Mortgage The document that indicates that a debt has been removed from the title of a property Down Payment An amount of a purchaser’s money provided to the vendor from his or her own resources (not included in a mortgage loan). Under certain programs this amount may be borrowed. Equity Take‐Out (ETO) The removal of equity by refinancing of the property Interest Rate The rate at which interest, which is a fee paid to the lender for borrowing money, is calculated Mortgage The providing of real property to a lender as security in exchange for a debt Mortgagee The lender Mortgagor The borrower Chapter 2: Basic Mortgage Concepts 57 Payment A periodic amount, in dollars, required to be made in relation to a mortgage contract. A payment may be interest only or a blend of interest and principal. Personal Property Everything one owns that is not real property. That includes chattels and other goods. Personal property is typically not fixed in its location and normally has a shorter useful life expectancy than real property. Real Property Land and everything affixed to it. It is in a fixed location and is permanent, remaining, to one extent or another, long after the current owners have relinquished their rights to it. Self‐Insured lender A lender that does not use default insurance, but that charges a lender’s fee and pools this money in a reserve fund to help offset the risks associated with lending high ratio mortgages without the protection of default insurance. The amount of this fee is typically similar to what a borrower would pay for default insurance. Standard Charge Terms The terms and conditions of the mortgage contract, including the remedies available to the lender upon default by the borrower Term An amount of time before the mortgage contract must be repaid or renegotiated Title A term that refers to the ownership of a property. If something is registered “on title” it means that it is officially registered against the ownership of the property through the Land Titles Office, where property ownership is recorded 58 Chapter C 2: Bassic Mortgage Concepts 2.11 1 Review w Questio ons Answers to the Revview Questio ons are found at www.REM MIC.ca Sho ort Answe er Questio ons 1. Disscuss the difference betwe een a mortgage and a car loan. 2. There are two mortgages m reggistered again nst the title oof Barbara’s p property. Onee was reggistered on May M 20, 2006 and the other was registe red on March h 17, 2005. W Which is the 1st nd mo ortgage and which w is the 2 ? 3. Jon nathan owns a house valued at $250,00 00 with a cur rent 1st mortggage that hass a balance off $190,000. Jonaathan has cred dit card debtss of $12,500 tthat he wishees to consolid date by e. Would Jonaathan requiree a conventio onal or high raatio inccreasing his first mortgage mo ortgage? 4. De escribe the pu urpose of the Charge/Morttgage. ontract. 5. Naame and desccribe three of the main borrrower obligaations under a mortgage co 6. Every mortgage e comes with a set of Stand dard Charge TTerms. Discu uss the purpose of this do ocument and its importancce in the morttgage transacction. Chapter 3: Advvanced Mortggage Conceptts 5 59 Chaptter 3: Advanc A ced Moortgagee Conceepts Lea arning Outccomes Succcessful undersstanding of th he concepts presented p in tthis chapter w will enable the learner to: Liist and definee the financial components of a mortgaage Describe D the tyypes of mortggage repayment plans andd explain the benefits and risks of each Describe the different d prepayment optio ons available to borrowerss and explain the benefits an nd risks of each Describe D the cash c back option available to borrowerss and explain its benefits aand risks Describe D a com mbination or bundled morrtgage and exxplain its beneefits and riskss Discuss D the po ortability optio on and describe its benefitts and risks Discuss D the asssumability op ption and describe its beneefits and riskss 3.1 Financia al Compo onents off a Mortga age The basic premise behind everyy mortgage is the borroweer’s promise tto repay the aamount borro owed. There are a several co omponents to o a mortgage,, as is illustrated in the Staandard Chargge Termss, but at its co ore a mortgagge payment iss made up off the followingg financial co omponents: The Face Va alue The faace value or the t face amou unt of a loan is the total am mount of thee mortgage th hat is registtered against the property. This is the amount a that tthe borrowerr has contractted to repay. It is im mportant to note n that this amount is no ot necessarilyy what the bo orrower receivves, but it is the am mount for wh hich the borro ower is liable.. The Term The mortgage m conttract will indicate the time e that the conntract will be in force. Afteer this time expire es the contract must eithe er be paid in full (referred tto as paying tthe lender a b balloon payment) or renew wed with the current lende er. These aree the only two o options that a borrower has. Refinaancing with the current len nder has the same effect aas making a b balloon payment since the mortggage is paid out o by the new w loan. In esssence, the lennder is giving itself the balloon payment. The sam me occurs with a switch, transfer of the mortgage fro om one lendeer to another,, or goiing to anothe er lender and getting a new w mortgage. In this case, tthe mortgagee is paid out through a balloon payment mad de by the new w lender. 60 Chapter 3: Advvanced Mortggage Conceptts The Amortiz ation The co ontract will sttipulate the amortization a period for thee mortgage. The amortizaation refers to o the to otal number of o years that it i will take to fully repay thhe amount bo orrowed, and d requires a blend ded periodic payment p of bo oth interest and a principal. Interest Acccruing Mortgaages and Intere est Only Morttgages do nott have an amo ortization perriod and are d discussed lateer under “Type es of Contemp porary Mortggage Repayme ent Plans.” The Interest Rate The mortgage m conttract also stip pulates the am mount of inteerest charged to the borro ower, includin ng how this t interest iss to be calculaated. Slight variations v in tthe rate will leead to changes in the payment amount as a well as the e amount paid d in interest. For exxample, a mo ortgage with a face value of o $200,000 a mortized oveer 25 years, w with a 5‐year term and a rate of 6% calculated semi‐annuaally, will resu lt in a monthly payment o of $1,279.62. Over the t term of the mortgage,, the borrowe er will repay $$76,777.20, o of which $20,327.06 will bee applie ed to principaal and $56,450.14 will be applied a to inteerest. If the rate were 6.1 1% instead off 6%, with all other factorss remaining th he same, the borrower would d be making payments p of $1,291.53. $ Over O the term of the mortggage, the borrrower would repayy $77,491.80, of which $20 0,074.54 would be applied to principal aand $57,417.26 would be applie ed to interestt. This .1 1% increase in the rate fro om 6% to 6.1% % has resulte d in a $714.660 increase in the amount paid during d the firsst 5 years by the t borrowerr, or an averaage of $142.922 per year. The Compou unding Frrequency of the In nterest R Rate Lende ers must indiccate the rate of interest be eing applied i n either annu ual or semi‐an nnual comp pounding, as per p the Intereest Act, R.S., 1985, 1 c. I‐15, ss. 6; 2001, c. 4, s. 92. Morre information on the e effects of co ompounding frequencies may m be foundd in the chaptter, Calculatin ng a Mortgagge Payment. The follo owing section n of the Intereest Act clearlyy stipulates th hat: When never any prin ncipal money or interest seecured by mo rtgage on reaal property orr hypothec on n immo ovables is, by the mortgagee or hypothecc, made payabble on a sinkiing fund plan,, on any plan underr which the pa ayments of prrincipal moneey and interesst are blendedd or on any plan that involvves an allowance of interesst on stipulateed repaymennts, no interesst whatever sh hall be charg geable, payab ble or recovera able on any part p of the priincipal moneyy advanced, u unless the mortg gage or hypotthec containss a statement showing the amount of thhe principal m money and the rate of o interest cha argeable on that money, calculated yeaarly or half‐yeearly, not in a advance. R.S., 1985, 1 c. I‐15, s. 6; 2001, c. 4, s. 92. Pay ment Am mount The co ontract will laay out the am mount of each h payment duuring the term m, based on th he face value,, intere est rate, paym ment frequency, and the am mortization. It is of intereest to note that the term iss not ussed in the calculation of th he payment amount. a The term is only o of interest to the date of the co ontract expiryy. Chapter 3: Advvanced Mortggage Conceptts 6 61 3.2 Types of Mortgag ge Produ ucts As a mortgage m age ent it will be your y role to de etermine thee most approp priate producct for your client. To do so yo ou will need to o fully undersstand your cliients’ needs aand circumstaances, which is disccussed in detaail in the chap pter on the in nitial consultaation. To be aable to make an informed recom mmendation to t your clientt requires you u to be well veersed in all off the current products availaable. This secction examine es the types of o mortgage pproducts that may be available to you and discusses the benefits b and risks of each. By understaanding the beenefits and rissks you will bee able to t better iden ntify which prroduct is best suited to youur client. Oncce you have a firm underrstanding of the t product tyypes, we will then examin e the optionss that are avaailable with these products. It’’s comparable e to buying a car; first youu find the mod del that’s righ ht for you theen you decide on the options. We begin by listiing the most common types of mortgagge products, follow wed by a detaailed examination of each. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. The Partially Am mortized, Blen nded Constan nt Payment M Mortgage – Fixxed Rate The Partially Am mortized, Blen nded Constan nt Payment M Mortgage – Vaariable Rate The Partially Am mortized, Blen nded Variable e Payment M ortgage – Variable Rate The Interest On nly Mortgage The Home Equity Line of Cre edit (HELOC) The Interest Accruing Mortgage The Reverse Mo ortgage The Straight Lin ne Principal Re eduction Morrtgage The Graduated Payment Mo ortgage The Partially y Amortiz zed, Blen ded Consstant Payyment Mo ortgage – Fixe ed Rate This iss the most co ommon repayyment plan in Canada todaay. This mortgage has seveeral characteristics. Partia ally Amortized The amortization refers r to the total t amount of time that it will take to o repay the m mortgage. Thee 2 years, although there a re several diffferent length hs currently most common amortization is 25 availaable. The term m partially am mortized indiccates that theere is a term iinvolved. If there wasn’t a term, it would be a fully amortized mortgage e, which is unncommon in O Ontario todayy. Term This iss a period of time t in which h the loan is repaid, typica lly anywhere between six months and five years (althouggh longer term ms are availab ble). The morrtgage contraact is based on this term and, at a the end of the term, the e contract com mes up for reenewal. The b borrower can n then renew with his h or her current lender based b on the terms t of the rrenewal, refin nance with th he current lende er or a new lender, or switcch to a new le ender. Blend ded Payment The blended paym ment is a comb bination of prrincipal and innterest, allow wing the borro ower to pay the acccumulated in nterest due fo or the payme ent period as well as an am mount to pay down the principal amount of o the loan that is outstand ding. 62 Chapter 3: Advvanced Mortggage Conceptts Consttant Paymentt This means m that th he payment does not change throughouut the term. For example,, given a mortggage of $200,,000 at a rate of 6% compo ounded semi‐‐annually, a term of 5 yearrs and an amorttization of 25 5 years, the monthly m payment is $1,2799.62. This payment p would remain con nstant for the e full 5 years, at the end off which time the outstaanding balancce would havve to be repaid, either by rrenewal, refin nance, switch or full payment from the borrower’s own o money. The portion of inte erest and prin ncipal within this t constant payment will change everry month as the am mount of inte erest payable decreases. In this exampple, the amount of principaal paid in the first payment p would be $291.90 0 while the in nterest paid w would be $9877.72. By the end of the term, in the sixtietth payment th he amount off principal paiid has increassed to $390.3 36 while the unt of interestt has decreased to $889.26 6. amou Fixed Rate This refers to the fact f that the interest rate is i fixed or doees not changee for the entire term. Beneffits Security m benefit of o this type off mortgage re epayment pla n centres aro ound securityy. The main The borrower know ws what the payment p is th hroughout thee term of thee mortgage an nd can budget accordingly. This security s should not be ove erlooked in teerms of imporrtance, especially for first time home h buyers who may be used to renting and payinng a fixed amo ount for sheltter every month. Many firstt time home buyers b are no ot fully awaree of the other costs associaated with home e ownership, the t clarification of which is part of the duty of the m mortgage agent. Risks Pootential Lack of o Savings. There e are no basicc risks attache ed to this type e of mortgagee repayment plan for the b borrower other than the factt that he or sh he may not saave as much interest as po ossible when compared to o the vaariable rate option. The fo ollowing figurre illustrates the t reduction n of the outsttanding balannce on a Blend ded Constantt Payment Mortgage e. The Partially y Amortiz zed, Blen ded Consstant Payyment Mo ortgage – Variiable Ratte The characteristicss of this type of mortgage are the samee as the Partiaally Amortized d, Blended Consttant Paymentt Mortgage – Fixed Rate, except concerrning the interest rate. While e there are diffferent types of variable raate mortgagees, the main feature is thatt a variable rate mortgage m has an interest rate that flucttuates. This type of repaym ment plan is designed d to protect p the le nder from miismatching fu unds that it has on deposit. Ass their rates paid p on depossit products, ssuch as bank accounts and d investmentss fluctu uate, so does the rate of th he variable rate mortgage.. This allows a lender to keeep the spread between what w it is payin ng on its depo osits to what they are receeiving on theiir mortgages more consistent, thus protectin ng profit marggins. Chapter 3: Advvanced Mortggage Conceptts his increased security to th he lender, the e borrower teends to receivve a lower ratte than on a For th fixed rate mortgagge. Figure 10 – Outstandin ng Balance of a Blended Consta ant Payment Moortgage ollowing figurre illustrates how h principal and interestt are repaid o on a Blended Constant The fo Payment Mortgage e. nd Principal Paid d in a Blended Constant C Paymennt Mortgage Figure 11 – Interest an 6 63 64 Chapter 3: Advanced Mortgage Concepts At the beginning of the mortgage, the payment is typically set at the lender’s posted 3‐year rate. Many lenders offer a capped variable rate mortgage that caps the amount of interest that can be charged at that preset rate, which is typically included in a Schedule attached to the Standard Charge Terms. The rate fluctuation is normally tied to the lender’s current prime rate and can be reset monthly. Typical variable rate mortgages carry interest rates that are lower than their fixed rate mortgages. For example, a lender may offer its variable rate mortgage at its prime rate minus 50 basis points (a basis point is 1/100th of 1 percent; therefore there are 100 basis points in 1 percent). If its current rate is 6.5%, then its current variable rate would be 6.5% ‐ .5% = 6%. In this type of variable rate mortgage, the payment remains the same, or constant, while the percentage of the payment allocated to interest and principal fluctuates according to the current interest rate. If the rate goes up, more of the payment is comprised of interest, and vice versa. If the rate was to rise past a certain point, the borrower would not be repaying all of the interest for the period, let alone any principal. This would result in a negative amortization; in other words the mortgage would not be paid off during the amortization period. In fact, it would extend beyond the contracted amortization period. For this reason lenders will have a clause in the standard charge terms that indicates that if the amount of the loan exceeds a set percentage the lender has the right to increase the payment amount. There was an increase in the number of variable rate mortgages taken out from 2001 to 2005 due mainly to the fact that variable rate mortgages provided a lower interest rate than fixed rate mortgages. In 2006, it was estimated that 22 per cent of new or renewed mortgages were comprised of variable rate mortgages compared to 36 per cent in 2005, due mainly to the decrease in the difference between fixed and variable rates. However, it was back up to 48% in the third quarter of 2008 as that spread increased. Once again that trend reversed itself as the economy faltered. According to CMHC’s Canadian Housing Observer report, only 21% of insured mortgages funded in 2010 were variable rate mortgages. Benefits Savings For borrowers who are not “risk sensitive” (fluctuations in rates do not cause them stress) this type of repayment plan can save them money. In most cases, the rate for variable rate mortgages has been lower than those of fixed rate mortgages. Ability to Switch to a Fixed Rate Most variable rate mortgages offer the flexibility of allowing the borrower to switch to a fixed rate product through the same lender without penalty. This provides the borrower with the comfort of being able to switch if the variable rate begins to rise. Risks Volatility This type of mortgage, while being able to save the borrower money, can also have the reverse affect if the lender increases its rates. The borrower must be financially sophisticated enough to keep a close watch on rates and make the decision to switch to a fixed rate product if and when the situation warrants it. Chapter 3: Advvanced Mortggage Conceptts 6 65 Neegative Amorttization If the interest rate rises, the possibility existss that the fixeed payment w will not be suffficient to coverr the interest due for the payment p perio od. This will ccause the borrrower to pottentially enteer a negative amortizzation scenariio, which can force him orr her into incrreasing his or her mortgage mortgage to a positive payment or payingg a lump sum of money to the lender too return the m amorttization. Payment Increaase entioned under Negative Amortization, A , if the borrow wer falls into that categoryy and must As me increaase his or herr payment, the question th hen becomes can the borro ower afford tthe higher payment? The fo ollowing is an n example of a variable ratte clause: This tells thee borrower w when this clause is app plicable GNATED AMO OUNT (applicaable to Variab ble Rate Morttgages only) DESIG (a) “D Designated am mount” shall mean m the lessser of: (i) the designate ed amount sp pecified in the e schedule, o r (ii)) if you have a conventionaal mortgage, 80% of the faair market vallue of your pro operty as estaablished by an up‐to‐date appraisal repport of your p property whicch eitther we obtain at your exp pense, from a real estate a ppraiser acceeptable to us,, or wh hich you provvide to us, sign ned by a real estate appraaiser first approved in writing by us, or (iii) if you have a CMHC insured mortgage e, the lesser oof: A. 80% (95 5% if insured under the Firrst Time Hom me Buyer Proggram) of the lesser of the appraised value or o purchase price p of your property, plu us the CMHC insurance premium, or B. 110% of o the original balance of th he Mortgage,, including thee CMHC insurance premium. This section n tells the borrrower what is expected to happen if i this clause aapplies (b) If the t loan amo ount exceeds the designate ed amount, yyou shall be reequired to takke one of o the followin ng actions: A. increase the e amount of each e regular payment p undeer the Mortgaage, in order to am mortize the Mortgage overr the remainin ng amortizatioon period; um B. reduce the total amount of the loan amount then oowing by makking a lump su payment sufficient to reduce e such total amount to a ppoint below th he designated d am mount; and C. convert the Mortgage to a fixed rate mortgage m havving equal mo onthly payments. If you are unable to take any off the actions set s out in (i), ((ii) or (iii) abo ove, then, at o our option, the Mortgage M will immediately become due and payable.. 66 Chapter 3: Advvanced Mortggage Conceptts Su uccess Tip – Determiining a borrrower’s n needs Many borrowers do not kno ow what to lo ook for in theiir mortgage. Do they need d a fixed or vaariable rate mortgage? m The answer isn’’t always stra ightforward. It is necessary to de etermine the borrower’s needs n and asssess his or herr risk tolerancce to determiine the right type of mortgage for him orr her. More in nformation caan be found iin the chapteer, The Initial Co onsultation. This T will help ensure that you y get your client the right product, and thereby su uccessfully clo ose the transaaction! The Partially y Amortiz zed, Blen ded Vari able Payyment Mo ortgage – Variiable Ratte This type of variable rate mortggage is identiccal to the Varriable Rate, Fiixed Paymentt mortgage excep pt that the payment will ch hange each tim me that the l ender’s prime rate, which is used to determine the variiable rate, changes. This iss designed too minimize thee risk to the lender of the borro ower experien ncing a negatiive amortization. Beneffits Savvings This type of mortgage tends to offer the borrrower the greeatest savinggs possible sin nce the rate o of est charged te ends to be the e lowest amo ong mortgagee products offfered in the m market today.. intere In add dition if the raate drops, the e payment wiill drop, improoving the borrrower’s cash h flow. Maaintain Amorttization Regarrdless of the change c in the e interest rate e the paymennt will fluctuatte to match that change, thereby keeping th he amortizatio on the same. This is impoortant if the borrower is insistent that m be paid p off in a sp pecific numbe er of years wiithout being aaffected by th he rate. the mortgage Risks Voolatility This type of mortgage, while be eing able to saave the borroower money, can also havee the reverse effectt if rates rise. The borrowe er must be fin nancially sophhisticated eno ough to keep p a close watcch on rattes and make e the decision n to switch to a fixed rate pproduct if and d when the situation warraants it. Payment Fluctuuation h time the len nder’s interesst rate fluctuaates, the borrower must Since the paymentt is reset each ensurre that he or she s has sufficcient funds to reflect any inncreases in th he payment. This results in cash flow f uncertainty for the bo orrower. The Interest Only Mo ortgage The in nterest only mortgage m is sttraightforwarrd. The borroower takes ou ut a lump sum m of money and only o repays the interest due each payment period. TThis means th hat, througho out the life of the mortgage, m the borrower will always owe e the same am mount of prin ncipal. For example, given a mortggage of $200,,000 with an interest i rate of o 6% compoounded semi‐aannually, nott in advance, over a 1‐year term m, the borrower would be making m montthly repaymen nts of $987.73. An interesst only mortgage m doe es not have an amortizatio on since theree is no repaym ment of principal. Chapter 3: Advvanced Mortggage Conceptts 6 67 Beneffits Inccreased Cash Flow From a borrower’ss perspective,, the fact thatt no principal is being inclu uded in the m mortgage payment typically results in a lo ower payment than would otherwise bee the case in an amortized d mortggage. This maay be beneficcial to a borro ower who knoows that he o or she will be receiving an increaase in income e in the near future. f Once that increasee is realized, tthe borrowerr can switch to a blen nded paymen nt mortgage. Fo or your infformation… … Interest Rates Mortgage interrest rates on Partially Amo ortized, Blendded Constant Payment Mo ortgages, eitther fixed or variable rate,, typically follow this hieraarchy: Hiighest Rate 1 Year Open n Mortgage 6 Month Op pen Mortgage e 10 Year Clossed Mortgage e, Zero Downn Payment Mo ortgages 7 Year Close ed Mortgage,, Cash Back M Mortgages (deepending on % %) 6 Year Close ed Mortgage 5 Year Close ed Mortgage 4 Year Close ed Mortgage 3 Year Close ed Mortgage 2 Year Close ed Mortgage 1 Year Close ed Mortgage Variable Ratte Mortgage Lo owest Rate Inccreased Purchhasing Powerr If, how wever, the bo orrower wishes to keep the payment att the same am mount as he o or she would have been paying in a blended payment mortgage, he or she will be able to borrow w more moneey than otherwise o possible. See th he following figure f for an iillustrated example. Invvestments If thiss type of repayment plan iss used to purcchase an inveestment prop perty, for exam mple, the investtor can deducct the interest paid as a co ost of investinng. Under this scenario, th he investor is able to t purchase a property at a higher value e than using a blended payyment repayment plan while using the inccome from the property to o make the m mortgage paym ments. Risks Noo Principal Reduction The faact that there e is no princip pal reduction can put both the lender and the borrow wer at risk. The riisk to the lend der is that, if the borrowerr defaults andd the propertty does not ap ppreciate, their principal mayy be at risk, de epending on the loan to v alue. For th he borrower, if he or she uses u this repayyment plan too increase hiss or her purch hasing powerr and property p price es decrease, he h or she can end up owin g more than the property is worth. The intere est only mortggage is one of the factors that t contribuuted to the mortgage crisiss in the United Statess in 2007. 68 Chapter 3: Advvanced Mortggage Conceptts Figure 12 – Amounts Available A to Borrrow – Blended Payment P vs. Inteerest Only The Home E quity Lin e of Cred dit (HELO OC) A HELLOC is a Line of o Credit secu ured by real property. p A Liine of Credit ((LOC) is an am mount of creditt made available to a borro ower but not advanced onn closing. For example, if a borrower haad a $200,000 LOC he e or she would d be able to use u these fun ds wheneverr he or she wiished. As of mber, 2014 the Office of the Superintendent of Finaancial Instituttions (OSFI) reequires Novem federally‐regulated d financial insstitutions to limit the loan to value of in nterest only H HELOCs to 65%.1 Howe ever, payments are only made on the outstanding baalance of the LOC. A typiccal HELOC hass monthly paymentss of interest only o based on n a variable raate. The borrrower can maake paymentss as small as the inte erest only or as a large as he e or she wishees. Beneffits Fleexibility This plan p allows the borrower to borrow fun nds as necessaary and makee repaymentss that fit his o or her bu udget. Risks Voolatility A HELLOC contains the same rate e volatility ass a variable raate mortgage.. 1 http:://www.osfi‐bssif.gc.ca/eng/fii‐if/rg‐ro/gdn‐o ort/gl‐ld/pagess/b20.aspx Chapter 3: Advvanced Mortggage Conceptts 6 69 The Interest Accruing g Mortgag ge Intere est accruing mortgages m are e loans that have h no repayyment of prin ncipal or interrest during their life. At the end of the mortgage, the en ntire principaal amount is rrepayable, inccluding all of the acccrued interest. Standard forms of Inte erest Accruingg Mortgages tend to be fo or short period ds of time due to the lender’s risk. As the t following figure illustraates, this type of mortgage accum mulates intere est at a very fast f pace, which is why lennder’s don’t liike these repayment planss to be outstanding for much longer than a ye ear. Beneffits Cash Flow ment plan therre is absolute ely no impact on a borroweer’s cash flow w. In other Under this repaym wordss, they can sim mply borrow the funds and forget abouut the mortgaage, until the term expiress, of cou urse. Risks Inccreasing Debtt Under this repaym ment plan the amount borrrowed increasses over timee. The followiing chart illustrrates that incrrease. Based on this exam mple, the borrrower will ow we just under $270,000 at the en nd of 5 years,, an increase of nearly $70 0,000 in debt.. Reeduced Equityy Since the debt incrreases it eats into the equiity that the p roperty has. The borroweer must hope that the property appreciates a in n value over the t same per iod to offset this loss. Figure 13 – Outstandin ng Balance of an n Interest Accruing Mortgage 70 Chapter 3: Advvanced Mortggage Conceptts The Reverse e Mortgag ge A Revverse Mortgagge is a type off interest accruing mortgaage that is typ pically provideed to seniors. The major m provider of Reverse Mortgages in Ontario todaay is the Canaadian Home Income Plan (CHIP). This organization provid des homeown ners who are 55 years of aage or older u up to 50% of the prroperty value e in a lump sum of cash, less any currennt debt secureed by the pro operty. This amou unt accumulattes interest until the death h of the homeeowner (the ssurviving hom meowner, in the caase of spouse es) or until the e property is sold, at whichh time the mo ortgage is due and payab ble. Accorrding to CHIP,, this tax free type of morttgage is suitabble for seniorrs looking to eenhance theirr lifestyyle, renovate their home or o pay off their debts withoout having to o use their savvings. As of Novem mber, 2013, the t current raate for a CHIP P reverse morrtgage rangess from 3.99 to o 5.79%. At one point, Reve erse Mortgage es were referrred to as RAM MS or Reverse Annuity Mo ortgages. These e mortgage pllans would op perate the same as the CH HIP Reverse M Mortgage but,, instead of provid ding the borrower with a lump sum of cash, c the pro ceeds would be used to purchase an annuiity that would d pay the borrower a monthly income. Proceeds fro om a CHIP Reverse Mortggage can still be used to acccomplish this, but the terrm RAM is no ow no longer aas relevant ass it oncce was. Beneffits Cash Flow he Reverse M Mortgage has no impact on n the Similaar to the Interrest Accruing Mortgage, th borro ower’s cash flo ow. Reepayment Since the Reverse Mortgage is not n due (unde er the CHIP) pprogram, until death of the remaining home eowner or sale of the prop perty, the borrower never has to repay the debt in his or her lifetim me. Risks Reeduced Equityy This mortgage m mayy reduce in paart or in whole the amounnt of equity reemaining to b be passed into o the esstate. In addition, the potential of redu uced equity m may be an issu ue if the hom meowner decides to sell the property durring his or herr lifetime. The Straightt Line Pri ncipal Re eduction Mortgag e A Straaight Line Prin ncipal Reducttion Mortgage e is a type of repayment p plan that allow ws the borro ower to pay offf a set amount of principaal each paymeent along witth the accrued interest (interrest that has accumulated) a ) for that period. This is noot a common n form of morrtgage in Ontarrio or Canada, but is more prevalent in the United Sttates. This type of loan may m be benefiicial to the maanufacturing industry wheen dealing in depreciating assetss. For examp ple, if an autom mobile rental company puurchases a fleeet of automo obiles it can b be said that their expenses would be less to maaintain those vehicles at th he outset wheen they are new. Over time, itt will become more expenssive to maint ain the fleet d due to higherr maintenancce costs.. Under this scenario, s the company maay wish to havve its loan payyments decreease over tim me to maatch the incre ease in its costts. Chapter 3: Advvanced Mortggage Conceptts 7 71 Beneffits Cash Flow ents occur at the outset off the mortgagge. This can b be beneficial tto a business The highest payme if it be elieves its cassh flow will de ecrease over time and it h as the cash fllow to comfo ortably make the in nitial paymentts. Risks Higgh Initial Paym ment Size The siize of the payyment is large est at the outset. This resuults in limited d circumstancces where thiss beneficial to type of o repaymentt plan can be the borrowe r. The Graduatted Paym ment Morttgage A Graduated Paym ment Mortgagge is a type off loan that hass lower paym ments at the o outset that wiill e. For the first several payments, the am mount paid iss not sufficien nt to pay the increaase over time full am mount of inte erest accumullated during the t period, m meaning that tthe outstandiing balance o of the mortgage m is acctually increassing. This trend will continnue until the payment incrreases to such h a poin nt that it payss the full amo ount of the intterest for thee period plus ssome principal. This, like the Sttraight Line Principal Redu uction Mortgaage, is not a c ommon form m of mortgagee in Ontario o or Canad da. The major m risk to a lender unde er this repaym ment plan is thhat the borro ower’s cash flo ow will not be able to t afford the increase i in paayments overr time, and/o r that the pro operty value w will not appre eciate. This co ombination can c lead to a property p withh a higher loan balance thaan its value where e the borrower cannot afford the paym ments. A similar situation to this occurred in the Un nited States inn 2007, which h saw tens of thousands off home becoming unaffordable eowners walkk away from their propertie es due to theeir payments b along with the com mbination of loan l to valuess in excess off 100 per centt. Although the situation iin w not due to t Graduated d Payment Moortgages, the effect was th he same. the United States was This type of repaym ment plan wo ould be benefficial for someeone who exp pects their income to increaase over time e, such as in a newly forme ed business. H However, thee risks to the lender make this tyype of plan virtually unheaard of, exceptt in texts and theory. Beneffits Cash Flow h flow for a The payment in this repaymentt plan is at its lowest initiallly, resulting iin better cash borro ower who beliieves their cash flow will in ncrease over time. Risks Priincipal Risk This type of repaym ment plan has risk associated with the principal, since it acts as a type of intere est accruing lo oan at the outset due to th he payments being insufficcient to pay tthe full amou unt of principaal and interesst due in each h period. 72 Chapter 3: Advvanced Mortggage Conceptts 3.3 Mortgag ge Option ns In tod day’s market, there are maany features that t lenders ooffer borroweers to suit theeir financing needss. Lenders, ovver the past several s decad des, have becoome more seensitive to thee changing marke et and have produced p morrtgage features that betteer reflect the b borrower’s go oals and attitudes towards mortgage financing. These e features can n be broken down d into categories: 1. Pre epayment Op ptions a)) Fully Open n b) Partially Open c)) Closed 2. Re epayment Opttions a)) Periodic Paayment Increase b) Accelerate ed Mortgage Payment m Payments c)) Lump Sum d) Extended Amortization A 3. Cash Back Optio ons 4. Bu undled Option ns 5. Po ortability Options 6. Assumability Op ptions 1. Prepayme P ent Optio ns Lende ers are offerin ng borrowers more option ns than ever bbefore to prep pay their morrtgages, that is, to pay the morttgage off soon ner than was agreed to in the original m mortgage con ntract. The lende er begins with h the standard d repayment plans that weere discussed d earlier. The borrower then has h options to o enhance the repayment plan by deteermining the ttype of prepaayment features they would like as partt of the plan. In this sectioon we’ll be discussing the sseveral b havve when it co omes to prepaaying and rep paying their m mortgage, different options borrowers beginning with the e fully open prepayment option. a) Fully F Ope n A fullyy open mortggage allows th he borrower to t repay the m mortgage, in whole or in p part, at any time without w penaalty or notice. This option is particularlyy beneficial to o those borro owers who know that they maay be coming into a cash windfall, w such as from an in nheritance orr property sale. Beneffits Fleexibility The mortgage m can be repaid at any time, pro oviding the boorrower with the flexibilityy to pay the mortggage off from m his or her ow wn proceeds or o refinance tthe mortgagee with anotheer lender. Noo penalties A fullyy open mortggage has no prepayment penalties, meaaning that thee borrower caan prepay thee mortggage without being charge ed the 3 montth interest peenalty or the interest rate differential (discu ussed later in this chapter). This can savve the borrow wer from hun ndreds to tenss of thousand ds of dolllars in penaltties. Chapter 3: Advvanced Mortggage Conceptts 7 73 Risks Higgher Rate Most fully open mortgages are at a higher in nterest rate. TThis is primarrily due to thee fact that the lende er has no guarrantee in how w long the borrrower will keeep the fundss. This meanss that the lende er has no certaainty about the overall ratte of return oon the mortgaage. Since a b borrower would d usually onlyy take this opttion if he or she planned too repay the m mortgage early, the lenderr typicaally charges a premium intterest rate forr that right. b) Partially P Open O A parttially open mortgage allow ws the borrow wer to repay tthe mortgagee in whole witth a penalty o of eitherr 3 months’ worth w of interest or the interest rate diffferential (thee difference b between the mortggage’s rate an nd lender’s cu urrent mortgaage rate). Beneffits Fleexibility The mortgage m can be repaid at any time, pro oviding the boorrower with the flexibilityy to pay the mortggage off from m his or her ow wn proceeds or o refinance tthe mortgagee with anotheer lender. Risks Higgher Rate Although this optio on doesn’t caarry the same rate premium m as the Fullyy Open featurre, it can come with a higher rate than fo ound in a Clossed mortgagee. Penalties t flexibility to prepay the mortgage aat any time, th he penalty to o fully prepay Although it offers the m mayy outweigh the benefits of refinancing w with a different lender, because the cosst the mortgage of the e penalty mayy be more thaan the amoun nt saved by reefinancing at a lower rate w with anotherr lende er. These pote ential penalties are discussed next. Calculating thee Prepaym ment Penallty The actual prepaym ment penaltyy when prepayying the entirre amount off the principall during the term is based on either 3 months’ worth of interest i or th e interest ratte differential, whichever iis higheer. For the detailed equatio ons used to calculate c thesse penalties p please refer to o the chapterr, “Calcu ulating a Morrtgage Payme ent.” c) Closed C Mo ortgage Prepayme P ent Optio on This type of prepayyment featurre actually only applies to tthe sale of the property. U Under all other circumstance es, the borrow wer has no right to prepayy the entire p principal owed d, although there are typically other repaym ment options such as increeasing his or h her periodic p payment or makin ng lump sum payments. However, H the main charactteristic of thiss feature is th hat it does not allow for full prepaayment at anyy time duringg the term of the mortgagee except by saale of the prope erty. This must normally be b considered d an arm’s lenngth sale, as w well, meaningg that a borro ower couldn’t “sell” the pro operty to a faamily membe r simply to prrepay the mo ortgage. Although this type of mortgage feature is no ot the norm, sseveral lenders do offer it.. It is imporrtant to ensure that the lender’s prepayyment optionns are undersstood before deciding on a mortggage for the client. c 74 Chapter 3: Advvanced Mortggage Conceptts d a closeed mortgage as one that ccan only be For exxample, Home Trust has a clause that defines repaid d on a “bona fide sale”. It reads, “You may m prepay tthe initial loan n or any otheer fixed loan o or renew wal of such loan only upon n the closing of o a bona fidee arm’s length h sale of yourr property in the op pen market and a payment of the prepayyment chargee set out belo ow in section 5.3. If the initial loan or the fixed f loan or the t renewal is for a term oof more than three (3) yeaars, you may also at a any time affter the third year of the te erm, prepay yyour mortgagge in full but o only with payment of the pre epayment charge set out below b in secttion 5.4.” Contrrast this with a clause foun nd in CIBC’s Sttandard Charrge Terms desscribing repayyment of its closed d mortgage. It reads, “If you have a fixe ed rate closedd mortgage o or a 6‐month convertible closed d mortgage, you y may prep pay some or all a of the outsstanding princcipal amount of your mortggage before maturity.” m ment before Both lenders refer to their morttgages as clossed, but whilee CIBC offers full prepaym maturity Home Tru ust does not. Once again, it is very impportant that the lender’s teerminology iss fully understood. u Beneffits Rate p feature f provid des the lendeer with significant security regarding Since this type of prepayment their mortgage portfolio, they are a often incliined to providde their loweest rates on th heir Closed mortggages. If the borrower is fairly certain that t they wonn’t need to reefinance theirr mortgage orr prepaay it in full during the term m then this typ pe of feature can be financcially beneficial due to thee lowerr rate. Risks Lacck of Flexibilitty As the e borrower is “locked in” on o this mortgage, he or sh e has no flexibility to prep pay the entiree mortggage amount or refinance with anotherr lender. Thiss can limit hiss or her options if rates decre ease or if he or o she wishes to increase his h or her morrtgage amoun nt. Su uccess Tip – Defining g a “Closed d Mortgag ge” Th he term “Clossed Mortgage e” is often use ed interchanggeably with th he term “Fixed Rate Mortgage.” Altthough this iss an incorrectt usage of thee terms, it is im mportant thaat you, as a nt, understand d what each lender l meanss by its termin nology. mortgage agen Fo or example, iff a lender calls its loan a “cclosed mortgaage” it is impeerative that yyou read its gu uidelines to determine whether it mean ns a closed m ortgage, as w was described d above, or whether it meaans a partiallyy open mortgage. There iss no universally accepted p phraseology that must be fo ollowed by lenders, so to provide p your cclient with th he best advicee, it is up to yo ou to understand the lende er’s products! 2. Repaymen R nt Option ns While e prepaymentt options focu us on the ability of the borrrower to make a lump sum m payment and fu ully prepay th he mortgage, repayment options o focus on the abilityy to change h how they repayy the mortgagge during its term. Chapter 3: Advvanced Mortggage Conceptts 7 75 a) Periodic P Payment P Increase e This option o allows the borrower to increase his or her payyment, in maany cases up tto 100% of th he origin nal payment amount, a durin ng the term of o the mortga ge. This can be an extrem mely importan nt measure when it comes c to paying a mortgagge off more q uickly and saving money in the processs. Anoth her nice featu ure of this opttion is that most lenders w will allow the borrower to lower his or her paayment to an n amount no less than the original paym ment amount if he or she ffinds that the increaased payment can no longger be afforde ed. The exact timing of the paymen nt increase an nd the exact aamount of thee increase will determine the prrecise savingss but, as the following f chart illustrates, those savinggs can be subsstantial, even n with as a low as a 25 5% increase in n the paymen nt. The follow wing chart usees the examp ple of a $200,000 mortgage with an inte erest rate of 6% 6 compoun ded semi‐ann nually, not in advance, witth monthly paymentss. The originaal amortizatio on period is 2 5 years. The increase in th he monthly payment is assume ed to take plaace from the first f paymentt forward. Increaasing the payment amount at other tim mes during thee life cycle off the mortgagge will have similaar, but less dramatic effectts, dependingg on when thee payment inccrease occurss. Figure 14 – Effects of Increasing I Morttgage Paymentss over time Beneffits Savvings As is illustrated by the above ch hart, the effeccts of an increeased paymeent will save substantial sums over time. Risks Cash Flow 76 Chapter 3: Advvanced Mortggage Conceptts ncreased, there is a decreaase in the borrrower’s cash flow. This Since the paymentt amount is in must be examined d before incre easing the payyment amounnt to ensure tthat the borro ower will not be ne egatively impaacted. b) Accelerat A ed Mortg age Paym ment An accelerated mo ortgage paym ment option is simply an opption that pro ovides for an iincreased dic mortgage payment. Th his can be com mpared to th e Periodic Paayment Increaase; howeverr period this option allows the borrowerr to increase his or her moortgage payment before th he first payment begins, whereas w the Periodic P Paym ment Increase is required to o be requesteed once the mortggage has been n advanced. Typicaally, mortgage origination software (software used bby the mortgage agent thaat performs comm mon calculatio ons and allow ws for the elecctronic submiission of an a pplication) w will allow the origin nator to reque est an accelerrated mortgage payment ffor the borrow wer, and in so o doing does not haave to do a manual m calculaation to deterrmine the am mount of the aaccelerated p payment. Thiss, howe ever, has led to t some misco onceptions ab bout the acceelerated paym ment. First, accelerating a payment haas virtually no othing to do w with the paym ment frequen ncy. You may have heard the staatement that “by changingg the payment frequency a borrower caan save tens o of thoussands of dollaars over the liffe of their mo ortgage.” Thiis statement is patently false. Changging the paym ment frequency is not whaat acceleratess a mortgage; increasing th he mortgage payment is. The fo ollowing exam mple illustrate es this point. Barbaara requires fiinancing in th he amount of $200,000. S he is able to o obtain a morttgage in this amou unt amortized d over 25 yearrs and at a ratte of 6% com mpounded sem mi‐annually, n not in advan nce. We be egin our analysis by calculating her regular monthly payment und der this scenaario. You will learn how to calculate a payme ent using a fin nancial calculaator later in tthe course, but in the ntime I can tell you that he er monthly payment workss out to be: mean $1,279.62 $ Based d on this scenario it will takke Barbara 30 00 payments to retire this mortgage. (A Actually 299.9 9964 paymentts, but this wiill be explaine ed in detail inn the section o on calculatingg a mortgage payment). By multtiplying the number n of payyments by th e payment am mount, the to otal amount that Barbara B will be b repaying ovver the life off this mortgagge in monthlyy payments caan be calcullated. Total Amount A Repaaid by Barbaraa in monthly payments = $$1,279.62 x 300 = $383,886 It is now necessaryy to calculate what Barbara would be ppaying if she w was making w weekly payments instead of monthly payments. In this scenario the weekly p payment workks out to be: $294.74 Chapter 3: Advanced Mortgage Concepts 77 Based on this scenario it will take Barbara 1,300 payments to repay this mortgage. By multiplying the number of payments by the payment amount, the total amount that Barbara will be repaying over the life of this mortgage in weekly payments can be calculated. Total Amount Repaid by Barbara in weekly payments = $294.74 x 1,300 = $383,162 Now we can calculate the savings by taking what she would pay in monthly payments, $383,886, and subtract from it what she would pay in weekly payments, $383,162 Barbara’s savings =$383,886 ‐ $383,162 = $724 That is a savings of $724, over 25 years! That is hardly the tens of thousands of dollars’ worth of savings that we are led to believe exists simply by changing the payment frequency. In actuality, the only way to pay a mortgage off faster is to increase the amount of the periodic payment. With that said, let’s look at how to accelerate this mortgage. As mentioned, the typical software will calculate the accelerated mortgage payment for the user. The equation that is used is simple and straightforward. The regular monthly payment is divided by the frequency of the accelerated payment. For example, if an accelerated weekly payment is desired, the software would calculate the payment using the following formula. Monthly Payment / 4 weeks = accelerated payment It is important to note that there are not 4 weeks in a month, except in February. If there were only 4 weeks in a month there would only be 48 weeks in a year (4 weeks x 12 months). This is why the payment ends up being accelerated. To calculate the accelerated weekly payment we must divide the monthly payment by 4. $1,279.62 / 4 = $319.91 You can already see that this weekly payment is larger than the weekly payment that was calculated earlier. By making weekly payments of $319.91, it will take a total of 1,092.34 payments to repay this mortgage. (You will learn how to calculate this number later in the course). The total amount paid under this scenario is calculated by multiplying the weekly payment by the number of payments it will take to repay the mortgage. $319.91 x 1,092.34 = $349,450.49 Now let’s compare this to the non‐accelerated weekly payment. To do so we can subtract the amount repaid by accelerated payments from the amount repaid by non‐accelerated payments. $383,162 ‐ $349,450.49 = $33,711.51 78 Chapter 3: Advanced Mortgage Concepts That is a significant savings. In actuality, the effect of increasing the weekly payment under this scenario is equivalent to making one extra monthly payment per year. In each case of accelerating a mortgage payment, whether it is weekly or bi‐weekly, the net effect is that the borrower is making what equates to an additional monthly payment annually. As a matter of fact, you can accelerate a monthly payment as well. Let’s look at how this would be accomplished. As mentioned, the effect of acceleration is simply an additional monthly payment per year. Therefore, if thirteen monthly payments were spread over twelve months, the result would be an accelerated monthly payment. We begin by multiplying 13 months times the regular monthly payment. We then take that amount and divide it by 12 months. 13 x $1,279.62 = $16,635.06 (amount paid per year) $16,635.06 / 12 = $1,386.26 Therefore, the accelerated monthly payment would be $1,386.26. It can now be calculated that, by making accelerated monthly payments it will take 253.03 months to repay this mortgage. Under this scenario the total paid is: $1,386.26 x 253.03 = $350,765.37 Compared to the non‐accelerated monthly payment this equates to a savings of: $383,886 ‐ $350,765.37 = $33,120.63 That is also a significant savings! You may hear some say that the majority of the savings occur due to the fact that under a weekly scenario, more periodic payments are being applied to the principal than under a monthly repayment plan, but that is simply not the case. There is no magic of compounding interest saving the borrower tens of thousands of dollars; it is simply that they are making larger payments. Looking at this example, the effects of compounding on this transaction are minimal. Accelerated Weekly Savings – Accelerated Monthly Savings = Total Savings $33,711.51 ‐ $33,120.63 = $590.88 This $590.88 represents the total savings over the entire life of the mortgage that the change in payment frequency has from monthly to weekly. To summarize, accelerating a mortgage payment is achieved by increasing the amount of the mortgage payment, not by changing the payment frequency. Benefits Savings As discussed the effects of an accelerated payment are clear: tens of thousands of dollars in savings over time. Chapter 3: Advvanced Mortggage Conceptts 7 79 Su uccess Tip – Paymen nt frequenccy Th he majority off consumers believe b that simply s changiing the paymeent frequency will save them thousand ds of dollars over o the life of o their mortggage. By know wing that thiss is not the caase and why, you y can explaain this to you ur client. Thiss is simply mo ore proof thaat you are thee mortgage profe essional and that t you can truly advise tthem on how to save significant am mounts of mo oney over the e life of their mortgage! m Risks Cash Flow easing the moortgage paym ment. Since the payment The effect of accelerating a mortgage is incre amou unt is increase ed, there is a decrease in the borrower’’s cash flow. This must bee examined before increasing the t payment amount to en nsure that thee borrower w will not be neggatively impaccted. c) Lump L Su m Payme ents This option o allows the borrower to make a lu ump sum payyment which is applied directly to the principal amount of o the mortgaage. This, in addition a to th e payment in ncrease discussed previo ously, can significantly incrrease the savvings over tim me by decreassing the amou unt of interest payab ble. As is the case with periodic payment increases, the effect off making a lum mp sum payment will be most m significan nt the earlier it is made. Thhe following chart uses the same mp sum paym ment (10% of tthe original lo oan amount) example as above,, but applies a $20,000 lum at diffferent times during d the loaan life cycle to illustrate thhe effects of ssuch a paymeent. The Totaal Amou unt Repaid inccludes the lum mp sum paym ment of $20,0000. Figure 15 – Effect of Making M a 10% ($2 20,000) One Tim me Lump Sum Paayment 80 Chapter 3: Advvanced Mortggage Conceptts Analyysis By comparing the effect e of makking a one‐tim me lump sum payment witth the effect o of an increaased mortgagge payment, the t best scenaario for a borrrower, if his o or her cash flow permits, would d be to increaase his or her monthly payments througghout the lifee of the mortggage. If he orr she iss unable or un nwilling to do this, the nexxt best scenarrio would be tto make a lum mp sum payment directly to the principal of his or he er mortgage aas soon as po ossible. If the borrower could combine the ese scenarios,, the total savvings would bbe substantiallly increased. d) Extended E Amortiza ation As pro operty valuess have increassed substantially over timee in comparisson with incomes, the marke et has respon nded by develloping creativve options to assist borrow wers in keepin ng their mortggage payments affordable. One such option is the eextended amo ortization. o allows the mortgage e to be amorttized for a peeriod longer than 25 years. For This option example, in today’s market a bo orrower migh ht qualify for aan extended amortization n of 30 years. Increaasing the amo ortization hass the effect off lowering thee mortgage p payment or allowing the borro ower to borrow an increase ed amount off funds. ollowing exam mple illustrate es the effectss of extendingg an amortizaation period. The fo Example Let’s use u the same e example thaat we used earlier in this chhapter. Our cclient is borro owing $200,000. This mo ortgage has a 25‐year amo ortization, a raate of 6% com mpounded seemi‐annually, not in n advance and d monthly payyments. Under this scenario o, the payme ent would be $1,279.62. A As discussed eearlier, this paayment would d resultt in the borrower repayingg a total of $383,886 over 225 years. a to t 30 years, the monthly ppayment is reduced to $1,1 189.65. This By exttending the amortization mightt be beneficiaal to the borro ower if he or she can’t quaalify for a mortgage paymeent of $1,27 79.62; howeve er it does com me at a price. Under this 30 yearr amortization n scenario, th he borrower w would be makking 360 paym ments of $1,18 89.65. That means m that the e borrower would w be repaaying: Total Repaiid = 360 X $1,,189.65 Total Re epaid = $428, 274 By savving $89.97 per p month the e borrower en nds up repayiing an additio onal $44,388.. While this option may allow the t borrowerr to borrow th he amount off funds requirred for their p purposes, for example to purchaase a home, itt is necessaryy to advise theem of the add ditional intereest that is repayyable using this option. To mitigate the efffect of this op ption the borrrower can re‐‐amortize thee mortgage to o a shorter amou unt once they can afford th he increased payment. p The extended amo ortization can also increase e the amountt that the borrrower can bo orrow. Chapter 3: Advvanced Mortggage Conceptts 8 81 e borrower caan qualify for the mortgagee payment off $1,279.62 th hey can applyy For exxample, if the this payment over 30 years with h the result being b that insttead of borro owing $200,00 00 they can now borrow b $215,126, an incre ease of $15,12 26 over its 255‐year counteerpart. This has h the effect of allowing the t borrower to “purchasee more housee” for the sam me payment. It can be argued thatt the introducction of this repayment r opption, along w with the interest only option, has allowed property vaalues to remaain high or inccrease with litttle impact on borrowers’ abilityy to qualify fo or these increased housingg values. It mayy be of intere est to learn th hat our marke et is not the oonly one with increased am mortization options. This has been b available in the Unite ed States for several yearss. Many home buyers in Japan n resorted to using u 100‐yeaar amortizatio on options too be able to affford housingg at the peak of the e real estate bubble, b allow wing the market to continu e its rise. 3. C ash Back k Option In thiss type of option, the borro ower receivess an amount oof cash, on clo osing (the tim me that the mortggage funds), that t represen nts a percentaage of the tottal loan amou unt. The amo ount of the Cash Back option can c range from 1% to 7%, depending onn the lender aand the product. Beneffits Cash on Closingg me home buyeers, invest all of their money as a down n Since many home buyers, especcially first tim e beneficial to receive funds on closingg that could b e used to purrchase payment, it may be appliaances, finance e renovationss, replenish bank accountss, etc. Risks Higgher Rate Most Cash Back Op ptions come with w a higher rate of intereest on the mo ortgage. Thiss is designed o advancing additional a mo onies that do not have to b be repaid by the borrowerr. to offfset the cost of Reepayment of the t Cash Backk If the borrower decides to refin nance their mortgage durinng the term, tthey will be required to repayy a portion of the amount that t was rece eived under thhis option. Fo or example, if a borrower receivved a 5% Cash h Back on a $200,000 morttgage with a 5 year term aand decided tto refinance with a different len nder on the 3rd anniversary of the term m, the followin ng calculation n would be used to t determine e the amount repayable to the lender. Amou unt Repayable e = Number of o full or partial months re maining in th he term Number of months in th e term = 5% 5 x $200,000 0 x (60 month h term – 36 m months alread dy paid) / 60 = $10 0,000 x 24 / 6 0 = $10,000 x 0.4 = $4,000 Th herefore, the amount the borrower wo ould be requirred to repay w would be $4,000. 82 Chapter 3: Advvanced Mortggage Conceptts 4. C ombined or Bundlled Optio on For ou ur purposes, a “Combined or Bundled Option” O is onee that includees a standard d mortgage along with another type of debtt, such as a line of credit. Scotiabank ccurrently offers this option n in the e form of the STEP mortgagge. If, for exaample, a borrrower were to o take out a $ $200,000 mortggage he or she could have that split into o both a stan dard mortgagge and a line of credit. If the mortgage m amo ount was for $199,999 $ and d the line of crredit began aat $1, then evvery payment,, as the e principal on the mortgagge was reduce ed, would inc rease the am mount available under the line of credit. In esssence, the amount that the property i s encumbereed by (the amount of debt that iss registered on o title) remains at $200,0 000, but the ppercentage made up of thee mortgage and line of credit changes c over time. The fo ollowing charrt provides an n example of a $200,000 a mount borrowed, with a $ $199,999 mortggage component, amortize ed over 25 ye ears with a ratte of 6% compounded sem mi‐annually, not in n advance and d monthly payyments, along with a $1 linne of credit ccomponent. O Over time, ass the mortgage m amo ount owed decreases, the available a linee of credit incrreases. Figure 16 – Blended Op ption Mortgagee with a Mortga age and Line of CCredit Beneffits Fleexibility This type of option n allows the borrower b to have access too the equity o of his or her p property at any time by way off the line of credit, c withou ut having to reeapply to borrrow addition n funds. Risks Reegistered Debt The fu ull amount off the $200,000 Bundle is allways registe red against th he title of thee property. Wherreas in a stand dard mortgagge, the amoun nt registered against the p property decrreases as the Chapter 3: Advvanced Mortggage Conceptts 8 83 d the amount of the Bundle re emains consttant at the tottal amount originally debt decreases, appro oved. This is due d to the facct that the bo orrower has aaccess to the ffunds, wheth her or not he or she e has actuallyy borrowed th hem. 5. Po ortability Option The Portability Opttion, also refe erred to as po orting, allowss the current homeowner tto effectivelyy h or her current mortgagge to his or he er new home.. Under a typ pical scenario, the take his borro ower would be e selling the current c home e and purchassing a new on ne. If the morrtgage is defau ult insured and he or she was w porting it within two yeears, he or sh he would be eeligible for a premium credit fro om the mortggage default insurer. Afterr two years th hat credit no longer appliees and th he full insurance premium m (for example e, through CM MHC) would aapply to eitheer the entire mortggage (if it is in ncreased) or the t top‐up po ortion (the am mount increassed). Since different premiums apply un nder both sce enarios, it is necessary n to ddetermine wh hich option iss best suited tto the bo orrower. The e borrower co ould then take e this mortgaage to his or h her new homee. There are three options: nt loan in the exact amoun nt that is outsstanding provvided that thee Loan to Take the curren eeded Value of the oriiginal mortgage is not exce nt loan in a re educed amount that does nnot exceed th he original Lo oan to Take the curren Value nt loan to the new propertty and increasse the amoun nt by having tthe Take the curren nder blend the current rate charged on a new mortggage with thee borrower’s ccurrent rate. len Beneffits Rate Protectionn es are currenttly higher than the borrow wer’s contractted interest raate on the mo ortgage, he o or If rate she caan benefit by keeping the lower rate an nd porting it tto the new ho ome Risks Lim mited Application This feature can be e fantastic wh hen current market m intere st rates are h higher than th he borrower’ss contraacted rate, bu ut in an era with w consisten ntly low rates , the applicattion of this op ption is limite ed. 6. As ssumabil ity Optio n An Asssumable Opttion allows a purchaser p to assume or taake over the ccurrent homeeowner’s debtt on the e property be eing purchase ed. For the cu urrent borrow wer to be releeased from th heir covenantt with the t lender, th he purchaser must be apprroved by the lender and co omplete an A Assumption Agree ement. Beneffits Rate Protectionn r are currrently higher than the ratee of the existing, assumablle mortgage, it If marrket interest rates may be b beneficial for f the purch haser to assum me the currennt mortgage. 84 Chapter 3: Advanced Mortgage Concepts Risks Limited Application This feature can also be very beneficial when current market interest rates are higher than the borrower’s contracted rate, but in an era with consistently low rates, the application of this option is limited. Chapter 3: Advanced Mortgage Concepts 85 Key Terms and Definitions Accelerated Mortgage Payment A mortgage payment larger than required to retire the mortgage over the contracted amortization, having the effect of repaying the amount borrowed sooner and saving the borrower interest Amortization The total amount of time contracted to repay a mortgage Assumability Options This option allows a purchaser the ability to take over the current homeowner’s mortgage Balloon Payment The amount repayable at the end of the term Basis Point 1/100th of one percent Blended Payment A payment that includes a combination of interest and principal Bundled Option Also referred to as a Combination Option, this option combines a mortgage and a line of credit. Capped Variable Rate Mortgage A variable rate mortgage that cannot exceed a preset interest rate Cash Back Option An option whereby on closing of the mortgage, a percentage of the mortgage loan is paid to the borrower by the lender Closed Mortgage A mortgage with no option to repay the outstanding principal balance unless the property is sold to an arm’s length purchaser Compounding Frequency The number of times per year in which an interest rate is charged. Typical compounding frequencies include semi‐annually and monthly. Constant Payment A payment that remains the same throughout the term of the mortgage Default The failure to meet the obligations of a contract. In a mortgage contract default typically refers to the failure to make the regular periodic mortgage payments Equity The difference, in dollars between the value of the property and the amount of financing 86 Chapter 3: Advanced Mortgage Concepts currently on the property. Value – Financing = Equity Extended Amortization An amortization that exceeds the standard amortization of 25 years Face Value of the Mortgage The amount repayable by the borrower Fixed Rate An interest rate that remains the same throughout the term of the mortgage Fully Open Mortgage An option allowing early repayment of the mortgage principal without penalty or notice Graduated Payment Mortgage A mortgage repayment plan whereby the mortgage payments are initially small but grow over time. The initial payments may not be enough to pay the principal and accrued interest for the period. High Ratio Mortgage A mortgage in excess of 80% loan to value Home Equity Line of Credit (HELOC) A line of credit secured by a property Interest Accruing Mortgage A mortgage with a term whereby no repayments of interest or principal are made. The principal and compound interest are repayable at the end of the term. Interest Only Mortgage A mortgage with a term and a constant mortgage payment consisting of only interest payable for the payment period. At the end of the term, the principal amount is repayable. Interest Rate Differential The difference between a borrower’s current contracted mortgage rate and the lender’s current available rate for a similar term Line of Credit A debt with a credit limit that allows the borrower to withdraw funds up to that credit limit. Repayments are based on a percentage of the outstanding balance and interest is charged only on the amount of the credit limit that is actually used. Loan to Value The amount of a loan to the value of the property expressed as a percentage. Loan to Value (%) = Loan / Property Value Lump Sum Payment A payment of money applied directly to the principal of a mortgage Chapter 3: Advanced Mortgage Concepts 87 Mortgage Default Insurance An insurance policy which protects the insured (the lender) against losses suffered by the default of the borrower Mortgage Rank The position of a mortgage registered on title of a property in relation to the timing of other registered mortgages. The first mortgage registered on title is considered a 1st mortgage. The next mortgage registered after the 1st is considered a 2nd mortgage, and so on. Negative Amortization A scenario in which the periodic payment is not sufficient to pay the accumulated interest and the principal for the payment period. This causes the amortization to extend beyond the amount contracted. Open Mortgage A mortgage that allows the borrower to repay the entire principal balance or portion thereof without penalty (fully open mortgage) or with an interest rate differential or 3 month’s interest penalty (partially open mortgage) Outstanding Balance The amount of the mortgage remaining to be repaid at a given time Partially Amortized A mortgage contract that has a term Partially Amortized, Blended Constant Payment Mortgage – Fixed Rate A mortgage with a term and a repayment plan consisting of a fixed interest rate and the same periodic payment made up of a combination of interest and principal throughout the term. Partially Amortized, Blended Constant Payment Mortgage – Variable Rate A mortgage with a term and a repayment plan consisting of a variable interest rate that changes whenever the lender’s prime rate changes and the same periodic payment made up of a fluctuating combination of interest and principal throughout the term Partially Amortized, Blended Variable Payment Mortgage – Variable Rate A mortgage with a term and a repayment plan consisting of a variable interest rate and a fluctuating periodic payment that both change whenever the lender’s prime rate changes. The payment consists of a fluctuating combination of interest and principal throughout the term Portability Option This option allows the borrower to take the mortgage with him or her to his or her new home Power of Sale A process that allows the lender to commence a proceeding against the borrower without using the courts and sell the property. This can be a quick and fairly inexpensive remedy available to lenders upon default by the borrower Prepayment Options Options available to the borrower to prepay a part of his or her mortgage. These options may or 88 Chapter 3: Advanced Mortgage Concepts may not include a penalty for this right. Prepayment Penalty A penalty charged by a lender to a borrower for early prepayment of the mortgage Principal The amount of money advanced on a mortgage loan, excluding interest or any other costs Property Insurance Insurance that protects the insured against losses to the property due to fire and other covered perils Purchaser The buyer of a property Quiet Possession The right of the borrower to enjoy the property without interference by the lender unless there is a default by the borrower Reverse Mortgage An interest accruing mortgage typically reserved for seniors. The mortgage is usually only repayable upon the death of the surviving homeowner or sale of the property. Straight Line Principal Reduction Mortgage A mortgage repayment plan whereby equal payments of principal are made throughout the term in addition to the interest payable for that period Term A period after which the mortgage must be fully repaid or renegotiated Variable Rate An interest rate that fluctuates based on a lender’s prime rate Vendor The seller of a property Chapter 3: Advvanced Mortggage Conceptts 3.4 8 89 Review w Questio ons Answers to the Revview Questio ons are found at www.REM MIC.ca Sho ort Answe er Questio ons 1. Wh hat are the fivve financial components that are requi red to calculaate a mortgagge payment? een acceleratting a mortga ge and using the increased payment 2. Disscuss the difference betwe op ption to pay th he mortgage off more quicckly. 3. Disscuss the difference betwe een an open mortgage m andd a closed mo ortgage. hy might a co onsumer be co onfused as to o the differen ces between an open and d closed 4. Wh mo ortgage? 5. Un nder what circcumstances would w a prepaayment pena lty be charged? escribe a scen nario under which w a 3 mon nth interest peenalty would be charged. 6. De 7. De escribe a scen nario under which w an interest differenti al penalty wo ould be chargged. 8. Wh hat is a bundlled mortgage e? Name and describe thee lenders thatt currently offfer bundled mo ortgages in Ontario. This will w require yo ou to compleete outside invvestigation. 9. Wh hat is the most common tyype of mortgage repaymeent plan in On ntario today? 10. A borrower haas asked you for f options re egarding repaaying his morttgage more q quickly. Explain the optiions available e to him and under u what ccircumstancess you would aadvise him to use e these optio ons. 90 hapter 4: Property Ownersship in Ontario Ch Chaptter 4: Property P y Owneership in Onttario Lea arning Outccomes Succcessful undersstanding of th he concepts presented p in tthis chapter w will enable the learner to: Distinguish D between person nal and real property p Explain the meeaning of property ownersship Explain estates in land Discuss the various types off encumbrancces and the eeffects each hhas on properrty ownershipp Explain the typpes of co‐ownnership of reaal property Discuss D the im mpact of judgm ments on reall property 4.1 Properrty Rea al Propertty Prope erty can be claassified in two distinct wayys: personal aand real. Reaal property caan be defined d as the e land and eve erything affixxed to it. It is in a fixed loccation and is p permanent, remaining, to one extent e or anotther, long afte er the current owners havve relinquisheed their rightss to it. Pers sonal Pro operty In con ntrast, person nal property is defined as everything e th at is not real property. Th hat includes chatte els and other goods. Perso onal propertyy is typically nnot fixed in itss location and d normally haas a shorter useful life e expectancyy than real pro operty. 4.2 Owners ship Owne ership of real property is co ommonly tho ought of as ow wning the lan nd and everything affixed tto it. Ho owever in a le egal sense this is not the caase. The currrent owner off a piece of reeal property actually owns the right to use th he land. The only owner oof the land is the Crown. IInitially the Crown n provided grrants to indiviiduals allowin ng them to usse the land. EEvery piece off real propertty that iss owned by anyone other than the Crow wn or Aborig inal peoples iin Canada has an original grant. The re esult of this iss that individu uals own diffe erent rights t o the real pro operty. Thesee rights are determined by the e type of ownership, referrred to as the Doctrine of EEstates. The m most common formss of estates in n Ontario todaay are fee sim mple estates aand leasehold d estates. Another type off estate e, a life estate e, is becomingg more popular in Ontarioo and while otther estates eexist, these three common forms will be exxplored in thiss chapter. 4.3 Estates s in Land d Fee Simple Estate E The fe ee simple estate is the mo ost common fo orm of owne rship in Ontario and provides the holdeer with the t widest breadth of rights available. Fee refers to the fact thatt the estate m may be Ch hapter 4: Property Ownersship in Ontario 9 91 mple refers to o the fact thatt there are noo prohibitionss against who o may inherit inheriited while sim it. The owner of this estate e is in co ontrol of the real r propertyy for as long as he or she has it, subject to payying the prop perty taxes an nd other municipal obligatiions and subjject to any intterests in thee prope erty that may be registered d against the property’s tittle. This indivvidual may trransfer his or her in nterest in the property durring his or herr lifetime or ddictate who w will inherit thee fee simple intere est upon his or o her death. In addition, he h or she mayy mortgage the interest, p pledge it as security for a loan such as throu ugh a secured d line or crediit, and so on. If the fee simple ow wner dies witthout a will an nd there are no heirs, the fee simple in nterest is terminated and the property will escheat or revert back tto the Crown. Lea sehold E state The le easehold estaate, commonly referred to as a lease, iss an interest in land createed by a landlo ord and tenan nt, most commonly by a le ease. This inteerest in land is created forr a fixed period d of time, succh as a month h, year, or mo ore. There is no limit on th he time that a leasehold estate e may be in effect. A leassehold estate provides the e owner of thiis estate the rright to exclu usive use and possession o of the prroperty, subje ect to contracctual limits co ontained in thhe terms of th he lease. Life Estate / Life Lea ase A life estate is defined as the rigght to use or occupy real pproperty for tthe duration o of one’s life. At the e end of that person’s life, the life estatte is over andd the fee simp ple ownership p goes to the remaiinderman. A remainderman is the indivvidual who iss on the deed as the next in line to own n the prroperty. Example John owns o a house e. He is a wid dower and has a six year o ld daughter aand his motheer is still alivee. John wants w to ensu ure that if anyything happens to him his mother can live in his hou use for the rest of o her life. Ho owever, once she passes aw way he wishees the house tto go to his d daughter. In this sccenario John can create a life estate forr his mother, and name his daughter ass remaiinderman. Anoth her form of liffe estate is co ommonly refe erred to as a ““life lease”. TThis is typically seen in senior’s developments where the senior purrchases the ri ght to live in a house until death. Full owne ership of the house h then re everts to the corporation c ( typically a no on‐profit) that owns and manages the proje ect. In 2007 CMHC C reporte ed that there were at leastt 135 life leasse developments in Ontario O containing more th han 8,600 uniits. It is im mportant to note n that the holder of a liffe estate will find it difficu ult to obtain a mortgage due to o the difficultty that the len nder will have e in recoverinng their moneey upon defau ult. Howeverr, some lenders are willing w to finaance life lease es if the projeect has a guarranteed buy‐b back program m. This area a is conside ered to be a niche n market because appproximately 90% of life lease owners purch hase the life le ease from the e proceeds off selling their previous hom me, which ressults in virtuaally no deman nd for life leasse purchase financing. f 92 Ch hapter 4: Property Ownersship in Ontario Su uccess Tip – Life Esta ate / Life Leease Mo ortgage agents must be aw ware of these e types of estaates and ensu ure that if thee mortgage iss forr a life estate or life lease that t the application clearlyy indicates th his. In addition the agent mu ust be sure th hat the appliccation is subm mitted to a lennder that has a product for this type of ow wnership, and d that the app plicant meets the product requirements. Failure to do so could ressult in wasted d time and money for both h the agent a nd the appliccant. 4.4 Condom minium Ownershi O ip Condo ominiums com mbine fee sim mple ownersh hip of individuual units, refeerred to as strrata lots, includ ding all of the e rights attach hed to that ow wnership, witth a combined d ownership of common areas, referred to as a common elements. e The ese common elements incclude the hallways, recreaational facilities, elevatorss, lobby, and so s on. Each uunit pays a co ondominium m maintenance fee on n a monthly basis b to the co ondominium corporation. The condom minium corporation is a corpo oration create ed under the Condominium m Act that is ccharged with managing the condo ominium, inclluding its asse ets, and main ntaining and rrepairing the common elem ments. It is managed by a Board of Directors consisting of unit owne rs who are elected by the other unit owne ers on a regulaar basis. 4.5 Encum mbrances An en ncumbrance iss an interest in property th hat has the efffect of limiting the rights of fee simplee owne ership of real property. Typical encumb brances are m mortgages, easements, and d restrictive coven nants. Morrtgages A morrtgage is regisstered on title and has con ntractual obli gations that prohibit the ffee simple owne er from havingg full control of his or her property. p Eas ements Easem ments are righ hts acquired for f the beneffit of real propperty, grantin ng rights to usse another prope erty. The land d giving the riight is called the t servient ttenement wh hile the land rreceiving the right is i called the dominant d ten nement, wherre the term teenement simp ply refers to tthe real prope erty. An eaasement is an interest in laand that passe es from one oowner to ano other or as is ccommonly referrred to, “runs with w the land d.” Unlike a fe ee simple inteerest that maay be transferrred by the current owner, an easement cannot be extin nguished by tthe owner of tthe servient ttenement. t owner of the dominan nt and servien nt tenement m must agree to o remove an easement. Both the Example Adam m owns a cottaage that frontts onto a lake e. Immediateely behind Adam’s propertty is Mary’s cottagge. Her cottaage does not have h direct access to the l ake. To imprrove Mary’s p property, Adam m and Mary haave agreed to o create and allow a the use of a three fo oot wide strip of land on the faar right of Adaam’s propertyy as a path fro om Mary’s coottage to the lake. This haas the effect o of Ch hapter 4: Property Ownersship in Ontario 9 93 v Adam’s prroperty. As ssuch, this creaates an granting Mary’s prroperty access to the lake via easem ment which iss registered on title. mportant to note n that an easement e must benefit thee property, no ot simply thee property It is im owne er. In this example, Mary’ss property hass gained lake access and h has therefore improved the prope erty. If it simp ply benefited Mary, it wou uld only be coonsidered a co ontract, not aan easement. In add dition to standard easeme ents between dominant annd servient teenements, pro ovincial legislaation has creaated special types of easem ments where a dominant ttenement is n not required. These e easements, referred to as statutory rights of way, aare normally provided to p public utilities, allowing the utilityy to run, for example, hydrro lines throu gh a propertyy. Res strictive Covenant C s A resttrictive coven nant is a restriction of use placed on titlle of the servient tenemen nt for the beneffit of the dom minant tenement. As with an easementt, a restrictivee covenant ru uns with the land and a can only be extinguish hed through the agreemennt of both currrent owners of the domin nant and servvient tenements. Example Adam m owns two paarcels of land d. One fronts a lake while the other is d directly behin nd that parcell. Adam m is going to build b a new tw wo‐storey hom me on the pa rcel behind the lakefront parcel and seell the lakefront parce el. When sellling the lakefrront parcel, A Adam wishes to ensure thaat the new owne er does not co onstruct a building higher than t one storrey, since thiss would impede Adam’s prope erty’s view of the lake. In so s doing, Adaam and the puurchaser of th he lakefront llot have agree ed to place a restrictive r covvenant on titlle that prohibbits the construction of a b building higheer than one o storey. In this scenariio Adam would also requeest an easemeent granting h his parcel of land access a to the lake. Buil ding Sch hemes A buillding scheme is a group off restrictive co ovenants regiistered againsst several pro operties in a development plan that is bindin ng on all purcchasers of a p roperty withiin that develo opment. Thiss has th he effect of ensuring that all a propertiess in the develoopment confo orm to a set o of prede etermined policies for thatt developmen nt. An exampple of this form m of restrictivve covenant mightt be to limit th he colour variations of pro operty exterioors in a new ssub‐division, llimit the numb ber of stories of propertiess in a new sub b‐division, andd so on. 4.6 Co-Ow wnership of o Real Prroperty Prope erty can be ow wned by an in ndividual or by b several ind ividuals, referred to as co‐‐ownership. Co‐ow wnership occu urs in one of two t ways: byy a tenancy in common or tthrough a joint tenancy. The major m differen nce between the t two cente ers around thhe right of surrvivorship, wh hich refers to o how ownership o is transferred t on o the death of o one of the co‐owners. Ten ancy in Common C A tenaancy in comm mon is a type of co‐ownersship of real prroperty typicaally used by p parties who wish to t own individ dual shares in n a property. For examplee, two businesss partners w would like to purch hase an office building. On ne is providingg sixty percennt of the purcchase price w while the otheer partner is investingg forty percen nt. To reflectt this arrange ment, the ow wnership of th he property iss 94 hapter 4: Property Ownersship in Ontario Ch enting a sixty percent own nership with tthe other being divided into two portionss, one represe representing a fortty percent ow wnership. Eitherr party can se ell, mortgage, or will his orr her interest in the properrty, although most lenderss would d require all owners o to sign n on any morrtgage placed on the propeerty. This is d due to the facct that, if the borrow wer defaults, the lender wo ould have a diifficult time selling a portio on of an officce building. If one e party decide ed to sell his or o her interesst in the prop erty, the otheer party woulld become the new tenant t in com mmon. Join nt Tenanc cy A join nt tenancy is a type of co‐o ownership of real propertyy typically useed by spousess purchasing a matrimonial home e. Unlike a tenancy in com mmon, where each owner o owns a divideed share of the prroperty, jointt tenants own n an undivided d interest in tthe property.. In other wo ords, both own one hundred h perce ent of the pro operty togeth her. If one co ‐owner dies, the propertyy then becom mes the surviving owner’s property without having tto go through h the probatee process. Some e parents will add a child or children on title as joint tenants so th hat, on the deeath of the survivving parent, the property becomes b the child’s witho ut going thro ough the proccess and paying the costs off probate. Ho owever, there e may be incoome tax impliications involved in this ess since, whe en property other than a principal p residdence is transsferred to a no on‐spouse, a proce disposition is deem med to occur at fair market value. The result is that any accrued gain is taxable in the e year of dispo osition which may result in n tax payablee that exceedss the amountt that would have been payable e in probate fees. 4.7 Judgments and d Liens Jud gments A judggment, as it relates to a de ebt, is a judge e’s decision thhat a debt is o owed by a deebtor to a credittor. In Ontariio a creditor can, c after obttaining a judggment, file a W Writ of Seizurre and Sale off land against a a debttor in any cou unty or districct in which thhe debtor own ns land. The writ will encum mber any currently owned d land in any county c or disttrict, or land w which is purcchased in the future e by the debtor, by way off placing a lien n against the property. It should be no oted that, eveen thouggh a creditor has h obtained a judgment, he or she doees not have to file a Writ o of Seizure and d Sale, and a can wait until he or sh he knows thatt the debtor oowns land. n lend on a property unttil this debt iss paid, unless,, with certain n lenders, the Most lenders will not debt is i being paid from the proceeds. Four months m after filing of the writ w with the enforcementt office, a creditor can direect the enforcement office e, through the sheriff, to seize s and sell the land. Thee actual sale of the land canno ot take place until after the e writ has bee en on file for six months. The writ w expires sixx years from the date it is issued and m may then be reenewed for aanother six‐ year period. p Ch hapter 4: Property Ownersship in Ontario 9 95 Lien ns A lien is security aggainst a prope erty, either re eal or person al, for a debt. Legislation allows for the placin ng of a lien on n a property for f construction costs not paid, which iss commonly rreferred to ass a mecchanic’s lien. Under the Peersonal Propeerty Security A Act (also refeerred to as thee PPSA), a lien n can be registered against a perso onal property such as for a car loan. A lien does not force the salee of pro operty but sim mply uses that property ass security for a debt. 96 4.8 Chapter 4: Property Ownership in Ontario Key Terms and Definitions Building Scheme A group of restrictive covenants registered against several properties in a development plan that is binding on all purchasers of a property within that development Chattel Personal property, movable property and other property not deemed to be fixtures Condominium The whole collection of individual home units along with the land upon which they sit. Individual home ownership is composed only of the air‐space within the boundaries of the home, as defined by a document known as a Declaration, filed on record with the local governing authority. Dominant Tenement A property receiving a benefit Easement A right for the benefit of the dominant tenement over that of the servient tenement that is normally registered on title and that runs with the land Encumbrance An interest in property that has the effect of limiting the rights of fee simple ownership of real property. Typical encumbrances are mortgages, easements and restrictive covenants. Fee Simple Estate The most common form of ownership in Ontario and provides the holder with the widest breadth of rights available. Fee refers to the fact that the estate may be inherited while simple refers to the fact that there are no prohibitions against who may inherit it. The owner of this estate is in control of the real property for as long as he or she has it, subject to paying the property taxes and other municipal obligations. This individual may transfer his or her interest in the property during his or her lifetime or dictate who will inherit the fee simple interest upon his or her death, mortgage the interest, and so on. Joint Tenancy A type of co‐ownership of real property whereby all owners own an undivided interest in the property Judgment A final court ruling resolving the key questions in a lawsuit and determining the rights and obligations of the opposing parties, such as the awarding of monies to an injured party Leasehold Estate An interest in land created by a landlord and tenant, most commonly by a lease. This interest in land is created for a fixed period of time, such as a month, year, or more. There is no limit on the time that a leasehold estate may be in effect. A leasehold estate provides the owner of this estate the right to exclusive use and possession of the property, subject to contractual limits contained in the terms of the lease Chapter 4: Property Ownership in Ontario 97 Lien Security against a property, either real or personal, for a debt Personal property Everything one owns that is not real property. That includes chattels and other goods. Personal property is typically not fixed in its location and normally has a shorter useful life expectancy than real property. Real Property Land and everything affixed to it. It is in a fixed location and is permanent, remaining, to one extent or another, long after the current owners have relinquished their rights to it. Restrictive Covenant A restriction of use placed on title of the servient tenement for the benefit of the dominant tenement Runs with the land Means that an interest in property, such as an easement or restrictive covenant, transfers from owner to owner Servient Tenement A property giving up a benefit Tenancy in Common A type of co‐ownership of real property typically used by parties who wish to own individual shares in a property 98 4.9 hapter 4: Property Ownersship in Ontario Ch Review w Questio ons Answers to the Revview Questio ons are found at www.REM MIC.ca Sho ort Answe er Questio ons 1. De escribe the diffferences bettween real an nd personal p roperty. hat does a ho omeowner actually own in relation to hhis or her prop perty? 2. Wh 3. De escribe the term “Fee Simp ple” and discu uss the rights of the fee sim mple holder. 4. De escribe the term “Leaseholld Estate” and d discuss the rights of a ho older of this type of estatee. 5. Wh hat makes co ondominium ownership o un nique? 6. Wh hat impact on n property ow wnership do encumbrance e es have? hat is an ease ement and wh hat are its impacts on propperty rights? 7. Wh 8. Wh hat is a restrictive covenan nt and what are a its impactts on propertyy rights? 9. De escribe the diffference betw ween a buildin ng scheme annd a restrictivve covenant. 10. Discuss the maain difference e between joint tenancy annd tenancy in n common. 11. Exxplain the impact of a judggment on pro operty ownersship. Chapter 5: Regulation R andd Legislation 9 99 Chaapter 5: Regullation aand Leggislatioon Lea arning Outccomes Succcessful undersstanding of th he concepts presented p in tthis chapter w will enable the learner to: Describe the roole and organnizational struucture of the regulator, thhe Financial Seervices Commission off Ontario (FSC CO) Iddentify activitties that are subject s to reggulation Iddentify the four licenses caaptured by the Act and Reggulations, resstrictions, exeemptions, how they are issued, registe ered, suspend ded, revoked and enforced Innterpret the Act A and Regullations (includ ding Standardds of Practicee) that govern n mortgage brokerages Innterpret the Act A and Regullations that govern g mortgaage agents Innterpret the Act A and Regullations that govern g mortgaage brokers Innterpret the Act A and Regullations that govern g princippal brokers Correctly interrpret and use terminology related to thhe mortgage bbrokerage inddustry’s egulatory envvironment re Intro oduction Note: This chapterr contains info ormation abo out and interppretations of legislation. N Neither the autho or nor the pub blisher is a law wyer and in no n way does aany information contained d in this text constitute legal advice. Legal and other decisions relatedd to financial or any other type of transaaction should d be complete ed only after seeking s advicce from a com mpetent profeessional and should not be base ed on informaation contained herein. N either the pu ublisher nor th he author is engagged in rendering legal or other professional advice. The mortgage m brokkerage industtry is now higghly regulatedd, although it was not alwaays. The Mortg gage agents Act, A dating baack to the late e 1960s, was not substanttially updated d for 30 years. Origin nally, the Real Estate and Business B Brokkers Act, also referred to as REBBA, (thee legislation that regulates r real estate broke ers), regulated d mortgage aagents, until the Mortgagee agents Act took effect e which separated s mo ortgage broke ering from reaal estate brokkering. With the creation of the e Mortgage agents Act, reaal estate brokkers were deeemed mortgaage agents. H However the new legislation thaat was enacte ed in July 2008 removed thhat provision.. The fo ocus of the le egislation enacted in 2008 is to ensure tthat the Ontaario consumer is protected d and provided p with necessary disclosure to make m an inform med decision n regarding th he potential transaaction. The Financial F Services Commisssion of Ontariio (FSCO) enfforces the leggislation and regulaates the morttgage brokeraage industry as a well as sevveral others. Pa ause for cllarification n – Disclosure Th he act of reve ealing someth hing, or makin ng something evident. Sevveral types off disclosure arre required un nder the MBLLAA and Regu ulations. 100 Chapter 5: Regulation R andd Legislation mportant for a mortgage agent a to unde erstand the leegislation andd its impact, eespecially It is im given that licensed d brokers can be in the possition of man aging licensed mortgage aagents for whom m brokers havve some respo onsibility. Furthermore a licensed brokker can also h hold the position of principal broker, the e Chief Compliance Officerr of a brokeraage – in otherr words, the perso on within the brokerage wh ho is responsible to FSCO ffor compliancce. A mortgaage agent must have sufficient understanding of the le egislation to eensure that hee or she is maaking inform med decisionss on his or he er actions as well w as those of the brokerrage and to quickly and successfully locate e legislative in nformation on n a day‐to‐dayy basis as req quired. Failurre to know an nd apply the relevant legislation caan put the bro okerage and tthe broker’s license in jeopardy. The Financial Serviices Commisssion of Ontario (FSCO) is reesponsible for enforcing th he current legislaation and regulating the mortgage m brokkerage industtry, among otthers. Pa ause for cla arification n – Regulatte To o govern or diirect accordin ng to rule, to make m regulatiions for or conncerning an industry. m have a clear c understaanding of FSCCO’s mandatee as well as th he means by Mortggage agents must which h FSCO accom mplishes its ro ole as regulato or of all activiities related tto dealing and d trading in mortggages as well as lending in the province e of Ontario. c will exxamine, in de etail, the man nner in which mortgage aggents and the mortgage This chapter broke erage industryy are regulate ed in Ontario.. 5.1 The Re egulator: FSCO The Financial Serviices Commisssion of Ontario (FSCO) is thhe regulator ffor the mortggage broke erage industryy in Ontario. FSCO was cre eated on July 1, 1998 as an n arm’s length agency of the Ministry M of Finance. Integraating the ope erations of thee former Ontario Insurancce Comm mission, Pension Commissiion of Ontario o and Depositt Institutions Division of th he Ministry of Finance, FSCO com mprises three key parts: The Commis ssion The purpose of the e Commission n includes pro oviding regulaatory servicess and making recom mmendations to the Ministter of Finance e on matters affecting thee regulated seectors. Fina ancial Se ervices Trribunal (T Tribunal) This iss an independ dent, adjudicaative body that hears appeeals of regulaatory decision ns by the Superrintendent. The T Tribunal has h exclusive jurisdiction too exercise thee powers con nferred underr the Fiinancial Services Commissiion of Ontario o Act, 1997 annd other Actss that confer powers on orr assign n duties to the Tribunal. The Superin tendent and a Stafff The Superintenden nt of Financiaal Services is responsible r foor issuing and d revoking liceenses, as well as forr enforcing co ompliance, all of which are e designed to protect the p public. All FSC CO staff Chapter 5: Regulation R andd Legislation 10 01 reporrt directly or indirectly to the Superintendent. The sstaff, who aree civil servantss appointed underr the Public Seervices Act, perform FSCO’s day‐to‐dayy work. han the mortgage brokeraage industry. Following is a summary o of FSCO is concerned with more th 1 the re egulated elem ments of FSCO O’s day‐to‐dayy concerns ass of Decembeer 3 1, 2015 : 1,1196 licensed mortgage m bro okerages (1,0 075 in Feb, 20015 and 1,1699 in 2012) 2,6696 mortgagee agents (2,6000 in Feb 2015 and 2,466 i n 2012) 10,977 mortgagge agents (9,7703 in Februaary, 2015 and 8,134 in 2012) 143 licensed moortgage admiinistrators (1330 in Februarry, 2015 and 995 in 2012) 327 insurance companies c (3 332 in February, 2015 and 350 in 2012) 7,0059 pension plans p (7,234 in February, 2015 2 and 7,6007 in 2012) 110 credit unions and caissees populaires (118 in Februuary, 2015 annd 157 in 2012) 51 loan and trust companiess (52 in Februuary, 2015 annd 58 in 2012)) 1,8800 co‐operattive corporations (1,788 in February, 22015 and 1,6994 in 2012) 51,324 insurancce agents (488,928 in Februuary, 2015 annd 46,222 in 22012) 5,5511 corporatee insurance agencies (5,2884 in Februaryy, 2015 and 44,632 in 2012)), and 1,5510 insurancee adjusters (11,588 in Februuary, 2015 annd 1,657 in 20012) F websitte at www.fsco.gov.on.ca More information may be found by visiting FSCO’s In 200 04, due to the e increase in the t popularity of mortgag e agents and the growth in the mortggage industryy, The Ministry of Finance began b the proocess of revieewing the Mo ortgage agentts Act, the legislation n in place at th he time. The stated goals of the review w were to enssure that the ed safeguards for the public while givingg mortgage agents fair and d effective legislaation provide rules that encourage industry growth g and innovation. This process p began n with a consu ultation pape er entitled “Im mproving the Mortgage ag gents Act” thaat put fo orward ideas for new legislation and promoted indu stry involvem ment in the prrocess. The resultt was, through Bill C‐65, th hat the Mortg gage agents A Act was repeaaled and replaaced by the Mortg gage Brokera ages, lenders and a Administtrators Act, 20006 (MBLAA). The Ministeer of Finance includ ded provisions that one or more person ns be appointted to review the operatio on of the MBLA AA and its Reg gulations every five years. Sum mmary of the Act and a Regu ulations The mortgage m brokkerage industtry is regulate ed by one prinncipal Act and d its correspo onding Regullations (includ ding one that addresses Sttandards of P ractice). Stan ndards of Praactice are found d in many industries and dictate the bussiness rules bby which that particular ind dustry operaates. In Onttario, legislation is passed when a Bill (w which has a nnumber) is inttroduced to tthe legislaturee, goes through t several phases called “readings,” and if afteer the Third reeading there are enough votes, it receives what’s w called “Royal Assent” by the Lieuutenant Goveernor. At this stage it becom mes an Act orr Statute. 1 http:://fsco.gov.on.ca/en/about/P Pages/default.aspx 102 Chapter 5: Regulation and Legislation The following is a summary of the Act and Regulations that are currently in place for the mortgage brokerage industry. Each piece of legislation has a name and, in the case of the Regulations, a number, by which it is referred. The applicable sections of the Act and Regulations will be described in detail in a subsequent chapter as they relate to the brokerage, the mortgage agent, the mortgage broker, the principal broker and the mortgage administrator. The MBLAA The Mortgage Brokerages, lenders and Administrators Act, 2006 (MBLAA) is the principal legislation governing this industry. It is commonly referred to simply as the “MBLAA” or “the Act.” The Regulations Mortgage Brokerages 408/07 Mortgage Brokerages: Licensing 188/08 Mortgage Brokerages: Standards of Practice Principal Brokers 410/07 Principal Brokers: Eligibility, Powers and Duties Mortgage agents and Agents 409/07 Mortgage agents and Agents: Licensing 187/08 Mortgage agents and Agents: Standards of Practice Cost of Borrowing and Disclosure 191/08 Cost Of Borrowing and Disclosure to borrowers Mortgage Administrators (note: this is not covered on the exam as it does not apply to mortgage agents) 406/07 Regulated Activities: Additional Prescribed Activities 411/07 Mortgage Administrators: Licensing 189/08 Mortgage Administrators: Standards of Practice Licensing Exemptions 407/07 Exemptions from the Requirement to be Licensed Reporting Requirements 193/08 Reporting Requirements for Licensees General 190/08 General Penalties 192/08 Administrative Penalties 5.2 Activities that are Regulated The MBLAA regulates the following activities: dealing in mortgages in Ontario Chapter 5: Regulation R andd Legislation 10 03 traading in mortggages in Ontaario carrrying on business as a len nder in Ontariio, and carrrying on the business of administering a g mortgages inn Ontario Regulated activitie es are set out in MBLAA, se ections 2 to 66. These sectiions, which reefer t “dealin ng” and “trading in mortgaages”, as well as “lending”, which were speciffically to the terms includ ded in the old d Mortgage ag gents Act butt never defineed, are now cclearly explain ned. Those dealin ng or trading in mortgagess, as well as th hose lending on real estatee (unless exempted) mustt have a broker’s or agent’s license. For th he purposes of o the legislation, the defin nition of the tterm “dealingg in mortgagees” is defined as anyyone who solicits another person or bu usiness to buyy, sell or exchange mortgages, or who does so on his/herr own behalf or o on behalf of o another (thhat is, who so olicits a perso on or entity, such as a a business or corporatio on, to borrow w or lend monney on the security of real estate). In additiion, if a perso on or businesss assesses a borrower, b whhich would incclude underw writing a mortggage application, provides information to a lender oor negotiates or arranges a mortgage on n behalf of another person p or bussiness is deem med to be “deealing in morttgages.” Regarrding lending activities, the e MBLAA stattes that anyonne who lendss money in On ntario on real prope erty is deemed to be a lend der. In this caase the persoon or businesss must be liceensed as a mortggage brokeragge, unless it iss exempt. Tyypically a busiiness would b be exempt if iit was licensed underr other legislaation, such ass the Bank Actt or the Trustt and Loan Co ompanies Act,, or if the perso on’s or busine ess’s lending activities a were e done solelyy through a m mortgage brokkerage or other regulated len nder. mmission of O Ontario Act, 19 997 as well as Severral changes were made to the Financiall Services Com the Liicence Appeall Tribunal Actt, 1999 to refllect the changges to legislattion, resultingg in the MBLA AA. One that is of particulaar interest is paragraph 5 oof subsection n 35.2 of the Securities Act, which h states: “Sub bject to the re egulations, re egistration is nnot required to trade in th he following securities: Mortgagges or other encumbrance e es upon real oor personal property, otheer than er encumbran nces contained in or secureed by a bond,, debenture o or similar mortggages or othe obligaation or in a trust deed or other instrum ment to securre bonds or debentures orr similar obligaations, if such h mortgages or o other encumbrances aree offered for sale by a person or comp pany licensed,, or exempted d from the requirement too have a licence, under thee Mortgage Brokeerages, lenderrs and Administrators Act, 2006.” The MBLAA M introduced a new liicensing requ uirement for tthose adminisstering mortggages. This activitty is defined as a being any individual or business thatt receives mo ortgage paym ments on behaalf of ano other. If engaaged in this activity the ind dividual or buusiness must have a Mortggage Admin nistrator’s license. 5.3 Licensu ure Pau use for cla arification – Licensuree Lice ensure can be e defined as permission p graanted by an aagency of govvernment to aan individual or entity e to engaage in a given profession or occupation.. 104 Chapter 5: Regulation R andd Legislation Fou r License es In ord der to regulate, the MBLAA A provides for four types oof licenses to be issued by the Superrintendent of Financial Serrvices: a brokerage licensee, a mortgage broker’s license, a mortggage agent’s license l and a mortgage ad dministrator’ss license. Eacch is described d in the Act, sectio ons 7 – 12 and d discussed in n more detail later in this cchapter. enses are issuued to individ duals. Corporrations, Mortggage brokers’’ and mortgagge agents’ lice partnerships, sole proprietorships and presccribed entitiess that carry o on the businesss of dealing in mortggages, tradingg in mortgage es or lending money on thee security of real propertyy are required d to havve a brokeragge license or a Mortgage Administrator A r’s license. Pa ause for cllarification n – Corpora ations, parrtnershipss and sole prroprietorsh hips A corporation is a legal business entity crreated under federal or prrovincial statu utes. A partnership is a type of bu usiness entityy in which parrtners (ownerrs) share with h each other the profits or lo osses of the business b unde ertaking in whhich all have iinvested. A sole proprietorship consissts of a sole owner, also caalled a proprieetor, of an un nincorporated d usiness. bu The MBLAA M states that, to enfo orce compensation for anyy of its licenseed activities, tthe person orr business must be licensed. Sim mply stated, if a person arraanges a mortgage for anotther party and expeccts to be compensated by a lender, thatt lender may refuse to do so if the persson is not appro opriately licen nsed at the tim me of the transaction and the person w would not be able to sue the le ender for paym ment. Res strictions The MBLAA M restriccts the use of the titles “mortgage brokerage,” “morrtgage brokerr,” “mortgagee agentt,” “mortgage e administrattor” and theirr French equivvalents to persons and enttities licensed d as succh under the MBLAA. Thiss prohibition includes usinng abbreviatio ons such as m mtg. broker, o or their equivalents in n another lan nguage. Exe mptions to Licens sure Regullation 407/07 7 details the circumstances c s under whichh certain people or entities are exemptt from obtaining a license under the MBLAA. Exemptions ffrom obtainin ng a license under the Act are in ndicated in various circumsstances and fo or various enntities which aare spelled ou ut in detail in the Reegulation (sim mple referralss, lawyers, an nd so on). Folllowing is a su ummary. A simple referral (d described in sections s 1 – 2 of the Regullation) is a term used to deescribe the acct of refferring a potential borrowe er to a potenttial lender, orr vice versa, iff the referrerr informs the other party, in writting, that a fe ee will be rece eived for the referral, the nature of thee relationship p betwe een the partie es, and as lon ng as the onlyy other inform mation provid ded is the nam me, address, teleph hone numberr, fax numberr, email addre ess or websitee address of tthe individual being referrred. In addition, if no fee is i payable, a person p or enttity does not have to be liccensed. Chapter 5: Regulation R andd Legislation 10 05 uld be a real estate e salespperson who reefers a client tto a bank An exxample of thiss situation cou mortggage rep. In this t case, if th he real estate salesperson abides by theese rules, he or she does not haave to be lice ensed under the MBLAA. A lawyer (as per se ections 3 – 5) is exempt from prescribeed activities iff he or she is acting solely on be ehalf of his or her client and is not holdiing him or he rself out to b be trading, dealing or admin nistering morrtgages to the e general public. An exxample of thiss scenario cou uld be a divorrce lawyer whho has a client who requirees a mortgage to payy his spouse a settlement. In this case it would be leegal for this laawyer to arraange this financcing for that client c withoutt being licenssed under thee MBLAA. However, this laawyer could not ad dvertise, for example e in a newspaper, that t he brokeers mortgagess. Otherr exemptions from licensin ng include tru ustees in bankkruptcy, thosee acting undeer a court orderr, statutory co orporations, a personal corrporation of a broker or aggent, motor vvehicle dealership financin ng companiess, directors an nd employeess of Crown aggencies or oth her exempted d perso ons or entitiess. As per secttion 11 of Reg gulation 407//07, consumer reporting aggencies are exempt if they are only providin ng informatio on on prospecctive borroweers to prospective lenders and are not otherw wise dealing in mortgages.. Registtered real esttate brokeragges, brokers or o agents are exempt when n they are arrranging or attem mpting to arraange a vendorr take‐back mortgage m for a client, as lon ng as they aree not holdingg themsselves out to the public ass dealing in mortgages. Pa ause for cla arification n – Vendorr take‐backk A vendor v take‐b back, also kno own as a VTB, is where thee seller of thee property pro ovides all or some of the financing to the e purchaser in n order to selll the propertyy. A person or entity registered un nder the Secu urities Act is eexempt, as peer sections 12 2 – 14, under certaiin circumstan nces, as long as a they are no ot holding theemselves out to the publicc as trading in n mortggages. In add dition, those involved in the securitizati on of mortgaages are also eexempt. If a pe erson or entitty only lends through t a mo ortgage brokeerage or otheer exempt perrson or entityy, they are a not requirred to have a mortgage brrokerage licennse (section 115 on Mortgaage Lending). ed to have a Mortgage M Administrator’s license if theey are A person or entity is not require admin nistering morrtgages on behalf of the Crrown, a financcial institution, a collection agency registtered under the Collection Agencies Actt, or if they arre only admin nistering morttgages that constitute mortgagge backed seccurities as per sections 16 – 19, Exempttions for Adm ministering Mortggages. Gettting and Keeping a Licens se Sectio ons 13 to 22 of o the Act stattes that any party p wishingg to apply for a license musst complete the ap ppropriate ap pplication and d forms, alongg with the ap plicable fee tto the Superin ntendent, using the process laid l out in the e applicable Regulation. R TThe licensing p process for a mortgage broke erage is contaained in Regullation 408/07 7; the licensinng process forr mortgage aggents and agentts is contained d in Regulatio on 409/07 and the licensinng process forr Mortgage A Administratorss 106 Chapter 5: Regulation R andd Legislation ntained in Reg gulation 411//07. The actual forms usedd to process aan application n for licensingg is con may change c from time t to time, with current forms being available on FSCO’s website or by contacting the regulator directly. The Superintenden nt has the right to refuse to t issue or rennew a licensee, suspend a liicense or propo ose to impose e conditions on o a licensee, if it is believeed that the ap pplicant doess not meet the requirrements for licensing. In such s cases the e applicant haas the right to o request a hearing by thee Tribun nal, as long as that requesst is made witthin 15 days oof receiving notice from th he Superrintendent regarding his or her license application. Hav ving a Lic cense Iss ued by FSCO F The Superintenden nt of FSCO is empowered e to: t t issue a lice ense issue or refuse to nd conditionss on a license, and impose or amen ren new or refuse e to renew a license l FSC CO's Pub lic Regis try Regullation 190/08 8 created the requirement of a public reegistry for liceensees (brokeerages and Admin nistrators) wh hich maintain ns the following informatioon: each name in which w it is licen nsed and its licence numbber the e type of licen nce that it ho olds and whetther the licen ce is in good standing or iss suspended its mailing addrress in Ontario o as it appearrs in the reco rds maintaineed by the Sup perintendent its telephone nu umber as it appears in the e records mai ntained by th he Superinten ndent any conditions that t apply to the licence forr a brokerage e, the name off its principal broker For tw wo years afte er a brokeragge or Mortgage Administrrator ceases tto be licensed, the registeer must contain the following f info ormation abou ut the formerr brokerage o or Mortgage A Administratorr: w it was licensed and itts former lice nce number each name in which e type of licen nce that it held the the e date on which it ceased to be licensed d wh hether the lice ence was surrendered or revoked r Similaarly, the public register of o mortgage agents and aagents that iis to be maintained undeer subse ection 28 (1) of the Act must m contain n the followinng informatio on about eacch broker an nd agentt: the e name in wh hich he or she e is licensed and the licenc e number the e type of licen nce that he or she holds, itts expiry datee and whetheer the licence is in good staanding or is su uspended the e name of the e brokerage on o whose beh half he or shee is authorized d to deal or trrade in mo ortgages any conditions that t apply to the licence, other o than coonditions relaating to educaational quirements req Again, if a brokerr or agent ceases c to be licensed, thhe register m must contain the followin ng inform mation about the former broker b or agent: the e name in wh hich he or she e was licensed d and his or h er former liceence numberr Chapter 5: Regulation R andd Legislation 10 07 the e type of licen nce that he or she held the e name of the e brokerage on o whose beh half he or shee was authorizzed to deal orr trade in mo ortgages imm mediately befo ore ceasing to o be licensed the e date on which he or she ceased to be e licensed wh hether the lice ence expired,, renewal of the t licence w as refused, th he licence waas surrendered or the licence was w revoked The in nformation re equired must be kept on th he register unntil two yearss after the exp piry date of the in ndividual’s lice ence or, if the e licence was surrendered or revoked b before the expiry date, until two t years after the date on which the licence wouldd have expired d if it had nott been surren ndered or revvoked. Proh hibited Activities A The MBLAA M (sectio ons 43 – 50) clearly c lays ou ut what are coonsidered to be prohibited d activities underr the legislatio on. These incclude a prohib bition on: counselling or advising a anyone to give false or deceptiive informatio on in a transaaction ob bstructing the Superintendent from performing his oor her duties o or withholdin ng anything rellevant to an inquiry pro oviding false or misleadingg information n to the Superrintendent a person p or bussiness taking adverse a emplloyment actioon against an employee beecause the em mployee proviided informattion or docum ments to the SSuperintendeent. Pa ause for cla arification n – Prohibited activitties Th he Mortgage Brokerages, B lenders and Administratorss Act, 2006 an nd Regulation ns, prohibit: Trading or dealing in moortgages withhout a licencee: As of July 11, 2008, all mortgage a agents m must be licensed with FSCO O to carry on brokeragess, administrators, brokers and business in Ontario, unle ess an exemp ption applies. Using an un nauthorized name: n You caan only use thhe name in which you are licensed. Com mpliance and Enfo orcementt The MBLAA M specifiically states what w is required of a licenssee and how ffailure to com mply will be enforced. Sectio ons 28 – 42, for example, creates c the re equirement thhat licensees provide inforrmation as requirred under Regulations. Th he legislation provides the Superintend dent or a persson designateed by the e Superintend dent the rightt to enter (without using fforce) and insspect a licenseee’s premisess (but not n areas thatt are deemed d to be dwellin ngs, unless thhe occupant cconsents), exaamine moneyy, valuables, docume ents and records of the lice ensee, requiree employees or those app pearing to be emplo oyees to answ wer questionss, produce do ocuments or rrecords, inclu uding data sto orage systemss and re emove any ite em that may be relevant to t the inquiryy or examination (receipts for all items removved must be provided). If the Superintende ent or its designee is refussed entry or itt is believed tthat they will be refused entry,, an order maay be obtained from a justice of the peaace, which may be enforceed through the usse of force byy police office ers, if that force is reasona bly necessaryy to execute tthe order. 108 Chapter 5: Regulation R andd Legislation s tools tto enforce co ompliance witth licensing Under the MBLAA,, the Superinttendent has several requirrements and conditions. The T Superinte endent, if he or she believes that someething the licenssee is doing co ontravenes th he MBLAA, may m issue a Coompliance Ord der to correctt the issue. The licensee has th he right to ap ppeal this decision to the TTribunal within 15 days of receiving the Superrintendent’s proposal p conttained in the Compliance O Order, in which case the C Compliance Orderr will be on ho old until the hearing h occurrs. If, howeveer, in the opin nion of the Superrintendent, it is in the public’s interest to t immediateely implement the Compliaance Order, the Su uperintenden nt has the righ ht to do so. The T licensee’ss rights to req quest a hearin ng within 15 days of o being notiffied of the Co ompliance Ord der still rema in in effect. Furthermore, the Superintende S ent has the rigght to issue oorders to freezze assets or ttrust funds if necesssary to prote ect the public,, and may maake applicatioon to the courrt to appoint a receiver orr truste ee. Section 36 6.8 of the MB BLAA allows fo or the individ ual to preven nt the Superin ntendent from m doingg so if he or sh he provides th he Superinten ndent with a bond in the aamount and m manner requirred by the Superintendentt. Pa ause for cla arification n – Trust fu unds Tru ust funds are those monie es received byy a brokeragee or Administrrator on behaalf of or paayable to anotther party. The MBLAA M (sectio ons 43 – 50) gives g FSCO tw wo types of ennforcement to ools: adminisstrative penalties and charrges under the e legislation. Pa ause for cla arification n – Adminisstrative peenalties Th his is a penaltyy assessed byy the Superinttendent for leess serious co ontraventionss of or failures to comply with the MBLAA. Regullation 192/08 8 spells out ru ules and proce edures relateed to administtrative penaltties. This Regullation (section ns 1 – 4) proh hibits the Sup perintendent ffrom imposin ng penalties o on those coverred in section 46 of the MB BLAA (which prohibits p reprrisals against those who provide inform mation to the e Superintend dent). Admin nistrative pen nalties are eitther “general”” or “summarry” and are co overed in dettail in Regullation 192/08 8 sections 1 – 6. The same timeframes apply to both h. The Superintendent may impose admin nistrative pen nalties for con ntraventions oof or failures to comply wiith the MBLAA mined in accordance with the t Regulatioons. If the Sup perintendentt proposes to in amounts determ imposse an adminisstrative penallty, the affectted party mayy request a heearing beforee the Financiaal Servicces Tribunal. A summary process p is pro ovided for adm ministrative p penalties imp posed on licenssees who fail to t provide infformation to the Superinteendent in acccordance with h the Regullations. An ad dministrative penalty mayy not exceed $$10,000 in the case of a co ontravention or faillure to complly by a mortgage agent or agent or $255,000 in the caase of a contrravention or failure e to comply by b a brokeragge, Mortgage Administratoor or any otheer person or eentity, or such h lowerr amounts as may be presccribed. The MBLAA M empow wers the Supe erintendent to t impose adm ministrative p penalties to p promote comp pliance with th he MBLAA up p to a maximu um of $25,0000 for a brokerrage or Administrator, up R andd Legislation Chapter 5: Regulation 10 09 0,000 for a brroker or agen nt and up to $25,000 $ for annyone else. Iff the Superinttendent to $10 propo oses to imposse an administrative penalty the licenseee has the right to appeal tthis proposal to the e Tribunal witthin 15 days of o receiving itt. If the pena lty is not paid d, it is consideered a debt to o the Crrown and can n be enforced d as such. Those e assessed a penalty p must pay the penaalty within thiirty days of beeing assessed d the penalty or oncce a hearing has h been conducted, or longer if providded for in thee penalty or order made from the hearing. Beyon nd administraative penaltie es, the MBLAA A allows the SSuperintendent to charge individuals orr businesses with an n offence und der the legislaation. Anyonee who contravenes any of the sections as listted in section 48 of the MB BLAA is consid dered to be gguilty of an offfence. e offences incclude contravening any one of the follow wing: These subsection 2.2 or o 2.3, Dealin ng in Mortgagges subsection 3.2 or o 3.3, Tradin ng in Mortgagges subsection 4.2, Mortgage Leending subsection 5.2, Administerinng Mortgages secction 27, Prohhibition re Dissclosure in Addvertising secction 30.6, Inquiries and Examinations subsection 43.11 or 43.2, Prohibition re Faalse or Decepttive Informattion subsection 44.11 or 44.2, Prohibition re Obbstruction subsection 45.11 or 45.2, Prohibition re Faalse or Mislea ding Informaation, and secction 46, Prohhibition re Reeprisals Individuals charged d with an offe ence are liable to a fine upp to $100,0000, imprisonmeent for up to one year, or both while w corporaations are liab ble to a fine oof up to $200,,000. It is imp portant to note that t directorss and officers of a corporation that has committed aan offence aree also liable. Sectio on 48.2 of the e MBLAA also o dictates thatt any contravventions of ap pplicable Stan ndards of Practiice are an offence under the MBLAA an nd liable to thhe fines as preeviously discu ussed. Hav ving a Lic cense Sus spended or Revokked by F SCO The Superintenden nt is empowe ered to: nd conditionss on a license impose or amen new or refuse e to renew a license l ren susspend or revo oke a license allow or refuse to allow the surrender of a license, andd impose conditio ons on the surrender of a license l As per the Act, secctions 13 – 22 2, the Superintendent has tthe right, without giving n notice, to autom matically susp pend a license e under severral circumstannces. A mortggage brokeraage’s license will be e automatically suspended d if it fails to have h at least one licensed mortgage aggent. A mortggage broker’ss and mortgagge agent’s lice ense will be aautomaticallyy suspended iff the broke erage’s license e is lost or suspended, or if i that brokerrage no longeer authorizes tthe broker orr agentt to deal in mo ortgages on its behalf, which in effect i s when the b brokerage term minates the broke er’s or agent’ss employment. In other words, w only whhen employed by a brokerrage is a mortggage agent orr broker licensed. 110 R andd Legislation Chapter 5: Regulation o these suspe ensions will be automaticaally revoked iff the reason ffor the suspen nsion is Any of rectifiied. For exam mple, if the brroker’s license is suspendeed due to the brokerage’s suspension, the brroker’s license will be reinstated as soo on as the brokkerage’s licen nse is no longer suspended d. If the broker or age ent is terminaated, as soon as he or she is employed by another b brokerage his or herr license will be reinstated d. The Superintenden nt must first give g notice off his or her prroposal and give the appliccant or licenssee an opporttunity to requ uest a hearingg on the propposal before the Financial SServices Tribun nal. If it is in the t public interest to act im mmediately, tthe Superinteendent may ssuspend a licensse before a he earing can be held before the t Tribunal. If an applicant a or liicensee fails to t pay a fee or o administrattive penalty u under the MB BLAA or if an appliccant does nott give the Sup perintendent information oor documentss required un nder the MBLA AA, for examp ple, the Superrintendent maay revoke or refuse to issu ue or renew a license witho out making a proposal p firstt or giving the e licensee or aapplicant an o opportunity tto request a hearin ng. The Superintenden nt may also su uspend or revvoke a licensee due to unpaaid fees or ad dministrative penalties, the failu ure to provide e the Superinttendent with information or documentts required to o be submitted, or fo or other reaso ons which maay be prescribbed in the futture. Sectio on 4.1 of Regu ulation 408/0 07, entitled Su urrender of Liicense, detaills the criteria which the Superrintendent must use to dettermine whetther a brokerrage is alloweed to surrender its license.. The re emainder of this t chapter will w provide a detailed exp lanation of eaach of the fou ur licenses, along with the requirements for obtaining and keeping eaach one. 5.4 The Mo ortgage Brokerage B e License e The MBLAA M has cre eated a licensse not previously seen in O Ontario. Prior to the MBLA AA a licensed d mortggage agent would be emplloyed by a company, oftenn referred to as a brokeragge, and in so doingg the companyy would be alllowed to deaal or trade in mortgages. Under the MBLAA the corporation, partnership or sole prroprietorship must obtain its own broke erage license. This license allows the liccensee to deaal or trade in mortgages, aas well as carrry on bu usiness as a le ender. This liccense is subje ect to meetingg certain eligibility requireements and other terms and co onditions as prescribed p byy Regulation 4408/07 and 1888/08, Mortg gage Brokeerages: Standards of Practiice. Lice ensing Re equireme ents (Sec tions 1 – 3, Regu ulation 40 08/07) A brokerage licensse may be issu ued to a corporation, partnnership or so ole proprietorrship if it meetss all of the following requirements: In the case of a corporation, it was incorp porated in anyy jurisdiction of Canada, In the case of a partnership, it was forme ed under the llaw in any jurrisdiction of C Canada, In the case of a sole propriettorship, the proprietor p is a resident of C Canada. In all cases, it haas a mailing address a that is not a post ooffice box and d that is suitaable to permitt serrvice by registered mail. Chapter 5: Regulation R andd Legislation 11 11 In all cases, it haas Errors and Omissions in nsurance withh at least $1 m million of coverage per year, and a minimum of $500,000 of cove erage per occcurrence. It m must also include a pro ovision for loss resulting frrom fraudulent acts. Pa ause for cla arification n – Errors and a omissiions insura ance (E & O O) Errrors and Omissions insurance, often refferred to as E & O, is insurrance that pro ovides coverage for errrors or omisssions made byy a brokeragee, broker, ageent or adminisstrator. This inssurance mustt contain a provision for fraaud. In the case of a corporation or partnershiip, the applicaation includes the particullars of the priincipal brokerr, who must meet m eligibilitty requiremennts as found in section 7.7 7 of the MB BLAA. In the case of a sole e proprietorship the sole pproprietor is aalso the princcipal broker. Pa ause for cla arification n – Principa al broker Th he position of Principal Bro oker is a licenssed mortgagee broker who is responsiblle for en nsuring that th he brokerage, and all of itss brokers andd agents, com mply with the requirementss of the MBLAA, including enssuring that an ny contraventtions of the Act are dealt w with, and thatt the e brokerage has h the prope er policies and d proceduress in place to eensure that all brokers and d agents are adeq quately superrvised and thaat they compply with everyy requirementt under the MB BLAA. Suittability fo or Licensiing (Secttions 1 – 3, Regullation 40 8/07) A corp poration, partnership or so ole proprietorship must bee found suitable for licenssing as a mortggage brokeragge. This is de etermined by a four part teest which aim ms to establish h lack of suitab bility: Whhether havingg regard to itss financial position, the coorporation, paartnership or sole pro oprietorship cannot c reasonably be expe ected to be fiinancially responsible in th he conduct off its business. Whhether the paast conduct, in the case of a corporatio n, of any direector or officeer of the corporation affo ords reasonable grounds for f belief thatt the businesss of the corpo oration will no ot be carried on o in accordance with the law and withh integrity and d honesty. In n the case of a partnership thiss applies to th he conduct off a partner; inn the case of tthe sole prop prietorship, t proprietor him/herselff. thiis applies to the Whhether the coorporation, paartnership or sole propriettorship is carrrying on activvities that contravene or will w contraven ne the Act or the Regulatioons if a licens e is granted. Whhether in the case of a corrporation a diirector or offiicer of the corporation hass made a falsee staatement or haas provided faalse informattion to the Su perintendentt with respect to the application for a license. In the t case of a partnership tthis would ap pply to a partn ner. In the casse of a sole proprietorship p, this would apply a to the pproprietor him m/herself. A licensed brokeraage may obtaiin a license in n either its leggal name or b both its legal n name and a name e registered under the Busiiness Names Act A as per Se ction 4 of Reggulation 408//07. Whetheer the naame is legal or o not, the Superintendentt can refuse t o issue a licen nse in that naame if the Superrintendent reasonably beliieves that the e name mightt confuse the public with aanother licenssed brokerage e or that the name n might be b objectionaable on any public groundss. If a 112 Chapter 5: Regulation R andd Legislation erage carries on o any other business, as per Regulatioon 188/08 Secctions 56 – 60 0, it must broke ensurre that it doessn’t allow the e other busine ess to “jeoparrdize its integgrity, indepen ndence or comp petence when n carrying on the t business of dealing or trading in mo ortgages or carrying on business as a morttgage lender.”” Stan ndards off Practice e (Regula ation 188 8/08) Stand dards of Practice contain th he business ru ules that a brrokerage musst follow, in addition to other rules as set out o by the MB BLAA and its Regulations. R Contraventio on of the Stan ndards of Practiice as set out in Regulation n 188/08 is an n offence undder the MBLA AA’s section 4 48.2 and is subject to the fines outlined in section 49 off the MBLAA. The followin ng will providee a detailed explanation of the different secctions found in the Standa rds of Practicce for mortgage broke erages. Pub blic Relat ions Sectio ons 5 ‐ 9 of Reegulation 188 8/08 define public relationns materials aas any advertisement by th he broke erage in connection with h its business as a brok erage that is published, circulated o or broad dcast by any means, or any a material that a brokeerage makes available to o the public in conne ection with itss business as a brokerage. A brokerage must use its authorized name when w conductting any busin ness, and it m must prominently includ de its authorizzed name and d license num mber in all of its public relaations materrials. If the brokerage is a franchise, it must state thhat it is independently own ned and operaated. If an individual’s naame is included in the matterial, his or hher title (i.e., broker or ageent) must be includ ded. For exam mple, if Bob Smith S is a morrtgage agent and his namee is used in an n adverrtisement, he must include e the words, “mortgage “ brroker” or “bro oker” beside his name, resultting in “Bob Smith, Mortgaage Broker,” or o “Bob Smithh, Broker.” A Abbreviations may also be used. A brokerage must also provide the license in nformation, iff requested, tto a person w who requests it. This does not mean m that a brokerage is re equired to proovide a list off all of its brokers or agentts, just those specifically re equested by a person. Com mplaints Process P The brokerage must have a com mplaints process so that if an individuall makes a com mplaint to thee broke erage in writin ng, the brokerage must resspond in writting, also indicating that if the comp plainant believves that the brokerage b hass contravenedd the MBLAA A he or she maay refer the comp plaint to the Superintenden nt. All complaints must bee documented and handleed by one or more authorized in ndividuals. Cus stomer Re elations Sectio ons 10 – 17 off Regulation 188/08 1 require the brokerrage to verify the identity of the borro owers, lenderss and Investo ors involved in n a mortgage transaction. If it is unablee to do so it must advise the otther parties in n the transacttion. A brokeerage cannot complete anyy transaction Chapter 5: Regulation R andd Legislation 11 13 nformation provided to thhe brokerage is suspicious,, the that itt feels is unlawful. If the in broke erage must inform any and d all lenders in nvolved in thee transaction n as soon as p possible. If a brrokerage arraanges a mortggage through an investor oor lender of any type, it cannot make a guaraantee to that investor or le ender in respe ect to the moortgage. For eexample, a brrokerage canno ot guarantee a specific rate e of return to o an investor, nor can it gu uarantee that all paymentss will be e made by the borrower. Retu urn of Do ocuments s (Section n 17, Reg gulation 188/08) A brokerage is required to returrn any deed, instrument oor other document to its ow wner regard dless of whetther the broke erage has bee en asked to r eturn these d documents, and must do sso promptly and with hout charge when w requeste ed in writing. A brokerage may only o use inforrmation gathe ered for the ppurposes for w which it was o obtained. An ny other use requires the written consent c of the person or eentity who is tthe subject o of the inform mation. Info rmation about a the e Brokera age Sectio ons 18 and 19 9 of Regulatio on 188/08 req quire the brokkerage to discclose specific information to pro ospective borrrowers. Certtain informatiion must be ddisclosed to aall prospectivee borrowers while other inform mation need only o be disclossed when reqquested. In all cases, a brokerage must disclose, d in wrriting, if it is a cting solely o on behalf of eeither the lende er or the borro ower, or if it is i acting on behalf of bothh without show wing preference to either (except in cases where the brokkerage is the lender). The brokerage m must also discllose, in writin ng, the numbe er of lenders on whose behalf the brokkerage acted aas a represen ntative duringg the prrevious fiscal year and if itt was a lenderr. When n requested by b the borrow wer, the broke erage must diisclose, in wriiting, when th he brokerage was the lender for more than fifty percent of o the total nuumber of morrtgages (including renew wals), and if and when the brokerage ussed only one lender, and tthat lender’s name, for more than fifty percent of the total t number of mortgagess (including reenewals) during the previo ous fiscal year. Fee s and Pa ayments The MBLAA M and Reegulations speak to severaal topics relat ed to fees an nd other paym ments: representation of fees f and costts, disclosure of fees in wriiting to a borrrower, disclosure of the o borrowing (see Chapter 11: Consume er Protection:: Disclosure) aand acceptingg payments. cost of Each is i described below. b Sectio ons 20 – 23 off Regulation 188/08 1 speciffy that a brokkerage is not aallowed to make any form m of rep presentation that t any fees or costs payaable to the brrokerage in co onnection with carrying on the bu usiness of deaaling or tradin ng in mortgagges or acting as a mortgagge lender are set or appro oved by any government g authority, unle ess they are i n respect to d disbursements to register or dep posit instrum ments under th he Land Titless Act or the R Registry Act. 114 Chapter 5: Regulation R andd Legislation w to a bo orrower if thee brokerage, broker or ageent may or A brokerage must disclose, in writing, will re eceive a fee or o other remu uneration in connection wiith the mortggage or a morrtgage renew wal, from who om it may or will be receivved and the bbasis for calcuulating the am mount. The borro ower must ackknowledge in writing that he or she hass received thiis disclosure. The same disclo osure applies if the brokeraage may or will w pay any fe e or other remuneration tto another perso on or entity in connection with w the morttgage or morrtgage renewaal. Pa ause for cla arification n – Remuneeration Re emuneration is i the total co ompensation that is receivved in exchange for the serrvice that hass be een provided. Mortgage aggents and age ents typicallyy receive remu uneration in tthe form of mo oney, most offten as comm mission, but caan also receivve non‐cash rremuneration n such as rew ward points, trips, etc. ulation 188/08 8, a brokeragge cannot acceept an advance payment As per Sections 37 – 39 of Regu from the borrowerr on transactions where th he principal a mount of thee mortgage is $400,000 (ass of Jan brokerage cannot accept nuary 1, 2016; it was previo ously $300,00 00) or less. Inn addition, a b fundss from a lende er or investorr unless in reggards to a speecific mortgagge. In other w words, a broke erage cannot accept funds from a lende er or investor to be held on n deposit or in trust unlesss those e funds are for a specific mortgage. m If fund ds are receive ed and are co onsidered dee emed trust fuunds (funds th hat are payab ble to anotherr party)) the brokerage must provvide a written n statement too the person or entity providing the fundss. Dutiies in Pa rticular Transacti T ons Sectio ons 24 – 32 off Regulation 188/08 1 require the brokerrage to “ensure that any m mortgage or investtment in a mo ortgage that it i presents fo or the consideeration of a borrower, lend der or investtor, as the casse may be, is suitable for the t borrowerr, lender or investor havingg regard to th he needss and circumsstances of the e borrower, le ender or inveestor.” In add dition, the bro okerage mustt inform the borrower, b lennder or investtor, in writingg, as to the “mate erial risks of each e mortgagge or investme ent in a morttgage that thee brokerage p presents for the co onsideration of the borrow wer, lender orr investor,” a nd obtain written acknow wledgment thaat this disclosure has been made. Neither of th hese requirem ments appliess to lenders o or investors that are a members of a designatted class of le enders and invvestors, as deefined in the Interpretation sectio on of this Regulation. Disc closure The MBLAA M is explicit about req quirements re elated to discclosure. Furth her to those aalready mentioned are oth her disclosure e obligations such s as discloosure of the b brokerage’s reelationships, poten ntial conflicts of interest, mortgages m prreviously in deefault and of the cost of borrowing, thee latter disclosure be eing very explicit. Disclosu ure requirem ents are discu ussed in detaail in a later chaptter. Chapter 5: Regulation R andd Legislation 11 15 Poli cies and Procedu ures Sectio ons 40 and 41 1 of Regulatio on 188/08 dettail the policiees and proced dures that a b brokerage must have in place e. These policcies and proce edures must address the ffollowing: e description of the role off the brokerage in relationn to borrowerrs and lenders and its the dissclosure to bo orrowers and lenders as re equired by thiis Regulation the e verification of the identitty of borrowe ers, lenders aand investors in the circum mstances req quired by thiss Regulation the e determination of the suitability of a mortgage m or i nvestment in n a mortgage for a bo orrower, lende er or investorr, as the case may be the e identificatio on of the matterial risks of a mortgage oor investmentt in a mortgagge for a bo orrower, lende er or investorr, as the case may be, and their disclosu ure to the borrower, lendeer or investor, as the t case may be, as required by this Re gulation e identificatio on of potentiaal conflicts off interest betw ween the bro okerage or anyy broker or the agent authorize ed to deal or trade t in morttgages on its bbehalf and a borrower, len nder or invvestor who is represented by the broke erage, and theeir disclosuree to the borrower, lender o or invvestor, as the case may be e, as required by this Regullation the e provision off incentives other o than mo oney for dealiing or tradingg in mortgagees to its bro okers and age ents by otherr persons and entities, if thhe brokerage permits any of its brokerss or agents to recceive such inccentives e provision off incentives other o than mo oney for dealiing or tradingg in mortgagees to brokers the and agents who o are authorizzed by anothe er brokerage to deal or traade in mortgaages on the oth her brokerage e’s behalf, if the t brokerage e provides inccentives to an ny brokers orr agents of the oth her brokerage e Rec cord Keep ping A brokerage must retain all reco ords as follow ws: reccords that relate to a morttgage or morttgage renewaal agreement, as the case may be, for aat le east six years after the exp piry of the term of the morrtgage or reneewal or otherr expiry of thee mortgage m transaction all records that relate to a pu urchase, sale or trade in a mortgage for at least six yyears after th he traade completio on date or oth her expiry of the transacti on O. Reg. 1888/08, s. 48 ((2) forr at least six years y all other records thatt are requiredd by subsectio on 46 (1) or tthat the bro okerage is oth herwise required to create e or maintain under the Acct. O. Reg. 18 88/08, s. 48 4 (3) Pause forr clarificatiion – Tradee completiion date Regulation 188/08 1 define es the trade completion c daate as the earrlier of: a) the date on o which an investor, or a brokerage onn behalf of an n investor, en nters into an agreement to t trade in the e mortgage, or o b) the date on o which the trade in the mortgage m is ccompleted. e kept at its principal p place e of business in Ontario, iff any, or, if the brokerage reccords must be has notified th he Superinten ndent that it keeps k recordss at other speecified premisses in Ontario o, att those premiises O. Reg. 188/08, 1 s. 48 (4) Re ecords may be e kept electro onically in anyy location as llong as they ccan be retrievved promptlyy, if requested. 116 Chapter 5: Regulation R andd Legislation p a written record of all deeemed trust fu unds that it receives and aall A brokerage is required to keep transaactions relatin ng to the funds as per Reg gulation 188/0 /08 sections 449 ‐ 55. Thesee records musst be recconciled mon nthly and signed by the principal brokerr certifying th hat they are accurate. If there are any shorrtfalls the brokerage must immediately notify FSCO. Within ninetty days of thee end of o the brokeraage’s fiscal year it must pre epare and subbmit an annu ual reconciliattion to FSCO. A brokerage must also: maaintain a mailing address in Ontario thaat is suitable tto permit servvice by registtered mail maaintain an em mail address ensure that only the currentt versions of approved a form ms are used b by its brokerss and agents Rev verse Morrtgages Sectio on 29 of Regu ulation 188/08 8 requires bo orrowers invoolved in a reveerse mortgage to obtain indep pendent legal advice. This section also details d the deefinition of a reverse morttgage under the Reegulation. Com mpliance Review A brokerage is resp ponsible for ensuring e that all completedd mortgage ffiles in a given n transaction are re eviewed to en nsure compliaance with the e Act and Reg ulations. 5.5 The Mo ortgage Agent A License Regullation 409/07 7 deals with who w is suitable e to be a licennsed mortgagge agent (as w well as brokerr) and th he requireme ents for licenssing. Licensess are issued w when approveed, and are th hen renewed everyy two years on n a fixed date e. For examplle, March 31, 2012 and each two year p period thereafter. Licensses for agentss are renewed d as long as the agent sati sfies all of the original liceensing requirrements and if they meet any continuin ng education requirementts that may bee instituted b by FSCO from time to o time. To become a licenssed mortgage e agent an ind dividual mustt: be at least 18 ye ears old be a resident off Canada have a mailing address a in On ntario that is not n a post offfice box and tthat is suitablle to permit serrvices by registered mail be authorized by b a brokerage to deal or trade in mortggages on its b behalf d an approved d education pprogram for m mortgage agents within have successfullly completed wo years beforre he or she applies a for the e license tw A person is deeme ed to have me et the educatiion and expe rience requirrements if thee Superrintendent is satisfied thatt the individuaal has a combbination of ed ducation and experience equivalent to the requirements r s. The individual may also be exempted d from the required educaation and exp perience requirements if he e or she was licensed as a mortgage aggent at any time during d the 24 4 months befo ore applying for f the licensee. R andd Legislation Chapter 5: Regulation 11 17 eemed unsuittable for a license (as will a broker) if: An aggent will be de the e individual’s past conductt affords reassonable grounnds for belief that he or sh he will not deal or trade in morttgages in acco ordance with h the law and with integrityy and honesty e individual iss carrying on activities thatt contravene or will contraavene the MB BLAA or its the Reegulations the e individual has h made a false statement in his or herr application ffor a license Individuals who are remunerate ed for dealingg in mortgagees or trading iin mortgages in Ontario, aas emplo oyees or othe erwise, are re equired to havve either a m ortgage brokker’s or mortggage agent’s licensse. The mortgage m agen nt license allo ows the licenssee to deal orr trade mortggages on behaalf of one licenssed mortgage brokerage in n Ontario, “un nder the supeervision of a m mortgage bro oker” (section n 9, sub bsection 5). The T MBLAA do oes not define what this teerm means in n regards to tthe number o of agentts allowed to be supervised d by a brokerr. However, FFSCO’s mortggage agent Qu ualifying Stand dards (MBQS), a documentt that details the t knowledgge that a morrtgage agent must have to o obtain n a license, in ncludes such items i as application overs ight as well aas other itemss related to the management m of o agents. In addition, in itts webinar, FSSCO clearly sttated that thee desired outco ome of supervvision is the high h standards of ethical coonduct and business practtices and includ des hiring the e right people, establishingg effective po licies and pro ocedures, traiining brokers and agents and mo onitoring brokers and agen nts. Furtherm more, the MB BLAA does nott deem real estate e brokers to be b licensed. With regards to bo orrower disclo osure, the mo ortgage brokeerage is respo onsible for all disclosure obligaations as per the t Act and Regulations. R The T mortgagee agent is ressponsible for following broke erage procedu ures in this re egard. Stan ndards off Practice e The mortgage m agen nt is responsiible for meetiing the Standdards of Practtice outlined in Regulation 187/0 08. These Staandards of Praactice apply equally e to moortgage agentts and are listed below. First and a foremostt, neither a liccensed brokerr nor a licenseed agent mayy do anythingg that jeopardizes the bro okerage’s lice ense. Section ns 4 and 5 of R Regulation 1887/08 restrictt how a brokeer or age ent may be paaid. A brokerr or agent mu ust be paid dirrectly by the brokerage fo or any activityy relate ed to dealing or trading in mortgages. An A exception applies to no on‐monetary incentives, which h may be paid d directly to th he broker or agent. Regarrding advertissing and public relations materials, m a brroker or agent is not allow wed to use anyy other name other than his or he er licensee naame and musst include his or her brokerrage’s name and license numbe ers, prominen ntly displayed d, and if the b rokerage is a franchise, th he materials must clearly indicaate that the brokerage is in ndependentlyy owned and operated. A broker or agentt must also su upply this info ormation to anyone who reequests it. Materials can not contain c false,, misleading or o deceptive iinformation aand only the ttitle “Morttgage Broker,,” “Broker,” “Mortgage “ Aggent” or “Age nt” (or an abbreviation) m may be used. hat a broker or o agent mustt maintain a m mailing addreess suitable fo or Finallyy, the Regulation states th registtered mail, an nd must maintain an email address. 118 5.6 Chapter 5: Regulation and Legislation The Mortgage Broker License Regulation 409/07 addresses who is suitable to be a licensed mortgage agent and the requirements for licensing. As with the mortgage agent license, a licenses is issued when approved, and is then renewed every two years on a fixed date. For example, March 31, 2012 and each two year period thereafter. Licenses are renewed as long as the broker satisfies all of the original licensing requirements and meets any continuing education requirements that may be instituted by FSCO from time to time. Just like an agent, a broker will be deemed unsuitable for a license if: the individual’s past conduct affords reasonable grounds for belief that he or she will not deal or trade in mortgages in accordance with the law and with integrity and honesty the individual is carrying on activities that contravene or will contravene the MBLAA or its Regulations the individual has made a false statement in his or her application for a license To become a licensed mortgage agent an individual must: be at least 18 years old be a resident of Canada have a mailing address in Ontario that is not a post office box and that is suitable to permit services by registered mail be authorized by a brokerage to deal or trade in mortgages on its behalf have successfully completed an approved education program for mortgage agents have been licensed as a mortgage agent for at least 24 of the 36 months immediately before he or she applies for the license have successfully completed an approved education program for mortgage agents and passed the approved qualifying exam within three years before applying for the license A person is deemed to have met the education and experience requirements if the Superintendent is satisfied that the individual has a combination of education and experience equivalent to the requirements. The individual may also be exempted from the required education and experience requirements if he or she was licensed as a mortgage agent at any time during the 24 months before applying for the license. This license allows the licensee to deal or trade mortgages on behalf of only one licensed mortgage brokerage in Ontario. A mortgage agent must work for only one specified brokerage, and that brokerage must be licensed. Just like the agent, a mortgage agent is responsible for adhering to the brokerage’s procedures related to compliance and for adhering to the Standards of Practice already described for mortgage agents. Chapter 5: Regulation and Legislation 5.7 119 The Principal Broker A principal broker is not a separately licensed position, but is a licensed mortgage agent who is designated by the brokerage to be its chief compliance officer. Under the MBLAA, the brokerage is licensed and it must have one licensed mortgage agent designated as the principal broker. This person is responsible for activities as outlined in Regulation 410/07, which defines the role of the principal broker, who is eligible to hold this position and the duties of the principal broker. To be eligible to be the principal broker for a brokerage, the individual must be authorized by the brokerage to deal or trade in mortgages on its behalf and must have the following status in relation to the brokerage: if the brokerage is a corporation, he or she must be a director or officer of the corporation if the brokerage is a partnership, other than a limited partnership, he or she must be a partner if the brokerage is a limited partnership, he or she must be a general partner or a director or officer of a corporation that is a limited partner if the brokerage is a sole proprietorship, he or she must be the sole proprietor The position of principal broker is responsible for ensuring that the brokerage, and all brokers and agents, comply with the requirements of the MBLAA, including ensuring that any contraventions of the Act are dealt with, and that the brokerage has the proper policies and procedures in place to ensure that all brokers and agents are adequately supervised and that they comply with every requirement under the MBLAA. 5.8 The Mortgage Administrator License Those involved in the administration of mortgages as defined in the MBLAA and Regulation 406/07 must have a Mortgage Administrator’s license. The MBLAA itself is vague on what constitutes administering a mortgage; however Regulation 406/07, section 1, subsection 1 states that the activity that constitutes administering mortgages is “taking steps, on behalf of another person or entity, to enforce payment by a borrower under a mortgage.” The requirements for obtaining a Mortgage Administrator’s license are defined in Regulation 411/07, while the obligations to maintain that license are reflected in Regulation 189/08, Mortgage Administrators: Standards of Practice. Corporations, partnerships and sole proprietorships wishing to be licensed as a Mortgage Administrator must meet licensing requirements and must pass tests of suitability as per Regulation 411/07. Mortgage Administrators have exactly the same licensing eligibility requirements as mortgage agents and brokers and must pass the same tests of suitability with only one additional requirement: that the corporation, partnership or sole proprietorship have a financial guarantee in an amount equal to $25,000. This may be unimpaired working capital or something else acceptable to FSCO. Standards of Practice for Mortgage Administrators are stated separately in the Regulations but parallel those of mortgage brokerages. Naturally, the Standards of Practice of a brokerage refer 120 Chapter 5: Regulation and Legislation also to responsibilities related to mortgage agents and mortgage agents. No such references are found in the Regulations for mortgage administrators. 5.9 Summary The MBLAA and its Regulations have significant regulatory oversight of the brokerage industry and require brokerages, brokers and agents to be fully aware of their regulatory responsibilities. The principal broker, a position mandated by legislation, requires unprecedented oversight over a brokerage’s operations. This individual must institute policies and procedures that will ensure compliance with the MBLAA and its Regulations, as well as take corrective measures as necessary to modify non‐compliant policies and procedures. To effectively achieve these tasks requires an in‐depth understanding of the regulatory environment, the MBLAA and its Regulations. 5.10 External Resources Financial Services Commission of Ontario The regulator for the mortgage brokerage industry Website: www.fsco.gov.on.ca E‐laws Database of Ontario’s statutes and regulations Website: www.e‐laws.gov.on.ca Chapter 5: Regulation and Legislation 121 5.11 Key Terms and Definitions Administrative Penalties A penalty assessed by the Superintendent for less serious contraventions of or failures to comply with the MBLAA Authorized Name The name authorized to be used by FSCO. Typically this is the name found on a licensee’s license Borrower The individual responsible for the receipt and repayment of mortgage proceeds Complaint A disagreement or statement of dissatisfaction with a brokerage or Administrator. Both must have policies and procedures in place to deal with complaints. Compliance Conforming to the MBLAA and its Regulations Corporation A legal business entity created under federal or provincial statutes Cost of Borrowing The MBLAA defines the cost of borrowing as “the interest or discount applicable to the mortgage; any amount charged in connection with the mortgage that is payable by the borrower to the brokerage or lender; any amount charged in connection with the mortgage that is payable by the borrower to a person other than the brokerage or lender, where the amount is chargeable, directly or indirectly, by the person to the brokerage or lender, and; any charge prescribed as included in the cost of borrowing, but does not include any charge prescribed as excluded from the cost of borrowing. It must be disclosed as either a percentage or in dollars and cents depending on the disclosure requirements of the Regulations.” Deemed Trust Funds (also see trust funds) Funds that are deemed to be payable to another party. These funds must be kept in a separate trust account. Designated Class of Lenders and Investors A term used to describe specific lenders and investors that may be exempt from certain requirements under Regulation 188/08, section 2.(1) which states, “2. (1) For the purposes of this Regulation, a person or entity is a member of a designated class of lenders and investors if the person or entity is a member of any of the following classes: 1. The Crown in right of Ontario, Canada or any province or territory of Canada. 2. A brokerage acting on its own behalf. 3. A financial institution. 4. A corporation that is a subsidiary of a person or entity described in paragraph 1, 2 or 3. 5. A corporation that is an approved lender under the National Housing Act (Canada). 6. An administrator or trustee of a registered pension plan within the meaning of 122 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. Chapter 5: Regulation and Legislation subsection 248 (1) of the Income Tax Act (Canada). A person or entity who is registered as an adviser or dealer under the Securities Act when the person or entity is acting as a principal or as an agent or trustee for accounts that are fully managed by the person or entity. A person or entity who is registered under securities legislation in another province or territory of Canada with a status comparable to that described in paragraph 7 when the person or entity is acting as a principal or as an agent or trustee for accounts that are fully managed by the person or entity. A person or entity, other than an individual, who has net assets of at least $5 million as reflected in its most recently‐prepared financial statements and who provides written confirmation of this to the brokerage. An individual who, alone or together with his or her spouse, has net assets of at least $5 million and who provides written confirmation of this to the brokerage. An individual who, alone or together with his or her spouse, beneficially owns financial assets (being cash, securities within the meaning of the Securities Act, the cash surrender value of a life insurance contract, a deposit or evidence of a deposit) that have an aggregate realizable value that, before taxes but net of any related liabilities, exceeds $1 million and who provides written confirmation of this to the brokerage. An individual whose net income before taxes in each of the two most recent years exceeded $200,000 or whose net income before taxes in each of those years combined with that of his or her spouse in each of those years exceeded $300,000, who has a reasonable expectation of exceeding the same net income or combined net income, as the case may be, in the current year and who provides written confirmation of this to the brokerage. A person or entity in respect of which all of the owners of interests, other than the owners of voting securities required by law to be owned by directors, are persons or entities described in paragraphs 1 to 12. O. Reg. 188/08, s. 2 (1).” Disclosure The act of making something evident. There are several disclosure requirements mandated by the MBLAA and its Regulations with relation to a mortgage being recommended to a borrower, investor or lender by a brokerage. Disclosure Form A form, prescribed or otherwise, used to provide disclosure to a borrower, lender or investor, as the case may be, in accordance with the MBLAA and its Regulations Errors and Omissions Insurance Insurance that provides coverage for errors or omissions made by a brokerage, broker, agent or Administrator. This insurance must contain a provision for fraud. Financial Guarantee A requirement under the MBLAA in regards to Mortgage Administrators requiring licensees to have at least $25,000 in unimpaired working capital or in another form as approved by FSCO. Financial Services Tribunal An independent, adjudicative body that hears appeals of regulatory decisions by the Superintendent Chapter 5: Regulation and Legislation 123 FSCO The Financial Services Commission of Ontario. This is the regulatory body that oversees the mortgage brokerage industry and enforces the Mortgage Brokerages, lenders and Administrators Act, 2006 (formerly the Mortgage agents Act), as well as several other industries and Acts. Guarantees In regards to the MBLAA, a promise to pay. Guarantees are prohibited under several circumstances including a brokerage, broker, agent or Administrator guaranteeing payment from a borrower to an investor. Investor (also see lender) An individual or entity lending money on the security of a mortgage lender (also see Investor) An individual or entity lending money on the security of a mortgage Licensure Permission granted by an agency of government to an individual to engage in a given profession or occupation Limited Partnership An association of two or more partners formed to conduct a business jointly and in which one or more of the partners is liable only to the extent of the amount of money they have invested MBLAA The abbreviation of The Mortgage Brokerages, lenders and Administrators Act, 2006, the legislation regulating the activities of mortgage brokerages, lenders and Administrators Mortgage Administrator An individual or entity that enforces payments by borrowers on behalf of lenders or investors. Mortgage Administrators must be licensed. Mortgage Agent Individuals who are remunerated for dealing in mortgages or trading in mortgages in Ontario, as employees or otherwise. Mortgage agents are restricted in their abilities by the MBLAA and its Regulations and must be supervised by a licensed Mortgage agent. Mortgage agents must be licensed. Mortgage Broker Individuals who are remunerated for dealing in mortgages or trading in mortgages in Ontario, as employees or otherwise. A mortgage broker may hold the position of principal broker and may supervise licensed mortgage agents. Mortgage brokers must be licensed. Mortgage Brokerage Corporations, partnerships, sole proprietorships and prescribed entities that carry on the business of dealing in mortgages, trading in mortgages or lending money on the security of real property 124 Chapter 5: Regulation and Legislation Partnership A type of business entity in which partners (owners) share with each other the profits or losses of the business undertaking in which all have invested Policies and Procedures A policy is a plan or course of action, while a procedure is a step by step process on how to perform a certain task. Under the MBLAA, brokerages and Administrators must have a set of documents that describe an organization's policies for operation and regulatory compliance, and the procedures necessary to fulfill the policies Principal Broker A title held by the licensed mortgage agent responsible for ensuring that the brokerage, and all brokers and agents comply with the requirements of the MBLAA, including ensuring that any contraventions of the Act are dealt with, and that the brokerage has the proper policies and procedures in place to ensure that all brokers and agents are adequately supervised and that they comply with every requirement under the MBLAA. There may be only one principal broker per brokerage who must be identified to FSCO. Proprietor A sole owner of an unincorporated business, also called a sole proprietor Public Register of Licensees A registry required to be maintained by FSCO that provides access to licensee information Public Relations As defined in Regulation 188/08, any advertisement by the brokerage in connection with its business as a brokerage that is published, circulated or broadcast by any means, or any material that a brokerage makes available to the public in connection with its business as a brokerage. Regulated activities As defined by the MBLAA, any activities that require a license which are currently listed as dealing or trading in mortgages and mortgage lending Simple Referral A term used to describe the act of referring a potential borrower to a potential lender, or vice versa, if the referrer informs the other party, in writing, that a fee will be received for the referral, the nature of the relationship between the parties, and as long as the only other information provided is the name, address, telephone number, fax number, email address or website address of the individual being referred Sole Proprietorship (also see Proprietor) A sole owner of an unincorporated business, also called a proprietor Standards of Practice Regulation 188/08, which applies to mortgage brokerages, Regulation 187/07, which applies to mortgage agents and agents, and Regulation 189/08, which applies to mortgage administrators constitute the Standards of Practice under the MBLAA. These Regulations detail the business rules that licensees must follow to comply with the MBLAA and its Regulations. Chapter 5: Regulation and Legislation 125 Superintendent The Superintendent of Financial Services is a position responsible for issuing and revoking licenses, as well as for enforcing compliance, all of which are designed to protect the public. All FSCO staff report directly or indirectly to the Superintendent. Trade Completion Date Regulation 188/08 defines the trade completion date as the earlier of: a) the date on which an investor, or a brokerage on behalf of an investor, enters into an agreement to trade in the mortgage, or b) the date on which the trade in the mortgage is completed. Trust Account A bank account held by a brokerage or Administrator for the purposes of keeping money held on behalf of clients separate from the funds of the professional or her business Trust Fund (or Account) Reconciliation A written record of all deemed trust funds received and all transactions relating to the funds, summarized and checked for accuracy. Trust Funds (also see deemed trust funds) Funds that are deemed to be payable to another party. These funds must be kept in a separate trust account. Vendor Take‐Back (VTB) Where the seller of the property provides all or some of the financing to the purchaser in order to sell the property. The arranging of a VTB by a real estate salesperson is an exempted activity under the MBLAA as long as certain conditions are met. 126 Chapter 5: Regulation R andd Legislation 5.12 2 Review w Questio ons Answers to the Revview Questio ons are found at www.REM MIC.ca True e or Fals e Questi ons 1. As of January 20 009, a brokerrage must disclose to a bo rrower if onee of its agentss will receive a fee e from a lender in connecttion with the mortgage rennewal. orrowers are entitled e to the following in nformation, oonly if they assk: brokeragee name and 2. Bo lice ense numberr. 3. It is a good ideaa for a brokerage to have a complaints process but tthis is not req quired by law.. 4. The Superintendent of FSCO O has the auth hority to refusse to grant a license to a b brokerage if the e Superintend dent thinks th he name migh ht confuse th e public with h another exissting bro okerage. 5. A sole s proprieto orship must establish e its eligibility for li censure as a mortgage bro okerage wh hereas a corporation does not. 6. Un nder certain circumstances c s, the Superin ntendent of F SCO may suspend a brokeer’s license witthout warning. o changes may be made to o the Regulatiions without ggoing through the formal process of 7. No recceiving Royal Assent. 8. The Financial Se ervices Comm mission is onlyy concerned w with one secttor, the mortggage bro okerage industry. 9. Staandards of Prractice are guiding principles that busin esses are enccouraged to implement. 10. Regulatory deccisions by the e Superintend dent of FSCO are final, based on the powers conferred upon n the position. 11. As per the MBLAA, there arre currently th hree differen t licenses in tthe mortgagee brokerage ind dustry. 12. Th he Superinten ndent of FSCO O (or his/her designate) m may visit a bro okerage within the FSCO reggistry to exam mine documents and recorrds. 13. Th he principal broker b designation was cre eated by the M MBLAA to address compliance issues witthin the brokkerage. he role of the e brokerage may m be define ed as “taking steps, on beh half of anotheer person or 14. Th entity, to enforce payment by b a borrower under a mo rtgage.” 15. A mortgage aggent may worrk only for one e brokerage w whereas a mo ortgage agent may be em mployed by se everal brokeraages at the saame time. Chapter 5: Regulation R andd Legislation 12 27 Sho ort Answe er Questio ons 1. Wh hat are the ed ducational requirements to t obtain a m ortgage agen nt’s license? 2. Wh hat is/are the e difference(ss) between a mortgage m ageent and mortgage broker?? 3. De escribe the du uties and resp ponsibilities of o the principaal broker. 4. Wh hat administrrative penalties may be im mposed on a bbrokerage, bro oker or agentt? 5. Wh hat is the diffference betwe een an offencce under the MBLAA and aan administraative penalty?? dual would bee deemed unssuitable to bee granted a 6. Lisst the circumsstances in which an individ mortgage m brokker’s license. 7. De escribe the co omplaints poliicy that a bro okerage must have to comply with the M MBLAA and itts Regulations. 8. Wh hat information must be in ncluded in evvery public rellations item?? 9. Lisst the items th hat must be disclosed d to a borrower in a disclosure d document. 10. What W amount of errors and d omissions in nsurance musst a brokeragee have to com mply with thee MBLAA? M 11. What W is the am mount of time e that recordss of a mortgagge transactio on are requireed to be kept byy the brokeraage? 12. What W types of funds must be b deposited into a trust a ccount? 13. What W informattion must be provided to a potential prrivate lender before he or she can co ommit to funding a mortgage? 14. What W titles (i.e e., broker, age ent, etc.) musst/can be useed by brokers and agents in n advertising materials? m 128 Chapter 5: Regulation and Legislation Appendix 1: FSCO Organization Chart as of November 23, 2015 Figure 17 – FSCO Organization Chart as of November 23, 20152 2 http://fsco.gov.on.ca/en/about/Documents/2015‐orgchart‐nov23.pdf Chapter 6: Transaction Overview 129 Chapter 6: Transaction Overview Learning Outcomes Successful understanding of the concepts presented in this chapter will enable the learner to: Explain who the clients are in a brokered transaction Discuss the role of the agent as advisor Explain the expectations that are made by the borrower and lender Summarize the steps in a brokered transaction Introduction Brokering a mortgage in Ontario can be both financially and personally rewarding, when done properly. The mortgage agent will obtain the appreciation of the borrower and receive handsome remuneration at the completion of the transaction. However, like any profession, ours has a set of standard procedures that must be followed to achieve successful completion of a transaction. This chapter will discuss the mortgage agent’s role in the process and the basic steps in the transaction. Regardless of whether you are a licensed mortgage agent or licensed mortgage agent, the process of brokering a mortgage is the same. 6.1 Who is the Client? Brokering a mortgage transaction involves several key participants in the mortgage industry. Before the process of brokering a mortgage transaction can be examined, it is important to answer a basic question: Who is the client? Let us begin answering this question by revisiting the definition of a mortgage agent as discussed previously. Mortgage agent / Agent A practicing professional who assesses a borrower’s financial goals with respect to real estate financing and after detailed analysis provides solutions to meet those goals by acting as an intermediary with the appropriate lending source. In determining the “appropriate lending source,” two facts are assumed: one, that the client is appropriate for the lender and two, that the lender is appropriate for the client. Therefore, by this definition a mortgage agent has two clients: the borrower and the lender. Let’s explore this further by describing in more detail why the lender and borrower are both clients. Borrower A mortgage agent finds the appropriate lender for his or her borrower; therefore the borrower is obviously a client. Mortgage agents promote that they will obtain the best mortgage for a borrower, implying that they work for the borrower. While in some cases a mortgage agent will charge a fee directly to the borrower, in the vast majority of cases agents are compensated by 130 Chapter 6: Transaction Overview ender in the fo orm of a finde er’s fee or commission. Thhis could poteentially resultt in a the le mortggage agent ge etting a borro ower a mortgaage with a lennder becausee the lender p pays a higher finderr’s fee and no ot because it is i in the best interests of tthe borrower. If, how wever, the mortgage agen nt follows the definition off a mortgage aagent illustraated above ass well as a adheres to the four borrrower expectations in the section entittled, “The Role of the Mortggage Agent ass Advisor,” th he mortgage agent a will unddoubtedly actt in the best iinterests of the bo orrower in alll cases. Lende er or his or her borrower, thee Once a mortgage agent a has deccided on the most m approprriate lender fo nes. In otherr words, the agentt must ensure e that the borrrower meetss all of the lennder’s guidelin agentt must ensure e that the borrrower is apprropriate for t hat lender. TTherefore, sin nce the agentt has a duty to the le ender, the len nder is also th he client, wheether or not tthe lender is p paying the agentt a finder’s fee e or commisssion, or the aggent is chargi ng a fee direcctly to the bo orrower. 6.2 The Ro ole of the Mortgag ge Agent a as Adviso or Why do d lenders de eal with mortgage agents?? m think th hat since the mortgage m age ent finds the bborrower, thee lender doessn’t have to You might pay th he costs assocciated with obtaining that borrower, suuch as advertising and marketing, having branch officces, etc., and therefore de ealing with moortgage agen nts is more profitable for a lende er. While thatt is certainly the t case, it is only true wh en mortgage agents meett the following set off basic expecttations. If a broker b fails to meet these eexpectations,, then the len nder will mostt likely stop dealing with that bro oker since the e brokered traansactions wiill become un nprofitable. Len der Expe ectations These e expectations can be summarized as: 1. Provide borrrowers who are suitable for f the lenderr 2. Provide app propriate protection again nst fraud 3. Facilitate th he transaction n to its successsful complettion (funding)). These e three expectations form the cornersto one of the rellationship bettween the len nder and the broke erage community. The best way to en nsure that the ese expectations are consiistently met is to adopt them as core values or philosophies that are applied to evvery transacti on. To me eet these exp pectations the ey must first be b explained.. 1. Pro oviding borro owers that are e suitable forr the lender The le ender’s first expectation e iss that the morrtgage agent will only send d an application on behalff of a borrower b thatt fits the lende er’s lending criteria. c Lendding criteria in nclude such th hings as incom me and emplo oyment requirrements, property requireements, credit requiremen nts and so on.. This means m that th he mortgage agent a must kn now and und erstand the leender’s lending criteria and be b able to accurately assess the borrower to determ ine if they meeet those critteria. Chapter 6: Transaction Overview 13 31 t some moortgage agen nts send them m applicationss Unforrtunately, a tyypical lender complaint is that for prroducts that they t do not have. This typ pe of error cann erode the cconfidence that lenders have in the brokerrage commun nity. 2. Pro oviding appro opriate prote ection againstt fraud Lende ers have been n suffering fro om an increasse in mortgagge fraud over the past seveeral years. Although not techn nically a morttgage agent’ss legal responnsibility, it is a mortgage aggent’s ethical and moral m responssibility to makke reasonable e attempts too protect the llender from ffraud. In many brokerage es’ set of Bestt Practices it is deemed neecessary for th he mortgage agent to review w all documentation receivved from the borrower fo r accuracy an nd consistency. This mean ns identiifying any sign ns of potentiaal fraud, such h as poorly wrritten or typeed income verrification as well as a verifying income and ide entity. More information on fraud prevvention can be b found in thhe chapter, M Mortgage Frau ud. 3. Facilitating the transaction to t its successsful completio on A lend der expects th hat a mortgagge agent has submitted ann application to that lendeer because hee or she e has determined that lend der to be the most approppriate for the borrower. In n addition, the lende er expects thaat, if approved d, the mortgaage transactioon will close. That requirees the mortggage agent to o ensure that the borrower is committeed to completting the transsaction and underrstands what is required of him or her to t conclude itt. der also expects that a mo ortgage agentt will be availaable to assist in ensuring tthe transactio on A lend closess if there is an nything that the t mortgage e agent is requuired to accomplish such aas meeting outstaanding condittions. m agen nt’s other clie ent, the borro ower, also be gins by havin ng a set of exp pectations in The mortgage regard ds to the morrtgage agent. Borrrower Ex pectation ns These e expectations can be summarized as: 1. Act in the borrower’s b be est interests 2. Completelyy analyze the borrower’s needs 3. Make appro opriate recom mmendations based on thee borrower’s needs 4. Facilitate th he transaction n to its successsful complettion (funding)). These e four expectaations form th he cornerston ne of the trannsaction. By eensuring thatt these expecctations are met, m the morttgage agent will w develop a strong relatio onship with tthe borrower and ensure that th he industry ass a whole is well w representted. The best way to en nsure that the ese expectations are consiistently met is to adopt them as core values or philosophies that are applied to evvery transacti on. To me eet these exp pectations the ey must first be b explained.. 132 Chapter 6: Transaction Overview 1. Act in the borrower’s best interests The borrower’s first expectation is that the mortgage agent will at all times act in the best interests of the borrower. This expectation is key to the borrower and is vital to the success of the transaction. Acting in the best interests of the borrower can best be defined as putting the borrower’s needs and concerns first and foremost above others involved in the transaction, limited only by ethical, moral and legal restrictions. This has the effect of ensuring that the mortgage obtained for the borrower is both financially best for them and suits their other needs and goals, such as providing prepayment privileges that the client believes are important to them, a term that that best reflects their goals, and so on. The philosophy of always doing what is best for the client differs from always doing what is suitable for the client. For example, mortgage agents have made the case that if a borrower has poor credit they may deserve a mortgage; however they may not deserve the best rates. Example Brian was referred to a mortgage agent, Cynthia, by a past client who felt that Cynthia had provided excellent service and advice. Brian has explained to Cynthia that he has had credit problems in the recent past. After taking Brian’s application and performing the required analysis, Cynthia has determined that she can obtain a mortgage for Brian from two different sources. The first source will offer Brian a 5‐year fixed rate mortgage with a rate of 6.5% compounded semi‐annually over a 25 year amortization with monthly payments. The finder’s fee to Cynthia would be 50 bps. The second source will offer Brian a 5‐year fixed rate mortgage with a rate of 6.55% (.05% higher than the first option) compounded semi‐annually over a 25 year amortization with monthly payments. The finder’s fee to Cynthia would be 75 bps. All other terms and conditions of these two mortgage options are the same. Cynthia now has a decision to make. Which option does she offer to Brian? Cynthia may consider that for only a .05% increase in the rate she will earn an extra $500 compared to the lower rate option. She may further believe that Brian will accept either suggestion that she makes since he was referred to her and has full trust in her. What option should she provide to Brian? Hopefully the decision is clear. Cynthia should offer Brian the lower rate mortgage even though the finder’s fee she earns will be less because her interests must come second to Brian’s. That is the core belief behind always acting in the borrower’s best interests. This was a fairly simple, straight forward example but it is important to point out that there are many products in the mortgage market today that will pay the mortgage agent a higher finder’s fee if he or she is able to sell their client a higher rate. By subscribing to the philosophy that a mortgage agent must always do what is in the best interests of the borrower the solution is always obvious. Chapter 6: Transaction Overview 13 33 Su uccess Tip – Act in th he best inteerests of th he client Byy always doingg what is in th he best intere est of the clieent, you will fiind that your referral bu usiness increaases over time e. Even thouggh you may m make less mo ney on a singgle traansaction, you will grow yo our business through t wordd of mouth reeferrals, resulting in inccreased earniings in the futture. A practical reason foor doing the rright thing! ompletely ana alyze the borrower’s need ds 2. Co Takingg a mortgage e application and a finding th he right lendeer and producct for the borrrower is not possib ble unless the e mortgage aggent has detaailed knowleddge of a borro ower’s needs. This is different from simply asking the e borrower what w type of m mortgage theyy would like. To completely analyze a borrow wer’s needs re equires that tthe mortgagee agent assist the borroweer in dettermining what those need ds are. That is i an importa nt distinction n from simplyy having the borro ower express what w they be elieve their ne eeds to be to the mortgagee agent. The mortgage m agen nt must deterrmine the oth her factors thhat are importtant to the bo orrower. Some e of these facttors will include: The borrower’s risk tolerancce. This can determine d whhether a variaable rate prod duct is suitable er. forr the borrowe The borrower’s intentions with w regards to o how long thhey intend to live in this ho ome. This can ether a long or o short term mortgage is suitable. determine whe her words, dooes the borrow wer think theey may need The borrower’s debt expectaations. In oth to take equity out o of their prroperty in the e future by reefinancing it? This can determine wh hether a close ed or open mortgage is suiitable. The borrower’s saving habitss. This can de etermine wheether the borrrower requirres more agggressive prep payment privileges. Su uccess Tip – Service is i the key Diffferentiate yo ourself from your y competition by providding more seervice. Part off this service maay include a full f financial check‐up. c Havve you heardd of agents co ompleting bud dgets for their bo orrowers? Pro obably not, and if you had you would m most likely rem member them m. That is tru uly a differenttiator! 3. Ma ake appropriate recomme endations based on the bo orrower’s neeeds If the mortgage aggent embraces the above philosophies p tthen this borrrower expecttation is a natural extension. By completing a full analyysis of their nneeds and beiing determineed to do whaat is in their best inte erests, the mo ortgage agentt will make thhe appropriatte recommendation, provid ded that theyy have the req quisite knowledge to dete rmine what tthat recommeendation should be. This means m that, to o be able to make m an apprropriate recom mmendation based on thee borrower’s needss, the mortgage agent musst be fully verrsed on all of the lenders aavailable and their produ ucts. Not only does the mortgage age ent have to be b aware of p roducts available to them,, but they must also take reasonable steps to be aware e of products offered through lenders n not dealing 134 Chapter 6: Transaction Overview t mortgage e brokerage in ndustry. This may include major banks or any otherr lender. Thiss with the is a crritical point be ecause a morrtgage agent cannot makee an appropriaate recommeendation if they are a unaware of all of the mortgage m products availabble to the borrower. Takingg reasonable steps to ensu ure that the mortgage m ageent has this in nformation may seem like an overwhelming task, t but it sim mply refers to o ensuring thaat the mortgaage agent kno ows productss to wh hich the borro ower should have h reasonable access. Su uccess Tip – Stay up to date on n lender’s p products Re eview lender marketing m maaterials and communicatioons daily to ensure that yo ou have the mo ost up to date e information n on lenders’ products andd attend tradee shows and llender presentations whenever w posssible. By doiing so you wi ll be able to cconfidently reecommend e borrower. products to the For in nstance, if the ere is a small credit c union that t doesn’t ddeal with mortgage agentss and only servicces a small, lo ocal communiity that has ju ust lowered thheir rates for the next two o weeks, a mortggage agent might not be aware of this. Nor could thhey be expectted to be awaare of this. b that does not deal witth brokers haas done the saame, the If, on the other hand, a major bank mortggage agent sh hould be aware of this. In this manner he or she can n provide whaat they truly believve to be the most m appropriate recommendation to tthe borrower. 4. Facilitate the trransaction to o successful co ompletion A borrower further expects, and d has the righ ht to expect t hat the mortgage agent w will facilitate the trransaction to a successful completion. In other wordds, the mortggage agent wiill be by theirr c side until u the transsaction closess. Succe essful mortgagge agents will advise the client c of all off the steps in tthe transactio on and stay in n touch h with them th hroughout, evven when the e mortgage aggent is no lon nger involved d. For example, once he or she has fulfilled the lender’s conditioons there is n nothing else ffor the mortggage agent to o do except wait w for the traansaction to cclose. ever, successfful mortgage agents will fo ollow up with the borroweer to ensure that required Howe appoiintments have been sched duled and preparations havve been made. Not only w will this provid de the borrow wer with adde ed security an nd peace of m mind but will ensure that tthe mortgagee agentt is aware of any a issues thaat arise, allow wing him or heer to assist in solving the isssue before the trransaction is jeopardized. Conclusion Some e of the conce epts discussed d in this sectio on may, uponn closer exam mination of the brokerage industry, seem to go g beyond wh hat many mo ortgage agentts deem necesssary. Howevver, by going beyon nd what mostt are doing, a mortgage aggent is destineed to differen ntiate themseelves from their competition and a exceed th heir clients’ expectations. e That is truly the paath to successs in this indusstry. Chapter 6: Transaction Overview 13 35 Su uccess Tip – Adopt th he four borrrower exp pectationss Ad dopt the four borrower exp pectations ass your four Coore Values or Philosophies and write the em down. Ke eep them with you at all times and makke certain thaat your clientss know that yo ou subscribe to them. In so o doing you will w exceed yoour clients’ exxpectations in n virtually evvery transactio on. 6.3 The Step ps in a Brrokered Transacti T ion A brokered mortgaage transactio on has a set of o typical stepps. We’ll begiin by listing th hem and then n describe each one individually. 1. Attracting a client 2. First contacct 3. The initial consultation c 4. File creation and management 5. Application analysis: Borrower incom me and GDS/TTDS ratios 6. Application analysis: Borrower Creditt 7. Application analysis: The property an nd LTV ratio ( includes ordeering an apprraisal if applicable) 8. Choosing a lender 9. Submitting the applicatio on 10. Obtaining the commitme ent 11. Preparing disclosure d doccuments 12. Presenting the commitm ment and disclosure docum ments 13. Meeting conditions 14. Instructing the lawyer 15. The lawyer//client meetin ng 16. Funding the e transaction 17. File submisssion to the brrokerage 18. Receiving commissions 19. Record keeping The fo ollowing is a description d off each of thesse steps. 1. Atttracting a Client Attraccting a client refers to any activity that results in a m mortgage agent obtaining a potential borro ower. This can n be achieved d by marketin ng, advertisingg, or referral.. 2. Firrst Contact This iss the first time that the po otential borro ower and the mortgage ageent have conttact, be it on the ph hone, through email or facce to face. 3. Th he Initial Conssultation The In nitial Consultaation is the sttep in which the t agent com mpletes the b borrower’s ap pplication and d determines the ne eeds of the bo orrower. At this stage the agent has no ot completed a detailed analysis to determine the optio ons available to t the borrow wer but has a firm understtanding of what the borrower wishes to acccomplish. 136 Chapter 6: Transaction Overview e Creation an nd Manageme ent 4. File The mortgage m agen nt creates the e borrower’s file, typically in both papeer format and d using his or her orrigination sofftware. Pa ause for cla arification n‐ Originattion softwa are Orrigination Sofftware is the computer pro ogram which the mortgagge agent uses to input the bo orrower’s app plication. Thiss software is designed d to ccalculate requ uired ratios, p pull a credit bu ureau report, electronicallyy submit the application a too a lender, ass well as provide other fun nctions for th he mortgage agent. a 5. Ap pplication Anaalysis: Borrow wer Income and GDS/TDS Ratios The mortgage m agen nt analyses th he borrower’ss income to ddetermine thee amount of tthe mortgagee for wh hich the borrower can quaalify based on n the availablee borrower d documentatio on and the incom me ratios, the GDS and TDSS, both of whiich are explaiined in detail in a later chaapter. 6. Ap pplication Anaalysis: Borrow wer Credit The mortgage m agen nt will obtain a credit repo ort using his oor her origination softwaree. The industry jargon forr this is referrred to as “pulling a credit rreport”. The mortgage agent will then analyze it. This analysis will dettermine which lenders maay approve the application. 7. Ap pplication Anaalysis: The Prroperty and LTTV Ratio The mortgage m agen nt begins a prreliminary analysis of the pproperty to d determine wh hich lender wiill accep pt this propertty type and th he maximum loan amountt that can be approved based on the value of the prope erty, referred to as the loan n to value or LTV. The LTV V is explained d in detail in a later chapter. c Dep pending on th he type of the e transaction, an appraisal (a valuation of the prope erty to be mortgaged) mayy be required. Pa ause for cla arification n ‐ Appraisal An n appraisal is a report creaated by a certified appraiseer (the individ dual conductiing the ap ppraisal) to de etermine a do ollar value of the property and describee its condition n. der 8. Choosing a lend Based d on the analyysis complete ed so far, the mortgage ageent will now decide on an appropriate lende er to which to submit the application. a The T mortgagee agent requirres significantt knowledge regard ding the num merous lenderrs’ guidelines to determinee the approprriate lender fo or the borro ower. 9. Submitting the Application Usingg the Originatiion Software,, the mortgagge agent electtronically sub bmits the app plication. If the le ender cannot accept electrronic submisssions, the morrtgage agent may be required to print the ap pplication using the Origin nation Software and fax it tto the lenderr. There is no o legal requirrement on ho ow an applicaation is submiitted to a lendder. It is soleely up to the lender on how w it will accept a mortgage application: by emaail, fax, paperr format or electronically vvia the origin nation software. Chapter 6: Transaction Overview 13 37 O the Commitmentt 10. Obtaining If app proved, the lender will send the mortgaage agent a coommitment leetter. A commitment letterr is an offer from the lende er to the borrower to fundd the mortgagge based on the borrower’’s abilityy to meet certain condition ns that are lissted in the coommitment leetter. 11. Preparing Discclosure Docum ments In eve ery brokered transaction in n Ontario, the e mortgage a gent must prrovide the borrower with a borro ower disclosurre. This docu ument discloses the terms of the mortggage as well as the associated costs in nvolved in it being b obtained. Typically tthis documen nt is produced d by the Origin nation Softwaare based on the t lender’s commitment c letter in addition to otherr information from the borrowerr’s application n. 12. Presenting the e Commitmen nt and Disclossure Documennts The mortgage letter, borro m agen nt must then present the commitment c ower disclosurre, and an amorttization sched dule to the bo orrower for signing. The m mortgage ageent must leavee a copy of both the t amortizattion schedule e and signed borrower b discclosure with tthe borrowerr. Once comp plete, the sign ned commitment letter is sent s by the m mortgage agen nt to the lend der. Pa ause for cla arification n – Amortizzation scheedule An n amortization schedule iss a printout off all of the moortgage paym ments during tthe term, inccluding the am mount of inte erest and prin ncipal per payyment and the outstandingg mortgage baalance after eaach payment is made. 13. Meeting M Conditions In the e lender’s com mmitment letter there will be a list of coonditions thaat must be meet before the mortggage can be funded. One of o the many conditions c maay be to provvide the lendeer with appro opriate incom me verification n. The commitment letterr will typicallyy describe what docum mentation is considered c accceptable to the t lender. Itt is up to the mortgage agent to advisee the bo orrower of th he conditions and assist the borrower inn meeting thee conditions tto ensure thaat the mortgage m is funded. nstructing the e Lawyer 14. In Once satisfied thatt all of the conditions have e been met, t he lender willl send instrucctions to the lawye er who is closing the transaaction on beh half of the lennder. Certain lenders will d dictate the lawye er who will be e used to close the transacction while otthers will allow w the borrow wer to choosee his orr her own law wyer. It is imp portant to notte that while tthe borrowerr pays the law wyer’s fee, the lawye er is actually working w primaarily on behalf of the lend er. 15. Th he Lawyer/Bo orrower Meetting The laawyer will con ntact the borrower and arrange for an appointmentt for the borro ower to sign the closing documents at the laawyer’s office e. The lawyerr will also info orm the borro ower of the ments require ed to be brou ught with the borrower to this meeting. Once the laawyer has docum comp pleted the app propriate taskks, funds will be requestedd from the len nder for depo osit into the lawye er’s trust acco ount. 138 Chapter 6: Transaction Overview 16. Funding the Transaction Once the lawyer has completed the appropriate tasks, the mortgage will be registered and the funds will be disbursed by the lawyer from the lawyer’s trust account. 17. File Submission to the Brokerage Before an agent will receive his or her commission the completed mortgage file must be submitted to the brokerage for a compliance review. This will ensure that the transaction complied with applicable legislation and that all appropriate documents are in the file. The brokerage will then store this file. Based on legislation the regulator has the right to inspect these files for compliance. 18. Receiving Commissions Upon receipt of the required documentation from the lawyer indicating that the transaction has been successfully funded, the lender will forward the finder’s fee or commission to the brokerage. In the case where there is no finder’s fee, the mortgage agent will have charged the borrower a fee for arranging the mortgage. This fee is typically taken from the mortgage advance on closing and is sent to the mortgage agent’s brokerage by the lawyer. The mortgage agent’s brokerage will then pay the mortgage agent the finder’s fee based on the contract that the mortgage agent has with the brokerage. 19. Record Keeping By Regulation the brokerage is required to keep certain documentation on file for a set number of years. These files may be periodically audited by FSCO. It’s also a good practice for the agent to make electronic copies of the file documents and keep them securely stored in case needed in the future. Chapter 6: Transaction Overview 6.4 139 Key Terms and Definitions Advertising A paid, controlled message through a non‐personal medium. Types of advertising include publicity, public relations, product placement, sponsorship, and sales promotion. Advisor An expert who provides objective advice. A mortgage agent, for example, acts as an advisor to a borrower. Application A form used to record information about a potential borrower’s state of affairs, including financial, credit and employment Budget An estimate of income and spending Commission (from a lender) A commission or fee paid to a mortgage brokerage by a lender. This fee is usually based on a certain number of basis points multiplied by the mortgage amount. Commission (from a brokerage) The amount paid to the broker or mortgage agent who completed the transaction. This is typically based on a percentage of the commission or finder’s fee paid by the lender to the mortgage brokerage. Commitment Letter A document illustrating an offer by a lender to a borrower, including the terms and conditions of that offer Conditions (relating to a Commitment Letter) These are the requirements of the lender that must be met before the mortgage will be funded Disclosure Documents These are the documents prescribed under the Mortgage Brokerages, lenders and Administrators Act, 2006 (formerly the Mortgage Brokers Act) that must be provided to the borrower (and the investor in the case of a private transaction) before the mortgage can be funded. These documents include the Investor / Lender Disclosure for Brokered Transactions, the Investor / Lender Disclosure Statement for Brokered Mortgages on Renewal, and the borrower disclosure. Finder’s Fee A commission or fee paid to a mortgage brokerage by a lender. This fee is usually based on a certain number of basis points multiplied by the mortgage amount. Marketing Presenting products or services to potential customers in a fashion that positively promotes the product or service and makes customers eager to buy or use those products or services 140 Chapter 6: Transaction Overview Referral A client or customer who has been advised by a third party to use the product or service of another Remuneration A payment or reward provided to someone for a product or service rendered Chapter 6: Transaction Overview 6.5 Review w Questio ons Answers to the Revview Questio ons are found at www.REM MIC.ca Sho ort Answe er Questio ons 1. Disscuss the expectations thaat lenders make regarding their businesss dealings wiith a mortgage agen nt. 2. Disscuss the expectations thaat borrowers make regardiing their expeectations of a mortgage agent. 3. If a finder’s fee is 85 bps, how w much would a lender paay the mortgaage brokeragge on a $350,000 mortggage transacttion? 4. Disscuss the positives and neggatives of cre eating a budg et for the borrrower. 5. Wh hat step(s) in the mortgage transaction n do you feel is/are the mo ost importantt and why? 14 41 142 Chapter 7: Insuraance in the M Mortgage Indu ustry Chapter C r 7: Insu urance in the Mortggage Inddustry Lea arning Outccomes Succcessful undersstanding of th he concepts presented p in tthis chapter w will enable the learner to: Explain the purpose and beenefits of morrtgage defaul t insurance Discuss D the hisstory of CMHC and the introduction of mortgage default insurance in Canada Describe D the current c prograams offered by b default inssurers Discuss D the be enefits of morrtgage credito or and life inssurance Describe D the differences d be etween mortggage creditorr life insurance and term liffe insurance Discuss D the be enefits of and need for pro operty insurannce Discuss D the be enefits of title e insurance Describe D the covered c and excluded e riskss of title insurrance Explain the purpose and beenefits of erroors and omisssions insurancce Intro oduction Insuraance and the mortgage ind dustry have never n had as ssignificant a rrelationship aas they do in todayy’s mortgage market. Lend ders are prote ected by defaault and title iinsurance wh hile borrowers are prrotected by creditor/life in nsurance as well w as properrty and title in nsurance. Mo ortgage agentts, brokers and brokeragess find their prrotection in e rrors and omissions insuraance. While e the several types t of insurrance provide e far differentt coverage for their respecctive policyyholders, it is a truism thatt insurance is providing siggnificant protection for a cchanging marke et, especially from the van ntage point off the mortgagge borrower w who is more p prone to mortggage fraud than ever beforre. This chapter c will exxplore the various forms of o insurance aavailable and their impact on the multi‐‐ billion n dollar Canad dian mortgagge industry. 7.1 Mortga age Defau ult Insurance Wha at is Morttgage De efault Ins urance? Mortggage default insurance i is an a insurance policy p betweeen the insureer and the len nder that will comp pensate the le ender for losses suffered on an insured loan. It’s im mportant to note that mortggage default insurance i doe es not compe ensate the boorrower. Bac kground The Central C Mortgage and Houssing Corporattion, a Crownn Corporation n now known as Canada Mortggage and Hou using Corporaation (CMHC) through the National Houusing Act, 195 54 (NHA, 1954)) established mortgage deffault insurancce in Canada in 1954. Thee overriding goal of the NHA, 1954 was to increase the supply of mo ortgage funds available in tthe mortgagee market, becau use, as of the end of the se econd world war, w there waas a significan nt increase in family formaation and imm migration and d therefore th he need for neew housing. Previous legislation that attem mpted to meet this need was w found to be b insufficientt and in need d of reform. Chapter 7: Insuraance in the M Mortgage Indu ustry 14 43 e that CMHC created for default insura nce is still in use today. The basic structure In 196 63, the Mortggage Insurancce Company of o Canada (M ICC), a private insurer, enttered the Canad dian market. The industryy continued its expansion i n 1973 with tthe formation n of two otheer comp panies that evventually merged in 1978 to t form the Innsmor Mortgaage Insurancee Company. 1981 saw the mergger of Insmorr and MICC, with w the new ccompany retaaining the MIICC name. GEE Capitaal Mortgage Insurance Can nada entered d the default iinsurance maarket in 1995 and in so doingg acquired the e mortgage in nsurance porttfolio of MICCC, leaving the market with two insurerss: CMHC C and GE Capital Mortgage e Insurance Canada, later rreferred to ass GEMIC. In 2 2005 GEMIC underrwent structu ural changes and a was renamed Genworrth Financial M Mortgage Insurance Comp pany of Canad da, commonlyy referred to as simply Gennworth. As of 2006, CMHC dominated th he mortgage default insurrance market,, owning approximately 70% of o it compared to 30% by Genworth G Fin nancial. Also in 2006 the A AIG United Gu uaranty Mortggage Insurancce Company Canada, C comm monly referreed to as simply AIG, the largest generall insuraance company in the Unite ed States, enttered the Cannadian markeet. On April 16, 2010, a Canad dian private in nvestor group p, comprised of the Ontar io Teachers’ PPension Plan and Nationall Mortggage Guarantty Holdings In nc., acquired AIG A United G uaranty Morttgage Insuran nce Companyy Canad da. This transaction create ed the only 10 00% Canadiann‐owned private mortgagee insurance comp pany, known as a Canada Guaranty Mortggage Insurancce Company ((“Canada Guaaranty”) How w Mortgag ge Defau ult Insura nce Workks As pre eviously state ed, mortgage default insurrance is a poliicy between tthe insurancee company, CMHC C, Genworth or o Canada Gu uaranty, and the t lender. Itt is designed tto compensate the lenderr if the lender sufferrs a loss on an n insured mortgage. The i nsurance com mpany chargees the mortggage default insurance i pre emium to the lender. How wever, the len nder typically passes that premium on to the e borrower. Normally N the lender will addd the premium to the tottal loan amou unt and the bo orrower will pay p it back to o the lender oover the life of the mortgagge, however the bo orrower could d also pay thaat amount in cash to the leender. This n normally doessn’t happen since the borrower is using all of o their funds for the downn payment. If the borrower goes into defau ult (normally by b failing to m make his or heer mortgage payment), the lende er must underrtake steps to o collect the defaulted d payyments. If thee lender fails to collect these payments an nd has to pow wer of sale the e property, o ne of two outcomes will o occur. One possib ble outcome is if the lende er sells the ho ouse for moree than is owin ng to it. In this scenario it must give that profit to the hom meowner. The homeowneer and the len nder are then n done with one another. The other possible e outcome is if the lender sells s the housse for less thaan is owing to o it. In this scenaario the lende er suffers a losss. Since the mortgage is ddefault insureed, the lendeer can now make a claim to the insurance company c to recover that looss. The insu urance compaany then payss ender and the erefore the lender has no longer suffereed a loss. In rreturn for payying the claim m, the le the le ender assigns any debts paayable to it byy the borroweer to the insurer. In other words, the mone ey that the len nder was owe ed by the borrower is now w owed to thee insurance co ompany. Thee insure er may then take t legal actiion against th he borrower tto recover thee claim that itt paid to the lende er. If you everr happen to see CMHC, Ge enworth or Caanada Guaran nty as a creditor in a bankrruptcy procee eding or a con nsumer propo osal, it is mosst likely becau use of this typ pe of situation n. 144 Chapter 7: Insuraance in the M Mortgage Indu ustry nder Beneffits to the len Allow ws the lender to t make loans in excess off 80% loan to value and recover insured d losses by makin ng a claim to the t insurer. Beneffits to the borrower Allow ws the borrow wer to receive a high ratio mortgage m witth favourable terms and a favourable intere est rate. Prog grams Please Note: Regu ulatory changges enacted in n July, 2012 hhave reduced the maximum m LTV of refinaances to 80%,, the maximum amortizatio on to 25 yearrs, the maxim mum GDS to 39% and the maxim mum TDS to 44%. 4 The following section ns on CMHC, Genworth an nd Canada Gu uaranty detail their current defau ult insurance programs avaailable througgh today’s len nders. While offered by these insurers, nott all lenders offer o these inssured produccts. It is alwayys up to the leender if it wishe es to offer an insured product. The info ormation provvided below iis directly from the respective insurer.. CMH HC The fo ollowing figurre illustrates the t standard CMHC premiiums and is provided as saample inform mation only. Information is subject to change. c Speccific product iinformation ccan be found at ww ww.cmhc.ca Figure 18 – CMHC Prem miums as of Jan nuary, 20161 Pre emium on To otal Loan Prem mium on Incrrease to Loaan Am mount for Port or Refi Up to o and includiing 65% 0.60% 0.6% % Up to o and includiing 75% 0.75% 2.6% % Up to o and includiing 80% 1.25% 3.15% % Up to o and includiing 85% 1.80% 4.00% % Up to o and includiing 90% 2.40% 4.90% % Up to o and includiing 95% 3.15% 5.65% % 90.01 1% to 95% – Non‐Traditional Down n Payment 3.35% Loan‐to‐Value Ratio 1 http:://www.cmhc‐schl.gc.ca/en/co/moloin/mo oloin_005.cfm Chapter 7: Insuraance in the M Mortgage Indu ustry 14 45 Su uccess Tip – Purchasee plus imp provementss program m Be ecome familiaar with the Pu urchase Plus Improvement I ts program. TThis program m, offered by all three insurers, can assist real estate saalespersons t o sell homes that need im mmediate repairs that buyyers might no ot otherwise be b interestedd in purchasin ng. Help yourr real estate salesperson sell more homes and he or she will help yyou fund more mortgages!! Gen nworth Fi nancial 2 The fo ollowing figurre illustrates the t standard Genworth prremiums and is provided aas sample inform mation only. Information is subject to change. c Speccific product iinformation ccan be found at ww ww.genworth.ca Figure 19 – Genworth’’s Standard Prem mium as of Janu uary, 2016s3 Standard Premium Rate R Chart Includes thee following p products** LTV Prem mium Raate op‐up To Pre emium Up U to 65.00%* * 0.6 60% 0.60% 0 65 5.01 ‐ 75.00%* 0.7 75% 2.60% 2 75 5.01 ‐ 80.00%* 1.2 25% 3.15% 3 80.01 ‐ 85.00% % 1.8 80% 4.00% 4 85.01 ‐ 90.00% % 2.4 40% 4.90% 4 90.01 ‐ 95.00%*** 3.6 60% 5.65% 5 Homeb buyer 95 Cash‐Out Refinance (max. 80% LTV) Cashback Equity Ow wner‐ Occupaancy Family Plan Insured d Progress Advance New to Canada Secondary Homes (TType A) Purchasse Plus Impro ovements ** FFor specific underw writing guidelines related to the aboove products, plea se refer to the app plicable product oveerview. m **** For Cashback Equuity Program the sstandard premium ratee is 2.90% and thee premium for porttability/top‐up is 4.255% * A .25% premium surchargge will be applied for everyy 5 years of a mortization b beyond the tradition nal 25 ‐ year mortgage m am ortization peeriod Can nada Gua aranty The fo ollowing figurre illustrates the t standard Canada Guarranty premiums and is pro ovided as sample information only. Information is sub bject to changge. Specific p product inform mation can bee found d at www.canadaguaranty.ca 2 3 Genw worth Financiaal, www.genwo orth.ca http:://genworth.caa/en/lenders/p premium‐rate‐table.aspx 146 Chapter 7: Insuraance in the M Mortgage Indu ustry Figure 20 ‐ Canada Gu uaranty Standard Premiums as of o January, 201664 Canada C Guarranty Premiu ms Standard Premium Chaart Low‐Doc Advantage™ ™ Rental Advaantage™ (Self‐eemployed) Loan‐‐to‐Value Rattio Single Refi/Port Top‐up Single Refi/Port Top‐up Single Reefi/Port TTop‐up ≤ 65% % 0.60% 0.60% 0.80% 1.50% 1.25% 2 2.75% 65.01 1 ‐ 70% 0.65% 2.25% 1.00% 2.60% 1.75% 3 3.00% 70.01 1 ‐ 75% 0.65% 2.25% 1.00% 2.60% 1.75% 3 3.00% 75.01 1 ‐ 80% 1.00% 2.75% 1.64% 3.85% 2.50% 3 3.75% 80.01 1 ‐ 85% 1.75% 2.90% 5.50% 85.01 1 ‐ 90% 2.00% 4.75% 7.00% 90.01 1 ‐ 95% 2.75% Flex 95 9 Advantage™ 2.90% NOTE:: Mortgage insurance premiu ums are non‐re efundable. Defa ault Man agement Program ms (also kknown ass “workou ut opti ons”) Both CMHC C and Ge enworth Finaancial provide e mortgage deefault management prograams that are design ned to assist borrowers who get into financial difficuulty and havee trouble makking their sched duled mortgagge payments.. ograms are provided throu ugh the lendeer in conjuncttion with the insurer and Typicaally, these pro are de esigned to provide a solution. These op ptions can incclude: Special Paymen nt Arrangements A lender may make m arrangem ments with th he borrower tto recover paayment arrearrs over the sho ortest period, as long as itt is within the e borrower’s ffinancial abilitty. For example, with a CM MHC policy a lender l may do this with am mounts up too $10,000 withhout CMHC’s prior approval. eamortization Re A lender may in ncrease the am mortization of o a mortgagee when the deefault is due tto the payments no lo onger being afffordable for the borrowe r. For examp ple, with a CM MHC policy a len nder may exte end the amorrtization up to o 30 years wiithout CMHC’’s prior appro oval. Capitalization t amount oof arrears to the loan amou unt. For This procedure allows the lender to add the exaample with a CMHC policyy, a lender maay increase thhe loan amou unt up to $20,,000 one timee during the borrower’s ownership withoutt CMHC’s prioor approval. Other options 4 http:://www.canadaguaranty.ca/d downloads/CG G_Premium%200Rates_handoout_EN.pdf Chapter 7: Insuraance in the M Mortgage Indu ustry 14 47 Lenders may haave additional options thatt can be apprroved by the iinsurer before implementation n. More information may be found on the insurers’ websitees or by contaacting them d directly. 7.2 Mortga age Crediitor and Life L Insurrance Wha at is Morttgage Cre editor Ins surance? ? There e are two type es of mortgagge creditor insurance. The first is typiccally a life insurance policyy provided to a borrower bby an institutiional lender. The second is a life insurancee policy proviided to a borrrower througgh a third partty, such as thhe ortgage Prote ection Plan (M MPP), that is not n affiliated with an instittutional lendeer Mo t of morttgage credito or insurance are designed tto pay the insstitutional len nder upon Both types death h of the insure ed. Lende er’s Mortgage e Creditor Inssurance This type of insurance is obtained by the borrrower from tthe lender, ussually in the b branch of thee er when they apply for the mortgage. This T type of poolicy is very cconvenient fo or the lende borro ower to obtain n and the insu urance premiium is usuallyy included in tthe mortgagee payment, makin ng it virtually invisible to th he borrower. This type of policy offered by le enders is a gro oup policy, m meaning that aall borrowers are lumped together in the sam me category. For example e, smokers annd non‐smokeers alike are ccombined in the saame age categgory, often re esulting in pre emiums that may not accu urately reflect the condition of the bo orrower’s heaalth. In add dition, this type of insurance is post und derwritten, m meaning that the borrowerr simply has tto answe er three basicc health questions in the application a fo r coverage. Iff the borroweer answers no o to all of the questions, he or she is typically approved. a If the borrower answers yess to any of the questtions, he or sh he must supply additional details along with the app plication. Thee lender may then decide d what steps, s if any, must be take en for it to ap prove the borrower’s application for insuraance. If the e borrower dies and a claim m is made by the borrowe r’s spouse, esstate, etc., the insurance comp pany will then underwrite the t applicatio on. This meanns that the in nsurance com mpany will now w review w how those three questio ons were answ wered and reesearch the borrower’s past medical record ds to ensure that t the answ wers were ansswered accurrately. If theyy were not, th he insurer maay declin ne to pay the claim. If a bo orrower decid des to switch lenders at so ome point, th e borrower w will then havee to reapply fo or insuraance with the e new lender. This could re esult in higheer premiums d due to the bo orrower’s increaased age and//or changes in his or her medical m condiition. The co overage provvided by morttgage creditor insurance iss also a factorr to consider. This type of policyy is often refe erred to as de eclining term insurance. i Thhis means thaat the amoun nt of the coverrage declines as the outstaanding balancce of the morttgage is repaiid by the borrrower. Howe ever, the prem miums remain n constant. 148 Chapter 7: Insuraance in the M Mortgage Indu ustry editor insurannce will typically expire wh hen the Regarrding continued coverage, mortgage cre mortggage is paid off o or when th he borrower reaches r 70 yeears of age, reesulting in a lo oss of coverrage for the policy holder. Finallyy, mortgage creditor c insurrance has onlyy one beneficciary: the lend der. This simply means that whatever w the financial nee eds of the survvivor(s), the iinsurance payys the lender,, not the survivving family me ember(s). Third Party Insurance In com mparison, the e Mortgage Protection Plan, which insuures over 110,,000 people ffor life insuraance and in excess of 40,000 for disability insurance is portable, m meaning thatt this policy can be taken with the borrowerr to a new len nder. The Mortgage M Prottection Plan’ss characteristtics vary from m typical morttgage creditorr insurance byy includ ding a total diisability optio on, being inde ependent of tthe lender, an nd offering a 6 60 day refund d on pre emiums if the e policy holde er decides to cancel his or her policy. This type of plan iss only available through a mortgage ageent, so the avverage borrow wer does not have access to it. Wha at is Life Insuranc ce? In thiss section, term m life insuran nce, which is a life insurancce policy thatt is in force fo or a contraacted numbe er of years at which w time itt then comes up for renew wal, will be refferred to as life insurance. This type of insu urance contrasts with who le life insuran nce that requ uires the insure ed to make paayments for a set number of years, how wever the covverage contin nues for the entire ety of the policyholder’s liffe. This insurance is often more expenssive than term m insurance and iss not similar enough e to mo ortgage credittor insurancee for an accurate comparisson. Life insuraance is a policcy purchased by an individ dual that will ppay his or herr beneficiariees in the even nt of deaath of the insured. This tyype of policy is designed too replace the financial valu ue of the perso on who passed d away and coverage is no ormally relateed to income, not debt. Liffe insurance can only be obtained through a licensed life insurance br oker or agentt and part of the process is determining the am mount of covverage require ed based on tthe individual’s unique sett of circum mstances. Th his may result in the policyholder requirring more insurance than w would otherwise be provided by mortgage creditorr insurance. nsurance is prre‐underwrittten, meaning that the indivvidual policy holder must go through a Life in health h questionnaire that allow ws the insurer to determinee if coverage is warranted and to set the prremium based on the indivvidual, not a group. g This iss referred to as pre‐underrwriting as oppossed to mortgaage creditor insurance thaat is post‐und erwritten. Th he net result is that the policyyholder can be assured thaat upon death h the insurer will pay his o or her claim quickly. In essen nce, a life insu urance compaany has two years y from thee date of app proval to dispute a policyyholder’s claim m on their inssurance application. If theey do not the insurance co ompany no longer has any recourse, meaniing that the in nsurer cannott refuse to paay the insured d’s claim. Life in nsurance has level premium ms that are valid for the teerm of the po olicy and the aamount of coverrage remains constant. When the policy comes up foor renewal th he premium w will most likelly increaase, unless th he policyholde er has improvved medicallyy. Normally th his is not the case and eveen if it were, w the policcyholder wou uld now be old der and requiire higher preemiums due tto age. Chapter 7: Insuraance in the M Mortgage Indu ustry 14 49 Su uccess Tip – Partner with a pro ofessional Paartner with a qualified q life insurance prrofessional annd make him or her your in nsurance representative.. Tell your client that “you ur insurance rrepresentativve” will contacct them to disscuss their inssurance need ds. You will asssist your clieents and get rreferral business from your inssurance repre esentative. A great way to o grow your bbusiness! The fo ollowing figurre provides a visual compaarison betweeen mortgage creditor insurance and term life insurance e. Figure 21 – Mortgage Creditor vs. Terrm Life Insurancee Term Life Insurance Mortgage Creditor Insu urance Und derwriting Post‐underrwritten Pre‐underwritten Mayy require medical inveestigation, len ngthening thee pro ocess Con nvenience Quick and easy e to qualiffy Porrtability None Indeependent of a lender Pre emiums Level Levvel Am mount of Initia al Coverage Determined d by the amoount of the mortgaage Dettermined by tthe insured If the borro ower defaultss or cannot makke his or her mortgage payment, p the insurance will w cease as tthe insurance is tied to the mortgage payment p As llong as the in nsured can pay the insurance prremium, the insu urance will co ontinue, regardless of wh hether the mortgage paymeent cannot bee mad de. Decreases Con nstant When the mortgage m is ppaid or upon transfer to a new llender At tthe end of thee term Pro otection on deffault/illness Am mount of Conttinuing Covverage Exp piry 150 Chapter 7: Insuraance in the M Mortgage Indu ustry neficiaries Ben Num mber of Deatth Benefits Spe eed of Claim Payment P Lender One, the ou utstanding baalance of the morttgage Can take up p to several m months due to insu urer investigattion Nam med by the in nsured If tw wo homeown ners are insu ured and therre is a com mmon disasteer where both h are killed, two death benefitss are paid. Paid d within dayss Wha at insuran nce is be est for yo ur Clientt? The general consensus is that te erm life insurrance is a bettter option forr the borroweer than mortggage creditor insurance for several of th he reasons nooted above. However, bettter coveragee is onlyy applicable when w the term m insurance is in force. Onn average, on nly about 20% % of mortgagee agentts’ clients actu ually take mo ortgage credittor insurance . Quite often n, this is due tto the borro ower indicatin ng that he or she s currently has adequatte insurance o or that he or sshe feels thatt insuraance is not re equired underr his or her cirrcumstances.. Since the m mortgage agen nt is not a licenssed life insuraance represen ntative he or she s cannot deetermine wheether those sstatements arre accurate. In add dition, even iff the borrowe er indicates th hat he or she will take term m life insuran nce instead off mortggage creditor insurance, th he borrower may m not see a life insurancce agent quicckly enough to o ensurre that there is i adequate in nsurance in fo orce as soon as the mortggage begins. IIn many casess the bo orrower simp ply forgets or puts off seein ng the life inssurance agentt and ends up p not being prope erly insured. One option o to ensu ure that the client c is prope erly protectedd is to suggesst that the borrower take the in nsurance provvided by the Mortgage M Pro otection Plan or the credito or life insuran nce policy and d then meet m with a life insurance agent at his or her convennience. While this does not address th he issuess noted earlie er regarding the difference es in coveragee, it does ensure that the b borrower is coverred immediately. Another sound busine ess practice iss to obtain th he borrower’ss permission to havve your insurance agent (aan insurance agent a that yoou know and ttrust) initiatee the contact with the t borrowerr. This reduce es the potential of the bor rower forgettting or negleccting to contact an insuran nce agent on his h or her own. In add dition, curren nt legislation requires r that the mortgagee agent or broker offer inssurance to the borro ower. If the borrower declines, the agent or broker sshould have tthe borrowerr sign a waiveer declin ning the insurrance. This will w protect the e agent or brooker if at som me point in the future therre is a qu uestion as to whether the insurance waas ever offereed. This can b be especially important if a home eowner dies during d the mo ortgage and a spouse or otther survivor sues the morrtgage agent or bro oker for not offering o insuraance during the applicatioon phase. These e steps are of vital importaance. They will ensure thaat, if the borro ower dies, hiss or her family will be e adequately protected, which w should be b an overridding concern ffor every morrtgage agent.. Chapter 7: Insuraance in the M Mortgage Indu ustry 7.3 15 51 Properrty Insura ance Wha at is Prop perty Insu urance? Prope erty insurance e is a policy of insurance th hat provides ccoverage for the homeow wner against coverred risks. Why y is it nec cessary? Basic insurance to cover the rep placement off the building (normally thee house) and other structtures on the property p is vittal to lenderss and is a requuirement of the Standard Charge Terms. This in nsurance protects the insu ured against loss, and by eextension protects the lend der’s securityy for the loan. Lenders require th hat the insuraance policy haave a provisio on that assign ns the eeds first to th he lender. Th he lender can then decide whether to replace the bu uilding, which h proce is typical, or use th he proceeds to pay off the mortgage. If the borrower fails to pay the insurance pre emium the leender has the right to pay tthe premium on the e homeowne er’s behalf or replace the policy p (some i nsurance com mpanies will n not accept a premium paymentt from anyone e but the insu ured). The hoomeowner ow wes the lendeer the costs i involvved in either instance. Typ es of Ins urance Home e insurance This type of policy is for the hom meowner and d is designed to protect no ot only the ph hysical building, but all the e things in the homeowne er’s house as w well. A stand dard house in nsurance policcy will en nsure that if something s likke fire, vandalism or theft ooccurs the ho omeowner will be protected and his or o her valuab bles will be replaced. It is aalso possible for a homeow wner to be eople have wh hile on the prroperty which h necessitatess the need fo or held liable for accidents that pe liabilitty insurance. Most home insurance policies carry c standard d coverage. TThe followingg list summarizes this coverrage. Buuilding Coveraage Alll risk coveragee insures the building for the t most com mmon types o of losses. When there is All Rissk coverage in n place, the building b is insu ured for everyything, unless it is specificcally excluded d fro om the policy (e.g., intentio onal damage to the propeerty by the ow wner would not be covvered). Naamed‐Perils Coverage This includes a list of the mo ost common types of thinggs covered un nder the insurrance policy. Naamed‐Perils in nclude fire, th heft and wate er damage. Evverything is liisted very cleearly in the po olicy contract so the policy owner has a complete an d thorough u understandingg of what thee inssurance policyy covers. Nam med‐Perils bu uilding coveraage is very rarre since it lim mits the am mount of cove erage. Coontents Alll‐risk contentss coverage insures belongings inside thhe house for tthe most com mmon types of 152 Chapter 7: Insurance in the Mortgage Industry losses. When the policy owner has All Risk coverage, the contents are insured for everything, unless it is specifically excluded from the policy. A standard house policy provides for the Actual Cash Value (ACV) replacement of belongings. This means that the policy owner only receives the value of the item, less depreciation. For example, if the policy owner purchased a TV 5 years ago for $1,500, he or she might only get $500 for it if it was destroyed in a fire. Even though it may cost $1,800 to replace that same TV today, the insurance would still only give the policy owner $500. Many people choose to add the Replacement Value option to their contents coverage. Replacement value coverage means that the contents of the policy owner’s house are insured for the amount it costs to replace them. When the owner replaces the item with a similar kind and quality, within a specified time, the insurer will pay what it cost to replace the item, not what it was actually worth in its used state. This means if a 5 year‐old TV was lost in a fire, the owner would get the full amount it would cost to replace it, even if that is more than was originally paid for the TV. Detached Private Structure This type of coverage applies to structures that exist on the property but are not connected to the primary residence. For example, a detached garage could be included under this coverage. Additional Living Expenses If the owner is forced to leave the house because of a loss, this coverage pays for reasonable and necessary expenses to temporarily live away from home. Hotel and food costs are the type of expenses that would be covered under such circumstances. Personal Liability Liability is a legal responsibility. Liability Insurance provides protection from having to pay damages to people, if the owner has been found responsible for unintentionally injuring them or damaging their property. Example If someone is injured on the insured’s property, the owner may be responsible for damages. For example, if someone slips on the front steps of this property, breaks an arm, and cannot go to work, the owner could be held responsible for the person's lost wages. This insurance coverage would pay the injured person those damages up to the policy’s maximum covered amounts. Another benefit of liability insurance is that it protects the policy owner anywhere in the world. For example, if the policy owner was golfing and his or her golf club accidentally flew out of his or her hands, and struck and injured another player, liability insurance would cover this accident. Voluntary Payments for Medical Expenses This covers medical costs if someone accidentally injures him or herself as a result of your personal activities or the way you have maintained your building. It also covers injuries experienced by resident employees, such as nannies or housekeepers, while working for you. You don't have to be found liable to make a claim under this coverage, but some limits do apply and may be different from company to company. Chapter 7: Insurance in the Mortgage Industry 153 Voluntary Payments for Damage to Property The accidental physical damage to the property of others is covered. This may occur as a result of personal activities or the way the policy owner’s building is maintained or used. Pets or animals that are owned or cared for by the policy owner may also cause damage. This type of coverage would also include the intentional acts of other insured individuals under a certain age (set by the individual provider). Rental Loss Insurance In the case where the insured property is being used as a rental, it is prudent to obtain this type of addition to the standard policy. This addition (or rider as it is referred to) will protect the insured against loss of income due to covered perils. For example, if the home burns down, the standard policy will cover its replacement. However if it was being used as a rental, the standard policy will not cover replacing the lost income from the renter while the property is being rebuilt. This insurance coverage does. Condominium Insurance When a purchaser buys a condominium, the purchaser owns the "unit" and a share in the common areas of the condominium ‐‐ the roof, basement, elevator, heating room, lobby, swimming pool, parking garage, etc. An owner may be held responsible for harm caused to any part of the building or to others who live or visit the condominium complex. A condominium insurance policy can remove some of the financial worries of condominium ownership. This insurance policy provides coverage for the owner’s personal property, structural improvements to the unit and additional living expenses if the owner is the victim of fire, theft, or other disaster listed in the policy. The owner will get liability protection to protect him or her from harm caused to any part of the building or to others who live in or visit the condominium complex. An important feature of this insurance policy is loss assessment. The condominium owner shares responsibility with others in the building for common property. Loss assessment protects the owner from damage to these common areas. A "master policy" is purchased and provided by the condominium board. This covers the common areas shared with others in the building like the roof, basement, elevator, heating room, lobby, swimming pool, parking garage, etc. for both liability and physical damage. Sometimes the condominium corporation is responsible for insuring the individual condominium as it was originally built, including standard fixtures. In this case, the condominium unit owner would only be responsible for insuring personal property as well as any alterations the current owner or a previous owner have made to the original structure of the condominium, like remodelling the kitchen or bathtub. In other cases, the condominium corporation is responsible for insuring only the bare walls, floor, and ceiling. The owner would be responsible for insuring personal property plus things like the kitchen cabinets, built‐in appliances, plumbing, wiring and bathroom fixtures. Limitations In House Insurance, Condo Insurance or Tenants Insurance Policy Coverage With standard house insurance, condo insurance or tenants insurance policies there are limitations regarding theft coverage for jewellery, furs, silverware, business property, bicycles, money, etc. If the homeowner owns any of these items he or she would be required to purchase additional insurance to cover them. 154 Chapter 7: Insuraance in the M Mortgage Indu ustry ng a House Inssurance, Condo Insurance e, or Tenants Insurance Deeductible Payin When n an insured makes m a claim m, the homeowner always pays a small portion of the claim, whilee the in nsurance com mpany pays the rest. The portion p paid bby the homeo owner is called d the deducctible. The am mount of the deductible affects the pri ce of the insu urance policy. The higher the de eductible, the e less the cost of the insurance premium m. 7.4 Title Ins surance Wha at is Title e Insuran ce? Title insurance is a policy of insu urance that provides p coveerage for the ttitle‐related rrisks associated with real estate tran nsactions. It is designed too cover the un npredictable or undettectable issue es such as forgery, fraud, missing m heirs, etc. that can n affect rightss of ownership p. Becau use it is insuraance, a title in nsurance policy moves thee risk associatted with title from the home ebuyer, the le ending instituttion or the law wyer, to the ttitle insurer. If there is a problem with title that t only beco omes known after closing,, the title insu urer may rectifyy the problem m or compenssate the title insurance poolicyholder, prrovided the tyype of proble em that surfaaces is covere ed by the title e insurance poolicy. Typ es of Pollicies Title Insurance policies can typically be broken down intoo two basic caategories: Lender Policy ormally taken at the reque est of the lendder upon clossing of a refinancing This policy is no traansaction. Th hese policies may m provide coverage c to bboth the lender and the ho omeowner, wh hich is recomm mended. Ho omeowner’s Policy P This policy is no ormally taken by the new homeowner h w when purchassing a properrty; however titlle insurance can c be purchaased at any tiime during thhe homeowneer’s ownershiip of the pro operty. A Title e Insurance policy p typicallyy protects against the folloowing risks: Deefence of titlee Fraaud and forgeery (includingg title theft, thhe registratio n of a frauduulent mortgagge, etc) Unnenforceabilitty of the insurred mortgagee Deefects that woould have beeen revealed by b an up to daate Survey Errrors in the Survey Leggal services, including lawyyer negligencce, lawyer fra ud, lawyer deeath, disbarm ment or rettirement Deefects in title such s as liens, executions, adverse a claim ms, encroachm ments, unregistered easements, mortgages and other o encumb brances Unnmarketabilityy of title Hyydro, tax, water and gas arrrears Exeecutions agaiinst prior ownners Coondominium status s certificcates Septic system violations v Woork orders, noon‐conforminng zoning Chapter 7: Insuraance in the M Mortgage Indu ustry 15 55 Re estrictive cove enants Mu unicipal workk orders and permits p Un nregistered hyydro easemen nts Other risks cove ered by the policy. A Title e Insurance policy p will typiically not pro otect against tthe followingg risks: Tittle issues thatt arise after thhe policy datee that were nnot present beefore (other tthan fraud annd oth her covered risks) r Tittle defects thaat the homeoowner was aw ware of and too which the h homeowner aagreed Tittle defects thaat the homeoowner was aw ware of and abbout which th he homeowner did not infform the insurer Environmental hazards, unleess noted on title t Leggality or rents Firre retrofit com mpliance Coosts of movingg fences or booundary wallss Losses from failling to make a claim in a timely fashion Other exclusionns included in the policy. Soli citor’s O pinion on n Title vs s. Title In surance – A Com mparison Pa ause for cla arification n – “Solicito or’s Opinio on on Titlee” A “Solicitor’s “ Opinion on Title” is a reportt by the lendeer’s real estatte lawyer outlining the condition of the e title of the mortgaged m prroperty. The T Issue The se ervices provid ded by the Solicittor Soliciitor’s Opinion n on Title Perform ms required searches s on title Facilitaates the closin ng Provide es a Letter of Opinion on title Legal fe ees Disburssements Costs Lawyerr’s Malpracticce Insurance which typically t cove ers lawyer neglige ence Protection Title Insuraance Appliees for a title innsurance policy on behalf of the homeo owner Legal ffees Disburrsements Title In nsurance Policy Total ccosts are typically less duee to few wer searches rrequired. Lawyeer negligence (depending on thee policy) Title defects Fraud,, forgery Other protection ass described inn Types of Policies seection above 156 Restriictions Chapter 7: Insuraance in the M Mortgage Indu ustry Homeoowner must prove p lawyer’ss Refer tto Types of Policies section neglige ence Typical coverage maaximum is $1 million abovee Coveraage maximum m up to policyy amoun nt Typicallly only the hoomebuyer Homebuyer, buyer’’s spouse andd Who is covered? After Closing Makin ng a claim Solicitoor’s opinion coovers issues Errorss not made by the e Solicitor up to closing Must show Solicitorr negligence May haave to sue the e Solicitor Solicito or must have valid v malpractice insurance for a claim m to be made m No coverage as Soliccitor’s insuran nce only covers him or herr No covverage Does nnot matter whho makes thee error aas long as thee risk is covereed Full retroactive covverage, including fraud com mmitted by Solicitor Fraud d Surve eys childreen, whomeveer receives title upon homebuyyer’s death Based on policy covverage includes items afteer closing Homebuyer makes a claim directly to the insurer for covereed risks Generaally an up to date d survey iss Generally no surveyy is required require ed for an Opin nion on Title The Cost of Title Insu urance Title Insurance typ pically costs between $200 0 and $300, deepending on the type of p policy, the prope erty type and the value of the property. This is a onee‐time premium. Mak king a Cla aim on a Title Ins urance P Policy To maake a claim on n a title insurance policy th he insured (thhe homeown ner) must com mplete a statem ment of loss and a submit it to the title in nsurer prompptly. The titlee insurer will p provide assistance in comp pleting the req quired docum mentation. The History of Title I nsurance e The first title insurance compan ny, the Law Prroperty Assurrance and Tru ust Society, w was formed in n Pennssylvania in 18 853. Title Insu urance was de eveloped in tthe United Staates and until the early 1990ss was not available in Canaada. Virtuallyy all real estatte transaction ns in the Unitted States currently carry title e insurance, while w its popu ularity is conttinuing to gro ow in Canada.. As can n be seen by the followingg figure, the popularity p of ttitle insurance has risen drramatically over the t past decaade, enjoying nearly a 1,40 00% increase in premiums.. However, as the popullarity of title insurance i inccreases, so do oes the percenntage of claim ms, as is evideenced by nextt Chapter 7: Insuraance in the M Mortgage Indu ustry 15 57 e. This Figure illustrates an n increase fro om an averagee of 10% in cllaims in 1998 8 to an averagge figure of neaarly 30% since e 2004. Figure 22 – Title Insura ance – Net Prem miums and Net Claims C Prov viders of Title Ins surance In Onttario there arre currently several Insurance compani es licensed to o provide titlee insurance5: Chicago Title Insurance Company Fiddelity Nationaal Title Insurance Companyy Firrst American Title T Insurancce Company Firrst Canadian Title T Law wPro Steewart Title Guuaranty Comppany Traavelers Guaraanty Companyy of Canada Su uccess Tip – Suggest title insurrance to yo our clients Every homeowner can benefit from the protection p thaat title insura ance providess against fraaud. Contact your past clie ents and sugggest that theyy take out a p policy. And do on’t forget to o ask them aboutt their current financing ne eeds; they maay need to reefinance theirr mortgage orr consolidate deb bt. Another way w to increase your businness now! 5 FSCO O 158 Chapter 7: Insuraance in the M Mortgage Indu ustry Figure 23 – Title Insura ance – Percenta age of Claims to Premiums 7.5 Errors and Omis ssions In nsurance Wha at is Erro ors and Omissions O s insuran ce (E&O )? Errorss and Omissio ons insurance e is an insuran nce policy thaat covers the professional from claims made e against him or her due to o negligence in the form off errors comm mitted in a traansaction. Insuraance policies prior to 2008 8 did not have e a fraud provvision. Thereefore, if the m mortgage agen nt were to commit fraaud and the borrower b sufffer a loss he oor she could n not receive co ompensation from the broker’s errors e and om missions policcy. Under the Mortgage Brokeragees, lenders and Administraators Act, 20006 it is mandatory that all licenssed brokerage es have a poliicy in place th hat not only pprotects again nst errors and d omissions but frraud as well. The purpose behind this requirement r iis to bring thee brokerage ccommunity in n line with w other pro ofessions and provide prottection for co nsumers. h the insurer, and the brokkers and agen nts working The brokerage willl have a master policy with for the brokerage will w be covere ed under this master policcy. In other w words, individual brokers and agents do not have their ow wn policy rath her they are ccovered undeer the brokeraage’s master policyy. Chapter 7: Insurance in the Mortgage Industry 7.6 159 Key Terms and Definitions Approved lender A lender approved by CMHC Beneficiary The person who receives the payment of the amount of insurance after the death of the insured Business for Self Another term for an individual who is self‐employed Canadian Association of Accredited Mortgage Professionals (CAAMP) The mortgage industry’s national trade association Capitalization The act of adding mortgage arrears or other costs associated with a mortgage to the principal amount. For example, capitalizing a lender’s fee means that this fee would be added to the mortgage principal and amortized. Chattel Loan A purchaser borrows funds for the purchase of movable personal property (the chattel) from the lender. The lender then secures the loan with a mortgage against the chattel. Claim A legal action to obtain money, property or the enforcement of a right protected by law against another party. An insurance claim is a claim made under the terms of the insurance contract. CMHC Canada Mortgage Housing Corporation Common Areas The areas of a condominium building that are common to all unit owners. For example, a swimming pool, gym, etc. Condominium The whole collection of individual home units along with the land upon which they sit. Individual home ownership is composed only of the air‐space within the boundaries of the home, as defined by a document known as a Declaration, filed on record with the local governing authority. Condominium Corporation A Corporation without share capital, created under the Condominium Act for the purposes of administering the operation, maintenance and repair of the common elements and assets of the condominium. The Corporation is guided by a Board of Directors consisting of homeowners. Condominium Status Certificate A document containing information regarding the operational, legal, and financial status of the condominium corporation. This document can contain the declaration, by‐laws, rules and regulations, insurance information, reserve fund balance, other financial disclosures, legal 160 Chapter 7: Insurance in the Mortgage Industry description of the unit and management contract (if applicable). It may also include information about any legal filings or judgments against the condominium. A buyer should always review the status certificate. Deductible In relation to an insurance contract, this is the insured’s share of the claim. The insured pays the deductible and the insurance company pays the remainder of the claim. Default Management Programs in place by mortgage default insurers that allow the lender to assist the borrower in resolving mortgage arrears Depreciation Depreciation refers to the fact that certain assets, normally physical assets, can lose value over time. The amount of depreciation is calculated based on an item’s original purchase price or economic value, its anticipated life expectancy and its residual value at a future point in time. Disbarment A revocation of a lawyer's ability to practice law Disbursements Amounts payable. In mortgage financing, disbursements typically relate to amounts paid from the mortgage proceeds Down Payment An amount of a purchaser’s money provided to the vendor from his or her own resources (not included in a mortgage loan). Under certain programs this amount may be borrowed. E&O or Errors and Omissions Insurance Insurance that provides coverage for errors or omissions made by a brokerage, broker, agent or Administrator. This insurance must contain a provision for fraud. Easement The right of use or passage over another person’s owned or leased property. Easements have several legal requirements and will “run with the land,” or be passed from owner to owner. Encroachments When a piece of real property hangs from one property over the property line of another’s. The structure that encroaches might be a tree, garage, fence, part of a building, or other fixture. Environmental Hazards Any situation or state of events which poses a threat to the surrounding environment. This may be caused by chemicals leaking into the soil, ruptured gas tanks at a gas station, etc. Executions A “Writ of Execution” filed with the sheriff in the district in which the debtor lives or owns land. This allows a plaintiff who has successfully obtained a judgment against a debtor in court to enforce the judgment Chapter 7: Insurance in the Mortgage Industry 161 Extended Amortization Period An amortization that exceeds the original amortization period Fire Retrofit The Municipal Act and Planning Act permit one apartment in most detached houses, semi‐ detached houses and some types of row houses as long as minimum health and safety requirements can be met. The requirements for fire safety in such units are regulated under one of two provincial regulations, either the Building Code or Section 9.8 of the Fire Code. The requirements for a legal second unit can be summed up with these four points: there must be a fire separation between each unit; there has to be a way for occupants to escape from each unit; each unit must have smoke alarms; the units must meet electrical safety standards Grossing up Taxable Income The process of adding deductions originally taken from an individual’s income back to that income Group Policy An insurance policy that groups together certain policyholders based on general criteria Home Buyers’ Plan (HBP) A program that allows a first time home buyer to withdraw up to $25,000 in a calendar year from his or her registered retirement savings plans (RRSPs) to buy or build a qualifying home. A first time home buyer is considered to be an individual who has not owned real property within four years prior to purchasing the current property. Home Insurance Insurance to protect the home owner against covered risks and perils Independent Mortgage agents Association of Ontario (IMBA) The provincial mortgage association in Ontario Insurance policy A policy that, in return for the payment of a premium or premiums, provides insurance coverage to the insured Liability An obligation of an individual or other entity to compensate for past occurrences that have caused injury or loss to another Lien Security against a property, either real or personal, for a debt Life Insurance A policy of insurance that provides financial compensation to a beneficiary upon the death of the insured Malpractice Insurance (Lawyer’s) Insurance that provides coverage for acts of negligence or malpractice by a lawyer. This will compensate the injured party. 162 Chapter 7: Insurance in the Mortgage Industry Master Insurance Policy (Condominiums) Typically found with condominium buildings, this policy outlines the coverage for the entire building. Mortgage Brokerages, lenders and Administrators Act, 2006 The legislation that governs the mortgage brokerage industry in Ontario. This legislation is enforced by FSCO and replaces the previous Mortgage agents Act. Mortgage agents Act The legislation predating the Mortgage Brokerages, lenders and Administrators Act, 2006. This legislation governed the mortgage brokerage industry in Ontario until July 1st, 2008 and was enforced by FSCO. Mortgage Creditor Insurance Insurance that provides coverage to the insured so that, in the case of the insured’s death or other covered risk, payment is made to the lender Mortgage Creditor Life Insurance Insurance that provides coverage to the insured so that, in the case of the insured’s death, payment is made to the lender Mortgage Default Insurance An insurance policy which protects the insured (the lender) against losses suffered by the default of the borrower Mortgage Fraud The deliberate omission of information, use of misstatements or misrepresentations to obtain, purchase or fund a mortgage loan National Housing Act The legislation that created mortgage default insurance in 1954 Non Owner‐Occupied Property A property that is rented Non‐Permanent Resident Refers to people from another country who had an employment authorization, a student authorization, or a Minister's permit, or who were refugee claimants at the time of a census, as well as family members living in the same dwelling Owner‐Occupied Property A property that is occupied by the owner Portability The ability to transfer something such as a mortgage or insurance to another property, or transfer mortgage creditor insurance coverage to another lender Premium An amount paid in return for insurance coverage Chapter 7: Insurance in the Mortgage Industry 163 Premium Surcharge An additional premium paid to the insurer for additional coverage Principal Residence The place in which an individual normally resides Private insurer A non‐governmental insurance company Property Insurance Insurance that protects the insured against losses to the property due to fire and other covered perils Reamortization The process of changing the amortization on a current mortgage Refinance The process of paying off a current mortgage and replacing it with another Rental Property A property used solely for the process of renting to generate income for the owner Replacement Value The cost to replace an item in today’s dollars Restrictive Covenant A restriction of use placed on title of the servient tenement for the benefit of the dominant tenement RRIF A Registered Retirement Income Fund. A fund purchased by an individual that pays a regular return RRSP A Registered Retirement Savings Plan is a savings plan that is registered with Canada Revenue Agency and allows the individual to defer taxes, generally until retirement. Second Home A vacation property such as a cottage or other property not used as a principal residence Self‐Directed RRSP A type of RRSP (Registered Retirement Savings Plan) whose owner determines the asset mix held in the trust Self‐Employed borrower A mortgage borrower whose income is derived from self‐employment activities Septic System A domestic wastewater treatment system (consisting of a septic tank and a soil absorption 164 Chapter 7: Insurance in the Mortgage Industry system) into which wastes are piped directly from the home. Bacteria decompose the waste, sludge settles to the bottom of the tank, and the treated effluent flows out into the ground through drainage pipes. Solicitor’s Letter of Opinion A report by the lender’s real estate lawyer outlining the condition of the title of the mortgaged property Survey A document that determines the boundaries of a property Tenant An individual renting a property Term life insurance A life insurance policy with a specified term or amount of time that the policy will be in place Title A term that refers to the ownership of a property. If something is registered “on title” it means that it is officially registered against the ownership of the property through the Land Titles Office, where property ownership is recorded Title Defects Any problem that “clouds” the property’s title. A title defect can be a lien, a person or entity that may have had interest in the property and never surrendered it, or any number of other situations making the title less than perfect Title Insurance An insurance policy that provides protection against errors in title such as survey errors, zoning infractions and property encroachments. It can also protect the homeowner against fraud. Underwriting The process that a product or service provider uses to assess the eligibility of a customer to receive its products such as mortgage financing, insurance or other credit to a consumer Chapter 7: Insuraance in the M Mortgage Indu ustry 7.7 16 65 Review w Questio ons Answers to the Revview Questio ons are found at www.REM MIC.ca Sho ort Answe er Questio ons 1. Ho ow has mortgage default in nsurance imp proved the moortgage markket? 2. Wh ho are the current mortgaage default prroviders in Onntario? 3. Wh hat is/are the e main benefits of mortgagge default inssurance to a) the borrowerr? b) the len nder? 4. Ho ow can a borrower currenttly in default be assisted byy the lender aand the morttgage default inssurer? 5. Ho ow does title insurance i ben nefit a) the bo orrower? b) tthe lender? c) the real estaate lawyer? 6. Wh hat type of in nsurance wou uld you suggesst to a purchaaser of a cond dominium? 7. Wh hen was title insurance first introduced d? 8. Disscuss the maiin differencess between mo ortgage credi tor life insuraance and term m life inssurance. 9. Wh hich companiies are curren ntly licensed to t provide tit le insurance iin Ontario? 10. Without W errorss and omissio ons insurance, what might the consequences be to a mortgage bro oker who com mmits an erro or and is sued d by a client? 166 Chapter 8: Calculating a Mortgage Payment Chapter 8: Calculating a Mortgage Payment Learning Outcomes Successful understanding of the concepts presented in this chapter will enable the learner to: Describe the components of a mortgage payment Describe the effect of compound interest Use the HP10BII financial calculator Perform an interest rate conversion Calculate the payment required to repay a mortgage based on different interest rates, mortgage amounts, payment frequencies and amortization periods Introduction In today’s mortgage brokerage industry, virtually all mortgage agents use mortgage origination software. This software performs the calculations required to determine a borrower’s mortgage payment and various other financial components of a mortgage without the broker having to perform these calculations manually. However, as today’s mortgage agent is a professional, it is necessary for him or her to know more about the financial components of a mortgage than the average consumer. By doing a simple search on the internet, a consumer can find numerous different types of online mortgage calculators that will calculate a payment, accelerate a payment, provide an amortization schedule, calculate prepayment penalties and so on. Therefore, to know more than the average consumer in today’s information age, the mortgage agent must have a solid understanding of how a mortgage payment is calculated, including the effects that changing different components of a mortgage have on the mortgage payment. This will be achieved by using the most popular financial calculator in North America today, the HP10BII. 8.1 The Components of a Mortgage Payment We will begin our journey of calculating a mortgage payment by analyzing the different components of a payment. There are six components present in each mortgage payment, and without 5 of them a mortgage payment cannot be calculated. They are: 1. The Present Value (the mortgage amount) The mortgage amount typically refers to the amount of money that must be repaid by the borrower 2. The Amortization Period The amortization period tells us how long it will take to fully repay the mortgage amount. The amortization period is expressed in years Chapter 8: Calculating a Mortgage Payment 167 3. The Interest Rate The interest rate tells us how much the lender is receiving in interest in return for providing the mortgage amount. This number has two components: the annual rate and the compounding frequency 4. The Compounding Frequency The compounding frequency tells us how often the annual rate of interest compounds, which in turn tells us the precise amount of interest that is being charged 5. The Future Value The future value tells us how much money will be outstanding at some future point in time. For our purposes the future amount will always be zero since the payment being calculated is the payment that is required to pay the entire mortgage amount off over the full amortization period. 6. The Payment Once you have the previous 5 components, you can calculate the payment. The payment tells us exactly how much money is required to be paid to the lender in each payment period. A payment period would be equal to a month if the mortgage had monthly payments, a week if the mortgage had weekly payments, and so on. These six essential components of a mortgage payment are reflected by six keys on the calculator, which will be reviewed once you have configured the calculator. 8.2 Configuring the HP10BII The HP10BII has several functions that allow us to explain the components of a mortgage payment without having to resort to algebra to calculate a payment. The following figure is a picture of the calculator. 168 Chapter 8: Calculating a Mortgage Payment Figure 24 – HP10BII Calculator To calculate a payment we’ll be using this row of buttons… …the +/‐ button …and the shift or 2nd function button Chapter 8: Calculating a Mortgage Payment 169 Our focus will rest primarily on the top row of the calculator, focusing on the top five buttons. A few other keys will be used as well but these five are the keys you will need to use most often. As you can see, the top row’s five buttons have white letters on the top and gold letters on the bottom. This means that these keys or buttons have two functions each. One of the key’s functions is accessed by using the white portion of the button and the other by using the gold portion of the button. To use the white portion, all the user must do is press the key. This is in contrast to using the gold portion of the key. To access this function the user must first press the second function key. This key is the third button from the lower left hand corner of the calculator and looks like this: Figure 25 – HP10BII Shift/2nd Function Key As calculations are performed, each button required will be clearly indicated. Nothing will be left to chance. Turning the Calculator ON The first step in our process begins with turning on the calculator. Locate the ON key at the lower left hand corner of the calculator. The key looks like this: Figure 26 – HP10BII ON/OFF Key Press the ON key. Your display should now read 0.00. If it doesn’t, don’t worry; simply follow the rest of the directions and you will end up with the proper display. Setting the Calculator to a Floating Decimal Place The calculator comes pre‐programmed with the display set to show a number to two decimal places. To perform mortgage calculations, a floating decimal place is required. A floating decimal place means that the calculator will display a number to however many decimal places are required without rounding the number. To accomplish this press the following keys: The Shift Key to access the second function keys. Once you’ve pressed this key, simply press the next key. 170 Chapter 8: Calculating a Mortgage Payment Figure 27 – HP10BII Display Key The Display Key. This is the second function under the = sign on the button located on the bottom row, the 4th key on the right of the ON button. Figure 28 – HP10BII Decimal Key The Decimal Key. This is the first function on this button. This key is located on the bottom row, the 3rd key on the right of the ON button. Your display should now read 0 (no decimal point after the zero). If your display reads anything but a single 0 please repeat the above steps. Your calculator is now ready to be used in the following sections. 8.3 Interest Rates Before a mortgage payment can be calculated, it is vital to understand the role that interest rates play in the process. Interest rates in Canada are typically compounded. This means that the rate is charged more than once per year with the effect of charging interest on interest. The effects of compound interest can be significant. However, before the effects of compounding can be discussed, the method in which interest rates are expressed or written must be explained. The standard form of expressing an interest rate verbally is by first indicating the rate, then the compounding frequency followed by whether the rate is calculated at the beginning of the compounding period or at the end of the compounding period. Canadian mortgages are calculated in arrears, or at the end of the compounding period. For example, if a borrower was making monthly payments on his or her mortgage and the next payment date was January 1st, that payment would cover the month of December. For other financing, such as a car lease, payments are made in advance so interest must be calculated in advance. For example, if an individual had a car lease and his or her next payment was due on January 1st, that payment would cover the month of January. Therefore, for Canadian mortgages an interest rate is expressed verbally in the following manner, considering an annual rate of 6% for the following example: “The rate is 6% compounded semi‐annually, not in advance.” That is how the rate is expressed verbally. However, it is necessary to write these calculations and therefore the method of expressing a rate on paper must be explained. That same statement would be expressed in the following manner on paper: Chapter 8: Calculating a Mortgage Payment 171 J2 = 6% J refers to the fact that this is an annual interest rate 2 refers to the fact that this interest rate is compounded semi‐annually, or twice per year (there are two semi‐annual periods in a year). 6% is the rate of interest. If the rate was 6% compounded annually, not in advance it would be written as: J1=6% If the rate was 6% compounded monthly, not in advance it would be written as: J12=6% The following chart illustrates how compounding frequencies are written for an annual interest rate: Figure 29 – Expressing Compounding Frequencies Compounding Frequency Annually Semi‐Annually Monthly Bi‐Weekly Weekly Daily Written as: J1 J2 J12 J26 J52 J365 The next step is to explore the effects of compounding on a borrowed amount. Example An individual is borrowing $100,000 at J2=6%, over a one year period and not making any payments during that period (this is an example of an interest accruing mortgage – although not a popular mortgage it is best suited to illustrate the effect of compound interest). During the year, interest will be charged twice since the compounding frequency is semi‐ annually. In the first 6 months (first semi‐annual compounding period) 3% will be charged (6% divided by two compounding periods) on the outstanding balance of the mortgage, as is illustrated below: $100,000 x 3% = $3,000 The $3,000 represents the amount of interest charged in the first 6 months. After the first 6 months the borrower will owe the principal ($100,000) plus the accrued interest ($3,000) as is illustrated below: $100,000 + $3,000 = $103,000 172 Chapter 8: Calcu ulating a Morrtgage Paymeent e second 6 mo onths which is the second semi‐annual compoundin ng period, ano other 3% will In the be charged on the current outstanding balan nce, as is illusstrated below w: $103,00 00 x 3% = $3,0090 The $3,090 represe ents the amo ount of interest charged in the second 6 months. Affter the secon nd 6 mon nths the borrower will owe the outstan nding balancee ($103,000) p plus the accru ued interest ($3,09 90) as is illusttrated below: $103,000 + $3,090 = $1006,090 In thiss example, th he effect of co ompound inte erest, which ssimply meanss charging inteerest on intere est, is clear. If the borrower waas told that he e or she woulld be borrow ing $100,0000 on an interest accruing mortggage over one e year and at the end of th hat year woulld owe $6,0900 in interest, how much would d the interestt rate be if it was w charged only o once a yyear compared to twice? W Written mathe ematically the equation lo ooks like this: X (the unknow wn) x $100,0000 = 6,090 X = 6,,090 / 100,0000 X = .06 6090 OR 6.0900% This means m that J2 2=6% has the exact same effect e as J1=6..09%. In otheer words, theese interest rates are equivalen nt. Pa ause for cla arification n – Equivallent interes est rates Tw wo interest rates are said to be equivaleent if, for thee same amoun nt borrowed over the same period of time, the sam me amount iss owed at thee end of that p period. What has just been n accomplished is a basic rate r conversioon. Howeverr, to perform this task more quickly and efficiently, e the HP10BII financial calculaator will be ussed. 8.4 Converrting an In nterest Rate R with the HP10 0BII Becau use the calculator providess the paymen nt per compouunding period d, the interesst rate must first be b converted to its equivalent interest rate r per comppounding perriod. For exam mple, if calcullating a montthly mortgage e payment wh hen the rate ffor the mortggage is J2=6% without conve erting the rate e, the calculator would pro oduce a paym ment per sem mi‐annual period. This is no ot the de esired calculaation. efore a rate co onversion mu ust first be pe erformed to c onvert the seemi‐annual in nterest rate to o There its mo onthly equivaalent interest rate. Chapter 8: Calculating a Mortgage Payment 173 To accomplish this task using the HP10BII financial calculator, the following keystrokes will be used. Figure 30 – HP10BII NOM% Key The NOM% button is the first key that will be used for an interest rate conversion. It is located on the top row, the second button from the left. NOM% refers to the annual rate of interest. Figure 31 – HP10BII P/YR Key The P/YR button is the second key that will be used for an interest rate conversion. It is located on the top row, the second button from the right. P/YR refers to the number of compounding periods per year. Figure 32 – HP10BII EFF% Key The EFF% button is the third key that will be used for an interest rate conversion. It is located on the top row, the third button from the left and right (the middle button). EFF% refers to the annual rate of interest with one compounding period. Let’s look at an example to convert the interest rate of J2=6% to its equivalent J1 rate. To perform this task the following buttons will be pressed: 6 2 What you should now see on your display is 6.09. Remember to press the keys exactly as shown and do not press any other keys. If you have followed the above keystrokes you will get 6.09 on your display. 174 Chapter 8: Calcu ulating a Morrtgage Paymeent Pa ause for cla arification n – “E” in your y displa ay If you y ever get an a answer on n your calculaator’s display that looks sim milar to this: 9.1 1234567 E‐2 this means thatt you must move the decim mal place twoo places to the left, or the number of plaaces indicated d by the number followingg the E. In thiis example th he actual answ wer would be e .091234567 To ensure that you u are perform ming the necesssary steps, aalways write tthe keystrokees on paper ass you co omplete them m. It is thereffore necessarry to stop usinng pictures an nd begin usin ng the appro opriate notation. The follo owing chart illlustrates the process. Fro om this point fforward, the inputtting will be written w on the left, the keyss that are preessed will be w written in thee middle and the diisplayed outp put on the right. INPUT T KEEYSTROKES OUTP PUT 6 SH HIFT NOM% 6 2 SHIFT S P/YR 2 SHIFT EFF% 6.0 09 Writin ng the previous example would w therefo ore look like tthis: 6 SHIFFT NOM% 2 SHIFFT P/YR SHIFTT EFF% 6.09 Example 1 Let’s look l at anoth her example. The in nterest rate iss J2=4.5% and d the J1 equivvalent rate neeeds to be callculated. Thiss problem would d be solved ussing the following format: 4.5 SH HIFT NOM% 2 SHIFFT P/YR SHIFTT EFF% 4.5506 625 There efore the J1 raate is 4.55062 25% Pa ause for cla arification n – Roundin ng interest rates Intterest rates are NEVER rou unded. Write e the entire raate as it appeears on your d display. Ro ounding the raate would have the effect of changing tthe rate that is charged on n the mo ortgage. 175 Chapter 8: Calculating a Mortgage Payment Example 2 J2=5%, what is the J1 equivalent? 5 SHIFT NOM% 2 SHIFT P/YR SHIFT EFF% 5.0625 Therefore the J1 rate is 5.0625%. Now that converting an interest rate to its J1 equivalent has been mastered it is necessary to take this one step further. As mentioned earlier, the calculator will provide a payment per compounding period. By converting a rate to its J1 equivalent, in other words a rate with one compounding period per year, the calculator will provide an annual mortgage payment. How many mortgage payments are annual? Virtually none! Therefore a conversion to match the frequency of the payment must be completed. Example 3 Bob wishes to take a mortgage that has a rate of J2=6% with monthly payments. What is the equivalent annual rate with monthly compounding? Solution: The following are the steps that must be completed: STEP Step 1: Input the current rate Step 2: Convert to its J1 equivalent Step 3: Convert to the required rate KEYSTROKES 6 SHIFT NOM% MEANING The rate is 6% annually. 2 SHIFT P/YR There are 2 compounding periods per year. SHIFT EFF% This is the J1 rate. A rate must always be converted to the J1 rate before it can be converted to another frequency. 12 SHIFT P/YR We input the number of compounding periods that the new equivalent rate has. SHIFT NOM% We solve for the new rate. 176 Chapter 8: Calculating a Mortgage Payment These steps will be written as follows: 6 SHIFT NOM% 2 SHIFT P/YR SHIFT EFF% 6.09 12 SHIFT P/YR SHIFT NOM% 5.92634643744 Therefore J12 = 5.92634643744% Example 4 Mary wishes to take a mortgage that has a rate of J2=4% with weekly payments. What is the equivalent annual rate with weekly compounding? In this example the payments are weekly which means that the rate must be converted to its weekly equivalent. Since there are 52 weeks in a year 52 must be inputted as the number of annual compounding periods. Solution: 4 SHIFT NOM% 2 SHIFT P/YR SHIFT EFF% 4.04 52 SHIFT P/YR SHIFT NOM% 3.96203408856 Therefore J52 = 3.96203408856% By this point you should be comfortable performing a rate conversion. This is necessary to convert the rate stated by the lender into its equivalent rate with the same number of compounding periods as the payment frequency. If you are still having difficulty, begin this section again and complete the examples and the Review Questions on rate conversions until you are confident enough to move to the next section. These calculations are the necessary first step in being able to calculate a mortgage payment. 8.5 Calculating a Mortgage Payment with the HP10BII Before we can use the buttons required to calculate a mortgage payment, we need to review what they are, where they are and what they look like. Take a moment to review the following chart and find the keys on your calculator. Chapter 8: Calculating a Mortgage Payment 177 Figure 33 – HP10BII Keys Used for Calculating a Mortgage Payment The HP10BII Keys Used for Calculating a Mortgage Payment KEY OR BUTTON HOW IT IS WRITTEN ON PAPER MEANING SHIFT Allows access to the second function of a key SHIFT NOM% By pressing SHIFT first, you access the NOM% key which is where the annual interest rate is inputted. SHIFT P/YR By pressing the SHIFT key, you access the P/YR key which is where the number of compounding frequencies per year is inputted. PMT The PMT key represents the periodic payment. This is the last button pressed when solving for a mortgage payment. SHIFT EFF% By pressing the SHIFT key, you access the EFF% which provides the J1 rate as an answer. N The N key represents the number of compounding periods in total (the number of years multiplied by the number of compounding periods per year). +/‐ The +/‐ key changes a value to a negative amount and is used right before the PV key. PV The PV key represents the present value or the mortgage amount. It must always be preceded by the +/‐ key. FV The FV key represents the future value. It will always be 0 when calculating a mortgage payment. 178 Chapter 8: Calcu ulating a Morrtgage Paymeent nverting an in nterest rate th he foundation n for calculatiing a mortgagge payment h has been laid.. In con The next step is to examine the e process of caalculating a m mortgage payyment, which is outlined in n the fo ollowing chartt. Figure 34 – Calculating g a Mortgage Pa ayment – Keystrrokes STEP Step 1: 1 Input the current rate r Step 2: 2 Conve ert to its J1 equivalent Step 3: 3 Conve ert to the required rate Step 4: 4 Input the mortgage amou unt Step 5: 5 Input the number of comp pounding periods in total MEANING KEYSTTROKES HIFT NOM% SH We input the annu ual rate SHIFFT P/YR SHIFTT EFF% SHIFFT P/YR SHIFTT NOM% (Mortgage amount) a +/‐ PPV (Num mber) N Step 6: 6 Input the Future Value V 0 FV Step 7: 7 Solve for the paym ment PMT P We input the comp pounding frequeency We co onvert to the J1 equivalentt. We m must always co onvert to the J1 ratee before we ccan convert to o anything else. We input the numb ber of compo ounding perio ods that the new eequivalent ratte has. We so olve for the neew rate. We input the morttgage amountt follow wed immediattely by the +//‐ key, th hen the PV bu utton. We input the numb ber of years plied by the n number of multip compo ounding perio ods per year follow wed immediattely by the N button n. The fu uture value w will always be zero. Input 0 follow wed immediately by thee FV button. We prress the PMT button and view tthe results on n the display. Pa ause for cla arification n – “BEGIN N” in your d display If you’re y following the steps exactly and your y mortgagge payment iss still off by a few dollars or cents, check to make sure e that your display is NOT showing BEG GIN. If it is your calculator is calculating interrest at the be eginning of thhe period, nott the end. This is not correct. To fix this t press the e SHIFT key th hen the Beg/EEnd key (the kkey on the second row fro om the top, faar right) Example 1 Mr. Borrower has been approve ed for a morttgage on his hhome in the aamount of $20 00,000. The payments are mon nthly based on an amortizaation of 25 yeears and an in nterest rate o of J2=6%. What is his monthly payment? Chapter 8: Calcu ulating a Morrtgage Paymeent 17 79 Solutiion: 6 SHIFFT NOM% 2 SHIFFT P/YR SHIFTT EFF% 6.09 HIFT P/YR 12 SH SHIFTT NOM% 5.92634643744 200,0 000 +/‐ PV 0 FV 25 X 12 1 N PMT 1,279.61324735 Pa ause for cla arification n – Roundin ng a mortg gage paym ment Fo or practical pu urposes mortggage paymen nts are alwayys rounded up p to the next highest cent. Fo or example, a mortgage payment of $1,279.61001111 would actuaally be $1,279 9.62. Recall, ho owever, that interest ratess are never rounded! There efore the roun nded paymen nt is $1,279.62 Example 2 Mrs. Homeowner H has been app proved for a mortgage m on hher home in tthe amount o of $420,000. The payments are weekly based d on an amorrtization of 300 years and an n interest ratte of J2=4.5%. What is her weeklyy payment? Solutiion: 4.5 SH HIFT NOM% 2 SHIFFT P/YR SHIFTT EFF% 4.5506 625 52 SH HIFT P/YR SHIFTT NOM% 4.45202652104 420,0 000 +/‐ PV 0 FV 30 X 52 5 N 180 Chapter 8: Calcu ulating a Morrtgage Paymeent 4 73 PMT 488.0044176 There efore the roun nded paymen nt is $488.01 Su uccess Tip ‐ N In the above exxample the am mortization iss 30 years witth weekly payyments. Thatt means that yo ou must input 30 x 52 as th he N. Always remember thhat the N is th he total numb ber of compounding periods p multiiplied by the total t numberr of years. Example 3 Malikk is obtaining a second morrtgage to payy off his creditt card debt. H He has been aapproved for a morrtgage in the amount of $3 32,500. The payments p aree monthly bassed on an am mortization of 15 years and an intterest rate off J2=9.55% wiith a one yearr term. Whatt is his paymeent? Solutiion: 9.55 SHIFT S NOM% 2 SHIFFT P/YR SHIFTT EFF% 9.7780 00625 HIFT P/YR 12 SH SHIFTT NOM% 9.36535833066 32,50 00 +/‐ PV 0 FV 15 X 12 1 N PMT 336.7375526 19 3 There efore the roun nded paymen nt is $336.74 Pa ause for cla arification n – Term’s effect on a mortgag ge paymen nt In the above exxample there is a one‐yearr term. The teerm does nott affect the blended paayment as the e payment is calculated c based on comppletely repayin ng the mortgage over the en ntire amortizaation period of o the loan. Chapter 8: Calculating a Mortgage Payment 8.6 181 Calculating an Interest Only Mortgage Payment The difference between a blended mortgage payment and an interest only mortgage payment is that an interest only mortgage payment doesn’t contain any principal. That means that the amount that you borrow will be the amount that you owe at the end of the term because you are only repaying the interest due during the mortgage and not any of the principal. This also means that interest only mortgages are not amortized because there is no principal reduction. Example 1 John is obtaining a $14,500 second mortgage from a private lender. The rate is 14.5% compounded semi‐annually with monthly payments of interest only. The term of the mortgage is 1 year. Because it is an interest only mortgage there is no amortization. Solution: 14.5 SHIFT NOM% 2 SHIFT P/YR SHIFT EFF% 15.025625 12 SHIFT P/YR SHIFT NOM% 14.08044164941 14,500 +/‐ PV the future value is the same as the present value because no principal is being repaid 14,500 FV 12 N PMT 170.1386699303 Therefore the rounded payment is $170.14 we're using 12 N because this mortgage is for one year 182 8.7 Chapter 8: Calculating a Mortgage Payment Using the SHARP EL-738 (refer to this guide only If you are using the Sharp EL‐738 Calculator) NOTE: you don’t need to know how to calculate an equivalent interest rate using the Sharp EL‐738. It is not part of the process to calculate a mortgage payment as it is with the HP. Example: We are borrowing $400,000 at a rate of 6.5% compounded semi‐annually (J2), with monthly payments. What is the monthly payment? Before using, set the calculator to display 9 decimal places by pressing SETUP 0 0 9 After this you should see 0.000000000 on your display. STEP Step 1: Clear the Calculator KEYSTROKES 2ndF CA Step 2: Input the number of payments per year 2ndF P/Y 12 ENT Step 3: Input the number of compounding periods per year 2 ENT Step 4: Quit the C/Y input ON/C MEANING Sets the calculator to its default values We tell the calculator how many payments there are annually. Monthly is 12; Biweekly is 26; Weekly is 52 Press the down arrow key first. Your display will now show C/Y= Then we input the number of compounding periods per year. For example, a semi-annual rate has 2 compounding periods. An annual rate has 1 compounding period. A monthly rate has 12 compounding periods. By pressing the ON/C button we leave the C/Y input. We can now enter the rest of the mortgage information. What you see on your display 0.000000000 P/Y = 12.000000000 C/Y = 2.000000000 0.000000000 Chapter 8: Calculating a Mortgage Payment Step 4: Input the total number of payments in the entire amortization Step 5: Input the mortgage amount, known as the Present Value or PV Step 6: Input the annual interest rate Step 7: Input the amount owing at the end of the amortization, known as the Future Value or FV Step 8: Solve for the payment Step 9: Round the payment up 183 25 X 12 = N We input the number of years multiplied by the number of compounding periods per year followed immediately by the N button. ANS=N 300.0000000 400000 +/- PV We input the mortgage amount followed immediately by the +/key, then the PV button. (-400000)=PV -400,000.0000 6.5 I/YR We input the annual rate. 6.5=I/Y 6.500000000 0 FV The future value will always be zero. Input 0 followed immediately by the FV button. 0=FV 0.000000000 We press the PMT PMT= button and view the COMP PMT 2679.295144 results on the display. Rounding up means that the second decimal place will always go up to the next highest cent. In this example 2679.295144 becomes $2,679.30 Using the SHARP EL‐738 to calculate equivalent interest rates Example: J2=6% What is its J12 equivalent? STEP Step 1: Clear the Calculator Step 2: Input the number of compounding periods per year Step 3: Input the rate MEANING What you see on your display 2ndF CA Sets the calculator to its default values 0.000000000 2 (x,y) Tells the calculator the first of the variables, the compounding frequency 2,_ 0.000000000 KEYSTROKES 6 2ndF EFF Converts the rate of J2=6% to its J1 2,6 EFF equivalent, which is the 6.090000000 effective annual rate 184 Step 4: Input the effective annual rate Step 5: Input the new number of compounding periods and solve for the APR Chapter 8: Calculating a Mortgage Payment 12 (x,y) 6.09 2ndF APR Tells the calculator the first of the variables, the compounding frequency Converts the J1=6.09% to equivalent 12,_ 0.000000000 rate of 2,6 EFF its J12 5.926346437 185 Chapter 8: Calculating a Mortgage Payment 8.8 Using the Texas Instruments BAII Plus (refer to this guide only If you are using the TI BAII Plus Calculator) NOTE: you don’t need to know how to calculate an equivalent interest rate using the BAII Plus. It is not part of the process to calculate a mortgage payment as it is with the HP. Example: We are borrowing $400,000 at a rate of 6.5% compounded semi‐annually (J2), with monthly payments. What is the monthly payment? Before beginning you need to set your calculator to a floating decimal place. Press 2nd FORMAT 9 ENTER STEP Step 1: Clear the Calculator Step 2: Input the annual interest rate (I/Y) KEYSTROKES MEANING What you see on your display 2nd CLR TVM 2nd is the first button on the second row from the top; CLR TVM is the upper function of the last button on the second row from the top; NOTE: the P/Y and C/Y will be reset to 1, which is their beginning value 0 6.5 I/Y Step 3: Input the number of payments per year (P/Y) 2nd P/Y 12 ENTER Step 3: Input the number of compounding periods per year (C/Y) 2 ENTER Step 4: Leave the C/Y Mode 2nd QUIT We input the annual rate. We tell the calculator how many payments there are annually. Monthly is 12; Biweekly is 26; Weekly is 52 A semi-annual rate has 2 compounding periods. An annual rate has 1 compounding period. A monthly rate has 12 compounding periods. By pressing the 2nd QUIT buttons we leave the C/Y input. We can now enter the rest of the mortgage information. I/Y = 6.5 P/Y = 12 C/Y = 2 0 186 Chapter 8: Calculating a Mortgage Payment Step 5: Input the total number of payments in the entire amortization (N) Step 6: Input the mortgage amount, known as the Present Value or PV Step 7: Input the amount owing at the end of the amortization, known as the Future Value or FV Step 8: Solve for the payment (PMT) Step 9: Round the payment up 25 X 12 = N We input the number of years multiplied by the number of compounding periods per year followed immediately by the N button. N = 300 400000 +/- PV We input the mortgage amount followed immediately by the +/key, then the PV button. PV = -400,000 0 FV The future value will always be zero. Input 0 followed immediately by the FV button. FV = 0 We press the CPT then the PMT button and PMT = CPT PMT view the results on the 2,679.295144 display. Rounding up means that the second decimal place will always go up to the next highest cent. In this example 2679.295144 becomes $2,679.30 Using the Texas Instruments BAII Plus to convert an interest rate Example: J2 = 4.5%. What is the J12 equivalent? We enter the rate, then convert to its J1 equivalent, then convert to its J12 equivalent STEP KEYSTROKES Step 1: Switch to the conversion mode 2nd ICONV Step 2: Clear the calculator’s conversion mode 2nd CLR WORK MEANING 2nd is the first button on the second row from the top; ICONV is on top of the 2 button 2nd is the first button on the second row from the top; CLR WORK is the upper function of the button on the lower left hand side of the calculator. What you see on your display Doesn’t matter NOM= 0 Chapter 8: Calculating a Mortgage Payment Step 3: Input the effective annual interest rate (NOM) 4.5 ENTER Step 4: Input the number of compounding periods per year (C/Y) of the rate now 2 ENTER Step 5: Convert to the effective annual interest rate CPT Step 6: Enter the number of compounding periods we want to convert to 12 ENTER Step 7: Convert to the new interest rate CPT 187 You will see the NOM= in the left hand side of your display. NOM= 4.5 We input the annual interest rate. You will see the C/Y= in the left hand side of your display. The rate has 2 C/Y= 2. compounding periods, so we enter 2 compounding periods in C/Y You will see the EFF= in the left hand side of your display. We press the CPT EFF= 4.550625 button (top left button) to calculate the effective rate. You will see the C/Y= in the left hand side of your display. We’re converting to C/Y= 12. J12, so we enter 12 compounding periods in C/Y You will see NOM= in the left hand side of your display. We press NOM= the CPT button (top left 4.45838349 button) to calculate the new nominal rate 188 8.9 Chapter 8: Calcu ulating a Morrtgage Paymeent Advanc ced Mortg gage Callculations s Please Note: The following f calcculations are not required for testing p purposes on th he final exam m. They are here for your y informattion and to asssist you if yoou wish to calculate additio onal comp ponents of a mortgage m for your client. Acc elerating g a Mortg age By acccelerating a mortgage, m the e borrower is increasing thhe size of the mortgage paayment. The follow wing example illustrates ho ow to calculatte the amounnt saved by acccelerating a mortgage. Example A client has come to t you for advvice. She req quires a mortggage in the am mount of $35 50,000. You have informed herr that you can n obtain this mortgage m bassed on a rate of 4.9%, com mpounded semi‐annually, nott in advance, amortized ovver 25 years w with a 5 year tterm and monthly payments. She wo ould like to kn now what the e regular paym ment is in thiss scenario, an nd how much she would w save if she s decided to accelerate this t mortgagee with weeklyy payments. Solutiion The first step that must be unde ertaken is the e calculation oof the mortgaage payment. 4.9 SH HIFT NOM% 2 SHIFFT P/YR SHIFTT EFF% 4.9600 025 12 SH HIFT P/YR SHIFTT NOM% 4.85 5071533217 350,0 000 +/‐ PV 0 FV 25 x 12 1 N PMT 2,015.738940 058 Pa ause for cla arification n – Using th he “+/‐“ Ke Key When inputtingg the present value we use e the “+/‐“ keey to make the mortgage aamount a ne egative number. This results in the payment being a positive num mber. If you d do not use the “+/‐“ key the paayment will be b a negative number. Thi s is importan nt in the next example be ecause when entering e a changed payme ent amount yyou must enteer it as a posittive number if yo ou’ve used the e “+/‐“ key ass instructed above. If you haven’t, you will need to eenter the changed payme ent as a negattive! Chapter 8: Calcu ulating a Morrtgage Paymeent 18 89 efore the regu ular monthly payment in th his scenario i s $2,015.74. At the end of the There amorttization of thiis mortgage she s will have paid $604, 7222 ($2,015.744 x 300 paymeents). Howe ever, the morttgage has a te erm of 5 yearrs and it will nnot renew on the exact terrms of the current term. It is therefore ne ecessary to calculate how m much she will owe at the eend of the firsst 5 years of the mortgage to realistically deterrmine how m uch money she will save b by acceleratin ng this mortgage. m To accomplish this t requires the t learning oof a new proccess: calculatiing the outstaanding balancce of a mortggage. Calc culating the t Outsttanding Balance B ((OSB) of a Mortga age The process of calcculating an ou utstanding baalance (OSB) oof a mortgagee at a point in n time provid des the mortggage agent th he informatio on required too calculate the amount savved by accele erating a morrtgage payme ent. To accom mplish this tassk requires ussing two addiitional keys: the IN NPUT function n and the AM MORT function n. The IN NPUT function is located on o the first bu utton on the l eft hand sidee of the secon nd row from the to op. The AMO ORT function is the second function of thhe FV button used in prevvious calcullations and is located at th he far right of the top row.. To access th he AMORT function, the user must m first press the SHIFT key. Usingg the previouss example the e outstandingg balance will be calculated d at the end o of its five‐yeaar term (sixty monthlly payments).. The calculattion is perfor med using the following p process. Pa ause for cla arification n – Importa ant note a about the H HP10BII + If you y are usingg the HP10BII + (not the HP P10BII) you neeed to change the calculattor from a flo oating decimaal place to a fiixed decimal place. To do this press SH HIFT, DISP 9. TThis will set the e calculator to 9 decimal places. p If you don’t do thiss you will see the word RU UNNING on yo our display wh hen completin ng step 3. STEP 1: Calculate the t mortgage e payment 4.9 SH HIFT NOM% 2 SHIFFT P/YR SHIFTT EFF% 4.9600 025 12 SH HIFT P/YR SHIFTT NOM% 4.85 5071533217 350,0 000 +/‐ PV 0 FV 25 x 12 1 N PMT 2,015.738940 058 190 Chapter 8: Calcu ulating a Morrtgage Paymeent p roun nded mortgage payment. STEP 2: Input the properly 2,015 5.74 PMT STEP 3: Calculate the t outstanding balance at a the end of the term. The fo ollowing keysstrokes are re equired to acccomplish this task, where 112 representss the numberr of perriods per year and 5 represents the num mber of yearss in the term:: 12 x 5 INP PUT SHIFT AM MORT 60 – 60” should be displayeed. It is now necessary to press the “=”” Once those keys arre pressed “6 button. Once presssed, “Amort”” should appe ear at the topp left of the display, “PRIN”” should appeaar below it an nd 762.43802562 should appear below that. “Amorrt” representss “Amo ortization,” “P PRIN” represe ents “principle e” and the nuumber repressents the totaal principal paid in period 60 – 60, which re epresents the e sixtieth paym ment. By pre essing the “=”” button a seccond time “IN NT” replaces ““PRIN” and 1,253.3019742 28 replaces the prrevious numb ber. This num mber represen nts the amou nt of interestt paid in the ssixtieth payment. By presssing the “=” button b a third d time, “BAL” appears, replacing “INT” aand “‐ 309,2 287.166263” replaces r the previous p num mber. This nu mber represeents the outsttanding balance remainingg on the mortggage after the sixtieth payyment has been made (in o other words aat the en nd of the 5‐ye ear term). p is writtten like this: This process NPUT SHIFT AMORT A = = = ‐‐309,287.1666263 12 x 5 IN efore, in this scenario, s at th he end of the e five‐year terrm the client will owe $309 9,287.17. There Pa ause for cllarification n ‐ Roundin ng outstan nding bala ances Ou utstanding baalances are always rounde ed off. This m means that if tthe 3rd decimaal place is 5 o or nd higher, the 2 decimal place e increases by one; if it is 4 or lower the 2nd decimall place re emains the same. Exxample: An n outstandingg balance of $400,000.123 $ is $400,000. 12 because the 3rd decimaal place is 3 (w which is 4 or lo ower). is $400,000. 13 because the 3rd decimaal place is 6 An n outstandingg balance of $400,000.126 $ (w which is 5 or higher) h It is now necessaryy to calculate the outstand ding balance aat the end of five years baased on an accele erated payme ent. To accele erate this mortgage the moonthly paymeent is divided d by four. $2,01 15.74 / 4 = $50 03.935 ment must no ow be inputteed into the caalculator. Thiss will be donee The accelerated mortgage paym by re‐‐entering the mortgage with a weekly payment. p Chapter 8: Calculating a Mortgage Payment 191 4.9 SHIFT NOM% 2 SHIFT P/YR SHIFT EFF% 4.960025 52 SHIFT P/YR SHIFT NOM% 4.84319177322 350,000 +/‐ PV 0 FV 25 x 52 N PMT 464.449035727 The accelerated payment is now entered by completing the following keystrokes: 503.94 PMT Now that the new payment has successfully been inputted, the outstanding balance at the end of the term can be calculated using the following keystrokes, where 52 represents the number of periods per year and 5 represents the number of years in the term: 52 x 5 INPUT SHIFT AMORT = = = ‐297,675.736723 Therefore the amount owing at the end of the first five years using an accelerated payment is $297,675.74. This equates to a difference of $11,611.43 ($309,287.17‐ $297,675.74). However, the client wishes to know the amount that she will save over the first five years by accelerating the payment, and this amount does not represent the savings. This is because the payment has been increased and the extra money paid during the term of the mortgage must be subtracted from the savings. Therefore, under the monthly payment scenario the client would pay $120,944.40 during the five‐year term ($2,015.74 x 60) and under the weekly accelerated payment scenario the client would pay $131,024.40 ($503.94 x 260). Therefore, the client is actually paying $10,080 more under the accelerated scenario during the same period ($131,024.40 ‐ $120,944.40). This amount must be deducted from the difference between the two outstanding balances. $11,611.43 ‐ $10,080 = $1,531.43 Therefore the client would have a net savings of $1,531.43 over the first five years of her mortgage by using an accelerated weekly payment. 192 Chapter 8: Calculating a Mortgage Payment Example Based on borrowing $400,000 over 25 years at a rate of J2=5% with monthly payments and a five‐year term, calculate the savings realized during the term of the mortgage by accelerating the mortgage payment. Solution Step 1: Calculate the payment of the monthly mortgage 5 SHIFT NOM% 2 SHIFT P/YR SHIFT EFF% 5.0625 12 SHIFT P/YR SHIFT NOM% 4.94869855817 400,000 +/‐ PV 0 FV 25 x 12 N PMT 2,326.41994015 Step 2: Input the new payment 2,326.42 PMT Step 3: Calculate the OSB of the monthly mortgage 12 x 5 INPUT SHIFT AMORT = = = ‐354,030.024726 Step 4: Calculate the accelerated payment 2326.42 / 4 = 581.605 Step 5: Convert the rate to its weekly equivalent 5 SHIFT NOM% 2 SHIFT P/YR SHIFT EFF% 5.0625 52 SHIFT P/YR SHIFT NOM% 4.94086835724 Step 6: Change the amortization to weekly 52 x 25 N Step 7: Input the accelerated payment 581.61 PMT Step 8: Calculate the OSB of the accelerated mortgage 52 x 5 INPUT SHIFT AMORT = = = ‐340,590.299687 Step 9: Using the information calculated in the above equation, calculate the total savings of the accelerated mortgage. Savings = (OSB of mthly mtg – OSB of weekly mtg) – (Total weekly pmts – Total mthly pmts) Savings = (354,030.02 – 340,590.30) – [(581.61 x 260) ‐ (2,326.42 x 60)] Savings = $13,439.72 – ($151,218.60 ‐ $139,585.20) Savings = $13,439.72 ‐ $11,633.40 Savings = $1,806.32 Therefore the net amount saved over the term of this mortgage, by using accelerated payments, is $1,806.32. Chapter 8: Calcu ulating a Morrtgage Paymeent 19 93 Calc culating the t prepa ayment p enalty on n a partia ally open morrtgage In the e chapter, “Ad dvanced Morttgage Concep pts” we learneed about the different preepayment penalties. In this section s we explore the pro ocess of calcu lating these p penalties. Lett’s begin with h an exaample. Barbaara, the borro ower, has an outstanding o mortgage m amoount of $145,533.80. On tthe 36th payment, she has decided d to re epay the entirre amount of the outstand ding mortgagee. The lenderr has th he option of charging c Barb bara 3 monthss’ interest as a penalty or tthe interest rrate differential, whichever one is higher. There efore, the current rate of in nterest for a similar s mortggage from thee lender mustt be known to o determine which penalty p the le ender will charge the clientt. For this illu ustration, it w will be med that the lender’s l curre ent posted rate on its 2‐yeear term morttgage is 6% co ompounded assum semi‐annually, nott in advance. Her cu urrent rate off interest is 7.15% compou unded semi‐aannually, with h monthly payyments, a 25‐‐ and a 5‐year term. The am year amortization a mortization a nd term are n not required for the 3 month interest calculation, how wever in the IRD calculatioon the term iss required for calculating the nu umber of months remainin ng in Barbaraa’s mortgage w with her currrent lender an nd the amorttization is req quired when calculating c th he outstandin g balance at tthe end of th he term. 3 M onths’ In terest Pe enalty The fo ormula used to t determine e 3 months’ in nterest penaltty is: Penalty = Outstanding O Balance of the Mortgage x (Rate / 12 m months) X 3 m months The raate must be converted c to its monthly equivalent e (J1 2) since a sem mi‐annual ratte cannot be divide ed by twelve. The rate will then be divided by 100 too convert thee interest ratee to a decimaal. For exxample, J12 = 7.04576428197 is actually .07045764228197 when u used in a form mula. Penalty = $1 145,533.80 x [(7.04576428 8197 (equivallent monthly rate / 100))] / 12 x 3 80 x .07045766428197) / 122 x 3 Penalty = ($145,533.8 Penaalty = $145,533.80 x .005887147023 X 3 Pe enalty = $145 5,533.80 x .01176144107 Penalty = $2,563.49211243 Penalty = $2,563.449 There efore, the pen nalty that Barbara would have h to pay baased on 3 mo onths’ interesst penalty equattes to $2,563.49. 194 Chapter 8: Calcu ulating a Morrtgage Paymeent Inte rest Rate e Differen ntial The in nterest rate differential d pe enalty must be calculated tto determinee what Barbarra’s penalty will be e. For the folllowing illustrration, the Raate Differentiaal refers to th he difference between Barbaara’s rate and the current rate. r The fo ormula used to t determine e the interest rate differenttial penalty iss: Penalty = (Rate Diffferential / 12 2 months) x (tthe number oof months rem maining in Barbara’s mortggage) x (Outsttanding Balan nce) First, the rate diffe erential must be converted d to its monthhly rate, as was done in the 3 months’ intere est penalty caalculation. Th he rate of 7.15 5% compoun ded semi‐ann nually minus the rate of 6% % comp pounded semii‐annually leaaves a differen nce of 1.15%,, compoundeed semi‐annuaally. That ratte is then converted to t its monthlyy equivalent of o 1.14725444339. When cconverted to its decimal equivalent, the number is .0114 47254439. Penalty = (.0 01147254433 39) / 12 x (60 – 36) x $145,533.80 Penalty = .000956045366 x 24 x $145,533.80 Penalty = $3,339.285996149 Penalty = $3,339.229 There efore, the pen nalty under th he interest ratte differentiaal scenario is $$3,339.29. Conclusion In thiss scenario, Baarbara would be charged the interest raate differential of $3,339.2 29 since it is the hiigher of the tw wo penalties that the lend der has the opption of chargging. 8.10 0 Conclu usion In thiss chapter you u have learned d how to calcculate a basic mortgage paayment. The HP10BII can also be b used to: Calculate the ouutstanding baalance of an interest accruuing or reversse mortgage Dissplay the prinncipal and/or interest portion of a paym ment Dissplay the totaal amount of principal and/or interest ppaid in a streaam of paymennts (for exaample, in a te erm) Calculate the Coost of Borrow wing Calculate the Prresent Value of an investm ment Calculate the Fuuture Value of o an investme ent Calculate the paayment requiired to obtainn a Future Vallue Calculate the innterest rate chharged on a mortgage m wheere it is not known Calculate the raate of interestt required to obtain a Futuure Value, and Sevveral other fuunctions whicch are more advanced a andd are typicallyy taught in mo ortgage financing courses; however keep in mind that you cann use this calcculator for maany functions oth her than simp ply calculatingg a mortgage payment. Chapter 8: Calcu ulating a Morrtgage Paymeent 19 95 or to calculate e a mortgage payment cann also be quitte advantageo ous when Usingg the calculato meetiing a client ou utside of your office and iff you do not hhave your lap ptop. In this m manner you can caalculate the payment p for a client and trruly demonst rate your pro ofessionalism! Su uccess Tip – Practice! While these calculations pro obably seem very v complicaated, the old saying, “Practice makes pe erfect” definittely applies to o using the fin nancial calcul ator. By praccticing these calculations yo ou can masterr using the HP P10BII and confidently perrform these calculations fo or the benefitt of your client! 196 Chapter 8: Calculating a Mortgage Payment 8.11 Key Terms and Definitions Amortization Period The total amount of time required to fully repay a mortgage Compounding Frequency The number of times per year in which an interest rate is charged. Typical compounding frequencies include semi‐annually and monthly. EFF% The J1 rate or the annual interest rate with only one compounding period Equivalent Interest Rate A rate that is equal to another. Two rates are said to be equal if, for the same amount borrowed over the same period of time, the same amount is owed at the end of that period Floating Decimal Place The calculator provides the answer on the display to the number of decimal places the number requires without rounding. FV The future value also referred to as the outstanding balance at a given point in time HP10BII The financial calculator used to compute several mortgage calculations Interest Rate The rate at which interest, which is a fee paid to the lender for borrowing money, is calculated Interest Rate Conversion The process of converting a rate to its equivalent with a different frequency of compounding Mortgage Amount The amount of money borrowed, also referred to as the present value N The key on the HP10BII representing the total number of compounding periods required to repay a mortgage NOM% The key on the HP10BII representing the annual rate of interest Outstanding Balance The same as the future value, this is the amount owed at a given point in time. P/YR The key on the HP10BII representing the total number of compounding periods per year Chapter 8: Calculating a Mortgage Payment 197 PMT The key on the HP10BII representing the payment or the amount required to be repaid per compounding period PV The key on the HP10BII representing the Present Value, also referred to as the mortgage amount Rounded Payment A payment that has been properly rounded. A mortgage payment is rounded up to the next highest cent unless otherwise indicated. Term A contracted period of time in which mortgage payments are made. At the end of this period the contract is renewed, typically resulting in a different interest rate and payment amount. 198 ulating a Morrtgage Paymeent Chapter 8: Calcu 8.12 2 Review w Questio ons Answers to the Revview Questio ons are found at www.REM MIC.ca Sho ort Answe er Questio ons 1. No ote: This quesstion does nott apply to the e Sharp or Texxas Instrumen nts calculatorrs. Your client has asked you wh hich interest rate is lower:: 6% compoun nded semi‐an nnually or 93% compoun nded monthlyy. Which rate e is lower? 5.9 2. No ote: This quesstion does nott apply to the e Sharp or Texxas Instrumen nts calculatorrs. Perform the following rate conversions: c a. J12 = 7%. What W is the J4 4 equivalent? b. J4 = 3.2%. What W is the J1 12 equivalentt? c. J12 = 3%. What W is the J2 2 equivalent? d. J365 = 18%. What is the e J1 equivalen nt? 3. Your client has asked you to tell her the amount a of he r mortgage p payment baseed on the folllowing propo osed mortgagge: $295,500 mortgage am mortized overr 35 years witth an interestt ratte of 4.25% co ompounded semi‐annually s y, not in advaance, with weeekly paymen nts and a 3 year term. Whaat is her prop posed paymen nt? 4. Calculate the paayment for th he following mortgages: m a. $470,000 mortgage, m 25 year y amortizaation, monthlly payments, 3 year term, J2=6% b. $350,000 mortgage, m 40 year y amortizaation, bi‐wee kly paymentss, 5 year term m, J2=5.57% c. $20,000 seccond mortgagge, 15 year am mortization, m monthly paym ments, 15 yeaar term, J2=14% d. $1,250,000 mortgage, 35 5 year amortization, weekkly payments,, 5 year term,, J2=3.75% 5. Yo our client doe es not qualifyy for an institu utional mortggage so you h have arranged d a private se econd mortgaage for him. The T mortgage e amount is $$34,500 and tthe interest raate is 13% co ompounded semi‐annually s y. The month hly payments are interest only for one yyear. What iss th he amount off the proposed mortgage payment? p (H int: the preseent value and the future vaalue are the same s because e there is no principal p beinng repaid) Chapter 9: Attracting a Client 199 Chapter 9: Attracting a Client Learning Outcomes Successful understanding of the concepts presented in this chapter will enable the learner to: Discuss the impact of regulation and legislation on the marketing activities of mortgage agents Discuss the importance of and differences between a mission and vision Statement Discuss the importance of different types of business cards Explain networking and how to be successful at it Explain the marketing of intangibles Discuss the benefits of testimonials Illustrate how to differentiate oneself from the competition Explain database marketing Discuss various methods of obtaining referrals Introduction In the mortgage brokerage industry, there are two vital components to success: attracting a client and being able to achieve that client’s financing needs. Without a client a mortgage agent’s technical expertise in mortgage financing is useless. Today’s mortgage brokerage industry is comprised of over nine thousand mortgage agents in Ontario, all of whom are vying for the consumers’ attention. Some do this extremely well but it takes most several years to obtain a level of success that equates to a comfortable lifestyle. This is due in large part to a lack of understanding that in the mortgage brokerage industry the majority of work that is performed is sales‐related. The ability to obtain a mortgage broker’s or agent’s license, while vitally important, is of little consolation if the broker or agent doesn’t have a sufficient flow of clients to generate a sustainable income. In referring back to the 80‐20 rule discussed earlier, it is, at least anecdotally, a fact that twenty percent of sales people will produce eighty percent of the business in any commission based industry. This is a truism for several reasons, but primarily because the commissioned agent is his or her own boss. If he or she has a focused, disciplined and committed boss then success can follow. However, if his or her boss allows frequent time off and does not provide a structured environment in which to flourish the agent will typically fail. The net result of this relationship is that the commissioned agent must have a dedication to his or her success that, at the outset of his or her career, is equal to that of a new business. A recent survey produced by Entrepreneur.com found that approximately 50% of businesses failed during the first four years of business. This actually contradicts the statement that eighty percent of businesses fail in the first year of business, a statement that has attained the status of urban myth. Both statements, however, illustrate the difficulty that new businesses have in the early stages of their development and the commissioned agent is no exception to this rule. As an individual making a career change, moving into sales for the first time or leaving a financial institution to undertake a new challenge, the mortgage brokerage industry can be an incredibly 200 Chapter 9: Attractingg a Client c if done e properly. Th his can be de fined as having a sound teechnical rewarrding career choice knowledge of the mortgage m ind dustry as well as the abilityy to attract an nd keep clientts. This chapter c will exxplore some successful s strrategies for thhe mortgage agent in meeeting the goall of attracting clientts, with a focu us on advertissing, networkking, marketin ng, and datab base management. 9.1 The Impa act of Reg gulation and a Legis slation The activities available to attracct a client are e numerous, aand many aree impacted byy legislation and other o industryy guidelines. Legislation an nd industry guuidelines are designed to prevent such practiices as misleaading advertissing, the bait and switch (pproviding a co onsumer with h an attractive offer to obtain him m or her as a client c but being unable to provide the p product or service at the indicaated price), faalse advertisin ng and so on. d legislation Before addressing the methodss used to attraact a client, thhe industry gguidelines and that affect a these methods m mustt be discussed d. The first seet of guidelines that need to be explored is called the t Canadian Code of Adve ertising Standdards. The Canadia an Code of o Adverttising Sta andards The Canadian C Code e of Advertisiing Standardss was createdd by the adverrtising industry in 1963 to promote the profe essional practtice of advertiising. This Coode is regularrly updated byy Advertising Stand dards Canada,, (ASC), which h was founded in 1957. Thhis not‐for‐profit, self‐regu ulatory body regulaates the adve ertising industtry and handles consumerr complaints rrelated to advvertising. The Code C promote es truth, hone esty, fairness,, and accuracyy in advertising and is com mprised of fourte een clauses th hat set the crriteria for acce eptable adve rtising. The ffollowing is a condensed versio on of those clauses: 1. Acccuracy and Clarity C Adverrtisements must not contaain inaccurate e or deceptivee claims, statements, illusttrations or representations, either direct or o implied, witth regard to a product or sservice. In asssessing the truthffulness and accuracy of a message, m the concern is noot with the in ntent of the seender or precisse legality of the t presentattion. Rather, the focus is oon the messaage as receiveed or perce eived, i.e. the general imprression conve eyed by the addvertisementt. 2. Dissguised Adve ertising Techn niques No ad dvertisement shall be presented in a format or style that conceals its commercial intent. 3. Priice Claims No ad dvertisement shall include deceptive prrice claims or discounts, un nrealistic pricce comp parisons or exaggerated claaims as to wo orth or value. ait and Switch h 4. Ba Adverrtisements must not misre epresent the consumer’s c oopportunity to o purchase th he goods and servicces at the term ms presented d. Chapter 9: Attracting a Client 201 5. Guarantees No advertisement shall offer a guarantee or warranty, unless the guarantee or warranty is fully explained as to conditions and limits and the name of the guarantor or warrantor is provided, or it is indicated where such information may be obtained. 6. Comparative Advertising Advertisements must not unfairly discredit, disparage or attack other products, services, advertisements or companies, or exaggerate the nature or importance of competitive differences. 7. Testimonials Testimonials, endorsements or representations of opinion or preference, must reflect the genuine, reasonably current opinion of the individual(s), group or organization making such representations, and must be based upon adequate information about or experience with the product or service being advertised, and must not otherwise be deceptive. 8. Professional or Scientific Claims Advertisements must not distort the true meaning of statements made by professionals or scientific authorities. 9. Imitation No advertiser shall imitate the copy, slogans or illustrations of another advertiser in such a manner as to mislead the consumer. 10. Safety Advertisements must not without reason, justifiable on educational or social grounds, display a disregard for safety by depicting situations that might reasonably be interpreted as encouraging unsafe or dangerous practices, or acts. 11. Superstition and Fears Advertisements must not exploit superstitions or play upon fears to mislead the consumer. 12. Advertising to Children Advertising that is directed to children must not exploit their credulity, lack of experience or their sense of loyalty, and must not present information or illustrations that might result in their physical, emotional or moral harm. Child‐directed advertising in the broadcast media is separately regulated by the Broadcast Code for Advertising to Children, also administered by ASC. Advertising to children in Quebec is prohibited by the Quebec Consumer Protection Act. 13. Advertising to Minors Products prohibited from sale to minors must not be advertised in such a way as to appeal particularly to persons under legal age, and people featured in advertisements for such products must be, and clearly seen to be, adults under the law. 14. Unacceptable Depictions and Portrayals It is recognized that advertisements may be distasteful without necessarily conflicting with the provisions of this clause; the fact that a particular product or service may be offensive to some people is not sufficient grounds for objecting to an advertisement for that product or service. Advertisements shall not: 202 Chapter 9: Attractingg a Client orm of person nal discriminaation, includinng that based d upon race, n national origin n, (a) condone any fo relligion, sex or age; (b) ap ppear in a realistic mannerr to exploit, co ondone or inccite violence;; nor appear tto condone, o or dirrectly encouraage, bullying;; nor directly encourage, oor exhibit obvvious indiffereence to, unlawful behavviour; (c) de emean, denigrrate or disparrage any iden ntifiable persoon, group of p persons, firm,, organization n, ind dustrial or com mmercial activity, professiion, product oor service or attempt to bring it or them m intto public conttempt or ridiccule; (d) un ndermine hum man dignity; or o display obvvious indiffereence to, or en ncourage, graatuitously and d witthout merit, conduct c or atttitudes that offend o the staandards of pu ublic decencyy prevailing am mong a significcant segmentt of the population. Pa ause for cla arification n – Advertiising Stand dards Cana ada Mo ore informatiion on Adverttising Standaards Canada ccan be found by visiting ww ww.adstandards.com Leg islation Adverrtising and maarketing, refe erred to by th he MBLAA andd its Regulatioons as public relations materrials, is discusssed in four sp pecific locatio ons: section 227 of the MBLLAA, sections 7 to 9 of Regullation 187/08 8, sections 5 to 7 of Regula ation 188/08 aand sections 18 to 20 of Regulation 191/0 08. The se ections of Reg gulation 187//08 and Regu ulation 188/088 deal with th he use of nam mes in public relatio ons materialss as well as a prohibition on the usage oof false, misleeading or deceptive inform mation. Pub blic Relat ions Mat erials: Ag gents and d Brokerss To begin, Regulatio on 187/08 de efines the term m “public relaations materiials” as: (a) an ny advertisem ment by the brroker or agen nt in connectioon with his or her status aas a licensee o or hiss or her dealin ng or trading in mortgagess that is publi shed, circulatted or broadccast by any me eans, or (b) an ny material th hat a broker or o agent make es available too the public in n connection with his or her status as a licensee l or his or her dealiing or tradingg in mortgagees. O. Reg. 18 87/08, s. 1 (2)). Pa ause for cla arification n – Examplles of publilic relation ns materialls He ere are some examples of what are con nsidered publ ic relations m materials: Radio ad Businesss cards Magazine ad Newspaaper ad, whether it is a d classifie ed ad or displlay ad Flyer or Bro ochure A sign (i.e ( on a build ding or vehicle e) Website Billboarrd or poster An ad placed on a websitte Bench ad a An advertorrial (an articlee that is an A prom motional email advertisemeent) Chapter 9: Attractingg a Client 20 03 R alsso regulates the use of an agent’s and bbroker’s namee in the follow wing sectionss This Regulation of Reg gulation 187//08. o licensee name Use of 7. A mortgage m age ent or agent shall s not deal or trade in m mortgages in a name otherr than his or her licensee name. O. Reg. 187/08, 1 s. 7. This means m that a broker or age ent can only do d business bby using their name as it is registered with FSCO. F FSCO does d allow an n agent or bro oker to be reggistered in hiss or her full leegal name as well as a an also kno own as, so thaat if your legaal name is, forr example, W William and yo ou are known n as Billl, you can do business usin ng either nam me. Use of o name, etc.,, in public relaations materrials 8. (1)) In all of his or her public relations materials, a morrtgage agent or agent shalll disclose his or her licensee name and the authorized name and liccence number of the brokeerage on wh hose behalf he or she is au uthorized to deal d or trade iin mortgages, and the nam mes and numbers must be b clearly and d prominentlyy disclosed. O O. Reg. 187/008, s. 8 (1). (2) If the authorize ed name of th he brokerage is, or includees, a franchisee name that tthe brokeragee is permitted p to use under a franchise f agre eement, the ppublic relatio ons materials must clearly ind dicate that the brokerage is i independently owned a nd operated.. O. Reg. 187/ 7/08, s. 8 (2). (3) In n the public re elations mate erials, at least one referencce to the brokker or agent m must include one of the following titles an nd the materiials may also include an eq quivalent titlee in another lan nguage: 1. When referrring to a broke er, the title “m mortgage brooker”, “brokeer”, “courtier en hypothèques” or “courtie er” or an abbrreviation of aany of those titles. 2. When referrring to an agent, the title “mortgage “ ageent”, “agent”” or “agent en n hypothèques” or an abbreviation of an ny of those tittles. O. Reg. 187/08, s. 8 ((3). Prohibition re pub blic relations materials 9. A mortgage m age ent or agent shall s not inclu ude false, mis leading or deeceptive inforrmation in hiss or her public relations materrials. O. Reg. 187/08, s. 9. Pub blic Relat ions Mat erials: Mortgage M B Brokerag ges Regullation 188/08 8 defines “pub blic relations materials”, inn relation to a brokerage aas: (a) an ny advertisem ment by the brrokerage in co onnection witth its businesss as a brokerrage that is published, circu ulated or broaadcast by anyy means, or (b) an ny material th hat a brokeragge makes available to the public in connection with its business aas a brokerage; b This Regulation R alsso regulates the use of the e brokerage’s name in thee following sections of Regullation 188/08 8. Use of o authorized name 5. A brokerage b shaall not carry on o business in n a name otheer than its au uthorized nam me. O. Reg. 188/0 08, s. 5. 204 Chapter 9: Attractingg a Client o name, etc.,, in public relaations materrials Use of 6. (1)) A brokerage e shall disclose e its authorized name andd its licence nu umber in all o of its public rellations materrials and the name n and num mber must bee clearly and prominently disclosed. O. Reeg. 188/08, s. 6 (1). (2) If the authorize ed name of a brokerage is, or includes, a franchise n name that thee brokerage iss permitted to usse under a fraanchise agreement, the puublic relationss materials must clearly ind dicate that the brokerage is i independently owned a nd operated.. O. Reg. 188/ 8/08, s. 6 (2). (3) If,, in its public relations matterials, a brokkerage identiffies a broker or agent by n name, the bro okerage shall use the nam me in which th he broker or aagent is licenssed. O. Reg. 1 188/08, s. 6 (3)). or agent, the materials (4) If,, in its public relations matterials, a brokkerage refers to a broker o mu ust include att least one refference to the e broker or a gent that includes one of the followingg titlles, and the materials m mayy also include an equivalennt title in another languagee: 1. When referrring to a broke er, the title “m mortgage brooker”, “brokeer”, “courtier en hypothèques” or o “courtier” or an abbreviiation of any of those titlees. 2. When referrring to an agent, the title “mortgage “ ageent”, “agent”” or “agent en n hypothèques” or o an abbreviation of any of o those titless. O. Reg. 1877/08, s. 8 (3). Mislleading, Deceptiv e and Fa alse Adve ertising As secction 9 of Reg gulation 187//08 states, “A mortgage aggent or agent shall not incllude false, misleaading or dece eptive information in his or her public rrelations mateerials.” To fu ully underrstand the sco ope of this se ection require es a fuller undderstanding o of the terms m misleading, decep ptive and false. Misleadingg can be defin ned as decep tive or tendin ng to create a false impre ession. Misleading advertiising occurs when w a repressentation relaated to a prod duct or servicce is decceptive, materially false or misleading in n order to pe rsuade the co onsumer to b buy it. Decep ptive can be defined d as the e act of convincing anotheer to believe information that is not true, or not the wh hole truth as in certain typ pes of half‐truuths, while fallse can be defined as delibeerately decep ptive. False ad dvertising is the t use of falsse or misleading statemen nts in adverrtising. As advvertising has the potentiall to persuadee people into commercial ttransactions that they might otherwise avoid d, many gove ernments arouund the world d use regulattions to contro ol misleadingg, deceptive or o false adverttising. Broke erages must be b keenly awaare of the deffinitions of th e terms used d in this Regullation, especcially in this cllimate of financial turmoil and the increease of overssight of lendin ng and broke ering practices. Several other jurisdictio ons have alre ady deemed phraseology currently used by some Ontaario brokeragges as deceptive or misleadding. For exaample, the Au ustralian estment Commission penaalized a brokeerage for using the phrasess, Securrities and Inve “independent and impartial” an nd “we work for f most of thhe lenders,” w when this was proven factuaally incorrect.. The contextt is an importtant factor whhen advertisin ng. These same statem ments may be e considered true when made m by one bbrokerage and d false when made by anoth her. The fo ollowing is a list of potentiial terms, phrrases and scennarios that m may also be deeemed to be misleaading, decepttive or false, depending d on n the context in which theey are used. Chapter 9: Attracting a Client 205 “Have access to all / work with all lenders” While the broker/agent making this statement may believe it to be true, does he or she know for certain that his or her brokerage in fact has access to all of the lenders in the industry? In most cases this statement will be factually incorrect since both the Bank of Montreal and the Royal Bank of Canada do not deal directly with brokers. “Access to over 50 lenders” Is this true? The question that must be asked before using this statement is how many lenders did the brokerage actually use in the previous year? The MBLAA and its Regulations require this answer to be disclosed to borrowers when requested. If the brokerage didn’t use in excess of 50 lenders in the previous year, why would its representative make this statement? In other words, what is the goal of this statement? In most cases the goal of this type of statement is to convey to the consumer that the brokerage can shop for the best mortgage for him or her by having access to a vast number of lenders. If the number 50 is factually incorrect the brokerage may be using misleading terminology in its advertising. It should ensure that all of its public relations material accurately reflects the number of lenders that it has actually used and whenever this is not the case the materials should be amended. “No job? No credit? No problem!”, “Good credit, bad credit or no credit...all are approved!”, “Guaranteed approval” These are all statements designed to get a consumer with difficulty in obtaining a mortgage to contact the brokerage, broker or agent. While the argument can be made that anyone can be approved as long as they have enough equity, regardless of their circumstances, these statements could be considered misleading, deceptive or false because they imply that everyone will be approved regardless of their circumstances, which is clearly not possible. “Lowest rates in town” This statement implies that this brokerage has the lowest rates for everyone. Unless a brokerage can prove this statement to be factual, it can be considered misleading, false or deceptive. Consider what the brokerage would have to do to prove this statement. This would require being able to state without doubt that it knows all of the other rates that every brokerage and lender offer and that it has the lowest of them all. While possible, it is not probable and the brokerage would most likely not be able to prove this statement. Quoting teaser or discounted rates without advising of other costs or details For example, quoting a rate of 1%, which may be a three month teaser rate, without indicating that the rate increases after those three months would likely be considered misleading, deceptive or false, as would an advertisement that offered a rate of 1% but didn’t disclose the fact that to obtain this rate required the borrower to pay to buy down the rate. The U.S. Federal Trade Commission (FTC) at one point in 2007 stated that more than 200 companies had been warned about “potentially deceptive” mortgage advertisements. The FTC slammed advertisers for highlighting teaser rates and low payment options without explaining the harsh reality of these loans to consumers. Quoting payments based on extended amortizations that appear to be less expensive than regular amortized mortgage A way to make payments appear lower than they would traditionally appear is to use an extended amortization. If the payment is in fact based on an amortization period in excess of 25 206 Chapter 9: Attractingg a Client t advertisem ment it may bbe considered d misleading since the years and it is not disclosed in the payment is most likely the prim mary selling po oint of the addvertisement.. The British C Columbia Registtrar of Mortggage Brokers included i this example in a n information n bulletin to tthe BC mortggage brokeragge industry1. Bait and a switch This iss a term that reflects when n a brokerage e attracts connsumers by ad dvertising a certain producct at a raate lower thaan the markett rate, but nevver actually pprovides that rate. For exaample, an adverrtisement may boast a rate e of 2% to qualified borrow wers (the baitt). However tthe brokerage may never n actuallyy arrange a mortgage m at th hat rate becauuse either no consumer caan meet the qualiffications for that product or o it doesn’t actually a exist. The consum mer is then offfered a higheer rate in n line with prrevailing markket rates (the e switch). Adv ertising Tips T – Co ompetitio on Bureau u of Cana ada When n a brokerage e is developing policies and d procedures that ensure iits public relaations materrials are comp pliant, it may wish to inclu ude some of tthe following advertising tips from the Comp petition Bureaau of Canada.. Do: Doo avoid fine print disclaimeers. They ofteen fail to channge the generral impressionn conveyed byy an advertiseme ent. If you do use them, maake sure the ooverall impreession created d by the ad and the disclaim mer is not missleading. Doo fully and clearly disclose all material innformation inn the advertissement. Doo avoid using terms t or phraases in an advvertisement tthat are not m meaningful an nd clear to the ord dinary person n. Doo, when conduucting a contest, disclose all a material d etails. Doo ensure that your sales force is familiarr with these ""Dos and Donn'ts." Advertissers may be held responsible for representations mad de by employ ees. Don't Doon't confuse "regular price" or "ordinaryy price" with "manufacturrer's suggesteed list price" oor a like term. The ey are often not n the same. Doon't use "reguular price" in an a advertisem ment unless t he product has been offerred in good faith for sale at that price for a substantiaal period of ti me, or a subsstantial volum me of the pro oduct has bee en sold at thaat price within n a reasonablle period of time. Doon't use the words w "sale" or o "special" in n relation to t he price of a product unleess a siggnificant price e reduction haas occurred. Doon't run a "salle" for a long period or reppeat it every w week. Doon't increase the t price of a product or service to cov er the cost off a free produ uct or service. Doon't make a peerformance claim c unless you y can provee it, even if yo ou think it is aaccurate. Testimonials ussually do not amount a to ad dequate prooof. Doon't sell a prodduct above yoour advertiseed price. Doon't unduly deelay the distriibution of prizes when connducting a contest. 1 Regisstrar of Mortgaage Brokers, British Columbiaa, Bulletin MB 06‐002 Chapter 9: Attractingg a Client 20 07 Doon't forget thaat no one actually needs too be misled foor a court to find that an aadvertisemennt is misleading. m 9.2 Business B s Develop pment forr Mortgag ge Agentts Please Note: The following f top pics are design ned to assist you in undersstanding how w to market yourself and begin n obtaining clients as a licensed mortgagge agent. Ho owever this seection is not includ ded in the cou urse’s final exxamination. The fo ollowing topiccs are designe ed to assist th he new mortggage agent in n learning how w to develop his orr her businesss. By embraciing business development d t activities immediately up pon getting licenssed, the new mortgage m age ent increases his or her likkelihood of su uccess, because the fact is that no n mortgage agent a can be successful without first finnding a clientt. Miss sion and Vision Statement S ts Missio on Statement A Misssion Stateme ent is a plan fo or companiess and people tto accomplish the goals th hey set. It is design ned to shape the companyy’s or individu ual’s identity and is typicallly based on a vision, goal,, or eth hics. A Misssion Stateme ent can be helpful to a mortgage agent because it prresents a wayy to establish and understand go oals, and brings substance and meaningg to the purpo ose of the bu usiness. The fo ollowing are some s examples of Mission n Statements:: w superior products p and services by ddeveloping innovations and solutions "Provvide society with that im mprove the quality q of life and satisfy cu ustomer needds, and to pro ovide employyees with mean ningful work and a advancem ment opportu unities, and innvestors with a superior raate of return” ‐ Merckk "To enable people and businessses throughout the world to realize theeir full potenttial” ‐ Micro osoft "Orgaanize the world's informatiion and make e it universallyy accessible aand useful” ‐ Google n Statement Vision A Vision Statement is something that the business or mo rtgage agent aspires to beecome. It should illustrate th he core belieff of the busine ess or mortgaage agent and d effectively ccommunicatee that to the reader.. The main m objective e of a Vision Statement S is to t explain thee core belief o of where the company or mortggage agent is going with th he business. Prope erly developed Mission and d Vision state ements can p rovide daily ffocus for the business or agentt and assist in keeping goals at the foreffront. This daaily refocusin ng can substan ntially increaase the poten ntial for succe ess. For the consumer the se statementts clearly and succinctly outlin ne the beliefs and direction n of the busin ness or the m ortgage agen nt. In so doing they can quickly communicaate and articu ulate key messsages to the consumer. A well designeed Mission 208 Chapter 9: Attractingg a Client V stateme ent will assistt the consume er in positive ly relating witth the busineess or and Vision mortggage agent. municating yo our Mission and a Vision Staatements Comm It is im mportant thatt, once constrructed, these e statements aare communiicated to clien nts, potentiall clients and others within the industry. This can c be done iin several ways such as byy including them in or on: Staationary Buusiness cards Addvertisementss Neewsletters Proomotional maaterials Em mails Anny items that the t public see es. Bus iness Ca ards “Grea at sales start with a great Business Carrd” ‐ Jo oe Girard, “W World’s greate est Salesperso on” accordingg to the Guin nness Book off World Records The purpose of an effective bussiness card is to attract andd set in motio on the wheels of acquiringg poten ntial users of your y service. It provides the mortgage agent with: A direct d marketting vehicle A person‐to‐pe p rson sales calll Ann advertisemeent A lead generatoor A networking n to ool A visual v represe entation of yo ou. c as a mo obile, miniature version of the mortgage agent. For those just Think of business cards beginning, it is ofte en the most inexpensive, affordable a toool. It createss and makes a statement aboutt who the mo ortgage agent is and how he h or she condducts his or h her business. A business card is an image bu uilder, provid ding a first and d potentially powerful imp pression that can judge the mortggage agent po ositively or ne egatively. It can c provide a n insight into o what he or sshe stands for, especcially if a Misssion and/or Vision Stateme ent is include d in it. Within the businesss card the mortgage agen nt should incluude all of his or her contacct inform mation, the USP U and a logo o. The Missio on and/or Vis ion Statemen nt, a brief bioggraphy, a coupo on or helpful tips for the co onsumer mayy also be incluuded. A card d can be mad de to stand ou ut from otherrs by using co lour, Mylar or plastic stock, using a graph hic, or includin ng a picture of o oneself. Ho owever the b usiness card is designed th he core idea is simple: be unique. Chapter 9: Attractingg a Client 20 09 ness Card Don n’ts Busin Neever cross thinngs out – prinnt new cards when w info ch anges and ch halk it up to a business expense Neever use a sticcker – again, get g new cards Doon’t use neon stock, it’s oftten too hard to read the pprint Doon’t use difficult to read foont ‐ Test the font on friendds who wear reading glassses and enlarge it if neccessary Doon’t use skinny letters ‐ Usee easier to reead, thicker leetters Doon’t use all capital letters, THEY’RE T TOO O DIFFICULT TTO READ Doon’t use too many m different type faces, they are conffusing Doon’t use scriptt or fancy fonts that are tooo difficult to read Uniq que Form ms of Bus siness Ca ards In atte empting to differentiate th he mortgage agent from hhis or her com mpetition, he or she might consid der using uniq que forms of business card ds. Currentlyy there are au udio and video o business cards. Both offer the t ability to provide a mo ore in‐depth ppresentation of products aand services; ever they can be considerably more exp pensive than sstandard business cards. howe Audio o Business Ca ards Audio o business carrds are definittely an attenttion grabber, telling poten ntial clients th hat the mortggage agent is different and d serious about his or her bbusiness. Theey are less likkely to be throw wn away and tend t to peak people’s curiosity, causingg them to be listened to in n their entire ety. Audio bu usiness cards are gaining in popularity aand can typiccally be purch hased with softw ware through businesses b su uch as Stapless, Future Shopp, etc. Video o Business Cards Video o Business Carrds offer the same benefitts of audio buusiness cards with further latitude in the abilityy to visually craft a messagge. They allow w the mortgaage agent to iinterview passt customers and have customer testimonials. Testimoniaals are vital inn the marketing of intangibles such as servicces. o Business Carrds should typ pically be no longer than 6 to 8 minutees to ensure th hat the Video poten ntial customer does not losse interest. Tips for f Distributin ng Business Cards C For bu usiness cards to be successful, they mu ust end up in tthe hands of potential cusstomers. To achievve this goal th he mortgage agent should d always leavee his or her ho ome or officee with at leastt twentty business caards and be prepared p to giive them awaay. By settingg a goal of disstributing a certaiin number of cards per we eek, he or she e will be able to increase h his or her expo osure to poten ntial customers and increase his or her volume of buusiness. a friends, aat seminars, in ndustry eventts, workshops, Be sure to provide business cards to family and netwo orking eventss, classes, meetings and an nywhere else there might be a potentiaal customer. 210 Chapter 9: Attractingg a Client Su uccess Tip – Businesss cards Ne ever leave your home or office o withoutt at least 20 bbusiness cardss. Get into th he practice off givving them to people you do d not know. You will incr ease the num mber of peoplle who are aw ware of your business b and thereby incre ease the num mber of poten ntial new custtomers, which h is the goal of alll successful sales s people! Netw working Definition e are several definitions d off Networking, but at its corre, Networkin ng is building or expandingg There one's social netwo ork or sphere of influence by b initiating m mutually advaantageous neew relatio onships with people. Netw working can be b one of thee most cost efffective mean ns of obtaining new business, b which can be esp pecially imporrtant for new w sales peoplee. The purpose of nettworking is to o create mean ningful relatioonships. Today’s environm ment is very comp petitive, and a personal relationship can n separate a m mortgage ageent from all off those who are simply marketiing and adverrtising. People like to dea l with those tthey know and trust, and perso onal contact through netwo orking can cre eate that. Netw working Strate egies for Funcctions Weear a nametag Doon’t hover, jusst mingle Coomment on innteresting artiicles of clothing as a conveersation startter Haave a businesss card enlargeed and laminaated and weaar it as a name tag Alw ways smile an nd look intere ested Bee confident Haave goals about whom to meet m Think of things to discuss in groups, like current c affairss; be up to daate on current events Reemember the goal: set apppointments annd get contacct informationn for your Dattabase Maarketing proggram Bee a host, not a guest Focus your atteention, do nott let it wander Follow up Coollect businesss cards Haave fun Wherre to Networkk Service Clubs Church groups Chamber of Com mmerce Personal parties Buusiness functioons (i.e. tradee shows, etc.)) Chapter 9: Attractingg a Client 21 11 Su uccess Tip ‐ Networkking Ne etworking is a fantastic me eans of developing personnal relationships. However, it must be do one in moderration. Ensure e that you inttroduce yoursself to new people and pro ovide them with a businesss card, but do o not try to se ell at an eventt. After you’vve made yourr introduction n an nd have very briefly b mentio oned your line of businesss, change the subject. If th hey feel the ne eed to speak to t you immed diately they will. w You do nnot want to become the peerson that no o on ne likes having at his or he er party! By approaching eevents with a determinatio on to subtly prromote yourself, you will be b readily acccepted. The Marketin ng/Adver tising of Intangiblles or Se ervices Marke eting intangib bles or service es is quite diffferent in com mparison with h marketing p products that a poten ntial customer can see and d feel. Studies indicate thaat upwards off sixty percen nt of consu umers will cho oose a mortgage agent based on their pprior dealingss with the ageent, the reputation of the agent a or being referred to the agent. This clearly c indicattes that a perssonal relation nship is vital, which is whyy networking and personal contact is so important. In marrketing mortggage financingg, which is an n intangible, itt is importantt to use e marketing to focus consu umers on keyy concepts thaat have the efffect of turnin ng the intanggible into the tangible. Th he following are strategies designed to market the in ntangible servicce of mortgagge financing. Testim monials The use of testimo onials can havve the effect of o reducing thhe need of a cconsumer to touch or feell a prod duct. Testimo onials from saatisfied clientts have the efffect of perso onalizing the p process. The consu umer can relate to anotherr person who o has had a beeneficial expeerience and trranslate that experrience to him or her. In essence this provides the coonsumer with h something tangible: anoth her consumerr who can be seen or heard d. Clarity Since uncertainty causes nt to provide your c apprehension and stress, s it is vittally importan poten ntial client witth clarity. This means cleaarly outlining the process iinvolved in ob btaining mortggage financing so that the client can understand thaat progress is being made aas steps are comp pleted. This caan be done verbally or in pamphlets p orr brochures. Atten ntion to Detaiil Since mortgage fin nancing is an intangible i serrvice, it must be described d to the clientt. This processs must be done in ass much detail as the client requires. Ass some clientss are more deetail oriented than others, o the mortgage m agen nt must first determine d thee appropriatee level of detaail to provide to the e client and th hen ensure th hat he or she pays particul ar attention tto these detaails. One of the faastest ways to o lose a clientt’s faith is to be b uncertain oof the detailss of their appllication or of any part of the mo ortgage appliccation process. Continued Contactt After the sale is co omplete and the t mortgage has closed, ccontinue to sttay in contactt with the client. By having a competent CRM C (Custom mer Relationshhip Managem ment) program m the mortggage agent caan ensure that he or she re eceives repeaat business an nd referrals frrom this clien nt. 212 Chapter 9: Attractingg a Client Marrketing: th he Art of Differen tiation Marke eting comes in i a variety off forms but in n the mortgagge industry it is important to understan nd that most m lenders and mortgage brokeragess are offering the same pro oduct: moneyy. Since the consume er sees the prroduct as virtu ually identicaal between brrokerages and d lenders, it iss necesssary to devellop a marketing program that t differenttiates one mo ortgage agentt from anoth her, whether that t person works w for a brrokerage or a lender. Thiss assists the co onsumer in differentiating between mortgaage providerss and making the decision of whom to cchoose based d on tho ose differences. To be able to achie eve this goal, the mortgage e agent mustt understand the competittion, the produ ucts and serviices offered and a focus on the t differencees. Some of tthe factors to o focus on aree: Produ uct Availabilitty Mortggage brokerages have acce ess to produccts and servic es provided b by numerous non‐bank lende ers, whereas banks b only haave access to their own prooducts. While this does no ot differentiate one mortgage m age ent from anotther, it is a maajor differenttiation that neeeds to be made e clear to pote ential clients. However, since most connsumers belieeve that all m money is create ed equally or that most len nders have th he same prodducts, simply sstating in marketing materrials that the mortgage agent has accesss to over a vaast number o of lenders is n not sufficient to hellp the client understand u ho ow that is of benefit to him m or her. By usiing a testimonial, this can be summarizzed quickly annd efficiently.. For examplee, including a testim monial in marketing that saays, “I though ht I knew whaat I wanted w when I was approved at myy bank, but after I sp poke with Maalik, my mortggage broker, I realized there were manyy more options available to me than jusst what my bank had offerred. It was a real eye open ner,” can clearly differentiatte between a bank and a mortgage m age nt. Of course, the testtimonial mustt be honest and genuine bbut this clearlyy illustrates the power of testim monial‐based marketing in illustrating the differencees in product availability beetween tradittional lenderss and the morrtgage brokerrage communnity. Servicce Servicce can be a major m differenttiator betwee en mortgage providers if m marketed pro operly. If marke eted imprope erly the word service will simply s be anoother overuseed word with virtually no mean ning. In todayy’s market eve eryone professes to have ssuperior servvice but, unlesss that service is cleaarly defined the claim beco omes vague. To make thee claim importtant requiress knowledge o of the co ompetition’s service levelss. In so doingg the mortgagge agent can eexplicitly dem monstrate thee differences betwee en his or her service and that of the co mpetition. For exxample, if the e mortgage aggent completes a budget tto assist in deetermining the suitability o of financcing solutionss at the initiall consultation n stage, this s hould be focu used on sincee most mortggage sales people do not. A further exaample would be in ease off contact. Thee phrase, “I’m m availaable seven days a week twenty‐four hou urs a day” is nnot only inco rrect, but sou unds despe erate. There are no mortggage agents who w will answ wer a phone caall in the middle of the night,, but by clearly setting out the hours off contact and if there are o other membeers of the mortggage agent’s team t who are e available to o answer callss, a differentiaation can be m made. TD Canad da Trust had a very successful campaign n at differenttiating it from m the rest of the banks in Chapter 9: Attracting a Client 213 Canada by clearly stating that it is open longer than any of its competitors. That statement differentiated the bank. If it had simply marketed great service and convenient hours, the distinction would have been lost on most consumers. Professionalism Another overused word, it is necessary for the mortgage agent to clearly define how they are professional. This can be done by including professional designations in marketing materials, and explaining those designations when appropriate. Niche Marketing Niche marketing is the ability of a marketer to target a specific group or demographic and design a marketing campaign that answers the needs of that group or demographic. An excellent example of niche marketing can be found in the automobile insurance industry by companies with a program designed specifically for drivers over the age of fifty. This program targets a specific demographic, one that the insurance brokerage has decided offers high returns, and markets specifically to that group through media used by that group. In the mortgage brokerage industry the marketing tends to be undifferentiated. Advertisements tend to include several messages, such as offering mortgages to individuals with poor credit, no income, who are self‐employed, or who are looking for the best rates. While this casts the widest net, it does not speak to any specific target market. Therefore, no one encountering this marketing will feel like it is speaking directly to him or her, which is a key element of any marketing. Potential areas of niche marketing for the mortgage agent include: The medical profession Often these professionals are self‐employed high‐income earners with significant debt that could benefit from non‐bank products Construction workers Often seasonally employed working long hours, they might benefit from specific products from non‐bank lenders as well as more convenient methods of applying for mortgage financing. The above examples provide an insight into what niche marketing might be for the mortgage agent. In all cases niche marketing requires the marketer to identify a potential niche market, research what the characteristics and needs of that market are and either develop or identify products or services to meet those needs. Whatever the message ends up being, it must eventually be delivered to the public. This can be done in several ways, of which the following is a partial list: Flyers Classified Advertisements Yellow Pages advertisements Unaddressed admail through Canada Post Promotional items such as pens, fridge magnets, etc. Sponsoring an event Sponsoring an award Hosting or being a presenter at a seminar 214 Chapter 9: Attractingg a Client Bro oadcast faxing De elivering coup pons Be ench advertising Billboards Ne ewspaper inse erts Ne ewspaper inte erviews Maagazine articles Ne ewsletters Em mails Dirrect mail Your website Orr any means that can delive er a message to a wide au dience. Whatever the messsage is and however h it is delivered, d thee key to succeessfully markeeting a produ uct or service is developingg the strategyy and then im mplementing iit. As P.T. Barrnum once said, “without “ prom motion some ething terrible e happens – nnothing!” Su uccess Tip – Make th he phone ring! r Th he goal of all marketing an nd advertisingg is simple: too make the ph hone ring! Keeep this in mind when devveloping yourr marketing and advertisinng pieces and create them with that ulttimate goal in n mind. Data abase Ma arketing Datab base marketin ng is the functtion of wareh housing potenntial and existting client infformation in an ele ectronic mediium that allow ws the user to o assemble o r list these cliients in group ps to whom marke eting efforts may m be directted. Databasse marketing begins with a single client and can be built to t encompasss thousands of o clients. The key to data base marketiing is to havee a system in place whereby clie ents receive marketing m on a regular bassis. List off potential clients might in nclude: Firrst time homee buyers Reenewers, and Reefinancers. By seggmenting the ese potential clients c into caategories, thee mortgage aggent can tailo or the messaage. For exam mple, the info ormation sentt to first timee home buyerrs would be different than that sent s to renew wers, and so on. o In add dition, inform mation sent to o current clien nts would difffer from that sent to potential clients. The mortgage m agen nt will have a more person nal relationshhip with his orr her current clients and may send s marketin ng such as birrthday cards, quarterly new wsletters, and so on. These clients should be personally contacted on a regular basis to updaate their reco ords and ensu ure that the inform mation in the database is current. c This also providess opportunityy to search fo or additional needss such as refin nancing for a debt consolid dation or hom me renovation before the client’s mortggage is up forr renewal. Chapter 9: Attractingg a Client 21 15 e marketing program p in pl ace, the oddss of obtainingg repeat By having a consisttent database business is greatly increased, lo owering the co osts associateed with obtaiining businesss. Refe errals Referrals refer to those t clients who w have bee en advised too do business with the mortgage agent by a third party. A client may be b referred to o him or her bby a financial planner, a Reeal Estate salepe erson, an insu urance agent,, a past clientt, or whoeverr has come into contact wiith the mortggage agent in the past. This type of bussiness tends tto be the leasst difficult to complete, since the client is acting a on the advice of som meone who iss typically a frriend of his or hers. The relatio onship that client has with h the referral source preveents the usual apprehensio on that poten ntial clients haave with new w sales people e. Tips for f Obtaining Referrals Doo the people you y deal with know you ne eed referrals?? Many peop ple who know w you will thin nk you are so successful that yo ou do not nee ed any referraals. Ensure th hat they realize you need every one and treat t them alll with the pro ofessionalism they have grrown to know w and expect fro om you. Doo your referreers know the quickest q and easiest routee to get their referral to yo ou? Pro ovide your re eferrers with a simple referrral form thatt they can em mail or fax to yyou. It only needs some bassic informatio on, such as who the client is, their conttact informatiion and what the ey need. Thank‐you letteers: ensure thhat you alwayys send a thannk‐you letter tto your referral source, wh hether the refferral turns in nto a client orr not. Uppdate your daatabase with the t referral in nformation. Coontact the pottential custom mer as soon as a possible. Guuarantee conffidentiality too all parties. Send a thank‐yoou gift when the t financingg is completedd. Invvite your refeerrers to comppany parties to t show yourr appreciation n. Su uccess Tip – Getting family and d friends’ m mortgagess Do oing the morttgage of a fam mily member or friend cann be difficult ffor new and eexperienced aggents alike. Family and frie ends tend nott to want to l et you see th heir credit, and may not bee co omfortable with the thought of you kno owing their prrivate businesss. But don’tt worry, be ecause you caan still get the eir business! I suggest findding a highly ssuccessful aggent or brokerr in your brokeraage. Partner with him or her h to do the mortgages fo or your familyy and friends.. No ow you can te ell your familyy and friends that you’ve bbecome a liceensed agent aand think thatt they should use e your colleaggue to do the eir next mortggage! Just bee sure that your colleague paays you a nice e referral fee. 216 Chapter 9: Attracting a Client 9.3 Key Terms and Definitions Advertising A paid, controlled message through a non‐personal medium. Types of advertising include publicity, public relations, product placement, sponsorship, and sales promotion. Advertising Standards Canada (ASC) This not‐for‐profit, self‐regulatory body founded in 1952, regulates the advertising industry and handles consumer complaints related to advertising. Audio Business Card A smaller version of a CD that allows the user to create their own audio business card Bait and Switch Providing a consumer with an attractive offer to obtain him or her as a client but being unable to provide the product or service at the indicated price Business Card A marketing tool that provides contact information, a logo, and other relevant information about the company, products and/or services of the company and/or the individual Classified Advertisement A print advertisement placed in the Classified section of a newspaper Database Marketing Database Marketing is the function of warehousing potential and existing client information in an electronic medium that allows the user to assemble or list these clients in groups that can be marketed to. Flyer A stand‐alone marketing piece, usually on 8.5 x 11 inch paper Marketing Presenting products or services to potential customers in a fashion that positively promotes the product or service and makes customers eager to buy or use those products or services Mission Statement A Mission Statement is a plan for companies and people to accomplish the goals they set. It is designed to shape the company or individual’s identity and is typically based on a vision, goal, or ethics. Mortgage Agent Individuals who are remunerated for dealing in mortgages or trading in mortgages in Ontario, as employees or otherwise. Mortgage agents are restricted in their abilities by the MBLAA and its Regulations and must be supervised by a licensed mortgage agent. Mortgage agents must be licensed. Networking Building or expanding one's social network or sphere of influence by initiating mutually Chapter 9: Attracting a Client 217 advantageous new relationships with people Niche Marketing Marketing to a specific audience or target demographic Referral A client or customer who has been advised by a third party to use the product or service of another Standards of Practice Regulation 188/08, which applies to mortgage brokerages, Regulation 187/07, which applies to mortgage agents and agents, and Regulation 189/08, which applies to Mortgage Administrators constitute the Standards of Practice under the MBLAA. These Regulations detail the business rules that licensees must follow to comply with the MBLAA and its Regulations. Testimonials An endorsement in writing, verbally or electronically by a client The Canadian Code of Advertising Standards The Canadian Code of Advertising Standards was created by the advertising industry in 1963 to promote the professional practice of advertising Unaddressed Admail Bulk, unaddressed advertising that is delivered in bulk to a certain area by Canada Post Video Business Card A visual presentation of a sales person on CD Vision Statement A Vision Statement is something that the business or mortgage agent aspires to become. It should illustrate the core belief of the business or mortgage agent and effectively communicate that to the reader. 218 Chapter 9: Attractingg a Client 9.4 Review R Questions Q s Answers to the Revview Questio ons are found at www.REM MIC.ca Sho ort Answe er Questio ons 1. Wh hat is a “Bait and Switch”?? 2. Wh hat does the Canadian Cod de of Advertissing Standardds promote? 3. Wh hat does the Mortgage Brrokerages, len nders and Adm ministrators A Act, 2006 prohibit reggarding adverrtising? 4. Disscuss the differences betw ween a Missio on and a Visioon Statement.. 5. Wh hat does a bu usiness card provide p to the e mortgage aggent? 6. Wh hat are the be enefits of an audio business card? plain your answer. n tyypically more e or less expen nsive than maarketing? Exp 7. Is networking 8. In what ways caan a mortgage e agent differrentiate him oor herself fro om the compeetition? 9. Wh hy are testimonials beneficial in the maarketing of inttangible prod ducts or services? 10. Discuss three ways w that a mortgage m agen nt can obtainn referrals. Chapter 10: First Contact 219 Chapter 10: First Contact Learning Outcomes Successful understanding of the concepts presented in this chapter will enable the learner to: Explain the importance of the initial telephone call Discuss the benefits of a call script Use a call script in an incoming and outgoing telephone conversation Introduction Please Note: The following topics are designed to assist you in handling first contact with a potential client from a sales perspective. However this chapter is not included in the course’s final examination. First contact with a potential client is a vital part of the mortgage application process. It is the mortgage agent’s first chance at a good impression and the first opportunity to turn a potential client into an actual client. As discussed earlier, the purpose of a mortgage agent’s advertising and marketing efforts is to initiate first contact. The purpose of first contact is twofold: to determine if the client may qualify for financing, and to get an appointment. There are a few different models concerning the workflow of a mortgage application, including having the potential client complete an online mortgage application; however it is important to note that developing a relationship with a potential client is a key component in completing the mortgage transaction. 10.1 The Initial Telephone Call The initial telephone conversation is vital to developing a relationship with a potential client. Once the phone rings the mortgage agent’s advertising/marketing has been successful. If the mortgage agent finds that he or she is receiving calls from clients that he or she does not want, then the first area to consider modifying is the advertising/marketing. In today’s environment, most calls fielded by mortgage agents have one characteristic in common: a question about the rate. This is a question that most consumers have been programmed to ask from television advertising and other marketing by major lending institutions. Most consumers believe that the only difference between mortgages offered by lenders revolves around the interest rate; therefore when inquiring about obtaining a mortgage that is typically the first question that is asked. This question, however, is virtually impossible to answer successfully. If the mortgage agent answers this question by telling the caller what the lowest rate is, the caller will most likely end the call and continue shopping to compare what other mortgage agents have to offer. 220 Chapter 10: First Coontact e is a model of buying behaaviour called the Phenomeenological Bu uying Behavio our Model thaat There breakks the buying of services in nto four categgories as seenn from the buyer’s perspecctive. They are: Neeed Pree‐purchase reesearch Purchase Poost‐purchase cognitive c disssonance (remorse). ns the processs The potential purcchaser, in our case the potential home bbuyer or morrtgagee, begin by fee eling a need to t obtain morrtgage financiing. This can be triggered by the need to purchase a home e, the need to o refinance, co onsolidate de ebt, etc. Whaatever the reaason behind tthe need, thee need exists in the potential p purchaser’s mind d. The next step, pre‐‐purchase ressearch, is fairly unique to sshopping for higher priced d goods and servicces. This activvity revolves around reseaarching and leearning aboutt the required d product or servicces. Unlike less expensive items where research is nnot normally d done, purchasers feel the need to learn as much m as possib ble about the product or s ervice they are considerin ng purchasingg to be able to make e an informed d decision. The potential purcchaser then be ecomes an acctual user or ppurchaser of the product o or service, which h is typically followed by post‐purchase cognitive disssonance, com mmonly referrred to as “buye er’s remorse.”” he potential mortgage m borrower, the prre‐purchase rresearch stagee can lead to researching For th online e and makingg several phon ne calls before finally settl ing on a morttgage provideer. This may resultt in the caller asking the sim mple question, “What is y our best 5 yeear rate?” beccause he or she iss in the researrch stage and d is looking for informationn, not to applyy for a mortggage. ever, a mortgaage agent, un nderstanding that part of hhis or her function is sales,, must turn Howe this siimple requestt for informattion into a po otential clientt. That requirres a specific process for dealin ng with incom ming telephon ne calls that le eaves little too one’s imagin nation, and fo ocuses on using a call script. Pa ause for cllarification n – Call scrripts A call script is a written document that outlines o or scrripts a converrsation. This is used to allow the agentt to remain fo ocused on covvering certainn topics that he or she feeels are ne ecessary in th he call and allo ows the agen nt to refer to sstandard resp ponses for typ pical qu uestions. Pro ofessional age ents always usse a script, w hether in pap per format orr by co ommitting the e script to me emory. There e is no way of knowing who o is calling, ho ow he or she obtained you ur telephone number or what his or her intent might be. This uncertainty requirees the agent to o initially treaat every incom ming call in the same fashio on, tailoring the t conversattion to the specific caller o only after theiir purpo ose has been determined. Within the first ten n to fifteen se econds, you must m tell the ccaller…. Whho you are Chapter 10: First Contact 221 The benefit you will provide to him or her You have to do the same two things on an incoming call as an outgoing cold call, but they are done differently. On an incoming call, you have already done something to prompt the potential client to call you, such as place an ad. In most cases, your potential client is contacting you to ask one simple question: “What is your best 5 year rate?.” It is strongly suggested that you attempt to deflect this question, for several reasons. First, you do not know anything about the client and will not know if they qualify. If you tell them a low rate, then find out that they do not qualify for it, they may think that you are practicing the “bait and switch,” which is enticing them with one promise only to switch later to something worse. Secondly, if you immediately give them the rate, they can simply hang up and go to the next ad, always looking for the lowest rate, continuing to research. Many people who call think all mortgages are created equally, so they believe the only difference is rate, which simply is not the case. Thirdly, you need to develop a relationship with this potential client, and if he or she has all of the information that he or she wanted (i.e., rate) before the agent has even introduced him or herself to the caller, that caller will feel no connection with the agent and will have no problem in hanging up. The following is an example of an incoming call script that attempts to address these issues. Keep in mind, however, that no script is perfect. A successful agent will eventually have to address concerns as they arise in any given conversation. 10.2 Incoming Call Script The following script is a basic example of how to handle an incoming telephone call. The agent’s lines are in normal font and potential client responses are in italics. Good (afternoon, morning or evening), (Your company name), how may I help you? Hi, can you tell me your five‐year rate please? I would love to sir, but first off let me introduce myself. My name is (your name), and may I ask your name please? Sure, my name is Bob Andrews. And would you prefer that I call you Mr. Andrews or by your first name? Bob would be fine. Wonderful. Bob, may I ask who referred you? 222 Chapter 10: First Contact Actually I’m calling from your ad in the newspaper. Super. Bob, most of my business comes from referrals from satisfied past clients. May I treat you the same way that I would treat one of my referred clients? Sure. Great! Okay Bob, the rate that I can get you depends on many different factors, but I can say with the outmost of certainty that I can get you the best rate based on your circumstances. In addition, I will get you the best overall mortgage to suit your needs. I have a few brief questions I need to ask you to determine what we can do to get you the best possible mortgage, but before I continue, can I get your telephone number just in case we get cut off? Client answers. Thank you. Now, are you looking to purchase a home, refinance your existing home, or do you have a mortgage coming up for renewal? Client answers. And how much money do you need? Client answers. And how would you say your credit is? Client answers. Fantastic. Well, based on this preliminary information it sounds like we have three different programs that will meet your needs. I need to go into some more specific details about your situation to ensure I get you the lowest possible rate and the right mortgage to suit your needs, so I suggest we meet to discuss your situation further. I have some available time either (give two possible days) at either (give two possible times) which do you prefer? Client answers. Great. Can I get your exact address please? Client answers. Now, I need you to have a few documents ready for our chat so that I can get you the best mortgage for your needs. If you could have a …..(list the required documents based on what they are looking for, i.e., Purchase, refinance, pre‐qualification, etc.) Do you have those handy? Client answers. And if you can’t find any of those documents, don’t worry, we can still proceed without them. So I will meet you on (reiterate the date and time). One last question Bob, do you have a significant other? Chapter 10: First Coontact 22 23 Clientt answers. Wond derful. I suggest that we all get togethe er for this meeeting so that we can address any questtions your spo ouse may havve as well. Thankk you so much h for your call and I look fo orward to meeeting you. G Good‐bye. ember: the go oal of the advertisement iss to get peopl e to call. Thee goal of the aagent is to geet Reme an appointment with w the caller as long as the agent belieeves that the ccaller is qualified. Agents must also considerr that meeting with those who may nott qualify has its merits. Th he agent can practiice his or her interviewing technique, database d the cclient for the future (the cclient’s situattion may chan nge in the future), or obtaiin potential r eferral clients. Tips s for Suc cess Practiice makes pe erfect Reme ember to pracctice your scriipt before you start gettin g calls. Like ccold calling, aask your spousse or significant other (som meone who will w give you h elpful advice on how you are performing) to be your incomin ng call or pracctise by recordding yourselff and listeningg to the conve ersation. In all cases, try to o record yourrself and revieew the tape aafter your calls. This way you caan identify if you are soun nding aggressiive, defensivee, or just right! Use a mirror Becau use a smile traanslates acro oss a telephon ne line, you shhould ensure that you are always smilin ng when you’re on a call. A great way to ensure thatt you are is byy having a sm mall mirror in front of you so thaat you can watch your smille. Write e things down n Be sure to have pe en and paper for each call. Write downn the caller’s n name as soon n as you get itt (there e’s nothing more m embarrassing then forgetting a cal ler’s name affter they’ve ju ust given it to o you!),, and any other details thaat might be he elpful. Make e these wordss your own Make e sure you use e words and phrases p that are a comfortabble for you. IIn other word ds, rephrase the sccript to match h how you no ormally speak. This will en sure that you u do not soun nd like you aree readin ng from a script, even whe en you are! Do no ot be afraid Reme ember that the phone can be your best friend. The m more comforrtable you aree on the phone e, the easier it i will be to meet m your objective: gettinng appointmeents with qualified clients. 224 Chapter 10: First Coontact 10.3 3 Outgoin ng Cold Call C Scrip pt for Refe errals Pa ause for cllarification n – Cold ca alls A cold call is an n outgoing call made to someone who iis not known to the agent and who hass no ot been referrred to him orr her. This potential client is considered d “cold” or un nfriendly. Thee ob bject of a cold d call is to transform the “ccold” individuual into a “waarm” prospecct, or someone who is warm to o the idea of doing d businesss with the aggent. By follo owing a scriptt, the agent hances of succcess! haas the best ch dition to receiving incomin ng calls you may m wish to coontact potenttial referral so ources, such In add as a Real R Estate Salesperson or Financial Planner. Withinn the first ten to fifteen secconds you must tell the poten ntial referrer:: Whho you are The benefit that you can proovide to him or o her If you don’t, chancces are he or she s will stop listening. Thiink of the cold calls you reeceive. As soon as you realize e they are nott someone yo ou know, but they are som meone trying tto “sell” you, you trry to find a way to hang up p the phone. By peaking hhis or her inteerest in the firrst ten to fifteen seconds, yo ou will get som meone who wants w to hearr more! The ffollowing is a basic script c be used to o accomplish this task. Th he agent’s linees are in norm mal font and p potential that can client’s responses are in italics. Hi, myy name is (your name) and d I’m calling from (your brookerage), a national (or large local, local, successful, etc.) mortgage e brokerage. The purposee behind my ccall today is to o discuss how w g your business, all at no cost to you. Does we caan help you caan make more money by growing makin ng more money and doing more busine ess interest yoou? Let th hem answer. ncern by sayin ng: If theyy say no, address their con “Serio ously, sir/ma’am, I respectt that you’re a busy personn and I would dn’t want to w waste your time, but I can help p you like I’ve e helped othe ers to increas e their busineess and makee more moneyy, all at no cost to you. Doesn’t th hat sound like e something tthat might bee worth a few w moments off your time?” t d not or if th ey insist on h hanging up, leet them go! They should respond positively,, but if they do Cold calling c is a numbers game so don’t get caught up figghting with yo our cold call, jjust move on to the e next one! “Yes!!” Excelllent! I’m sorrry, to whom am a I speakingg? This iss Mr. Jones. Chapter 10: First Contact 225 Great, Mr. Jones, and please, feel free to call me (your first name) Now that you’ve gotten their attention, it’s time to focus on your strengths, and what you are really calling about: helping them do more business, which will, undoubtedly, help you do more business. Talk to them about your strategies, including: Joint advertising Referrals to them of potential home buyers Joint seminars and workshops focusing on home buying and mortgaging Joining them at their sales meetings to add value by discussing rates and sales techniques Sharing sales techniques that you keep up on through constant training Helping them cold and warm call Going on “walk abouts” with them (dropping off flyers) Helping them with open houses, or showing a property Arranging office parties for them and their clients. Now, to discuss the great ways I can help you make more money and do more business all we have to do is get together for a chat. I have time on (give them two choices, like Tuesday and Thursday) at either (give them two opposite choices, like one morning and one afternoon – if they aren’t available at those times, ask them when it’s convenient for them). Which do you prefer? The goal of any cold call is to get to meet with the client/referral source, so everything you do must be dedicated to that end! 226 Chapter 10: First Contact 10.4 Key Terms and Definitions Call Script A written document that outlines or scripts a telephone conversation, allowing the user to remain focused on the purpose and objectives of the call Cold Call A call made to a cold or potentially unfriendly new client or referral source who does not know the caller Post‐purchase Cognitive Dissonance Commonly referred to as buyer’s remorse, this refers to the emotional state a buyer is in after completing what is typically a large purchase and who is no longer in an emotionally charged state. Pre‐purchase Research The research done by a potential purchaser of a more expensive item. This may include online research as well as contacting past clients, calling service providers, etc. Warm Call A call made to a warm or potentially friendly new client or referral source who may know the caller or may have been referred to the caller by a third party Chapter 10: First Coontact 22 27 10.5 5 Review Question ns Answers to the Revview Questio ons are found at www.REM MIC.ca Sho ort Answe er Questio ons 1. Wh hat is the typical question that a potenttial client askks when first ccontacting a m mortgage agent? 2. Wh hat are five tiips for successs when usingg a call script?? 3. Disscuss the ben nefits of usingg a call script. 4. Wh hat is a cold call? c 5. Ho ow can a cold call be turne ed into a warm m call? 6. Wh hat information should be e provided to the caller witthin the first tten to fifteen n seconds of a calll? 7. Wh hy is it importtant to develop a relationsship with a pootential client? 228 Chapter 11: The Initial Consultation Chapter 11: The Initial Consultation Learning Outcomes Successful understanding of the concepts presented in this chapter will enable the learner to: Determine the documentation that must be obtained from an applicant Create a mortgage file on an applicant Use a file checklist and file worksheet Discuss the locations in which the client meeting can occur and the advantages and disadvantages of each location Determine the needs of the applicant Complete a mortgage application Introduction The initial consultation with your potential client is a major step in the mortgage application process. There are several considerations for this step, including: The location of the meeting Preparing the client for the meeting, including advising him or her of the time involved, who should attend and what documents to have available Preparing for the meeting, including creating a blank file Verifying the client’s identity Completing the application Determining the borrower’s needs. A well‐prepared mortgage agent will find that the meeting will usually proceed smoothly resulting in the potential client transforming into a client. Many mortgage agents often miss the difference between a potential client and a client, since it can occur rather subtly. However there is a major difference. A potential client is one who is not yet dedicated to completing the transaction with this particular mortgage agent. A client is an individual(s) who has made the decision to complete the transaction with the mortgage agent, usually based on several factors, including trusting the mortgage agent, developing a personal relationship with the agent, believing in the agent’s technical proficiency and having the agent satisfy the four borrower expectations found in chapter 7, which are that the mortgage agent will: 1. Act in the borrower’s best interests 2. Completely analyze the borrower’s needs 3. Make appropriate recommendations based on the borrower’s needs 4. Facilitate the transaction to its successful completion. 11.1 Required Documentation Each type of mortgage transaction requires documentation to be obtained from the applicant in addition to a signed mortgage application. The following list outlines those documents as well Chapter 11: The Initial C onsultation 22 29 e purpose beh hind obtaining each. A clie ent should bee instructed to provide theese, as as the appliccable, at the initial consulttation. Doc cumentatiion for al l Transac ctions Em mployment Ve erification Em mployment do ocumentation n requiremen nts vary from lender to lender; howeverr the followin ng is a list of docum mentation that is typically acceptable ffor an employyee: Letter of Em mployment Pay Stubs T4 NOA (Notice of Assessment – often re equested wh en there is co ommission income) Tax Return (also may be requested when w there is commission iincome) For a self‐employe ed individual the t following may be requuired: Financial Sttatements Business Liccense Business Ch heque PIP PEDA Consen nt This document allows the mortgage agen nt to use the aapplicant’s peersonal inform mation for the purposes contained within the consent fo orm. Ph hoto Identifica ation Photo identificaation is requirred to prove the t identity oof the applicant. The original document sho ould be viewe ed and a photocopy obtain ned for the fi le. ation Agreem ment (if appliccable) Divvorce/Separa If applicable a this document outlines o the terms t and connditions of th he separation or divorce and will typicallly include anyy payments th hat are requirred to be mad de for alimon ny. Ch hild Support Order/Agreem O ment (if appliicable) If applicable a this document outlines o the terms t and connditions of ch hild support, iincluding anyy payments that are a required to be made. Spe ecific Doc cumentat ion for a Purchas e The fo ollowing is a list of docume entation thatt is typically reequired when n a client is purchasing a prope erty: Purchase and Sale Agreemen nt MLLS Listing Pro oof of Down payment Re ental Letter (iff applicable) Re eal estate sale esperson Information 230 Chapter 11: The Initial C onsultation Spe ecific doc umentati on for a Refinancce, Equityy take-Ou ut and Swittch The fo ollowing is a list of docume entation thatt is typically reequired when n a client is reefinancing hiss or herr current morrtgage, takingg equity out of o his or her pproperty or sw witching lendeers on renew wal: Current mortgaage statementt Charge/Mortgage Traansfer/Deed Pro operty tax staatement Pro operty insuraance policy Mo ortgage repayyment historyy (if applicable) 11.2 2 File Cre eation pplication file should have the same cheecklist. A typ pical file can b be made up of Everyy mortgage ap a legaal size file fold der with two forms f stapled d to the insidee of the foldeer. On the lefft side will be a checkklist and on th he right side a worksheet for f notes and calculations.. Mortgage agents may have different styles of files and d the informaation may be in different fo ormats or in vvarying orderrs; however th he informatio on is essentiallly the same. File Checklis st A file checklist is a key compone ent for ensuring that the rrequired docu umentation iss obtained on n everyy transaction. This preventts the embarrrassment of hhaving to go b back to a clien nt for additiional docume entation in the future and provides a quuick summaryy of what is in n the file. If the fille is broken in nto sections based b on the checklist, theen every file w will follow thee same orderr, allowing the mortggage agent to o know where e to find spec ific documents in any file. A coloured e section oof the file forr ease of filingg documents.. sheet or file folderr can be used to separate each Prope er completion n of the checkklist and the worksheet w wi ll allow the m mortgage agen nt to quickly reacquaint him or her with the file, especiallly if the file haasn’t been worked on for several days or if there are seve eral files being processed simultaneous s sly. The fo ollowing figurre is an example of a file checklist, and may be repro oduced in wh hole or in partt. In the e top section the t client’s co ontact inform mation is noteed. It is helpfu ul to mark thee best time and contact number to reach th he client shou uld the need aarise. The neext section allows the mortggage agent to o check off the e documents that are in thhe file and acts as a reminder for docum ments that arre typically required for evvery transactioon as well as the documen nts specificallly for a condominium c m, refinance, equity e take‐o out, switch or purchase. Th he final sectio on is dedicated to disclo osure docume ents. Each file must have each of thesee documents except for th he Investtor/lender dissclosure, which is only app plicable on prrivate mortgaage transactio ons. 23 31 Chapter 11: The Initial C onsultation Figure 35 – Residentia al Mortgage App plication File Cheecklist Ressidential Mortgage Applicaation File Checklistt Source: Client Names (First,, Last) Addresss: Home Tel: ( ) Work W Tel: ( ) Cell: ( ) Best time and number to contacct: Closingg Date: Appliication Numbber: Standa ard Documen ntation Employyment Verificcation Sign ned Application n PIPEEDA Consent T4s Pay SStubs Pho oto ID Cred dit Bureau Emp loyment Letter NOA App praisal Requestt Appraisal Renttal Income Proo of Tax R Return Divo orce/Separatio on Agreement Finanncial Statemen nts Busin ness License Child Support Ord der/Agreementt Businness Listing Busin ness Cheque Oth her: Otheer: Oth her: Otheer: For Co ondominiumss Only Stattus Certificate Mastter Insurance PPolicy For Re efinancing / Equity E Take‐O Outs and Swittches Current Mortgage e Statement Charrge/Mortgage List of debts/balan nces (Refinance only) Tran sfer/Deed Property Tax State ement Propperty Insurancee Policy Mortgage Repaym ment History: _______ _ Month hs Otheer: For Pu urchases Onlyy Purchase & Sale Agreement A Prooof of Down payyment / Gift Letter MLSS Listing Renttal Letter (satissfactory rent paid) Reaal Estate Salesp person Contactt Information Otheer: Disclossure Docume entation Sign ned lender Com mmitment Morttgage Summarry/Amortization Inve estor/lender Disclosure Credditor Insurance Request or W Waiver Sign ned borrower disclosure d Otheer: Note: This T form mayy be reproducced without ppermission, in n whole or in part 232 Chapter 11: The Initial C onsultation File Workshe eet A file worksheet is a key compo onent used fo or recording nnotes and more importantly providing a quick summary of the file. This can be particcularly imporrtant if more tthan one person is workin ng on the e file, if the mortgage m agen nt is working on several filles simultaneeously or if the file hasn’t been worked on in n some time. The fo ollowing figurre is a sample e of a mortgagge worksheett, which may be reproduceed in whole o or in parrt. In the top section is a brief b summaryy of the morttgage requestt, including th he amount, the raank, the purpose of the mo ortgage, the GDS G and TDS,, the credit sccore and the d date the creditt report was obtained. o This date should d be changedd whenever a new credit reeport is pulled on the e client. If there are severral credit repo orts in the filee, the most cu urrent will bee readily known. Figure 36 – Residentia al Mortgage Worksheet Resid dential Mortgage M W Worksheet Client Names (First,, Last) Mortgage Amount: $ Purposse of Mortgagge: Loan to Value: Credit Score: Raank: 1 st 2 nd 3 rd Source: Otheer: GDS: TDS: Cre edit Bureau D Date: Is th he client working with anyy other broker or lender? Yes / No If yees, whom? Client Objectives (i.e. improve cash c flow; low wer the interrest rate, etc.) Appliccation Challen nges: GDS/TD DS, Credit, Em mployment, Prroperty, Etc. ((explain) List of Potential len nders (explain n why for eacch) 1 2 3 First Contact Notess Date of Inquiry Initial Consultation n Notes Date of Meeting: Additional Notes (include date of o note entry) Note: This T form mayy be reproducced without ppermission, in n whole or in part Chapter 11: The Initial C onsultation 23 33 The next section iss used as a prompt for the mortgage aggent to check whether the client is working with or haas been working with anotther mortgagee agent or len nder. This is important to identiify quickly as it will help de etermine how w serious the client is in deealing with th he mortgage agentt. Su uccess Tip – Is your client c workking with ssomeone eelse? To o determine iff your client is working witth another brroker or lendeer, use the fo ollowing qu uestion, prefe erably before you meet with the client: “Mr. Client, I need to ask you if you arre cu urrently working with any other o broker or lender on your financin ng needs as m most lenders will look negatiively on and not n deal with an applicantt who is dealin ng with severral sources at the same time.. Are you deaaling with anyy other sourcees Mr. Client??.” This quesstion is short an nd to the poin nt and will help the client understand u thhat they shou uld only be deealing with yo ou and no one e else! The Client C Objectivves section off the Workshe eet ensures t hat the mortgage agent has clearly identiified what is important to the client. Th his is particul arly useful if, for example,, a client wishe es to consolidate debts to lower his or her h payment and the morttgage agent iss able to accom mplish this, bu ut at a higherr rate than the e client was eexpecting. Byy understandiing the client’s main objective, the e mortgage agent can focu us on the factt that this maain objective w was achieved d. The Application A Ch hallenges secttion is designed to clearly articulate anyy challenges tthe client’s appliccation may haave, quickly and clearly so that the morrtgage agent ccan easily ideentify these issuess on reviewing the file or in n discussions with the lendder or the clieent. The next two sections are availaable for notess on the first contact, the initial consulttation or any other notes that may m be relevant. It is a besst practice to summarize th he first contaact and initial consu ultation as soo on as they have occurred to t allow the ccapture of all relevant info ormation. This can be important for f future con nversations. 11.3 3 Meeting g the Client There e are three baasic places wh here a mortgaage agent cann meet a clien nt: The client’s hom me The mortgage agent’s a office Annother outsidee location. There e are several positives p and negatives forr each locatioon, but it is im mportant to fo ocus on provid ding good cusstomer servicce for the client, so wherevver is best forr the client is often the right choice. c Wherever the meeting takes place it is vital that trust bee created with h the client ass soon as possible. The T different locations sim mply necessitaate different processes to create this trust. Firs t Impress sions It is im mportant to begin b every meeting, m regarrdless of wheere it occurs, w with a positivve attitude an nd professional deme eanor. To make a good firsst impressionn it is important to dress likke a n time, and be well preparred. Once in tthe meeting aask open‐end ded questionss, professional, be on 234 Chapter 11: The Initial C onsultation listen well, and takke notes. Takking notes from the beginnning of the meeeting beforee the actual intervview begins iss an importan nt way of telling the client that the morrtgage agent b believes that what the client hass to say is imp portant, and it is. Pa ause for cllarification n – Open‐eended quesstion An n open‐ended d question is a question th hat does not eelicit a single word or shorrt response. Fo or example, asking a perso on how long he h or she has worked at hiss or her job w will elicit a sh hort response e. This is a clo osed‐ended question. Ask ing a person tto describe h his or her job sh hould result in n a much longger response, which will m most likely include how lon ng he or she haas been at the e job. This is vital in developing a good dialogue witth your client. The Client’s Home When n visiting a clie ent in his or her h home, it is important tto prepare to arrive early. This limits the po ossibility of getting lost in unfamiliar te errain and proovides the mo ortgage agentt an opporrtunity to revview the client’s file before e entering hiss or her homee. A best pracctice is to arrive e at least ten minutes aheaad of schedule and park doown the road d. This time should be taken to reacquain nt oneself witth the client’ss information,, including hiss or her namee and the purpo ose of the finaancing. n approachingg the home fo ocus on the taask at hand. This means that the mortggage agent When should clear his or her mind and d leave all of his or her trooubles, concerns, plans and any other distraaction outside e of the home e. Once the client answers the door, the mortggage agent shhould introduce him or herrself. Providee the ho omeowner with w a business card, preferrably a card w with a photo o on it to put th he home eowner at easse about the agent’s a identity. Don’t forrget to shake hands. While this may seem obvious, it may m not be to someone wh ho has not be en in sales beefore. The neext step is contro olling the envvironment. The agent musst suggest thaat the meetin ng occur in the kitchen or a sittingg room. Any place that do oes not have a television o r other distraaction is acceptable. When n sitting, the mortgage m age ent must ensu ure that the cclient is seated across the ttable and nott to the e left or right of him or herr. If the meetting includes a spouse it iss important to o have them both sitting s across from the age ent. This is im mportant becaause if the aggent ends up between the couple, he or she will w not be ab ble to gauge both b of their rreactions simultaneously. By being ablee to watch the clientts’ movementts and body laanguage, thee agent will bee able to bettter determinee who the t decision‐m maker is. Pa ause for cllarification n – Decisio on‐maker Th he decision‐m maker is the sp pouse or individual in a re lationship wh ho is primarilyy re esponsible forr the ultimate e decision. Th he non‐decisioon making sp pouse or indivvidual will offten look at th he decision‐m maker when a question is bbeing asked o or a decision m must be made. By askin ng simple que estions at the e beginning off the meetingg you can deteermine who the decision‐maker is by waatching this be ehaviour. Payy attention to o both, but fo ocus on the de ecision‐makerr! Chapter 11: The Initial C onsultation 23 35 It is not rude to ask a client to turn off a television or radiio, or limit the amount of distraction that may m be occurring around the room, succh as by puttinng a dog in an nother room.. If the mortggage agent te ells the client that his or he er full attentioon is required d to ensure th hat the right produ uct and best rate r is attaine ed, the client should agreee to the requeest. Before beginning the t interview it is importan nt to create trust. This is m much more d difficult and time consuming c to o do in a client’s home as opposed o to thhe agent’s offfice since the office enviro onment in itself depicts prrofessionalism m. In the hom me environmeent the agentt must prove professionalism an nd technical proficiency. p This T should bee done at the outset. The client will alread dy unconsciou usly begin to look at the aggent as a proofessional if th he agent dressses professionally; how wever this is not n enough to o create trustt quickly. To acccomplish thiss task requires preparation n. A few minuutes should b be spent discu ussing the agentt’s background and experie ence. If the agent a is new, then the focu us should be on the broke erage’s background. This will w reassure the t client thaat he or she iss dealing with ha professional. Once e this has bee en accomplish hed it is time to move on tto taking the application. The Mortgag ge Agent’ s Office Meeting in the age ent’s office re equires the saame attentionn to detail as meeting in a client’s homee; howe ever it is easie er to set the to one of the me eeting beforeehand. Given n the promineent display off any aw wards, professsional accom mplishments, diplomas, etcc., the client w will begin to u unconsciouslyy develop a level of trust t as soon as he or she enters the m meeting room.. To illustratee this point consid der a doctor. In each exam mination room m there tendss to be a diplo oma on the w wall. This is design ned to reassu ure the patien nt that the do octor is indeedd a practicingg professional. The same resultt occurs when n a client seess the evidence of accompl ishments in tthe agent’s offfice. Yet anoth her example is the promine ent displayingg of awards bby Real Estatee Salespersons. They underrstand that qu uickly creating trust is key to a strong r elationship. Limiting distraction ns by turning off cell phones and closinng the office d door is also reequired, as well as a ensuring th hat the client or clients are e seated acrosss from the m mortgage agent. Ano other Outs side Loca ation A morrtgage agent once said thaat he had ove er two hundreed offices in O Ontario. He w was referring to Tim m Horton’s loccations. Mee eting a client at a another ouutside locatio on, although p perhaps moree conve enient for the e client, limitss the control that t the agennt has over the environment. This mean ns that distracctions may be e unavoidable e. To limit thee distractionss, the agent sh hould arrive early and choose an a area within n the location n that has thee least amoun nt of traffic. The saame process that occurs in n a client’s ho ome must theen be followeed. Ensure that the client or clie ents are seate ed across from m the agent and a that the i ntroduction iincludes sufficient inform mation on the e agent’s cred dentials to elicit a feeling oof trust from tthe client. 11.4 4 Identity y Verificattion In tod day’s mortgagge market, ide entity theft and impersonaation are a siggnificant concern, making it necessary for the e mortgage agent to verifyy the identity of his or her client at the initial 236 Chapter 11: The Initial Consultation consultation. Regardless of whether the appointment is conducted at the client’s residence or elsewhere, the mortgage agent must obtain photo identification for all clients. Where possible a photocopy should be taken of this identification, or a picture taken, either using a camera or smartphone, but if not possible then an attestation to the fact that the identification was viewed must be made and put in the file. In all cases the statement below that best represents the circumstances of the identity verification should be included in the application when submitted to the lender, ideally in the notes section. Three forms of typical attestations, based on differing circumstances are: “I have / have not met the client before however I have viewed photo identification in the form of (driver’s license, passport, etc,) and attest to the fact that it appears to be an accurate representation of the client,” or “The client is a previous client of mine and I have viewed photo identification in the form of (driver’s license, passport, etc.) and attest to the fact that it appears to be an accurate representation of the client,” or In the case of taking an application by email or through the Internet where personal contact is not possible, “I have/have not met the client before and have not personally met the client in this transaction and therefore cannot verify the client’s identify through photo identification.” While obtaining photo identification is not legally mandated as of the date of publication of this book, it is a best practice and should be followed without fail to protect the integrity of the transaction and the security of all parties involved. In so doing the mortgage agent affirms his or her professionalism to both of his or her clients: the lender and the borrower. If the borrower protests, inform him or her that it is for his or her protection. If the client continues to protest this should be taken as a red flag for fraud and the mortgage agent should refuse to continue with the transaction until the client agrees to produce valid identification. 11.5 The Application Form The mortgage application form is the document that is used to obtain all of the information required to qualify the borrower. There is no standard application; many brokerages have their own form. However, all forms request the same information from the borrower and therefore require the same explanation. Example Bob Clark has decided that he wants to buy a new home. He’s found a house currently under construction and would like to see if he qualifies for a mortgage. You have met with Bob and have taken his application, as illustrated in the following figure. 23 37 Chapter 11: The Initial C onsultation Figure 37 – Sample Ap pplication Form REEMIC Mortgagess Inc. Sourcce: Flyer 123 Anywhere A Stre eet, Suite 100 0 Toron nto, ON, M1S 5B2 Tel: (4 416) 555‐1212 Mortgaage Ap pplicaation Form m AP PPLICANT(S) Name e of Applicantt in Full Bob Clark C Contaact Informatio on Tel: 416‐555‐9999 Name e of Co‐Appliccant in Full N/A Contaact Informatio on DOB (MM/DD D/YYYY) 03/22/1970 Cel: 647‐5 555‐1212 SIN N 55 55‐121‐121 Email: bob.clark@ @hotmail.com DOB (MM/DD D/YYYY) SIN N Present Address 1155 Renter Boule evard, Toronto, ON, M1S 1N1 1 Previo ous Address No of Yeaars 4 No. of Years DETAILS OF MORTGAGE M R REQUEST Purpo ose of Mortgaage Purch hase a new ho ome currentlyy under consttruction Amou unt Rate Term Frequency F Amortization A Date Requ uired Rank (1st, 2nd) th $500,000 4.5% 5 Years Monthly M 25 2 years February 220 , 2013 1st PARTICULLARS OF SECU URITY Lot # Plan # Municipallity O Occupancy R Rental Incomee 99 W1234 W Toronto A Applicants $N/A Civic Address A (if diffferent from Present Addrress) ot size Lo 1234 borrower Lan ne, Toronto, ON, O M1S 1M1 1 50ft. X 150 ft. PR ROPERTY TYP PE AND CONSSTRUCTION Annuaal Taxes Date Acquired A Purchase Price Down Present $500 Payment Value (MM//DD/YYYY) 0,000 $3,200 0.00 $0.00 $500,0000 N/A Detached Duplex Triplex Semi Townhouse Other Age of o Building: Ne ew Constru uction: Brick Storeys: 2 Zoning: Residential Garagge: Single ‐ Atttached He eating: Forced d Air/Gas Condo (M Mtc Fee: $___________) # of Bedroo oms: 3 Prope erty Extras (Describe) Finish hed Basementt, central air, central vac, outdoor o Jacuzzzi 238 Ran nk Chapter 11: The Initial C onsultation urrent Cu Baalance DETAILS OF EXISTING E FIN NANCING Rate R Paym ment Lender (%) Renew wal Date To Remain n? 1st Mtg N/A N/A N//A N/A N/A N/A 2nd Mtg N/A N/A N//A N/A N/A N/A EMPLOYMENT INFORM MATION APPLIICANT’S EMP PLOYER’S NAM ME: SELF‐EMPLO OYED? Delivery Inc. POSITION: Truck T Driver FastD ADDR RESS: 600 Freiight Lane, Torronto, ON INCOM ME: $125,000 0 Per Year TEL. 416‐8 888‐9999 FAX: 416‐9 999‐0000 NO. OF YEA ARS: 4 CO‐AP PPLICANT’S EMPLOYER’S E NAME: SELF‐EMPLO OYED? OTHER INCOME (SPECIFY SOUR RCE AND AMO OUNT) N/A ASSETS AND LIABILITTIES ASSETT TYPE BANK K ACCOUNT 2007 Ford F150 Perso onal Effects RRSP OTHER: TOTAL NET WORTH W AMOUNT LIABILITYY TYPE A AMOUNT PAYMENT TO REMAIN?? $ 50,000.00 $ 25,000.00 MasterCaard $ 0.00 $ 0.00 Y $ 40,000.00 $ $ $ 25,000.00 $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $140,000.00 0 $ 0.00 $ 0.00 ASSETS ($14 40,000.00) – LIABILITIES ($$0.00) = NETT WORTH $140,000.00 NOTES Mr. Clark would likke a 25 year amortization a with w a loan too value of 1000%. CONSENT C IN CONNECTION WITH MY M APPLICATION FOR CREDIT, I/WE HEREBY AGREE TO O YOU PROCURIN G ANY CREDIT OR R OTHER REPORTSS TO MINE MY ABILITY TO OBTAIN MORTGAGE FINANCING AND SHARE TH HIS INFORMATION N WITH OTHER CR REDIT GRANTORS OR DETERM CONSUM MER REPORTING AGENCIES. I/WEE FURTHER AGREEE THAT YOU MAYY ASSIGN THIS APPPLICATION TO TH HE LENDER OF YO OUR CHOICE AND MAY DESIG GNATE THE CLOSING LAWYER. I/W WE ACKNOWLEDG GE THAT YOU MA AY RECEIVE A FIND DERS FEE FROM TTHE LENDER R. I/WE FURTHER STATE THAT THE INFORMATION CONTAINED IN THIIS APPLICATION ISS ACCURATE TO THE BEST OF MY/O OUR KNOWLLEDGE. I/WE AU UTHORIZE YOU TO O USE THE INFORMATION CONTA AINED WITHIN TH HIS APPLICATION AND AS OBTAIN NED THROUG GH THIS TRANSAC CTION TO PROVID DE ME/US WITH INFORMATION TH HAT YOU BELIEVEE MAY BE OF INTEREST TO US IN TTHE FUTURE E. DATE: Jan 20, 2013 3 APPLICANT’S SIGNATUREE: Bobb Clarkk 23 39 Chapter 11: The Initial C onsultation Sec tion-by-S Section Applicatio A on Analyssis Appliccant(s) Inform mation Figure 38 – Borrower Application: A Info ormation Sectio on REEMIC Mortgagess Inc. Sourcce: Flyer 123 Anywhere A Stre eet, Suite 100 0 Toron nto, ON, M1S 5B2 Tel: (4 416) 555‐1212 Mortgaage Ap pplicaation Form m AP PPLICANT(S) Name e of Applicantt in Full Bob Clark C Contaact Informatio on Tel: 416‐555‐9999 Name e of Co‐Appliccant in Full N/A Contaact Informatio on DOB (MM/DD D/YYYY) 03/22/1970 Cel: 647‐5 555‐1212 Present Address 1155 Renter Boule evard, Toronto, ON, M1S 1N1 1 Previo ous Address SIN N 55 55‐121‐121 Email: bob.clark@ @hotmail.com DOB (MM/DD D/YYYY) SIN N No of Yeaars 4 No. of Years Source Source refers to o how the app plicant heard about the m mortgage agen nt. Examples might be a refferral, in whicch case it is ne ecessary to ask who referrred the appliccant, or an ad dvertisement, in which case it is necessary to ask which advertisemeent the applicant viewed. orrower’s Nam me Bo The applicant must m provide his h or her fulll legal name, as it will be u used to complete the credit inq quiry as well as a on all othe er loan docum mentation, inccluding the legal documen ntation to reggister the mo ortgage. It is a best practicce to view phooto identificaation at this sttage to ensurre thaat the applicaant is the persson that he or she is applyying as. pplicant Date Of Birth and Co‐App Date of Birth Ap Do ocument the applicant’s a an nd co‐applicant’s date of bbirth. Use thee application’s format. If 3/7/1980 maay no o format is sho own, use a fo ormat that is easily e identifi able. For exaample, using 3 be misinterpretted. Instead use u the formaat March 7, 11980. Social Insurance e Number (SIN) It is helpful to have h the sociaal insurance number n whenn completing a credit inquiiry; however it is not n mandatory. If the app plicant does not wish to prrovide his or h her social insu urance 240 Chapter 11: The Initial C onsultation he mortgage agent a cannott demand it. A An applicant may legally refuse to number then th pro ovide this info ormation. Co ontact Informaation Re ecord the applicant’s contaact informatio on, including his or her em mail address. The email address will be especially useful in the futture when maarketing to th he applicant. Ensure that the e main contacct number is clearly indicaated. pplicant’s Pressent Address Ap Do ocument the applicant’s a cu urrent addresss with postal code and ind dicate the len ngth of time thaat the applicaant has reside ed at this locaation. The poostal code is o of particular im mportance fo or the e default insu urer as the inssurer has auto omated valuaation systemss that use thiss information n to assist in dete ermining if the e value noted d on the appliication is con nsistent in thee area in whicch the e property is located. Pre evious Address If the t applicant has resided at a their prese ent address foor three yearss or less, the m mortgage agent should do ocument the applicant’s previous addreess. The totaal of all addresses should b be at least three ye ears. Co o‐Applicant orr Guarantor Co o‐applicant sp pouses are inccluded in the same applicaation. All otheer applicants’’ names sho ould be listed d in the appliccation, howevver each appllicant should have a separrate application com mpleted on him or her to ensure e that al l information n is captured aand that infformation rele evant to each h applicant is separate. Foor example, iff there is a bro other who is a co‐applicant hiss name should d be included d in the appliccation to ena ble anyone viewing the application to know k that he or she must refer r to the bbrother’s appllication as weell. Pa ause for cllarification n – Co‐app plicants and d guaranttors A co‐applicant is an individu ual who is app plying with thhe applicant aand who will be re egistered on title and/or on n the mortgagge. The co‐appplicant’s inccome and deb bts are included in all mortgage m calcculations. egistered on title but who o is guaranteeeing to the A guarantor is an individuall who is not re lender that if th he applicant fails f to meet his or her oblligations undeer the loan th he gu uarantor will meet m those obligations, o su uch as makingg the loan payyments. The guarantor’s income and debts are not in ncluded in the e mortgage caalculations un nless he or sh he lives in the same home e. Details of Mortgagge Request Figure 39 – Borrower Application: A Dettails of Mortgag ge Request DETAILS OF MORTGAGE M R REQUEST Purpo ose of Mortgaage Purch hase a new ho ome currentlyy under consttruction Amou unt Rate Term Frequency F Amortization A $500,000 4.5% 5 Years Monthly M 25 2 years Date Requ uired February 220th, 2013 R Rank (1st, 2nd) 1 1st Chapter 11: The Initial Consultation 241 Purpose of the mortgage This section must be as detailed as possible, indicating the purpose or reason for the requested financing. For example, if it is an equity take‐out, the use of the proceeds must be indicated. Amount Requested Enter the total amount that the applicant is requesting based on the preliminary consultation. This amount may change once it has been determined if a mortgage default insurance premium is being added and/or any other fees need to be added to the mortgage amount. Term of Mortgage Document the term that the applicant and mortgage agent have decided is appropriate for the applicant. This requires the mortgage agent to discuss the applicant’s future plans. Amortization The Amortization period is the total number of years it will take to fully repay the mortgage, as decided upon after a discussion between the mortgage agent and the applicant. A shorter amortization period will result in a higher payment while a longer amortization period will result in a lower payment. Date Required If the application is for the purchase of a home, document the closing date of the purchase. If it is for a switch or renewal, document the date that the term expires. If it is for a refinance, document the date on which the applicant requires the funds or the date that the mortgage agent expects the transaction to fund. Do not use “ASAP” or “As Soon As Possible” without discussing the time frame with the applicant. It is important to manage the applicant’s expectations regarding the time that the process will take from application to funding. Type of Mortgage Document the type of mortgage that the applicant is requesting, such as a VRM or variable rate mortgage, FRM or fixed rate mortgage, LOC or line of credit, etc. Accelerated Payment Document if the applicant would like to accelerate the mortgage payment to repay the mortgage in a shorter period of time, which will save the applicant money over time. The applicant must understand that an accelerated mortgage payment is higher than a regular mortgage payment. Rank Document whether the requested mortgage is a 1st, 2nd, 3rd or other mortgage. 242 Chapter 11: The Initial C onsultation urity Particculars of Secu Figure 40 – Borrower Application: A Parrticulars of Secu urity PARTICULLARS OF SECU URITY Lot # Plan # Municipality O Occupancy 99 Toronto W1234 W A pplicants Civic Address A (if diffferent from Present Addrress) 1234 borrower Lan ne, Toronto, ON, O M1S 1M1 1 R Rental Incomee $N/A ot size Lo 50ft. X 150 ft. umber (Part of o the Legal Description) Lott and Plan Nu A lot refers to a tract or parccel of land and each parcell is assigned a lot number,, as well as a plaan number which refers to o the plan. Th his informatioon is typically found on thee Purchase and Sale Agreem ment, the Traansfer/Deed and a Charge/M Mortgage. Mu unicipality (paart of the Leggal Description) Do ocument where the properrty is located.. This inform ation is typically found on n the Purchasee and Sale Agreem ment, the Traansfer/Deed and a Charge/M Mortgage. Occcupancy If the t property will w be occup pied by the ow wner alone, chheck the applicant box. Iff the propertyy will be rented to a tenant, ch heck the tenaant box. If thee property will be occupieed by the wner and a tenant, check both b boxes. ow ental Income Re If the t property is being rente ed or leased to t tenants, hoow much is th he rent? Civvic Address Of The Propertty To Be Morttgaged This is the stand dard address of a propertyy, including thhe street nam me and numbeer, city, pro ovince and po ostal code. Complete C this section if thee property to be mortgageed is differentt fro om the applicant’s current address. Forr example, if tthe applicantt is currently rrenting and thiis application is to purchasse another prroperty, the ccurrent addreess will be his or her rental address while the property to t be mortgagged address w will be the neew home address. Lott Size Incclude the lot specifications s s here. Prope erty Type and d Constructio on Figure 41 – Property Type T and Constru uction Date Acquired A (MM//DD/YYYY) N/A PR ROPERTY TYP PE AND CONS TRUCTION Purchase Price Down Present 0,000 $500 Payment Value $0.00 $500,0000 Detached Duplex Triplex Semi Townhouse Other Age of o Building: Ne ew Constru uction: Brick Storeys: 2 Annuaal Taxes $3,200 0.00 Condo (M Mtc Fee: $___________) # of Bedroo oms: 3 243 Chapter 11: The Initial Consultation Zoning: Residential Garage: Single ‐ Attached Heating: Forced Air/Gas Property Extras (Describe) Finished Basement, central air, central vac, outdoor Jacuzzi Date Property Acquired or Purchased Document the date that the property was originally purchased. Purchase Price (If Less than 2 Years Ago) Document the price paid for the property. Down Payment Document the amount of down payment that the applicant originally provided. Present Value Document the value that the applicant feels his or her house is currently worth. Annual Taxes Document the amount of taxes that are paid on the property annually. If Condo, Condo Mtc. Fee If the property to be mortgaged is a condominium unit it will have a maintenance fee. This amount must be recorded in this section, including what items are including in the fee. Check the boxes that apply regarding the type and description of the building(s) Property Extras List any property extras of interest such as a finished basement, indoor or outdoor pool, etc. Details of Existing Financing This section is designed to document any and all existing financing currently on the property to be mortgaged. If the application is for a purchase, this section may be left blank. Figure 42 – Borrower Application: Details of Existing Financing Rank Current Balance DETAILS OF EXISTING FINANCING Rate Payment Lender (%) Renewal Date To Remain? 1st Mtg N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A 2nd Mtg N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A Mortgage(s) Document the current outstanding balance of the mortgage, the current rate of interest, the amount of the payment, including the frequency of the payment (i.e., monthly, weekly, etc.), which institution or private lender the first mortgage is currently held by, the contact information for that lender and if the mortgage is to be paid off from the proceeds of the 244 Chapter 11: The Initial Consultation new mortgage being applied for if it will remain in place. Complete this process for all mortgages on the property, including any Lines of Credit. Employment Information Figure 43 – Borrower Application: Employment Information EMPLOYMENT INFORMATION APPLICANT’S EMPLOYER’S NAME: SELF‐ EMPLOYED? FastDelivery Inc. POSITION: Truck Driver ADDRESS: 600 Freight Lane, Toronto, ON INCOME: $125,000 Per Year CO‐APPLICANT’S EMPLOYER’S NAME: EMPLOYED? TEL. 416‐888‐9999 FAX: 416‐999‐0000 NO. OF YEARS: 4 SELF‐ OTHER INCOME (SPECIFY SOURCE AND AMOUNT) N/A Employer’s Name, Address/Tel# Document the applicant’s current employment information. Self‐Employed? If the applicant is self employed Position Document the applicant’s position or title with his or her current employer. # of Years Document the number of years that the applicant has been employed by his or her current employer. Salary Document the salary or income of the applicant before taxes are deducted. Per Year or Month Document whether the salary or income from the previous section is an annual or monthly amount. Other Income Document any other income that the applicant has ensuring that full details are provided. Previous Employer’s Information Complete the fields attached to this section in the same fashion as for the current employer. Co‐Applicant’s Employer Complete the fields attached to this section in the same fashion as for the applicant. 245 Chapter 11: The Initial Consultation Financial Information Figure 44 – Borrower Application: Assets and Liabilities ASSETS AND LIABILITIES ASSET TYPE BANK ACCOUNT 2007 Ford F150 Personal Effects RRSP OTHER: TOTAL NET WORTH AMOUNT LIABILITY TYPE AMOUNT PAYMENT TO REMAIN? $ 50,000.00 $ 25,000.00 MasterCard $ 0.00 $ 0.00 Y $ 40,000.00 $ $ $ 25,000.00 $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $140,000.00 $ 0.00 $ 0.00 ASSETS ($140,000.00) – LIABILITIES ($0.00) = NET WORTH $140,000.00 Assets Document all assets owned by the applicant. Include an addendum if there is not enough space to list all of them. All personal effects can be totalled and listed as Personal Effects. If this mortgage is a refinance, switch or equity take‐out, be sure to include the value of the property in this section as well. Add up all assets and document this as Total Assets. Liabilities Document all liabilities for which the applicant is responsible. Include an addendum if there is not enough space to list all of them. If this mortgage is a refinance, switch or equity take‐ out, be sure to include the outstanding balance of the mortgage in this section as well. Add up all liabilities and document this as Total Liabilities. Payments Document the payment totals for each listed liability as a monthly amount. Document the total monthly obligations of the applicant in the space provided. To Remain? Document which, if any, of the liabilities will be paid off from the proceeds of the proposed mortgage. Net Worth List the Assets and Liabilities. Subtract the liabilities from the assets and list this amount as the Net Worth. Notes Detail anything of importance that may impact the applicant’s ability to obtain an approval and/or that may add to or clarify information in the application. 246 Chapter 11: The Initial C onsultation orization Autho This section, once signed by the e applicant(s), allows the m mortgage ageent to perform m the requireed investtigations and provide requ uired information to potenntial lenders. Tips s for a Co omplete Applicatio A on plete all Fields Comp Ensurre that all field ds of the application are completed, whhether or nott information n is obtained for that field. For example, e if th he field does not apply to tthe applicatio on it is best to o enter “N/A”” or “no ot applicable”” in the field. If the field iss left blank soomeone viewiing the appliccation in the future e will be unab ble to determ mine if the info ormation wass missed bein ng entered or if it was not appliccable to this applicant. a pare Informattion with Doccumentation Comp When n taking an ap pplication verify that what the applican t is saying maatches the infformation found d in the suppo orting documentation. Some applicantts may inadveertently provide inaccuratee inform mation such as a employment income or outstanding balances on his or her mo ortgage or other debts. Signature When n completing a paper appliication, ensurre that the appplicant(s) siggn(s) the application. By having the client’s signature on the applicatiion, the morttgage agent h has consent to o complete the ne ecessary inve estigations to obtain a com mmitment fro m a lender. A Although verb bal autho orization is acceptable, som me applicantss may disputee providing au uthorization aat some pointt in the e future. For example, e if an n applicant iss declined andd six months later attemptts to obtain financcing, he or she may not recall the reaso on for the inq uiry on his orr her credit reeport. The appliccant may then n contact Equ uifax or Transunion (whichhever credit reeporting agen ncy the inquirry was found through) and d request thatt the inquiry bbe removed. Equifax or Transunion will contact the mortgaage agent or mortgage bro okerage to reequest the authorization fo or that credit inquirry. If there is no signed ap pplication, the e applicant m may have a casse that the mortgage agen nt initiatted the creditt inquiry without the applicant’s authorrity, which is a breach of the contract betwe een the credit reporting aggency and the e brokerage. In this case tthe mortgagee agent would d be req quired to provide addition nal details abo out how the aauthorization n was given an nd when it was given g to be ab ble to prove th hat it was a le egitimate creddit inquiry. Notess The mortgage m application form itself does no ot provide sppace for explaanatory notess. The mortggage agent sh hould use a se eparate piece e of paper or a Notes pagee, such as the Worksheet, to maake notes rele evant to the application. a For F example, if the applicaant indicates tthat he or shee has haad past creditt issues, the mortgage m age ent must docuument that in nformation an nd include it iin the lo oan submissio on to the lend der. A best prractice is to innclude explan natory notes ffor any poten ntial questions that a lende er may have about a the appplication. 11.6 6 Determiining the Applican nt’s Need ds Deterrmining the applicant’s nee eds is a very important i steep in completting the application. To determine the app plicant’s need ds, specific questions mustt be asked. Th he following fform, which may be b reproduced without permission, assists in determ mining those n needs. Once the form hass Chapter 11: The Initial Consultation 247 been completed the mortgage agent can search for specific products that meet the applicant’s needs. The following figure is a sample of an Applicant Needs Assessment form. Figure 45 – Applicant Needs Assessment Applicant Needs Assessment 1. What are your goals with regards to this mortgage? Purchase: Price Range from $__________ to $__________ Down payment Available: $__________________ Obtain a lower rate: Current Rate: _________% Obtain a lower payment: Current Payment: $__________ Consolidate Debt: Amount: $___________ Renovations: Amount: $__________ Type of Renovations: __________________________________ Other. Explain:_______________________________________________________________ 2. What is the amount of the mortgage payment that you believe would fit your current lifestyle? From $__________ to $__________ 3. What interest rate range do you expect to obtain? From __________% to __________% 4. Do you plan on moving in the next 5 years? If yes, when? 5. Do you plan on changing employers in the next 5 years? Is yes, when? 6. Do you believe your current home will meet your family’s needs over the next five years? Yes No 7. Do you typically receive bonus or commission income in addition to your regular income? If yes, how often? Annually Monthly 8. Do you intend to make a lump sum payment or payments on your mortgage to pay it off faster? Yes No 9. Which is most important to you: Debt Repayment: Paying your mortgage off as soon as possible? 248 Chapter 11: The Initial Consultation Cash Flow: Having a low or the lowest payment possible? 10. Which is most important to you: Mortgage Payment: Having a mortgage payment that fits your cash flow? Interest Rate: Having a low or the lowest interest rate possible? 11. When it comes to your mortgage payment, would you say that you: Would like a mortgage payment that stays the same month to month? Would like a mortgage payment that might increase or decrease if there is the potential to save money? 12. If given the option to have a variable interest rate that is lower than a fixed interest rate, would you: Be willing to watch interest rates on a monthly basis to ensure that your mortgage has the best rate possible?, OR Prefer to have a fixed interest rate that did not fluctuate and did not require regular attention? 13. Would you prefer a payment frequency that is: Monthly Additional Notes: Bi‐Weekly Weekly Chapter 11: The Initial Consultation 249 11.7 Key Terms and Definitions Business License A license provided to a business that serves as proof that a business is registered and operational Civic Address The street address of a property, including the number of the property, the street, the unit number (if applicable), the province and the postal code Closed‐ended Question A question designed to elicit a single word answer such as a yes or no Co‐Applicant An individual who is registered on title and who is applying for financing with the applicant Decision‐Maker The individual who tends to make the majority of the decisions for the family unit File The collection of relevant documents related to a mortgage transaction File Checklist A document that allows the mortgage agent to check off the documents received in the file Financial Statements Formal records of a business' financial activities. These statements provide an overview of a business' profitability and financial condition in both short and long term. Guarantor An individual who is not registered on title but who is guaranteeing that payments will be made to the lender if the borrower defaults Legal Description A description of the property, including the lot and plan number, and the municipality, township or borough in which the property is located Letter of Employment A document provided by an employer that lists the employee’s position, length of employment and income MLS Listing Multiple Listing Service. This is typically how real estate salespersons expose a property to the marketplace. Mortgage Repayment History A history of the applicant’s mortgage payments, typically over twelve to twenty‐four months, provided by a lender 250 Chapter 11: The Initial Consultation Open‐Ended Question A question designed to elicit a conversational answer, not simply a “yes” or “no” answer Paystub A document provided to an individual by his or her employer each time the employee is paid (by cheque, direct deposit or other), and is often required by a lender in addition to a job letter and/or any other document used to verify the employee’s income PIPEDA Consent Consent under the Personal Information Protection and Electronic Documents Act that allows the mortgage agent to use the applicant’s information for a set of specific purposes Property Insurance Policy An insurance policy that insures the property against losses due to fire, vandalism, etc. Property Tax Statement A statement provided by the municipality in which the property is located indicating the amount of annual property taxes and if any property taxes are outstanding Purchase and Sale Agreement The document completed by a real estate salesperson for the sale of property T4 A document provided to an individual by his or her employer, typically when there is employment income, such as salaried or hourly income. Employers are required by law to provide the T4 so that employees may file their income tax returns. The T4 indicates, among other things, the amount of money the employee earned in the one year period, as well as the deductions from earnings Tax Return The document required to be completed by a taxpayer and submitted to Canada Revenue Agency that describes income, deductions, expenses, etc. as prescribed by the Income Tax Act Chapter 11: The Initial C onsultation 25 51 11.8 8 Review Question ns Answers to the Revview Questio ons are found at www.REM MIC.ca Sho ort Answe er Questio ons 1. De escribe the do ocumentation n that must be e obtained byy a mortgage agent in every mortgage traansaction. hat documen ntation is typiccally required d for a self‐em mployed indivvidual? 2. Wh 3. Wh hat documen ntation is typiccally required d for a purchaase transactio on? 4. Wh hat documen ntation is typiccally required d for a refinannce, equity taake‐out or sw witch traansaction? 5. Disscuss the imp portance of th he file checklist. 6. Wh here are the different d placces that a clie ent may be m et and what aare the positiives and negatives of eacch? 7. Wh hy is it importtant to verifyy an applicantt’s identity? 8. Disscuss the difference betwe een a co‐appllicant and a gguarantor. 9. Wh hy is it importtant to have the t mortgage e application signed by thee applicant(s)? 10. How can a mortgage agent determine th he applicant’ss needs? 252 Chapter 12: Application Analysis – Borrower Documents Chapter 12: Application Analysis – Borrower Documents Learning Outcomes Successful understanding of the concepts presented in this chapter will enable the learner to: Analyze documents used for income verification Analyze documents used when purchasing a property Complete an application for creditor insurance Identify inconsistencies in borrower documents Identify potential fraudulent borrower documents Review borrower documentation for potential misrepresentation or fraud Introduction The Chapter on the Initial Consultation identifies which documents must be obtained from a potential client. Presented with this documentation, a mortgage agent must be able to review each document to determine if there is any potential misrepresentation or fraud. This requires the mortgage agent to be familiar with these documents, understand the information provided in each and its relevance to the mortgage application, and be able to identify inconsistencies in these documents before they are submitted to the appropriate lender. Clearly it is in the agent’s best interests to do such a review. If an application submitted to a lender contains information in the application that is different than in the supporting documentation, the application process will be slowed down significantly and/or the application may be declined by the lender. The following sections contain a visual representation of each document as well as an analysis of each. 12.1 Fraud and Forgery Unfortunately each of the following documents can be forged and used for fraudulent purposes in the mortgage application process. To help safeguard against submitting forged documents to a lender, the agent must have an understanding of the information contained in each document. With today’s technology, individuals wishing to create a forged document can and will. They can use software to manipulate documents provided by employers, the government or other participants in the mortgage transaction to appear to be valid. Because forgery is more sophisticated in today’s marketplace than ever before, it is necessary for the mortgage agent to closely inspect the documents provided by the borrower. In the vast majority of cases borrowers are honest and supply legitimate documentation. However it is the dishonest borrower who will cause the greatest harm to a mortgage agent’s reputation if that mortgage agent submits forged documentation to a lender that he or she should have known was forged. Chapter 12: Applicatio on Analysis – Borrower Do ocuments 25 53 ollowing docu uments are provided as samples of whaat a mortgagee agent can eexpect to The fo receivve, dependingg on the type of transactio on, as well as the types of information tthat can be expeccted to be fou und in these documents. d 12.2 2 Income Docum mentation In thiss section we will w begin by learning how w to identify bborrower docu uments, follo owed by an explanation and an nalysis of them for accuraccy and inconssistencies, inccluding poten ntial fraud, where e applicable. T4A A A T4A A is a document provided to t an individu ual by his or hher employer which summarizes incomee from various sourcces and is use ed by the indivvidual for subbmitting an annual incomee tax return. This document d is typically obtaiined by a broker/agent whhen the appliccant has com mmission or contraact income, such s as a com mmissioned saales person orr independen nt contractor. There are, howe ever, other tim mes that an applicant will receive r a T4A A. The tyypes of incom me that are re eflected in a T4A T include: pension or supeerannuation lum mp‐sum paym ments sellf‐employed commissions c annuities rettiring allowannces patronage alloccations RESP accumulatted income payments p RESP educationnal assistance payments feees or other am mounts for se ervices or othher income suuch as researrch grants, certain paymennts under a w wage‐loss replacement plan n, death benefits, and certain benefits b paid to partnersh ips or shareholders. Emplo oyers must also prepare a T4A slip if they provided ggroup term liffe insurance (taxable beneffits) for forme er employeess, or retirees, even if the tootal of all ben nefits paid in tthe calendar year was w $500 or less. In additiion, the employer must prrepare a T4A slip if they are the Admin nistrator or trrustee of a multi‐employer plan and th ey provided ttaxable beneffits under thee plan to t employeess, former emp ployees, or retirees, if the ttotal of all beenefits paid exxceeded $25. 254 Figure 46 – Sample T4A A Chapter 12: Applicatio on Analysis – Borrower Do ocuments Chapter 12: Applicatio on Analysis – Borrower Do ocuments 25 55 o a T4A Detailed analysis of This section describes the sectio ons of a T4A that t are mostt relevant to tthe mortgagee process. 1 ‐ Social insurance numb ber Box 12 Emplo oyers must en nter the sociaal insurance number n (SIN) of the recipieent as it appeears on the recipient's SIN card d. If an emplo oyer cannot obtain o the SIN N, the employyer must enteer nine zeroes. Success Tip ‐ SIN S If an applicant pro ovides a T4A with nine zerroes in Box 122, it doesn’t n necessarily meean anything other than the fact th hat the appliccant didn’t prrovide his or h her SIN to thee employer. Full verification v of the applican nt’s informatiion is require d to ensure that he or shee is actually the same s individu ual named in the t T4A. Box 13 1 – Business Number If the T4A is for a business b the employer e must enter the ffirst nine digitts of the recip pient’s business number (BN). Box 16 1 ‐ Pension or o superannuation If the recipient recceived annuityy payments frrom the emp loyer, the em mployer must enter the taxable part of ann nuity paymen nts it paid to an a employee or retired em mployee out o of, or under, a superrannuation orr pension fund d or plan, including disabillity benefits p paid in the form of a life annuiity. Box 18 1 ‐ Lump‐sum m payments Emplo oyers must en nter the taxab ble part of a single s payme nt out of a peension fund o or plan due to o any of the followin ng reasons: witthdrawal from m the plan, re etirement fro om employmeent, or death of an employyee or formerr em mployee; or terrmination of, amendment to, or modification of the plan; or reiimbursementt of any over‐contribution to the plan. Box 20 2 ‐ Self‐emplloyed commissions One of o the most im mportant secttions of a T4A A for a brokerr/agent, Box 220 contains th he amount off comm missions an em mployer paid to a person working w as ann independen nt agent (i.e., not an “employee”). GSTT paid to the recipient r on those servicess is not includ ded in this am mount. Box 22 2 ‐ Income ta ax deducted This iss the total inccome tax deducted by the employer froom the recipieent's remuneeration duringg the ye ear. This inclu udes the fede eral, provinciaal (except Queebec), and territorial taxess that apply. This box b will be blaank if the emp ployer didn’t deduct any t axes during tthe year. Amounts withh held under the e authority off a garnishee or a requirem ment to pay tthat applies to o the emplo oyee's previously assessed d tax arrears will w not appeaar here. 256 on Analysis – Borrower Do ocuments Chapter 12: Applicatio 6 ‐ Payer's Bu usiness Number (BN) Box 61 This iss the 15‐digit BN of the em mployer, and does not apppear on copiess provided to o the recipient. If the BN does app pear the broke er/agent shou uld confirm thhe informatio on on the slip p from the emplo oyer as this may m be a sign of a forged document, sinnce many indiividuals aren’t aware that the BN is not to ap ppear on the recipient’s r slip. T4 A T4 is a documentt provided to o an individual by his or he r employer to o summarize income for a given one year perriod. This doccument is typ pically obtaineed by a brokeer/agent when the appliccant has employment inco ome such as salaried or ho urly income. Everyy employer (re esident or non‐resident) must m provide a T4 slip to em mployees if itt has paid its emplo oyees any of the t followingg types of inco ome: em mployment income taxxable allowannces and beneefits fishing income or o any other payments forr services ren dered duringg the year sallary, wages (including pay in lieu of term mination notiice,) tips or gratuities, bon nuses, vacation pay, em mployment commissions, c gross and inssurable earnings of self‐em mployed fishers, and all other o remune eration paid to t employeess during the yyear taxxable benefitss or allowancces deductions withhheld by the employer e durring the year and pension adjustm ment (PA) am mounts for em mployees whoo accrued a beenefit for the year under the e employer’s registered pe ension plan (R RPP) or deferrred profit‐shaaring plan (DPSP) Detailed analysis of o a T4 This section describes the sectio ons of a T4 th hat are most rrelevant to th he mortgage process. Emplo oyer's name The operating or trrading name of the emplo oyer. Emplo oyee's name and address The employee's lasst name, follo owed by the first f name andd initial, not iincluding the title of the emplo oyee (such ass Director, Mrr., or Mrs.), fo ollowed by th e employee'ss address, inccluding the provin nce, territory, or U.S. state e, Canadian postal code orr U.S. zip codee, and countrry. Year The fo our digits of the t calendar year y in which the employeer paid the remuneration tto the emplo oyee. Chapter 12: Application Analysis – Borrower Documents Figure 47 – Sample T4 257 258 Chapter 12: Application Analysis – Borrower Documents Box 10 ‐ Province of employment One of the following abbreviations will indicate where the employee reported to work: AB BC MB NB NL NS NT ZZ Alberta NU Nunavut British Columbia ON Ontario Manitoba PE Prince Edward Island New Brunswick QC Quebec Newfoundland and Labrador SK Saskatchewan Nova Scotia YT Yukon Northwest Territories US United States Other ZZ is used if an employee worked in a country other than Canada or the U.S., or worked in Canada beyond the limits of a province or territory (for example, on an offshore oil rig). For any employee who worked in or whose employment was located in more than one province, territory, or country in the year, separate T4 slips are completed. For each location, the total remuneration paid to the employee and the related deductions, such as CPP/QPP contributions, EI premiums, and tax is listed. Box 12 ‐ Social insurance number The employee's social insurance number (SIN) as it appears on the employee's SIN card. If the employer doesn’t have the SIN, this section will contain nine zeros. Box 14 ‐ Employment income This box reports the total income before deductions, including all salary, wages (including pay in lieu of termination notice), bonuses, vacation pay, tips and gratuities, honorariums, director's fees, management fees, and executor's and Administrator's fees received to administer an estate (as long as the Administrator or executor does not act in this capacity in the regular course of business). Boxes 16 and 17 ‐ Employee's CPP or QPP contributions This box reports the amount deducted from the employee for contributions to the Canada Pension Plan (CPP) or Quebec Pension Plan (QPP). Box 18 ‐ Employee's EI (Employment Insurance) premiums This box reports the amount of EI premiums deducted from the employee's earnings. If premiums were not deducted this box will be blank. Based on federal regulations, the maximum amount to be deducted for EI premiums in 2012 is $839.97. 25 59 Chapter 12: Applicatio on Analysis – Borrower Do ocuments Succcess Tip – EI E premium ms If the e amount in Box B 18 exceed ds the maximu um annual prremium, as in ndicated in the chart below w, the brokerr/agent should d review the T4 to ensure that it is not fraudulent. TThe follow wing table illu ustrates the maximum m amounts of insuurable earninggs and maxim mum employee premiums over the past p several years. y ear Max. Ann nual Insurab ble Earning gs Ra ate (%) Feder ral Quebec Max. A Annual Empl oyee mium Prem Max. Annual Employer Premium Federal Quebec Federal Quebec 2012 $45,900 1.8 83 1.47 $839.97 $674.73 $1,175.96 $944.62 2011 $44,200 1.7 78 1.41 $786.76 $623.22 $1,101.46 $872.51 2010 $43,200 1.7 73 1.36 $747.36 $587.52 $1,046.30 $822.53 2009 $42,300 1.7 73 1.38 $731.79 $583.74 $1,024.51 $817.24 2008 $41,100 1.7 73 1.39 $711.03 $571.29 $995.44 $799.81 2007 $40,000 1.8 80 1.46 $720.00 $584.00 $1,008.00 $817.60 2006 $39,000 1.8 87 1.53 $729.30 $596.70 $1,021.02 $835.38 2 ‐ RPP contrributions Box 20 This box b reports th he total amou unt the emplo oyee contribuuted to a regisstered pensio on plan (RPP). If the employee did not contribute to a plan,, this box willl be blank. Box 24 2 ‐ EI insurab ble earnings This box b reports th he total amou unt used to caalculate the eemployee's EI premiums. TThis box will b be blank if: theere are no inssurable earninngs inssurable earninngs are the saame as the em mployment inncome in boxx 14; or inssurable earninngs are over the t maximum m for the yearr (see the desscription provvided for Box 18) Box 26 2 ‐ CPP/QPP pensionable earnings In mo ost cases, this box will be blank. b Box 46 4 ‐ Charitable e donations This box b reports am mounts deducted from the e employee'ss earnings forr donations to o registered charitties in Canadaa. Box 22 2 ‐ Income ta ax deducted This box b reports th he total incom me tax deductted from the employee's rremuneration n. This includees the fe ederal, provin ncial (except Quebec), Q and territorial taxxes that apply. If no taxes were deduccted this box will be blank. 260 Chapter 12: Applicatio on Analysis – Borrower Do ocuments Su uccess Tip – Income tax rates Mortgage agen nts should be aware of the e following taxxes to be ded ducted and sh hould ensure that the amoun nts on the T4 appear to me eet the follow wing table. Iff a mortgage aagent believees that the taxes deducted d in Box B 22 are no ot reflective oof the applican nt’s income h he or she sh hould confirm m the informattion on the slip from the eemployer as this may be a sign of a fo orged docume ent. Tax ratess can be obtained from Caanada Revenu ue Agency’s w website at htttp://www.craa‐arc.gc.ca Fo or 2012, the Federal F rates are: 15% on n the first $42 2,707 of taxable income, + 22% on n the next $42,707 of taxaable income (oon the portio on of taxable income over $4 42,707 up to $85,414), + 26% on n the next $46,992 of taxaable income (oon the portio on of taxable income over $8 85,414 up to $132,406), + 29% off taxable income over $132 2,406. or 2011, the Ontario O rates are: Fo 5.05% on the first $39,020 of taxxable income,, + $ + 9.15% on the next $39,023, % on the amount over $78,,043 11.16% 5 ‐ Business Number Box 54 This box b contains the t 15‐digit Business B Number (BN) thatt is used by th he employer tto report deducctions to CRA A. The BN shou uld not appeaar on the twoo copies of thee T4 slip that are given to emplo oyees. If the BN does appear the broke er/agent shouuld confirm th he informatio on on the slip from the employerr as this may be a sign of a forged docuument, since m many individu uals aren’t aware e that the BN is not to app pear on the re ecipient’s slip . "Othe er informatio on" area The "o other informaation" area att the bottom of the T4 slipp has boxes fo or the employyer to enter codess and amountts that relate to employme ent commissioons, taxable aallowances an nd benefits, deducctible amountts, fishers' inccome, and other entries iff they apply. Example 40 Boxx ‐ Case 22400.98 Amoun nt ‐ Montant Codess 30 to 85 ‐ Ta axable allowaances and be enefits, deducctible amoun nts, employm ment comm missions, and other entries 30 ‐ Housing, bo oard, and lodging 31 ‐ Special worrk site 32 ‐ Travel in a prescribed zo one Chapter 12: Applicatio on Analysis – Borrower Do ocuments 33 34 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 53 70 71 72 73 74 75 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 ‐ ‐ ‐ ‐ ‐ ‐ ‐ ‐ ‐ ‐ ‐ ‐ ‐ ‐ ‐ ‐ ‐ ‐ ‐ ‐ ‐ ‐ ‐ ‐ ‐ ‐ 26 61 Medical traavel Personal usse of employe er's automob bile Interest‐fre ee and low‐interest loan Employee home‐relocat h tion loan deduction Security op ptions benefitts Security op ptions deduction 110(1)(d) Other taxab ble allowance es and benefits Security op ptions deduction 110(1)(d.1) Employmen nt commissio ons Canadian Forces F personnel and policce deduction Deferred se ecurity option ns benefits Municipal officer's o expe ense allowancce Status Indiaan employee Section 122 2.3 income ‐ employment e outside Canaada Number of days outside e of Canada Pre‐1990 past service co ontributions while w a contriibutor Pre‐1990 past service co ontributions while w not a coontributor Workers' co ompensation benefits repaid to the em mployer Fishers gross earnings Fishers net partnership amount Fishers share‐person am mount Placement or employme ent agency workers gross earnings Drivers of taxis t or other passenger‐caarrying vehiclles gross earn nings Barbers or hairdressers gross earninggs Public transit pass Employee‐p paid premium ms for private e health servicces plans Job Letter A job letter is a document provided to an ind dividual by hi s or her employer. This do ocument is her documenntation, to verrify an applicaant’s often required by a lender, in addition to oth emplo oyment as we ell as income.. The followin ng is a samplee of a job lettter. A legend is provided tto explain each sectio on of the lette er. To be acce eptable the joob letter shou uld contain all of the inform mation identiffied in the leggend. It is important that a broker/ageent review thee job letter to o ensurre that it conttains all of the e necessary in nformation, aas well as to cconfirm that it is authenticc. If there are any spe elling errors the t broker/aggent should reeview the document careffully. If the broke er/agent has any a doubts re egarding its authenticity hee or she shou uld verify its ccontents by: Ensuring the coompany existss. Perform a Canada C 411 ssearch (www..canada411.ccom) to verifyy b should contaact the borrow wer for thaat the company is listed. If it isn’t the broker/agent furrther informaation. The bro oker/agent caan also visit thhe company’s physical add dress to determine if it is actually the ere. 262 Chapter 12: Application Analysis – Borrower Documents Contacting the employer using the contact information found in the job letter to verify its contents. Regardless of whether the broker/agent finds any reasons to suspect that the letter is not authentic, he or she should verify the information found in the job letter. Legend A: Company Letterhead, including logo (if applicable) and contact information. Ensure that this information is correct by verifying it using Canada 411, calling the contact number(s) and/or visiting the physical location. B: Date: The job letter needs to be recent in relation to the application. If the job letter was written before the broker/agent took the application a current pay stub should also be obtained to ensure that the applicant is still employed by this employer. If the job letter is over one month old the lender may require an up‐to‐date job letter. C: Re line. This line may or may not be present, depending on the policy of the employer. D: To line. If it is addressed to a specific individual, that individual should be the broker/agent or lender. If it is addressed to another individual the broker/agent should confirm the identity of that person and the reason for the other name. It may be a job letter that was supplied to another broker/agent or lender. E: Position. The job letter must contain the applicant’s position, and if he or she is full‐time, part‐time, seasonal, temporary, contract or on probation. F: Date of employment. The job letter must contain the date that the applicant was first hired. G: Income amount. The job letter must contain the amount of annual income earned by the applicant, and if it is salary, hourly or commission based. Any additional income, such as bonus income, must be listed separately from the salaried income. H: Writer’s information. The writer of the job letter should be clearly identified so that he or she may be contacted to verify the letter’s information. Chapter 12: Application Analysis – Borrower Documents 263 Figure 48 – Sample Job Letter A A B August 29, 2012 C Re: Employment Verification of Mr. John Q. Public D To Whom It May Concern, 1234 John Street, Somewhere, ON M4M 4M4 Tel: (416) 555‐1212 Fax: (416) 555‐2121 As requested by Mr. John Q. Public this letter is to verify that Mr. John Q. Public is employed at E ABC Manufacturing Inc. as a salaried Assembly Line Operator. He has been employed in this position since January 17th, 2009 F and earns $75,500 per year. If you have any questions please do not hesitate to contact the undersigned. Sincerely, H Sarah Public HR Assistant ABC Manufacturing INC. G 264 Chapter 12: Applicatio on Analysis – Borrower Do ocuments Pay stub A payystub is a docu ument provid ded to an individual by his or her emplo oyer and is offten required by a le ender in addiition to a job letter and/orr other incom me verification n. A paystub is generally used to t prove thatt the applican nt is still active ely employedd by the employer since a jjob letter mayy be on ne or more we eeks old. In addition, a the paystub p can bbe used to en nsure that thee applicant’s earnin ngs on the job b letter are acccurately reflected in the yyear‐to‐date section of the paystub. For exxample, if the e job letter indicates that the t applicant earns $60,0000 per year an nd the paystub is obtained precisely att the middle of o the year, itt should indiccate a year‐to o‐date incomee of $30 0,000. Figure 49 – Sample Paystub 265 Chapter 12: Application Analysis – Borrower Documents Employee # 0004 STATEMENT OF EARNINGS BULLETIN DE PAIE Rate Amount Y.T.D. DEDUCTIONS RETENUES 1,303.95 NET PAY PAIE NETTE Period From To 2008/10/31 2008/11/14 711.03 2,049.30 16.587.57 21.60 DEPOSIT Y.T.D Payday 2008/11/21 0004 12345 12345678911 NET PAY ALLOCATION DETAILS DE LA PAIE NETTE 477.37 EMPLOYER DEDUCTIONS AND CONTRIBUTIONS RETENUES DE L'EMPLOYE ET COTISATIONS PATRONALES Current Y.T.D. Type Current Department # 99 Type 1,303.95 20 UNION/LOCAL 15 FED. TAX 14. E.I. 56,736.60 13 G.P.P GROSS PAY PAIE BRUTE 477.37 37,367.10 1,781.32 1,781.32 19,369.50 Hours BOB BORROWER Type 00 Salary Current Courant 56,736.60 SUMMARY SOMMAIRE Year-to-date Cumul annuel Employer # 1234-b TEST COMPANY, 1234 COMPANY LANE, TORONTO, ON, M1M 1M1 266 Chapter 12: Applicatio on Analysis – Borrower Do ocuments Notiice of As sessmen nt (NOA) An NO OA is issued by b the federall governmentt when a perssonal tax retu urn has been ccompleted and fiiled. This doccument provid des a breakdo own of the yeear’s income along with th he balance owingg or refund du ue. A broker//agent will typically obtainn this documeent when pro ocessing an appliccation using a “Stated Inco ome” program m to provide pproof that theere are no ou utstanding back taxes t owing to t the Canadaa Revenue Aggency. This doocument mayy also be requ uired in otherr circum mstances, as determined d by b each lende er. Figure 50 – Sample NO OA Canad da Revenue Agenccy Agence du u revenu du Canadaa NOTICE O OF ASSESSMEN NT T451 E (08) 2 Date me Nam Sociaal Insurance no. Tax Year Tax centrre Aug 6, 2016 RTGAGE CLIENT MOR 000 000 000 2015 ON P3A 5C1 Sudbury O Summary Line 150 236 260 350 6150 420 428 435 437 486 482 Desccription Total Income e Deductions from f total inco ome Net Income Taxable Inco ome Total federal non‐refundab ble tax credits Total Ontario o non‐refundable tax credits Net federal tax t Net Ontario tax Total payable Total income e tax deducted d Payment on filing Total creditss (Total payab ble minus Totall credits Balance from m this assessment Balance Due e $ Amountt Not ice that figures up to section 61500 are wh ole numbers only andd do not havee any centts. Have a loo ok for this when review wing a borrrower’s document to ensure it iis authentic. DR DR 65,00 00 10,50 00 55,00 00 55,00 00 2,00 00 65 50 7,500.0 00 4,000.0 00 11,500.0 00 11,000.0 00 200.0 00 11,200.0 00 300.0 00 300.0 00 300.0 00 Chapter 12: Applicatio on Analysis – Borrower Do ocuments 26 67 Bus iness Lic cense A Bussiness License e may be requ uired by a lender to prove an applicant’’s ownership of a businesss. Figure 51 – Business Liicense Maaster Bu usiness Licencee Date Issued: I 2013 3−01−16 Bu usiness Numb ber: 1234567899 (yyyy−m mm−dd) Business Name and d Mailing Add dress: REMIIC MORTGAG GES, 2175 Sheppard S Aven nue East, Suite 213, TORO ONTO, ONTA ARIO CANAD DA M2J 1W8 Business Addreess: SAM ME AS ABOVE E Teleph hone: Ext: Fax: Emaill: Legal Namee(s): JOH HN ADAM PU UBLIC Type of Legal Entity y: LE PROPRIET TORSHIP SOL Business Activiity: TRA AINING OF MORTGAGE M BROKERS/AG B GENTS Business Informatio on BUSIN NESS NAME REGIS STRATION Number 456789 1234 Effectivee Date Expiry Date (yyyy−mm m−dd) (yyyy−mm−d dd) 2013−01−16 2018−01−116 Page 1 off 1 To the Client: C When the Master M Business Lic cence is presented to any Ontario bussiness program, yo ou are not required to repeat informattion contained on th his licence. Each Ontario O business pro ogram is required tto accept this licencce when presented d as part of its registrattion process. Call th he Ontario Busines ss Connects Helplin ne at 1−800−565−1 1921 or (416) 314− −9151 or TDD (416 6) 326−8566 if you have an ny problems. To the Ontario O business program: A client is not required to repeat r any informattion contained in th his licence in any otther form used in your reg gistration process. 268 Chapter 12: Applicatio on Analysis – Borrower Do ocuments Fina ancial Sta atements s Financial Statemen nts can be defined as the presentation p of financial d data, includingg balance sheets, income staatements and other supporting statemeents intended d to communicate an entityy's financial position at a point in time. Typicaally a bookkeeper or the owner o of a business will re cord and sum mmarize the ttransactions o of the bu usiness. These transaction ns include the e sale of mercchandise, payyroll, inventorry purchases and other o financial transactionss throughout the year. Th is information is then com mpiled and financcial statemen nts are preparred. These statements connsist of the Baalance Sheet and Income Statem ment, the two o primary documents, and d are accomp anied by the Statement off Retained Earnin ngs, Statemen nt of Changess in Financial Position (SCFFP) and the Notes to the Financial Statem ments. A balaance sheet, illustrated in the following figure, f is a deetailed snapsh hot of the financial health st of a business b on a specific date,, typically Deccember 31 ; however thiss date might b be different iff the bu usiness is, forr example, seasonal. Balan nce sheets shoow the relatio onship betweeen the dollarr amou unt of assets (what ( the bussiness owns), liabilities (whhat a business owes) and o owner's equitty (whatt the owner or o stockholderrs own). The totals must bbalance based d on the form mula: Assets A = Liabilities + Owneer’s Equity The in ncome statem ment, also refferred to as th he profit and loss statement, illustrated d in next figure e, details the amount of money m that the business m ade or lost ovver a specific period of time, typically a month, a quartter or a year. The income statement is based on thee formula: Net income = Revenues ‐ EExpenses Manyy brokers and agents will only o occasionaally come intoo contact with financial staatements and d may not n have the training t or exxpertise to pro operly interp ret them. Th he brokerage should have a policyy in place to have h financial statements reviewed, r whhen necessaryy, by a staff m member or anoth her broker wh ho understand ds and can prroperly interppret these staatements. Chapter 12: Application Analysis – Borrower Documents 269 Figure 52 – Sample Balance Sheet Mortgage agent Inc. Balance Sheet as at December 31, 2015 Assets 2015 2014 Cash Accounts Receivable Inventory Loans to Shareholders $85,333 172,500 18,364 12,328 $51,276 129,657 4,888 ‐ Total Current Assets 288,525 185,821 Office Equipment Machinery 15,055 29,580 8,992 21,960 Total Non‐Current Assets 44,635 30,952 $331,160 $216,773 2015 2014 Current Liabilities Accounts Payable Income Tax Payable Salaries Payable $72,166 17,125 75,000 $93,554 14,387 45,000 Total Liabilities 164,291 152,931 Shareholders' Equity: Common Stock Retained Earnings 100,000 66,869 50,000 13,842 Total Shareholders' Equity 166,869 63,842 Total Liabilities & Equity $331,160 $216,773 Total Assets Liabilities 270 Chapter 12: Application Analysis – Borrower Documents Figure 53 – Sample Income Statement Mortgage agent Inc. Income Statement For the year ended 2015 Income Revenue Cost of Goods Sold 2015 $2,375,590 879,566 2014 $1,713,054 611,055 1,496,024 1,101,999 5,000 25,885 8,500 38,066 2,115 800 2,889 75,000 4,511 14,400 3,487 2,000 13,944 3,078 15,226 1,238 800 3,101 45,000 3,489 14,400 2,433 180,653 104,709 Net Income before Taxes Provisions for Income Taxes 1,315,371 328,900 997,290 219,404 Net Income $986,471 $777,886 Gross Profit Expenses Operating Expenses Depreciation Advertising and promotion Accounting and legal Automotive Bank charges and interest Dues and licenses Insurance Management fees Office supplies Rent Telephone and utilities Total Operating Expenses 27 71 Chapter 12: Applicatio on Analysis – Borrower Do ocuments 12.3 3 Properrty Docum mentation n A broker/agent will be required d to submit ad dditional docuuments to a llender based on the purpo ose of the mo ortgage. For example, e an MLS M listing annd purchase aand sale agreeement will most often be requ uired by a len nder in a purcchase transacction, while a property tax bill will be requirred for a swittch or refinance. Multtiple List ing Serviice (MLS ) MLS allows a real estate salespeo ople to see prroperties beinng sold by oth her agents, a benefit to both buyers and se ellers of real estate. e The Multiple M Listinng Service effficiently distributes inform mation so thaat, when a reaal estate salessperson is inttroduced to a potential home buyer, the salesp person may search the MLLS system and d retrieve infoormation abo out all homes for sale in a given area or price e range, whether under a listing contracct by that saleesperson’s brrokerage or b by any of the other paarticipating brokers. MLS, then, functions as a huge database that allows real estate salesp people repressenting sellerss underr a listing contract to widely share inforrmation abouut properties w with real estaate salesp people who may m representt potential bu uyers. The M MLS combines the listings o of all availablee prope erties that are e represented d by brokers who w are bothh members off that MLS sysstem and of CREA,, the Canadian Real Estate e Association. Many lendeers require thee borrower to o provide a copy of o the MLS do ocument to prove p that it iss an arm’s lenngth transaction – in otherr words, the prope erty has been offered to th he public. The e following iss a sample of an MLS document. Figure 54 – Sample MLLS listing Civicc Address 1234 Borro ower Lane $32 29,900 For Sale Toronto, O Ontario M1M1M1 W20 457‐‐32‐D Pt Lt 00R PPlan M1234 SPIS:N Legal Deescription Semi‐Detacched Frontting E On n: 2‐Storey Acreaage: < .49 Dir/Cross SSomewhere/Anywhere St: Lot: 66.85X34 Metrees Last New w Status: Rooms: MLS#: W12345 Open House Notes: 6+2 B Bedrooms: 3 W Washrooms: 3 2xx4, 1x2 TB BA means To Be A Advised Lot Irreg: B Backs Westerlyy Sun Open House: Oct 1 Property Taxes Taxes: $3,,100/2014 Occup: Owner From: 9 am m To: 5 pm DOM: 10 Please leave shoes on porch Holdover: 90 Possessio on: Nov 29 / Tbaa / Flx PIN#: 272 Chapter 12: Applicatio on Analysis – Borrower Do ocuments Exterio or: Kitcchens: 1 Fam m Rm: N Other Drive e: Full Parkin ng Space es: Firepllace/Stv: N CAC: C Mutual Zoning: GarType e/Sp Attache acess: d/1 Base ement: Finished Heat: H Brick Cable TV: Gas: 2 UFFII: No Force ed Air Pooll: None 6‐15 Apxx Sqft: 1100 0‐1500 Phonee: Municipal Water Supplly: Sloping Apxx Age: Hydro o: Water: Gas Y Residential Sewers: Sewers Spec Desigg: Unknown Farm/Agr:: Public Transit Assesssment: Rec Centre # Roo om Level Dimensions (fft) 1 Livin ng Ground 10.99 x 2 Dining Ground 9.91 x 11.3 38 Hardwood d Floor Comb ined W/Living Open Concept 3 Kitcchen Ground 9.88 x 10.0 01 Ceramic Floor B/I Disshwasher x 10 0.1 Ceramic Floor Familyy Size Kitchen W/O To Deck 10 0.1 Semi Ensu uite His/Heers Closets Broadloom Broaddloom Large Closet 4 Breakfast Ground 10.5 14 4.8 Hardwood d Floor Open Concept Overlook Patio Ceramic Back Splash 5 Masster 2Nd 18.01 x 6 2nd d Br 2Nd 10.99 x 10.0 01 Wainscottting 7 3rd Br 2Nd 10.01 x 9.5 55 Closet Orgganizers Windoow Broadloom 8 Recc Bsmt 15.49 x 10 0.2 Finished Stuccoo Ceiling Broadloom 9.42 6.3 33 Partly Finished Fluoreescent 4 Pc Bath 9 Laundry Bsmt x Immaaculate&Clean Thru‐Out Hom me&Area,Brightt Home,Upgraddes Galore, Beeautiful Strip Hdwd Flrs&C Ceramics,Outstanding Finished Bsmt With Rec Romm&4 Piece Bath&Ln ndry Area& &Cantina,Interlocking Stone Front F Walkwayy&Front&Rear Gardens*Fron nt Porch,Huge Private Rear Deck* *Wroght‐Iron Gate G Fridge e,Stove,Bi Dw,Bi Microwave,Cac,El.Grg.Ope ener&2 Remottes,All Shutterss&Blinds&Wind dow Coverrings,Elfs,High Eff Furn&Hwt,Surrond‐Sound d Spkrs,Mirr.C lst.Drs,Bi Shelvves,Hot&Cold H H2O Outside Frnt& &Back,Brss&Glsss Door Insrt,Sh hower&Closet Valences Excellent Layout,Completely Finish hed Top2Botto om With Qualitty Extras&Upggrades Thru‐Ou ut,Quiet Streett,Walk To Pub//Sep School,Exxcellent Home& &Neighbourhoood,Great Family Home,Easy To Show& &Sell*Lockboxx* Contrract Date: 5/10 0/2015 Sunil Liister 416‐555‐‐1212 REMIC R REAL ESTATE BR ROKERAGE Exp piry Date: 9/30 0/2015 Tel: 4166‐555‐1212 Fax: 4166‐555‐2121 Agre eement of o Purcha ase and Sale S The agreement of purchase and d sale is a doccument used when real esstate in Ontarrio is being purch hased or sold. In all cases, where the ap pplicant is ap plying for a m mortgage to p purchase a new or o resale hom me, the lenderr will require a fully compl eted purchasse and sale aggreement. Th he Chapter 12: Application Analysis – Borrower Documents following sample form is used to demonstrate how a typical purchase and sale agreement should be completed by the real estate salesperson. Figure 55 – Sample Agreement of Purchase and Sale 273 274 Chapter 12: Application Analysis – Borrower Documents Chapter 12: Application Analysis – Borrower Documents 275 276 Chapter 12: Application Analysis – Borrower Documents Chapter 12: Application Analysis – Borrower Documents 277 278 Chapter 12: Applicatio on Analysis – Borrower Do ocuments 12.4 4 Other Documen ntation As pre eviously mentioned, the documents thaat the mortgaage agent mu ust obtain in aany given transaaction will be based on the e purpose of the mortgagee. In addition n, other documentation may be b required to o prove inform mation provid ded in the appplication. We’ve already reviewed thee incom me and property documenttation, now itt’s time to revview the otheer documentss that may bee reque ested by a len nder or that a mortgage aggent may find useful. Gift Letter A gift letter is a document that outlines the terms t of a giffted down payment in a pu urchase transaaction. Mone ey provided by b a family me ember to be uused as a dow wn payment, as long as it iis not re epayable to th hat family me ember, can be e used in lieu of the borrower having to o use his or her ow wn funds for the down payyment. This form f must bee completed b by both the recipients, or the pu urchasers, an nd the donorss, who are the e family mem mbers providin ng the gift to the recipientts. This form will be re equested by the t lender to prove to thee lender that tthe down payyment has no ot been borrowed. Figure 56 – Sample Gifft Letter GIFT LEETTER R _____ ___________ ____________ __ (date)) To Wh hom it may concern: This le etter confirms that the undersigned is making m a finaancial gift of $$________________ to: __ ____________ ___________ ____________ _______________________________________ (printt names of reccipients) for usse toward the e purchase of the propertyy located at: _____ ___________ ____________ ___________ ________________________________________ (address of properrty being morttgaged) We, the undersigned Recipientss and Donors, hereby certify that: a) These funds are e a genuine gift from the Donors; D as succh, are not reequired to be repaid at anyy tim me, and b) No o part of the financial f gift is being provided by any thhird party havving any interrest (direct o or ind direct) in the sale of the su ubject property, and c) The Donor is an n immediate family f membe er. Recipients Name e: __ ____________ __________ Name: ________________________ Chapter 12: Applicatio on Analysis – Borrower Do ocuments Signatture: __ ____________ __________ Signatur e: ________________________ Date: __ ____________ __________ Date: ________________________ e: Name __ ____________ __________ Name: ________________________ Signatture: __ ____________ __________ Signatur e: ________________________ Date: __ ____________ __________ Date: ________________________ Relatiionship: __ ____________ __________ Relation ship: ________________________ Addre ess: __ ____________ __________ Address:: ________________________ P City, Prov.: __ ____________ __________ City, Proov.: ________________________ Telephone: __ ____________ __________ Telephonne: ________________________ 27 79 Don nors Prop perty Ass sessmentt A Property Assessm ment is a document provid ded by the M unicipal Prop perty Assessm ment Corpo oration (MPAC) to homeow wners to illusttrate the valuue of a home,, as assessed or determined by MP PAC, for the purposes p of caalculating prooperty taxes. A broker/agent maay find this usseful in assisting to determ mine a value o of a property in a switch or refinaance transaction, before an n appraisal haas been comppleted, if the homeowner does not havve any in nformation on n the potentiaal value of the home. It’s im mportant to note that MPA AC uses an automated valuuation model or AVM to caalculate the value. This assessm ment is typicaally not accep pted by lendeers to prove p property valuee, and the broke er/agent shou uld be aware that t the value e shown on t his documentt may differ ffrom the value as dettermined by an a appraisal. It is, howeve er, valid to bee used to provvide a generaal idea of whaat the vaalue of the prroperty may be b for use by the mortgagee agent. 280 Chapter 12: Applicatio on Analysis – Borrower Do ocuments Figure 57 – Sample Pro operty Assessmeent Chapter 12: Applicatio on Analysis – Borrower Do ocuments 28 81 Morrtgage St atement A morrtgage statem ment is a docu ument provid ded by a homeeowner’s currrent mortgagge provider to o the ho omeowner de etailing the cu urrent financial standing oof the mortgaage, includingg its outstaanding balancce, interest raate, time rem maining in the term and oth her important financial inform mation. This document is typically obtaained by a brooker/agent in n a switch or rrefinance transaaction to show w the outstan nding balance e of the existiing mortgagee. While the m mortgage statem ment may be several weekks or months old, the brokker/agent can n calculate thee current balance at the date e of the appliication by using the outstaanding balancce at the datee of the statem ment. This is vital to deterrmine the exaact amount o f principal that must be reepaid to the current lender on closing. c While e it is important for the bro oker/agent to o obtain a moortgage statem ment to calcu ulate the current outstandin ng balance of the applicantt’s mortgage,, this documeent is not used by the new w lende er to determin ne the amoun nt required to o pay off the m mortgage. Th he new lendeer will requestt a statement directtly from the current lenderr before closi ng, to ensuree that the info ormation is accurate and that there t are no arrears on th he current moortgage. 282 Chapter 12: Application Analysis – Borrower Documents Figure 58 – Sample Mortgage Statement SUPERBANK INC. November 21, 2011 Mr. J. Borrower 123 Kingston Street, Southwest, Toronto, ON, M1M 1M1 Mortgage Number: 1155667898 Annual Mortgage Statement Statement Period: Property Address: January 1, 2011 to December 31, 2011 123 Kingston Street, Southwest, Toronto, ON, M1M 1M1 Mortgage Details Maturity Date Interest Rate (as at statement date) Payment Frequency Principal, Interest and Tax Payment July 28, 2014 6.89% Monthly $1,550.47 Transaction Summary Opening Principal Balance Advances During Statement Period Principal Paid (including any privilege payments) Closing Principal Balance Interest Paid (during statement period) $199,920.42 $0.00 $2,180.78 $197,739.64 $13,515.94 Tax Account Summary Opening Tax Balance Tax Payments Received Taxes Paid to Authority Closing Tax Balance $493.13 CR $2,293.00 $2,307.15 $478.98 CR Please Note: DR is a Debit = Minus to your account. CR is a Credit = Plus to your account If you have any questions, please feel free to contact our Customer Service Toll‐Free Number at 1‐866‐555‐1212 If any of the balances, interest rates or other financial data appear incorrect, please contact our auditors detailing any discrepancies: Pricewatershed rd Suite 1000, 123‐53 Ave Toronto, ON Attention: Joseph Blank Tel: (416) 555‐9900 Fax: (416) 555‐9911 28 83 Chapter 12: Applicatio on Analysis – Borrower Do ocuments Tax Bill A tax bill is a docum ment provide ed to a homeo owner by thee municipal taax authority in n the jurisdiction in whicch the properrty is located. A mortgagee agent must o obtain a copyy of this docum ment in a switch or refinan nce transactio on to ensure tthat the prop perty taxes arre up to date. While e the lawyer closing c the traansaction willl confirm thiss information,, it is importaant for the mortggage agent to o confirm this information as soon as poossible to preevent a situation whereby the bo orrower doessn’t have enough money on o closing to ppay any back taxes owing. Figure 59 – Sample Ta ax Bill T City of Toronto TAX X BILL 012 Final Tax Bill 20 Mortgaage Company: SuperBank Inc. Mortgaage Number: 1155667898 Billing D Date Sep ptember 1, 20 012 Roll No. 00‐010‐04700 0‐0000 1234‐00 Borrower, JJohn Borrow wer, John 123 Kin ngston Street,, Southwest, Toronto o, ON, M1M 1M1 1 123 Kingstoon Street, Sou uthwest, Toronto, ON N, M1M 1M11 Pt. Lot 2, RP 11R68166 Part 1 66.00 FR 1775.00D .20AC C Asssessment Tax Class RTEP Sub Tottals Municipal Ed ducation Value Municipaal Levies Tax T Rate (%) Amount Tax Rate ((%) Amou unt 365,468 Reside ential 0.6109226 2,237.72 0.264000 00 964.8 84 Municipal Levy Sp pecial Charge es/Credits 2,237.72 CV VA Phase‐In 0.0 00 Summ mary Municcipal + Educattion Speciaal Charges 964 4.84 3,197 7.56 0 0.00 2008 TTax Cap Adj Final 22008 Taxes Less In nterim Billing 0 0.00 3,197 7.56 ‐1,598 8.78 Total A Amount Due 1.598 8.78 284 Chapter 12: Applicatio on Analysis – Borrower Do ocuments nto tax rates 2011 City of Toron The fo ollowing charrt illustrates the tax rates for f the City off Toronto for the year 201 11. While tax rates vary from mu unicipality to municipality this is a sampple of how municipal ratess are calcullated. Final 2011 Propertty Tax Rates Descrription City C Tax T Rate % Educcation Tax Raate % Total Tax Ratte % Reside ential 0.5619218% 0 0.23310000% 0.7929218% Multi‐‐Residential 1.8635584% 1 0.23310000% 2.0945584% Comm mercial Generral 1.8257360% 1 1.54404080% 3.3661440% Example: Estimate ed taxes on a residential prroperty with an Assessed V Value of $427 7,177: Estimated propertyy tax = Assesssed Value x Residential R Taxx Rate = $4277,177 x 0.792 29218%= $3,387.18 Con ndominium m Status Certifica ate A Stattus Certificate e, formerly kn nown as an Esstoppel Certifficate, is a do ocument provvided by a condo ominium corp poration (the entity that ru uns the condoominium) to tthe owner off the condo ominium unitt. This docum ment is require ed by lenderss to confirm tthat the condominium corpo oration has su ufficient reserrve funds for its continuedd operation; aand reveals th he amount of the co ondominium maintenance e fee, and whe ether there aare any legal p proceedings aagainst the condo ominium corp poration, amo ong other info ormation. Thhe mortgage aagent should inform the appliccant that this document is required as soon s as possi ble, since it m may take seveeral days for the co ondominium corporation to t provide. There T is typicaally a fee charrged to the ho omeowner to o obtain n this docume ent, which caannot exceed $100 as per tthe Condominnium Act. Sam mple Stat us Certif icate (Under subsection 76(1)) of the Condomiinium Act R.S.O. 1998, 1 as amendeed) TORO ONTO STANDA ARD CONDOM MINIUM CORP PORATION NO O. 1234 The Corporation C hereby certifie es that as of the date here of: 1. Th he owner(s) of o Unit (Suite #), Level (Floo or #), Unit (Loocker #) Level (Floor #) and d Unit (Paarking #) Leve el (Parking Levvel #), Torontto Standard CCondominium m Plan No. 123 34, registered d in the Land Title es Division off the Toronto Registry Officce (No. 66), iss: on element exxpenses, pendding clearancce from the bank. [ x ] not in default of commo [ ] in default of o common element expen nses in the am mount of ($______) 2. A payment p on account a of common expen nses of ($Monnthly Condo FFees) in respeect of the above‐noted un nit(s) is due on (Date) to co over the periood from (Datee – Date) 3. The Corporation has the amount of ($___ ___) in prepaiid expenses ffor the unit. 4. There are no am mounts that the t Condomin nium Act, 19998 requires to o be added to o the common expenses payab ble for the unit. 5. The current bud dget is accuraate, however,, the Corpora tion cannot aaccurately determine at thiis time wheth her the budge et will result in a surplus orr a deficit as iit has no conttrol over any,, Chapter 12: Application Analysis – Borrower Documents 285 as yet, unannounced increases in utility rates, increased labour and material costs, and any other cost factors which are beyond the normal budgetary controls of the Corporation, including any costs which might impact on the budget. 6. Since the date of the budget of the Corporation, for the current fiscal year, the common expenses for the unit: [ x ] have not been increased, or [ _ ] have been increased by (% increase) and by (Amount in dollars) per month for the unit due to increased utility rates. 7. Since the date of the budget of the Corporation for the current fiscal year, the Board: [ x ] has not levied any additional assessments against the unit, or [ _ ] has levied the following assessment(s) against the unit, to increase the contribution to the reserve fund or the Corporation’s operating fund or for any other purpose. 8. The Corporation has no knowledge of any circumstances that may result in an increase in the common expenses for the aforesaid unit(s), save and except for any usual budgetary increases. Reserve Fund 9. The Corporation’s unaudited reserve fund amounts to (Amount in dollars) as at (Date) 10. A comprehensive reserve fund study will be conducted (Expected Date) 11. The balance of the reserve fund at the beginning of the current fiscal year was (Amount in dollars). In accordance with the budget of the Corporation for the current fiscal year, the annual contribution to be made to the reserve fund is annual (Contribution in dollars) and anticipated expenditures to be made from the reserve fund for the current fiscal year, are (projected figure in dollars). The Board of Directors anticipates that the reserve fund: [ x ] will be adequate; [ _ ] will not be adequate in the current fiscal year for the expected costs of major repair and replacement of the common elements and assets of the Corporation. 12. There are no plans to increase the reserve fund under a plan proposed by the Board under subsection 94(8) of the Condominium Act, 1998 for the future funding of the reserve fund. Legal Proceedings, Claims 13. There are no outstanding judgments against the Corporation. 14. The Corporation is not a party to any proceedings before a court of law, an arbitrator or an administrative tribunal. 15. The Corporation has not received a notice of, or made an application for, an order to amend the declaration and description where the court has not made the order, under section 109 of the Condominium Act, 1998. 16. The Corporation has no outstanding claim for payment out of the guarantee fund under the Ontario New Home Warranties Plan Act. 17. There is not currently an order of the Superior Court of Justice in effect appointing an inspector under section 130 of the Condominium Act, 1998, or an Administrator under section 131 of the Condominium Act, 1998. Alteration / indemnity Agreements 18. With respect to Agreements with owners relating to changes, additions or improvements to the common elements as per clause 98(1 )(b) of the Condominium Act, 1998. [ x ] The unit is NOT subject to any Agreement; [ _ ] The unit is subject to one or more agreements. To the best of the Corporation’s information, knowledge and belief, the agreements have been complied with by the parties. 286 Chapter 12: Application Analysis – Borrower Documents Leasing of Units 19. With respect to leased units, during the fiscal year preceding the date of this Status Certificate and as per section 83 of the Condominium Act, the Corporation: [ _ ] Has not received notice that any unit within this Corporation was leased; [ x ] Has received notice that (number of units) units were leased. Insurance 20. The Corporation has secured all policies of insurance that are required under the Condominium Act, 1998. Additional Information 21. It is the purchaser’s responsibility to review the declaration and description pertaining to the unit, including any exclusive use common element area, to determine whether or not the vendor or any previous owner or occupant of the unit has carried out a structural change to the unit or has modified the common elements in circumstances where the Board has not given its prior written consent. If, following an inspection of the unit by the purchaser, there is any question as to whether or not a breach of the declaration and/or the rules has/have occurred, the purchaser is advised to address a specific inquiry to the Corporation by describing such change or modification in writing to the Corporation at is mailing address, following which the Corporation will carry out an inspection of the unit and respond appropriately. Unit purchasers (and their solicitors) are required to notify, in writing, this Corporation at its current mailing address immediately following the completion of the transfer of title and change of ownership to the Unit(s). Until and unless such notification is provided to the Corporation, its records shall remain in the name of the present owner as prescribed under the Condominium Act, 1998, and the new owner may not receive notices of any meetings and other written communication from the Corporation. Substantial changes to the common elements, assets or services 22. There have been no additions, alterations or improvements to the common elements, changes in the assets of the Corporation or changes in a service in the Corporation. Rights of Person Requesting Certificate 23. The person requesting this certificate has the following rights under subsections 76(7) and (8) of the Condominium Act, 1998 with respect to the agreements listed on the attached Schedule “A” — Attachments. Upon receiving written request and reasonable notice, the Corporation shall permit a person, who has requested a Status Certificate and paid the fee charged by the Corporation for the Certificate, or an agent of the person duly authorized in writing, to examine the agreements listed in Schedule “A”— Attachments, hereto, at a reasonable time and at (address). The Corporation shall, within a reasonable time, provide copies of the agreements to a person examining them, if the person so requests and pays a reasonable fee to compensate to the Corporation for the labour and copying charges. 24. The Property Manager of this Corporation is: (Property Management Company Name and Address) 25. The Directors and Officers of the Corporation are: (List Directors names and positions) 26. The Address of Service, for the Directors and Officers is: (Address and other contact info followed by signature of president and date. I have authority to bind the Corporation. ) Chapter 12: Applicatio on Analysis – Borrower Do ocuments 28 87 ollowing docu uments are ussually attache ed to this Stattus Certificate and form part of it: The fo 1. Certificate of In nsurance 2. Current Operating Budget 3. De eclaration of the t Condomin nium (to whicch Schedules “A,” “B,” “C,”” “D,” “E,” and “G” are atttached) 4. By‐Law No. 1 (G General) 5. By‐Law No. 2 (SShared Facilitiies Agreemen nt) 6. By‐law No. 3 (D Driveway Entrance Agreem ment) 7. By‐law No. 4 (M Mediation/Arb bitration Proccedure) 8. By‐law No. 5 (Sttandard Unit)) 9. By‐law No. 6 (Amended Sharred Facilities Agreement) 10. Co ondominium Managemen nt Agreement with (Managgement Comp pany Name) Certtificate o f Indepen ndent Le gal Advicce (ILA) In cerrtain cases the e lender will require r that the t borrowerr (or Guaranto or, as the case may be) meet with his or her own lawye er to discuss the t terms andd conditions o of the propossed mortgagee. m occur in situations s where the individual is actingg as a Guaran ntor for a frien nd or family This may memb ber, or where e the mental state s of the borrower b mayy be in question. The lawyyer acting on ding ILA, and behalf of the lende er will send th he closing mo ortgage docum ments to the lawyer provid this laawyer will me eet with the client c and exp plain the morttgage to him or her. Oncee done, this lawye er will comple ete a Certificaate of Indepen ndent Legal A Advice, which basically stattes that the lawye er has met witth the client, explained the terms and cconditions of the mortgagge, and that the client attests that he or she e is not takingg the mortgagge under dureess or undue influence. Sam mple Certtificate off Indepen ndent Leg gal Advicce CERTIFICA ATE OF IND DEPENDEN NT LEGAL A ADVICE TO: SU UPBERANK INC.. T AND TO: SU UPERLAW INC., their solicitorss UPBANK INC. MORTGAGE M LO OAN TO Mr. J. Borrower, B 123 Kingston Streeet, Southwest, Toronto, ON, RE: SU M1M M 1M1 r to the above‐noted transaction, on this 23RD day of NOVEMBER R, 2012 , I was cconsulted by With respect Mr. J. Borrower, in his h presence alo one as to the effect e of his ex ecuting: M Loan n Commitmentt issued by SUP PERBANK INC., in his capacityy as Guarantor; 1. A Mortgage 2. A Mortgage/Char M rge of Land in favour f of SUPEERBANK INC. o ver the lands m municipally known as 123 Kin ngston Street, Southwest, S Toronto, ON, M1 1M 1M1 (the “M Mortgage”) in his capacity ass Guarantor; 3. Authorization to insert dates an nd other incorrrect data; G Assignment of Rents and Leases in favour of SUP ERBANK INC. rrespecting the lands 4. A General mu unicipally 123 Kingston K Streett, Southwest, Toronto, T ON, M M1M 1M1 5. Acknowledgement of receipt off Standard Chaarge Terms andd Direction re: funds; o Personal Pro operty Securityy Act Financing Statements; 6. Acknowledgement of Receipt of on‐Merger Ackn nowledgementt. 7. No 8. Re‐Direction of fu unds; 288 Chapter 12: Applicatio on Analysis – Borrower Do ocuments 9. Certain Statutoryy Declarations, Warranties, Directions D and U Undertakings iin connection w with the abovee‐ n; and notted transaction 10. Any other docum ments ancillary to the above (collecctively the "doccuments"). d andd advised him fully as to the liability which I explaained to Mr. J. Borrower the nature of the documents he wo ould incur by exxecuting them.. I also advised d him fully as too the manner iin which such lliability could be enfforced. Mr. J. Borrower B informed me, and I am satisfied tthat he fully un nderstands thee nature and effect of executing the documentss and that in exxecuting the Doocuments is accting freely and d voluntarily ot under any undue influence e exercised by SUPERBANK IN NC, or any other person. and no orrower as his solicitor and inn his interest o only and without regard to, o or I have given this advvice to Mr. J. Bo deration for the e interest of SU UPERBANK INC C., or any otherr person. consid n acting on be ehalf of SUPER RBANK INC., or any other perrson in connecttion with this m matter. I am not o Solicitor: ___ ____________ ________________ Name and Address of he statements made in this CCertificate are ttrue and that M Mr. Borrower’ss I hereby acknowledgge that all of th m herein was consulted by me m as my persoonal solicitor aand in my interrest only. lawyer, in advising me WITNESS: ) ) _____________ ____________ ______ ) ____ ) Cre ditor Insu urance A pplicatio n This iss a documentt used by an Insurance Com mpany to dettermine the eeligibility of an n applicant fo or credittor insurance. Creditor inssurance has become b a regular offering in a mortgage transaction n. Used to ensure thaat applicants have protection against thhe perils asso ociated with d death, disability or job losss, it is importtant to consid der. Failurre of the morttgage agent to adequatelyy advise the ppotential borrrower of his o or her option to obttain creditor insurance can n result in the e agent beingg sued by the borrower if tthe borrower was not n adequatelly insured and d one of the covered c perilss occurred. TTo protect bo oth the borro ower and the agent, the aggent must info orm the borroower of the aavailability of the insurancee and have the borro ower either waive w the insu urance or appply for it. Su uccess Tip – Answer honestly in n the crediitor insura ance appliccation Be e sure to advisse your appliccant to answe er all of the qquestions in th he application n honestly. Iff yo our applicant answers a “no”” to any of the e health quesstions the app plicant must p provide furrther informaation and explanations. Once the insurrance compan ny has review wed the ap pplication it may m then requ uest additionaal informationn or medical iinvestigation,, such as a do octor’s report. plication. The fo ollowing docu ument is a sam mple of a typical creditor iinsurance app Chapter 12: Applicatio on Analysis – Borrower Do ocuments Sam m ple Cred ditor Insu urance Ap pplication n 28 89 290 Chapter 12: Applicatio on Analysis – Borrower Do ocuments These are the three e health question ns. The applicant must answer th hese question ns honestly to ensurre that a claim m is paid in the futture. If not an nswered honestly the insurer may m decline to o pay the claiim! Chapter 12: Applicatio on Analysis – Borrower Do ocuments 29 91 292 Chapter 12: Application Analysis – Borrower Documents 12.5 Summary Under the MBLAA and its Regulations the brokerage has a significant responsibility, which falls on the shoulders of the principal broker, to ensure that its brokers and agents take all reasonable steps to provide mortgages that are suitable to its borrowers, lenders and investors. This requires that brokers and agents be able to prove the information provided to them by their borrower by obtaining the proper documentation. In addition the MBLAA requires the brokerage to have policies and procedures in place that detects and prevents fraud, whenever possible, and ensures the accuracy of information and documentation gathered by its brokers and agents. The successful implementation of these policies and procedures requires that the brokerage’s brokers and agents understand what constitutes fraud and are vigilant in watching for the warning signs typically associated with fraud. It is critical that a broker/agent take the proper steps to verify a borrower’s identity and assess all of the information and documentation obtained from the borrower. The proper employment of these safeguards will ensure that the brokerage remains compliant and that its borrowers, lenders and investors are protected from being exposed to potentially harmful transactions. These steps will also ensure that the brokerage, its brokers and agents are adequately protected from being involved in potential criminal wrongdoing and minimize the likelihood of civil prosecution when, as will undoubtedly happen, a transaction is deemed to be fraudulent through no fault of the brokerage. Chapter 12: Application Analysis – Borrower Documents 293 12.6 Key Terms and Definitions Agreement of Purchase and Sale A document used in the purchase of real estate in Ontario Certificate of Independent Legal Advice (ILA) A document that states that the borrower’s lawyer has met with the borrower, explained the terms and conditions of the mortgage, and that the borrower attests that he or she is not taking the mortgage under duress or undue influence Creditor Insurance Application A document used by an insurance company to determine the eligibility of an applicant for creditor insurance Employment Insurance (EI) premiums Premiums deducted from an employee’s earnings which go into a general fund; EI premiums are automatically deducted from wages but are not paid by self‐employed workers Estoppel Certificate See Status Certificate Gift Letter A document that outlines the terms of a gifted down payment in a real estate purchase transaction; in other words, the down payment came from a source other than the purchaser. Job Letter A document provided to an individual by his or her employer. This document is often required by a lender, in addition to other documentation, to verify an applicant’s employment as well as income Mortgage Statement A document provided by a homeowner’s current mortgage provider to the homeowner which outlines the details of the current mortgage Multiple Listing Service (MLS) One or more databases available to real estate agents/brokers which allow real estate brokers representing sellers under a listing contract to widely share information about the seller’s property with other real estate brokers who may represent potential buyers. In some, but not all cases, real estate listings involve MLS at the outset because of the clear marketing advantages. Notice of Assessment (NOA) A form that the federal government issues when a personal tax return has been completed and filed. This document provides a breakdown of the year’s income along with the balance owing or refund. Paystub A document provided to an individual by his or her employer each time the employee is paid (by cheque, direct deposit or other), and is often required by a lender in addition to a job letter 294 Chapter 12: Application Analysis – Borrower Documents and/or any other document used to verify the employee’s income Property Assessment A document provided by the Municipal Property Assessment Corporation (MPAC) to homeowners to illustrate the value of a home, as assessed or determined by MPAC, for the purposes of calculating property taxes; although homeowners might argue about the value of their home, it is the MPAC Property Assessment Value that is used to determine the property’s value for tax purposes Self‐employed commissions Commissions paid to an independent agent, in other words, someone working not as an employee but on a contract or self‐employed basis, who earns commission based directly on production, such as sales volume. This amount will be shown on a T4A Status Certificate Formerly known as an Estoppel Certificate, this is a document provided by a condominium corporation (the entity that runs the condominium) to the owner of the condominium unit to indicate the current status of the corporation, among other items TBA To Be Advised. This abbreviation is typically used when information is currently unavailable but will be available at a later date. T4 A document provided to an individual by his or her employer, typically when there is employment income, such as salaried or hourly income. Employers are required by law to provide the T4 so that employees may file their income tax returns. The T4 indicates, among other things, the amount of money the employee earned in the one year period, as well as the deductions from earnings T4A A document provided to an individual by his or her employer, typically when there is self‐ employed commission income or other income not listed on a T4. Employers are required by law to issue the T4A when applicable so the individual may file his/her income tax return. The T4A indicates, among other things, the amount of money the individual earned in this manner in the one year period Tax Bill A document provided to a homeowner by the municipal tax authority in the jurisdiction in which the property is located. The tax bill reflects, for the mortgage agent, the amount of taxes payable by the homeowner Chapter 12: Applicatio on Analysis – Borrower Do ocuments 29 95 12.7 7 Review w Questio ons Answers to the Revview Questio ons are found at www.REM MIC.ca Sho ort Answe er Questio ons 1. Briiefly describe e when a morttgage agent would w be req uired to obtaain the following do ocuments from m an applican nt. a) T4 b) T4A c) Job lette er d) Paystub b e) NOA f) Agreeme ent of Purchaase and Sale g) Gift letter h) Property assessmentt i) Propertyy tax bill j) Mortgagge statement k) Status certificate 2. De escribe the infformation fou und in an MLSS document. 3. Wh hat is a certificate of indep pendent legall advice and uunder what ciircumstancess would it be req quired? 4. Un nder what circcumstances must m a mortgaage agent com mplete a cred ditor insurancce application? 5. Wh hat information must be in n a job letter for it to be accceptable to a lender? 6. The next section contains blaank documen nts found in t his chapter. TTest your kno owledge of the ese documen nts by writing the appropriate informatiion in documents’ blank fields without refferring to the chapter. On nce done, refe er to the chappter to review w the accuraccy of your answers. 296 Chapter 12: Applicatio on Analysis – Borrower Do ocuments Chapter 12: Application Analysis – Borrower Documents 297 298 Chapter 12: Application Analysis – Borrower Documents Chapter 13: Application Analysis – Application Ratios 299 Chapter 13: Application Analysis – Application Ratios Learning Outcomes Successful understanding of the concepts presented in this chapter will enable the learner to: Perform a loan to value calculation in a given scenario Calculate the maximum mortgage amount using the loan to value ratio Calculate the GDS and TDS ratios in a given scenario Calculate the maximum mortgage amount using the TDS ratio Indicate the industry standards regarding the GDS and TDS ratios Introduction The mortgage agent has three basic ratios that must be applied to virtually every transaction: the loan to value (LTV), the gross debt service ratio (GDS) and the total debt service ratio (TDS). The LTV is used to determine the maximum loan possible based on the value of the property, while the GDS and TDS ratios determine the maximum loan possible based on the borrower’s income. The lender will then use the lowest of these three loan amounts as the mortgage amount. While the majority of lenders will use all three of these ratios, the GDS is not typically used in sub‐prime transactions or by private lenders. In this chapter, the mortgage agent will be introduced to these three ratios and taught how to apply them in a mortgage transaction. 13.1 Loan to Value Ratio (LTV) The LTV is the amount of the loan, in dollars, in relation to the value of the property, in dollars, expressed as a percentage that is typically rounded off to two decimal places (unless it is an exact number). For example, if the LTV is exactly 90% there is no need to show any decimal places. Lenders use this ratio to determine the maximum loan amount for a given property based on the specific type of loan product that is offered by the lender. There are two calculations when using the LTV. The first is calculating the LTV of a mortgage. To accomplish this we divide the amount of the loan by the value of the property. For example, if we had a $200,000 mortgage and a $400,000 house, the equation would look like this: $200,000 / $400,000 Loan Amount Value of the house The second use for the loan to value is to determine a maximum mortgage amount. To accomplish this we multiply the loan to value by the value of the house. For example, if we have a loan to value of 90% and a $400,000 house, the equation would look like this: 300 Chapter 13: Applicattion Analysis – Application n Ratios Loan to Value 90% % x $400,000 Value of the house Pa ause for cla arification n – The “/”” characterr Th he calculations in this chap pter use the “//” character tto represent tthe division ssign. e these calculations let’s lo ook at a few eexamples. To better illustrate Calc culating the t LTV of o a 1 s t Mortgage M Example 1 ount of $270, 000. The pro operty he is purchasing is A client would like a 1st mortgagge in the amo st 0. What is the LTV of the proposed p 1 mortgage? valued at $300,000 Solutiion LTV L = (Propossed 1st mortgaage amount / Property vallue) x 100 LTV = (270,0 000 / 300,0000) x 100 LTV V = .90 x 100 LTV L = 90% Therefore, the loan l to value of the propoosed 1st mortggage is 90%. Pa ause for cllarification n – Converrting decim mals to perrcentages When W you calcculate a perceentage the de ecimal numbeer must be multiplied by 1 100 to obtain the percentage e. For example, 10 is 10% of 100. We ccan calculate this by dividing 10 by 100 (10/100). Thatt, however, eq quals 0.10. The answer is not 0.10 perccent. To convvert the de ecimal to its percentage p yo ou must multiply it by 100 . Therefore, 0.10 multiplied by 100 eq quals 10. Thiss (10) is the percentage. Example 2 mount of $1885,000. She h has told you A client would like to refinance her 1st mortggage in the am that her h home is worth w $222,00 00. What is th he LTV of thiss proposed m mortgage? Solutiion LTV L = (Propossed 1st mortgaage amount / Property vallue) x 100 LTV = (185,0 000 / 222,0000) x 100 LTV = (8.33333333E‐1) x 100 Chapter 13: Applicattion Analysis – Application n Ratios 30 01 LTV = .8 833333333 x 1100 LTV = 83.33% Therefore the loaan to value off the proposeed 1st mortgagge is 83.33%. Pa ause for cllarification n – “E” in your y displa ay Although this was w discussed d in chapter 8, remember tthat if you evver get an ansswer on your caalculator’s display that lookks like our lasst example, 8.3 33333333E‐1 this means thatt you must move m the decim mal place onee place to thee left, or the n number of places indicated by the num mber followingg the E. In th is example th he actual answ wer would e .833333333 3 be Calc culating the t LTV of o a 2nd Mortgage e To calculate the LTTV of a 2nd mo ortgage the mortgage m agennt must comp plete the sam me process as above e; however he e or she mustt also include the first morrtgage in the calculation. Example 1 A client has a 1st mortgage m in th he amount of $270,000, annd would like an additionaal $15,000 as a 2nd mortgage to co onsolidate cre edit card debtt. The properrty is valued aat $300,000. The loan to value would be callculated as fo ollows: Solutiion LTV = [(1sts mortgage amount + Prop posed 2nd moortgage) / Pro operty value] x 100 LTV = [(270,000 + 15,000) / 3000,000] x 1000 LTV = (285,0 000 / 300,0000) x 100 LTV = 0.95 x 100 LTV L = 95% The erefore the lo oan to value of o the propossed 2nd mortggage is 95%. Example 2 A client has a 1st mortgage m in th he amount of $185,000 an d would like aan additionall $20,000 as a 2nd mortgage to re enovate her house. The prroperty is valuued at $222,0000. The loan n to value would d be calculate ed as follows: Solutiion LTV = [(1sts mortgage amount + Prop posed 2nd moortgage) / Pro operty value] x 100 LTV =[(185,000 + 20,000) / 2222,000] x 100 302 Chapter 13: Applicattion Analysis – Application n Ratios LTV = (205,0 000 / 222,0000) x 100 LTV = 9.23423423E‐1 x 100 LTV = 0.9 923423423 x 100 LTV = 92.34% Therrefore the loaan to value off the proposeed 2nd mortgage is 92.34%.. Calc culating the t LTV of o Additio onal Morttgages If the applicant is applying a for a 3rd mortgage e (or any morrtgage other tthan a 1st mo ortgage) the mortggage agent must complete e the same prrocess as abovve; however he or she mu ust also includ de all mo ortgages that rank before the t proposed d mortgage inn the calculatiion. Example A client has a 1st mortgage m in th he amount of $270,000, annd a $15,000 2nd mortgagee and would like to o borrow an additional a $7,,500 to repayy a loan that hhas been placced in collections. The appliccant believes that this is th he best option n since both tthe 1st and 2nnd mortgages are closed an nd canno ot be refinancced before their respective e renewal dattes. The prop perty is valued at $300,000 0. The lo oan to value would w be calcculated as folllows: Solutiion LTV = [(1st mortgage + 2nd mortgage + Proposed 3rd mortgage) / Property valu ue] x 100 LTV = [(2 270,000 + 15,,000 + 7,500) / 300,000] x 100 LTV = (292,5 500 / 300,0000) x 100 LTV = 0.975 x 1000 LTTV = 97.5% erefore the lo oan to value of o the proposeed 3rd mortgaage is 97.5%. The Usin ng the LT TV to Cal culate a Maximum m Mortga age Amou unt When n using the LTTV to calculate e a maximum m mortgage am mount, the m mortgage agen nt needs to know the LTV that is offered byy the lender as well as the value of the p property. Knowing the lende er’s LTV is straaightforward and involves understandinng the lenderr’s products. Knowing the value of a propertyy can be difficcult unless there has beenn an appraisal performed o or it is a hase (under normal circum mstances the value v of a prooperty being p purchased is the purchasee purch price)). Chapter 13: Applicattion Analysis – Application n Ratios 30 03 ormula for de etermining the maximum mortgage m am mount using th he LTV calculaation is as The fo follow ws: M Amo ount = LTV / 1100 x Propertty Value Maximum Mortgage The LTTV is divided by 100 since it is a percentage and the calculation rrequires it be converted to o its decimal equivallent. Example A borrower wishess to purchase a new home e and has askeed his mortgaage agent to aadvise how much of a down paayment he re equires. The purchase p pricce is $400,0000. The mortggage agent haas determined that th his borrower qualifies with h a lender whho offers a maaximum loan to value of 95%. Our next step is to calculaate the mortggage amount based on thiss loan to valu ue. Solutiion Maximum m Mortgage Amount A = 95% % / 100 x $4000,000 Maxim mum Mortgagge Amount = .95 x $400,0000 Maximum Mortggage Amountt = $380,000 Therefore the maxim mum mortgage amount baased on the LLTV is $380,00 00. To answer the borrower’s question, the borrrower would need a $20,0000 down payyment which is the pu urchase price e minus the mortgage m ($40 00,000 ‐ $3800,000 = $20,0000). 13.2 2 Gross Debt D Serrvice (GDS S) and To otal Debtt Service (TDS) Ratiios The GDS G and TDS are a debt service ratios thatt are designeed to determine whether a mortgage payment can be affforded by the e potential bo orrower. A d ebt service raatio is the rattio of debt to incom me expressed as a percentaage. While th hese ratios haave not changged in several decades, they remain r the fu undamental calculations in n determiningg affordabilityy. Calc culating the t Gross s Debt Se ervice Ra atio (GDS S) Indusstry Standard – 32% The GDS G is designe ed to determiine if the pote ential borrow wer can afford d the proposeed mortgage payment based on n his or her income (or a co ombined incoome, if there iis more than one appliccant). The GD DS combines the t costs thatt a potential borrower hass regarding sh helter and divide es that cost by his or her gross income (the ( income bbefore taxes aare deducted d). The maximum m ratio that is typiccal in the morrtgage industtry is 32%. Th his means thaat 32% of a poten ntial borrower’s gross income may be used u to servic e his or her shelter costs. The GDS hass one main m purpose: to determin ne if the prop posed mortga ge payment iis within the lender’s maxim mum GDS ratio. The GDS is i calculated using u the folloowing equatiion: GD DS = [(PITH + ½ Condo Maiintenance feee) / Gross Income] x 100 304 Chapter 13: Applicattion Analysis – Application n Ratios The Compon nents of GDS G To understand how w to calculate e the GDS, lett’s break it doown into each h of its compo onents. PITH The PITH represents the Princip pal, Interest, Property Tax es, and Propeerty Heat. Leet’s have a look at a what each letter of PITH H represents. nterest) PI (Principal and In The Principal and Interest consiist of the amo ount of the m mortgage paym ment necessaary to repay the bllended principal and intere est for the paayment periodd. T (Pro operty Taxes) The property taxess consist of th he actual amo ount of propeerty taxes payyable on the p property. H (Pro operty Heat) CMHC C states that mortgage m pro ofessionals arre expected too ask the prospective borrrower what the monthly m heatin ng costs are for f the subjecct property annd use the acttual heat cost records, if provid ded by the prrospective borrower. Where no history is readily avaailable, the heeat costs used d must be a reasonable estimate taking into co onsideration factors such as property ssize, location and/o or type of heaating system. Such estimattes are to be based on a so ound rationalle, providing an acccurate estimaate that is refflective of the e characterist ics of the pro operty being p purchased. 1 a a stand dard amount of $100 per month for heeat for most p properties, Most lenders will accept while a higher amo ount may be used for a larrge property. Although heeat varies from m property to o prope erty, this standard amountt is applied to o all debt servvice ratio calculations unleess advised otherwise by the le ender. he purposes of o this course $100 will be assumed unl ess otherwisee noted. For th Condo ominium Maintenance Fe ee The co ondo maintenance fee is the t fee that a condominiu m unit ownerr pays to the condominium m corpo oration for the e maintenancce of the com mmon elemen ts. Common elements aree those itemss that are a common to t all unit owners such as upkeep of thee building, lobby, hallwayss, pool, gymnasium, etc. The T GDS uses fifty percent of this expennse. Naturallyy, if the property being mortggaged is not a condominium, this part of o the formulaa is excluded. Grosss Income The gross income is i the potentiial borrower’ss total incom e before payiing income taaxes. Conve erting to a Pe ercentage The entire amountt must be multiplied by on ne hundred too provide a peercentage. 1 http:://www.cmhc‐schl.gc.ca/en/hoficlincl/molo oin/mupr/muppr_015.cfm 30 05 Chapter 13: Applicattion Analysis – Application n Ratios Example 1 Mr. Borrower wish hes to purchase a home vaalued at $3500,000. He hass $87,500 as a down payment, leaving a required mo ortgage in the e amount of $$262,500. Yo ou have deterrmined that his monthly mortggage paymentt will be $1,67 79.50. This iss not a condominium and ttherefore there is no maintenance fee. Mr. M Borrower has an annuaal income of $$77,500 and p pays $3,100 per ye ear in propertty taxes. What is Mr. Borrrower’s GDS?? Solutiion GDS G = [(PITH) / Gross Incom me] x 100 Annual Property Taxes DS = [(($1,679 9.50 x 12) + ($ $100 x 12) + $$3,100)/ $77,,500] x 100 GD Monthly mortgage payment x 12 = the annual mortgage payment GDS = [($ $20,154 + $1,200 + 3,100)) / $77,500] x 100 GDS = ($24,454 / $77,5000) x 100 Monthly heat x 12 = the annual heating payment GDS = 3.1 15535484E‐1 x 100 GDS = 0.315535484 x 100 DS = 31.55% GD The erefore Mr. Bo orrower’s GD DS is 31.55%. In thiss case Mr. Bo orrower’s GDSS is within the e acceptable iindustry standard of 32%, meaning thaat his GD DS will qualifyy with most le enders. Pa ause for cllarification n – Frequen ncy of payyments in G GDS All figures in th he GDS calcullation must be b based on thhe same freq quency. In Exxample 1 the mortgage paym ment is month hly and the in ncome is annuually. It is theerefore necesssary to an nnualize all figgures, which is why the mo ortgage paym ment and heat is multiplied d by twelve. Example 2 – Condo ominium Uniit Ms. House H owns a condominium m unit valued d at $200,0000 that has a m mortgage with h an outstaanding balancce of $120,00 00. She would d like to refinnance this mo ortgage, increasing it to $145,000. Ms. House has informed you thatt the monthlyy condominiu um maintenan nce fee is $35 50 and her property taxes t are $1,9 900 per year while w she hass a monthly in ncome of $5,0 000. Based o on your calculations c you y have dete ermined that her monthly mortgage paayment based d on this propo osed mortgagge will be $927.72. What is her GDS? Solutiion ½ of the condo nce fee maintenan DS = [(PITH + ½ Condo Maiintenance feee) / Gross Income] x 100 GD GDS G = [(($927 7.72 x 12) + ($ $100 x 12) + (.50 ( x $350 x 12) + $1,900)) / ($5,000 x 1 12)] x 100 306 Chapter 13: Applicattion Analysis – Application n Ratios GD DS = [($11,132.64 + $1,200 0 + $2,100 + $$1,900) / $600,000] x 100 GDS G = ($16,33 32.64 / $60,0000) x 100 GDS = 2.7 72210667E‐1 x 100 GDS = 0.272210667 x 100 GD DS = 27.22% Th herefore Ms. House’s GDSS is 27.22%. ouse’s GDS is within the accceptable induustry standarrd of 32%, meeaning that In thiss case Ms. Ho Ms. House’s H GDS will w qualify with most lende ers. Su uccess Tip – If GDS iss above ind dustry stan ndard If the GDS is higgher than the e allowable in ndustry stand ard it will be necessary to consult further with the client to eitther bring the e GDS within acceptable lim mits by decreeasing the paayment or sugggest a lender that may allow a GDS th at is higher th han the indusstry standard. GDS S and Se cond Mo rtgages Since the debt servvice ratio includes all costss for shelter, w when you aree calculating tthe GDS for a 2nd mortgage appliication, you must m include in i the GDS thhe 1st mortgagge payment aas well as the propo osed 2nd morttgage paymen nt. Example – 2nd Morrtgage Tedro os is applying for a 2nd morrtgage in the amount a of $117,000. You h have determined that the mortggage payment for this morrtgage will be e $200.88 perr month. Tedros has inform med you thatt he live es in a single family detach hed home and that his 1st mortgage payment is $25 55.92 per weeek and his property taaxes are $2,400 per year. Tedros earnss $6,350 per m month. Whatt is Tedros’ nd GDS under u this pro oposed 2 mo ortgage? Solutiion Since Tedros lives in a single fam mily detached d home theree is no condom minium maintenance fee nd st payab be included in ble. Since thiss is a 2 morttgage the 1 mortgage payyment must b n this calcullation. GDS G = [(PITH) / Gross Incom me] x 100 GDS = [(($255.92 x 52) + ($200.88 x 12) + ($100 x 112) + 2,400) / ($6,350 x 12 2)] x 100 1st mortgage e payment GDSS = [($13,307..84 + $2,410.5 56 + $1,200 + $2,400) / $776,200] x 100 GDS G = ($19,31 18.40 / $76,2200) x 100 GDS = 2.5 5352231E‐1 x 100 Prroposed mortgaage payment Chapter 13: Applicattion Analysis – Application n Ratios 30 07 GDS = 0.25352231 x 100 DS = 25.35% GD Therefore Te edros’ GDS is 25.35%. In thiss case Tedross’ GDS is withiin the acceptable industryy standard of 32%, meanin ng that his GD DS will qualify with most lenders. Calc culating the t Total Debt Se ervice Ra tio (TDS ): Pre-Qu ualifying Indusstry Standard ‐ 40% Like the GDS the TDS is designe ed to determine if the borrrower can affford the poten ntial mortgagge payment, howeverr this calculattion also inclu udes all otherr debts that th he borrower has. The TDS has two main m functions. It can be used u to: 1. Pre e‐qualify the borrower by determining the maximum m mortgage p payment thatt the borroweer caan afford. 2. Ve erify that the payment p quaalifies by determining if thee potential m mortgage paym ment falls within w the lend der’s TDS ratio. e‐qualify a po otential borro ower it is nece essary to deteermine the am mount of a m mortgage To pre payment that he or o she can affo ord based on the TDS calcuulation, and tthen use thatt payment amou unt to determ mine the maxim mum mortgage amount. Pre‐qualifying a po otential borro ower based on n the TDS is ccalculated by using the folllowing equattion: Maxximum Mortgage Paymentt = (Income x Max TDS / 1000) – (Propertty Taxes + Heeat + ½ Condo o Maintenancce Fee + Othe r Debts) nce the TDS Ratio R is a percentage, it is necessary n to cconvert it to iits decimal eq quivalent by Sin divviding the num mber by 100. n be defined as a other obliggations that, iif the borrow wer failed to m make a Other debts can d require monies to be paid to anotherr party. For eexample, if a b borrower had d payment, would a car c loan and failed f to make e his or her monthly m paym ments, the carr would be rep possessed and the e borrower would w still owe e the balance e of the loan. If the borrow wer failed to make his or her monthly car insurance payment, on the other han d, the borrow wer would no ot owe any furrther money since s the car insurer would cancel the iinsurance policy. Examples of items included in the TDS ratio: Loans Mo ortgage paym ments Cre edit cards Child support Alimony ny payment th hat, if disconttinued, would d result in a b alance owingg. An Examples of items not included d in the TDS raatio: 308 Chapter 13: Applicattion Analysis – Application n Ratios RR RSP contributiions Car insurance Pro operty insuraance Life insurance An ny payment th hat, if disconttinued, would d not result inn a balance ow wing Su uccess Tip – Outstanding balan nce or cred dit limit in the TDS? Lenders will typ pically use 3% % of the outstaanding balan ce on a creditts cards and o other types o of un nsecured revo olving credit as a the paymen nt amount w hen calculatin ng the TDS, although this can vary from le ender to lend der. For secured debts CM MHC suggests lenders calcu ulate what the mo onthly payme ent would be if the debt was w amortizedd over 25 yearrs. It is imporrtant to know w ho ow a lender caalculates the TDS before submitting an application tto that lenderr. Example 1 – Condo ominium Uniit Ms. House H owns a condominium m unit valued d at $200,0000 that has a m mortgage with h an outstaanding balancce of $120,00 00. She would d like to refinnance this mo ortgage, and w wishes to know how much sh he qualifies to o borrow. Ms. House has informed you u that the mo onthly ominium maintenance fee e is $350 and her property taxes are $1,,900 per yearr while she haas condo a mon nthly income of $5,000. Further investigation showss that Ms. Ho ouse has a carr payment of $310 per month, credit c card payments of $1 145 per monthh and a loan payment of $ $225 per month. Ms. House e also makes weekly contrributions of $550 to her RRSSP, spends $1 185 per month for he er car insuran nce, and has a life insurancce policy that costs her $300 per month. What is the maxim mum monthly mortgage paayment for whhich Ms. House qualifies b based on a TD DS of 40% %? Solutiion The first step is to determine which w payments are includeed in the TDSS calculation aand which aree not. The T car paym ment, credit caard payment, and loan payyment must b be included as other debtss, while the weekly RRSP R contribu ution, car insu urance, and liffe insurance payments aree not. The se econd step is to determine e whether the e calculation will be done based on mo onthly or annuaal numbers. This T example has a mixture of monthly income, mon nthly paymen nts, and an annuaal amount of property taxe es. For the saake of simpliccity in this exaample the annual propertyy taxes will be divide ed by twelve to t determine e the monthlyy payment and all other deebts will be m Heaat is standard dized at $100 per month. kept monthly. Maximum M Mo ortgage Payme ent (MMP) = Income x (MA AX TDS / 1000) – (Property Taxes + ½ Condomin nium Mainten nance Fee + H Heat + Other D Debts) MM MP = ($5,000 x 40% /100) – ($1,900 /12 2) – (.50 x $3550) – $100 (heeat) ‐ $310 ‐ $ $145 ‐ $225 MP = ($5,000 x .40) ‐ $158.3 33 – $175 – $$100 ‐ $310 – $145 – $225 MM MMP = $2,000 ‐ $158.33 ‐ $175 ‐ $1000 ‐ $310 ‐ $1445 ‐ $225 Other Debts Chapter 13: Application Analysis – Application Ratios 309 MMP = $886.67 Therefore the maximum mortgage payment that Ms. House qualifies for is $886.67 per month. Example 2 Mr. Orange would like to apply for a mortgage to purchase a new home valued at $400,000. Mr. Orange has stated that the property taxes are $2,900 per year. His income is $73,000 per year. Further investigation shows that Mr. Orange has a car payment of $275 per month, credit card payments of $195 per month and a loan payment of $300 per month. a) What is the maximum monthly mortgage payment for which Mr. Orange qualifies based on a TDS of 40%? b) What is the maximum loan amount for which Mr. Orange qualifies based on an interest rate of 6% compounded semi‐annually, not in advance, and a 25‐year amortization? Solution a) For the sake of simplicity in this example the annual property taxes and annual income will be divided by twelve to determine the monthly amount and all other debts will be kept monthly. Heat is standardized at $100 per month. Maximum Mortgage Payment (MMP) = Income x (MAX TDS / 100) – (Property Taxes + ½ Condominium Maintenance Fee + Other Debts) MMP = [($73,000 / 12) x (40% /100)] – ($2,900 /12) – $100 (heat) – $275 ‐ $195 ‐ $300 MMP = ($6,083.33 x .40) ‐ $241.67 – $100 ‐ $275 – $195 – $300 MMP = $2,433.33 ‐ $241.67 ‐ $100 ‐ $275 ‐ $195 ‐ $300 MMP = $1,316.66 Therefore the maximum monthly mortgage payment for which Mr. Orange qualifies is $1,316.66. b) To determine the maximum mortgage amount, based on the payment that was calculated above, it is necessary to complete the following calculation: 6 SHIFT NOM% 2 SHIFT P/YR SHIFT EFF% 6.09 12 SHIFT P/YR SHIFT NOM% 5.92634643744 1,316.66 +/‐ PMT O FV 12 X 25 N PV 205,790.304644 The difference between this calculation and calculating a mortgage payment in chapter 8 is simply that here we enter the payment and solve the PV 310 Chapter 13: Applicattion Analysis – Application n Ratios efore the maxximum loan amount based d on these terrms is $205,790.30 There Calc culating the t Total Debt Se ervice Ra tio (TDS ): Verifyi ng If the mortgage aggent has alreaady determine ed the mortg age paymentt that the potential borro ower requires, it is then necessary to de etermine if th at payment m meets the ind dustry standard 40% TDS ratio or whattever the ratio is for the leender we’ve cchosen or aree considering.. Example 1 Malikk and Nancy Borrower B are purchasing a house valuedd at $450,0000 and have $8 80,000 as a down n payment, resulting in a re equired mortgage of $3700,000. You haave reviewed their appliccation and have determine ed that the le ender best forr them is currrently offeringg a rate of 4.75% % with a 25‐ye ear amortizattion and monthly paymentts. You have calculated th hat the monthly mortgage e payment on this propose ed mortgage w will be $2,0999.59. From their application you know w that they have a combinned monthly income of $8 8,355. They have car paymentss of $175 and d $300 per mo onth, credit c ard payments of $190 perr month and a stude ent loan paym ment of $100 per p month. The T property taxes for thiss home are esstimated to be $3,10 00 per year. Based B on the lender’s TDS ratio of 40%,, will they quaalify for this p proposed mortggage? Solutiion Heat is standardize ed at $100 pe er month. TDS = [(PITH + Oth her Debts) / I ncome] x 1000 TDSS = [($2,099.5 59 + $100(heaat) + $175 + $300 $ + $190 + $100 + ($3,1100 / 12)) / $8 8,355] x 100 TDS = [($2,969.59 9 + 258.33) / $$8,355] x 1000 TDS = ($3,22 27.92 / $8,35 5) x 100 TDS = 3.8 86345901E‐1 x 100 TDS = .3 386345901 x 100 TD DS = 38.63% There efore Malik an nd Nancy quaalify for this mortgage m baseed on the lender’s TDS req quirement. Su uccess Tip – If TDS is above ind dustry stan ndard If the TDS is higgher than the e allowable industry standaard, it will be necessary to o consult further with the client, eithe er to bring the TDS within acceptable limits by reduccing debt or de ecreasing the payment, or to suggest a lender that m may allow a TTDS that is higgher than industry standaard. Chapter 13: Application Analysis – Application Ratios 311 Example 2 Anna and Ronin own a home and would like to obtain a $31,000 2nd mortgage to consolidate all of their current debts. Their property is valued at $450,000 and they currently have a 1st mortgage that has monthly payments of $1,454.02. You have reviewed their application and have determined that the lender best for them is currently offering a rate of 12.75% with a 15‐ year amortization and monthly payments. You have calculated that the monthly mortgage payment on this proposed mortgage will be $380.55. From their application you know that they have a combined monthly income of $7,400. They have car payments of $175 and $300 per month, credit card payments of $190 per month and a student loan payment of $100 per month. The property taxes for this home are $2,800 per year. Based on the lender’s TDS ratio of 40%, will they qualify for this proposed mortgage? Solution It is necessary to include the first mortgage payment in this calculation. Since this is a debt consolidation and all of the applicants’ debts will be paid off from the proceeds of this proposed 2nd mortgage, they must not be included in this calculation. Heat is standardized at $100 per month. TDS = [(PITH + Other Debts) / Income] x 100 TDS = [(($1,454.02 + $380.55 + $100 + ($2,800 / 12)) / $7,400] x 100 TDS = [($1,939.57 + 233.33) / $7,400] x 100 TDS = ($2,172.90 / $7,400) x 100 TDS = 2.93635135E‐1 x 100 TDS = .293635135 x 100 TDS = 29.36% Therefore Anna and Ronin qualify for this mortgage based on the lender’s TDS requirement. 13.3 Calculating the Maximum Mortgage Amount The lender will use either the LTV or GDS/TDS calculation when determining the maximum mortgage amount. The lender’s decision will be based on the lower of the two. For example, if a property is valued at $400,000 and a lender’s maximum LTV is 90%, the maximum loan based on the LTV would be $360,000 (.90 x $400,000). However, if after using the GDS/TDS calculation the maximum mortgage amount for which the borrower qualifies was $340,000, then the lender would base the mortgage on the lowest value, or $340,000. 312 Chapter 13: Application Analysis – Application Ratios 13.4 LTV, GDS and TDS Quick Reference Guide Loan to Value (LTV) LTV of a 1st mortgage LTV = Mortgage Amount / Property Value LTV of a 2nd mortgage LTV = (1st Mortgage Amount + 2nd Mortgage Amount) / Property Value LTV calculating the maximum loan amount Maximum Mortgage Amount = LTV x Property Value Gross Debt Service Ratio (GDS) GDS: verifying that a payment meets the lender’s GDS ratio GDS = (PITH + ½ Condo Mtc. Fee) / Income Total Debt Service Ratio (TDS) TDS: verifying that a payment meets the lender’s TDS ratio TDS = (PITH + ½ Condo Mtc. Fee + Other Debts) / Income TDS: calculating a maximum mortgage payment Maximum Mortgage Payment = (MAX TDS x Income) – Taxes ‐ Heat ‐ Other Debts Chapter 13: Application Analysis – Application Ratios 313 13.5 Key Terms and Definitions Gross Debt Service Ratio (GDS) A debt service ratio that measures the amount of shelter (housing) payments in comparison to the amount of gross income, expressed as a percentage. The industry standard is 32%. Industry Standard An amount that the mortgage industry will typically use in a calculation or a practice Loan to Value (LTV) The amount of a loan to the value of the property expressed as a percentage. Loan to Value (%) = Loan / Property Value Percentage A fraction or ratio with 100 understood as the denominator; for example, 0.98 equals a percentage of 98 Property Value The value, in dollars, of a property, usually determined by independent verification such as an appraisal Total Debt Service Ratio (TDS) A debt service ratio that measures the amount of shelter payments (PITH and condo maintenance fees, when applicable) and other debt payments in comparison to the amount of gross income, expressed as a percentage. The industry standard is 40%. The formula is (PITH [Principal + Interest + Taxes + Heating] + other debts + ½ condo maintenance fee [when applicable]) / Gross Income. 314 Chapter 13: Application Analysis – Application Ratios 13.6 Review Questions Answers to the Review Questions are found at www.REMIC.ca 1. A house has been appraised at a value of $550,000. The owner requires a 1st mortgage in the amount of $255,000 and a 2nd mortgage in the amount of $70,000. a) What is the LTV of the 1st mortgage? b) What is the total LTV of the combined 1st and 2nd mortgages? 2. Tedros has been approved for a mortgage in the amount of $262,500 on a 1st mortgage. The property he is buying is worth $350,000. What is the LTV of this mortgage? 3. Adela and Carlos are applying for a mortgage through you, their local mortgage agent. They have requested a mortgage in the amount of $455,000 with weekly payments for a 3 year term at 5.95% compounded semi‐annually with a 25 year amortization. They have told you that they also have a car payment of $385 per month, annual car insurance of $2,712, a weekly loan payment of $45 and total monthly credit card payments of $510. Their property taxes are $2,100 per year. Their combined income is $126,966 per year and heat on this house is $100 per month. a) What is their mortgage payment? b) What is their GDS? c) What is their TDS? 4. Hisa and Botan are applying for a mortgage through you, their local mortgage agent. They have requested a mortgage in the amount of $300,000 with monthly payments for a 5 year term at 4.95% compounded semi‐annually with a 25 year amortization. They have told you that they also have a car payment of $275 per month, annual car insurance of $2,000, a weekly loan payment of $95 and total monthly credit card payments of $300. Their property taxes are $2,100 per year. Their combined income is $95,000 per year and heat on this house is $100 per month. a) What is their mortgage payment? b) What is their GDS? c) What is their TDS? 5. Joe and Mary are applying for a mortgage through you, their local mortgage agent. They have requested a mortgage in the amount of $640,000 with bi‐weekly payments for a 5 year term at 3.75% compounded semi‐annually with a 25 year amortization. They have told you that they also have a car payment of $405 per month, annual car insurance of $3,000, a weekly loan payment of $55 and total monthly credit card payments of $400. Their property taxes are $2,100 per year. Their combined income is $145,000 per year and heat on this house is $100 per month. a) What is their mortgage payment? b) What is their GDS? c) What is their TDS? 6. Lin and Shen have been approved for a mortgage through you, their local mortgage agent in the amount of $200,000 with monthly payments for a 1 year term at 8.25% compounded semi‐annually with a 25 year amortization. They have told you that they also have a car payment of $405 per month, a Line of Credit payment of $180 per month and total monthly Chapter 13: Application Analysis – Application Ratios 315 credit card payments of $400. Their property taxes are $2,100 per year. Their combined income is $75,000 per year and heat on this house is $100 per month. a) What is their mortgage payment? b) What is their GDS? c) What is their TDS? 7. Dalila has been approved for a $30,000 2nd mortgage with monthly payments, a 1 year term, 10 year amortization at 12.5% compounded semi‐annually. She has a first mortgage with an outstanding balance of $220,000 (down from $230,000 when she first took out the mortgage) with bi‐weekly payments of $700. The second mortgage is going to consolidate her credit cards for which she currently pays $390 per month. She has a car lease of $360 per month, annual car insurance payments of $2,300 and monthly home insurance premiums of $150. Her property taxes are $3,500 per year and it costs $100 per month to heat her home, which has been appraised at $350,000. Dalila earns $78,000 per year as a manager. a) What is the LTV of the 1st mortgage? b) What is the LTV of only the 2nd mortgage (excluding the 1st mortgage)? c) What is the total LTV of the 2nd mortgage? d) What is her mortgage payment for the 2nd mortgage? e) What is her GDS? f) What is her TDS? 8. Your clients, Aarav and Anika have applied for a mortgage with you. They are buying a high‐ rise condo and need a mortgage in the amount of $320,000. You’ve suggested that they take a mortgage with monthly payments for a 5 year term at 3.35% compounded semi‐annually with a 20 year amortization. They have told you that they also have a car payment of $310 per month, annual car insurance of $2,000, a weekly loan payment of $80 and total monthly credit card payments of $275. The property taxes are $2,100 per year while the condo maintenance fees are $418 per month. Their combined income is $117,000 per year and heat, which is not included in the maintenance fee, is estimated at $100 per month. a) What is their mortgage payment? b) What is their GDS? a) What is their TDS? 316 Chapter 14: Application Analysis – Borrower Credit Chapter 14: Application Analysis – Borrower Credit Learning Outcomes Successful understanding of the concepts presented in this chapter will enable the learner to: Differentiate between the credit report a consumer receives and the report a mortgage agent receives List the main credit bureaus in Canada Interpret and analyze a credit report Explain the components of a credit score Introduction Lenders use an applicant’s current and past repayment history to determine the likelihood of future repayment. Although there is no way to perfectly predict an applicant’s future repayment of debt, reviewing the applicant’s current and past repayment history provides a fairly accurate indicator of future repayment trends. Lenders rely on a credit bureau or credit agency, a company that compiles information provided to its members. The credit bureau’s members consist of credit grantors such as banks, trust companies, finance companies, loan companies, and so on. These members provide the credit bureau with information on the individuals to which credit has been granted or who have applied for credit through the credit grantor. This information is compiled into two distinct reports. One report is available to consumers. This report is designed to be read by consumers and is therefore compiled in a fashion that is easy for the average consumer to understand. The other type of report is the one provided to the credit bureau’s members. This report is more detailed and relies heavily on codes that are typically only understood by its members. This chapter will discuss the different Canadian credit bureaus and the impact of credit reports on the mortgage application. 14.1 Credit Bureaus There are currently two credit reporting agencies operating in Canada: Equifax and Transunion, with Equifax holding the majority of the market share. Headquartered in Atlanta, Georgia, Equifax Inc. employs approximately 7,000 people in 15 countries through North America, Latin America and Europe. Its Canadian operations are headquarted in Toronto, Ontario. Equifax was founded in Atlanta, Georgia, as the Retail Credit Company in 1899 and by 1920 had offices throughout the US and Canada. By the 1960s, the Retail Credit Company was one of America’s largest credit bureaus, holding files on millions of American and Canadian citizens. Even though they still did credit reporting the majority of their business was making reports to Chapte er 14: Applicaation Analysiss – Borrower Credit 31 17 insuraance companies when individuals applied for new innsurance policcies, such as life, auto, firee and medical m insuraance. 70, when the company mo oved to comp puterize its re cords, which would lead to much wider In 197 availaability of the personal p information it held, the Unitedd States’ Congress held heearings to determine any pottential consum mer protectio on issues. Theese hearings lled to the creeation of the Fair Credit C Reporting Act which gave consum mers rights re garding inforrmation storeed about them m in corrporate datab banks. For most m of its exisstence, Equifaax has operatted primarily in the busineess‐to‐businesss sector, sellingg consumer credit c and insu urance reports and relatedd analytics to o businesses in a range of industries. In 1999 9, it began offfering credit fraud f and ideentity theft prrevention pro oducts to consu umers. More information can be found d on Equifax bby visiting its w website at ww ww.equifax.cca Operaating out of Burlington, B On ntario, Transu union Canadaa provides thee same types of products and se ervices as its main compettitor, Equifax Canada. Theey also markeet their creditt reports directtly to consum mers, in additio on to their co ore business oof providing tthese reports to their memb bers. More in nformation caan be found on o Transunionn by visiting its website at www.transunion.cca 14.2 2 Credit Reports A cred dit report is the documentt that presentts the informaation that thee credit bureaau has comp piled on the ap pplicant and comes c in two o forms. The first is the creedit report prroduced for the co onsumer, whiile the other is i the credit report r producced for the crredit bureau’ss members. To illu ustrate the differences bettween a crediit report provvided to the cconsumer and d one provid ded to a credit bureau member, both are a illustratedd in the follow wing figures. Sam ple Credi t Report Provided P to Consum mers Example of an Equ uifax Credit Re eport provide ed to a consuumer. Figure 601 – Sample Crredit Report Pro ovided to Consum mers CONSSUMER RELATTIONS P.O. BO OX 190 STATIION JEAN TALLON MON NTREAL QUEB BEC H1S 2Z2 JANEE DOE 10 PLLEASANT ST. TORO ONTO ONTAR RIO M2N 1A2 CONFFIDENTIAL INFORMATION NOT TO BE USED FOR CREDIT PURPOSES P 1 Equiffax Canada 318 Chapter 14: Application Analysis – Borrower Credit RE: EQUIFAX UNIQUE NUMBER: 3140123054 Dear JANE DOE, Further to your request, a disclosure of your personal credit file as of 03/27/01 follows: PERSONAL IDENTIFICATION INFORMATION: The following personal identification information is currently showing on your credit file. Your date of birth and social insurance number have been partially masked to protect your personal information (i.e.: Birth Date/Age: 01/xx/60, Social Insurance Number: 123‐xxx‐789). DATE FILE OPENED: 07/04/92 NAME: Doe, Jane CURRENT ADDRESS: 10 PLEASANT ST. TORONTO,ON DATE REPORTED: 12/96 PREVIOUS ADDRESS: 2 AVENUE ST,TORONTO,ON DATE REPORTED: 12/93 PRIOR ADDRESS: 3 DU BOULEVARD,MONTREAL,PQ DATE REPORTED: 07/92 BIRTH DATE/AGE: 10/XX/1968 SOCIAL INSURANCE NUMBER: 123‐XXX‐789 OTHER REFERENCE NAMES: CURRENT EMPLOYMENT: EDITOR PREVIOUS EMPLOYMENT: TRANSLATOR PRIOR EMPLOYMENT: CHEF OTHER INCOME: CREDIT INQUIRIES ON YOUR FILE: Following is a list of Equifax members who have received a copy of your credit file for credit granting or other permissible purposes. Addresses are available by calling Equifax at 1‐800‐ 465‐7166. DATE 03/02/00 02/22/00 01/16/00 REQUESTOR NAME CANADA TRUST MTG TD BANK BQE NATIONALE TELEPHONE (416) 361‐8518 (800) 787‐7065 (450) 677‐9122 The following inquiries are for your information only and are not displayed to others. They include requests from authorized parties to update their records regarding your existing account with them. DATE REQUESTOR NAME TELEPHONE 03/23/00 SOC ALCOOLS (not displayed) (514) 873‐6281 03/22/00 CANADA TRUST MTG (not displayed) (416) 361‐8518 02/16/00 CMHC SCHL (not displayed) (888) 463‐6454 01/16/00 AMERICAN EXPRESS (not displayed) (416) 123‐4567 CONSUMER INTERVIEWS AND OTHER SERVICES: You contacted our office in 12/98 to request a review of your credit file. Chapte er 14: Applicaation Analysiss – Borrower Credit 31 19 CRED DIT HISTORY AND/OR A BANKING INFORM MATION: The following f info ormation was reported to us by organizzations listed below. Information is recceived every 30 3 days from most credit ggrantors. All aaccount numb bers with your creditors havve been maskked to protectt your personnal account in nformation an nd only the t digits will w be displaye ed (i.e.: xxx...123). last three AC last reporte ed to us in 01 1/01 rating yo our installmennt account ass I1, meaning paid as GMA agree ed and up to date. The rep ported balancce of your acccount was $10000. Your acccount numb ber: xxx...345 5. The account is in the sub bject's name oonly. Date acccount opened: 04/99. Credit limit or high hest amount of credit advanced: $44000. DATE OF LA AST ACTIVITY meaning mments: o transaction n made on th his account waas in 12/00. A Additional com the laast payment or auto loan. Monthly payments. ADA TRUST MC M last reportted to us in 01 1/01 rating yoour revolvingg account as R R1, meaning CANA paid as agreed and up to date. At the time the t reported balance of yo our account w was $285. mber: xxx...234. Date accou unt opened: 006/99. Credit limit or higheest amount Your account num of cre edit advanced d $2000. DATTE OF LAST AC CTIVITY meanning the last p payment or trransaction made e on this acco ount was in 12 2/00. PREV VIOUS PAYMEENT STATUS: 30 DA AYS: 1 time (ss) account pre eviously R2 meaning m one ppayment pastt due ON: PUBLLIC RECORDS AND OTHER INFORMATIO The following f info ormation was reported to your y file on t he date indiccated. A CO OLLECTION waas assigned in n 10/96 to Com mmercial Creedit by Transaamerica Finan ncial in the amou unt of: $2675 5. Date reportted paid: 07/9 97. Collectionn status: PAID D. DATE OF LA AST ACTIV VITY was in 04/96. Collection agency re eference num mber: 222222.. A JUD DGEMENT waas FILED IN 01 1/96 in Min Govt G Serv. Plaiintiff and/or ccase number: Chrysler Canaada 4444. Deffendant/other info: joint with w Dossier. A Amount repo orted: $7525. Status reported: Satisfied d. Date satisfied: 09/97. A BANKRUPTCY was w FILED IN 08/97 0 in SC Ne ewmarket. Caase number aand/or trusteee: 5555555 SYND DIC & ASS. Liaabilities: $250 0000.Assets: $8900000.Item $ m classificatio on: individual. Information reporrted on: The subject s only. The item is reeported as: D DISCHARGED. DATE SETTLED: 05/98. Additional A com mments: abso olute dischargge from bankkruptcy. THE CONSUMER C PROVIDED P A PERSONAL P STTATEMENT too us in 12/98. The statement has been recorrded as follow ws: RE: BANKRUPTCY, B , CONSUMER DECLARED BANKRUPTCY DUE TO DIVO ORCE This stattement is to be re emoved from the file in: 12 2/04. Sam ple Credi t Report Provided P to Equifaxx Membe rs The fo ollowing figurre is an example of an Equ uifax credit re port provided d to an Equifaax member. This report is for trraining purpo oses only. The e code in the left hand column of the reeport corressponds to the e Equifax Lege end in next figure, which ffollows this reeport. 320 Chapter 14: Application Analysis – Borrower Credit Figure 612 – Sample Credit Report Provided to Credit Bureau Members Equifax Consumer Credit Report (provided to credit bureau members) This report shows a sample of potential information found on a credit report. This is not an actual report. CONSUMER REPORT [1] 1 800 465‐7166 [2] 6/16/2004 [3] File Requested by: NTREM Identification Name: Current Address: Previous Address: Date of Birth, SIN: Reference: TEST, FILE,P. 110, SHEPPARD AVE, NORTH YORK, ON,M2N6S1 60, BLOOR ST W, TORONTO,ON,M4W3C1. 1942/02/16, 999‐999‐998. NTREM Employment Employer, Occupation: OWNER TESTS HAIR SALON [4] Subject 1: Alert, Score, Identification, Inquiries, Employment, Summary, Public, Trades, Banking, Declaration. Consumer Alert (Subject 1) [5] Warnings Invalid Social Insurance Number [6] SAFESCAN SF‐9 Possible True Name Fraud [7] Product Score (Subject 1) Risk Score 509 Serious delinquency and public record or collection filed Time since delinquency is too recent or unknown Number of accounts with delinquency Length of time revolving accounts have been established Bank. Nav. Index 230 Age of derogatory public records. Average age of retail trades. Number of recent inquiries. Average age of trades. 2 Equifax Canada Chapter 14: Application Analysis – Borrower Credit Identification (Subject 1) [8] Unique Number 3455234199 [10] Date File Opened: 01/23/1975 [12] DOB/Age: 02/16/1942 [14] Name: [15] Current Address: [16] Since, R/O/B: [17] Reported: [18] Former Address: Since, R/O/B: Reported: [19] 2nd Former Address: Since, R/O/B: Reported: [20] Also Known As: [9] File Number 00‐0008095‐00‐037 [11] Date of Last Activity: 06/03/2004 [13] SIN: ** Consumer Declaration ** TEST, FILE, EQUIFAX 110, SHEPPARD, TORONTO, ON, M2B 6S1 01/2003 STS Reported 1231, 15 TH AVE, CALGARY, AB, T3C 0X6 01/2003 Tape Reported 2314, 11 TH AVE 1201, TORONTO, ON, M4W 3C1 01/2003 Verbally Reported PRETEND, FILE, EQUIFAX Inquiries (Subject 1) [21] Subject shows 3 inquiries since 03/17/2004 [22] Member Inquiries: Date Member No 06/03/2004 001BB05697 05/08/2004 481FF00722 05/02/2004 057ON00374 10/13/2002 481BB99080 [23] Total number of inquiries: 4 [24] Foreign Bureau Inquiries: Date 06/02/2002 Member No/City INTLUSA 401BB17978 Employment (Subject 1) Employment Information: [25] Current Employer: [26] Since, Left, Position, Salary: [27] Former Employer: Since, Left, Position, Salary: [28] Second Former Employer: City, Province: Since, Left, Position, Salary: Verified, Status: Member Name Telephone BANQUE SCOTIA (222) 333‐3333 ASSOCIATES FINANCIAL (111) 222‐2222 PRESIDENTS CHOICE MC (333) 777‐7777 SCOTIABANK (444) 555‐5555 Province and Description TD/GM VISA TESTS HAIR SALON , , OWNER, HILTON HOTEL , , HAIR STYLIST, DISNEY CRUISE LINE TOR, ON 04/1999, 02/2001, HAIR STYLIST, 1900 02/2001, 321 322 Chapter 14: Application Analysis – Borrower Credit [29] Summary (Subject 1) Pub/Other Trade Oldest‐Newest Total High Credit Rating for R/O/I/M/C 4 01/2001 ‐ 06/2004 3 2800 ‐ 28K 1‐One, 1‐Two, 1‐Other [30] Public Records/Other Information (Subject 1) [31] Information from Bankruptcy Superintendent : Filed Type 01/2000 Ind Case No/Trustee: Disposition: Description: Court Name Court No MIN OF ATTORNEY GEN 472VF00022 22855 MORRIS ETAL Discharged. 10/2000 Bankrupt Absolute Discharge Liab 28000 Asset 480 Filed By Subject [32] Collection: Rptd NORDON COLLECTION, 04/2002 Verified Date: Acct/Creditor: Description: Type Amt DLA Bal Reason 481YC00036 Unpaid 482 01/2002 482 Unknown 04/2002 55555 SEARS Subject disputes this account Ledger Number 1111111 [33] Secured Loan : Filed 08/2002 Creditor/Amt: Description: Court Name Court No CENT REG TOR 481VC00214 SUPERIOR CREDIT 9 ELLIS AV TOR 3600 Security Disposition Unknown Maturity 12/2004 [34] Judgment : Filed 05/2002 Defendant: Case No: Plaintiff: Description: Type Court Name Court No Jdgm 481VC00297 Test File 55555/02 TRANS CANADA CREDIT Disposition Unknown Amt 4800 Status Date Vrfd [35] Trade Information (Subject 1) Member Trades: Bus/ID Code Rptd Opnd HC Terms CIBC (999) 999‐9999 *J 007BB01351 06/2004 04/2001 28K 555 Prev Hi Rates: I3‐07/2002, I4‐06/2002, I5‐02/2002 BAL PDA Rt 30/60/90 MR DLA 4200 555 I2 4/3/1 21 04/2004 323 Chapter 14: Application Analysis – Borrower Credit Account: Description: ZELLERS *I 650DV00014 Account: Description: 8454545 Personal Loan Semi‐Monthly Payments 01/2004 06/2001 2800 26 2555 845555555 Amount in H/C Column is credit limit Monthly Payments TD VISA (999) 999‐9999 *650ON00044 06/2004 Status: Lost or stolen card [36] Credit Utilization: 22% R1 0/0/0 16 0/0/0 30800 6755 [37] Banking (Subject 1) Checking/Saving: Rptd Opnd Amount BANQUE SCOTIA, 001BB05697, (999) 999‐9999 06/2004 09/1999 L5F Nb NSF, Status: 4 NSF 2002, Account No Account Type Checking/Saving [38] Consumer Declaration (Subject 1) Rptd, Purge: 06/2004, 06/2005 Declaration: *****WARNING*****CONFIRMED TRUE NAME FRAUD/FRAUDULENT CREDIT APPLICATIONS HAVE BEEN SUBMITTED USING THIS NAME/ IF YOU ACCESS THIS FILE AS PART OF A CREDIT CHECK, PLEASE VERIFY WITH THE CUSTOMER THAT IT IS LEGITIMATE BEFORE EXTENDING CREDIT/PHONE (123)456‐7890 End Of Report 05/2004 324 Chapte er 14: Applicaation Analysiss – Borrower Credit Figure 623 – Equifax Le egend Equ ifax Cred dit Reporrt Legend d ONSUMER REEFERRAL TELEEPHONE NUM MBER: [1] CO Tells credit c grantorr where consumers may caall if they are denied crediit. [2] Daate file was acccessed (mm//dd/yy). NQUIRY DATA A: Shows inforrmation used to inquire onn the file. [3] IN [4] Su ubject 1: Detaails sections of o the file thatt are populateed and displaayed. [5] CO ONSUMER FILLE ALERT: Info ormation input on inquiryy does not maatch file orr is invalid. [6] SA AFESCAN WARNING: Fraud d alert messaage warns youu of potentiall appliccation fraud. (Available only to SAFESCA AN subscribe rs.) CORES AND REASON R CODEES: A risk scorre accompaniied by up to ffour reason codes appearss [7] SC in thiss section. Reaason codes indicate the maain reasons foor the score. (Available on nly to risk score subscribers.)) IDENT TIFICATION SECTION: S [8] Un nique Numbe er: for Equifaxx internal use e only. [9] Fille Number: fo or Equifax intternal use only. D file was established. e [10] Date [11] Date D of last acctivity on file.. [12] Date D of birth or o age of Subjject (mm/dd//yy). [13] SIN: S Social Inssurance Numb ber (will only display here if provided o on input and m matches with h inform mation on file e). [14] Subject S name. [15] Current C addre ess. [16] Since: S Date ad ddress was re eported and added a to the Equifax Repo ort. R/O/B: Indicates if thee subject Rents Own ns or Boards their t current address. a 3 Equiffax Canada Chapter 14: Application Analysis – Borrower Credit 325 [17] Reported: Indicates type of customer that reported the address information, STS = direct link customer, Tape = monthly tape reporting customer, DAT= Internet customer ‐ verbal internal Equifax person. [18] Former address ‐ Previous address of subject. [19] Second former address. [20] AKA or name subject is also known as ‐ this credit report will contain the information under both the name information and this section, therefore, no need to make additional credit report inquiries under this name. INQUIRIES SECTION: [21] Alert message appears if there have been three or more inquiries within the past 90 days. [22] Date, member number and member name for inquiries in the past 36 months. Member phone number will display for inquiries in past 12 months. [23] Total Number of Inquiries: Total number of inquiries since file was established. [24] Foreign Bureau Inquiries: Date, Member number and name of U.S. inquiring customers. EMPLOYMENT SECTION: [25] Current Employer: Company name of most recent reported current employer. [26] Since, Left, Position, Salary: Occupation of subject and when verified start date, left date and salary. [27] Former Employer: Company name of previous employer. Since, Left, Position, Salary: Occupation of subject and when verified start date, left date and salary. [28] Second Former Employer: Company name of second or previous employer. Since, Left, Position, Salary: Occupation of subject and when verified start date, left date and salary. [29] SUMMARY SECTION (provides synopsis of file items): Pub/Other‐ Number of Public Record or Other information found in the Public Record section. Trade Oldest ‐ Newest: Oldest opening date of trade and most recent reporting date of trade. Total ‐ Total number of trades on the file. High Credit ‐ High credit range of trades on file. Rating for R/O/I/M/C: Ratings of the trades on file. R = Revolving account, I = Installment account O = Open account, M = Mortgage account and C = Line of Credit [30] PUBLIC RECORDS OR OTHER INFORMATION: Information obtained from Public Sources. 326 Chapter 14: Application Analysis – Borrower Credit [31] Bankruptcies: A person legally declared to be unable to pay debts (date filed, type of action, [IND for personal; BUS for business], court name, court code, liability, assets, filer [subject, spouse or both], case number and trustee, disposition of bankruptcy and description of the bankruptcy). [32] Third‐party collections: A debt which a creditor is unable to collect and hires a third party to do so (name of third‐party collection agency, collection agency member number, reported date, type of collection [UP CL ‐ unpaid collection or PD ‐ paid collection], original amount of collection, date of last activity with credit grantor, balance as of date reported, reason, ledger number, verified date, credit grantor and account number, description). [33] Secured loans: A chattel mortgage, registered loan, or registered lien is a loan where the debtor has given personal property as collateral and the loan is registered with the provincial government. This is not derogatory information. (Secured loans are not extended in the province of Quebec.) [Date reported; name of reporting government agency; member number of reporting agency, maturity date of the loan, name and address of creditor; amount of loan; description of loan status]. [34] Judgments: A court order against a debtor for payment of monies owing (date judgment granted or date filed; judgment status [ST JD ‐ satisfied judgment, JD GT ‐ judgment]; court identification number/name of court; amount of judgment; defendant; judgment number; plaintiff; status of judgment [satisfied, unsatisfied or disposition unknown] and date, when applicable). Other public record information may include foreclosures, credit counselling, and orderly payment of debt (OPD). [35] TRADE INFORMATION Bus/ID Code: Company name and/or telephone number and/or customer number. RPTD ‐ Date item was reported to Equifax. OPND ‐ Date account was opened with credit grantor. H/C ‐ High credit on the account; the highest amount owed or credit limit. TRMS ‐ Monthly repayment amount. BAL ‐ Balance owing as of date reported. PDA ‐ Past due amount as of date reported (shown if applicable). RT ‐ Type of account and manner of repayment: see Trade Information Descriptions and Manner of Payment (North American Standard ratings) for detailed rating descriptions. 30/60/90 ‐ Number of times subject has been 30, 60 or 90 days past due with this account. MR ‐ Months Reviewed ‐ the number of times or months this account has reported. DLA ‐ Date Last Activity ‐ Date of last activity with this account, could be purchase date, last payment date or in worst case, write‐off date. Chapte er 14: Applicaation Analysiss – Borrower Credit 32 27 ormation wass updated by an accounts receivable tape. * Indicates the info Prev Hi H Rates ‐ relaates to the 30 0/60/90 section; provides ratings and d dates of the 3 most recentt delinq quencies Descrription ‐ Provides additional information about the aaccount. [36] Credit C Utilizattion: Providess the percenttage that the customer hass utilized theiir credit by dividing balances by b high creditt. The total off all open highh credit amou unts and all o open account balances are also displayed. d [37] BANKING B INFORMATION SECTION: S Type of account, name and tele ephone numb ber of instituttion; date item m was reported to Equifaxx; o account; cu ustomer’s me ember numbe er; date accouunt was open ned with credit grantor; type of balance of accountt (approximatte range); add ditional infor mation on acccount. [38] CONSUMER C STATEMENT S SECTION: S Rptd, Purge: Datte reported and date inforrmation will b be delete ed from the credit c report ‐ Declaration: Statement tthe consumerr or subject ad dded to the file to o explain discrrepancies or other o comme ents. Trad de Inform mation De escription ns When n viewing a trade line it is important i to be able to unnderstand wh hat the codingg is telling you u. The fo ollowing is a list of the cod des used in rating a trade l ine. Figure 634 – Equifax Trrade Informatio on Descriptions Typess of accounts:: O: R: I: C: M: 4 Open acco ount (30 dayss or 90 days). This indicatees that the acccount has jusst been opened an nd the borrow wer hasn’t eve en made his oor her first paayment yet, so it cannot bee rated. Revolving or option (op pen‐end acco ount). An exaample of this would be a credit card such as a Visa, V Mastercard, departm ment store carrd, etc. The w word revolving refers to th he fact that as the borrower makes a paayment, that amount is aggain availablee as part of th he credit limitt. For example, if you have a credit carrd with a $5,0000 limit and you owe $4,000 and d you make a payment of $4,000, that aamount is again available to you to borrow. nt (fixed num mber of payme ents). An exaample of this would be a ccar loan, Installmen personal lo oan, etc. Thiss type of cred dit has equal ppayments thaat will eventu ually fully repay the loan. Unlike a credit card when the boorrower makees a payment that amount is not available to be re e‐borrowed. Line of Cre edit Mortgage Equiffax Canada 328 er 14: Applicaation Analysiss – Borrower Credit Chapte Trad de Inform mation Ra atings Figure 64 – Trade Information Ratingss Mann ner of payment (North Am merican Stand dard account ratings): 0‐ o rate; approved but not used. u Too new to 1‐ Pays (or paaid) within 30 0 days of paym ment due datte or not overr one paymen nt past due. 2‐ Pays (or paaid) in more than t 30 days from paymennt due date, b but not more than 60 dayss, or not morre than two payments p passt due. 3‐ Pays (or paaid) in more than t 60 days from paymennt due date, b but not more than 90 dayss, or not morre than three e payments paast due. 4‐ Pays (or paaid) in more than t 90 days from paymennt due date, b but not more than 120 days, or fo our payments past due. 5‐ Account is at least 120 days overdue e but is not yeet rated “9.“ 7‐ nts under a co onsolidation oorder or similar arrangement. Making reggular paymen 8‐ Repossession (voluntarry or involuntary return of merchandisee). 9‐ ollection; skip. Bad debt; placed for co Cre dit Rating g Examp les Let’s say s that your borrower haas a credit carrd that is currrently up to date. The rating on this card will w be an R1. R represents a revolving type of debt,, while 1 indiccates that thee account is u up to datte with no past due amoun nts. If, howevver, this borr ower is behin nd two month hs, which is two payments, p the e rating will be an R3. If the borrower has a loan, such h as a car loan n, and it is up to date it will be rated as an I1. I represents an instaallment type debt which tyypically has fiixed paymentts, while 1 ind dicates that the acccount is up to t date with no n past due amounts. If, hhowever, this borrower is behind four months, which is four payments, the rating will w be an I5. If the lender decides to reposse ess the car be ecause of thesse missed payyments, it hass the right to reposssess, or take the security and a sell it. In n this case his rating on this car loan wo ould be an I8. If, afte er the car was sold there was w still an ou utstanding am mount owing to the lenderr, and the lende er didn’t feel it could get th hat money fro om this borroower, it would d change the rating to an I9. Th his means thaat the lender does not expect to get thi s money and has thereforre written off this debt. Chapte er 14: Applicaation Analysiss – Borrower Credit 32 29 Equ ifax Glos ssary of Terms T Us sed in a C Credit Re eport Figure 655 – Equifax Glossary G The fo ollowing key words w are spe ecific abbreviiations used i n various secctions of the ccredit file. Pleease use this lisst to interpre et the abbreviiations when you see them m. The highligghted terms aare typically tthe ones that a mortgage aggent will most frequently encounter. e A Spou usal account ACC Account A numbe er AGE Age A of subject AKA Also A known as B Both h BAL Baalance BDS Birth date ‐ Subject BKRPT T Bankruptcy BRN Creditor’s C name e and/or addresss BUS Business BUS Business industry code CA Current address CASE NO. N Case number CDC Consumer debt counseling CF Co‐‐subject’s form mer emplo oyment CHKAC C Chequing acccount CRCLD D Court consoliidation CRT Update by in‐ho ouse operator D Divo orced DAPA Debtor assistaance pool account DEF Defendant DEPS Dependents DIS Dispute following resolution DLA Date D of last activity DN De eath notice DVFD Divorce filed DVFL Divorce D final EC Spo ouse’s current employment EF Spo ouse’s former employment e 5 Equiffax Canada EMP Date employed e ES Employm ment ‐ subject E2 Subject’ss second formeer Employmen nt FA Former address a FAD File acttivity date FB Foreign bureau b FN File num mber or former name (depends on line) NV V Not Verified O Own or open account OP PD Orderly payyment of debt OP PND Date Opeened PD D Date paid P//D Past due am mount PR R/BK Proposal under bankruptcy FORCL Foreclosure PR R/OI Public reccords or other information R Revolving acco ount FS Date file was establisheed GARN Garnishment H/C High Crredit I Installmen nt (account/inddividual) ID Identificaation informatiion IND Individu ual RP PTD Date reported RTT Current ratin ng (i.e R1, I1, ettc.) S SSingle SA AVAC Savings aaccount SEECLN Secured loan SINCE Date file w was established INQS Inquirries IN VOL Invo oluntary INVER Indirectly verified J Joint JUDG Judgm ment SP PECL Special no otice item SSSC Social insuraance/spouse SSSS Social insuraance/subject STTJD Satisfied ju udgment STTS System‐to‐system customer LEFT Date le eft employmennt LIAB Liabilitties (amount) LWR Lawyer M Married MAR Maritaal status MATURE Daate of maturityy MR Monthss reviewed N/RES Non‐‐responsibility notice NSF Non‐sufficient funds TR RMS Terms (paayment amoun nt) U Unknown UN N Unique file n number UP PCL Unpaid collection VEER Date verifieed VLLDEP Voluntaryy deposit VO OL Voluntary W Widow, widower XX X Automatic co ombine 330 Chapte er 14: Applicaation Analysiss – Borrower Credit Inte rpreting a Credit Report R In the e following sections the cre edit report se een previouslyy in this chap pter will be exxplained in a detailled, section by section anaalysis. The fo ollowing figurre, section [1]] shows the contact inform mation which may be provvided to the appliccant if there are a any questtions or conce erns about th e file. The ap pplicant cannot be given a copy of o this credit report doing so contraven nes the contraact between the brokeragge and the creditt bureau. Secction [2] show ws the date th hat the file waas accessed. Figure 66 – Equifax: Co ontact Informattion CONSSUMER REPORT [1] 1 800 8 465‐7166 6 [2] 6//16/2004 The fo ollowing figurre is the inforrmation that was w used to oobtain the creedit report, reeferred to in the mortgage m indu ustry as “pullin ng the credit report”. Thiss information n is typically eentered into the mortgage m origiination softw ware and throu ugh the use oof that softwaare, the creditt report is obtain ned. Figure 67 – Equifax: In nformation Used d to Obtain a Crredit Report [3] Fille Requested d by: NTREM Identification Name e: Curre ent Address: Previo ous Address: Date of Birth, SIN: Referrence: TEST, FILE,P. 110, SHEPPA ARD AVE, NO ORTH YORK, O ON,M2N6S1 60, BLOOR ST S W, TORON NTO,ON,M4W W3C1. 1942/02/16 6, 999‐999‐9998. NTREM Emplo oyment Emplo oyer, Occupa ation: OWNER R TESTS HAIR R SALON The fo ollowing figurre shows the sections of th he file that arre populated and displayed d in the rest o of the re eport. Figure 68 – Equifax: Su ubject 1 [4] Su ubject 1: Alertt, Score, Identification, Inq quiries, Emplooyment, Summary, Public,, Trades, Banking, Declaratio on. The fo ollowing figurre show the message m that you will receeive if the info ormation thatt you inputted d in you ur application n does not maatch the file in nformation o r is invalid. Figure 69 – Equifax: Co onsumer File Aleert Consu umer Alert (SSubject 1) [5] Warnings W Invalid Social Insurrance Number Chapter 14: Application Analysis – Borrower Credit 331 The following figure is a fraud alert message that is warning you of potential application fraud. This “Safescan” warning is available only to those brokerages that are subscribers of the Safescan service. Figure 70 – Equifax: Safescan Warning [6] SAFESCAN SF‐9 Possible True Name Fraud The following figure indicates the Risk Score, referred to as the Beacon Score (Equifax’s credit score), followed by the Bank Nav Index, another scoring model, with a list of reasons for the score. The risk score and the Bank Nav Index are only available to subscribers of these services. Figure 71 – Equifax: Beacon Score [7] Product Score (Subject 1) Risk Score 509 Serious delinquency and public record or collection filed Time since delinquency is too recent or unknown Number of accounts with delinquency Length of time revolving accounts have been established Bank. Nav. Index 230 Age of derogatory public records. Average age of retail trades. Number of recent inquiries. Average age of trades Identification Sections The following figure illustrates the Identification Section of the report. Ensure that you review the information in this section and match it with the information that you obtained when completing the application, including information from documentation such as the applicant’s photo ID. Discrepancies may indicate that there are errors in the report that must be corrected, that the applicant has made an error in disclosing information or that the applicant is trying to misrepresent him or herself. Figure 72 – Equifax: Identification Section Identification (Subject 1) [8] Unique Number 3455234199 [9] File Number 00‐0008095‐00‐ 037 [10] Date File Opened: 01/23/1975 [11] Date of Last Activity: 06/03/2004 [12] DOB/Age: 02/16/1942 [13] SIN: ** Consumer Declaration ** [14] Name: TEST, FILE, EQUIFAX [15] Current Address: 110, SHEPPARD, TORONTO, ON, M2B 6S1 [16] Since, R/O/B: 01/2003 [17] Reported: STS Reported [18] Former Address: 1231, 15 TH AVE, CALGARY, AB, T3C 0X6 Since, R/O/B: 01/2003 332 Chapte er 14: Applicaation Analysiss – Borrower Credit Reporrted: [19] 2nd 2 Former Address: A Since,, R/O/B: Reporrted: [20] Also A Known As: A Tape Reported 2314, 11 TH AVEE 1201, TORONTO, ON, M4 4W 3C1 01/2 2003 Verbally Reporteed PREETEND, FILE, EEQUIFAX Su uccess Tip – Question n discrepa ancies En nsure that you u match the information that your cliennt has provided on his or h her ap pplication with the informaation contained in the creddit report. If there are disscrepancies yo ou must ask your client to clarify them and a update thhe applicatio n, if necessarry, or update Eq quifax. Inquirry Sections The fo ollowing figurre is an alert that t appears if there have been three o or more inquiiries within the last ninety dayys. In this case there have been three innquiries, resu ulting in the alert. Figure 73 – Equifax: In nquiry Alert Inquirries (Subject 1) [21] Subject S shows 3 inquiries since 03/17/2004 The fo ollowing figurre displays the date of inqu uiries over thhe past thirty‐‐six months as well as the creditt bureau mem mber’s name and a contact information foor inquiries o over the past twelve months. This is he elpful for a len nder who wishes to contacct a previous inquirer to determine if creditt was advance ed or declined d. Figure 74 – Equifax: In nquiries [22] Member M Inqu uiries: Date 06/03 3/2004 05/08 8/2004 05/02 2/2004 10/13 3/2002 Member No 00 01BB05697 48 81FF00722 05 57ON00374 48 81BB99080 Mem mber Name TTelephone BAN NQUE SCOTIA A (222) 333‐33333 ASSOCIATES FINA ANCIAL (111)) 222‐2222 PREESIDENTS CHO OICE MC (3333) 777‐7777 SCO OTIABANK (4444) 555‐5555 ollowing figurre displays the number of inquiries sincce the file hass been openeed as well as iff The fo there are any inquiries by Amerrican members. In this casse we can seee that there w was an inquiryy from TD/GM Visa on o 06/02/200 02 Figure 75 – Equifax: To otal Inquiries Sin nce File Opened d and Foreign Buureau [23] Total T number of inquiries: 4 [24] Foreign F Bureaau Inquiries: Date 06/02 2/2002 Member No/Ciity INTLUSA 401BB B17978 Provincee and Descrip ption TD/GM V VISA Chapter 14: Application Analysis – Borrower Credit 333 The following figure displays the subject’s current employer in section 25, and his former employers in sections 27 and 28. If information is recorded on the position, such as how long the subject has been at his current employer, when he left, the position’s title, salary and when it was verified, it will be included as shown below. Figure 76 – Equifax: Employment Section Employment (Subject 1) Employment Information: [25] Current Employer: [26] Since, Left, Position, Salary: [27] Former Employer: Since, Left, Position, Salary: [28] Second Former Employer: City, Province: Since, Left, Position, Salary: Verified, Status: TESTS HAIR SALON , , OWNER, HILTON HOTEL , , HAIR STYLIST, DISNEY CRUISE LINE TOR, ON 04/1999, 02/2001, HAIR STYLIST, 1900 02/2001, Summary Section The following figure displays a summary of the subject’s current credit. Pub/Other indicates that our subject has 3 Public Records (Pub) or Other Information (Other) on his file. 01/2001 indicates the oldest opening trade line, or the oldest opening date of credit that appears in the following section. 06/2004 indicates the latest reporting date of credit. Total‐3 indicates that there are a total of 3 trade lines (or items of credit) on the file, and they have balances, as indicated in the High Credit column, between two thousand eight hundred dollars and twenty‐eight thousand dollars. 1‐One, 1‐Two, 1‐OTHER indicates the ratings that our subject’s trade lines have. Figure 77 – Equifax: Credit Summary [29] Summary (Subject 1) Pub/Other Trade Oldest‐Newest Total High Credit Rating for R/O/I/M/C 4 01/2001 ‐ 06/2004 3 2800 ‐ 28K 1‐One, 1‐Two, 1‐Other The following figure lists the Public Records or Other Information in our subject’s file. Note that the date that this sample file was obtained or pulled is in 2004, so the dates of current and past activity are relevant to that date. In other words, something that happened in the year 2000 was just 4 years old when this report was obtained, so it would be relevant at that time. In this example our subject was bankrupt in January, 2000 and was discharged in October, 2000. If he didn’t advise you of this information when taking his application, you must verify it with him now. Obtaining an explanation as to why he went bankrupt may be helpful in explaining the situation to your lender. Since there were nine months between our subject’s filing for bankruptcy and his being discharged it is safe to assume that this was his first bankruptcy. An individual’s first bankruptcy 334 Chapte er 14: Applicaation Analysiss – Borrower Credit e months; wh hile a second bankruptcy iss discharged after twelve is typically dischargged after nine months and a third d bankruptcy can take two o or more yeaars before a d discharge is ap pproved. Figure 78 – Equifax: Pu ublic Records [30] Public P Record ds/Other Info ormation (Sub bject 1) ptcy Superintendent : [31] Information from Bankrup Filed Tyype 01/20 000 In nd Case No/Trustee: osition: Dispo Descrription: Courtt Name Court No 472VF000022 MIN OF O ATTORNEYY GEN 22855 MOR RRIS ETAL Discharged. 10/2000 Bankrupt Ab bsolute Dischharge Liab 28000 0 Asset 480 The fo ollowing figurre displays that there is an n account in t hird party collections. Thiis indicates that our o subject ow wes an outstaanding balancce of $482 to Sears. The d description ind dicates that our su ubject disagre ees with this, which requirres you to obttain as much information on this collecction account as possible, and a then explain it to yourr lender. Figure 79 – Equifax: Co ollections [32] Collection: C Bal Reasson Rptd Type Amt A DLA NORD DON COLLECT TION, 481YC0 00036 Unpaid 48 04/20 002 82 01/200 2 482 Unkknown 04/200 Verified Date: 02 55555 SEARS S Acct/Creditor: Subject disp Descrription: putes this account Leedger Numbeer 11 111111 Su uccess Tip ‐ Collectio ons If you see a collection on yo our client’s file e, ensure thatt you ask him m or her if it has been paid an nd, if so, if he or she has prroof. If it has been paid, thhe credit bureau must be notified to haave this sectio on reflect that payment an nd a zero outsstanding balaance. The fo ollowing figurre indicates th hat our subje ect has a secu red loan with h Superior Creedit, when it was fiiled (first ope ened) and when it was to mature. m This is not derogaatory credit. Figure 80 – Equifax: Se ecured Loan [33] Secured S Loan : Filed 08/20 002 Credittor/Amt: Descrription: N o Court Name Court No Maturity CENT REG R TOR 481VC00214 12/20004 SUPERIIOR CREDIT 9 ELLIS AV TOR R 3600 Security Disposition Unknown Filed By Subject Chapte er 14: Applicaation Analysiss – Borrower Credit 33 35 ollowing figurre shows the reader that our o subject haas a judgment against him m. This also The fo requirres that the mortgage m agent ask the clie ent for clarifi cation. Figure 81 – Equifax: Ju udgment [34] Judgment : Filed 05/20 002 Defen ndant: Case No: Plainttiff: Descrription: Tyype Court Name N Cou urt No Jdggm 481VC00297 Te est File 55 5555/02 TR RANS CANADA A CREDIT Disposition Unkknown A Amt 44800 Statu us Date Vrfd d Su uccess Tip ‐ Notes All explanations from the cliient regardingg his or her credit must bee included in tthe Notes se ection of the application a be efore submisssion to a lendder. The lend der’s underwrriter will no otice negative e information n on the credit report and will ask for an n explanation n. By prroviding it witth the submisssion you will save time annd prevent co onfusion. The fo ollowing figurre is a comple ete breakdow wn of the cliennt’s current credit into trad de lines. As was seen in the Summary sectio on, our subject has 3 tradee lines. He haas a CIBC loan n (we can tell e rating – I2, where w the “I”” stands for “IInstallment” aas well as thee fact that thee this because of the description describ bes this as a Personal P Loan n). He also haas a Zellers acccount, and a TD Visa that is reported as Lost or stolen in the t status. For eaach trade line e it is indicate ed when the account a was l ast reported by the creditt grantor (RPTD D), when it waas originally opened o or cre eated (OPND)), the highest credit that th he individual has haad on that traade line (H/C)), the monthly payments oor terms (TRM MS), the curreent outstaanding balancce (BAL), any past due amounts (PDA), the current rrating (RT), ho ow many times if any that th he account haas been delinq quent thirty, sixty and ninety days (30//60/90), the MR) and finally the last daate that theree numb ber of monthss that this acccount has bee en reported (M was any a activity on n this accountt (DLA). There efore, in looking at our sub bject’s Zellers account, it caan be seen th hat it was origginally openeed on Jun ne of 2001, eight months after a he was discharged frrom his bankrruptcy. The laast payment that he h made on th his account was w in May of 2004 and he is currently u up to date. W We can see that he h has never been b late in his h payments with his Zelleers account, w while his CIBC C account hass been late several times, t and he is currently behind b on hiss payments byy one month.. 336 Chapte er 14: Applicaation Analysiss – Borrower Credit Figure 82 – Equifax: Trrade Lines [35] Trade T Informa ation (Subjecct 1) Member Trades: Bus/ID Code Rptd Opnd HC H Terms BAL CIBC (999) 999‐9999 *J 007 06/2004 04/2001 28K 4200 7BB01351 2 555 I3‐07/2 Prev Hi H Rates: 2002, I4‐06/20 002, I5‐02/20002 Accou unt: 845454 45 Descrription: Personal Loan Semi‐M Monthly Paym ments ZELLEERS 280 00 2555 *I 650DV00014 01/2004 06/2001 0 26 unt: 845555 5555 Accou Descrription: Amoun nt in H/C Column is credit llimit Monthly Payments PDA Rt 30 0/60/90 MR DLA 5555 I2 4/3/1 21 1 04/2004 R1 0/0/0 16 6 05/2004 TD VISA (999) 999‐9999 *650O ON00044 06/2004 Lo Status: ost or stolen card c 0 0/0/0 Su uccess Tip – Question ning creditt issues What W questions should you ask our subje ect about his credit probleems? The queestion that sh hould be asked is, “What caused you to miss your paayments on yo our CIBC loan n?” The an nswer must be included in the Notes se ection of the aapplication. The fo ollowing figurre provides th he percentage e of the availaable credit th hat our subjecct has used. This iss calculated by b dividing hiss balances by his high creddit, which are typically the credit limits.. Figure 83 – Equifax: Crredit Utilization [36] Credit C Utilizattion: 22% 30800 6755 ollowing figurre illustrates what w the ban nking section appears like. This is not normally found The fo on mo ost credit rep ports. Figure 84 – Equifax: Ba anking Informattion [37] Banking B (Subjject 1) Checkking/Saving: Rptd Amo ount Opnd BANQ QUE SCOTIA, 001BB05697,, (999) 999‐99 999 06/20 004 09/199 99 L5F Nb NSSF, Status: 4 NSF 2002, 2 Account No o Accoun nt Type Checkking/Saving Chapte er 14: Applicaation Analysiss – Borrower Credit 33 37 ollowing figurre will indicatte that there is i a statemennt that the consumer has aadded to his o or The fo her fille and will pro ovide that staatement. This is not norm mally seen on most credit reports, howe ever it is vital that t you checck if there is a declaration included. In this examplee it is clear thaat our su ubject has been the victim m of fraud and d therefore al l information n must be verified. Figure 85 – Equifax: Narrative [38] Consumer C Declaration (Subject 1) 06/200 Rptd, Purge: 04, 06/2005 Decla aration: *****W WARNING*** ***CONFIRMEED TRUE NAM ME FRAUD/FR RAUDULENT CREDIT APPLICATIO ONS HAVE BEEEN SUBMITTTED USING TH HIS NAME/ IF YOU ACCESS THIS FILE AS PART OF A CREDIT CHECK, PLEA ASE VERIFY WITH W THE CUSTTOMER THATT IT IS LEGITIM MATE BEFOREE EXTEN NDING CREDIT/PHONE (12 23)456‐7890 ollowing figurre indicates th hat the reporrt is completee and that theere was no more The fo inform mation available on this co onsumer. Figure 86 – Equifax: En nd of Report End Of O Report 3 Credit Scores S and Analy ysis 14.3 A cred dit report con ntains information that is kept k on an inddividual’s filee for a certain n period of time. This can difffer from province to provin nce, but in Onntario the following chart illustrates how long both Equ uifax and Tran nsunion keep specific inforrmation. Figure 87 – Compariso on between Equiifax and Transun nion: Years keptt on file Item Creditt transactionss, from the daate of last acttivity Judgm ments, from the reporting date Collecctions, from the t first date of delinquenccy Securred Loans, fro om the date opened o Bankrruptcy, from the t date of diischarge Consu umer Proposaal, from the date d satisfied Creditt Counseling, from the datte paid on file Years kept o Eq quifax Transunion 6 6 6 7 6 6 6 5 6 7 3 3 3 2 Und erstandin ng a Credi t Score The credit score is a numerical representatio on of the subjject’s currentt and past creedit and can range e between 300 0 (the lowestt score repressenting the w worst credit) and 900 (the h highest score representing the best b credit). The T credit‐sco oring model uused by Equiffax and Transsunion is based d on the FICO (Fair Isaac Co ompany) mod del in the Uniited States. Equifaax’s credit sco ore is called the Beacon Sccore while TraansUnion’s is called Empirrica Score. Fo or the le ender, the cre edit score playys a significan nt factor in thhe decision to o lend, and in determining the te erms and conditions of thaat loan. The following f figuure illustrates why this is th he case, provid ding a tabulattion of the rates of delinqu uencies basedd on an indiviidual’s credit score. 338 Chapte er 14: Applicaation Analysiss – Borrower Credit Figure 88 – Canadian Delinquency D Rattes by Beacon Score Canadian Delinquency Rates by B Beacon Sc core source: Equifa ax Canada, 2015 60% 55% 50% 40% 33% 30% 21% 20% 11% 1 10% 0% 5% 300 to 499 500 to 549 550 5 to 599 600 0 to 649 650 tto 699 2% % 700 to 749 1% 1% 750 to 79 99 800 and ove er There e are several major m items that t affect an individual’s ccredit score, aas is illustrateed by the follow wing figure. Figure 89 – Breakdown n of a Credit Sco ore Chapte er 14: Applicaation Analysiss – Borrower Credit 33 39 Item ms that afffect a Cre edit Score Paym ment History Missin ng or late payyments will haave a negativve effect on a credit score. It is importaant to ensure that all a payments are a made on or before the eir due dates,, and in the co orrect amoun nt. Any judgm ments, bankru uptcies, collecctions and oth her public reccords are con nsidered quitee serious and have a significant detrimental d im mpact on a crredit score. Amou unts Owed A goo od rule of thumb is to keep p balances below thirty‐peercent of the aavailable cred dit limit. Balances over this amount mayy lower a cred dit score. Havving several aaccounts with high balancees in relaation to the available a credit may indicate that the inndividual is reelying heavily on credit to meet his or her daily living need ds. Lengtth of Credit History H The lo onger a trade line has been n established, the higher tthe credit sco ore. Thereforre if an individual is consid dering closingg an account he h or she shoould consider closing the m most recently opene ed account. New Credit C and Inquiries Multiple inquiries can lower a credit c score. The T program can determin ne that an ind dividual is a creditt seeker. How wever, if an in ndividual is se eeking mortgaage or auto fiinancing, the program allows for a thirty‐day buffer. For F example, if an individu al applies forr a mortgage on November th a the creditt report show ws three previous inquiriess in Novembeer, the prograam will ignoree 30 , and those e three inquiriies since theyy took place within w the thirrty‐day buffer zone. In add dition, if the individual hass mortgage orr auto inquiriees on his or h her credit report outside of that thirty‐day perriod, the proggram will onlyy count them as one inquirry provided th hat they weree e within a fourteen‐day period. made Howe ever, multiple e applications for other typ pes of credit ssuch as perso onal loans and d credit cardss will lo ower an individual’s credit score. The program p also takes into acccount the len ngth of time since the last new account was opened. Typess of Credit The best mix of cre edit is a comb bination of a store s credit ccard and a maajor credit carrd such as a Visa or o MasterCard d. It is importtant not to haave too manyy, however, as the numberr of trades on n a file can negativelly impact a crredit score. Numb ber of Tradess on File Too many m credit caards and loan ns may also lo ower an indiviidual’s credit score. By haaving only a few trrade lines, an n individual’s credit c score may m be improoved. Creditt Inactivity Usingg credit responsibly is one of o the fastestt ways to incrrease a credit score. Unfortunately those e who only use cash to makke purchases can have a loower credit sccore than tho ose who regulaarly use credit. The follow wing figure pro ovides an exaample as to how a credit‐sscore might be calcullated. Althou ugh this is only part of the model that F air Isaac usess, the followin ng was disclo osed by Fair Issaac when it presented p to the Federal TTrade Commission in Wash hington, D.C. 340 Chapter 14: Application Analysis – Borrower Credit on July 22. 1999. Since the credit‐scoring models used by the credit bureaus are proprietary, and although the following chart may be modeled on them, this is only for illustration purposes and does not insinuate nor purport to be how Equifax, Transunion, or any other credit bureau determines a credit score. Figure 90 – Calculating a Credit Score Own/Rent Years at Address Occupation Own 25 Rent 15 Other 10 <.5 .5‐2.49 2.5‐6.49 12 10 15 Professional Semi‐Prof Manager 6.5‐ 10.49 19 Office 23 Blue Collar 25 No Info 13 Retired Other 31 22 44 <.5 .5‐1.49 2 8 19 25 30 39 None Dept St Maj CC Both No answer No Info 0 11 16 27 10 12 Checking Savings Other No Info 5 10 Check & Sav 20 11 9 <15 15‐25 26‐35 36‐49 50+ 22 15 12 5 0 No Info 13 0 1 2 3 4 5‐9 3 11 3 ‐7 ‐7 ‐20 Years in File <.5 0 1‐2 5 3‐4 15 5‐7 30 8+ 40 Number of Revolving Trades 0 5 1‐2 12 3‐5 8 6+ ‐4 % of Limit Used 0‐15% 15 16‐30% 5 31‐40% ‐3 41‐50% ‐10 Worst Credit No Record Department Store (DS)/ Major Credit Cards (MCC) Bank Reference Debt Ratios Number of Inquiries 0 Any Derog ‐29 28 >10.49 50 Years on job 31 No Info 17 1.5‐2.49 2.5‐5.49 5.5‐12.49 12.5 Any Slow ‐14 1 Satisf Lines 17 >50% ‐18 2 Satisf 3 Satisf Lines Lines 24 29 Retired 43 No Record 0 No Info 27 No Info 20 Chapter 14: Application Analysis – Borrower Credit 341 14.4 Key Terms and Definitions Bankruptcy A legally declared inability of an individual or organization to pay their creditors Beacon Score A numerical representation of an individual’s credit provided by Equifax Collections A debt that has been placed with a collection agency which is a company assigned to collect a debt on behalf of a third party Consumer Proposal A proposal made by a consumer debtor to his or her creditors under Division II of Part III of the Bankruptcy and Insolvency Act (BIA), with the intention being to restructure the debt. A typical proposal will result in the debtor repaying less than the full debt but more than might occur in a bankruptcy Credit The granting of a money by one party to another with an arrangement to make periodic payments to the credit grantor to retire the debt Credit Bureau An agency that collects information on individuals and provides that information to its members Credit Counseling Credit counseling involves negotiating with creditors to establish a repayment plan that will repay the borrower’s debt with more favourable terms for the borrower than are currently in place. Credit Report A report on an individual’s credit. Two types exist: one which is made available to the consumer and one which is provided to a member of a credit bureau Credit Score A numerical representation of an individual’s credit Empirica Score A numerical representation of an individual’s credit provided by Transunion Equifax A Canadian credit bureau Fair Isaac Company (FICO) Fair Isaac, founded in 1956, is a company that provides software and consulting services. Its software is used by credit bureaus to calculate credit scores Judgment A final court ruling resolving the key questions in a lawsuit and determining the rights and 342 Chapter 14: Application Analysis – Borrower Credit obligations of the opposing parties, such as the awarding of monies to an injured party Public Records Information that is available to the Canadian public. Credit bureaus include publicly available information such as bankruptcies, judgments, etc. in their credit reports Secured Loan A loan in which a borrower pledges an asset such as a car that may be sold if the borrower is unable to repay the loan. This is typically registered under the Personal Property Security Act (PPSA) Trade Line Information on a debt, found in a credit report, that contains the date that the credit was granted, the balance, terms and repayment history Transunion A Canadian credit bureau Chapte er 14: Applicaation Analysiss – Borrower Credit 34 43 14.5 5 Review w Questio ons Answers to the Revview Questio ons are found at www.REM MIC.ca Sho ort Answe er Questio ons 1. De efine the term m trade line. 2. Disscuss the item ms that are involved in calcculating a creedit score. 3. Wh hat can an ind dividual do to o increase his or her creditt score? 4. If an a individual has a judgme ent filed again nst him or herr, in what secction of a cred dit report wo ould this inforrmation be fo ound? 5. If an a individual has an account rated as an n R3 on his orr her credit reeport, what type of credit is this t rating refferring to and d how many months m in arr ears is this acccount? 6. Wh hat is the relaationship betw ween a creditt score and thhe delinquenccy rates of Caanadians? 7. Ho ow long does a bankruptcyy remain on an individual’ss credit reporrt provided byy: a) Eq quifax? b) Transunion? ow long does credit counse elling remain on an individdual’s credit rreport provideed by: 8. Ho a) Eq quifax? b) Transunion? 9. If an a individual disputes an ittem in his or her credit repport, what caan he or she d do? 10. Can a mortgagge agent provide a copy of a client’s creedit report to the client? 344 Chap pter 15: Application Analyssis – The Prop perty Ch hapter 15: 1 App plicatio on Anaalysis – The Propertyy Lea arning Outccomes Succcessful undersstanding of th he concepts presented p in tthis chapter w will enable the learner to: Describe the purpose p of an approved real estate app raisal Discuss Autom mated Valuatio on Models (A AVMs) and ris k assessmentt tools and their impact on valuing properties Explain the thrree main wayys of determinning the valuee of a property Discuss D the three main type es of appraisaal reports andd the scope o of each Intro oduction A reall estate appraaisal is a key component c in n a lender’s d ecision to len nd. There aree several purpo oses for comp pleting a real estate appraiisal, includingg to determin ne: The cost to rebu uild the home e in case of damage, such as by fire (inssurable valuee) v so that a municipalitty can apply itts property taax rate (taxation purposess) A value The price that a real estate investor would pay for a p roperty based d on his or heer preferred ratte of return (iinvestment vaalue) The amount thaat the property can obtain n if sold (sellinng price) The future value of a properrty under construction (futture price) The value of a property p being expropriate ed by the Croown (expropriiation value) The market valu ue of a prope erty for a lend der to decide on an approp priate loan am mount for ortgage financing. mo The process in determining valu ue for each re eason differs,, since the vallue will differr based on thee appraaisal’s purpose. This chaptter will focus on the appra isal process o only as it relattes to mortggage financing. 15.1 1 Apprais sal Basic cs A lend der requires an a appraisal to t be completted on a propperty to deterrmine the maarket value off that property. p In addition, a an appraisal a can provide several other piecces of vital infformation requirred to make an a informed decision d to lend. Since lennders will lend d based on a LTV, the lende er requires an exact estimaation of value to determinee the exact m mortgage amo ount availablee. The Apprais er The appraiser is the accredited individual wh ho completess the appraisaal report. Alth hough a licensse to conduct appraisals is not required in Ontario, nno lender wou uld use a non n‐accredited appraaiser since the e decision to lend will typiccally involve sseveral hundred thousand d dollars. Thee lende er must be con nfident that the t appraisal company em mploys appraissers who are educated in performing appraisals, have pro oven track reccords or are ssupervised byy senior appraaisers, follow w ethicaal standards as a set forth byy the industryy and are gennerally known n to produce q quality reporrts. Chap pter 15: Application Analyssis – The Prop perty 34 45 o list of approved appraaisal companies. These arre companies Severral lenders will have their own that they have deaalt with in the e past or who have been thhrough an ap pproval process by the lende er that typically involves asssessing the appraisal a com mpany to ensu ure that it meets the lende er’s standardss. Acc reditation ns Appra aisal Institute e of Canada (A AIC) ‐ www.aaicanada.ca In Onttario, there are several accreditations provided p by pprofessional aassociations, eeach grantingg its ow wn designation. The most widely known n and accepteed designatio ons are offereed by the Appraaisal Institute of Canada (A AIC), a professsional appraissal associatio on. The AIC provides two design nations, the AACI A and the CRA. Both de esignations hhave educatio onal requirem ments such as a university degree as a well as exp perience and continuing edducation requ uirements. Acccredited App praiser Canad dian Institute,, Professionaal Appraiser (AACI, P.App)) This designation n is the highe est designatio on provided b y the AIC. Th his designatio on certifies thaat the holder is qualified to o offer valuattion and conssulting servicees on all types of pro operties, inclu uding residen ntial, industriaal, commerciaal, and rural. The designee holds an undergraduate degree from a recognized d university annd has complleted the AAC CI program off stu udies and hass fulfilled all of o the professional require ments of the AIC. Canadian Resid dential Appraaiser (CRA) The designee ho olds an undergraduate degree from a rrecognized un niversity and has completed the AACI A program m of studies and a has fulfilleed all of the p professional rrequirementss of the AIC. The CRA is qualiffied to offer valuation v and consulting seervices and exxpertise for ind dividual, unde eveloped residential dwellling sites and dwellings containing not more than fou ur self‐contained family ho ousing units. The Canadian C Natiional Associaation of Real Estate E Appraaisers (CNAREEA) ‐ www.cnarea.ca DA AR (Designate ed Appraiser Residential) This designation n identifies a member who o is qualified to perform appraisal and consultation asssignments of residential tyype propertie es consisting oof no more th han four houssing units and d no on‐complex co ommercial properties having a residenttial component. Requirem ments for this designation include three thousand hours of full time appraisal exp perience and the successfu ul completion of the t required Canadian C Nattional Associaation of Real EEstate Appraiisers educational pro ogram or its equivalent. e DA AC (Designate ed Appraiser Commercial)) This designation n identifies a member who o is qualified to perform appraisal and consultation asssignments of all types of re eal property including i com mmercial, industrial, and in nvestment. To o atttain this desiggnation an ind dividual mustt have the DA AR designatio n, five years o of full time appraisal experience, and co omplete the required Canaadian Nationaal Association n of Real Esttate Appraise ers educational program or its equivale nt. AC (with a Spe ecialty in Agrricultural) DA This designation n identifies a member who o is qualified to perform appraisal and consultation asssignments of all types of re eal property. The requirem ments for thiss specialty incclude the DAC C designation and d the complettion of the required Canaddian National Association o of Real Estatee Ap ppraisers educcational program or its equivalent. 346 pter 15: Application Analyssis – The Prop perty Chap CM MAR (Certified Mortgage Appraisal A Revviewer) This designation n identifies a member who o is qualified to perform p professional reeviews of anyy w might be b used for m mortgage purp poses. To attaain this ressidential apprraisal report which designation an individual mu ust have a minimum of 2 yyears experien nce in the mo ortgage financing professsion and com of Real Estatee mplete the re equired Canaddian National Association o Ap ppraisers educcation prograam. CA AR (Certified Appraisal A Revviewer) This designation n identifies a member who o is qualified to perform p professional reeviews of anyy appraisal reportt. To attain th his designatio on an individuual must havee the DAR dessignation and complete the re equired Canadian National Association of Real Estate Appraisers educational pro ogram; or, be e a registered mortgage brroker, hold thhe AMP designation of CAA AMP, have 5 years mortgage e financing experience, and d complete thhe required C CNAREA education pro ogram. O Real Estate E Association ‐ www.orea.com The Ontario Ma arket Value Appraiser A – Residential De esignation (M MVA) As of July 31, 20 007 this desiggnation is no longer being offered. How wever currentt holders of the e designation n may continu ue to use it prrovided they m meet certificaation and edu ucational req quirements. The Real R Estate Institute of Can nada ‐ www.rreic.ca Fellow of the Real Estate Insstitute (FRI) s design nation for the real estate s ales professio onal, FRI exem mplifies the Canada's most senior mo ost educated and experien nced real estaate salespersoon. The Apprais al An ap ppraisal is a re eport produce ed by a design nated appraisser that determines the m market value o of an intterest in land using accepted valuation techniques bbased on the p purpose of th he appraisal for a specific s clientt. The client in most cases of morttgage financing is the lendder, although the applicant typically pays for f the appraisal report. Itt is an importtant distinctioon to make th hat the client is paying for the se ervice of the appraisal a bein ng completed d, while the leender owns th he report. eport will basse the markett value on the e lender’s speecific criteria aand include d details about The re the prroperty that the t lender maay require. In n certain circuumstances, leenders will require a different emphasiss on propertyy characteristiics, resulting in the appraisal report being acceptablle to one e lender while unacceptab ble to another. nt’s request fo or financing aand the appliccant wishes tto provide thee If a lender decliness the applican appraaisal to another lender, the e appraiser must m re‐addre ss the appraisal to the new w lender and the ne ew lender mu ust be willing to accept it. This does noot always occu ur since differrent lenders have different requirements. pter 15: Application Analyssis – The Prop perty Chap 34 47 The Value off a Prope erty It is im mportant to distinguish d be etween marke et value and pprice. Price iss what may be paid for a prope erty; howeverr there are many reasons that t the pricee paid for a prroperty may b be higher or lowerr than what so omeone else may pay for it. For exampple, if a purch haser is buying a house from a family mem mber the price e paid may be e lower than tthe price wou uld be if sold to a non‐ familyy member. In n addition, a real r estate invvestor may p ay more for a property thaat he or she believves will provid de a high retu urn on his or her h investmeent. Market Value A lend der is interestted in knowin ng what the market m will paay for a propeerty under no ormal circum mstances. Th herefore, the real estate ap ppraiser mustt appraise thee market valu ue. The marke et value can be b defined as: The amount, in Can nadian funds,, for which a property shouuld exchangee on the date of valuation betweeen a willing buyer b and a willing w seller in i an arms‐lenngth transacttion after pro oper markeeting, where the buyer and d seller have each acted knnowledgeablyy, prudently, and without pressu ure. 15.2 2 Calcula ating the Market Value V of a Property y There e are three ap pproaches thaat appraisers use to calculaate the value of a propertyy: Inccome Approach Co ost Approach Dirrect Comparisson Approach h The In ncome Appro oach The In ncome Appro oach of appraiisal calculatess the value off income prod ducing properties, such ass apartment buildinggs and other commercial properties. p TThis method takes the net operating incom me that is generated by the e property an nd applies a caapitalization rate (a rate o of return typicaal for the areaa) to that inco ome. The ressult is the pro perty’s market value. Wh hile this proce ess is ideal forr income prod ducing properrties, it holds no value in d determining tthe market value of a residenttial property for f mortgage financing. The Cost C Approach h The Cost C Approach h of appraisal calculates th he value of a pproperty baseed on the cosst of replacingg it. This method takes the cost of o rebuilding the structuree, less depreciation, plus th he cost of thee land, resulting in a final value. The T value pro oduced by thiis method is iideal for deteermining the cost of o replacing a building for insurance i purrposes but hoolds little valu ue in determining the marke et value of a residential r prroperty for mortgage finanncing. This method m is inclluded in a typ pical residential appraisal tto illustrate th placing the he cost of rep prope erty and assist in determin ning the market value; how wever it is nott heavily relieed upon in makin ng the final vaaluation of market value. D Comparison Approaach The Direct This approach a in determining th he market value of a propeerty is the mo ost appropriaate for mortggage financing and is there efore relied heavily upon i n the appraissal report. Th his method uses the t principle of substitutio on as its basis. The conceppt is that if an n appraiser kn nows the pricee 348 Chapter 15: Application Analysis – The Property that was paid for a comparable property (an appraisal typically uses three comparables) that is similar to the subject property and has recently sold in the same neighbourhood as the subject property, the subject property should have a market value equal to that comparable property. This method would be simple if not for the fact that properties are heterogeneous or unique. While two houses may be located next to each other on the same street each will have differences, from its size to such characteristics as a finished basement, the number of bedrooms and washrooms, the type of heating, appliances, and so on. Because of these differences, the appraiser must make adjustments to the sales price of the comparable property. The following example illustrates this point. Example A 2 bedroom, 2 storey home was recently sold for $400,000. An appraiser is being asked to appraise the house next to it for mortgage financing. The homeowner feels that, as the property next door sold for $400,000, his home should be worth more since he has a larger back yard. The appraiser, while using the recently sold house next door as a comparable property, must also use two other properties that are similar to the subject and have recently sold. In this case the appraiser will determine the characteristics of the comparable property and compare them to the subject property and adjust the value of the comparable property to make it more like the subject property. Once this has been completed the adjusted value of the comparable property should be approximately equal to the market value of the subject property. The following chart provides an example as to how this calculation is completed. In the left column are the characteristics of the properties. In the column to the right is the description of the subject property. The far column describes the comparable property and lists the adjustments to the value necessary to make the comparable property more like the subject property. If the comparable characteristic is superior to the subject, subtract from the comparable property’s value If the comparable characteristic is inferior to the subject, add to the comparable property’s value Note that to compare characteristics the appraiser must obtain information from several sources on both the subject and comparable properties. In calculating the adjusted value the appraiser will add the total adjustments and either add or subtract them from the sale price of the comparable property. In this example the adjustments equal ‐$15,000 ($5,000 – $20,000 + $5,000 – $5,000) and that amount is therefore subtracted from the sale price of $400,000, resulting in an adjusted value of $385,000. Therefore, based on this simplified example, the market value of the subject property should be $385,000. In an actual appraisal, the appraiser will use three comparable properties and will either average the adjusted values or rely more heavily on the most similar property to determine the market value. 34 49 Chap pter 15: Application Analyssis – The Prop perty m Item Addrress Subject Pro operty 123 Markett Street Com mparable Pro operty 1 1255 Market Streeet # of days on the market m N/A 45 Date e of Sale N/A Deccember 18, 20 007 Sale Price N/A $4000,000 Site Size in square e feet 40 x 100 35 x 100 Size Liveable Floo or Area (L.F.A A) Age//Condition 1,200 Sim milar 35 +/‐ years 15 ++/‐ years Build ding Type and d Style 2 story detached Sim milar Room ms/Bedrooms/Baths 7/3/2 7/22/2 Base ement Finished Finiished Garaage/Parking 2 car garagge/private drivve Sim milar Othe er Cen ntral Vac The subject property is superior + $5,000 ‐ $20,000 +$5,000 ‐$5,000 Totaal Adjustmentts ‐$15,000 Adju usted Value $385,000 Pau use for cla arification – The num mber of com mparabless Thre ee comparables are used in i an appraisaal. In the exa mple above o only one is sh hown, but in an actual a appraissal three similar propertiess that have reecently sold w will be compaared to the subjject property to provide th he appraiser with w enough data to makee an informed d estimate of valu ue. Autom mated Valuattion Models (AVMs) ( Autom mated Valuation Models are computer programs thaat typically usse public reco ord data on reside ential propertties to calculaate the marke et value of a pproperty. Theese models have been gainin ng in populariity throughou ut the world and a are curre ntly most oftten used by leenders and mortggage default insurers, i as well w as municipalities for deetermining vaalues for prop perty tax purpo oses. AVMs can c also be off significant be enefit to real estate appraaisers in supporting valuess calcullated in an ap ppraisal. The Municipal M Property Assessm ment Corporaation’s (MPACC) AVM and TTeranet’s “reaavs” AVM aree currently the two AVMs A availab ble in Ontario. The subject property is inferior 350 Chap pter 15: Application Analyssis – The Prop perty e AVMs can provide quick, basic properrty values, theey are not appraisals and d do not involvee While a physical inspectio on of the property. There efore, they doo not replace the real estatte appraiser o or a real estate appraaisal. They arre prone to prroducing valuues that may o or may not acctually be representative of the t subject prroperty since an AVM cannnot make adjjustments forr the physical condition of the prroperty. If a lender relies on o an AVM foor determinin ng the value ffor mortgage financcing, the lend der may open itself up for abuse. a Theree are several examples of p property frau ud where e the propertty was mortgaaged based on an AVM va lue when thee property waas in significan nt disrep pair and there efore not worrth what the AVM indicateed. This can aallow a fraudster to obtain n financcing on a prop perty in excesss of its value e, then defaullt on the morrtgage while kkeeping the fundss. More information on property and mortgage m frauud can be found in the chapter, Mortggage Fraud. While e the risk of abuse is present, the use off AVMs by lennders is increasing, partly due to the comp petitive nature e of the morttgage industryy. Lenders arre making deccisions faster than ever before to maintain n their markett share. As th his process coontinues, incrreased care sh hould be taken when relyingg on AVMs fo or mortgage le ending. Risk Assessment A Tools T Although not a valuation model, both CMHC C and Genworrth use autom mated underw writing system ms that have a component of AVMs in them. CMHCC’s ‘emili’ and d Genworth’s ‘excel’ are autom mated programs that will underwrite u an n application from a lendeer and make a decision to appro ove or decline e mortgage de efault insuran nce. Part of tthese program ms determinees whether th he prope erty value, as disclosed in the t mortgage e application, is appropriatte for the areea in which the prope erty resides. Since S there iss no physical inspection off the propertyy, the same riisks inherent in AVMs are appliccable to these e risk assessm ment tools. 15.3 3 The Typ ypes of Ap ppraisals s There e are three baasic types of appraisal a repo orts, ranging iin scope from m basic to highly detailed. Des sktop App praisal (a also refe rred to a s a Saless Data R eport) The Desktop D Appraaisal is typically used when n an AVM is uunavailable an nd the property is located in a marketable m area. This repo ort relies on MLS M reports, iincluding dataa on recent saales and dataa on reccent listings. It does not provide p detailed informatioon on the pro operty nor is tthere a physiccal inspection n of the prope erty, which raaises the sam e issues as arre applicable to AVMs. Driv ve-by App praisal This type of appraiisal is based on o the same information aas the Desktop Appraisal; h however it also in ncludes an inspection of th he exterior off the propertyy. While AVM Ms and Desktop Appraisalss canno ot provide dettails on whether the prope erty is actuallly in a physicaal condition n normal for thee neighbourhood, a Drive‐by App praisal can at least indicatee that the pro operty’s exterrior is typical or con nforms to the e neighbourho ood. In addittion the Drivee‐by Appraisal allows the aappraiser to view and a provide details d on the e neighbourho ood, which is a key elemen nt in assessin ng the marke etability of th he subject pro operty. The re eport typicallly contains exxterior photographs of thee prope erty as well ass the immediaate neighbourhood. Chap pter 15: Application Analyssis – The Prop perty 35 51 praisal resultss in the determ mination thatt the propertty appears to be in a If the Drive‐by App condition that is no ot typical of the t neighbourhood, a Full Appraisal sho ould be comp pleted. Full Appraisa al A Full Appraisal expands on the e information and techniquues used in th he Sales Data Appraisal and the Drive‐by Appraaisal by having a full inspecction of the ssubject propeerty completeed. This inspection allows the t appraiser to documentt the characteeristics of thee subject prop perty, includ ding any upgrrades or defeccts in the hom me. The repoort typically co ontains interiior and exteriior photograp phs of the pro operty as well as the immeediate neighb bourhood. Co onsidered to offer the most info ormation and therefore the highest leveel of protection for the len nder, the Full Appraaisal is the appraisal of cho oice for lende ers who rely hheavily on thee property as security and less on o the personal covenant of o the borrow wer. Virtually every sub‐prrime and privaate lender wiill insist on a Full App praisal. The fo ollowing figurres are examp ples of a Drive e‐by Appraisaal report and a Full Appraisal report. They illustrate the differences in the levels of o detail contaained in the ttwo types of rreports. 352 Chapter 15: Application Analysis – The Property Figure 91 – Drive‐By Appraisal Report Drive‐by Appraisal Report RESIDENTIAL APPRAISAL REPORT "DRIVE‐BY" FORM Client Ref. #: ................................................. File #: ............................................................. Client: .......................................................... Address of Property: ................................................... Appraiser: ....................................................... Attention: .................................................... ..................................................................................... Company: ....................................................... Address: ....................................................... ..................................................................................... Address: ......................................................... .............................................................. ..................................................................................... ........................................................................ E‐mail: .......................................................... ..................................................................................... E‐mail: ............................................................ Phone: .......................................................... Province: ..................................................................... Phone: ............................................................ Fax: .......................................... Postal Code: .............................................................................. Fax: Applicant Name: .................................................................................................................................................................................................................. PROPERTY & NEIGHBOURHOOD DATA LEGAL DESCRIPTION: .......................................................................................................................................................................................................... MUNICIPALITY AND DISTRICT: ........................................................................................................................................................................................... ASSESSMENT: LAND $ ............................. IMP $ ................... TOTAL $ .......................... year ................. TAXES $ ................ year .............. PURPOSE OF APPRAISAL: To estimate market value or Other (describe) .................................................................................................... INTENDED USE OF APPRAISAL: ........................................................................................................................................................................................... PROPERTY RIGHTS APPRAISED: Fee Simple Leasehold Condominium Cooperative Other ....................... Is the subject a fractional interest, physical segment or partial holding? No Yes (If yes, see comments elsewhere in this report) OCCUPIED BY: Owner Tenant Vacant HIGHEST AND BEST USE: As improved or Other (describe) ................................................................................ Note: If Highest and Best Use is not the current use, or not the use reflected in the report, see comments attached. NATURE OF DISTRICT TREND OF DISTRICT CONFORMITY OF SUBJECT SUPPLY Residential Improving AGE: SIZE: Good Fair Poor Rural Stable Newer Larger Commercial/Industrial Transition Older Smaller DEMAND Mixed Deteriorating Good Fair Poor Similar Similar Other Other AVERAGE PROPERTY AGE: DISTANCE TO: PRICE RANGE OF PROPERTIES: DISTRICT Elem.School .............. Jr. Secondary ............... IN GENERAL DISTRICT ................ to Years High School ............... Downtown .................. $ ................ to $ IMMEDIATE AREA Public Trans. .............. Shopping Fac. .............. IN IMMEDIATE AREA ................ to Years Other ................................................................ $ ................ to $ SUMMARY: Includes market appeal, apparent adverse influences in area, if any (e.g. railroad tracks, unkempt properties, major traffic arteries, hydro facilities, anticipated public or private improvements, commercial/industrial sites, landfill sites, etc.) SUBJECT PROPERTY DESCRIPTION ZONING DES'N: ............ SIZE DIMS: ................................ SITE AREA: .......................... TOPOGRAPHY: PRESENT USE: ........................................................................................... DOES IT CONFORM? Yes No (see comments) ESTIMATED AGE OF SUBJECT: ...................... Years PARKING: Garage Carport Driveway CURB APPEAL: Good Average Fair Poor EXTERIOR CONDITION: Good Average Fair Poor EXTERIOR FINISH: ROOFING MATERIAL: Brick Veneer Solid Brick Insulbrick Asphalt Shingle Wood Shingle Tar & Gravel Stone Veneer Solid Stone Stucco Slate Metal Other Wood Siding Aluminum Siding Vinyl Siding ..................................................................................................................... Other .............................................................................................................................................................................................................................. COMMENTS: ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................... COMPARABLE SALES DATA ITEM Address MLS Listing #/(if applicable) Days on Market Date of Sale Sale Price Site Size Size L.F.A. Age / Condition Building Type & Style Rooms / Bedrooms / Baths Basement Garage / Parking Other SUBJECT PROPERTY NO. 1 NO. 2 NO. 3 / / / / / / / / / / / / Reconciliation/Conclusions: ................................................................................................................................................................................................ Chapter 15: Application Analysis – The Property 353 History and analysis of known current Agreements for Sale, prior sales, options, listings or marketing of the Subject in the past year. Indicated Exposure Time of Similar Properties in the Area: Under 3 months 3‐6 months Over 6 months This appraisal report represents the following value (if not current, see comments): Current Retrospective Prospective Update of report completed RESIDENTIAL APPRAISAL REPORT "DRIVE‐BY" FORM (Cont'd) PURPOSE, SCOPE, DISCLOSURES & DEFINITIONS PURPOSE OF THE APPRAISAL: This "drive‐by" report has been prepared for mortgage lending purposes for the exclusive use of the client and other intended users named. The client is aware that, as the degree of departure from a full appraisal report increases, there is a corresponding decrease in the level of reliability of the report, resulting in a higher level of risk for the user of the report. Due to the limitations of this reporting method, it is not intended for use by third parties and liability to any unintended users is expressly denied. The appraiser assumes diligence by all intended users. SCOPE OF THE REPORT 1. The client has specifically requested a "drive‐by" appraisal to be reported in an abbreviated report format. The Appraiser has been requested to perform an exterior inspection and not to disturb the occupants by entering the building. Both the client and the appraiser understands that NEITHER A PYSICAL INSPECTION OF THE INTERIOR OF THE SUBJECT PROPERTY NOR A STREET INSPECTION OF THE COMPARIABLES HAS BEEN PERFORMED (unless stated herein). 2. It is acknowledged by both parties that a subsequent physical inspection of the subject property and/or a more in‐depth investigation could result in a different conclusion. 3. The physical characteristics used to develop this appraisal are based on documents, records, etc. described below and on other information provided by sources identified below. The subject property was observed only from the public street and it is assumed that the information provided by the sources is accurate. Comments (on the efforts taken to obtain, and the source of, interior and exterior inspection information): ........................................................................................................................................................... 4. Sales and listing information of physically similar properties has been obtained from sources assumed to be reliable and accurate, and/or on information from the appraiser's files. 5. Neither the Income nor the Cost Approaches to value are appropriate methods of valuation for this assignment, considering the limited scope of the type of appraisal requested by the client, and therefore have not been completed. 6. Sales information on physically similar properties has been gathered and analyzed on the assumption that both the interior and exterior condition of the subject property are in average or typical condition for its age and that there are no physical or functional conditions associated with the property that would adversely affect the conclusions contained in this report, unless otherwise stipulated. It is assumed that the subject property is in 100% complete condition unless otherwise stated and the value range contained herein is based on this assumption. OTHER DISCLOSURES, COMMENTS, ETC.: .......................................................................................................................................................................................................................... DEFINITION OF MARKET VALUE The most probable price that a property should bring in a competitive and open market under all conditions requisite to a fair sale, the buyer and seller each acting prudently and knowledgeably and assuming the price is not affected by undue stimulus. Note: If other than market value is being appraised, see comments attached. DEFINITION OF HIGHEST AND BEST USE The reasonably probable and legal use of the property, that is physically possible, appropriately supported, and financially feasible, and that results in the highest value. ASSUMPTIONS AND LIMITING CONDITIONS The certification that appears in the "drive‐by" residential appraisal report is subject to the following conditions: 1. The appraiser will not be responsible for matters of a legal nature that affect either the property being appraised or the title to it. No registry office search has been performed and the appraiser assumes the title is good and marketable and free and clear of all encumbrances, including leases, unless otherwise noted in this report. The property is appraised on the basis of it being under responsible ownership. 2. Because market conditions change rapidly and, on occasion, without warning, the estimated market value range expressed as of the date of this appraisal cannot be relied upon as of any other date except with further advice from the appraiser confirmed in writing. 3. The subject property is presumed to comply with government regulations including zoning, building codes and health regulations and, if it doesn't comply, its non‐ compliance may affect market value. 4. The appraiser will not give testimony or appear in court concerning this appraisal unless required to do so by due process of law. 5. The appraiser has noted in this report any readily apparent adverse conditions that were observed during the street inspection of the subject property or that he or she became aware of during the normal research involved in performing this type of appraisal. 6. Unless otherwise stated in this report, the appraiser has no knowledge of any hidden or unapparent conditions of the property or adverse environmental conditions that would make the property more or less valuable and has assumed that there are no such conditions and makes no guarantees or warranties, express or implied, regarding the condition of the property. The appraiser will not be responsible for any such conditions that do exist or for any engineering or testing that might be required to discover whether such conditions exist. Because the appraiser is not an expert in the field of environmental hazards, this drive‐by appraisal report must not be considered as an environmental assessment of the property. The bearing capacity of the soil is assumed to be adequate. 7. The appraiser obtained information, estimates and opinions that were used in this report from sources considered to be reliable and accurate and believes them to be true and correct. The appraiser does not assume responsibility for the accuracy of items that were furnished by other parties. 8. The appraiser will not disclose the contents of this report except as provided for by the provisions of the Canadian Uniform Standards of Professional Appraisal Practice ("the Standards"). 9. The appraiser has agreed to enter into the assignment as requested by the client named in the report for the use specified by the client, which is stated in the report, which calls for things that are different from the work that would otherwise be required by the Standards. As this is a "drive‐by" appraisal, only limited inspections have been undertaken (Extraordinary Limiting Condition). The client has agreed that the performance of this limited scope appraisal and the "drive‐by" report format are appropriate for the intended use. 10. Written consent from the author and supervisory appraiser, if applicable, must be obtained before any part of the appraisal report can be used for any purpose by anyone except the client and other intended users identified in the report and, where the client is the mortgagee, its insurer and the borrower, if he or she paid the appraisal fee. Written consent and approval must also be obtained before any part of the appraisal can be altered or conveyed to other parties, including mortgages other than the client and the public through prospectus, offering memoranda, advertising, public relations, news, sales or other media. 11. Other (including any other Extraordinary Assumptions and Limiting Conditions involved in this appraisal): CERTIFICATION I certify that, to the best of my knowledge and belief: 1. The statements of fact contained in this report are true and correct. 2. The reported analyses, options and conclusions are limited only by the reported assumptions and limiting conditions and are my personal, impartial and unbiased professional analyses, opinions and conclusions. 3. I have no past, present or prospective interest in the property that is the subject of this report and I have no personal interest or bias with respect to the parties involved. 4. My compensation is not contingent upon developing or reporting a predetermined result, value range or direction in value range that favours the cause of the client, the amount of the estimated value range, the attainment of a stipulated result or the occurrence of a subsequent event. 5. My analyses, opinions and conclusions were developed and this report has been prepared, in conformity with the Canadian Uniform Standards of Professional Appraisal Practice. Please note the Extraordinary Limiting Condition above, indicating the property was not inspected. 6. I have the knowledge and experience to complete this assignment competently. Except as herein disclosed, no other person has provided me with significant professional assistance in the completion of this appraisal assignment. 7. The Appraisal Institute of Canada has a mandatory Recertification Program for designated members. As at the date of this report, the requirements of this program have been fulfilled. SUPERVISORY APPRAISER'S CERTIFICATION: If a supervisory appraiser has signed this appraisal report, he or she certifies and agrees that "I directly supervised the appraiser who prepared this appraisal report and, having reviewed the report, agree with the statements and conclusions of the appraiser, agree to be bound by the appraiser's certification and am taking full responsibility for the appraisal and the appraisal report.” PROPERTY IDENTIFICATION: Address: ...................................................................... City: ..................................... Province: .................................. Postal Code: ..................... Legal Description: ............................................................................................................................................................................................................... AS A RESULT OF MY APPRAISAL AND ANALYSIS OF ALL APPLICABLE DATA AND RELEVANT FACTORS THERETO, IT IS MY OPINION THAT THE SUBJECT PROPERTY IS ESTIMATED TO HAVE A VALUE RANGE OF 354 From $ As at Chapter 15: Application Analysis – The Property ...................................................................................................... To $ ..................................................................................................................................... (Effective Date of the Appraisal) APPRAISER: Signature: ...................................................................................................... Name: ...................................................................................................... Designation: .................................................................................................. Date signed: .................................................................................................. License Info (where applicable): ................................................................... NOTE: For this appraisal to be valid, an original or EDI signature is required. SUPERVISORY APPRAISER: (if applicable) Signature: ........................................................................................................................... Name: ................................................................................................................................. Designation: ....................................................................................................................... Date signed: ....................................................................................................................... License Info (where applicable): ......................................................................................... Chapter 15: Application Analysis – The Property 355 Figure 92 – Full Appraisal Report Full Appraisal Report RESIDENTIAL APPRAISAL REPORT "FULL" FORM Client Ref. #: .............................................................. ...................................................................................................... File #: ............................................................................ Client: ........................................................................ Address of Property: ................................................................... Appraiser: ...................................................................... Attention: .................................................................. ...................................................................................................... Company: ..................................................................... Address: ..................................................................... ...................................................................................................... Address: ........................................................................ ........................................................................... ...................................................................................................... ....................................................................................... E‐mail: ....................................................................... ...................................................................................................... E‐mail: .......................................................................... Phone: ....................................................................... Province: ..................................................................................... Phone: .......................................................................... Fax: ...................................................... Postal Code: ............................................................................................... Fax: Applicant Name: ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. These sections are the same as the Drive‐by MUNICIPALITY AND DISTRICT: .......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... ASSESSMENT: LAND $ ......................................... IMP $ ......................... TOTAL $ ................................. year ...................... TAXES $ ...................... year ................... appraisal year ................................................................... PROPERTY & NEIGHBOURHOOD DATA LEGAL DESCRIPTION: ......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... PURPOSE OF APPRAISAL: To estimate market value or Other (describe) ...................................................................................................................................... INTENDED USE OF APPRAISAL: Financing or Other (describe) ............................................................................................................................................................................. PROPERTY RIGHTS APPRAISED: Fee Simple Leasehold Condominium Cooperative Other (describe) ............................... Is the subject a fractional interest, physical segment or partial holding? No Yes (If yes, see comments elsewhere in this report) OCCUPIED BY: Owner Tenant Vacant HIGHEST AND BEST USE: As improved or Other (describe) ....................................................................................................... Note: If Highest and Best Use is not the current use, or not the use reflected in the report, see comments attached. NATURE OF DISTRICT TREND OF DISTRICT CONFORMITY OF SUBJECT ESTIMATED AGE OF SUBJECT AVERAGE PROPERTY AGE Residential Improving AGE: Years Rural Stable Newer Older Similar DISTRICT: Commercial/Industrial Transition CONDITION: SUPPLY …… to ………. years Mixed Deteriorating Newer Older Similar Good Fair Poor SIZE: IMMEDIATE AREA: Comments .............................. Other Larger Smaller Similar DEMAND …… to ………. years Good Fair Poor AREA BUILT UP Comments: ........................................... ………………. % DISTANCE TO: PRICE RANGE OF PROPERTIES: Elementary School ........................................ Jr. Secondary .................................................... IN GENERAL DISTRICT High School .................................................... Downtown ........................................................ $ ..................... to $ Public Transportation. ................................... Shopping Facilities ............................................ IN IMMEDIATE AREA Other ............................................................. $ ..................... to $ SUMMARY: Includes market appeal, apparent adverse influences in area, if any (e.g. railroad tracks, unkempt properties, major traffic arteries, hydro facilities, anticipated public or private improvements, commercial/industrial sites, landfill sites, etc.) ........................................................................................................................................................................ SITE DESCRIPTION SITE DIMENSIONS: ............................................................................ SITE AREA: ..................................................... CONFIGURATION: .............................................................. TOPOGRAPHY: .................................................................................. FEATURES: UTILITIES: DRIVEWAY: Paved Road Gravel Road Telephone Communal Well Private Concrete Sidewalk Curbs Natural Gas Sanitary Sewer Mutual Stone Street Lights Cablevision Propane Septic System Single Asphalt Comments: .......................... Municipal Water Storm Sewer Double Gravel Private Well Open Ditch None Other ........................ Comments: .................... PARKING: ELECTRICAL: LANDSCAPING: Garage Carport Underground Overhead Excellent Good Driveway None Other ........................ Average Fair Other Poor None CURB APPEAL: EASEMENTS: Excellent Good Average Utility Access Fair Poor Other ........................................................................ ZONING: ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................. PRESENT USE: ............................................................................................... DOES IT CONFORM TO CURRENT ZONING? Yes No (see comments) COMMENTS: (Includes any positive and negative features such as conformity with zoning, effects of known easements, known restrictions on title, such as judgments or liens, effects of assemblage, any known documentation of environmental contamination, etc.) These sections are much more detailed than the Drive‐by appraisal DESCRIPTION OF IMPROVEMENTS ‐ EXTERIOR Year Built (est'd): ................................................................... Effective Age: .......................................... Remaining Economic Life (est'd): ............................................. Construction Complete: ........................................................ Percentage Complete: ............................................................................................................................................ Holdback Recommended: Yes No ............ Comments: ............................................................................................................................................................................................ FLOOR AREA: BASEMENT: DESIGN: EXTERIOR FINISH: Source .................................................. Full One Storey 1 ‐ 1 1/2 Storey Brick Veneer Main ..................................................... Partial Split Level 2 Storey Solid Brick Second .................................................. Crawl Space Stone Veneer Third ..................................................... Total Area: ............................................. Other: ..................................................... Solid Stone Total ..................................................... Sq. M. …….... Sq. Ft. .............................. Stucco Sq. M …..….. Sq. Ft. .............................. ROOFING: Wood siding TYPE OF BUILDING: Asphalt Shingle Aluminum Siding CONSTRUCTION: Detached Wood Shingle Vinyl Siding Wood Frame Semi‐detached Tar & Gravel Insulbrick Brick Row/Townhouse Metal Other ..................................................... Stone Apartment Other ....................................................... Concrete Other ..................................................... Approx. Age. ........................................... Other .................................................... Source: .................................................... 356 Chapter 15: Application Analysis – The Property WINDOW SASH/GLAZING: UFFI APPARENT: OVERALL EXTERIOR CONDITION: No Good Average Yes ................................................ Below Average Poor Comments: ......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... RESIDENTIAL APPRAISAL REPORT DESCRIPTION OF IMPROVEMENTS ‐ INTERIOR WALLS: CEILINGS: ......................................................... FOUNDATION WALLS: Poured Concrete Concrete Block Concrete Slab Brick/Stone BATHROOMS (#): ……. 2‐pc. …….3‐pc. …….4‐pc. …….5‐pc. INSULATION: Ceiling Basement Walls Crawlspace Other ........................................................ PLUMBING LINES: Copper PVC/Plastic Galvanized ABS FLOORING: W‐W Carpet Sheet Vinyl Softwood Vinyl Tile Hardwood Ceramic Linoleum Other ....................................................... ELECTRICAL: Fuses Breakers Comments: ............................................... FLOOR PLAN: Good Average Good Average Poor Custom Fair Poor "FULL" FORM (Cont'd) FINISH: Drywall Plaster Paneling Other ................................................... OVERALL INTERIOR COND: Good Fair Average Poor HEATING: Forced Air Baseboard Hot Water Other ........................................................ Fuel Type ................................................. WATER HEATER: Gas Electric Other ........................................................ BUILT‐INS & EXTRA FEATURES: Garbage Disposal Oven Dishwasher Stove Central Air Air Cleaner Vacuum Whirlpool Swimming Pool Sauna Solarium Skylights Fireplace(s) Garage Opener Security System Other ........................................................ BEDROOMS (#): ……. Large ……. Average CLOSETS: Good Average ……. Small Fair Poor Rated capacity of main panel: Amps These sections provide much GARAGES/CARPORTS: ....................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... more detail than DECKS, PATIOS, OTHER IMPROVEMENTS: ........................................................................................................................................................................................................................ .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... the Drive‐by COMMENTS (Building, appearance, quality, condition, services, extras, anticipated public or private improvements, etc.): ........................................................................................ appraisal BASEMENT FINISHES, UTILITY: .......................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... ROOM ALLOCATION MAIN Total Rooms Entrance Living Dining Kitchen Full Bath Part Bath Bedroom Family Laundry Others SECOND THIRD BASEMENT COST APPROACH Source of Cost Data: Land Value ................... Building ........................ Cost . @ $ Garage ......................... Basement Finish .......... Manual Cost New: $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ Other Extras ................. Total Replacement Cost Contractor Other $ Depreciated Cost: $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ ............................. The cost approach is included Less: Accrued Dep. ….% Indicated Value ............ VALUE BY COST APPROACH (rounded) $ NOTE: The construction cost estimates contained herein were not prepared for insurance purposes and are invalid for that use. The Cost Approach is not applicable when appraising strata type dwelling units. DIRECT COMPARISON APPROACH ITEM SUBJECT PROPERTY NO. 1 Desc. Adjmt. NO. 2 Desc. Adjmt. NO. 3 Desc. Adjmt. Address MLS Listing # (if applicable) # of Days on Market Date of Sale Sale Price Site Size Size L.F.A. Age / Condition Building Type & Style Rooms / Bedrooms / Baths Basement Garage / Parking Other / / / / / / / / / / / / / / / Adjusted Values Reconciliation/Conclusions: ............................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... VALUE BY THE DIRECT COMPARISON APPROACH (rounded): $ ....................................................................................................................................................................................... FINAL ESTIMATE OF VALUE/COMMENT ON REASONABLE EXPOSURE TIME: ................................................................................................................................................................ Chapter 15: Application Analysis – The Property 357 History and analysis of known current Agreements for Sale, prior sales, options, listings or marketing of the Subject in the past year: (Including sources of the data and information): ............................................................................................................................................................... . This appraisal report represents the following value (if not current, see comments): Current Retrospective Prospective Update of report completed ........................................................................................................................................................................................... RESIDENTIAL APPRAISAL REPORT "FULL" FORM (Cont'd) SCOPE OF THE REPORT, DISCLOSURES & DEFINITIONS SCOPE OF THE REPORT: The scope of the appraisal encompasses the due diligence undertaken by the appraiser (consistent with the terms of reference from the client, the purpose and intended use of the report) and the necessary research and analysis to prepare a report in accordance with the Canadian Uniform Standards of Professional Appraisal Practice of the Appraisal Institute of Canada. The following comments describe the extent of the process of collecting, confirming and reporting data and its analysis, describe relevant procedures and reasoning details supporting the analysis, and provide the reason for the exclusion of any usual valuation procedures. DEFINITION OF MARKET VALUE The most probable price that a property should bring in a competitive and open market under all conditions requisite to a fair sale, the buyer and seller each acting prudently and knowledgeably and assuming the price is not affected by undue stimulus. Note: If other than market value is being appraised, see comments attached. DEFINITION OF HIGHEST AND BEST USE The reasonably probable and legal use of the property, that is physically possible, appropriately supported, and financially feasible, and that results in the highest value. ASSUMPTIONS AND LIMITING CONDITIONS The certification that appears in the appraisal report is subject to the following conditions: ORDINARY ASSUMPTIONS & LIMITING CONDITIONS 1. The report is prepared at the request of the client and for the specific use referred to herein. It is not reasonable for any other party to rely on this appraisal without first obtaining written authorization from the client, the author or any supervisory appraiser, subject to the qualification in paragraph 10 below. Liability to any person other than the client, designated intended users and those who obtain written consent is expressly denied and, accordingly, no responsibility is accepted for any damage suffered by any such person as a result of decision made or actions based on this report. Diligence by all intended users is assumed. 2. Because market condition, including economic, social and political factors, change rapidly and, on occasion, without warning, the market value estimate expressed as of the date of this appraisal cannot be relied upon as of any other date except with further advice from the appraiser confirmed in writing. 3. The appraiser will not be responsible for matters of a legal nature that affect either the property being appraised or the title to it. No registry office search has been performed and the appraiser assumes the title is good and marketable and free and clear of all encumbrances, including leases, unless otherwise noted in this report. The property is appraised on the basis of it being under responsible ownership. 4. The subject property is presumed to comply with government regulations including zoning, building codes and health regulations and, if it doesn't comply, its non‐ compliance may affect market value. 5. No survey of the property has been made. Any sketch in the appraisal report shows approximate dimensions and is included only to assist the reader of the report in visualizing the property. 6. This report is completed on the basis that testimony or appearance in court concerning this appraisal is not required unless specific arrangements to do so have been made before hand. Such arrangements will include, but not necessarily be limited to, adequate time to review the appraisal report and data related thereto and the provision of appropriate comparisons. 7. Unless otherwise stated in this report, the appraiser has no knowledge of any hidden or unapparent conditions of the property (including but not limited to, its soils, physical structure, mechanical or other operating systems, its foundation, etc.) or adverse environmental conditions (on it or a neighbouring property, including the presence of hazardous wastes, toxic substances, etc.) that would make the property more or less valuable. It has been assumed that there are no such conditions unless they were observed at the time of inspection or became apparent during the normal research involved in completing the appraisal. This report should not be construed as an environmental audit or detailed property condition report, as such reporting is beyond the scope of this report and/or the qualifications of the appraiser. The author makes no guarantees or warranties, express or implied, regarding the condition of the property and will not be responsible for any such conditions that do exist or for any engineering or testing that might be required to discover whether such conditions exist. 8. The appraiser obtained information, estimates and opinions that were used in this report from sources considered to be reliable and accurate and believes them to be true and correct. The appraiser does not assume responsibility for the accuracy of items that were furnished by other parties. 9. The opinions of value and other conclusions contained herein assume satisfactory completion of any work remaining to be completed in a good and workmanlike manner. Further inspection may be required to confirm completion of such work. 10. The content of this report are confidential and will not be disclosed by the author to any party except as provided for by the provisions of the Canadian Uniform Standards of Professional Appraisal Practice ("the Standards") and/or when properly entered into evidence of a duly qualified judicial or quasi‐judicial body. 11. The appraiser has agreed to enter into the assignment as requested by the client named in the report for the use specified by the client, which is stated in the report. The client has agreed that the performance of this appraisal and the report format are appropriate for the intended use. 12. Written consent from the author and supervisory appraiser, if applicable, must be obtained before any part of the appraisal report can be used for any purpose by anyone except the client and other intended users identified in the report and, where the client is the mortgagee, its insurer and the borrower, if he or she paid the appraisal fee. Written consent and approval must also be obtained before the appraisal (or any part of it) can be altered or conveyed to other parties, including mortgages other than the client and the public through prospectus, offering memoranda, advertising, public relations, news, sales or other media. 13. Other (including any other Extraordinary Assumptions and Limiting Conditions involved in this appraisal): 358 Chapter 15: Application Analysis – The Property RESIDENTIAL APPRAISAL REPORT "FULL" FORM (Cont'd) EXTRAORDINARY ASSUMPTIONS & LIMITING CONDITIONS: An extraordinary assumption is a hypothesis either supposed or unconfirmed, which, if not true, could alter the appraiser's opinions and conclusions (e.g. an absence of contamination where such contamination is possible, the presence of a municipal sanitary sewer where unknown or uncertain). An extraordinary limiting condition is a necessary modification or exclusion of a Standard Rule, which must be explained, justified by the appraiser (e.g. exclusion of a relevant valuation approach). The appraiser must conclude before accepting the assignment which involves invoking an Extraordinary Limiting Condition that the scope of the work applied will result in opinions and conclusions which are credible. Both must accompany statements of each opinion/conclusion so affected. HYPOTHETICAL CONDITIONS: Hypothetical conditions may be used when they are required for legal purpose, for purposes of reasonable analysis or for purposes of comparison. Common hypothetical conditions include proposed improvements and prospective appraisals. For every Hypothetical Condition, an Extraordinary Assumption is required (see above). An analysis based on a hypothetical condition must not result in an appraisal report that is misleading or that relies on actions or events that would be illegal or improbable within the context of the assignment. Following is a description of each hypothetical condition applied to this report, the rationale for its use and its effect on the result of the assignment. JURISDICTIONAL EXCEPTION: The Jurisdictional Exception permits the appraiser to disregard a part or parts of the Standards determined to be contrary to law or public policy in a given jurisdiction and only that part shall be void and of no force or effect in that jurisdiction. The following comments identify the part or parts disregarded, if any, and the legal authority justifying these actions. CERTIFICATION I certify that, to the best of my knowledge and belief: 1. The statements of fact contained in this report are true and correct. 2. The reported analyses, opinions and conclusions are limited only by the reported assumptions and limiting conditions and are my personal, impartial and unbiased professional analyses, opinions and conclusions. 3. I have no past, present or prospective interest in the property that is the subject of this report and I have no personal interest or bias with respect to the parties involved with this assignment, except as specified herein. 4. My engagement in this assignment is not contingent upon developing or reporting a predetermined result, upon the amount of value estimate, upon a direction in value that favours the cause of the client, upon the attainment of a stipulated result or the occurrence of a subsequent event. 5. My analyses, opinions and conclusions were developed and this report has been prepared, in conformity with the Canadian Uniform Standards of Professional Appraisal Practice. 6. I have the knowledge and experience to complete this assignment competently. Except as herein disclosed, no other person has provided me with significant professional assistance in the completion of this appraisal assignment. 7. The Appraisal Institute of Canada has a mandatory Recertification Program for designated members. As at the date of this report, the requirements of this program have been fulfilled. SUPERVISORY APPRAISER'S CERTIFICATION: If a supervisory appraiser has signed this appraisal report, he or she certifies and agrees that "I directly supervised the appraiser who prepared this appraisal report and, having reviewed the report, agree with the statements and conclusions of the appraiser, agree to be bound by the appraiser's certification and am taking full responsibility for the appraisal and the appraisal report.” PROPERTY INDENTIFICATION: Address: ...................................................................... City: ..................................... Province: .................................. Postal Code: ..................... Legal Description: ............................................................................................................................................................................................................... AS A RESULT OF MY APPRAISAL AND ANALYSIS OF ALL APPLICABLE DATA AND RELEVANT FACTORS THERETO, IT IS MY CONCLUSION THAT THE MARKET VALUE OF THE INTEREST IN THE SUBJECT PROPERTY DESCRIBED IS: $ .................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... At (Effective Date of the Appraisal) APPRAISER: Signature: ...................................................................................................... Name: ...................................................................................................... Designation: .................................................................................................. Date signed: .................................................................................................. License Info (where applicable): ................................................................... SUPERVISORY APPRAISER: (if applicable) Signature: ........................................................................................................................... Name: ................................................................................................................................. Designation: ....................................................................................................................... Date signed: ....................................................................................................................... License Info (where applicable): ......................................................................................... NOTE: For this appraisal to be valid, an original or EDI signature is required. ATTACHMENTS: Photo Addendum Other Additional Sales Map Addendum ............................................... Other Sketch Addendum Assumptions / Limiting Conditions ..................................................... Other Narrative Addendum Chapter 15: Application Analysis – The Property 359 SUBJECT PHOTO PAGE LENDER/CLIENT: ................................................ ADDRESS OF PROPERTY APPRAISER: ........................................................ ADDRESS: .......................................................... ADDRESS: .......................................................... TEL: ( TEL: ( ) ......................................................... ) ........................................................ Subject Front PHOTO Sale Price: ...................................................................................... Livable Floor Area: ........................................................................ Total Rooms: ................................................................................ Total Bedrooms: ........................................................................... Total Bathrooms: .......................................................................... Site: .............................................................................................. Age: .............................................................................................. Subject Rear PHOTO Subject Street PHOTO 360 Chapter 15: Application Analysis – The Property 15.4 Key Terms and Definitions Accredited Appraiser Canadian Institute, Professional Appraiser (AACI, P.App) The highest designation awarded to an appraiser of the Appraisal Institute of Canada Adjusted Value The value of a comparable property after the appraiser has made adjustments by comparing the comparable property to the subject property Adjustments The amount, in dollars, of characteristics which differentiate between a comparable property and a subject property Appraisal A report produced by a designated appraiser that determines the market value of an interest in land using accepted valuation techniques based on the purpose of the appraisal for a specific client Appraisal Institute of Canada (AIC) A national professional organization that designates and represents professional real estate appraisers and valuation consultants nationwide Appraiser The accredited individual who completes the appraisal report. Only reports from accredited appraisers are acceptable in the mortgage industry. Automated Valuation Model (AVM) A computer program that typically uses public record data on residential properties to calculate the market value of a property Canadian National Association of Real Estate Appraisers (CNAREA) A national, not for profit, independent association that certifies and regulates real property appraisers in Canada Canadian Real Estate Association (CREA) One of Canada's largest single‐industry trade associations, representing more than 92,000 real estate brokers/agents and agents working through more than 100 real estate Boards and Associations Canadian Residential Appraiser (CRA) A designation awarded to an appraiser by the Appraisal Institute of Canada Cost Approach An approach to calculating the value of a property by determining the replacement cost of a building, less depreciation plus the cost of the land Desktop Appraisal (also referred to as a Sales Data Report) A type of appraisal report that determines a value for the subject property based on MLS reports, including data on recent sales and data on recent listings Chapter 15: Application Analysis – The Property 361 Direct Comparison Approach An approach to calculating the value of a property by comparing it to similar properties that have recently sold Drive‐by Appraisal A type of appraisal report that combines MLS data as well as an inspection of the exterior of the subject property emili CMHC’s automated underwriting system excel Genworth Financial’s automated underwriting system Full Appraisal A type of appraisal report that combines MLS data with a full interior and exterior inspection of the subject property Income Approach An approach to calculating the value of an income producing property through the usage of the net operating income and capitalization rate typical for that type of property and the area in which it is located Market Value The amount, in Canadian funds, for which a property should exchange on the date of valuation between a willing buyer and a willing seller in an arms‐length transaction after proper marketing, where the buyer and seller have each acted knowledgably, prudently, and without pressure Real Estate Institute of Canada (REIC) An association of professionals that has been providing advanced real estate education and certifying specialists in real estate since 1955 Risk Assessment Tool An automated underwriting program 362 Chap pter 15: Application Analyssis – The Prop perty 15.5 5 Review w Questio ons Answers to the Revview Questio ons are found at www.REM MIC.ca Sho ort Answe er Questio ons 1. Lisst the differen nt purposes fo or which an appraisal a mighht be required. 2. Wh hat is the role e of the appraaiser in the ap ppraisal proceess? 3. Wh hat organizattions award designations to appraisers?? 4. Wh hat are the diifferent desiggnations that an appraiser may have? ow does markket value diffe er from the price for whichh a property m may be sold? 5. Ho 6. Disscuss the thre ee approache es to calculating the markeet value of a p property and describe the mo ost relevant approach a for mortgage finaancing. e made in the e direct compparison appro oach. 7. Explain how adjjustments are 8. Disscuss the positives and neggatives of AV VMs. 9. Wh hat is the most detailed tyype of appraissal report andd how does itt differ from tthe other two o typ pes of appraissal reports? Chapter 16: Choosing a Lender 363 Chapter 16: Choosing a Lender Learning Outcomes Successful understanding of the concepts presented in this chapter will enable the learner to: Differentiate between prime, sub‐prime and private lenders Interpret a lender’s product and rate sheet Understand the factors that must be considered when choosing a lender Introduction Once the mortgage agent has decided on the best product type for his or her client, it is now necessary to choose a lender. There are dozens of lenders in the mortgage market and choosing one specific lender to submit a client’s application to can be time consuming and confusing if the mortgage agent is not knowledgeable on lenders’ products, services and rates. In this chapter, the different types of lenders will be explored as well as varying lenders’ guidelines. Since lenders have different methods and styles of promoting their products a sample of a lender’s product sheet will be reviewed. However, for the mortgage agent to be fully aware of lenders’ products, services and rates, it is necessary for him or her to develop relationships with those lenders. For the mortgage agent who is joining an established mortgage brokerage, those relationships are typically already in place. In this circumstance the mortgage agent needs to ensure that his or her contact information has been provided to the lenders with whom the brokerage deals. The mortgage agent needs to review all of the current information that the brokerage has on those lenders. It is also important to note that, while most lenders will have relationships with all mortgage brokerages, some will not. Certain lenders will only deal with specific mortgage brokerages. Before joining a mortgage brokerage, the mortgage agent should satisfy himself or herself that the mortgage brokerage which he or she is joining has relationships with a sufficient number of lenders to be competitive in the market. For the new mortgage agent, this can only be accomplished by interviewing with several different mortgage brokerages to determine the best company with which to be affiliated. 16.1 Types of Lenders The Ontario mortgage industry, the largest in Canada, has dozens of lenders from which the mortgage agent may choose. It is important for the mortgage agent to know who those lenders are and the products, services and rates offered by each to determine the best lender for his or her client. Many lenders have a dedicated mortgage agent sales force comprised of Business Development Managers (BDMs) or Business Development Officers (BDOs). There are other titles that some lenders provide to their sales force but the terms BDM and BDO are most common. These individuals are tasked with obtaining business from mortgage brokerages and are normally a 364 Chapter 16: 1 Choosing a Lender der’s productss, services and rates. In ad ddition, a BDM M valuable source of information on their lend can offten assist a mortgage m age ent to have an n application approved byy liaising betw ween the mortggage agent an nd the underw writer. Lende ers are typically categorize ed by the type e of business in which theyy specialize, eeither prime mortggage lending or sub‐prime mortgage len nding. Prim me Mortg age Lend ding Prime e mortgage le ending is defin ned as lendingg to clients w who are consid dered to be p prime borro owers. A prim me borrower is typically an individual w ho has excellent credit, prrovable incom me and stable employmentt. This type of o lending is ooften referred d to as , “A len nding” or “Prim me lending.” The majority m of Canadians fall in nto this categgory, as is eviddenced by thhe volumes off mortgage transaactions comp pleted by prim me lenders. Typical prime lenders include those who o deal directlyy with the t public succh as Chartere ed Banks, Tru ust Companiees and Credit Unions. Therre are also several lenders wh ho deal with the t public only through moortgage brokeerages and th hese institu utions are normally referre ed to as non‐deposit takinng institutionss. Some e prime lenders also deal with w borrowerrs who, altho ugh not a prime borrowerr, are not a sub‐p prime borrower either. These borrowerrs are typicallly referred to o as Alt‐A borrrowers. An Alt‐A borrower is normally n an in ndividual who ose credit maay be good altthough not exxcellent, and who may m not be ab ble to prove his h or her inco ome but is stiill considered d a good risk b by the prime lende er. Sub b-Prime Mortgage M Lending (also refferred to as “Self--Insured”” Len ding) The su ub‐prime mortgage marke et has developed in Canad a over the paast several yeears in respo onse to Canad dians with spe ecific mortgagge financing nneeds, and who are not seerviced by thee lende ers in the prim me mortgage market. ncreasing sub b‐prime mortggage market provides p the ability for bo orrowers who have been or The in who would w be declined by prim me lenders to obtain financcing, either to o purchase a h home or refinaance their existing mortgagge. This markket has effecttively increased the number of potentiaal home e buyers by prroviding finan ncing that wo ould otherwisee be unavailaable. Althouggh this is viewe ed as a positivve developme ent in the mo ortgage markeet, it has also resulted in b borrowers being approved wh ho perhaps sh hould not be.. The tyypical sub‐prime borrowerr is an individual who mayy have a comb bination of the following characteristics: b behind in his or her payments on n one or moree credit cardss, Current poor crredit such as being loaans or other debts d Lesss than two years y at his orr her current job j Self‐employed Haas a previous bankruptcy Haas previous po oor credit witth no re‐estab blished creditt Re equires high LTV financing. Chapter 16: 1 Choosing a Lender 36 65 e no single characteristic frrom the abovve list may be enough for a prime lendeer to decline While an applicant’s application for fin nancing, a combination off those characcteristics typically will resultt in being declined by a priime lender. Itt has therefo re become neecessary to p provide poten ntial borrowers with altern native financin ng, which is ooffered by sub b‐prime lendeers. These lende ers normally charge c a highe er rate of inte erest than theeir prime counterparts and d may chargee the bo orrower a len nder’s fee. A lender’s fee is i a fee charg ed by the len nder, normallyy paid on closin ng by the borrrower from th he mortgage proceeds, as a bonus for p providing the financing. e lenders ofte en refer to the eir lender’s fe ee as a “self‐innsurance” feee, and many w will call These themsselves “self‐in nsured” lende ers. This simp ply refers to tthe fact that tthey do not o offer default insure ed mortgagess, rather they charge a lender’s fee thatt is designed to offset the risk of defaullt by a borrower. b Maany of these lenders l chargge fees simila r to that of th he default inssurers, but it iis imporrtant to note that the term m “self‐insure ed” is simply uused as a wayy of explainingg their lende er’s fees, as th hese lenders do d not use an ny type of deffault insurancce. The Private Mortgage e Market Privatte lenders are e classified ass individuals or o groups of inndividuals wh ho provide mortgage financcing. These in ndividuals have money to invest and haave decided tthat mortgagee financing offerss a profitable rate of return n. The typicaal private lendder will deal w with mortgage agents or broke erages and use those individuals/firms to t locate poteential clients.. A client requiring a private morrtgage will gen nerally not quualify through h a prime or ssub‐prime lende er. This client will normallyy have equity in his or her property and d be able to o obtain financcing to a maximum of 85% % LTV, depend ding on the arrea in which tthe property is located. nterest than pprime and sub‐prime lenders and will Privatte lenders willl charge a higgher rate of in normally charge a lender’s fee. The profile of o a typical prrivate mortgaage is an interrest only mortggage with mo onthly payments and a one e‐year term. Su uccess Tip – Sub‐prim me lenderss Most successfu ul mortgage agents a will havve between ttwo and four prime and tw wo and four su ub‐prime lend ders with who om they norm mally deal. Byy choosing a h handful of len nders with whom to work,, you will become familiar with their guuidelines and develop relattionships with their BDMs and d underwriterrs. It is, howe ever, also impportant to know the otherr lenders’ gu uidelines in caase your norm mal lenders caannot fund a specific transsaction. 16.2 2 Unders standing Lender Guidelines G s Lende ers, with the exception e of private lende ers, provide m mortgage agen nts with summaries of their products, serrvices and rates. These do ocuments are often referreed to as rate ssheets and produ uct sheets and d are normallly communicaated to mortggage agents vvia the lenderr’s BDMs, by email or are provid ded on the lender’s websitte (a usernam me and passw word may be rrequired to access this informaation online). Some lende ers have packaages that desscribe their prroducts in detaill while otherss provide basiic summaries. 366 Chapter 16: 1 Choosing a Lender Prod duct She ets A product sheet is designed to inform i the mortgage agennt of the term ms and conditions that musst be me et for approval, as well as the features of the mortgaage being desscribed, inclu uding the maxim mum LTV, the e amortization n and so on. While the forrmat of produ uct sheets difffers from lende er to lender, the following figure f is a sam mple of a prooduct sheet th hat contains ttypical inform mation. Figure 93 – Sample Pro oduct Sheet ABC Lender Inc. Productt Sheet Purpose Termss Mortggage Amounts Rate Hold H / Rate Dro op Amorttization Prepayyment Optionss Payout Options Lender’s Fees Property Requireme ents Location Appraisal GDS/TTDS Creditt Beacon Score Incom me/Employmen nt Meaans the borrow wer can provvide a letter stating their income without proving p it Down payment Payme ent frequency Property Taxes Portab ble Assum mable Means th he borrower can c provide documentatio d on to prove/ve erify their inco ome 95% % ‐ Purchase 90% % ‐ Refinance 3 an nd 5 year fixed Minimum $50,000 0 00 ($700,000 inn GTA) Maxximum $600,00 45 days, d one time rate drop 7 daays prior to closing 25, 30 3 and 35 yearrs Up to t 20% prepaym ment annuallyy + 20% increasse in paymentss once per yearr 3 mo onths interest or the Interestt Rate Differen ntial, whicheveer is greater 2% added a to the mortgage m Own ner Occupied only o Singgle family up to o a four‐plex High h‐ rise condominiums Hobby farms and rural r propertiees on exception n basis With hin 25km radiu us of populatioon of 25k With hin 30km radiu us of populatioon of 30k Required on all applications. Brooker may order using ABC’s aapproved list o of A cost tto be paid by b borrower apprraisers only. Appraisal No GDS, G TDS 50% Good credit, minim mum 2 years h istory, no majo or derogatories, bankruptcy wed over 2 yeaars discharged allow 80% % LTV or less: 58 85 ‐ 649 80.1 1 to 95% LTV: 650 6 + Stated Income: Must meet TDS rratio. ness license, orr Self‐‐Employed: Must prove self‐‐employment vvia NOA, busin Articcles of Incorpo oration, etc. In come will not be verified. Emp ployed: Letter of o employmen t, excluding saalary Full Doc d by most Self‐‐employed: Based on last 2 yyears average income verified rece ent financial staatements and most recent N NOAs Emp ployed: Must provide full incoome verificatio on by means off job letter, T4s, NOA As, etc for past 2 years. Verification requirred. Must show w 1.5% of purcchase price for closing costs iin bankk account no laater than 7 bussiness days beffore closing Mon nthly, weekly, bi‐weekly b Inclu uded in mortgaage payment Yes Yes – with approvaal 36 67 Chapter 16: 1 Choosing a Lender Rate e Sheets A rate e sheet is designed to inform the mortggage agent off the rate charged on a pro oduct, based on such factors as the LTV and the t Beacon or credit scoree. While the fformat of rate sheets differs from lenderr to lender, th he following figure f is a sam mple of a ratee sheet that contains typicaal information n. Figure 94 – Sample Ra ate Sheet ABC Lender Inc. – Sample R Rate Sheet Salaried and Business For Self (B BFS) Rate She eet: as of Octoober, 2012 SFD D is a “Single Family F Dwelling” ABC LENDEER INC. RATE SHEET Credit Score 680+ 6 650 0– 679 9 620 – 649 600 – 619 580 – 599 540 ‐ 5 579 SFD Stated Income e Salarie ed/BFS 5 Year Term LTV 90.0 01 ‐ 95% 85.0 01 ‐ 90% 75.0 01 ‐ 85% 60.1 1 ‐ 75% 0 ‐ 60% 6 Rate R 5.9% 5 5.8% 5 5.7% 5 5.6% 5 5.5% 5 Ratte 7.4 4% 7.3 3% 7.2 2% 7.1 1% 7% % Ratee 7.6% % 7.5% % 7.4% % 7.3% % 7.2% % Rate N/A 8.1% % 8% 7.9% % 7.8% % Rate N/A N/A 8.8% 8.7% 8.6% Rate N/A N/A N/A 9.1% 8.9% SFD Full Do oc Salarie ed/BFS 5 Year Term LTV 90.0 01 ‐ 95% 85.0 01 ‐ 90% 75.0 01 ‐ 85% 60.1 1 ‐ 75% 0 ‐ 60% 6 Rate R 5.3% 5 5.2% 5 5.1% 5 5.0% 5 4.9% 4 Ratte 6.4 4% 6.3 3% 6.2 2% 6.1 1% 6% % Ratee 6.6% % 6.5% % 6.4% % 6.3% % 6.2% % Rate N/A 7.1% % 7% 6.9% % 6.8% % Rate N/A N/A 7.8% 7.6% 7.6% Rate N/A N/A N/A 8.1% 7.9% BFS is “B Business for Self”, me eaning self‐ employed Su uccess Tip – If you’ree unsure... If you are unsu ure whether a lender will approve your client’s application or if yo ou are unsuree off the rate, eve en after reviewing the prod duct and ratee sheets, do n not guess! Co ontact either the lender’s BD DM or underw writer and discuss the cliennt with him or her. This caan save time an nd effort and ultimately yo our client! 368 Chapter 16: 1 Choosing a Lender 16.3 3 Choosiing a Len nder If the mortgage aggent determin nes the best product p for hiis or her clien nt and only on ne lender in the in ndustry offerss that productt, the choice is i clear. How wever, this is n not always the case. In all circum mstances it is best to rely on o the advice e of the brokeerage for whicch the mortgaage agent workss; however if the brokeragge does not sp pecifically reccommend a leender, then th he mortgage agentt should use the following points in determining the best lender tto choose. Loan to Value: Which lender(s) offer the LTV that the client requirees? he client proviide the Inccome Verificaation: What income verificcation is requuired? Can th appropriate doccument(s)? operty Type: Does the clie ent’s propertyy type meet thhe lender’s reequirements?? I.e., if the Pro clie ent has a renttal property, does the lend der have a re ntal product?? Cre edit Score: What W are the lender’s l requirements? D oes the lendeer offer a diffferent LTV based on creditt scores? If so o, does the client qualify? ender offers the t best terms for the cliennt such as preepayment priivileges, based Terms: which le he client? on the product chosen for th Rates: which len nder offers th he best rate based b on the product chossen for the cliient? ender provide es the quickesst response too an applicatiion submissio on? Speed: which le Service: which lender provid des the best service to bothh mortgage aagents and clients? Re eputation: which lender haas the best ovverall reputatiion in the mo ortgage industry? Re elationship: do oes the mortggage agent haave a good reelationship with the len nder/BDM/un nderwriter that creates loyyalty to that l ender Fin nder’s Fees: iff everything else e is equal and a two or moore lenders aare appropriatte for the clie ent, which off those lenderrs, if any, pays the highest commission?? Loyyalty Program m: if everythin ng else is equal and two orr more lenders are approp priate for the clie ent, which off those lenderrs, if any, offe ers a loyalty oor points proggram? In all cases, the right lender mu ust be the lend der that is beest for the clieent, regardlesss of the finderr’s fees or loyyalty program m that the lend der may or m may not have. By consisten ntly doing what is in the clien nt’s best interrests, the morrtgage agent will increase his or her chances of ming highly su uccessful. becom Pa ause for cllarification n – Loyaltyy or points program A loyalty or poiints program is a program provided by a lender thatt rewards thee mortgage aggent for funding mortgages through it. Chapter 16: Choosing a Lender 369 16.4 Key Terms and Definitions BDM / BDO Business Development Manager / Business Development Officer. These are two of the titles held by representatives of lenders who are tasked with obtaining business from mortgage agents. BFS Business For Self. This term applies to those clients who are self‐employed. O/O Owner occupied property Prime Lending Refers to mortgage lending to borrowers who are considered very good risks Private Lender A private lender is typically an individual investor with funds who would like to invest in mortgages. This individual will usually invest through his or her lawyer who may have clients requiring mortgage financing or a mortgage agent. His or her purpose may vary but normally an investor will invest in 2nd mortgages due to their higher rate of return when compared to 1st mortgages and other potential types of investments. Product Sheet A document provided by a lender that outlines the terms and conditions of its products Rate Drop Typically refers to the practice of decreasing a client’s mortgage rate after he or she has been approved but before the mortgage transaction has closed, when the lender’s interest rate on the product has decreased Rate Hold Typically refers to the practice of maintaining a rate for a specific period of time, whereby the lender will keep the client’s mortgage rate at the approved amount after he or she has been approved but before the mortgage transaction has closed, when the lender’s interest rate on the product has increased Rate Sheet A document provided by a lender that lists the interest rates for specific products, based on specific terms Self‐Insured lender A term used to describe a sub‐prime lender that charges a lender’s fee. This fee is often comparable in amount to the fees charged by default insurers. This fee is used by the lender to offset amounts lost by borrowers who default on their mortgages but is not an actual insurance premium since these lenders do not use default insurance SFD Single Family Dwelling 370 Chapter 16: Choosing a Lender Sub‐Prime Lending Refers to mortgage lending to borrowers who are considered poor risks or who do not qualify for prime lending Chapter 16: 1 Choosing a Lender 16.5 5 Review w Questio ons Answers to the Revview Questio ons are found at www.REM MIC.ca Sho ort Answe er Questio ons 1. Disscuss the differences betw ween the prim me and sub‐prrime mortgagge market. 2. Disscuss the differences betw ween prime an nd sub‐primee mortgages. 3. Wh hat factors caan cause a bo orrower to be considered ssub‐prime? 4. Wh hat type of bo orrower will typically t requ uire a private mortgage? hat information is typicallyy found in a le ender’s produuct sheet? 5. Wh 6. Wh hat information is typicallyy found in a le ender’s rate ssheet? 7. Wh hat should a mortgage m age ent do if he or she is unsurre if a lender will approve his or her clie ent’s applicattion? 8. Wh hat factors must m a mortgage agent consider when choosing a len nder? 9. Wh hich factors are a the least important forr a mortgage aagent when cchoosing a len nder? 10. What W impact does d a credit score s have on n the ability oof a borrowerr to access a lender’s pro oducts? 37 71 372 Chapter 17: Sub bmitting the Application A annd Obtaining a Commitmeent Chapteer 17: Submit S tting the Appllicationn and Obtaaining a Com mmitmeent Lea arning Outccomes Succcessful undersstanding of th he concepts presented p in tthis chapter w will enable the learner to: Discuss the iteems in an application whichh must be expplained in thee notes sectioon of the ap pplication Understand thhe differencess between subbmitting an aapplication too an institutional lender nd a private lender an Explain the importance of the t Investor/LLender Discloosure Complete C an Investor/Lend der Disclosure e Describe D the specific inform mation that must m be discloosed in the Invvestor/Lendeer Disclosure Describe D the timing require ements of the e Investor/Lennder Disclosu ure Describe D the means m in whicch the Investo or/Lender Dissclosure may be made Liist the standaard informatioon found in a commitment letter Innterpret a com mmitment lettter Explain the importance of meeting m the lender’s cond itions of apprroval Intro oduction Once the needs of the borrowe er have been determined d aand a lender cchosen, the p process of submitting an application is a siimple step. However, H it is a step that ccan be mishan ndled by a new mortgage m age ent. This chap pter will explo ore submittinng an applicattion to both aan institutionaal and private p lenderr, explaining the difference es and similarrities of both processes. Su uccess Tip – Only sub bmit to onee lender Yo ou should onlyy submit an application a to o one lender. While this iss not a legal rrequirement iit is a best practicce. It is your responsibility r y to choose thhe best lendeer for your clieent. To do so o yo ou need to kno ow the lende ers’ guideliness so that you’ ll have a high h expectation that the ap pplication will be approved d. Lenders mo onitor fundinng ratios (the number of ap pplications submitted to th hem to the nu umber of applications fundded by them)) and will refu use to deal with you if yourr ratio is unaccceptable. A high funding ratio means you are a true professional an nd will lead to o greater succcess! Once an applicatio on has been submitted, the e lender will, if everythingg goes accordiing to plan, appro ove the appliccation and pro ovide a comm mitment letteer. If declined d, the mortgage agent musst choosse a different lender and begin b the proccess anew. Given n an approval,, the commitm ment letter will w contain coonditions thatt must be meet. This chaptter will discusss meeting tho ose condition ns and preparring for the closing processs. Chapter 17: Submitting the Application and Obtaining a Commitment 373 17.1 Submitting the Application Once the application has been entered into the mortgage agent’s origination software and he or she has decided on which lender to whom to submit the application, it is as easy as choosing the lender from a drop down menu and submitting it. However, before that step occurs the mortgage agent must ensure that the application has been properly completed. The most common complaint by underwriters is that the mortgage agent does not make proper notes in the application when submitting. Every origination software has the capability of allowing the mortgage agent to add his or her notes to an application. These notes are designed to inform the underwriter of items that he or she might need to know to make a decision to lend. Before submitting the application, the mortgage agent must review the following areas and provide the underwriter with explanatory notes if any area requires further explanation. The areas to review are Credit, Property and Employment. Each is detailed below. Credit If the applicant has any derogatory credit such as missed payments in the past or is currently in arrears on any of his or her debts, the mortgage agent must inquire as to the reason for this derogatory credit and include this explanation in his or her notes. Explanations are required if the applicant’s credit report contains: Current or previously missed payments Current accounts currently listed as an R9 with or without an outstanding balance Accounts closed by the credit grantor Account balances exceeding credit limits Excessive recent inquiries Any judgments One or more previous bankruptcies Any accounts now or previously in collections Any accounts currently listed as an R7 (which indicate a consumer proposal) Any accounts rated a 2 or higher (i.e. R2 or higher, or I2 or higher) Property If there are any issues with the property, the mortgage agent must note them in his or her application submission. The property provides the lender with security for its loan. If that security is compromised, the lender’s position is weakened. If the property has been valued by an AVM or through CMHC’s or Genworth’s automated underwriting systems and no physical inspection of the property has occurred, any defects in the property will have been omitted. If the mortgage agent learns of any defects, he or she must investigate and include that information in the application submission. Possible defects or areas of concern may include: The property having renters or boarders (if the client has not indicated that this is a rental) Water damage in the basement – this may be a sign of a crack in the foundation Water damage in the ceiling or walls ‐ this may be a sign of a burst water pipe Excessive interior or exterior wear and tear that might impact the value of the property Evidence of UFFI or insulbrick Signs of insect or rodent infestation 374 Chapter 17: Sub bmitting the Application A annd Obtaining a Commitmeent Siggns of improp per use of the property succh as the pressence of commercial mach hinery in or on the e property that may indicaate that the property p is beeing used for b business purp poses. Emplo oyment The applicant’s em mployment afffects his or he er ability to reepay the morrtgage. Itemss requiring explanation include: Haaving several jobs j over the past two or three t years Anny periods of unemployme u ent Addditional income If the t mortgage e agent canno ot verify employment. By anticipating que estions that the underwritter would askk and answeriing them in th he notes sectio on of the appllication when n submitted, the t mortgagee agent will saave time and effort on thee underrwriter’s behaalf and may save an appliccant from bei ng declined. 17.2 2 Investo or/Lenderr Disclosu ure If the mortgage aggent has decid ded to use a private p lenderr for his or heer client’s mo ortgage financcing, by law itt is necessaryy to provide more m informattion than is reequired to bee provided to an insstitutional len nder. This information mu ust be provideed in the Inveestor/Lender Disclosure Form. Before discussing disclosure d req quirements, it must be notted that a bro okerage cann not accept fundss from a lende er or investorr unless in reggards to a speecific mortgagge. In other w words, a broke erage cannot accept funds from a lende er or investor to be held on n deposit or in trust unlesss those e funds are for a specific mortgage. m In add dition, disclossure is require ed to be provvided to an invvestor/lender who is not a member of a design nated class off lenders and investors, ass defined by leegislation. Wha at Must be b Disclos sed The disclosure doccument prese ented to the in nvestor mustt include the ffollowing info ormation: the e terms and conditions c of the proposed d mortgage bo orrower inform mation pro operty inform mation fee es and payme ents associate ed with the mortgage m the e role of the brokerage b the e nature of th he relationshiip between th he brokerage , borrower an nd any other party under the e proposed mortgage m any potential co onflicts of interest e risks associaated with the e proposed mortgage the Termss and conditions of the prroposed morttgage Typicaally an application submittted to an inve estor/lender, like an appliccation submittted to an institu utional lender will rely on the investor//lender settin g the terms aand condition ns of the mortggage in his or her commitm ment letter. However, H in ccircumstances where the investtor/lender maay be an indivvidual who re elies on the brroker/agent tto provide a ffull mortgagee Chapter 17: Submitting the Application and Obtaining a Commitment 375 scenario that the investor/lender is being asked to invest in, it is the responsibility of the broker/agent to provide complete details related to the terms and conditions of the proposed mortgage. In either case the broker/agent should provide full disclosure on the mortgage being applied for. The disclosure document must therefore include: the proposed closing date the proposed mortgage amount and frequency how the proposed payment can be made, i.e. pre‐authorized payment plan or post‐dated cheques the proposed amortization unless the proposed mortgage is interest only the proposed term the proposed interest rate as well as its compounding frequency the proposed prepayment privileges the full civic address and legal description of the property to be mortgaged any proposed fees or charges payable by the borrower on default or for NSF fees any proposed lender and brokerage fees Standard Charge Terms requirements, such as payment of property taxes, maintaining the property and maintaining fire insurance with the investor/lender assigned as first loss payee any proposed application fee payable to the investor/lender the solicitor under the proposed mortgage other terms and conditions as may be required by an investor of ordinary prudence Borrower information The following information must be provided to a prospective investor/lender before he or she can make a decision to lend: section 28 of Regulation 188/08 states that a brokerage cannot sell or otherwise attempt to sell a mortgage that has been in default at any point during the previous twelve months unless it has the lender’s written acknowledgment that it has received this disclosure documentary evidence of the borrower’s ability to meet the mortgage payments a copy of the application for the mortgage and of any document submitted in support of the application if the mortgage is a new mortgage, documentary evidence of any down payment made by the borrower for the purchase of the property a copy of any agreement that the lender or investor may be asked to enter into with the brokerage all other information, in writing, that a lender or investor of ordinary prudence would consider to be material to a decision about whether to lend money on the security of the property or to invest in the mortgage If the investment is in an existing mortgage, a copy of the mortgage instrument. Property information The following information must be provided to a prospective investor/lender before he or she can make a decision to lend: if the investment is in an existing mortgage, a copy of the mortgage instrument if an appraisal of the applicable property has been done in the preceding 12 months and is available to the brokerage, a copy of the appraisal if an appraisal of the applicable property is not available, documentary evidence of the value of the property, other than an agreement of purchase and sale 376 Chapter 17: Submitting the Application and Obtaining a Commitment if an agreement of purchase and sale in respect of the property has been entered into in the preceding 12 months and is available to the brokerage, a copy of the agreement of purchase and sale For renewals: if an appraisal of the property has been done in the preceding 12 months and is available to the brokerage, a copy of the appraisal if an agreement of purchase and sale in respect of the property has been entered into in the preceding 12 months and is available to the brokerage, a copy of the agreement of purchase and sale all other information, in writing, that a lender of ordinary prudence would consider to be material to a decision about whether to renew the mortgage Fees and payments As discussed under the terms and conditions, a brokerage is required to disclose any and all payments that the borrower, investor or lender may be required to receive or make under the proposed mortgage. The role of the brokerage Section 18 of Regulation 188/08 states that the brokerage must disclose, in writing to a prospective borrower or lender the following information about the nature of its relationship with borrowers and lenders: 1. Information about whether, and when, the brokerage is acting as a representative of the lender but not the borrower in a transaction. 2. Information about whether, and when, the brokerage is acting as a representative of the borrower but not the lender in a transaction. 3. Information about whether, and when, the brokerage is acting as a representative of both the borrower and the lender in a transaction and is not giving preference to the interests of either. O. Reg. 188/08, s. 18 (1). (2) Subsection (1) does not apply when the brokerage is the mortgage lender. O. Reg. 188/08, s. 18 (2). Role of the brokerage – sample clauses The following are samples of clauses that can be used to meet the disclosure requirements as discussed in the role of the brokerage. REMIC Mortgages Inc. is acting solely on behalf of the lender in this mortgage transaction. REMIC Mortgages Inc. is acting solely on behalf of the borrower in this mortgage transaction. REMIC Mortgages Inc. is acting on behalf of both the lender and the borrower in arranging this mortgage transaction. Relationship between brokerage, borrower and others The brokerage must ensure that any and all relationships between the brokerage, broker and/or agent and the borrower are fully disclosed to the potential investor/lender. This disclosure is necessary for the investor/lender to assist in determining if the proposed mortgage is suitable Chapter 17: Sub bmitting the Application A annd Obtaining a Commitmeent 37 77 of the disclossure must for him or her. Dissclosure mustt be made in writing and t he recipient o ackno owledge the disclosure d in writing. w Conflicts of interesst The brokerage must disclose to o a borrower, lender or invvestor in the ttransaction, aany potential conflict of interest that the brokerage may have. h Risks Risk tolerance is a concept that identifies the e investor/lennder’s accepttable level of risk. There are tw wo fundamen ntal requireme ents when co onsidering riskk: understand ding the invesstor/lender’s generral level of accceptable risk and disclosin ng the specificc risks associaated with thee mortgage being recommended by the bro oker/agent. This T requirem ment is describ bed in section n 25.1 of Regullation 188/08 8, Mortgage Brokerages: B Standards of PPractice, and states that, ““A brokerage shall disclose d in wrriting to a borrrower, lende er or investor,, as the case m may be, the m material risks of eacch mortgage or o investmen nt in a mortgaage that the bbrokerage preesents for thee consideratio on of the e borrower, le ender or investor.” Risks to an investo or/lender mayy include, butt are not limitted to: any risks associated with thee borrower’s ability a to repaay the mortgage pootential loss of investment if the properrty is not adeqquately insured and is dam maged or destroyed pootential loss of investment if the mortgaage is fraudul ently discharrged by anothher party pootential loss of investment if the properrty loses valuee and must bee sold for an amount less thaan the outstanding balance of the morttgage pootential expennses associateed with recovvering a mortggage due to ddefault pootential expennses associateed with recovvering a mortggage due to ffraud or forgeery where title inssurance was not n required lacck of quick liquidity failure to enforcce collection proceedings if the investoor/lender is a member of a syndicated ortgage mo How w Disclosu re Must be b Made A brokerage is required to provvide detailed disclosure d to lenders and iinvestors invo olved in a mortggage transacttion, includingg a mortgage renewal, unl ess that lender or investor is a member of a designated claass of lenderss and investorrs as previoussly defined in the Key Term ms and Definitions section n of Chapter 5. 5 This disclossure must incclude a completed disclosu ure form, in a form approved by the Superinteendent, signed by a brokerr. The disclossure documen nt used to provid de disclosure, consent or acknowledge a ment to an innvestor or len nder must be clear and concisse and presen nted in a man nner that is clearly understtandable. Whe en Disclos ure Must be Made Regullation 188/08 8 states that disclosure d mu ust be provideed to the lend der/investor aat the earliestt opporrtunity and, in n any case, no o later than two business days before tthe earliest off the followin ng eventts. This time period can be e reduced to one businesss day if the invvestor/lenderr consents in writin ng. 1. The brokerage receives r mon ney from the lender l or inveestor 2. The brokerage enters e into an n agreement to receive mooney from the lender or in nvestor 378 Chapter 17: Sub bmitting the Application A annd Obtaining a Commitmeent ers into an agreement to enter e into a m mortgage or th he investor en nters into an 3. The lender ente agreement to purchase, p exch hange or sell a mortgage 4. The money is ad dvanced to th he borrower under u the moortgage 5. The trade comp pletion date, which w is: a) the date e on which an n investor, or a brokerage on behalf of an investor, eenters into an n agreem ment to trade in the mortgaage, or b) the date e on which th he trade in the e mortgage iss completed. The Investor//Lender D isclosure Statemennt for Bro kered Traansactionss The fo ollowing figurre is the Invesstor/Lender Disclosure D Staatement for B Brokered Tran nsactions. Th his form is given to the potential in nvestor/lende er before the potential invvestor/lender can provide the aggent/broker with w a commiitment to fund a mortgagee. This form has been n created by FSCO F and con ntains the preescribed inforrmation as disscussed in thee previo ous sections. This form was updated in 2015 and those up pdates are refflected by higghlights and n notes. Chapter 17: Submitting the Application and Obtaining a Commitment Figure 95 – Investor/Lender Disclosure Form updated 2015 379 380 Chapter 17: Submitting the Application and Obtaining a Commitment Chapter 17: Submitting the Application and Obtaining a Commitment 381 382 Chapter 17: Submitting the Application and Obtaining a Commitment Chapter 17: Submitting the Application and Obtaining a Commitment 383 384 Chapter 17: Submitting the Application and Obtaining a Commitment Chapter 17: Submitting the Application and Obtaining a Commitment 385 386 Chapter 17: Submitting the Application and Obtaining a Commitment Chapter 17: Submitting the Application and Obtaining a Commitment 387 388 Chapter 17: Submitting the Application and Obtaining a Commitment Chapter 17: Submitting the Application and Obtaining a Commitment 389 390 Chapter 17: Submitting the Application and Obtaining a Commitment Chapter 17: Submitting the Application and Obtaining a Commitment 391 392 Chapter 17: Sub bmitting the Application A annd Obtaining a Commitmeent 17.3 3 The Co ommitmen nt Letter Once the application has been submitted s an nd the underw writer has app proved the m mortgage appliccation, he or she s will send the mortgage agent a com mmitment lettter or approvval. This docum ment explainss the terms and conditionss of the mortggage that thee lender is com mmitted to provid ding along with the condittions that must be met beffore the lender will fund the mortgage.. The fo ollowing is a list of informaation commonly found in a commitmen nt letter: Ap pplicants’ nam mes Pro operty address (address of the securityy) Mo ortgage amou unt Intterest rate Payment amount ency Payment freque Term Clo osing date Pre epayment priivileges Co onditions of ap pproval Terms of the ap pproved morttgage (such ass fees, appraiisal requirements, etc.). These e conditions are a typically based b on the information i ccontained in tthe applicatio on. For example, if the app plication state es that the ap pplicant has w worked for AB BC Company for six years a earns $70 0,000 per yeaar, the lenderr will include a condition th hat this as an Accountant and inform mation be pro oven by a job letter, T4s, pay p stubs, etc . The requireed documentss must be sen nt to the e lender and the t lender mu ust deem the em acceptablee before the d deal can be fu unded. It is imporrtant to note that if condittions are not met to the leender’s satisfaaction, the len nder will revokke the committment and caancel the morrtgage. Su uccess Tip –Double check c the commitme c nt letter On nce you receivve the commitment letterr, compare it tto your file to o ensure that all of the infformation is correct. c Lookk at the mortggage amount,, property address, and alll of the termss an nd conditions to confirm th hat the comm mitment letterr is based on what you sub bmitted to the len nder. It can sometimes s haappen whereb by an underw writer will app prove an application, but on n slightly diffe erent terms an nd conditionss then what the broker/aggent applied ffor. For example, the le ender may approve the application at a different ratte or loan to vvalue than ap pplied for. By checking thiss information n before meetting with the client you wiill be sure nott to be caught byy surprise whe en discussingg the commitm ment with your client. ollowing figurre is an example of a comm mitment letteer from a fictiitious lender. The fo 393 Chapter 17: Submitting the Application and Obtaining a Commitment Figure 96 – Sample Commitment Letter Mortgage Commitment Response: December 15, 2012 Page 1 of 4 Broker Information Name: Address: Attention: REMIC Mortgages Inc. 2175 Sheppard Avenue East, Suite 213, Toronto, ON, M2J 1W8 Adam Coren Application Reference Number: 1213456‐789 Lender Information Name: SuperBank Address: 2750 Yonge Street, Suite 6500, Toronto, ON, M1M 1M1 Lender Reference #: 1213456‐789 Mortgage Insurance Reference #: TBD Applicant Information Applicant(s): Noreen Borrower, Christopher Borrower 1234 Queen Lane, Toronto, ON, M1S 1M1 Address: Always check the Commitment to ensure the information, such as the property address, is correct With reference to the above noted property SuperBank is pleased to provide the following mortgage loan offer, subject to the following terms and conditions: Loan Terms Purchase Value: $237,500.00 Mortgage Type: Down payment: $11,875.00 Term Type: Amount: $225,525.00 Interest Rate (compounded semi‐ annually): Insurance Premium $6,201.94 Term (months): Total Loan: $231,726.94 Amortization (months): Other Mortgages: N/A Frequency: Product: Supersizer Cashback: N/A Closing Date: 3/1/13 Payment Principal and Interest: $1,399.64 Closed Taxes (Estimated): $149.58 5.390% Taxes Paid By: SuperBank Total Installment: 1,549.22 Commitment Expires 1/22/13 First 60 300 Monthly LENDER AUTHORIZATION All of our normal requirements and, if applicable, those of the mortgage insurer must be met. All costs including legal, survey, mortgage insurance, etc. are for the account of the applicant(s). The mortgage insurance premium (if applicable) will be added to the mortgage. This mortgage is subject to the details and terms outlines as well as the conditions described in the attached Schedule A. Approved by: John Underwriter, SuperBank Signature: _________________ Date: ________________ CLIENT ACCEPTANCE I/We the undersigned applicant(s) accept the terms of this mortgage as stated above and agree to fulfill the conditions of approval as outlined in the attached Schedule A to the lender’s satisfaction. I/We further certify that the information given on the mortgage application is true and correct. Applicant: Noreen Borrower Signature: _________________ Date: _________________ Applicant: Christopher Borrower Signature: _________________ Date: _________________ 394 Chapter 17: Submitting the Application and Obtaining a Commitment Mortgage Commitment – SCHEDULE A ASSUMPTION POLICIES Page 2 of 4 Assumption Option: The transferee or purchaser may, upon completion of a mortgage application which meets our mortgage approval criteria then in effect, personally assume (with the consent of his or her spouse where required by law) all of your obligations under your mortgage by executing an assumption agreement in the form required by us. CONDITIONS Mortgage: The mortgage loan to be made to you shall be subject to all extended terms set forth in SuperBank’s standard form of mortgage contract, and loans insured by a mortgage insurer will be subject to the requirements of the Certificate of Insurance issued by the mortgage insurer. Property Taxes: If stipulated by us, you will pay us monthly, an amount which in our opinion is sufficient to enable us to pay the annual property taxes on your behalf by the due date for the first installment of the tax bill in each year, based on the estimated annual taxes. We shall withhold a tax holdback from our mortgage advance sufficient to accumulate the required credit in your tax account. Any tax bills issued and unpaid at the interest adjustment date shall be paid from the proceeds of the mortgage loan. Fire Insurance: We shall require evidence of replacement cost all‐risk insurance coverage acceptable to us, taken with an insurer not disapproved by us. Such policy must contain the standard Insurance Bureau of Canada mortgage clause and must indicate our interest as mortgagee. Title Insurance: A title insurance policy acceptable to us and obtained by our solicitor at your cost. Processing Fee and Costs: Whether or not this loan is funded, you agree to pay the processing fee specified herein, if any, and all legal, appraisal and survey costs incurred by you or us in this transaction. CMHC/GEMICO/Canada Guaranty Insurance Fee: Insurance Fee: You agree to pay any mortgage insurance fee, as indicated, and all applicable federal or provincial taxes thereon. Interest Adjustment: Interest shall accrue from the date the first advance is made. Interest due to the interest adjustment date will be simple interest calculated daily and will be deducted from the first advance Pre‐authorized Cheque Plan: You agree to make repayment under the mortgage by a 'pre‐authorized cheque plan' or by such other means as may be requested by us. Commitment: This commitment is not transferable by you and the benefit may not be assigned by you. It may be assigned by us. Representation and Warranty: You warrant to us, and it is a condition of this loan, that all information submitted by you or your broker to us in connection with your loan application is true and accurate, and you agree to supply promptly, on request, any further information concerning yourself, your financial standing or the property to be mortgaged, which may be required by us. Title: You represent and warrant to us, and it is a condition of this loan, that you have a good and marketable title to the property to be mortgaged, satisfactory in all aspects. Zoning and Work orders: It is a condition of this loan that the mortgaged property and the use thereof comply with all applicable government laws and regulations and that there are no outstanding work orders, notices or directives against the property. Construction Loan: In the case of a construction loan, advances will be made at our discretion and we will always retain sufficient funds to complete construction. New Homes: If this mortgage loan is for the purchase of a newly constructed home, our solicitor will be required to obtain a certified copy of the New Home Enrolment endorsed by HUDAC (or the equivalent enrolment in any governmental new home warranty program in provinces other than Ontario) before making any mortgage advances. Date:______________________________ Initials:__________ Initials: __________ 395 Chapter 17: Submitting the Application and Obtaining a Commitment CONDITIONS Mortgage Commitment – SCHEDULE A Continued Page 3 of 4 No agency: You acknowledge that we may assign this commitment or the mortgage to a third party and may receive a fee in connection with such assignment. We may also receive a fee in connection with the servicing of this loan. We are not acting as your agent or otherwise in any fiduciary capacity in relation to you in connection with the loan described herein. Solicitor and Documentation: The solicitor specified by us will act on our behalf in this transaction. You agree to deliver to our solicitor your title documents, insurance policy and survey as soon as possible. Entire Agreement: This commitment, when accepted by you, will constitute the entire agreement and understanding between you and us with respect to this loan and will supercede all other agreements or understandings, whether oral or written. Survival: You agree that the terms, conditions & covenants contained in this commitment shall survive and will not merge upon registration of the mortgage and the advance of funds thereunder but will remain valid and subsisting obligations. Information: You agree that we may conduct credit checks with consumer reporting agencies and make such other investigations and collect such other information concerning you as we may deem advisable, all such information to be used for the purpose of underwriting, assessing the risk associated with, and administering this mortgage loan. Privacy: You agree that we may share information concerning you with (a) any proposed assignee of this commitment or the mortgage loan, (b) our duly authorized agents and representatives who are engaged in the processing or servicing of your mortgage, (c) any parties necessary or desirable in connection with any sale or securitization of this mortgage loan and (d) organizations with which the lender has strategic alliances who may use such information to provide you from time to time with information on financial products which may be of interest to you. If you prefer that your personal information not be shared with any party referred to in this document or future documents, you may so advise us in writing at any time and we will not share the information with them. PAYMENT FLEXIBILITY OPTIONS Circle Payment Option: Weekly Bi‐weekly Semi‐monthly Monthly INSTRUCTIONS The terms and conditions of this mortgage commitment will form part of the solicitor’s instructions. OTHER Borrower disclosure required prior to funding Title to be taken in the name of Borrower, Noreen and Borrower, Christopher Subject to satisfactory confirmation of down payment. Subject to satisfactory confirmation of income. Subject to CMHC approval Subject to signed and dated mortgage application Receipt of satisfactory purchase agreement including all addendums and MLS listing. Subject to no secondary financing. PORTABILITY OPTIONS If the mortgagor is not in default and has entered into an agreement to sell or transfer title to the mortgaged property, the mortgagor may exercise the Portability Option. Date:______________________________ Initials:__________ Initials: __________ 396 Chapter 17: Submitting the Application and Obtaining a Commitment Mortgage Commitment – SCHEDULE A Continued PREPAYMENT POLICIES Page 4 of 4 Privileges: 15% per year & Double Up The Mortgagor, when not in default of any terms or conditions contained in the Mortgage, may prepay the whole of the principal sum then outstanding without notice upon payment to the Mortgagee of the greater of i) three months' interest at the interest rate on the principal sum outstanding; or ii) the amount, if any by which interest at the Interest rate exceeds interest at the Mortgagee's current interest rate for reinvestment calculated on the principal sum outstanding. Such amount to be calculated from the date of prepayment to the maturity date of the mortgage. RATE ADJUSTMENT POLICIES If five days prior to closing our interest rate is lower than the guaranteed interest rate, upon requires, the lower rate will prevail. ADMINISTRATION AND SERVICE FEES NSFs, Stopped Payment, Returned Items: $150.00 Lender Administration Fee: $750.00 Date:______________________________ Initials:__________ Initials: __________ 17.4 A Declined Application If an application is declined by the lender, the mortgage agent should contact the underwriter to gain an understanding of why it was declined. In most cases, an application should not be declined since the mortgage agent has researched the lender and determined that the application suits the lender’s guidelines. If this is not the case, the mortgage agent must determine if he or she misinterpreted the guidelines or if the underwriter found something in the application that he or she did not think met those guidelines. If the mortgage agent disagrees with the underwriter’s decision to decline the application, he or she may request that the BDM become involved in the process and/or request that the underwriter’s supervisor review the application. The mortgage agent must have a good understanding of the lender’s underwriting guidelines and feel that the application merits approval before undertaking to challenge the decision, however, since disputing a legitimately declined application can harm the mortgage agent’s reputation and relationship with that lender. In cases where the application may meet the lender’s guidelines but it is not certain, the mortgage agent should contact the BDM or underwriter to discuss the application further. Whatever the reason for the decline, the mortgage agent must learn from the experience and continue to attempt to obtain the financing for his or her client, if possible. Once the application has been approved and a commitment received, it is time to prepare the borrower disclosure (the disclosure document for the client) and meet with the client to have him or her sign the documents. Chapter 17: Submitting the Application and Obtaining a Commitment 397 17.5 Key Terms and Definitions Administered Mortgage In a private transaction, the mortgage agent or a third party is handling the collection of payments and/or other duties related to the administration of the mortgage. Commitment Letter A document illustrating an offer by a lender to a borrower, including the terms and conditions of that offer Conditions Terms of a lender’s commitment that must be fulfilled before the mortgage will be funded Cooling Off Period A waiting period in which a potential investor cannot provide a commitment letter nor advance funds to a borrower Face Value The amount of the mortgage that must be repaid by the borrower Funding Ratio (also referred to as a Pull‐Through Ratio) The ratio of applications submitted to a lender compared to the number of fundings. For example if a mortgage agent submitted 10 applications to a lender and got 5 funded he or she would have a funding ratio of 50% (5 divided by 10). Insulbrick An inexpensive type of exterior siding designed to provide insulation that is most often found on older homes. Inferior types of insulbrick can pose a fire hazard and are typically grounds for declining a mortgage application. Investor/Lender Disclosure (Form 1) A disclosure document required under the Mortgage agents Act to be provided to a potential private lender Schedule (in relation to a Commitment Letter) An addendum to a mortgage commitment that outlines additional terms and conditions of a mortgage approval UFFI (Urea formaldehyde foam insulation) Urea formaldehyde foam insulation is a type of insulation that is injected as a mixture of urea formaldehyde resin, an acidic foaming agent, and a propellant such as air. It was commonly used in pre‐existing houses by injecting the foam into walls, where it was impractical to provide conventional insulation. Underwriter An individual employed by a lender who reviews mortgage applications to determine if they meet the lender’s lending guidelines, and who commonly provides a commitment letter when they are deemed to meet those guidelines 398 Chapter 17: Sub bmitting the Application A annd Obtaining a Commitmeent 17.6 6 Review w Questio ons Answers to the Revview Questio ons are found at www.REM MIC.ca Sho ort Answe er Questio ons 1. Lisst the typical items i that mu ust be explain ned in the nottes section off an application and pro ovide an exam mple of each.. enders should d a mortgage agent submitt an applicatiion at the sam me time? 2. To how many le 3. Disscuss the imp pact of fundin ng ratios on a mortgage aggent. 4. Wh hat is the most common complaint by underwriters u when referriing to mortgaage applications? 5. Lisst ten pieces of o information that are com mmonly founnd in a commitment letter. 6. Wh hat types of documentatio d on might a co ommitment leetter require aas proof of: a) An em mployed indiviidual’s income? b) A self‐employed ind dividual’s inco ome? 7. Wh hat options does a mortgaage agent havve if his or he r client’s application is decclined by the len nder? Chapter 18: Borrower Disclosure 399 Chapter 18: Borrower Disclosure Learning Outcomes Successful understanding of the concepts presented in this chapter will enable the learner to: Explain the purpose of disclosure to a borrower Understand the circumstances under which disclosure must be made in accordance with the MBLAA and its Regulations Describe the specific costs that must be included when calculating the cost of borrowing for disclosure purposes Describe the specific information that must be disclosed Describe the timing requirements of disclosure Describe the means in which disclosure may be made Introduction The purpose of borrower disclosure is to ensure that there is enough information to make an informed decision regarding the suitability of the transaction. The MBLAA and its Regulations define what and how disclosure must be made. While trade associations or others may provide form templates for disclosure, ensuring that disclosure is properly made is the responsibility of the brokerage. The MBLAA and its Regulations clearly define the information that must be disclosed and provide guidelines for borrower disclosure, however neither the MBLAA, its Regulations nor FSCO provide borrower disclosure forms necessary to make that disclosure. In fact, FSCO’s current policy is that it will not approve borrower disclosure documents. Rather, the brokerage must ensure that these documents are compliant based on interpretation of the MBLAA and its Regulations, and when a brokerage is audited FSCO will check these documents for compliance. Therefore while forms used by brokerages to provide disclosure may appear different, the information to be disclosed and how it is disclosed must be the same for each brokerage. Section 6.4 of Regulation 191/08, Cost of Borrowing and Disclosure to borrowers, states that, “A disclosure statement, or a consent in relation to a disclosure statement, must be written in plain language that is clear and concise and it must be presented in a manner that is logical and likely to bring to the borrower’s attention the information that is required to be disclosed.” In addition, if the brokerage does not require the borrower to pay for any of its services, including disbursements, transaction or other activities in relation to the mortgage, and the lender is a prescribed lender as found in section 1.2, and the lender provides its own disclosure that contains the information required by this disclosure, the brokerage is not required to provide the borrower with its own disclosure document. This is typically not the case because most lenders do not disclose all of the information that is required by the MBLAA. The purpose of this chapter is to explore the disclosure requirements for borrowers, including what information must be disclosed, how it must be disclosed and when it must be disclosed. 400 Chapter 18: Borrower Disclosure 18.1 Amendments To Ontario Regulations – January, 2016 As of January 1, 2016 seven major amendments regulations 187/08, 188/08 and 189/08 took effect. The following is the update that FSCO published summarizing these amendments.1 Amendments to Ontario Regulations 187/08, 188/08 and 189/08 Took Effect on January 1, 2016 Mortgage fraud is a growing problem that is estimated to cost hundreds of millions of dollars in Canada each year. In a continued effort to combat mortgage fraud and raise awareness of this important issue, the Government of Ontario made amendments to three existing regulations under the Mortgage Brokerages, Lenders and Administrators Act, 2006 (MBLAA): Ontario Regulation 187/08 – Mortgage Brokers and Agents: Standards of Practice Ontario Regulation 188/08 – Mortgage Brokerages: Standards of Practice Ontario Regulation 189/08 – Mortgage Administrators: Standards of Practice These changes were made in response to the Report to the Minister on the Five‐Year Review of the MBLAA [New Window]. The updated regulations came into effect on January 1, 2016. A summary of the changes that have been made to these standards of practice regulations are provided below. As of January 1, 2016, all mortgage brokerages, administrators, brokers and agents must be compliant with these regulations as amended. Summary of Changes to the Standards of Practice Regulations Mortgage brokerages, administrators, brokers and agents are prohibited from acting, or doing anything, or failing to do anything, in circumstances where they ought to know that they are being used to facilitate fraud, dishonesty, crime or illegal conduct. (This is required under section 14.2 of Ontario Regulation 188/08, section 10.1 of Ontario Regulation 189/08 and section 3.1 of Ontario Regulation 187/08.) Brokerages are prohibited from acting as a representative of a borrower, lender or investor if the brokerage has "reason to doubt" that the mortgage, its renewal, or the investment in it is lawful. (This is required under section 12 of Ontario Regulation 188/08.) Similarly, mortgage administrators are prohibited from administering a mortgage if they have "reason to doubt" that the mortgage, its renewal, or the investment in it is lawful. (This is required under section 10 of Ontario Regulation 189/08.) Brokerages are required to take reasonable steps to verify a borrower's legal authority to mortgage a property. (This is required under section 13 of Ontario Regulation 188/08.) The brokerage's duty to inform the lender if they have to reason to doubt the accuracy of a borrower's application or a borrower's legal authority to mortgage a property will continue after the borrower enters into a mortgage agreement. (This is required under section 14.1 of Ontario Regulation 188/08.) 1 http://www.fsco.gov.on.ca/en/mortgage/Pages/2015‐amendments‐to‐oregs.aspx Chapter 18: Borrower D Disclosure 40 01 equirement to disclose conflicts of interest was ameended to repllace "any con nflict of The re intere est" with "anyy conflict of in nterest or pottential conflicct of interest.." (This is req quired under sub‐se ections 27(1) and 40(3)5 of o Ontario Reggulation 188//08.) The principal amou unt in the req quirement concerning adv ance paymen nt by a borrow wer has been amen nded to $400,000 or less. (TThis is require ed under subb‐section 37(11) of Ontario Regulation 188/0 08.) es and proced dures on frau ud prevention n have been aadded to the ttopics that m must be Policie coverred in a broke erage's written policies and d procedures . (This is requ uired under su ubsection 40(3)((8) of Ontario o Regulation 188/08.) 1 18.2 2 Comple eting the Borrowe er Disclos sure Document Wha at Must be b Disclos sed The MBLAA M states that the borrrower disclosure must incllude the follo owing informaation: 1. Fees and payme ents associate ed with the mortgage m 2. The relationship p between th he brokerage and lender unnder the prop posed mortgaage 3. The role of the brokerage 4. The number of lenders the brokerage b rep presented durring the previous year 5. Po otential conflicts of interest 6. Rissks associated d with the pro oposed mortggage 7. Terms and cond ditions of the proposed mo ortgage 8. Esttimated costss 9. The cost of borrrowing 1. Fees F and pa ayments associated a with the m mortgage The MBLAA M and Reegulations speak to severaal topics relat ed to fees an nd other paym ments: representation of fees f and costts, disclosure of fees in wriiting to a borrrower, disclosure of the cost of o borrowing and acceptingg payments. Each is descrribed below. Sectio ons 20 – 23 off Regulation 188/08 1 speciffy that a brokkerage is not aallowed to make any form m of rep presentation that t any fees or costs payaable to the brrokerage (in cconnection w with carrying on the e business of dealing or trading in morttgages or actiing as a mortgage lender) are set or appro oved by any government g authority, unle ess they are i n respect to d disbursements to register or dep posit instrum ments under th he Land Titless Act or the R Registry Act. Pa ause for cla arification n – Fees aree not regu ulated Th he MBLAA maakes it clear th hat a brokerage cannot staate or insinuaate that a bro okerage fee is sett or approved d by the gove ernment or an ny governing body. The M MBLAA doesn’t state what is a minimum or o maximum fee, f nor does it state whatt is appropriatte to be chargged; this is up p to the brokeragge. However,, section 347 of the Criminnal Code makees it a criminaal offense to nd costs payable by the charge in excesss of 60%, which for a morttgage includees the fees an bo orrower in add dition to the interest chargged by the le nder. This figgure is repressented in the bo orrower disclo osure as the cost c of borrow wing. 402 Chapter 18: Borrower Disclosure A brokerage must disclose, in writing, to a borrower if the brokerage, broker or agent may, or will, receive a fee or other remuneration in connection with the mortgage or a mortgage renewal, from whom it may or will be received and the basis for calculating the amount. The borrower must acknowledge in writing that he or she has received this disclosure. The same disclosure applies if the brokerage may, or will, pay any fee or other remuneration to another person or entity in connection with the mortgage or mortgage renewal. As per Sections 37 – 39 of Regulation 188/08, a brokerage cannot accept an advance payment from the borrower on transactions where the principal amount of the mortgage is $400,000 or less. If funds are received and are considered deemed trust funds (funds that are payable to another party) the brokerage must provide a written statement to the person or entity providing the funds. Example: You are arranging a mortgage for a client who requires a private second mortgage. The client wants to pay cash for the appraisal. You have ordered the appraisal but the client has said he won’t be home at the time of the appraisal and that his son will be giving the appraiser access to the home. The client doesn’t want to leave the cash with his son, preferring to give the cash to you to pay the appraiser. Under these circumstances this money would be deemed to be trust funds because it is being given to you but is meant for another party. Therefore you would have to deposit it into your brokerage’s trust account and give your client a written statement that explains if interest is being paid and when this money will be paid either to the appraiser or returned to him. In this scenario the best solution would be for the client to leave a cheque with his son payable to the appraiser, or be at the home with cash when the appraiser arrives. As you can see, handling trust funds is a considerable responsibility. Fees and Payments ‐ sample clauses Where the brokerage is receiving a fee from the lender and/or other remunerations, such as points or volume bonus to which the broker/agent will be paid a percentage, a clause may be worded as follows: REMIC Mortgages Inc. will receive a fee and/or other remuneration by the lender on completion of this transaction based on a percentage of the loan proceeds to which the broker/agent is entitled a percentage. Where the brokerage is paying a referral fee to another party for obtaining the transaction a clause may be worded as follows: REMIC Mortgages will pay a fee to Mortgage Referrals Inc. on completion of this transaction based on a percentage of the loan proceeds. 2. The relationship between the brokerage and lender under the proposed mortgage A brokerage is required to disclose to the borrower, in writing, the “nature of the relationship between the brokerage and each lender” under the proposed mortgage, including if the brokerage is the lender. Disclosure must be made in writing and the recipient of the disclosure must acknowledge the disclosure in writing. Chapter 18: Borrower Disclosure 403 Relationship between brokerage and lender – sample clauses Where the brokerage is the lender a clause may be worded as follows: REMIC Mortgages Inc. is the lender under this proposed mortgage. Where the brokerage is the owner of the lender, such as a separate corporation a clause may be worded as follows: The lender under this proposed mortgage is a subsidiary of REMIC Mortgages Inc. 3. The role of the brokerage Section 18 of Regulation 188/08 states that the brokerage must disclose, in writing to a prospective borrower or lender the following information about the nature of its relationship with borrowers and lenders: 1. Information about whether, and when, the brokerage is acting as a representative of the lender but not the borrower in a transaction. 2. Information about whether, and when, the brokerage is acting as a representative of the borrower but not the lender in a transaction. 3. Information about whether, and when, the brokerage is acting as a representative of both the borrower and the lender in a transaction and is not giving preference to the interests of either. This does not apply when the brokerage is the mortgage lender. Role of the brokerage – sample clauses Clauses may be worded as follows: REMIC Mortgages Inc. is acting solely on behalf of the lender in this mortgage transaction. REMIC Mortgages Inc. is acting solely on behalf of the borrower in this mortgage transaction. REMIC Mortgages Inc. is acting on behalf of both the lender and the borrower in arranging this mortgage transaction. 4. The number of lenders the brokerage represented during the previous year Section 19.1 of Regulation 188/08 states that the brokerage must disclose, “in writing to a borrower the number of lenders on whose behalf the brokerage acted as a representative during the previous fiscal year and shall indicate whether the brokerage itself was a lender.” In addition, section 19.3 of Regulation 188/08 states that upon request, “a brokerage shall disclose the following information in writing to a borrower: 1. Whether the brokerage itself was the lender for more than 50 per cent of the total number of mortgages and mortgage renewals completed by the brokerage during the previous fiscal year. 2. The name of the lender, if any, with whom the brokerage arranged mortgages during the previous fiscal year if the mortgages constituted more than 50 per cent of the total number of mortgages and mortgage renewals completed by the brokerage during the previous fiscal year. O. Reg. 188/08, s. 19 (3).” 404 Chapter 18: Borrower D Disclosure ber of lenders dealt with in i the previou us year – sam mple clauses Numb Clauses may be wo orded as follo ows: ortgages Inc. acted a as a mo ortgage lendeer and represented XX lend ders in 20__. REMIC Mo REMIC Mo ortgages Inc. acted a as the lender l in morre than 50% oof its transacttions in 20__. REMIC Mo ortgages Inc. arranged a oveer 50% of its trransactions tthrough (nam me of lender) in n 20__. 5. Potential P Conflicts C off interest The brokerage must disclose to o a borrower, lender or invvestor in the ttransaction, aany potential conflict of interest that the brokerage may have. h Pa ause for cla arification n – Conflictt of interesst A potential p conf nflict of intereest is present when a brok erage, brokerr or agent has a direct or ind direct interest in the mortggage being arrranged resullting in a situaation where tthe broker/agent must m choose between b his or o her best intterests and th he interests o of his or her orrower, invesstor or lenderr, as the case may be. bo Conflicts of interesst – sample clauses c Wherre the brokeraage/broker/agent is relate ed to the lendder a clause m may be wordeed as follows: The brokera age/broker/agent in this trransaction is the (state thee specific nature of the relationship p to the lendeer such as wifee, husband, bbrother, sisterr, director, etcc.) of the lender. Wherre the brokeraage/broker/agent will obtaain a benefit at a future daate a clause m may be worde ed as follows: The brokera age/broker/agent in this trransaction exxpects to (statte the specificc nature of th he benefit such h as “obtain a stake in the mortgage”, “receive a finnancial or non n‐financial payment,” etc.) e in relatio on to this tran nsaction at a future date. Wherre the broker//agent has so old the borrow wer a higher rrate than thee lender’s low west rate to obtain n some beneffit a clause may m be worded d as follows: The broker//agent in this transaction will w receive a higher fee annd/or other reemuneration for providin ng you with a rate higher than the lendeer’s lowest raate based on yyour application. 6. Risks R assocciated with h the propo osed mortg gage Risk tolerance is a concept that identifies the e borrower’s acceptable leevel of risk. TThere are two o fundaamental requiirements whe en considering risk: undersstanding the borrower’s ggeneral level o of accep ptable risk and d disclosing th he specific rissks associatedd with the mo ortgage beingg recom mmended by the t broker/aggent. This requirement is described in section 25.1 of Regulation n 188/0 08, Mortgagee Brokerages: Standards off Practice, whhich states thaat, “A brokeraage shall disclo ose in writing to a borrowe er, lender or investor, as thhe case may b be, the materrial risks of each mortgage or investment in n a mortgage that the brokkerage presents for the co onsideration o of the bo orrower, lend der or investo or.” Furthermore, in itss October 24, 2008 webinaar, FSCO clearrly stated thaat it if a brokeerage is using a standardized disclo osure form it may consider providing thhe disclosure of risks in a ccover letter. Chapter 18: Borrower Disclosure 405 Regardless of how the disclosure is made it must be directly relevant to the specific mortgage being recommended. Risks – sample clauses Variable rate mortgage: The mortgage being recommended is a variable rate mortgage. This type of mortgage has inherent risks which you must be made aware of. These risks include the possibility of the interest rate rising, based on market conditions. To prevent the possibility of negative amortization, an increase in the interest rate may require you to increase the amount of your periodic payment; reduce the total amount of the loan amount then owing by making a lump sum payment sufficient to reduce such total amount to a point below the designated amount; or convert the mortgage to a fixed rate mortgage having equal monthly payments. If you are unable to take any of these actions then the mortgage, at the lender’s option, may immediately become due and payable. Extended amortization: The mortgage being recommended has an extended amortization (an amortization in excess of 25 years) of XX years. If you do not reduce this amortization period on renewal of the mortgage, you may pay substantially more in interest over the lifetime of this mortgage than you would on a mortgage with a 25 year amortization. If you decide to keep the extended amortization over the life of this mortgage and do not make any additional prepayments, you will pay $_____ more than you would have on a mortgage with a 25 year amortization. Shortened amortization: The mortgage being recommended has an amortization period less than that for which you qualify. While this will decrease the amount of interest that you pay the lender over the life of this mortgage, you may be at risk of financial hardship due to the impact of a higher mortgage payment on your cash flow. If your financial situation changes during the term of this mortgage and you are unable to meet your payment obligations you may not be able to decrease your mortgage payment without refinancing this mortgage, which may result in additional costs to you such as prepayment penalties, legal fees and/or other costs associated with refinancing. High TDS ratio: The mortgage being recommended allows you to have a higher total debt service ratio than typically allowed in the mortgage industry. By having a total debt service ratio of XX you may be at risk of financial hardship due to a reduced amount of cash flow and/or disposable income than you would have had if you had taken a mortgage with lower payments and/or if you had fewer monthly obligations. Interest only mortgage: The mortgage being recommended is an interest only mortgage. This means that you will not be reducing the amount of your outstanding principal during the term of this mortgage, resulting in the same amount owing at the end of the term as was borrowed at the beginning of the term. By not reducing the principal outstanding, you may be at risk of having less equity in your property than you would have had if you had taken an amortized mortgage if the value of your property remains the same or decreases. 406 Chapter 18: Borrower Disclosure Accelerated mortgage payment: The mortgage being recommended has an accelerated mortgage payment, which is a payment that is higher than that of a non‐accelerated mortgage payment. This may put you at risk of financial hardship due to a reduced amount of cash flow and/or disposable income than you would have had if you had taken a mortgage with lower payments. Cash back option The mortgage being recommended has a cash back option which provides you a lump sum of cash on closing. This option may put you at risk of having to repay some or all of this amount if you repay this mortgage before the end of the term. For example, if you repay this mortgage in the twelfth month you will be required to pay to the lender, in addition to any other penalties that may be charged, a pro‐rated amount of $____ which may hinder your ability to repay this mortgage before the term expires. Closed mortgage: The mortgage being recommended is closed. This means that you can only repay the mortgage before the term expires if you sell your property. You cannot refinance the mortgage before the term expires. This option may put you at risk of not being able to refinance this mortgage if interest rates decrease, if you wish to refinance your mortgage with another lender during the term, or if you need to repay this mortgage for any other reason other than sale of the property during the term of this mortgage. Failure to abide by the terms and conditions of the Standard Charge Terms: Every mortgage has terms and conditions which a borrower must abide by. You understand that this mortgage contains a set of Standard Charge Terms that governs your rights and obligations under this mortgage contract. There is a risk to you if you fail to meet these obligations which may include penalties assessed by the lender or an action to remedy the contravention by the lender’s use of the power of sale process. 7. Terms and conditions of the proposed mortgage As stated in section 24 of the MBLAA, in regards to term mortgages the brokerage must disclose the prepayment privileges, if any rebates are being made for a cost included in the cost of borrowing, if any charges or penalties are chargeable if prepayment is made, if any regular payment is missed, or the mortgage is not paid in full at maturity, and if the borrower has any rights or obligations under the mortgage related to these items. If the brokerage is also a lender, it may impose charges on the borrower, in addition to the interest charged, for the sole purpose of recovering the costs reasonably incurred for legal expenses and expenses related to processing a dishonoured cheque, if applicable. If the brokerage is acting as the lender in the transaction and requires the borrower to obtain insurance, it must inform the borrower that he or she may purchase insurance through any lawful provider, unless the brokerage has reasonable grounds to disapprove of the provider. Terms and Conditions – sample clauses A clause may be worded as follows: This mortgage contains the following terms and conditions: o If you repay this mortgage before the term expires you must pay a 3 month interest penalty or the interest rate differential, whichever is higher Chapter 18: Borrower D Disclosure o o o o o 40 07 Dish honoured payyments will be charged a $$XX NSF fee bby the lender You u are permitteed to make a lump sum paayment, crediited directly to o the outtstanding prin ncipal amount of this morttgage at the ttime of the pa ayment, in thee amount of XX% of o the origina al mortgage aamount once per calendar year You u are not allow wed to rent or o lease your pproperty withhout the writtten autthorization off the lender. You u must mainta ain your prop perty, pay youur property taaxes and main ntain accceptable property insurancce at all timess. Failure to ddo so can be cconsidered deffault by the leender. You u must abide by all of the terms t and connditions as exxpressed in th his mortgage’’s Standard Chargee Terms. Failure to do so ccan be considdered default by the lenderr. 8. Estimated E costs c Regullation 188/08 8, Mortgage Brokerages: B Standards of PPractice descrribes how info ormation must be disclosed if it is unknow wn. Section 34 3 of the Reg ulation statess that: (1) Th he information to be disclo osed under th his Regulationn to a borrower, lender or investor mayy be an estimate or may be based d upon an asssumption if, w when the discclosure is mad de, the broke erage cannot know the acttual informatiion to be discclosed and if tthe estimate or assumptio on is reasonable. (2) If the informattion disclosed d under this Regulation to a borrower, llender or inveestor is an estimate or is base ed upon an asssumption, th he brokerage shall so notiffy the borrow wer, lender or investtor, as the casse may be, in writing. mated costs – sample clausses Estim Wherre the cost of legal fees is unknown u a clause may be worded as fo ollows: “Estimated legal fees of $____ plus disbursementss” “Estimated legal fees of $____ including disbursem ments” 9. The T cost off borrowing g Disclo osure of the cost c of borrow wing is critical for compliannce purposess and is covereed in Regullation 191/08 8. The MBLAA A outlines thaat the cost of borrowing m must include the interest rate and a any amou unt payable by the borrow wer in connecttion with the mortgage. TThe MBLAA allows for certain items i to be exxcluded from m the cost of bborrowing, ass detailed in the Regulation n. Pa ause for cllarification n – The cosst of borro owing: dolllars and ceents While W the cost of borrowingg must be discclosed as an aannual percen ntage rate, seection 8.1 of Reegulation 191 1/08 states that it must alsso be discloseed in dollars aand cents oveer the course off the term forr all fixed and variable rate e mortgages. The MBLAA M imposes requireme ents on what constitutes thhe cost of borrowing and how it must be expressed, as well w as items of o additional disclosure. d TThe MBLAA sttates that a brrokerage musst disclo ose the cost of borrowing based b on the assumption tthat all obligaations of the b borrower aree met and a that it be expressed ass a rate per an nnum, exceptt if indicated otherwise byy regulation. In add dition, section n 27 prohibitss advertising the cost of boorrowing unleess it contains information n as req quired by Reg gulation 191/0 /08. This Regu ulation clearlyy describes w what informattion must be provid ded to borrow wers and how w it is to be prrovided. 408 Chapter 18: Borrower D Disclosure ost of borrow wing is calculaated using the e formula: The co APR = C / (T x P) x 1 00 in which, e rate cost of borrowing, “APR” meaans the annuaal percentage t of all costs legally req quired to be ddisclosed, “C” is the total a of the principal off the mortgagge outstandin ng at the end of each perio od “P” is the average for the calculation of in nterest under the mortgag e, before sub btracting any payment that hat time, and is due at th t of the mortgage m in ye ears, expresseed to at leastt two decimall points. “T” is the term The APR A may be ro ounded off to o the nearest eighth of a peer cent and iff the mortgagge is a variable rate mortgage m (VRM), the rate as a of the date e of the calcuulation must b be used. In ad ddition, the cost of o borrowing for a line of credit c or crediit card is the aannual rate that applies on the date off the diisclosure. Pa ause for cllarification n – Calcula ating the A APR/cost off borrowin ng While W the form mula to calculaate the APR appears a straigghtforward, itt cannot be caalculated ussing a regular calculator. This T is due to the fact that “P” represen nts the averagge principal o of the mortgage outstanding o at a the end of each e period. In other worrds, one mustt calculate thee ou utstanding baalance at the end e of each payment, p addd them all and d divide by the number of paayments to arrrive at “P.” This T calculatio on is no differrent than req quired under tthe previous Mortgage M agen nts Act; there efore all mortggage originattion software should continue to acccurately calculate the APR R/cost of borrrowing for thee broker/ageent. Cos st of Borr owing/AP PR – Incl uded and d Exclude ed Items The general rule is that costs asssociated with h obtaining a mortgage, su uch as those llisted below, must be included in the cost of borrowing, while w all otherr costs, such aas costs assocciated with buying a home, are e not included. Specifically, items that must be inclu uded in the ccost of borro owing/APR calculation inclu ude: administrative charges c including charges for services, transactions or any other activity in m rellation to the mortgage law wyer’s fees, in ncluding disbursements, fo or a lawyer hiired by the leender and paid by the bo orrower (the majority m of caases) inssurance chargges, excludingg those below w appraisal, inspeection or survey costs payaable by the boorrower, wheen required by the lender Itemss not included d in the Cost of o Borrowing//APR calculattion include: op ptional insuran nce charges, or if the borrower is the bbeneficiary (su uch as properrty insurance) charges for ove erdrafts charges to regisster documen nts penalties for prrepaying the mortgage m d to the transsaction or forr the borroweer’s own additional services of a lawyer not related wyer law titlle insurance where w the bo orrower has ch hosen the proovider and is the beneficiaary appraisals, inspections or surveys ordered d directly by, and received d by, the borrrower Chapter 18: Borrower D Disclosure 40 09 default insurance premiums for high‐ratio o mortgages charges for tax accounts that are optionaal or required for a high‐ratio mortgagee any charges to discharge d a se ecurity intere est, or default chargess Disc closure u nder Spe ecific Cir cumstancces The Regulation R is very v explicit about a the info ormation thatt must be pro ovided in the following circum mstances: 1. Fixxed interest mortgage m for a fixed amount 2. Variable interesst mortgage for f a fixed am mount 3. Lin ne of credit 4. Cre edit card applications 5. Cre edit cards Each is i detailed be elow. The folllowing inform mation is takeen directly fro om the Regula ation and must be included in every disclo osure document provided to the borrower in these mstances. circum 1. Disclosure D ‐ Fixed inteerest morttgage for a fixed am mount Regullation 191/08 8, Section 8, subsection 1 states s that a m mortgage bro okerage that eenters into orr arranges a mortgage for a fixed d interest rate e for a fixed a mount, (for eexample a partially amorttized, blended, constant payment p morttgage with a ffixed rate, as discussed in chapter 3) to o be rep paid on a fixe ed future date e or by instalm ment paymennts, must givee the borroweer an initial disclo osure stateme ent that includ des the follow wing informattion: 1. The principal am mount of the mortgage 2. The amount of each advance e of the princcipal and wheen each advan nce is to be m made 3. The total amount of all paym ments 4. The cost of borrrowing over the t term of th he mortgage, expressed in n dollars and ccents 5. The term of the e mortgage, and the period d of amortizaation if it is diffferent from tthe term 6. The annual inte erest rate and d the circumsttances, if anyy, under which h it is compou unded 7. The APR, if it difffers from the e annual interest rate 8. The date on and d after which interest is ch harged and innformation co oncerning anyy period during which interest does not n accrue 9. The amount of each paymen nt and when it i is due 10.The fact that eaach payment made on the mortgage m ust be applied first to the accumulated d cost of borrowing and then to t the outstanding princippal 11.An n amortization n schedule fo or the term off the mortgagge showing th he principal am mount, the due date and am mount of eacch periodic paayment, the pportion of eacch periodic paayment that is charged as interest or is app plied on princiipal, the outs tanding balan nce of the mo ortgage after each periodic payment and the t principal amount at m maturity 12.Infformation abo out any optio onal service in n relation to tthe mortgagee that the borrrower acccepts, the chaarges for each h optional service and thee conditions u under which the borrower maay cancel the service, if thaat information is not discloosed in a sepaarate statement before th he op ptional service e is provided 13.The information n required byy paragraphs 1 to 4 of secttion 24 of the Act, includin ng a description of any a components of a formula used to caalculate a reb bate, charge o or penalty to be imposed on the borrower if the borrow wer exercisess a right to reepay the amount borrowed d before the maturity of the mortgage m 410 Chapter 18: Borrower Disclosure 14.If section 16 of this Regulation applies with respect to the mortgage, the formula set out in subsection 16 (3) 15.The particulars of the charges or penalties referred to in paragraph 5 of section 24 of the Act, including default charges that may be imposed under section 17 of this Regulation 16.The property in which the lender takes a security interest under the mortgage 17.Any charge for a brokerage, if the brokerage charges are included in the amount borrowed and are paid directly by the lender to the brokerage 18.The fact that there is a charge to discharge a security interest and the amount of the charge on the day that the statement was provided 19.The nature and amount of any charge other than an interest charge. O. Reg. 191/08, s. 8 (1). (2) If the outstanding balance of the mortgage is increased because the borrower has missed a scheduled instalment payment or because a default charge is levied on the borrower for missing a scheduled instalment payment, such that the amount of each of the subsequently scheduled instalment payments does not cover the interest accrued during the period for which a payment is scheduled, and if the brokerage is a lender under the mortgage, the brokerage must give the borrower a subsequent disclosure statement not more than 30 days after the missed payment or the imposition of the default charge that describes the situation and its consequences. O. Reg. 191/08, s. 8 (2). 2. Disclosure ‐ Variable interest mortgage for a fixed amount Regulation 191/08, Section 9, subsection 1 states that a mortgage brokerage that enters into or arranges a mortgage with a variable interest rate for a fixed amount, (for example, the variable rate mortgages discussed in chapter 3) to be repaid on a fixed future date or by instalment payments, must give the borrower an initial disclosure statement that includes the following information: 1. The information described in section 1 above for a fixed interest rate for a fixed amount 2. The annual rate of interest that applies on the date of the disclosure statement 3. The method for determining the annual interest rate that applies after the date of the disclosure statement and when that determination is made 4. The amount of each payment based on the annual interest rate that applies on the date of the disclosure statement and the dates when those payments are due 5. The total amount of all payments and of the cost of borrowing based on the annual interest rate that applies on the date of the disclosure statement 6. If the loan is to be paid by instalment payments and the amount to be paid is not adjusted automatically to reflect changes in the annual interest rate that apply to each instalment payment (for example, a variable rate mortgage with fixed payments), i.the annual interest rate above which the amount of a scheduled instalment payment on the initial principal does not cover the interest due on the instalment payment, and ii. the fact that negative amortization is possible 7. If the loan does not have regularly‐scheduled payments, i.the conditions that must occur for the entire outstanding balance, or part of it, to become due, or ii. the provisions of the mortgage that set out those conditions. O. Reg. 191/08, s. 9 (1) (2) If the variable interest rate for the loan is determined by adding or subtracting a fixed percentage rate of interest to or from a public index that is a variable rate, and if the brokerage is the lender under the mortgage, the brokerage must give the borrower an additional disclosure statement at least once every 12 months that contains the following information: Chapter 18: Borrower Disclosure 411 1. The annual interest rate at the beginning and end of the period covered by the disclosure statement 2. The outstanding balance at the beginning and end of the period covered by the disclosure statement 3. The amount of each instalment payment due under a payment schedule and the time when each payment is due, based on the annual interest rate that applies at the end of the period covered by the disclosure statement. O. Reg. 191/08, s. 9 (2) (3) If the variable interest rate for the mortgage is determined by a method other than that referred to in subsection (2), and if the brokerage is the lender under the mortgage, the brokerage must give the borrower an additional disclosure statement no more than 30 days after increasing the annual interest rate by more than 1 per cent above the most recently disclosed rate and the disclosure statement must contain the following information: 1. The new annual interest rate and the date on which it takes effect 2. The amount of each instalment payment and the time when each payment is due, for payments that are affected by the new annual interest rate. O. Reg. 191/08, s. 9 (3) 3. Disclosure ‐ Line of credit Regulation 191/08, Section 10, subsection 1 states that a mortgage brokerage that enters into or arranges a mortgage securing a line of credit must give the borrower an initial disclosure statement that includes the following information: 1. The initial credit limit, if it is known at the time the disclosure is made 2. The annual interest rate, or the method for determining it if it is variable 3. The nature and amounts of any non‐interest charges 4. The minimum payment during each payment period or the method for determining it 5. Each period for which a statement of account is to be provided 6. The date on and after which interest accrues and information concerning any grace period that applies 7. The particulars of the charges or penalties referred to in paragraph 5 of section 24 of the Act, including default charges that may be imposed under section 17 of this Regulation 8. The property in which the lender takes a security interest under the mortgage 9. Information about any optional service in relation to the mortgage that the borrower accepts, the charges for each optional service and the conditions under which the borrower may cancel the service, if that information is not disclosed in a separate statement before the optional service is provided 10.A local or toll‐free telephone number, or a telephone number with a prominent indication that collect calls are accepted, that the borrower may use to get information about the account during the lender’s regular business hours 11.Any charge for a brokerage, if the brokerage’s charges are included in the amount borrowed and are paid directly by the lender to the brokerage. O. Reg. 191/08, s. 10 (1) (2) If the initial credit limit is not known when the initial disclosure statement is made, and if the brokerage is a lender under the mortgage, the brokerage must disclose it, (a) in the first statement of account provided to the borrower; or (b) in a separate statement that the borrower receives on or before the date on which the borrower receives that first statement of account. O. Reg. 191/08, s. 10 (2) 412 Chapter 18: Borrower Disclosure (3) Subject to subsection (4), if the brokerage is a lender under the mortgage, the brokerage must give the borrower an additional disclosure statement at least once a month that contains the following information: 1. The period covered by the disclosure statement and the opening and closing balances in the period 2. An itemized statement of account that discloses each amount credited or charged, including interest, and the dates when those amounts were posted to the account 3. The sum for payments and the sum for credit advances and interest and other charges 4. The annual interest rate that applied on each day in the period and the total of interest charged at those rates in the period 5. The credit limit and the amount of credit available at the end of the period 6. The minimum payment and its due date 7. The borrower’s rights and obligations regarding any billing error that may appear in the statement of account 8. A local or toll‐free telephone number, or a telephone number with a prominent indication that collect calls are accepted, that the borrower may use to get information about the account during the brokerage’s regular business hours. O. Reg. 191/08, s. 10 (3) (4) The additional disclosure statements described in subsection (3) are not required for a period during which there are no advances or payments and, (a) there is no outstanding balance at the end of the period; or (b) the borrower has notice that the mortgage has been suspended or cancelled due to default and the lender has demanded payment of the outstanding balance. O. Reg. 191/08, s. 10 (4) 4. Disclosure ‐ Credit card applications Regulation 191/08, Section 11, subsection 1 states that a mortgage brokerage that issues a credit card secured by a mortgage or arranges a mortgage securing a credit card and distributes an application form for credit cards must specify the following information in the application form or in a document accompanying it, including the date on which each of the matters mentioned takes effect: 1. The annual interest rate for a credit card with a fixed rate of interest 2. If the credit card does not have a fixed rate of interest, the fact that the variable interest rate is determined by adding or subtracting a fixed percentage rate of interest to or from a public index, the public index and the fixed percentage rate to be added or subtracted from it 3. The day on and after which interest accrues and information concerning any grace period that applies 4. The amount of any charges other than interest charges. O. Reg. 191/08, s. 11 (1) (2) Subsection (1) does not apply if, on the application form or in a document accompanying it, the mortgage brokerage prominently discloses, (a) a local or toll‐free telephone number, or a telephone number with a prominent indication that collect calls are accepted, that the borrower may use to get information required by subsection (1) during the mortgage brokerage’s regular business hours, and (b) the fact that the applicant may obtain the information otherwise required by subsection (1) at that telephone number. O. Reg. 191/08, s. 11 (2) Chapter 18: Borrower Disclosure 413 (3) If an individual applies for a credit card by telephone or any electronic means, the mortgage brokerage must give the applicant the information required by paragraphs 1 and 4 of subsection (1) when the application is made. O. Reg. 191/08, s. 11 (3) (4) If a mortgage brokerage solicits applications for credit cards secured by a mortgage in person, by mail, by telephone or by any electronic means, the information required by paragraphs 1 and 4 of subsection (1) must be disclosed at the time of the solicitation. O. Reg. 191/08, s. 11 (4) 5. Disclosure ‐ Credit cards Regulation 191/08, Section 12, subsection 1 states that a mortgage brokerage that enters into or arranges a mortgage secured by a credit card must give the borrower an initial disclosure statement that includes the following information: 1. The information described in paragraphs 1 and 3 to 11 of subsection 10 (1) 2. The manner in which interest is calculated and the information required by paragraph 1 or 2, as the case may be, of subsection 11 (1) 3. If the credit agreement requires the borrower to pay the outstanding balance in full on receiving a statement of account, i. mention of that requirement, ii. the grace period by the end of which the borrower must have paid that balance, and iii. the annual interest rate charged on any outstanding balance not paid when due 4. If a lost or stolen credit card is used in an unauthorized manner, the fact that the maximum liability of the borrower is the lesser of $50 and the maximum set by the credit agreement 5. If a transaction is entered into at an automated teller machine by using the borrower's personal identification number, the fact that the liability incurred by the transaction is the borrower’s maximum liability, despite paragraph 4 6. If the mortgage brokerage has received a report from the borrower, whether written or verbal, of a lost or stolen credit card, the fact that the borrower is not liable for any transaction entered into through the use of the card after the mortgage brokerage receives the report. O. Reg. 191/08, s. 12 (1) (2) If the initial credit limit is not known when the initial disclosure statement is made, the mortgage brokerage must disclose it, (a) in the first statement of account provided to the borrower, or (b) in a separate statement that the borrower receives on or before the date on which the borrower receives that first statement of account. O. Reg. 191/08, s. 12 (2) (3) Despite section 13, if a credit agreement for a credit card is amended, the mortgage brokerage must give the borrower a written statement at least 30 days before the amendment takes effect, and the statement must set out the changes to the information that was required to be given to the borrower in the initial disclosure statement, excluding information about the following changes: 1. Any change in the credit limit 2. Any extension to the grace period 3. Any decrease in charges other than interest charges and default charges referred to in paragraphs 3 and 7 of subsection 10 (l) 4. Any change concerning information about any optional service in relation to the credit agreement that is referred to in paragraph 9 of subsection 10 (1) 414 Chapter 18: Borrower D Disclosure 5. Any change in a variable interest rate referred to iin paragraph 2 of subsecttion 11 (1) as a result of a change c in th he public index referred tto in that paaragraph. O O. Reg. 191/08 8, s. 12 (3) How w Disclosu re Must be b Made Broke erages must provide p writte en disclosure to borrowerss (as per sectiions 6 of Regulation 191/0 08) that meetts the followin ng four key re equirements: 1. it may m be a sepaarate docume ent or part off another doccument 2. in cases where amounts required to be disclosed cannnot reasonablly be known, disclosure maay be based on o an assump ption or estimate, as long aas the assump ption or estim mate is reaasonable and the borrowe er is told that it is an assum mption or estiimate 3. it must m be writtten in clear, plain p language e that brings tthe required information tto the atttention of the e borrower 4. it may m be provid ded electronically, provide ed that the boorrower conssents in writin ng Whe en Disclos ure Must be Made Disclo osure must be e provided to the borrowe er at least twoo business days before thee borrower is requirred to make any a payment or enter into o the mortgagge agreementt; however, th he two business days mayy be waived iff the borrowe er consents inn writing and tthe disclosure is still madee before the borrow wer is required d to make anyy payment orr enter into th he mortgage aagreement. Pa ause for cla arification n – What disclosure d d documentss must be given to th he borroweer? Th he MBLAA req quires that wh hen the borro ower signs thee borrower d disclosure doccument the mo ortgage agent must give th he borrower: 1. A signe ed copy of the e borrower disclosure, andd 2. An amo ortization schedule for the e full term of tthe proposed d mortgage While most mo ortgage agents will also leaave a copy of the lender’s ccommitment, they are on nly legally required to leave e these two documents. d 18.3 3 Sample e Borrow wer Disclo osure Discla aimer: The fo ollowing samp ple borrower disclosure doocuments aree intended for illustration purpo oses only and are not warrranted to be compliant. c It is the respon nsibility of thee mortgage agentt to use only those t forms approved a by his h or her brookerage. Case Study S – Fixed d rate mortgaage The fo ollowing is a case c study that is used to provide p an exxample of thee potential dissclosure docum ment for use by a brokeragge arranging a fixed rate m mortgage for a borrower. m Coren is a liccensed mortggage agent wiith REMIC Moortgages Inc. Adam has reecently Adam arranged a fixed raate mortgage with constan nt payments ffor his clientss, Noreen and d Christopherr Borro ower to purch hase a new ho ome in Torontto. Adam is nnot charging a brokerage ffee since he iss being paid directlyy by the lende er. Given thiss scenario Adaam has comp pleted a borro ower disclo osure docume ent as provide ed by REMIC Mortgages Innc. The first d document bellow is the 415 Chapter 18: Borrower Disclosure lender’s commitment letter. The following document is the borrower disclosure based on this commitment letter. Figure 97 – Sample mortgage commitment Letter for use in disclosure Mortgage Commitment Response: December 15, 2012 Page 1 of 4 Broker Information Name: Address: Attention: REMIC Mortgages Inc. 2175 Sheppard Avenue East, Suite 213, Toronto, ON, M2J 1W8 Adam Coren Application Reference Number: 1213456‐789 Lender Information Name: SuperBank Address: 2750 Yonge Street, Suite 6500, Toronto, ON, M1M 1M1 Lender Reference #: 1213456‐789 Mortgage Insurance Reference #: TBD TBD means To Be Determined Applicant Information Applicant(s): Noreen Borrower, Christopher Borrower Property Information Address: 1234 Queen Lane, Toronto, ON, M1S 1M1 With reference to the above noted property SuperBank is pleased to provide the following mortgage loan offer, subject to the following terms and conditions: Loan Terms Purchase Value: $237,500.00 Down payment: $11,875.00 Amount: $225,525.00 Insurance Premium Total Loan: $6,201.94 $231,726.94 Other Mortgages: N/A Product: Mortgage Type: Term Type: Interest Rate (compounded semi‐ annually): Term (months): Amortization (months): Frequency: Payment First Principal and Interest: Closed Taxes (Estimated) 5.390% Taxes Paid By: 60 Total Installment: $1,399.64 $149.58 lender 1,549.22 300 Monthly Commitment Expires 12/22/2012 Supersizer Cashback: N/A Closing Date: 03/01/2013 LENDER AUTHORIZATION All of our normal requirements and, if applicable, those of the mortgage insurer must be met. All costs including legal, survey, mortgage insurance, etc. are for the account of the applicant(s). The mortgage insurance premium (if applicable) will be added to the mortgage. This mortgage is subject to the details and terms outlines as well as the conditions described in the attached Schedule A. Approved by: John Underwriter, SuperBank Signature: _________________ Date: ________________ CLIENT ACCEPTANCE I/We the undersigned applicant(s) accept the terms of this mortgage as stated above and agree to fulfill the conditions of approval as outlined in the attached Schedule A to the lender’s satisfaction. I/We further certify that the information given on the mortgage application is true and correct. Applicant: Noreen Borrower Signature: _________________ Date: _________________ Applicant: Christopher Borrower Signature: _________________ Date: _________________ 416 Chapter 18: Borrower Disclosure Mortgage Commitment – SCHEDULE A ASSUMPTION POLICIES Page 2 of 4 Assumption Option: The transferee or purchaser may, upon completion of a mortgage application which meets our mortgage approval criteria then in effect, personally assume (with the consent of his or her spouse where required by law) all of your obligations under your mortgage by executing an assumption agreement in the form required by us. CONDITIONS Mortgage: The mortgage loan to be made to you shall be subject to all extended terms set forth in SuperBank’s standard form of mortgage contract, and loans insured by a mortgage insurer will be subject to the requirements of the Certificate of Insurance issued by the mortgage insurer. Property Taxes: If stipulated by us, you will pay us monthly, an amount which in our opinion is sufficient to enable us to pay the annual property taxes on your behalf by the due date for the first installment of the tax bill in each year, based on the estimated annual taxes. We shall withhold a tax holdback from our mortgage advance sufficient to accumulate the required credit in your tax account. Any tax bills issued and unpaid at the interest adjustment date shall be paid from the proceeds of the mortgage loan. Fire Insurance: We shall require evidence of replacement cost all‐risk insurance coverage acceptable to us, taken with an insurer not disapproved by us. Such policy must contain the standard Insurance Bureau of Canada mortgage clause and must indicate our interest as mortgagee. Title Insurance: A title insurance policy acceptable to us and obtained by our solicitor at your cost. Processing Fee and Costs: Whether or not this loan is funded, you agree to pay the processing fee specified herein, if any, and all legal, appraisal and survey costs incurred by you or us in this transaction. CMHC/GEMICO/Canada Guaranty Insurance Fee: Insurance Fee: You agree to pay any mortgage insurance fee, as indicated, and all applicable federal or provincial taxes thereon. Interest Adjustment: Interest shall accrue from the date the first advance is made. Interest due to the interest adjustment date will be simple interest calculated daily and will be deducted from the first advance Pre‐authorized Cheque Plan: You agree to make repayment under the mortgage by a 'pre‐authorized cheque plan' or by such other means as may be requested by us. Commitment: This commitment is not transferable by you and the benefit may not be assigned by you. It may be assigned by us. Representation and Warranty: You warrant to us, and it is a condition of this loan, that all information submitted by you or your broker to us in connection with your loan application is true and accurate, and you agree to supply promptly, on request, any further information concerning yourself, your financial standing or the property to be mortgaged, which may be required by us. Title: You represent and warrant to us, and it is a condition of this loan, that you have a good and marketable title to the property to be mortgaged, satisfactory in all aspects. Zoning and Work orders: It is a condition of this loan that the mortgaged property and the use thereof comply with all applicable government laws and regulations and that there are no outstanding work orders, notices or directives against the property. Construction Loan: In the case of a construction loan, advances will be made at our discretion and we will always retain sufficient funds to complete construction. New Homes: If this mortgage loan is for the purchase of a newly constructed home, our solicitor will be required to obtain a certified copy of the New Home Enrolment endorsed by HUDAC (or the equivalent enrolment in any governmental new home warranty programme in provinces other than Ontario) before making any mortgage advances. Date:______________________________ Initials:__________ Initials: __________ 417 Chapter 18: Borrower Disclosure Mortgage Commitment – SCHEDULE A Continued ASSUMPTION POLICIES Page 3 of 4 No agency: You acknowledge that we may assign this commitment or the mortgage to a third party and may receive a fee in connection with such assignment. We may also receive a fee in connection with the servicing of this loan. We are not acting as your agent or otherwise in any fiduciary capacity in relation to you in connection with the loan described herein. Solicitor and Documentation: The solicitor specified by us will act on our behalf in this transaction. You agree to deliver to our solicitor your title documents, insurance policy and survey as soon as possible. Entire Agreement: This commitment, when accepted by you, will constitute the entire agreement and understanding between you and us with respect to this loan and will supercede all other agreements or understandings, whether oral or written. Survival: You agree that the terms, conditions & covenants contained in this commitment shall survive and will not merge upon registration of the mortgage and the advance of funds thereunder but will remain valid and subsisting obligations. Information: You agree that we may conduct credit checks with consumer reporting agencies and make such other investigations and collect such other information concerning you as we may deem advisable, all such information to be used for the purpose of underwriting, assessing the risk associated with, and administering this mortgage loan. Privacy: You agree that we may share information concerning you with (a) any proposed assignee of this commitment or the mortgage loan, (b) our duly authorized agents and representatives who are engaged in the processing or servicing of your mortgage, (c) any parties necessary or desirable in connection with any sale or securitization of this mortgage loan and (d) organizations with which the lender has strategic alliances who may use such information to provide you from time to time with information on financial products which may be of interest to you. If you prefer that your personal information not be shared with any party referred to in this document or future documents, you may so advise us in writing at any time and we will not share the information with them. PAYMENT FLEXIBILITY OPTIONS Circle Payment Option: Weekly Bi‐weekly Semi‐monthly Monthly INSTRUCTIONS The terms and conditions of this mortgage commitment will form part of the solicitor’s instructions. OTHER Borrower disclosure required prior to funding Title to be taken in the name of Borrower, Noreen and Borrower, Christopher Subject to satisfactory confirmation of down payment. Subject to satisfactory confirmation of income. Subject to CMHC approval Subject to signed and dated mortgage application Receipt of satisfactory purchase agreement including all addendums and MLS listing. PORTABILITY OPTIONS If the mortgagor is not in default and has entered into an agreement to sell or transfer title to the mortgaged property, the mortgagor may exercise the Portability Option. Date:______________________________ Initials:__________ Initials: __________ 418 Chapter 18: Borrower Disclosure Mortgage Commitment – SCHEDULE A Continued PREPAYMENT POLICIES Page 4 of 4 Privileges: 15% per year & Double Up The Mortgagor, when not in default of any terms or conditions contained in the Mortgage, may prepay the whole of the principal sum then outstanding without notice upon payment to the Mortgagee of the greater of i) three months' interest at the interest rate on the principal sum outstanding; or ii) the amount, if any by which interest at the Interest rate exceeds interest at the Mortgagee's current interest rate for reinvestment calculated on the principal sum outstanding. Such amount to be calculated from the date of prepayment to the maturity date of the mortgage. RATE ADJUSTMENT POLICIES If five days prior to closing our interest rate is lower than the guaranteed interest rate, upon request, the lower rate will prevail. ADMINISTRATION AND SERVICE FEES NSFs, Stopped Payment, Returned Items: $150.00 Date:______________________________ Initials:__________ Initials: __________ Chapter 18: Borrower Disclosure 419 Figure 98 – Sample Borrower Disclosure document Borrower Disclosure Page 1 of 4 REMIC Mortgages Inc. To: Noreen Borrower, Christopher Borrower 1234 Borrower Lane, Toronto, ON, M1M 1M1 We are pleased to inform you that we have arranged the following mortgage on your behalf: Details of the mortgage we have arranged on your behalf Address of property to be mortgaged: 1234 Queen Lane, Toronto, ON, M1S 1M1 Purpose: Purchase Closing Date: 03/01/2013 Commitment Expires: 12/22/2012 Loan Terms Payment Purchase Value: $237,500.00 Mortgage Type: First Principal and $1,399.64 Interest: Down payment: $11,875.00 Term Type: Open on Penalty Taxes (Estimated) $149.58 Amount: $225,625.00 Interest Rate: Fixed at 5.390% Taxes Paid By: Lender Insurance $6,201.94 Compounding: Semi‐Annual Total Installment: 1,549.22 Premium Term (months): 60 Total Loan: $231,726.94 Amortization 300 Due Date: 1st of each month (months): Other Mortgages: N/A Frequency: Monthly Product: Supersizer All mortgage payments are applied to interest first, followed by principal Other Terms and Conditions Prepayment Privileges: When not in default of any terms or conditions contained in the mortgage, you may prepay the whole of the principal sum then outstanding without notice upon payment to the mortgagee of the greater of three months' interest at the interest rate on the principal sum outstanding; or the amount, if any by which interest at the Interest rate exceeds interest at the mortgagee's current interest rate for reinvestment calculated on the principal sum outstanding. Such amount to be calculated from the date of prepayment to the maturity date of the mortgage. 15% per year & Double Up Rate Guarantee If five days prior to closing our interest rate is lower than the guaranteed interest rate, upon request, the lower rate will prevail. Portability Option If the mortgagor is not in default and has entered into an agreement to sell or transfer title to the mortgaged property, the mortgagor may exercise the Portability Option. 420 Chapter 18: Borrower Disclosure Borrower Disclosure Continued Page 2 of 4 Assumability Option The transferee or purchaser may, upon completion of a mortgage application which meets our mortgage approval criteria then in effect, personally assume (with the consent of his or her spouse where required by law) all of your obligations under your mortgage by executing an assumption agreement in the form required by us. Administration and Service Fees NSFs, Stopped Payment, Returned Items: $150.00 Other Obligations You must maintain your property, pay your property taxes and maintain acceptable property insurance at all times. Failure to do so can be considered default by the lender. You must abide by all of the terms and conditions as expressed in this mortgage’s Standard Charge Terms. Failure to do so can be considered default by the lender. You understand that time is of the essence and that you must meet all of the terms and conditions of the attached mortgage approval. Failure to do so may result in cancellation of the mortgage commitment without recourse by you resulting in potential financial loss. Other information about your mortgage As with all mortgages borrowing involves a certain degree of risk. The potential risks associated with this mortgage include: Standard Charge Terms Every mortgage has terms and conditions which a borrower must abide by. You understand that this mortgage contains a set of Standard Charge Terms that governs your rights and obligations under this mortgage contract. There is a risk to you if you fail to meet these obligations which may include penalties assessed by the lender or an action to remedy the contravention by the lender’s use of the power of sale process. About REMIC Mortgages Inc. REMIC Mortgages Inc. will receive a fee and/or other remuneration by the lender on completion of this transaction based on a percentage of the loan proceeds to which the broker/agent is entitled a percentage. REMIC Mortgages Inc. is acting on behalf of both the lender and the borrower in arranging The cost of this mortgage transaction. borrowing is REMIC Mortgages Inc. acted as a mortgage lender and represented 23 lenders in 2011. expressed as a percentage… Cost of Borrowing and APR The total APR of this transaction is 5.646% and includes the following costs of borrowing: Cost Details Appraisal fee: $250.00 You have already paid this amount … and in Legal fees plus disbursements (this is an $1,500.00 To be deducted on closing dollars and estimate): cents Total Costs: $1,750.00 Over the term of this mortgage if all of your payments are made on time and you do not make any prepayments you will have paid $26,482.83 in principal and $61,089.57 in interest and your outstanding balance at the end of 60 payments will be $215,161.49 Chapter 18: Borrower Disclosure Borrower Disclosure Continued 421 Page 3 of 4 Brokerage Acknowledgement I, Adam Coren, a licensed mortgage agent on behalf of REMIC Mortgages Inc., have completed this disclosure document in accordance with the Mortgage Brokerages, Lenders and Administrators Act, 2006. ________________________________ Signature of Adam Coren, Broker ________________________________ Date Borrower Acknowledgement By signing below we, Noreen Borrower and Christopher Borrower acknowledge that we have read and understand this document, including the terms and conditions of this mortgage and have received an amortization schedule. We understand that this disclosure must be made at least two business days before we are asked to make a payment, enter into the mortgage agreement or incur any other obligation in relation to this proposed mortgage unless we consent in writing to waive these two business days. By waive this waiting period, or do not waive this waiting period. signing below we By signing below we further acknowledge that we understand that time is of the essence and we must meet the terms and conditions of the attached mortgage commitment letter, and will undertake to do so immediately. We understand that failure to do so may result in this mortgage approval being cancelled without recourse. We further understand that if this mortgage approval is cancelled based on my/our failure to meet the terms and conditions of this transaction that we may suffer financial harm, in which case we agree to hold harmless and indemnify REMIC Mortgages Inc. from all liability. We further acknowledge that we may obtain independent legal advice, at our own cost regarding this transaction and that REMIC Mortgages Inc. has not advised us against this. __________________________________ Signature of Noreen Borrower __________________________________ Signature of Christopher Borrower __________________________________ Date __________________________________ Date 422 Chapter 18: Borrower Disclosure Borrower Disclosure Continued Page 4 of 4 Amortization Schedule (this must be included with every Borrower Disclosure document) Loan Amount: Interest Rate: Term: Amortization: Payment Number 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 $500,000 5% 1 year 25 years Payment Date Payment Amount 03/01/2013 04/01/2013 05/01/2013 06/01/2013 07/01/2013 08/01/2013 09/01/2013 10/01/2013 11/01/2013 12/01/2013 01/01/2014 02/01/2014 $2,908.03 $2,908.03 $2,908.03 $2,908.03 $2,908.03 $2,908.03 $2,908.03 $2,908.03 $2,908.03 $2,908.03 $2,908.03 $2,908.03 Compounding Frequency: Payment Frequency: Monthly Payment: Interest Adjustment Date: Amount to Principal $846.07 $849.56 $853.06 $856.58 $860.12 $863.66 $867.22 $870.80 $874.39 $878.00 $881.62 $885.25 Cumulative Principal $846.07 $1,695.63 $2,548.69 $3,405.27 $4,265.39 $5,129.05 $5,996.27 $6,867.07 $7,741.46 $8,619.46 $9,501.08 $10,386.33 Amount to Interest $2,061.95 $2,058.47 $2,054.97 $2,051.45 $2,047.91 $2,044.37 $2,040.81 $2,037.23 $2,033.64 $2,030.03 $2,026.41 $2,022.78 Semi‐Annual Monthly $2,908.03 February 26, 2013 Cumulative Interest Balance $2,061.95 $4,120.42 $6,175.39 $8,226.84 $10,274.75 $12,319.12 $14,359.93 $16,397.16 $18,430.80 $20,460.83 $22,487.24 $24,510.02 $499,153.93 $498,304.37 $497,451.31 $496,594.73 $495,734.61 $494,870.95 $494,003.73 $493,132.93 $492,258.54 $491,380.54 $490,498.91 $489,613.66 Chapter 18: Borrower Disclosure 18.4 Borrower Disclosure Checklist The following checklist can be used to assist in developing borrower disclosure form(s). Figure 99 – Borrower Disclosure Checklist Does our disclosure form(s) include: All fees and payments associated with the mortgage, including brokerage fees? The nature of the relationship between the brokerage and lender? The role of the brokerage? The number of lenders the brokerage represented during the previous year? Any potential conflicts of interest? The risks associated with the mortgage? The terms and conditions of the proposed mortgage, including prepayment penalties and NSF fees? The cost of borrowing expressed as an APR? The cost of borrowing expressed in dollars and cents? Good faith estimates for costs unknown at the time of disclosure? The amount of the mortgage? The interest rate of the mortgage and how it is compounded? The amount of each mortgage payment and when it is due? An amortization schedule? Information on any optional services, such as a home warranty or other insurance? Costs associated with discharging the mortgage? Any other items covered by the MBLAA and its Regulations and/or any items we want disclosed to our borrowers? List below: ______________________________________________________________ ______________________________________________________________ ______________________________________________________________ 423 424 Chapter 18: Borrower Disclosure 18.5 Summary Proper disclosure to borrowers, investors and lenders is vital to ensuring that they are aware of all of the risks, potential conflicts of interest, costs, rights and obligations and other important information associated with a proposed mortgage so that they can make an informed decision about the transaction. The brokerage is responsible for providing this disclosure in all transactions and will be held accountable even in cases where a broker or agent was at fault for improper or non‐compliant disclosure. To make certain that compliant disclosure is made in every transaction requires the brokerage to have the policies and procedures in place to adequately supervise all of its brokers/agents and oversee all transactions in which anyone acting on its behalf is involved in. Full disclosure to borrowers, lenders and investors will assist in limiting misunderstandings that can potentially lead to complaints being lodged against the brokerage with FSCO. It can also ensure that the borrowers fully understand the risks associated with the proposed mortgage and that it is suitable for them based on their needs and circumstances. Full disclosure to investors/lenders will assist in preventing them from investing in mortgages that have a higher level of risk than they are prepared to accept and ensure that they fully understand the risks and rewards associated with the proposed investment, allowing them to make an informed decision. Full disclosure is not only necessary for the purposes of compliance, but necessary to ensure that a brokerage’s borrowers, lenders and investors are satisfied customers, thereby providing an ongoing source of borrowers and investment funds that can assist the brokerage in its success and in maintaining its good reputation. As Warren Buffet once said, “It takes 20 years to build a reputation and five minutes to ruin it. If you think about that, you'll do things differently.” Chapter 18: Borrower Disclosure 425 18.6 Key Terms and Definitions Conflict of Interest A brokerage, broker or agent with a direct or indirect interest in the mortgage being arranged resulting in a situation where the broker/agent must choose between his or her best interests and the interests of his or her borrower, investor or lender, as the case may be Cost of borrowing The MBLAA defines the cost of borrowing as “the interest or discount applicable to the mortgage; any amount charged in connection with the mortgage that is payable by the borrower to the brokerage or lender; any amount charged in connection with the mortgage that is payable by the borrower to a person other than the brokerage or lender, where the amount is chargeable, directly or indirectly, by the person to the brokerage or lender, and; any charge prescribed as included in the cost of borrowing, but does not include any charge prescribed as excluded from the cost of borrowing. It must be disclosed as either a percentage or in dollars and cents depending on the disclosure requirements of the Regulations.” Disclosure The act of making something evident. There are several disclosure requirements mandated by the MBLAA and its Regulations with relation to a mortgage being recommended to a borrower, investor or lender by a brokerage. Disclosure Form A form, prescribed or otherwise, used to provide disclosure to a borrower, lender or investor, as the case may be, in accordance with the MBLAA and its Regulations Fees and Payments This phrase is used to describe all payments involved in arranging a mortgage transaction, excluding repayment of the mortgage Relationship between brokerage and lender This phrase is used to describe the nature of the relationship between the brokerage and lender, specifically if there is any relationship other than an arm’s length relationship between the two. This information must be disclosed to every potential borrower. Risk A concept that identifies the borrower’s or investor’s acceptable level of risk. There are two fundamental requirements when considering risk: understanding the borrower’s or investor’s general level of acceptable risk and disclosing the specific risks associated with the mortgage being recommended by the broker/agent Role of the brokerage This phrase is used to describe the nature of a brokerage’s relationship with borrowers and lenders, specifically on whose behalf the brokerage is acting, and must be disclosed in every mortgage transaction 426 Chapter 18: Borrower D Disclosure 18.7 7 SAMPL LE BORR ROWER DISCLOSU D URE - FIL LOGIX Chapter 18: Borrower D isclosure 42 27 428 Chapter 18: Borrower D Disclosure 18.8 8 Review w Questio ons Answers to the Revview Questio ons are found at www.REM MIC.ca True e or Fals e Questi ons 1. On ne of the things that must be disclosed to the borrow wer is the role of the brokerage. he relationship between the brokeragee and the borrower must b be included in n 2. The nature of th the e disclosure document d to the t borrowerr. 3. A brokerage b fee e must be disclosed to the borrower annd included in n the cost of b borrowing. a its Regula ations a borroower disclosu ure documentt should statee 4. To comply with the MBLAA and “re efer to the len nder’s commitment’ to dissclose the lennder’s terms aand condition ns. 5. If a prospective mortgage waas default inssured by CMH HC, the insuraance fee would have to be inccluded in the cost of borro owing. 6. Law wyer’s fees, excluding e disb bursements, must m be incluuded in the co ost of borrow wing. Sho ort Answe er Questio ons 1. Lisst the types off informationn (e.g., risks) that t must be included in a borrower dissclosure form m. 2. Explain the timiing requiremeents of providding disclosurre to a borrow wer. 3. Lisst the specific costs that must be included when calcculating the cost of borrow wing. 4. Hoow must the cost c of borrow wing be expre essed in a borrrower disclo osure form? 5. Whhen or under what circumstances woulld a broker noot have to suppply his or heer borrower witth a borrower disclosure form? f Chapter 19:: Closing the TTransaction 42 29 Ch hapter 19: 1 Clo osing thhe Trannsactionn Lea arning Outccomes Succcessful undersstanding of th he concepts presented p in tthis chapter w will enable the learner to: Liist common closing c costs Estimate comm mon closing costs c Explain how documents related to the transaction arre electronicaally registeredd Suummarize thee lawyer’s tassks in a purchase transacti on with a moortgage, a salee transaction an nd a standalo one mortgage e transaction Explain the steeps involved in closing a mortgage m tran saction Explain the intterest adjustm ment date (IA AD) Calculate C an in nterest adjusttment payme ent Intro oduction erly preparingg the borrowe er for the clossing process iis a step that can be overlo ooked by the Prope new mortgage m age ent, resulting in confusion on the part oof the borrow wer and/or thee borrower’s failure e to have ade equate funds to pay the clo osing costs. In thiss chapter, the e closing proccess will be discussed, com mmon closing costs will be described an nd the lawyer’s role in n the closing process will be b explained. By understaanding this process, the mortggage agent caan advise his or o her client on o what to exxpect, thereb by reducing orr removing th he confu usion and stre ess experience ed by the borrrower. 19.1 1 Estimating Clos sing Costts Before a transactio on can close, it is vital thatt the borroweer understand d and be prep pared for the closin ng costs assocciated with th he transaction n. Failure to pprepare for th hese costs haas caused manyy transactionss to be cancelled at the law wyer’s office bbecause the b borrower did not have thee fundss to close. The exact amou unt required by b the borrow wer on closingg differs baseed on the typee of transaction, butt a mortgage agent should ensure that tthe borrowerr has between 1.5% and 3% off the purchase e price set aside for closing costs. To e stimate the ccosts involved d in closing, the mortgage m agen nt should advvise the borro ower of comm mon closing co osts. Com mmon Clo osing Cos sts Mortggage Default Insurance Depending on the amount of th he mortgage and a the downn payment, th his number w will vary. While the de efault insuran nce premium is typically in ncluded in thee mortgage, tthe PST chargged on this be payable on premium is not. When W calculatting the premium, note thee amount of PPST that will b closin ng. 430 Chapter 19:: Closing the TTransaction hase Land Transfer Tax (LTT) ‐ purch If the transaction is a purchase,, the buyer must have fundds for the lan nd transfer taxx. This tax is calcullated based on o the following formula (tthe percentagges are calcullated on the aamount of the purch hase price thaat falls within each categorry): Land Transsfer Tax Pu urchase Price e of the Prope erty On th he first $55,00 00 0.5% % On th he excess between $55,000 ‐ $250,000 1% oof the excess amount On th he excess between $250,000 ‐ $400,000 1.5% % of the excesss amount On th he excess ove er $400,000 2% oof the excess amount Example If the purchase price were $300 0,000, the Lan nd Transfer Taax would be ccalculated as follows: $250,000 ‐ $55,000 $ = $195,000 $ The T first $55,000 $ ($55,00 00 x .005) + Value of $30 00,000 ‐ $250,000 = $ $50,000 ($19 95,000 x .01) + 015) ($50,000 x .0 = $275 + $1,950 + $7750 = $2,975 City of o Toronto Mu unicipal Land d Transfer Taxx (MLTT) In add dition to the provincial p LTTT, the City of Toronto T introoduced the fo ollowing tax that must be added d to the LTT as a of Februaryy, 2008. First time purchassers can receeive a rebate o on this tax up p to $3,,725.00. In th he above note ed example this is not a firrst time purch hase so the M MLTT would add an additional $2,725 $ to the e LTT for a tottal payable off $5,700. Pu urchase Price of the Prope erty Land Transsfer Tax On th he first $55,00 00 0.5% % On th he excess between $55,000 ‐ $400,000 1% oof the excess amount On th he excess ove er $400,000 2% oof the excess amount Chapter 19: Closing the Transaction 431 Home Inspection ‐ Purchase While prices vary, this cost can be estimated at between $250 and $300 Appraisal Fee While some lenders will waive the appraisal fee or reimburse the fee on closing, it is important to advise the borrower of the typical charge which ranges from $250 to $300. Though the borrower may have to pay this fee before the transaction closes, it should be considered by the borrower since it may reduce the amount that he or she has for closing costs. Legal Fees Legal fees associated with closing will vary depending on whether the transaction is a purchase or a refinance or equity take‐out. In April, 2007 the Working Group on Lawyers and Real Estate, comprised of the Ontario Bar Association, the County and District Law Presidents Association and the Ontario Real Estate Lawyers Association published a “Suggested Fee Schedule for Residential Real Estate Transactions” that suggests fees for transactions of average complexity. The following is an interpretation of those suggestions and may or may not accurately reflect the Working Group’s current or future opinions. The suggested fees are based on the following formulas: Purchase of a Residential Property with One Mortgage Purchase Price of the Property Fees On the first $100,000 $850 On the excess between $100,000 ‐ $300,000 0.5% of the excess amount On the excess over $300,000 0.25% of the excess amount These fees are based on completing the following tasks: Purchaser’s Solicitor for reviewing executed agreement of purchase and sale (but not including negotiating or drafting agreement) and advising Investigating title and checking the description Making requisitions on title and on other matters recited in the agreement Searching the arrears of realty and all other taxes and rates constituting statutory liens Advising on the applicability of GST legislation Searching for executions Searching for work orders Discussing with the purchaser all matters relating to title, zoning and statement of adjustments Reviewing and executing mortgage instructions Advising the client concerning insurance requirements Advising the client with respect to Rule 2.02(10)‐(13) of the Law Society of Upper Canada and options for assuring title, including Solicitor’s Opinion Letter and title insurance where appropriate for rural properties 432 Chapter 19: Closing the Transaction Advising client with respect to road access, shore allowance, septic issues, water potability and well issues Where appropriate advising the purchaser regarding Tarion warranties and claim periods Attending on execution of documents Attending to the closing Giving opinion on title or securing Title Insurance policy Reporting within 30 days of closing and all other required services. Purchase/Sale of a Residential Property with no mortgage Sale Price of the Property Fees (based on 66% of a Purchase transaction) On the first $100,000 $560 On the excess between $100,000 ‐ $300,000 0.33% of the excess amount On the excess over $300,000 0.165% of the excess amount These fees are based on the completion of the following tasks: Vendor’s Solicitor for reviewing executed agreement of purchase and sale (but not including negotiating or drafting agreement) and advising Preparing transfer, answering requisitions on title Preparing Statement of Adjustments and advising Advising on the applicability of GST legislation Advising on the applicability of any non‐resident taxes Reviewing charge taken back (if any) Attending on execution of documentation Attending to the closing and completing the sale Reporting to client and all other required services. In the case of a condominium unit, if required, supplying or arranging for copies of condominium status certificate and related documents, including the declaration, by‐laws, management contract, insurance trust agreement, and up‐to‐date insurance certificate. Registration of a Mortgage Only The amount to register a mortgage is recommended to be $650.00, subject to adjustment for the time spent, the complexity of the transaction, the amount involved, the result obtained and the requirements of the lender and any title insurer involved. There are also several tasks that a lawyer may be requested to perform in addition to the average transactions as listed above. Additional tasks will likely result in additional fees. Title Insurance Title Insurance typically costs between $200 and $300, depending on the type of policy, the property type and the value of the property. Chapter 19: Closing the Transaction 433 Property Insurance Depending on the type of coverage, this amount ranges. An average of $50 per month is appropriate under most circumstances. Interest Adjustment Amount The interest adjustment amount is an amount payable to a lender for the period of time that mortgage proceeds are held by the borrower before the period covered by the first mortgage payment. This amount will vary based on the mortgage’s interest rate and the number of days between the mortgage advance and the interest adjustment date. New Home Warranty Tarion, the new name for the Ontario New Home Warranty Program, regulates the home building industry in Ontario. Tarion steps in to protect consumers when builders fail to complete purchase agreements and construction contracts or fail to fulfill their mandatory warranty obligations in the Ontario New Home Warranties Plan Act. Tarion pays claims to consumers. The builder and/or vendor pays the warranty enrolment fee to Tarion before construction and will either include it in the purchase price of the home or show it as a separate item on the Statement of Adjustments. The fee ranges from $325 to $750 based on the sale price. (More information can be found by visiting www.tarion.com) New Hydro Account If the purchaser has not had hydro in his or her name before a deposit of $200 will likely be required. Status Certificate Fee – Condominiums only (previously referred to as an Estoppel certificate) The common fee is $100. Closing Adjustment An estimate should be made for closing adjustments for bills that the seller has prepaid such as property taxes, utility bills, and other charges. The borrower’s lawyer will inform him or her of the exact amounts once the appropriate searches have been completed. HST (formerly the GST) On a new home, HST is charged; however, the builder may include it in the purchase price. If it is not included, it must be paid on closing. In addition, there is an HST rebate applicable to new homes, substantially renovated homes, and modular and mobile homes for which an application must be completed. More information on the HGST rebate can be found at Canada Revenue Agency at www.cra.gc.ca. PST on Default Insurance In Ontario there is still 8% PST (not HST) payable on the premium. For example, a CMHC fee of $10,000 would result in a tax of $800.1 The following is an example of the potential closing costs associated with a sample transaction. 1 CMHC, How much does CMHC loan insurance cost? http://www.cmhc‐ schl.gc.ca/en/co/moloin/moloin_005.cfm 434 Chapter 19:: Closing the TTransaction Example Bob and a Mary are purchasing a resale, single e family detacched home fo or $420,000 in Barrie, Ontarrio and are pu utting $37,800 (9%) down.. The CMHC ppremium at 991% LTV is 3.6 6% of the $382,200 mortgage, or $13,759 9.20. They are moving in 110 days beforre the end of the month. This means m that th here will be 10 0 days of inte erest, which iss the interestt adjustment, required on closin ng. The closin ng costs for th his transaction n may be appproximately: Item Appraaisal Fee – not required on n this CMHC in nsured mortggage Closin ng Adjustmen nts (as per the e lawyer) HST – not applicab ble as this is not a new hom me Statuss Certificate Fee F – not a co ondominium Home e Inspection Intere est Adjustmen nt (based on 10 days at J2=6%) Land Transfer T Tax – LTT only as not in the GTTA Legal Fees New Home H Warran nty – this is a resale home New Hydro H Accoun nt Prope erty Insurance e – first montth’s premium payment PST on CMHC Prem mium @ 8% Title Insurance Total ounded) Cost (all ro $0 0 $35 50 $0 0 $0 0 $30 00 $64 41 $4,875 $2,150 $0 0 $20 00 $50 0 $1,101 $25 50 $9,917 or 2.3 36% of the purchasee price Su uccess Tip – Closing Cost Workksheet Prrovide your client with a Cllosing Cost Worksheet W (Apppendix 3) an nd prepare him or her at the initial consultation for th he costs involved. It is besst to know up p front if yourr client is go oing to have troubles t getting cash to paay the closingg costs. This ccan assist you u in de etermining the mortgage product p that best b suits youur client’s neeeds as well ass helping the cliient make an informed decision on the house that hhe or she is ab bout to purch hase. The od dds of losing a client at closing due to a lack of fundss will be greattly reduced, w which will he elp you close more businesss! 19.2 2 Electro onic Land d Registra ation Electrronic Land Registration (e‐‐reg) is a syste em that has rrevolutionized d the way doccuments are produ uced and registered in Onttario. The 200 0‐year‐old paaper‐based syystem was rep placed by e‐ reg, a completely electronic, e paaperless syste em where doccuments are ccreated, regisstered and wareh housed in an electronic format. The system containns records for over 5.7 milllion parcels of land in Ontario. Produ uced and mod dified online, these docum ments do not hhave to be prrinted on pap per to be legal. Registtration is com mpleted electrronically, elim minating the nneed for regisstering docum ments at a Land Registry Officce. Chapter 19: Closing the Transaction 435 The province of Ontario, through the Province of Ontario Land Registration Information System (POLARIS), in partnership with Teranet Land Information Services Inc., a private sector corporation created in 1991, has developed e‐reg. 1994 saw the provincial legislature pass legislation creating the statutory framework for e‐reg, and Teranet has developed the software, called Teraview, used to access and use the e‐reg system. The first electronic land registration occurred on January 25, 1999 in London in the county of Middlesex. Transfers, charges, discharges, and other conveyancing documents are prepared by the lawyer or a person authorized on his or her behalf, using a computer. These documents are completed and electronically signed by the lawyers involved in the transaction, not by the client. However, client authorization is required to allow this process to occur. This authorization is generated by the client signing an Acknowledgement and Direction document that the lawyer must keep on file. In a purchase transaction, a Document Registration Agreement (DRA) is completed by both the vendor’s lawyer and the purchaser’s lawyer. This document allows the lawyers to handle the client’s documents and funds and by signing this document, both lawyers agree to undertake their professional obligations as to the handling of these documents and funds. Before the documents are registered, the lawyers involved in the transaction must show their approval of these documents by signing for completeness. In so doing, all lawyers agree that the documents meet their clients’ requirements, are accurate and ready to be registered. Through Teraview, the lawyer can complete the following pre‐closing and closing procedures: Automated title searching Writ searching Subsearching Creation of drafts and documents ready to be registered Calculation and payment of land transfer taxes Electronic registration of documents, as well as other procedures. As of 2012 there are approximately 2 million annual transactions done electronically, representing over 99% of registrations in Ontario. The result has been and continues to be a streamlined process that saves time and simplifies the process of land registration in Ontario. 19.3 The Closing Process The following is a brief description of the process involved in closing a mortgage transaction and includes the steps involved in the purchase of a property with a mortgage. This process begins where an agent’s involvement typically ends, although it is in the agent’s best interests to be aware of how the process is progressing to ensure that the mortgage does in fact close. Once the agent has met all of the lender’s conditions, the process is in the hands of the lender, the lawyer and the borrower. 1. The purchaser’s lender is satisfied that all conditions have been met 2. Client or lender decides on which lawyer to use 436 Chapter 19:: Closing the TTransaction h been don ne earlier in the t process. It is always b est to have th he lawyer This step may have chosen early in the process so s that as soo on as the lendder is satisfied d that all conditions have been met it can n proceed to the t next step. Certain lenders will have a specific lawyer they wish too use to closee the transacttion, while oth hers will allow w the client to o use his or her own lawyeer. If the client uses his orr her own law wyer it is impo ortant to note that this law wyer is worki ng for the len nder, and while the lawyerr has a responsib bility to provid de disclosure to the client,, his or her main responsib bility is to thee nder. len 3. The lender send ds the closingg lawyer an “Instructions too Solicitor” p ackage This package co ommonly contains: A copyy of the lende er’s mortgage e approval The lender’s disclossure statement or’s Final Rep port and Certiificate of Titlee document ffor the lawyerr to fill in Solicito Solicito or’s Interim Report R and Re equisition for Funds docum ment for the llawyer to fill in uthorized Deb bit Form Pre‐au Acknowledgement and Direction n Instrucctions on the requirementts for title‐ins ured mortgagges and non ttitle‐insured mortgages nits, proof of Requirrements regarding propertty insurance, surveys, condominium un identitty, etc. In addition, if th he lender is prohibiting seccondary finanncing such as a vendor takke‐back or a 2ndd mortgage, the lawyer is required r to in nform the len der if he or s he becomes aaware of any seccondary finan ncing. This may cause the transaction tto be cancelleed. wyer meets with w the client 4. Law The lawyer perfforms due diligence such as a obtaining pproof of identtity in the forrm of photo ID D, and has the clie ent sign the Acknowledgem A ment and Direection (see th he Appendix ffor a sample Acknowledgment and Directtion). This do ocument allow ws the lawyerr to act on thee client’s behalf, register documents electronically e and includess authorizatio on to use the Document Re egistration Agreement (DRA A) (see the Appendix for a sample DRA A). The DRA aallows Solicitors to excchange docum ments, cheques, and keys before closing. 5. The purchaser’ss lawyer prep pares and sends documentts The purchaser’ss lawyer prep pares a draft e‐reg e deed, p erforms the rrequired seaarches/subse earches in POLARIS, and se ends a Requis ition letter to o the vendor’s lawyer. Pa ause for cllarification n ‐ Subsearrch A subsearch is an update off a previously completed fuull search, co mmonly perfformed on be ehalf of a purchaser by his or her lawye er immediatelly prior to reggistration of a transfer, and d on n behalf of mo ortgagees immediately prior to the reggistration of a mortgage. A subsearch typically consists of perform ming searches on the title o of the main property and ad djoining prope erties for easements, restrrictive covenaants, etc., as well as execu ution searches, ch hattel searche es and other land‐related searches. s Chapter 19: Closing the Transaction 437 6. The vendor’s lawyer receives documents The vendor’s lawyer receives the Requisition letter, reviews the e‐reg deed, and confirms use of the DRA by responding to the purchaser’s lawyer. 7. The purchaser’s lawyer receives documents The purchaser’s lawyer receives a response to the Requisition letter, updates the e‐reg deed if necessary, and finalizes the registration documents. 8. The vendor’s lawyer sends the purchaser’s lawyer the closing documents 9. The purchaser’s lawyer requests funds from the purchaser’s lender 10. The lender sends funds to or deposits funds into the purchasing lawyer’s trust account 11. The purchaser’s lawyer sends documents and closing funds to the vendor’s lawyer 12. The vendor’s lawyer receives all documents and monies 13. The purchaser’s lawyer registers the discharge/cessation of mortgage, transfer/deed, charge/mortgage and advises the vendor’s lawyer of registration 14. The vendor’s lawyer releases funds and documents and sends money to the original lender to discharge the current mortgage (if applicable) 15. The purchaser obtains keys, garage door opener, security codes, etc. 16. The purchaser’s lawyer advises the Tax and Assessment departments and condominium corporation (if applicable) of the change of ownership 17. The purchaser’s lawyer reports to the title insurer and remits the premium (if applicable) 18. The purchaser’s lawyer sends closing reports to the vendor’s lawyer, the lender and the new homeowner 19. The lender remits insurance premium to the mortgage default insurer (if applicable) 20. The lender sends the mortgage brokerage its finder’s fee (if applicable) 21. The mortgage brokerage pays the mortgage agent the contracted percentage of the finder’s fee 19.4 The Interest Adjustment Date (IAD) Mortgage payments are made in arrears, meaning that a monthly payment made on October 1st, for example, actually covers the payment due for the month of September. If a mortgage is funded exactly one month before the first payment, the first payment will cover the principal and interest due for that month exactly. However, if the mortgage is advanced on August 15th, for example, and the repayments are monthly on the first of every month, the first regularly scheduled monthly payment must begin on October 1st. Therefore, the first monthly payment 438 Chapter 19: Closing the Transaction will only pay the principal and interest due from September 1st until October 1st. This leaves interest due from the date of advance to the period exactly one month before the first payment. In this example, the borrower would have the mortgage proceeds from August 15th until September 1st without paying interest on those funds. The due date for the payment of this interest is referred to as the Interest Adjustment Date. The borrower is advised by the lender of this amount, normally by letter or by the lawyer closing the transaction, and a cheque is due on that date. Some lenders will deduct the amount of this interest on the date of closing, saving the borrower the aggravation of having to make an additional payment. However, if all of the mortgage proceeds are required on closing, the borrower can pay the interest adjustment on the interest adjustment date. With flexible mortgage repayment dates, a payment may be set up to be made exactly one month after closing. However, a borrower may prefer the payment to be set at the beginning, middle, or end of the month based on his or her specific budget. If the mortgage is advanced at any time greater than a month before the first payment, an interest adjustment payment is required. The same is true for any other payment frequency. For example, if the payment is weekly and the mortgage is advanced ten days before the first payment, there is an interest adjustment amount payable. When an interest adjustment payment is calculated, the term and amortization of the mortgage are not involved. The following calculation demonstrates calculating an interest adjustment payment using the HP10BII financial calculator. Please note that the following calculation is an advanced calculation and will not be included in the course’s final exam. Example 1 Mr. Borrower is receiving a mortgage for $250,000 on August 15th. The mortgage bears interest at a rate of 6% per year, compounded semi‐annually, not in advance. The mortgage has monthly payments that begin on October 1st. What is the amount of the interest adjustment payment due on September 1st? Solution Although this mortgage has a 5‐year term amortized over 25 years, these facts are not used in calculating the interest adjustment payment. N The first step is to determine the number of days between the mortgage advance date and the interest adjustment date. The day of the advance is always included in this calculation. Therefore, the interest adjustment date is August 31 (since there are thirty‐one days in August) and the mortgage was advanced on August 15th, the calculation is: 31 (Interest adjustment date) – 15 (date of advance) = 16 + 1 (the day of the advance) = 17 You can also look at this as the number of days before the first payment. That is 16 as the first payment is on the 17th. One is added to sixteen in this example to include the actual date of the advance, September 17th. This number will be used as N. P/YR Chapter 19: Closing the Transaction 439 This calculation will be used to accrue interest on the mortgage proceeds from August 15th for a period of seventeen days. Since the frequency of the compounding is daily and the contracted interest rate is semi‐annually, the interest must be converted to its daily equivalent. Therefore, the interest rate must be converted to its J365 equivalent. PV The mortgage amount advanced on August 15th will be inputted as the present value (PV) and will accrue interest for seventeen days. PMT Since there are no payments made during the seventeen days in which interest is accruing, the payment must be entered as zero. FV The unknown in this transaction is the future value (FV). Once this amount is calculated, the mortgage advance is deducted from it and the remaining amount is the interest adjustment payment. Therefore, the calculation is as follows: 6 SHIFT NOM% 2 SHIFT P/YR SHIFT EFF% 6.09 365 SHIFT P/YR SHIFT NOM% 5.91223922637 250,000 +/‐ PV 17 N 0 PMT FV 250,689.304206 Therefore, there will be $250,689.30 outstanding as of September 1st. To determine the amount of interest payable, the original mortgage advance must be subtracted from the current balance and the difference paid to the lender as the interest adjustment amount. $250,689.30 ‐ $250,000 = $689.30 Therefore, on September 1st the borrower must pay $689.30 to the lender. 440 Chapter 19: Closing the Transaction Example 2 The lender is advancing a mortgage for $250,000 on August 15th, at a rate of J2=6% with weekly payments and a 20 year amortization. If the first weekly payment begins on August 27th, what is the interest adjustment date and how much interest is payable on that date? Solution The interest adjustment date is August 20th, since the first payment is on August 27th and will cover the period between August 21st up to August 27th. 20 (Interest adjustment date) – 15 (date of advance) + 1 (day of advance) = 6 6 SHIFT NOM% 2 SHIFT P/YR SHIFT EFF% 6.09 365 SHIFT P/YR SHIFT NOM% 5.91223922637 250,000 +/‐ PV 6N 0 PMT FV 250,243.067146 $250,243.07 ‐ $250,000 = $243.07 Therefore, the interest adjustment payment due on the interest adjustment date is $243.07. If the interest adjustment date is set at the same time of advance, then the interest adjustment payment is deducted from the mortgage proceeds. The calculation for determining this amount is slightly different. In both cases, the outstanding balance, exactly one payment before the first payment is due, must be the face value of the mortgage (the amount the borrower is contracted to repay). When the interest adjustment payment is due one payment before the start of the first regular payment, the mortgage amount advanced accrues interest until that date, at which time the accrued interest is paid, leaving an outstanding balance the same as the face value of the mortgage. When the interest is deducted from the advance, the amount received by the borrower is less than the face value of the mortgage. This amount will now accrue interest so that on the date of payment before the start of the first regular payment, the outstanding balance will be exactly equal to the face value of the mortgage contract. Chapter 19: Closing the Transaction 441 While this may appear complicated, the net result is simply switching the face value of the mortgage from the PV to the FV and solving for the PV. Using the same scenario from Example 2, consider that, instead of advancing $250,000 on August 15th, the interest adjustment payment is deducted from the advance. The method of calculating the amount of that advance is as follows: 6 SHIFT NOM% 2 SHIFT P/YR SHIFT EFF% 6.09 365 SHIFT P/YR SHIFT NOM% 5.91223922637 250,000 FV 6N O PMT PV –249,757.168951 Therefore, the amount of the advance with the interest adjustment payment deducted is $249,757.17 One final observation can be made when comparing paying the interest adjustment payment after the mortgage advance or from the mortgage advance. The actual amount of the interest adjustment payment in this scenario, when deducted from the mortgage advance on the 15th is: $250,000 ‐ $249,757.17 = $242.83 The amount of the interest adjustment payment when made on the 20th is $243.07 or a difference of $0.24. The reason there is a difference is that under the first scenario interest is accruing for six days on $250,000, while in the second scenario interest is accruing for six days on $249,757.17. Although this is hardly enough to make a borrower change when he or she wishes to make the interest adjustment payment, he or she might be curious as to why there is a difference between the two options. 442 Chapter 19: Closing the Transaction 19.5 Key Terms and Definitions Acknowledgment and Direction (A&D) The Acknowledgment and Direction, signed by the client, provides the lawyer with the authorization to electronically register documents Closing Costs The costs associated with closing a real estate and mortgage transaction Document Registration Agreement (DRA) The document, signed by the vendor’s and purchaser’s lawyers that allows for closing an electronic transaction e‐reg The gateway used to access POLARIS and create and register land titles documents electronically in Ontario Interest Adjustment Amount The interest payable to a lender for the period of time that mortgage proceeds are held by the borrower before the period covered by the first mortgage payment Interest Adjustment Date (IAD) The date that the interest adjustment payment is due Land Transfer Tax A tax payable to the Provincial Government by the purchaser of a property upon the transfer of title from a seller POLARIS Province of Ontario Land Registration Information System Solicitor’s Final Report and Certificate of Title The document sent to the lender detailing the successful mortgage transaction Teranet The province of Ontario’s private sector partner in the creation of the electronic land registration system Teraview Teranet’s software that provides access to e‐reg and POLARIS Chapter 19:: Closing the TTransaction 44 43 19.6 6 Review w Questio ons ons are found at www.REM MIC.ca Answers to the Revview Questio Sho ort Answe er Questio ons 1. Lisst the commo on closing costs associated with a purchhase of a resale home wheen a mortgagee is used u to comp plete this purcchase. 2. Wh hat might be the legal feess on a purchaase of a $750,,000 residential property? perty? nder what circcumstances iss HST charged d in the purchhase of a prop 3. Un 4. Wh hat tax is charged on the mortgage m deffault insurancce premium? 5. Lisst the pre‐clossing and closing procedure es that a lawyyer can complete using Teraview. 6. Explain the sign nificance of th he Acknowled dgement and Direction in tthe closing prrocess. 7. Wh hat purpose does d the DRA A serve? n, who remits the insurancce premium to o the title insurer? 8. In a title‐insured transaction 9. De efine the IAD. 10. Ms. M Homeown ner is receiving a mortgage e for $350,0000 on Februaryy 11th. The m mortgage bearrs intterest at a ratte of 5.4% perr year, compo ounded semi‐‐annually, no t in advance. The mo ortgage has monthly m paym ments that beggin on April 1 st. What is th he amount off the interest adjustment payyment due on n March 1st? 444 Chapter 19: Closing the Transaction Appendix 1: Acknowledgment and Direction Chapter 19: Closing the Transaction 445 446 Chapter 19:: Closing the TTransaction App pendix 2: Docume ent Registtration Ag greemen nt (DRA) Chapter 19:: Closing the T ransaction 44 47 448 Chapter 19: Closing the Transaction Appendix 3: Closing Costs Worksheet Closing Costs Worksheet Client Name(s): Item Cost Appraisal Fee Broker’s Fee and/or lender’s Fee Closing Adjustments Condominium Status Certificate Fee HST (formerly GST – on new homes only) Home Inspection Interest Adjustment (based on anticipated closing date and 1st payment date) Land Transfer Tax @ ___% of Purchase Price: $____________ New Home Warranty Legal Fees New Hydro Account Property Insurance PST on CMHC Premium @ 8% x $____________ (if applicable) Title Insurance Total $ Chapter 20: Contract Law 449 Chapter 20: Contract Law Learning Outcomes Successful understanding of the concepts presented in this chapter will enable the learner to: Explain what constitutes a valid contract Explain the types of defects that may be present in a contract Discuss the rights provided by a contract Explain the ways in which a contract may be discharged Define a breach of contract Explain the remedies available under a breach of contract Introduction Contracts form the basis of all transactions in the mortgage industry and it is therefore necessary to have a basic understanding of contract law. However, this chapter is not designed to be a replacement or substitution for a qualified legal opinion, nor should any legal decisions be based on this information. The information contained in this chapter is a general overview of contract law and therefore does not provide an exhaustive discourse on the topic. There are exceptions to every generally accepted rule or concept discussed in this chapter, as is evidenced by the number of court cases involving contract law at any given time. In any situation where the mortgage agent is requested by a client to provide his or her opinion on a legal matter, it is necessary for the mortgage agent to suggest that the client contact a lawyer. If a mortgage agent does offer advice on legal matters, the client may assume that he or she is speaking as a professional and not simply offering a personal opinion, and rely on that advice in matters of contract law. That could result in the client suffering a loss. If that occurs, the client will most likely sue the mortgage agent for the faulty advice. Since the advice was provided in a professional capacity, the client may be able to win that suit. For this reason, it is necessary for the mortgage agent to understand that a basic comprehension of contract law is helpful in his or her mortgage practice but he or she is not qualified to provide any form of legal advice, whether or not that advice is ultimately determined to be correct. 20.1 What is a Contract? Simply stated, a contract is a legally enforceable agreement made between two or more parties. Contracts are made and fulfilled every day. Going to a restaurant and having lunch is a contract. Buying a newspaper is a contract. Even when virtually instantaneously fulfilled or performed, contracts form the basis of our interactions as consumers. Contracts can be either in writing or verbal, although verbal contracts are not necessarily prudent. If two parties enter into a verbal contract it is possible that although both parties have the best of intentions, a misunderstanding or faulty remembering of the terms of the contract might result in the contract not being completed in the manner that one or both had agreed to. 450 Chapte er 20: Contra ct Law ontracts shou uld be in writiing, if for no oother reason than to ensure that both In thaat sense, all co partie es clearly understand the terms t and con nditions of thhe contract. TTake, for exam mple, a contraact of employyment. There e are several conditions in most employyment contraacts, from non‐ccompete clausses to income e consideratio ons. If this coontract was m made verballyy, it is entirelyy possib ble that one or o both partie es would simp ply forget ter ms and conditions that haad originally been agreed to. Pa ause for cla arification n – Real esttate contra racts must be in writiing Altthough verbaal contracts arre legal, contrracts for the ppurchase and d sale of real eestate must auds, Chapteer be e in writing. This T requirem ment is found in the Ontarioo legislation, Statute of Fra S.1 19, subsection 1. 20.2 2 The Ele ements of o a Valid Contractt e contract, sevveral elements must be prresent. To be considered a valid, legallyy enforceable The Offer An offfer is a promiise to do som mething. For example, e Sam mir enters a co offee shop an nd goes to thee countter where he meets Bob, who w is workin ng behind the counter selliing coffee. Saamir asks Bob b how much m a cup of coffee is. Bob tells Samir that he will sell him a cup p of coffee if Samir gives him tw wo dollars. At A this stage Bob B has made e an offer to SSamir but theere is no contrract in place becau use Samir hass not indicated his acceptance of this offfer. An offfer can be terrminated in several ways, including by tthe offeror (tthe person making the offer)) who can rescind or take back b the offer before it ha s been accep pted. It can allso be terminated by the offeree (the person accep pting the offeer) through th he process of making a countter‐offer. A counter offer occurs when the offeree rrejects the offfer and propo oses a changee to thaat original offer. Acc eptance of the Offfer Accep ptance is a pro omise to acce ept the offer. Continuing w with the prevvious examplee, if Samir tells Bob that he will pu urchase the cu up of coffee, then Samir iss telling Bob tthat he promises to acceptt the co offee and payy him the purcchase price. This exchangge of promisess completes tthe process o of an offfer and accep ptance as longg as the prom mises are for aacts that are o occurring now w or will occu ur in the e future, whetther that is tw wo minutes frrom now or tw wo years from m now. If, how wever, Bob had taken a cu up of coffee with w him ontoo the sidewalkk and had seeen Samir walkin ng and simplyy gave Samir the t cup of co offee for whattever reason (perhaps Sam mir looked likee he ne eeded a cup of o coffee) with hout Samir firrst asking for the cup of co offee, Bob cou uld not then demaand payment for that cup of o coffee. Wh hile this exam mple is simplisstic, it illustrates the fact that a contract is binding b on futture acts, nott acts that havve been comm mitted wheree no contract had existed. Chapte er 20: Contra ct Law 45 51 Inte ntion to Create a Legal Re elationsh hip The parties enterin ng into an agrreement musst intend to foorm a legally binding agreeement. If onee party does not perrform his or her h promise, the t other partty may seek a remedy from m the courts.. Although the exam mple of Bob and Samir migght not appeaar to meet this test, upon ccloser inspection it will. Bob B fully expects that he will w be paid foor the coffee once it has been provided d to Sam mir. If Samir does not do so, s Bob has le egal recourse . Although th he odds of seeing a Bob and Samir in court contesting th he purchase of o a cup of cooffee are slim, the fact rem mains that Bob b expeccts to be paid. If Bob did not n expect to be paid or if he had a reassonable doub bt as to wheth her he would be paid, he would w not be creating a leggal relationsh hip between h himself and Samirr. He would also a not likelyy be in business for much loonger. n the approacch that moral or social agreeements lackk the intention